Skip to main content

Full text of "Extraordinary Encounters"

See other formats


EXTRAORDINARY 

ENCOUNTERS 


EXTRAORDINARY 

ENCOUNTERS 

An  Encyclopedia  of  Extraterrestrials 
and  Otherworldly  Beings 

Jerome  Clark 


ABC-CLIO 

Santa  Barbara,  California 
Denver,  Colorado 
Oxford,  England 


Copyright  ©  2000  by  Jerome  Clark 

All  rights  reserved.  No  part  of  this  publication  may  be  reproduced,  stored  in  a  retrieval  system,  or  transmitted,  in 
any  form  or  by  any  means,  electronic,  mechanical,  photocopying,  recording,  or  otherwise,  except  for  the  inclusion  of 
brief  quotations  in  a  review,  without  prior  permission  in  writing  from  the  publishers. 


Library  of  Congress  Cataloging-in-Publication  Data 
Clark,  Jerome. 

Extraordinary  encounters  :  an  encyclopedia  of  extraterrestrials  and 
otherworldly  beings  /  Jerome  Clark, 
p.  cm. 

Includes  bibliographical  references  and  index. 

ISBN  1-57607-249-5  (hardcover  :  alk.  paper) — ISBN  1-57607-379-3  (e-book) 
1.  Human-alien  encounters — Encyclopedias.  I.  Title. 

BF2050.C57  2000 

001.942’03— dc21  00-011350 

CIP 

06  05  04  03  02  01  00  10  9  8  7  6  5  4  3  2  1 

ABC-CLIO,  Inc. 

130  Cremona  Drive,  P.O.  Box  1911 
Santa  Barbara,  California  93116-1911 

This  book  is  printed  on  acid-free  paper  (§). 

Manufactured  in  the  United  States  of  America. 


To  Dakota  Dave  Hull  and  John  Sherman, 
for  the  many  years  of  friendship,  laughs,  and — always — good  music 


Contents 


Introduction,  xi 


EXTRAORDINARY  ENCO  UNTERS: 

AN  ENCYCLOPEDIA  OF  EXTRATERRESTRIALS 
AND  OTHERWORLDLY  BEINGS 


A,  1 

Abductions  by  UFOs,  1 
Abraham,  7 
Abram,  7 
Adama,  7 

Adamski,  George  (1891-1965),  8 

Aenstrians,  10 

Aetherius,  11 

Affa,  12 

Agents,  13 

Agharti,  13 

Ahab,  15 

Akon,  15 

Alien  diners,  16 

Alien  DNA,  17 

Aliens  and  the  dead,  18 

Allinghams  Martian,  19 

Alpha  Zoo  Loo,  19 

Alyn,  20 

Ameboids,  21 

Andolo,  21 

Andra-o-leeka  and  Mondra-o-leeka,  21 


Angel  of  the  Dark,  22 

Angelucci,  Orfeo  (1912-1993),  22 

Anoah,  23 

Anthon,  24 

Antron,  24 

Anunnaki,  24 

Apol,  Mr.,  25 

Arna  and  Parz,  26 

Artemis,  26 

Ascended  Masters,  27 

Ashtar,  27 

Asmitor,  29 

Athena,  30 

Atlantis,  31 

Aura  Rhanes,  34 

Aurora  Martian,  34 

Ausso,  35 

Avinash,  36 

Ayala,  36 

Azelia,  37 

Back,  39 

Bartholomew,  39 


vii 


viii  Contents 


Bashar,  39 

Being  of  Light,  40 

Bermuda  Triangle,  41 

Bethurum,  Truman  (1898-1969),  43 

Bird  aliens,  44 

Birmingham’s  ark,  44 

Blowing  Cave,  43 

Bonnie,  47 

Boys  from  Topside,  47 
Brodies  deros,  48 
Brown’s  Martians,  50 
Bucky,  51 

Buff  Ledge  abduction,  52 
Bunians,  53 
Calf-rustling  aliens,  55 
Captive  extraterrestrials,  57 
Cetaceans,  58 
Chaneques,  58 
Channeling,  59 
Chief  Joseph,  61 
Christopher,  61 
Chung  Fu,  61 

Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind,  62 

Cocoon  people,  67 

Contactees,  68 

Cosmic  Awareness,  72 

Cottingley  fairies,  73 

The  Council,  75 

Curry,  75 

Cyclopeans,  76 

Cymatrili,  76 

David  of  Landa,  79 

Dead  extraterrestrials,  81 

Dentons’s  Martians  and  Venusians,  87 

Diane,  87 

Divine  Fire,  88 

Dual  reference,  88 

Dugj  a,  90 

Earth  Coincidence  Control  Office,  91 

Elder  Race,  92 

Elvis  as  Jesus,  92 

Emmanuel,  93 

Eunethia,  94 

Extraterrestrial  biological  entities,  94 
Extraterrestrials  among  us,  95 
Fairies  encountered,  99 
Fairy  captures,  103 
Fossilized  aliens,  104 


Fourth  dimension,  104 

Frank  and  Frances,  105 

Fry,  Daniel  William  (1908-1922),  105 

Gabriel,  107 

Gef,  107 

Germane,  111 

Goblin  Universe,  111 

Gordon,  111 

Gray  Face,  112 

Great  Mother,  113 

Great  White  Brotherhood,  114 

Greater  Nibiruan  Council,  115 

Grim  Reaper,  115 

Gyeorgos  Ceres  Hatonn,  117 

Hierarchal  Board,  119 

Holloman  aliens,  119 

Hollow  earth,  121 

Honor,  123 

Hopkins,  Budd  (1931-  ),  124 
Hopkins’s  Martians,  125 
Hweig,  125 
Hybrid  beings,  126 
Imaginal  beings,  129 
Insectoids,  130 

Intelligences  from  Beyond  (Intelligences 
Dehors),  130 
Ishkomar,  130 
J.W.,  133 

Jahrmin  and  Jana,  133 

Janus,  134 

Jerhoam,  135 

Jessup’s  “little  people,”  135 

Jinns,  135 

Joseph,  136 

Kantarians,  139 

Kappa,  139 

Karen,  140 

Karmic  Board,  140 

Kazik,  14 1 

Keel,  John  Alva  (1930-  ),  142 

Khauga,  143 

Kihief,  143 

King  Leo,  144 

Korton,  145 

Kronin,  145 

Kuran,  145 

Kurmos,  146 

KwanTi  Laslo,  146 


Contents  ix 


Laan-Deeka  and  Sharanna,  149 

Lady  of  Pluto,  150 

Land  beyond  the  Pole,  151 

Lanello,  153 

Laskon,  154 

Lazaris,  154 

Lemuria,  155 

Lethbridge’s  aeronauts,  1 57 

Li  Sung,  158 

Linn-Erri,  158 

Luno,  159 

Lyrans,  160 

Mafu,  161 

Magonia,  161 

Marian  apparitions,  162 

Mark,  165 

Martian  bees,  166 

Mary,  166 

Meier,  Eduard  “Billy”  (1937-  ),  167 

Me-leelah,  169 

Melora,  170 

Men  in  black,  170 

Menger,  Howard  (1922-  ),  172 

Merk,  173 

Mersch,  173 

Metatron,  173 

Michael,  174 

Michigan  giant,  175 

Migrants,  175 

Mince-Pie  Martians,  175 

Miniature  pilots,  177 

Monka,  177 

Mothman,  178 

Mount  Lassen,  179 

Mount  Shasta,  181 

Mr.  X,  184 

MU  the  Mantis  Being,  184 
Muller’s  Martians,  185 
Noma,  187 
Nordics,  187 
Nostradamus,  188 
Octopus  aliens,  191 
Ogatta,  191 
OINTS,  192 
Old  Hag,  192 
Oleson’s  giants,  194 
Olliana  Olliana  Alliano,  195 
Orthon,  195 


Oxalc,  196 
Oz  Factor,  197 
Paul  2,  199 
Philip,  200 

Planetary  Council,  200 
Portia,  201 

Power  of  Light  (POL),  201 
Prince  Neosom,  202 
Psychoterrestrials,  203 
Puddy’s  abduction,  204 
R.  D„  207 
Ra,  207 

Rainbow  City,  207 
Ramtha,  209 
Ramu,  210 
Raphael,  211 
Raydia,  211 
Renata,  211 
Reptoid  child,  212 
Reptoids,  212 
Root  Races,  216 
Saint  Michael,  217 
Sananda,  217 
Sasquatch,  217 
Satonians,  220 
Secret  Chiefs,  220 
Semjase,  220 
Seth,  221 
Shaari,  222 
Shan,  222 
Shaver  mystery,  223 
Shaw’s  Martians,  226 
Sheep-killing  alien,  227 
Shiva,  227 
Shovar,  228 

Sinat  Schirah  (Stan),  228 

Sister  Thedra,  229 

Sky  people,  232 

Smead’s  Martians,  233 

Smith,  233 

Source,  234 

SPECTRA,  234 

Springheel  Jack,  235 

Sprinkle,  Ronald  Leo  (1930-  ),  236 

Star  People,  237 

Stellar  Community  of  Enlightened 
Ecosystems,  238 
Strieber,  Whitley  (1945-  ),  238 


x  Contents 


Sunar  and  Treena,  239 

Tabar,  241 

Tawa,  241 

Tecu,  241 

Thee  Elohim,  242 

Thompson’s  Venusians,  242 

Tibus,  244 

Time  travelers,  244 

Tin-can  aliens,  245 

Tree-stump  aliens,  245 

Tulpa,  245 

The  Two,  246 

Ulkt,  249 

Ultraterrestrials,  249 
Ummo,  249 
Unholy  Six,  252 
Vadig,  253 
ValThor,  254 
Valdar,  255 

Van  Tassel,  George  W.  (1910- 


Vegetable  Man,  256 

Venudo,  257 

Villanueva’s  visitors,  257 

VIVenus,  258 

Volmo,  259 

Walk-ins,  261 

Walton’s  abduction,  261 

Wanderers,  266 

White  Eagle,  266 

White’s  little  people,  266 

Wilcox’s  Martians,  267 

Williamson,  George  Hunt  (1926-1986),  268 

Wilson,  270 

Xeno,  273 

Yada  di  Shi’ite,  275 

Yamski,  275 

Y’hova,  276 

Zagga,  277 

Zandark,  277 

1978),  255  Zolton,  277 


Index,  279 


Introduction 


Extraordinary  encounters  have  been  reported 
for  as  long  as  human  beings  have  been 
around,  and  they  are  richly  documented  in 
the  world’s  folklore  and  mythology.  A  full  ac¬ 
counting  of  traditions  of  otherworldly  belief 
would  easily  fill  many  fat  volumes.  This  book, 
however,  is  not  about  traditions  but  about  ex¬ 
periences,  or  perceived  experiences,  of  other¬ 
worldly  forces  as  claimed  by  a  wide  range  of 
individuals  over  the  past  two  centuries  (with 
the  rare  look  farther  back  if  the  occasion  calls 
for  it).  In  other  words,  it  is  about  things  that 
people,  many  of  them  living,  say  happened  to 
them,  things  far  outside  mainstream  notions 
about  what  it  is  possible  to  experience,  but,  at 
the  same  time,  things  that  seem  deeply  real  to 
at  least  the  sincere  experients  (that  is,  those 
persons  who  have  had  the  experiences).  Not 
everyone,  of  course,  is  telling  the  truth,  and 
when  there  is  reason  to  be  suspicious  of  the 
testimony,  that  consideration  is  noted. 

Mostly,  though,  I  let  the  stories  tell  them¬ 
selves;  I  have  left  my  own  observations  and 
conclusions  in  this  introduction.  Though 
much  of  the  material  is  outlandish  by  any  def¬ 
inition,  I  have  made  a  conscious  effort  to  re¬ 
late  it  straightforwardly,  and  I  hope  readers 
will  take  it  in  the  same  spirit.  No  single  per¬ 
son  on  this  earth  is  guiltless  of  believing  some¬ 
thing  that  isn’t  so.  As  I  wrote  this  book,  I  tried 


to  keep  in  mind  these  wise  words  from  scien¬ 
tist  and  author  Henry  H.  Bauer:  “Foolish 
ideas  do  not  make  a  fool — if  they  did,  we 
could  all  rightly  be  called  fools.” 

Most  of  us  believe  in  at  least  the  hypotheti¬ 
cal  existence  of  other-than-human  beings, 
whether  we  think  of  them  as  manifestations  of 
the  divine  or  as  advanced  extraterrestrials.  At 
the  same  time  most  of  us  do  not  think  of 
these  beings  as  intelligences  we  are  likely  to 
encounter  in  quotidian  reality.  God  and  the 
angels  are  in  heaven,  spiritual  entities  who 
exist  as  objects  of  faith.  Extraterrestrials, 
though  not  gods,  “exist”  in  much  the  same 
way,  as  beings  who  science  fiction  writers  and 
scientists  such  as  the  late  Carl  Sagan  theorize 
may  be  out  there  somewhere  in  deep  space, 
though  so  far  away  that  no  direct  evidence 
supports  the  proposition.  When  devout  indi¬ 
viduals  report  feeling  the  “presence  of  God,” 
they  usually  describe  a  subjective  state  that  the 
nonbeliever  does  not  feel  compelled  to  take 
literally. 

Of  course  we  know  there  was  a  time  when 
our  ancestors  were  certain  that  otherworldly 
beings  of  all  sorts  walked  the  world.  Gods 
communicated  openly  with  humans.  One 
could  summon  up  their  presence  or  encounter 
them  spontaneously.  Fairies  and  other  super¬ 
natural  entities  haunted  the  landscape  as 


XI 


xii  Introduction 


things  that  existed  not  just  in  supernatural  be¬ 
lief  but  in  actual  experience.  We  also  know 
that  our  poor,  benighted  ancestors  knew  no 
better.  Superstitious,  fearful,  deeply  credu¬ 
lous,  they  mistook  shadows  and  dreams  for 
denizens  of  realms  that  had  no  reality  beyond 
the  one  ignorance  and  foolishness  assigned  it. 

Finally,  most  of  us  are  aware,  even  if  only 
dimly  so,  that  a  handful  of  people  in  our  own 
enlightened  time  make  more  or  less  public 
claims  that  they  have  personally  interacted 
with  supernormal  beings.  Such  persons  are 
thoroughly  marginalized,  treated  as  eccentric 
and  novel,  as  different  from  the  rest  of  us;  if 
they  are  not  lying  outright,  we  suspect,  they 
are  suffering  from  a  mental  disturbance  of 
some  kind.  And  we  may  well  be  right,  at  least 
in  some  cases.  As  for  the  rest,  we  could  not  be 
more  mistaken. 

As  it  happens,  reports  of  human  interac¬ 
tion  with  ostensible  otherworldly  beings  con¬ 
tinue  pretty  much  unabated  into  the  present. 
They  are  far  more  common  than  one  would 
think.  The  proof  is  as  close  as  an  Internet 
search,  through  which  the  inquirer  will 
quickly  learn  that  material  on  the  subject  ex¬ 
ists  in  staggering  quantity.  A  considerable  por¬ 
tion  of  it  is  about  channeling  (in  which  an  in¬ 
dividual  is  the  passive  recipient  of  messages 
from  the  otherworld,  usually  speaking  in  the 
voice  of  an  intelligence  from  elsewhere)  from 
a  wide  assortment  of  entities:  nebulous  energy 
sources,  soul  clusters,  extraterrestrials,  as¬ 
cended  masters,  interdimensional  beings,  dis- 
carnate  Atlanteans  and  Lemurians,  nature 
spirits,  even  whales  and  dolphins.  Besides 
these  purely  psychic  connections  with  the 
otherworld,  there  are  many  who  report  direct 
physical  meetings  with  beings  from  outer 
space,  other  dimensions,  the  hollow  earth, 
and  other  fantastic  places.  Not  all  of  these 
ideas  are  new,  of  course.  The  hollow  earth  and 
its  inhabitants  were  a  popular  fringe  subject  in 
nineteenth-century  America,  and  in  the  latter 
half  of  that  century,  spiritualist  mediums 
sometimes  communicated  with  Martians  or 
even  experienced  out-of-body  journeys  to  the 
red  planet.  In  1896  and  1897,  during  what 


today  would  be  called  a  nationwide  wave  of 
unidentified  flying  object  (UFO)  sightings, 
American  newspapers  printed  accounts  of 
landings  of  strange  craft  occupied  by  nonhu¬ 
man  crews  of  giants,  dwarfs,  or  monsters  pre¬ 
sumed  to  be  visiting  extraterrestrials. 

But  in  the  UFO  age — that  is,  the  period 
from  1947  to  the  present,  when  reports  of 
anomalous  aerial  phenomena  became  widely 
known  and  their  implications  much  dis¬ 
cussed — a  small  army  of  “contactees,”  re¬ 
counting  physical  or  psychic  meetings  with 
angelic  space  people,  has  marched  onto  the 
world  stage  to  preach  a  new  cosmic  gospel.  In 
a  secular  context,  UFO  witnesses  with  no  dis¬ 
cernible  occult  orientation  or  metaphysical 
agenda  have  told  fantastic  tales  of  close  en¬ 
counters  with  incommunicative  or  taciturn 
humanoids.  Some  witnesses  even  relate,  under 
hypnosis  or  through  conscious  “recall,”  trau¬ 
matic  episodes  in  which  humanoids  took 
them  against  their  will  into  apparent  space¬ 
craft.  The  early  1970s,  the  period  when  most 
observers  date  the  beginning  of  the  New  Age 
movement,  saw  a  boom  in  channeling — again 
nothing  new  (spirits  have  spoken  through  hu¬ 
mans  forever)  but  jarring  and  shocking  to  ra¬ 
tionalists  and  materialists.  The  same  decade 
spawned  such  popular  occult  fads  as  the 
Bermuda  Triangle  and  ancient  astronauts 
(prehistoric  or  early  extraterrestrial  visitors), 
based  on  the  notion  of  otherworldly  influ¬ 
ences — benign,  malevolent,  or  indifferent — 
on  human  life. 

As  cable  television  became  ubiquitous,  tele¬ 
vision  documentaries  or  pseudodocumen¬ 
taries  (some,  such  as  a  notorious  Fox  Network 
broadcast  purporting  to  show  an  autopsy  per¬ 
formed  on  a  dead  extraterrestrial,  were  thinly 
concealed  hoaxes)  served  to  fill  programming 
needs  and  proved  to  be  among  cable’s  most 
popular  offerings.  Books  alleging  real-life  en¬ 
counters  with  aliens,  such  as  Whitley 
Strieber’s  Communion:  A  True  Story  (1987), 
fueled  interest  and  speculation.  In  the  1990s 
Pulitzer  Prize— winning  Harvard  University 
psychiatrist  John  E.  Mack,  who  had  hypno¬ 
tized  a  number  of  persons  who  thought  they 


Introduction  xiii 


may  have  encountered  UFO  beings,  champi¬ 
oned  the  idea — which  not  surprisingly  gener¬ 
ated  furious  controversy  and  even  a  failed  ef¬ 
fort  to  have  him  removed  from  his  job — that 
well-intentioned  extradimensional  intelli¬ 
gences  are  helping  an  unprepared  humanity  to 
enter  a  new  age  of  spiritual  wisdom  and  eco¬ 
logical  stewardship.  Mack,  along  with  other 
prominent  investigators  of  the  abduction  phe¬ 
nomenon  such  as  Budd  Hopkins  and  David 
M.  Jacobs,  pointed  to  the  results  of  a  1992 
Roper  poll  as  evidence  that  as  many  as  3.7 
million  Americans  have  been  abducted — a 
conclusion  many  critics,  including  some  who 
are  open-minded  about  or  even  sympathetic 
to  the  abduction  phenomenon,  would  dis¬ 
pute.  Still,  there  seemed  no  doubt,  based  on 
the  experiences  of  investigators  who  have 
found  themselves  inundated  with  reports,  that 
thousands  of  otherwise  seemingly  normal  in¬ 
dividuals  believe  themselves  to  be  abductees. 

The  abduction  phenomenon  is  undoubt¬ 
edly  the  most  recent  manifestation  of  the  oth¬ 
erworldly-beings  tradition,  but  older  beliefs 
and  experiences,  though  eclipsed,  continue. 
Even  into  the  1990s,  encounters  with  fairies — 
which  extraterrestrial  humanoids  were  sup¬ 
posed  to  have  supplanted  in  the  imaginations 
of  the  superstitious  and  impressionable,  ac¬ 
cording  to  any  number  of  skeptical  commen¬ 
tators — were  noted  on  occasion.  At  least  one 
recent  book  from  a  reputable  publisher — Janet 
Bord’s  Fairies:  Real  Encounters  with  Little  Peo¬ 
ple  (1997) — argued  that  such  things  are  a  gen¬ 
uine  aspect  of  a  universe  “so  complex  that  we 
cannot  begin  to  understand  it.”  The  Blessed 
Virgin  Mary  appeared,  as  usual,  all  over  the 
world,  as  did  other  sorts  of  divine  entities. 

The  world,  of  course,  goes  on  with  its  busi¬ 
ness  as  if  none  of  this  were  true,  taking  serious 
(as  opposed  to  tabloid)  note  only  when  belief 
in  otherworldly  beings  goes  horrendously 
wrong  and  thirty-nine  cult  members  commit 
suicide  while  awaiting  the  arrival  of  a  space¬ 
ship  following  a  comet.  The  March  1997 
mass  death  in  San  Diego  of  the  faithful  of 
Heavens  Gate  (a  contactee-oriented  group 
that,  in  various  incarnations,  had  existed  since 


the  early  1970s)  sparked  big  headlines  even  in 
such  august  media  as  the  New  York  Times  and 
the  Washington  Post.  In  the  wake  of  the 
tragedy  came  all  the  predictable  lamentations 
about  alienation  and  irrationality  in  a  world 
that  more  and  more  seems  to  have  lost  its 
bearings.  But  the  San  Diego  incident,  al¬ 
though  hardly  unprecedented  (history  records 
numerous  episodes  of  group  suicides  commit¬ 
ted  in  the  name  of  otherworldly  powers),  was 
anomalous  in  one  important  sense:  few  who 
hold  such  extraordinary  beliefs,  including  the 
conviction  that  they  personally  interact  with 
beings  from  other  realms,  harm  themselves  or 
others.  In  fact,  most  incorporate  their  experi¬ 
ences  into  lives  so  seemingly  ordinary  that 
their  neighbors,  unless  told  directly  (which 
they  usually  are  not),  suspect  nothing. 

In  the  late  1970s,  when  I  lived  in  a  North 
Shore  suburb  of  Chicago,  I  met  a  likable,  gen¬ 
erous-hearted  family  man  named  Keith  Mac¬ 
donald.  Macdonald  recounted  a  UFO  sight¬ 
ing  (also  witnessed  by  his  family)  after  which 
he  felt  that  something  had  taken  place  that  he 
could  not  consciously  recall.  Under  hypnosis, 
he  described  what  would  later  be  judged  a 
rather  ordinary  abduction  experience:  gray¬ 
skinned  beings  took  him  into  the  UFO  and 
subjected  him  to  a  physical  examination 
against  his  wishes.  The  experience,  if  that  is 
what  it  was,  frightened  him  severely.  For  a 
time  I  lost  touch  with  Keith.  When  I  next  saw 
him,  he  told  me  he  had  been  hearing  mental 
voices  and  channeling  messages  from  a  planet 
called  Landa,  populated  by  wise,  spiritually 
committed  beings  who  looked  like  Greek 
gods  and  goddesses.  Keith  had  learned  that  he 
was  originally  from  that  planet  but  had  gone 
through  many  earthly  incarnations  so  that  he 
could  lead  the  Earth  as  it  entered  a  period  of 
turmoil  and  destruction  before  the  ships  from 
Landa  arrived  to  save  the  elect.  Over  the  years 
I  monitored  Keiths  emerging  beliefs  and  sat 
in  on  a  few — to  me  unimpressive — channel¬ 
ing  sessions  during  which  the  all-wise  David, 
his  father  on  Landa,  spoke  on  a  level  of  verbal 
and  intellectual  sophistication  that  exactly 
matched  Keith’s. 


xiv  Introduction 


Though  I  never  for  a  moment  believed  in 
the  literal  reality  of  “those  of  Landa,”  as  they 
called  themselves  in  their  characteristically 
stilted  syntax,  I  was  struck  by  a  number  of 
things.  One  was  the  almost  staggering  com¬ 
plexity  of  the  cosmos  Keith  had  conjured  up 
in  his  imagination — the  only  place  that  I 
could  believe  such  a  cosmos  existed,  with  its 
many  worlds,  peoples,  religions,  politics,  en¬ 
mities,  and  alliances.  None  of  it,  I  should  add, 
was  anything  somebody  could  not  have  made 
up,  consciously  or  unconsciously.  But  all  of  it 
would  have  done  credit  to  a  gifted  writer  of 
science  fiction.  Though  he  possessed  a  keen 
native  intelligence,  Keith  was  neither  a  writer 
nor  a  reader.  He  did,  however,  have  some  pre¬ 
viously  existing  interest — not  profound  or 
particularly  well  informed,  in  my  observa¬ 
tion — in  UFOs,  the  paranormal,  and  the  oc¬ 
cult.  As  I  listened  to  him  over  many  hours,  I 
began  to  feel  as  if  somehow  in  his  waking  life 
Keith  had  tapped  into  the  creative  potential 
most  of  us  experience  in  our  dreams.  As  we 
doze  off  to  sleep  and  dream,  images  begin  to 
well  up  out  of  the  unconscious;  in  no  more 
than  a  moment  we  may  find  ourselves  inun¬ 
dated  with  psychic  materials  sufficient  to  fill  a 
fat  Victorian  novel.  When  our  eyes  open  in 
the  morning,  all  of  that,  alas,  is  gone.  Keith 
had  the  capacity,  it  seemed  to  me,  not  only  to 
live  inside  his  dreams  but  to  keep  them  stable 
and  evolving. 

Only  once,  when  asked  outright,  did  I  ac¬ 
knowledge  my  skepticism.  The  confession  was 
moot  because  Keith  had  inferred  as  much  from 
my  noncommittal  responses  to  his  typically  ex¬ 
cited  revelations  about  the  latest  from  the  Lan- 
danians.  He  had  no  doubt — well,  maybe  98 
percent  of  the  time  he  had  no  doubt — that  he 
was  in  the  middle  of  something  real  in  the 
most  fundamental  sense  of  the  word.  He  also 
understood  that  he  had  no  proof  that  would 
satisfy  those  who,  like  me,  found  the  Landani- 
ans’  word  insufficient.  Therefore,  he  continu¬ 
ally  implored  the  Landanians  to  provide  him 
that  proof,  and  in  turn  they  regaled  him  with  a 
series  of  prophecies,  often  about  explosive 
world  events  (bloody  uprisings,  devastating 


earthquakes),  none  of  which  came  true;  then, 
as  if  to  add  insult  to  injury,  their  rationaliza¬ 
tions  for  the  failure  of  the  prophecies  to  be  ful¬ 
filled  bordered  on,  and  sometimes  surpassed, 
the  comical.  The  prophecies  and  promises  con¬ 
tinued  in  a  steady  stream  until  Keith’s  prema¬ 
ture  death  in  1999,  and  his  closest  friend  told 
me  that  even  at  the  end,  Keiths  faith  had  not 
faltered. 

Perhaps  the  most  amazing  aspect  was 
Keith’s  manifest  sanity,  which  he  never  lost 
through  the  many  ups  and  downs  of  his  inter¬ 
actions  with  the  Landanians  (not  to  mention 
the  literally  crippling  health  problems  he  suf¬ 
fered  at  the  same  time).  He  worked — as  a 
garage  mechanic  in  a  Waukegan,  Illinois,  car 
dealership — until  he  was  physically  incapable 
of  doing  so  any  longer.  He  was  a  good  hus¬ 
band  to  his  wife,  a  good  father  to  his  two 
boys,  and  a  good  friend  to  those  who  were 
lucky  enough  to  claim  him  as  a  friend  in  turn. 
His  children,  in  their  teens  at  the  initiation  of 
Keith’s  adventures  with  Landa,  and  his  wife 
vividly  recalled  the  original  UFO  sighting 
they  too  had  experienced  and  Keith’s  convic¬ 
tion  that,  after  they  had  gone  to  bed  and  he 
had  continued  watching  the  object,  some¬ 
thing  had  happened.  Still,  they  did  not  believe 
much  in  Landa,  and  his  older  son  told  me 
once  of  his  certainty  that  his  father’s  commu¬ 
nications  were  psychological  in  origin.  Yet 
they  loved  him,  and  only  those  very  close  to 
him  had  any  idea  that  at  any  given  moment  a 
good  portion  of  Keith’s  attention  was  focused 
on  a  world  far,  far  away  from  the  small  subur¬ 
ban  town  where  he  spent  much  of  his  adult 
life. 

In  1985,  I  flew  in  a  private  plane  with 
Keith  and  two  others  (both,  incidentally,  con¬ 
vinced  of  the  literal  truth  of  Keith’s  messages) 
to  the  Rocky  Mountain  Conference  on  UFO 
Investigation,  held  every  summer  on  the  cam¬ 
pus  of  the  University  of  Wyoming  in  Laramie. 
The  title  is  something  of  a  misnomer;  only  a 
relative  few  who  attend  can  be  called  “investi¬ 
gators.”  The  emphasis  is  on  experience  not 
just  with  UFOs  but  with  the  space  people 
who  fly  them.  The  bulk  of  the  attendees — the 


Introduction  xv 


number  ranges  from  a  few  dozen  to  as  many 
as  two  hundred  from  year  to  year — are  in  reg¬ 
ular  contact  with  benevolent  extraterrestrials. 
The  aliens  communicate  through  channeling, 
automatic  writing  (in  which  information  is 
dictated  to  an  individual  from  allegedly  un¬ 
earthly  beings),  dreams,  visions,  or  voices  in 
the  head,  or  they  are  perceived  as  if  physical 
entities.  (I  use  this  last  phrase  deliberately;  on 
close  questioning,  the  individuals  involved 
usually  turn  out  to  have  a  fairly  elastic  defini¬ 
tion  of  the  infinitive  “to  see”  in  all  its  permu¬ 
tations.)  Few  of  the  contactees  assembled  in 
Laramie  matched  the  stereotype  of  the  flam¬ 
boyant  charlatan  or  nut  case.  A  few — such  as 
a  young  Japanese  woman  whom  space  friends 
had  guided  to  the  United  States  in  pursuit  of 
her  mission  for  them — had  traveled  some  dis¬ 
tance.  Except  for  the  small  detail  of  their  asso¬ 
ciations  with  extraterrestrials,  most  were  de¬ 
cent,  ordinary  local  folk.  The  majority  were 
from  the  small  towns,  ranches,  and  farms  of 
the  Great  Plains,  the  sort  of  people  to  whom 
the  phrase  “salt  of  the  earth”  is  often  applied. 

Among  his  own  at  last,  Keith  could  not 
have  been  happier.  If  he  noticed  that  no  one 
else  spoke  of  Landa  and  its  impossible-to- 
overlook  plans  for  the  Earths  future,  or  that 
every  other  contactee  had  his  or  her  special 
space  friends,  all  with  their  own  individual 
hard-to-overlook  plans  for  the  Earth’s  future, 
he  never  said  a  word  about  it  to  me. 

Of  course,  nothing  is  as  simple  as  we 
would  like  it  to  be,  and  as  I  look  back  on  the 
episode,  I  realize  that  I  will  never  know  why 
“those  of  Landa”  called  on  Keith.  Not  that  I 
had  any  difficulty  understanding  who  they 
were.  However  tangled  some  of  the  details, 
there  was  no  mistaking  their  underlying  ba¬ 
nality  or  their  all-too-apparent  shallow  earth¬ 
iness,  with  their  Greek  togas,  pretentiously 
fractured  English,  and  (yes)  Roman  Catholic 
faith.  They  themselves  were  not  that  interest¬ 
ing;  what  made  them  worthy  of  attention  and 
reflection  was  this  curious  paradox:  to  the 
man  who  had  (unwittingly)  created  them, 
they  had  a  nearly  certain  independent  reality; 
to  virtually  any  independent  observer,  there 


could  be  no  question  of  who  had  brought 
them  (for  whatever  reason)  into  the  world 
and  to  whom  they  owed  what  passed  for  an 
existence. 

Yet  Keith  was  not  crazy.  Nor,  according  to 
psychological  surveys  of  other  space  commu¬ 
nicants  who  attend  the  Laramie  conferences, 
are  his  fellows.  The  evidence  from  this  and 
other  psychological  inventories  tells  us  that  we 
can  be  mentally  well  and  yet  hold  beliefs — 
and,  more  dramatically,  have  vivid  experi¬ 
ences — that  are  far  outside  the  mainstream, 
far  outside  our  conventional  understanding  of 
the  possible.  In  a  book-length  survey  of  out- 
of-ordinary  perceptions,  three  well-regarded 
psychologists  observe,  “Notwithstanding  the 
presence  of  anomalous  experiences  in  case 
studies  of  disturbed  individuals,  surveys  of 
nonclinical  samples  have  found  little  relation¬ 
ship  between  these  experiences  and  psy¬ 
chopathology”  (Cardena,  Lynn,  and  Krippner, 
2000,  4).  The  authors  stress  that  psychothera¬ 
pists  must  understand  the  difference  if  they 
are  to  treat  their  clients  effectively.  Psychologi¬ 
cal  research  into  extraordinary  encounters  of 
the  sort  with  which  this  book  is  concerned  is 
in  its  infancy. 

Still,  to  anyone  who  looks  carefully  at  the 
testimony  regarding  otherworldly  contacts,  it 
becomes  apparent  that  such  phenomena  do 
not  arise  from  a  single  cause.  There  is,  for  ex¬ 
ample,  little  in  common  between  the  average 
channeler  and  the  average  witness  to  a  close 
encounter  of  the  third  kind  (a  UFO  sighting 
in  which,  according  to  a  classification  system 
defined  by  the  late  astronomer  and  ufologist  J. 
Allen  Hynek,  “the  presence  of  animated  crea¬ 
tures  is  reported”  [1972,  138]).  Typically, 
channelers  have  had  a  long  history  of  occult 
interests  before  they  begin  communicating 
with  supernatural  entities  holding  forth  on  fa¬ 
miliar  metaphysical  doctrines.  Close-encoun¬ 
ter  witnesses,  on  the  other  hand,  fit  the  profile 
of  witnesses  to  less  exotic  UFO  sightings;  in 
other  words,  they  are  pretty  much  indistin¬ 
guishable  from  their  fellow  citizens. 

Consequently,  channelers  look  more  like 
candidates  for  subjective  experience,  and  in- 


xvi  Introduction 


deed  to  every  indication  channeling  is  just 
that.  It  is  not  veridical  (that  is,  independently 
witnessed  or  otherwise  shown  not  to  be  a  sub¬ 
jective  experience);  no  channeling  entity  can 
prove  its  existence,  and  the  information  pro¬ 
vided  through  the  channeling  process  is  sus¬ 
ceptible  to  neither  verification  nor  falsifica¬ 
tion.  The  “authority”  of  the  channeling  entity 
rests  solely  on  its  self-identification.  If  you  be¬ 
lieve  he,  she,  or  it  is  a  discarnate  Atlantean, 
space  alien,  or  ascended  master,  you  will  be¬ 
lieve  what  he,  she,  or  it  has  to  say.  If  you 
choose  not  to  believe  any  of  that,  the  channel¬ 
ing  entity  will  prove  helpless  to  get  you  to 
change  your  mind.  Experiences  such  as  close 
encounters,  conversely,  may  be  veridical  in  the 
sense  that  on  occasion  they  involve  multi¬ 
ple — or,  more  rarely,  independent — observ¬ 
ers.  In  the  case  of  multiply  witnessed  close  en¬ 
counters,  subjective  explanations  are  applied 
only  with  difficulty.  An  investigator  in  search 
of  an  explanation  has  limited  choices,  usually 
three:  (1)  the  claimants  made  up  the  story;  (2) 
they  naively  misperceived  what  were  in  fact 
conventional  stimuli;  or  (3)  they  underwent 
an  extraordinary  experience  that  defies  current 
understanding. 

Between  the  extremes  is  a  broad  range  of 
nonexperiential  material,  a  modern  folklore  in 
which  the  world  and  the  cosmos  are  rein¬ 
vented  on  the  basis  of  believed-in  but  undoc¬ 
umented  (and  often,  to  those  who  care  about 
such  things,  certifiably  false)  allegations.  Most 
persons  who  circulate  such  stuff  are  sincere, 
but  some  of  those  who  feed  the  stuff  to  them 
are  not.  Hoaxers  provide  documents,  such  as 
the  supposed  diary  attesting  to  Adm.  Richard 
E.  Byrd’s  voyage  into  the  hollow  earth 
through  a  hole  at  the  North  Pole,  that  believ¬ 
ers  cite  to  prove  their  cases.  Most  observers 
believe  James  Churchward’s  famous  (or  noto¬ 
rious)  books  on  the  alleged  lost  continent  of 
Mu  are  literary  hoaxes — Churchward  was 
never  able  to  produce  the  ancient  documents 
on  which  he  asserted  he  had  based  his  work — 
but  earnest  occultists  and  New  Agers  cite  his 
books  as  overwhelming  evidence  that  Mu 


(more  often  called  Lemuria)  was  a  real  place. 
Of  course,  embellishments  grow  on  top  of 
embellishments,  and  every  legend  of  a  place,  a 
world,  or  a  realm  that  is  home  to  otherworldly 
beings  evolves  and  has  its  own  rich  history. 
Atlantis,  for  example,  began  as  an  advanced 
civilization  for  its  time,  but  by  our  time  its 
people  had  come  to  be  seen  as  advanced  even 
beyond  us,  the  creators  of  fantastic  technolo¬ 
gies  and  even  the  recipient  of  knowledge  from 
extraterrestrial  sources.  The  hollow  earth  of 
John  Cleves  Symmes  (1779-1829)  is  not  the 
hollow  earth  of  Walter  Siegmeister  (a.k.a. 
Raymond  W.  Bernard,  1901-1965),  any 
more  than  the  imagination  of  one  century  is 
the  imagination  of  the  century  that  follows  it. 
Flying  saucers  were  not  part  of  Symmes’s 
world;  consequently,  they  did  not  exist  in  his 
hollow  earth.  By  the  time  Siegmeister  wrote 
The  Holloiv  Earth  (1964),  no  alternative-real¬ 
ity  book  could  lack  flying  saucers. 

It  is  entirely  likely  that  nothing  in  the  book 
you  are  about  to  read  will  tell  you  anything 
about  actual  extraordinary  encounters  and 
otherworldly  beings.  If  such  exist,  however,  it 
is  not  beyond  the  range  of  possibility  that 
somewhere  amid  the  noise  of  folklore,  belief, 
superstition,  credulity,  out-of-control  think¬ 
ing,  and  out-of-ordinary  perception  a  signal 
may  be  sounding.  If  so,  it  is  a  faint  one,  in¬ 
deed.  The  world  has  always  been  overrun  with 
otherworldly  experiences,  some  of  which  cer¬ 
tainly  appear  to  resist  glib  accounting;  yet  so 
far  it  has  proved  exasperatingly  tricky  to  estab¬ 
lish  that  otherworldly  experiences  are  also  oth¬ 
erworldly  events.  The  otherworld,  perhaps, 
can  happen  to  any  of  us  at  any  time,  but  we 
may  not  live  in  it — at  least  if  we  know  what’s 
good  for  us — in  the  way  that  we  live  enclosed 
within  the  four  walls  of  the  physical  structure 
in  which  we  read  these  words.  It  is  not  wise  to 
pass  through  a  world  of  physical  laws  while 
distracted  by  all-encompassing  dreams.  Even 
so,  there  is  still  a  nobility  to  dreaming.  There  is 
also  an  undying  appeal  to  the  sort  of  romantic 
impatience  that  imagines  new  worlds  bigger 
and  more  wondrous  than  our  own,  then 


Introduction  xvii 


brings  these  worlds  and  their  marvelous  inhab¬ 
itants  into  our  own.  If  extraordinary  encoun¬ 
ters  are  occurring  only  with  otherwise  hidden 
sides  of  ourselves,  they  are  still — or  surely  all 
the  more  so — worth  having. 

— Jerome  Clark 


References 

Cardena,  Etzel,  Steven  Jay  Lynn,  and  Stanley  Kripp- 
ner,  eds.,  2000.  Varieties  of  Anomalous  Experience: 
Examining  the  Scientific  Evidence.  Washington, 
DC:  American  Psychological  Association. 

Hynek,  J.  Allen,  1972.  The  UFO  Experience:  A  Scien¬ 
tific  Inquiry,  p.138.  Chicago:  Henry  Regnery 
Company. 


EXTRAORDINARY 

ENCOUNTERS 


A 

“A”  is  the  pseudonym  Ann  Grevler  (a  writer 
who  uses  the  pen  name  “Anchor”)  gives  the 
Venusian  whom  she  allegedly  encountered 
while  driving  through  South  Africa’s  Eastern 
Transvaal  on  an  unspecified  day  in  the  1950s. 
Grevler,  a  flying-saucer  enthusiast  sympathetic 
to  the  contactee  movement  (contactees  are  in¬ 
dividuals  who  claim  to  be  in  regular  communi¬ 
cation  with  kindly,  advanced  extraterrestrials), 
met  A  when  her  car  inexplicably  stopped  on  a 
rural  highway  As  she  was  looking  under  the 
hood,  she  became  aware  of  a  buzzing  sound  in 
her  ears  and  looked  up  to  see  a  smiling  space¬ 
man  standing  not  far  away.  Then  a  spaceship 
flew  toward  her  and  landed,  and  she  and  A 
stepped  into  it.  With  A  and  another  spaceman, 
B,  Grevler  flew  into  space.  They  approached 
what  Grevler  describes  as  “a  positively  huge 
Mother  Ship,”  which  tinier  ships,  similar  to  the 
one  they  were  aboard,  were  entering. 

Once  inside  the  mother  ship,  Grevler  and 
her  friends  went  to  “the  Temple,  visited  by  re¬ 
turning  crews  to  thank  the  Creator  for  a  safe 
voyage.”  Subsequently,  either  in  the  mother 
ship  or  in  the  smaller  scout  craft  (her  account 
is  vague  on  this  detail),  she  visited  Venus  and 
saw  beautiful  buildings  and  a  kind  of  univer¬ 
sity.  At  the  latter,  students  were  taught  univer¬ 
sal  knowledge  and  trained  in  extrasensory  per¬ 


ception.  They  also  learned  “Cosmic  Lan¬ 
guage — which  is  expressed  simply  by  symbols 
of  various  forms  and  colors,  so  that  meanings 
are  the  same  in  any  language”  (Anchor,  1958). 

Grevler  had  other  space  adventures.  One 
was  a  visit  to  a  depopulated,  destroyed  planet, 
the  dreary  result  of  science  gone  amok. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Anchor  [pseud,  of  Ann  Grevler],  1958.  Transvaal 
Episode:  A  UFO  Lands  in  Africa.  Corpus  Christi, 
TX:  Essene  Press. 


Abductions  by  UFOs 

Since  the  mid-1960s  a  number  of  individuals 
around  the  world  have  reported  encounters  in 
which  humanoid  beings  took  them  against 
their  will — usually  from  their  homes  or  vehi¬ 
cles — into  apparent  spacecraft  and  subjected 
them  to  medical  and  other  procedures.  As 
often  as  not,  witnesses  spoke  of  experiencing 
amnesia,  aware  at  first  only  of  unexplained 
“missing  time”  (a  much-used  phrase  that  has 
become  almost  synonymous  with  abduction) 
consisting  of  a  few  minutes  to  a  few  hours. 
Later,  “memory”  would  return,  sometimes 
spontaneously,  sometimes  in  dreams,  and 
often  (and  most  controversially)  through  hyp¬ 
notic  regression. 


1 


2  Abductions  by  UFOs 


In  the  first  case  to  come  to  the  attention  of 
ufologists,  a  Portsmouth,  New  Hampshire, 
couple,  Barney  and  Betty  Hill,  experienced  a 
close  encounter  with  a  UFO  on  the  night  of 
September  1 9-20  while  traveling  through  the 
White  Mountains.  At  one  point,  Barney  Hill 
stopped  the  car  and  stepped  out  with  a  pair  of 
binoculars;  through  them  he  saw  humanlike 
figures  inside  the  craft.  One  was  staring  di¬ 
rectly  at  him.  Terrified,  the  couple  fled,  all  the 
while  hearing  beeping  or  buzzing  sounds. 
Once  back  home,  the  Hills  eventually  realized 
that  at  least  two  hours  seemed  missing  from 
their  conscious  recall.  In  November  Betty  had 
a  series  of  unusually  vivid  dreams  in  which  be¬ 
ings  forced  her  and  her  husband  into  a  UFO. 
She  and  Barney  were  separated,  and  Betty  un¬ 
derwent  a  medical  examination  with  a  gray¬ 
skinned  humanoid,  whom  she  understood  to 
be  the  leader.  In  January  they  sought  out 
Boston  psychiatrist  Benjamin  Simon  in  an  ef¬ 
fort  to  deal  with  the  continuing  anxiety  they 
felt  about  the  incident.  Dr.  Simon  had  them 
hypnotized,  and  under  hypnosis  they  sepa¬ 
rately  recounted  an  abduction  episode.  Subse¬ 
quently,  the  story  appeared  in  a  Boston  news¬ 
paper,  and  soon  afterward  journalist  John  G. 
Fuller  wrote  a  best-selling  book,  The  Inter  - 
rupted Journey,  on  the  case. 

A  generally  similar  incident  took  place  in 
Ashland,  Nebraska,  in  the  early  morning 
hours  of  December  3,  1967,  when  police  offi¬ 
cer  Herbert  Schirmer  saw  a  hovering  UFO  a 
short  distance  from  him.  He  originally  be¬ 
lieved  that  the  sighting  had  lasted  no  more 
than  ten  minutes,  but  when  he  later  realized 
that  a  half  hour  had  passed,  he  got  nervous, 
experienced  sleeplessness,  and  heard  a  buzzing 
sound  inside  his  head.  Later  under  hypnosis 
Schirmer  related  an  onboard  experience  with 
short,  gray-skinned  humanoids  with  catlike 
eyes. 

During  a  wave  of  UFO  sightings  in  Octo¬ 
ber  1973,  two  Pascagoula,  Mississippi,  fisher¬ 
men  claimed  that  robotlike  entities  had 
floated  them  into  a  UFO.  The  story  received 
enormous  publicity,  as  did  an  even  more  spec¬ 
tacular  incident  in  November  1975,  when  a 


forestry  worker  from  Snowflake,  Arizona,  dis¬ 
appeared  after  six  colleagues  saw  a  beam  of 
light  from  a  UFO  hit  him  and  knock  him  to 
the  ground.  Travis  Walton  returned  five  days 
later  with  fragmentary  memories  of  seeing 
two  kinds  of  UFO  beings,  little  gray  men  and 
humanlike  (but  not  human)  entities.  A  few 
other  stories,  now  being  called  “abductions”  as 
opposed  to  “kidnappings,”  saw  print  in  the 
UFO  literature  but  were  little  noticed  else¬ 
where.  The  first  book  on  the  larger  phenome¬ 
non  of  UFO  abductions  (as  opposed  to  a 
single  case,  such  as  the  Hills’s),  Jim  and  Coral 
Lorenzen’s  book  Abducted!  was  published  in 
1977. 

From  the  Hill  incident  on,  critics  focused 
on  the  use  of  hypnosis  to  elicit  “recall,” 
pointing  out  that  confabulation  under  hyp¬ 
nosis  is  a  well-documented  psychological 
phenomenon,  most  dramatically  manifesting 
in  “memories”  of  past  lives.  As  early  as  1977 
three  California  investigators  attempted  to 
demonstrate  that  volunteers  under  hypnosis, 
instructed  to  imagine  UFO  abductions,  told 
stories  indistinguishable  from  those  related 
by  “real”  abductees.  Other  investigators  and 
observers  disputed  these  conclusions,  point¬ 
ing  to  methodological  and  logical  problems 
in  the  experiment,  and  subsequent  efforts  by 
other  researchers  to  replicate  it  failed.  One 
later  study  indicated  that  nearly  one-third  of 
abductees  consciously  remembered  their  ex¬ 
periences;  their  testimony,  folklorist  Thomas 
E.  Bullard  concluded,  was  indistinguishable 
from  corresponding  accounts  emerging  under 
hypnotic  regression.  Still,  hypnosis  and  its  va¬ 
garies  would  play  a  large  and  continuing  role 
in  the  controversy  surrounding  the  abduction 
phenomenon. 

In  the  late  1970s  Budd  Hopkins,  a  New 
York  City  artist  and  sculptor,  working  with 
psychologist  and  hypnotist  Aphrodite  Clamar, 
began  to  investigate  the  abduction  reports. 
Through  Hopkins’s  work  new  dimensions  of 
the  phenomenon  emerged,  including  not  just 
little  gray  humanoids  that  would  come  to 
dominate  abduction  reports  but  also  experi¬ 
ences  that  began  in  childhood  and  recurred 


Abductions  by  UFOs  3 


Betty  and  Barney  Hill,  who  believed  they  were  abducted  and  taken  aboard  a  UFO,  New  Hampshire,  September  1961 
(Fortean  Picture  Library) 


throughout  abductees’  lifetimes.  Some  bore 
scars,  the  causes  of  which  were  mysterious 
until  hypnosis  revealed  them  to  have  been  the 
result  of  alien  medical  procedures.  A  number 
claimed  that  their  abductors  had  placed  im¬ 
plants,  usually  through  the  nose  or  ear,  inside 
their  bodies.  Hopkins  and  his  colleagues  took 
their  cases  to  mental  health  professionals, 
whose  tests  of  abductees  suggested  that  they 
were  psychologically  normal. 

In  his  much-read  book  Missing  Time 
(1981)  Hopkins  argued  for  a  literal  interpreta¬ 


tion  of  abduction  stories.  In  other  words,  he 
held  that  extraterrestrials  were  literally  taking 
human  beings  and  doing  things  to  them  with¬ 
out  their  consent.  Other  ufologists  disagreed. 
Ufologist  Alvin  H.  Lawson,  who  had  overseen 
the  earlier  “imaginary- abduction”  experiment, 
offered  his  own  exotic  hypothesis  that  ab¬ 
ductees  were  suffering  imaginary  experiences 
in  which  they  relived  the  “trauma”  associated 
with  their  births.  More  modestly,  others  pro¬ 
posed  more  conventional  psychological  expla¬ 
nations,  such  as  hallucinations  and  confabula- 


4  Abductions  by  UFOs 


tion.  Few  observers  believed  that  conscious 
hoaxing  played  much  of  a  role  in  abduction¬ 
reporting.  Unlike  contactees,  abductees  sel¬ 
dom  had  any  background  in  occultism  or  eso¬ 
teric  interests,  and  hardly  any  sought  profit  or 
publicity.  To  every  indication  they  believed 
that  they  had  undergone  frightening,  bizarre 
experiences.  Some  psychological  studies 
found  that  abductees  often  evinced  all  the 
symptoms  of  post-traumatic  stress  disorder  of 
the  sort  ordinarily  associated  with  victims  of 
crime,  personal  assault,  or  other  threatening 
terrors. 

In  1987  Thomas  E.  Bullard,  author  of  an 
Indiana  University  Ph.D.  dissertation  on  the 
relationship  of  UFOs  to  folklore,  released  a 
two-volume  study  of  all  abduction  accounts 
then  known,  some  three  hundred.  Through  a 
searching  examination  of  the  narratives, 
Bullard  concluded  that  a  real  phenomenon  of 
strikingly  consistent  features  existed,  that  “ab¬ 
ductions”  were  not  simply  an  assortment  of 
random  fantasies.  He  noted  patterns  that  had 
escaped  even  the  most  attentive  investigators, 
including  “doorway  amnesia” — the  curious 
failure  of  abductees  to  remember  the  moment 
of  entry  or  departure  from  the  UFO.  Besides 
establishing  the  uniform  nature  of  hypnotic 
and  non-hypnotic  testimony,  Bullard  deter¬ 
mined  that  the  phenomenon’s  features  re¬ 
mained  stable  from  investigator  to  investiga¬ 
tor,  thus  casting  doubt  on  a  favorite  skeptical 
argument  concerning  investigator  influence 
on  the  story.  Beyond  that,  Bullard  wrote,  it 
was  difficult  to  say  more,  except  that  “some¬ 
thing  goes  on,  a  marvelous  phenomenon  rich 
enough  to  interest  a  host  of  scholars,  human¬ 
ists,  psychologists  and  sociologists  alike  as  well 
as  perhaps  physical  scientists,  and  to  hold  that 
interest  irrespective  of  the  actual  nature  of  the 
phenomenon”  (Bullard,  1987). 

Hopkins’s  next  book,  Intruders  (1987),  in¬ 
troduced  fresh  features  that  would  figure 
largely  in  all  subsequent  discussions.  From  his 
latest  investigations  he  had  come  to  suspect  a 
reason  for  alien  abductions:  the  creation  of  a 
race  of  hybrid  beings  to  replenish  the  extrater¬ 
restrials’  apparently  exhausted  genetic  stock. 


Female  abductees  would  find  themselves  preg¬ 
nant,  sometimes  inexplicably;  then,  following 
subsequent  abductions  involving  vaginal  pen¬ 
etration  by  a  suction  device,  they  would  dis¬ 
cover  that  those  pregnancies  had  been  sud¬ 
denly  terminated.  In  later  abductions  they 
would  be  shown  babies  or  small  children  with 
both  human  and  alien  features.  The  abductors 
would  explain  that  these  were  the  women’s 
children.  Hopkins  also  uncovered  a  pattern  of 
cases  of  sexual  intercourse  between  male  ab¬ 
ductees  and  more-or-less  human  alien  women 
(perhaps  adult  hybrids). 

Other  investigators  began  finding  similar 
cases.  Hybrids  were  a  new  wrinkle,  signifi¬ 
cantly  augmenting  the  already  considerable 
peculiarity  of  the  abduction  phenomenon.  As 
long  ago  as  1975,  in  his  book  The  Mothman 
Prophecies,  investigator  John  A.  Keel  noted,  in 
passing,  a  pattern  of  what  he  called  “hysterical 
pregnancies”  in  young  women  who  had  had 
close  encounters.  Even  so,  the  reports  met 
with  skepticism  among  scientifically  sophisti¬ 
cated  ufologists,  for  example,  Michael  D. 
Swords,  who  said  that  such  hybridization  is 
biologically  impossible.  Other  critics  argued 
that  mass  abductions  for  such  purposes  would 
not  be  necessary;  once  the  basic  reproductive 
materials  were  collected,  they  could  easily  be 
duplicated.  Most  damning  of  all,  independent 
inquiries  by  physician-ufologists  found  no  ev¬ 
idence  of  mysteriously  ended  pregnancies  in 
colleagues’  experiences  or  in  the  pediatric  lit¬ 
erature.  Still  the  reports  continue. 

Another  significant  development  in  1987 
was  the  publication  of  Communion  by  Whit¬ 
ley  Strieber,  heretofore  known  as  a  novelist 
specializing  in  horror  and  futuristic  themes, 
now  a  self-identified  abductee  with  a  series  of 
strange  adventures  in  his  past.  The  gray¬ 
skinned,  big-eyed  alien  on  the  best-selling 
book’s  cover  triggered  a  flood  of  “memories” 
among  many  who  saw  it.  Even  ufologists  who 
had  been  abduction  literalists  grew  puzzled, 
then  uneasy,  at  the  apparent  quantity  of  re¬ 
covered  abduction  recollections.  Strieber  also 
was  the  first  to  express  a  kind  of  New  Age 
view  of  the  abduction  phenomenon,  now  seen 


Abductions  by  UFOs  5 


not  as  an  entirely  negative  experience  (as 
Hopkins  and  others  held  it  to  be)  but  as  an 
initiation,  however  painful,  into  an  expanded, 
enlightened  view  of  large  cosmic  realities. 
What  to  Hopkins  were  “intruders”  to  Strieber 
were  “visitors.”  Communion  was  only  the  first 
of  a  series  of  books  Strieber  would  write  re¬ 
counting  ever  more  exotic  experiences  with 
aliens  possessing  vast  paranormal  powers. 

By  now  UFO  abductions  were  no  longer 
the  property  of  abductees  and  ufologists.  They 
had  expanded  into  popular  culture,  and  the 
gray  alien  became  a  staple  in  cartoons,  adver¬ 
tisements,  television  shows,  and  more. 
Alarmed  at  the  spread  of  what  they  regarded 
as  a  popular  delusion,  skeptics  and  debunkers 
sought  to  discredit  the  phenomenon.  In  1988 
the  first  book-length  attack  on  the  phenome¬ 
non,  its  claimants,  and  its  advocates,  Philip  J. 
Klass’s  UFO-Abductions:  A  Dangerous  Game, 
lambasted  its  subject  as  the  product  of  delu¬ 
sion  and  deceit. 

Though  the  phenomenon  itself  remained 
elusive,  psychologists  understood  that  at  least 
those  who  claimed  to  have  experienced  it 
could  be  studied.  Using  standard  psychologi¬ 
cal  tests,  they  documented  the  essential  psy¬ 
chological  normality  of  the  average  abductee. 
They  also  found  that,  contrary  to  one  popular 
theory,  abductees  were  not  prone  to  fantasy  or 
imaginative  flights  so  intense  that  they  could 
be  mistaken  for  reality.  Little  if  anything 
seemed  to  distinguish  abductees  from  their 
neighbors. 

The  phenomenon’s  most  notable  cham¬ 
pion,  Harvard  University  psychiatrist  John  E. 
Mack,  became  a  lightning  rod  in  the  contro¬ 
versy.  To  his  colleagues,  who  went  so  far  as  to 
try  to  have  him  removed  from  his  professional 
position,  he  was  a  good  scholar  gone  bad.  To 
New  Age-oriented  saucerians  on  the  other 
hand,  Mack  was  almost  something  of  a 
prophet.  His  controversial  book  Abduction 
(1994)  argued  for  a  benevolent  interpretation 
of  abducting  aliens,  paranormal  and  interdi- 
mensional  intelligences  who,  in  Mack’s  view, 
are  here  to  teach  us — particularly  those  of  us 
who  live  in  the  industrial  West — to  embrace 


Dr.  John  E.  Mack,  Harvard  University  psychiatrist,  1993 
(Dennis  Stacy/Fortean  Picttire  Library) 

other  realities  and  to  take  better  care  of  each 
other  and  the  world  we  live  in.  Mack  wedded 
the  contactee  message  to  the  abduction  expe¬ 
rience,  to  the  consternation  of  Hopkins,  Ja¬ 
cobs,  and  others  who  refused  to  draw  larger 
metaphysical  inferences  from  the  abduction 
experience.  Jacobs,  if  anything,  went  to  the 
opposite  extreme.  A  history  professor  at  Tem¬ 
ple  University,  Jacobs  worked  with  abductees 
whose  testimony,  usually  under  hypnosis,  led 
him  to  the  radical  hypothesis  that  the  abduct¬ 
ing  extraterrestrials  are  creating  a  population 
of  hybrids  to  replace  the  human  race  at  some 
point  in  the  not-distant  future. 

From  their  interactions  with  their  readers 
and  other  members  of  the  public,  Hopkins  and 
Jacobs  came  to  suspect  that  the  abduction  ex¬ 
perience,  far  from  rare,  was  ubiquitous.  Hop¬ 
kins,  for  example,  wrote  as  early  as  1981  that 
there  may  be  “tens  of  thousands  of  Americans 
whose  encounters  have  never  been  revealed” 
(Hopkins,  1981).  In  1991  he  and  Jacobs  were 
given  funding  for  a  survey  to  be  conducted  by 


6  Abductions  by  UFOs 


the  Roper  Organization.  Using  five  “indicator” 
questions,  they  sought  evidence  for  possible  ab¬ 
duction  experiences  among  those  surveyed. 
Pollsters  interviewed  5,947  adult  Americans.  In 
their  reading  of  the  results,  Hopkins  and  Jacobs 
deduced  that  “the  incidence  of  abduction  expe¬ 
riences  appears  to  be  on  the  order  of  at  least 
2%  of  the  population”  ( Unusual  Personal  Expe  - 
riences,  1992).  That  comes  to  3.7  million  ab- 
ductees.  Critics  rejected  this  assertion,  arguing 
that  the  study  contained  too  many  method¬ 
ological  flaws  to  mean  much.  Three  social  sci¬ 
entists,  all  with  backgrounds  in  ufology,  exam¬ 
ined  the  poll  and  came  to  a  wholly  different 
conclusion:  “For  the  present  we  have  no  reli¬ 
able  and  valid  estimate  of  the  prevalence  of  the 
UFO  abduction  phenomenon”  (Hall,  Rodeg- 
hier,  and  Johnson,  1992). 

In  a  study  of  the  various  theories  advanced 
to  explain  UFO  abductions,  psychologist  Stu¬ 
art  Appelle  observed  that  all  testable,  more  or 
less  conventional  hypotheses  (confabulation, 
fantasy  proneness,  false  memory,  sleep  halluci¬ 
nation,  and  the  like)  stand  on  shaky  empirical 
ground.  On  the  other  hand,  literalistic  inter¬ 
pretations  suffer  from  an  absence  of  anything 
like  solid,  veridical  evidence.  All  that  can  be 
said  with  certainty  is  that  abduction  experi¬ 
ences  have  the  feeling  of  reality  to  those  who 
undergo  them.  Most  do  not  fall  into  an  easily 
identifiable  psychological  category.  They  ap¬ 
pear  to  be  reasonably  consistent  in  their  core 
features,  and  some  cases  involve  multiple  wit¬ 
nesses.  These  last  cases,  in  Appelle’s  view, 
“may  provide  the  greatest  challenge  to  prosaic 
explanations”  (Appelle,  1995/1996). 

See  Also:  Alien  DNA;  Aliens  and  the  dead;  Cocoon 
people;  Contactees;  Dual  reference;  Gray  Face; 
Hopkins,  Budd;  Hybrid  beings;  Insectoids;  Keel, 
John  A.;  MU  the  Mantis  Being;  Nordics;  Puddys 
abduction;  Reptoids;  Strieber,  Whitley;  Walton’s 
abduction 

Further  Reading 

Appelle,  Stuart,  1995/1996.  “The  Abduction  Expe¬ 
rience:  A  Critical  Evaluation  of  Theory  and  Evi¬ 
dence.”  Journal  of  UFO  Studies  6  (new  series): 
29-78. 

Appelle,  Stuart,  Steven  Jay  Lynn,  and  Leonard  New¬ 
man,  2000.  “Alien  Abduction  Experiences.”  In 


Etzel  Cardena,  Steven  Jay  Lynn,  and  Stanley 
Krippner,  eds.  Varieties  of  Anomalous  Experience: 
Examining  the  Scientific  Evidence,  253-282.  Wash¬ 
ington,  DC:  American  Psychological  Association. 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  1987.  UFO  Abductions:  The 
Measure  of  a  Mystery.  Volume  1:  Comparative  Study 
of  Abduction  Reports.  Volume  2:  Catalogue  of  Cases. 
Mount  Rainier,  MD:  Fund  for  UFO  Research. 

- ,  1989.  “Hypnosis  and  UFO  Abductions:  A 

Troubled  Relationship.”  Jottrnal  of  UFO  Studies  1 
(new  series):  3-40. 

- ,  1991.  “Folkloric  Dimensions  of  the  UFO 

Phenomenon  .’’Journal  of  UFO  Studies  3  (new  se¬ 
ries):  1-57. 

- ,  2000.  “Abductions  under  Fire:  A  Review  of 

Recent  Abduction  Literature.”  Journal  of  UFO 
Studiesl  (new  series):  81-106. 

Clark,  Jerome,  2000.  “From  Mermaids  to  Little  Gray 
Men:  The  Prehistory  of  the  UFO  Abduction  Phe¬ 
nomenon.”  The Anomalist  8  (Spring):  11-31. 

Fuller,  John  G.,  1966.  The  Interrupted  Journey:  Two 
Lost  Hours  “Aboard  a  Flying  Saucer.  ”  New  York: 
Dial  Press. 

Hall,  Robert  L.,  Mark  Rodeghier,  and  Donald  A. 
Johnson,  1992.  “The  Prevalence  of  Abductions: 
A  Critical  Look.”  Journal  of  UFO  Studies  4  (new 
series):  131-135. 

Hopkins,  Budd,  1981.  Missing  Time:  A  Documented 
Study  of  UFO  Abductions.  New  York:  Richard 
Marek  Publishers. 

- ,  1987.  Intruders:  The  Incredible  Visitations  at 

Copley  Woods.  New  York:  Random  House. 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  1992.  Secret  Life:  Firsthand  Ac  - 
counts  of  UFO  Abductions.  New  York:  Simon  and 
Schuster. 

- ,  1998.  The  Threat.  New  York:  Simon  and 

Schuster. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New 
York:  Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and 
Company. 

Klass,  Philip  J.,  1988.  UFO-Abductions:  A  Dangerous 
Game.  Buffalo,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 

Lawson,  Alvin  H.,  1980.  “Hypnosis  of  Imaginary 
Abductees’.”  In  Curtis  G.  Fuller,  ed.  Proceedings 
of  the  First  Lnternational  UFO  Congress,  195-238. 
New  York:  Warner  Books. 

Lorenzen,  Jim,  and  Coral  Lorenzen,  1977.  Abducted! 
Confrontations  with  Beings  from  Outer  Space.  New 
York:  Berkley  Medallion. 

Mack,  John  E.,  1994.  Abduction:  Human  Encounters 
with  Aliens.  New  York:  Charles  Scribners  Sons. 

Strieber,  Whitley,  1987.  Communion:  A  True  Story. 
New  York:  Beach  Tree/William  Morrow. 

Swords,  Michael  D.,  1988.  “Extraterrestrial  Hy¬ 
bridization  Unlikely.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal  247 : 
6-10. 


Adama  7 


Unusual  Personal  Experiences:  An  Analysis  of  the  Data 
from  Three  National  Surveys  Condticted  by  the 
Roper  Organization,  1992.  Las  Vegas,  NV: 
Bigelow  Holding  Corporation. 

Abraham 

Channeler  Esther  Hicks  heard  from  abraham 
in  the  early  1980s.  She  renders  the  name  in 
lowercase  because  abraham  is  not  an  individ¬ 
ual  but  a  collection  of  highly  evolved  entities 
speaking  in  one  voice.  In  1986  she  and  her 
husband,  Jerry,  confided  their  experiences 
with  abraham  to  business  associates,  who 
soon  were  peppering  them  with  financial  and 
personal  questions  they  wanted  abraham  to 
answer.  When  the  Hickses  saw  how  satisfied 
their  friends  were  with  the  results,  they  de¬ 
cided  to  take  abraham  to  a  larger  public. 
Today  the  couple  conduct  workshops,  put  out 
a  newsletter,  and  lecture  widely  out  of  their 
San  Antonio,  Texas,  headquarters. 

Abraham  teaches  that  each  of  us  is  a  physi¬ 
cal  extension  of  an  essence  that  begins  in  the 
spiritual  realm.  Each  is  here  because  he  or  she 
has  chosen  to  be  so,  and  we  are  here  to  exer¬ 
cise  freedom  and  experience  joy.  The  universe 
is  benevolent,  and  it  gives  us  the  potential  to 
realize  all  of  our  dreams.  There  is  no  such 
thing  as  death;  all  of  us  live  forever. 

Further  Reading 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  American 
Religions.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale  Research. 

“A  Synopsis  of  Abraham-Hicks’s  Teachings.”  http:// 
www.abraham-hicks.com/bio.html. 

Abram 

Folklorist  Peter  M.  Rojcewicz  relates  the  expe¬ 
riences  of  a  young  university  student  to  whom 
he  gives  the  pseudonym  Polly  Bromberger.  In 
the  early  1980s  Bromberger  conjured  up  a 
spirit  guide — a  “personal  archetype,”  she 
sometimes  called  it — and  gave  it  the  name 
Abram.  With  long,  unkempt  hair  and  wearing 
a  white  robe  and  sandals,  Abram  looked  “bib¬ 
lical.”  He  came  more  clearly  into  focus  after 
Bromberger  had  undergone  a  period  of  medi¬ 
tation  and  reflection. 


A  student  of  the  great  psychologist  and 
philosopher  C.  G.  Jung,  Bromberger  used  a 
process  she  learned  from  Jung's  writings — 
“active  imagination” — to  bring  Abram  into 
her  life.  In  time  she  came  to  feel  that  he  had  a 
kind  of  independent  existence.  She  told  Roj¬ 
cewicz  that  “sometimes  I  feel  he  can  be  a  force 
opening  me  on  purpose  to  make  me  stretch 
myself,  and  work  myself,  and  sometimes  I  get 
frustrated  with  it.”  On  the  whole,  however, 
she  was  convinced  that  Abram  was  a  positive 
influence  in  her  life. 

Further  Reading 

Rojcewicz,  Peter  M.,  1984.  The  Boundaries  of  Ortho  - 
doxy:  A  Folkloric  Look  at  the  UFO  Phenomenon. 
Ph.D.  dissertation.  University  of  Pennsylvania, 
Philadelphia. 

Adama 

Adama,  who  channels  through  Dianne  Rob¬ 
bins,  is  an  Ascended  Master  and  High  Priest 
ofTelos,  the  great  Lemurian  city  now  located 
under  Mount  Shasta  in  northern  California. 
Because  of  his  pure  thoughts,  Adama,  like  the 
million  other  persons  who  live  in  the  city,  is 
able  to  live  for  hundreds  of  years.  He  is  cur¬ 
rently  more  than  six  hundred  years  old.  He  is 
a  descendant  of  the  Lemurians  who  fled  inside 
the  mountain  when  Lemuria  and  all  else  on 
Earths  surface  were  destroyed  in  a  nuclear 
holocaust.  Only  twenty-five  thousand  Lemu¬ 
rians  escaped  in  time. 

Since  then  the  Lemurians’  consciousness 
has  evolved  significantly.  Besides  attending  to 
their  spiritual  betterment,  the  Lemurians 
have  fought  off  marauding  extraterrestrials 
who  are  causing  harm  to  surface  dwellers. 
“We  are  all  part  of  God’s  grand  plan  for  the 
Universe,”  Adama  says,  “and  WE  ARE  NOW 
MERGING  OUR  THOUGHTS  INTO  ONE 
THOUGHT  FOR  THE  ENTIRE  HUMAN 
RACE.  Soon  we  will  all  be  on  the  same  wave 
band  of  consciousness,  broadcasting  our  love 
and  light  to  all  in  the  cosmos  and  letting  the 
cosmos  know  that  we  are  ready  to  join  with 
them  in  one  grand  FEDERATION  OF  PLAN¬ 
ETS”  (“Adama,”  1995). 


8  Adamski,  George 

See  Also:  Lemuria;  Mount  Shasta 

Further  Reading 

“Adama,”  1995-  http://www.salemctr.com/newage/ 
center36.html. 


Adamski,  George  (1891-1965) 

Though  largely  forgotten  today,  George 
Adamski  was  once  an  international  occult 
celebrity,  perhaps  the  most  famous  of  all  fly¬ 
ing-saucer  contactees.  His  claimed  meeting 
with  a  Venusian  in  the  California  desert  in 
November  1952  electrified  esoterically  in¬ 
clined  saucer  buffs.  In  three  books  published 
between  1953  and  1961  he  recounted  his 
trips  into  space  along  with  extensive  encoun¬ 
ters  with  benevolent  Venusians,  Martians,  and 
Saturnians.  In  1962  he  boarded  a  spaceship 
and  flew  to  Saturn  to  attend  an  interplanetary 
conference.  By  1965,  when  he  died,  many  of 
his  most  devoted  followers  had  broken  their 
connection  with  him,  convinced  either  that 
he  was  lying  or  that  evil  space  people  were 
misleading  him. 

Born  in  Poland,  Adamski  emigrated  with 
his  parents  to  upstate  New  York  when  he  was 
one  or  two  years  old.  In  the  early  1920s  he 
moved  to  California,  where  he  eventually  es¬ 
tablished  a  role  for  himself  on  the  local  oc¬ 
cult  scene  as  head  of  the  Royal  Order  of 
Tibet,  a  metaphysical  school  based  on  chan¬ 
neled  teachings  from  Tibetan  lamas.  When 
flying  saucers  became  an  object  of  popular 
interest  in  the  late  1940s,  Adamski  produced 
photographs  of  alleged  spacecraft;  some  of 
the  pictures  were  said  to  have  been  taken 
through  his  six-inch  telescope.  Published  in 
the  popular  occult  and  paranormal  digest 
Fate  in  1950  and  1951,  the  photos  along 
with  accompanying  text  afforded  Adamski 
his  first  wide  exposure.  On  November  20, 
1952,  as  six  others  (including  contactee  and 
fringe  archaeologist  George  Hunt  William¬ 
son)  watched  from  a  distance,  Adamski  ob¬ 
served  the  landing  of  a  saucer  and  the  emer¬ 
gence  of  the  beautiful,  blond-haired  Orthon, 
a  visitor  from  Venus,  who  expressed  concern 
about  the  human  race’s  warlike  ways.  (In 


later  years  Adamski  would  tell  confidants 
that  his  first  contacts  with  extraterrestrials 
occurred  in  his  childhood,  but  he  never  said 
as  much  publicly.)  Three  weeks  later  Orthon 
returned  in  his  scout  craft  over  Adamski’s 
Palomar  Gardens  residence  and  allowed  the 
ship  to  be  photographed.  The  resulting  pic¬ 
tures  would  generate  enormous  controversy 
and,  for  many,  virtually  define  the  image  of  a 
flying  saucer  as  a  domed  disc  with  a  three- 
ball  landing  gear. 

A  fifty-four-page  account  of  Adamski’s 
early  contacts  was  added  to  an  already  existing 
manuscript  (on  supposed  space  visitations 
throughout  history)  by  Irish  occultist 
Desmond  Leslie  and  published  in  1953  as  Fly  - 
ing  Saucers  Have  Landed.  Two  years  later,  in 
Inside  the  Space  Ships,  Adamski  expanded  his 
claims  to  encompass  further  interactions  with 
extraterrestrials,  both  on  Earth  and  aboard 
saucers.  According  to  Adamski,  the  “Space 
Brothers,”  as  he  called  them,  had  come  to 
help  the  human  race  out  of  its  backward,  vio¬ 
lent  ways,  which  were  leading  inexorably  to 
nuclear  war.  They  espoused  a  benign  occult 
philosophy  much  like  the  one  Adamski  had 
taught  for  many  years. 

Though  revered  by  many,  Adamski  also 
had  bitter  critics,  none  more  so  than  conser¬ 
vative  ufologists  who  dismissed  his  stories  as 
absurd  and  feared  that  he  was  bringing 
ridicule  to  all  of  UFO  research.  Some  ufolo¬ 
gists  actively  investigated  his  claims  and  un¬ 
covered  discrepancies  and  other  evidence  of 
untruthfulness.  One  found,  for  example,  that 
the  weather  on  a  particular  day  on  which 
Adamski  claimed  contact  was  not  as  he  had 
described  it.  Most  photo  analysts  concluded 
that  the  pictures  of  “spacecraft”  were  in  fact  of 
small  models.  On  one  occasion  skeptical  ufol¬ 
ogists  proved  that  one  Adamski  allegation  was 
unambiguously  false.  Adamski  had  reported 
that  as  he  was  traveling  to  Iowa  to  give  a  lec¬ 
ture,  the  train  suddenly  stopped  en  route. 
When  he  stepped  out  to  take  a  short  walk, 
space  people  met  him  and  flew  him  to  his  des¬ 
tination.  From  interviews  with  the  train  crew, 
investigators  learned  that  the  train  had  made 


Adamski,  George  9 


UFO  contactee  George  Adamski  with  his  six-inch  telescope  on  Mount  Palomar,  California  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


no  such  stop.  In  these  circumstances  Adamski 
tended  to  blame  his  accusers  of  being  agents 
of  a  sinister  “Silence  Group”  trying  to  destroy 
the  space  people’s  good  works.  But  in  later 
years,  following  his  death,  several  individuals 


disclosed  that  Adamski  had  acknowledged  to 
them  that  his  stories  were  not  true. 

By  1959  Adamski’s  renown  was  such  that 
he  was  able  to  embark  on  a  worldwide  tour, 
first  to  New  Zealand  and  Australia,  then  to 


10  Aenstrians 


Europe.  In  May  of  that  same  year,  Queen  Ju¬ 
liana  of  Holland  received  him,  igniting  fierce 
commentary  in  the  press  and  a  riot  at  the 
University  of  Zurich  when  Adamski 
attempted  to  give  a  lecture  in  Switzerland. 
Adamski  charged  that  the  students — and  in¬ 
deed  most  of  his  critics — were  agents  of  a  sin¬ 
ister  Silence  Group,  which  sought  to  frustrate 
the  moral  reforms  and  technological  advances 
advocated  by  the  space  people  and  their  ter¬ 
restrial  allies.  Though  the  reality  of  Adamski’s 
audience  with  Queen  Juliana  was  never  in 
doubt,  other  purported  meetings  with  nota¬ 
bles,  including  President  John  F.  Kennedy, 
Pope  John  XXIII,  and  Vice  President  Hubert 
H.  Humphrey,  that  figure  in  the  Adamski  leg¬ 
end  almost  certainly  did  not  occur  outside 
Adamski’s  imagination. 

In  the  early  1960s,  after  Adamski  openly 
embraced  psychic  approaches  of  which  he 
had,  till  then,  been  outspokenly  critical,  some 
of  his  followers  started  to  question  his  sincer¬ 
ity,  especially  when  he  began  doing  psychic 
consultations  for  profit.  His  associate  C.  A. 
Honey  circulated  damning  evidence  that 
Adamski  was  recycling  his  1930s-era  Tibetan- 
masters  teachings  and  putting  them  in  the 
mouths  of  space  people.  When  Adamski 
claimed  that  he  had  flown  to  Saturn,  the  story 
only  fueled  growing  doubts  even  among  de¬ 
voted  followers. 

His  career  in  decline,  his  credibility  never 
lower,  Adamski  went  on  a  final  lecture  tour 
through  New  York  and  Rhode  Island  in 
March  1965.  For  the  preceding  month,  his  fi¬ 
nancial  resources  exhausted,  he  had  been  liv¬ 
ing  with  Nelson  and  Madeleine  Rodeffer  in 
Maryland.  He  died  of  a  heart  attack  at  their 
home  on  the  evening  of  April  23. 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Orthon;  Ramu;  Williamson, 
George  Hunt;  Yamski 

Further  Reading 

Adamski,  George,  1955.  Inside  the  Space  Ships.  New 
York:  Abelard-Schuman. 

- ,  1961.  Flying  Saucers  Farewell.  New  York: 

Abelard-Schuman. 

- ,  1962.  Special  Report:  My  Trip  to  the  Twelve 

Counsellors  Meeting  That  Took  Place  on  Saturn, 
March  27— 30th,  1962.  Vista,  CA:  Science  of  Life. 


Bennett,  Colin,  2000.  “Breakout  of  the  Fictions: 
George  Adamski  s  1959  World  Tour.”  The  Anom  - 
alist%  (Spring):  39-84. 

Ellwood,  Robert  S.,  1995.  “Spiritualism  and  UFO 
Religion  in  New  Zealand:  The  International 
Transmission  of  Modern  Spiritual  Movements.” 
In  James  R.  Lewis,  ed.  The  Gods  Have  Landed: 
New  Religions  from  Other  Worlds,  167-186.  Al¬ 
bany,  NY:  State  University  of  New  York  Press. 

Good,  Timothy,  1998.  Alien  Base:  Earth’s  Encounters 
with  Extraterrestrials.  London:  Century. 

Heiden,  Richard  W,  1984.  Review  of  Zinsstag  and 
Goods  George  Adamski — The  Untold  Story.  The 
A.P.R.O.  Bulletin  32,  5  (August):  4-5. 

Leslie,  Desmond,  and  George  Adamski,  1953.  Flying 
Saucers  Have  Landed.  New  York:  British  Book 
Centre. 

Moseley,  James  W.,  ed.,  1957.  Special  Adamski  Ex  - 
pose  Issue.  Saucer  News  27  (October). 

Zinsstag,  Lou,  1990.  UFO...  George  Adamski: 
Their  Man  on  Earth.  Tucson,  AZ:  UFO  Photo 
Archives. 

Zinsstag,  Lou,  and  Timothy  Good,  1983.  George 
Adamski — The  Untold  Story.  Beckenham,  Kent, 
England:  Ceti  Publications. 

Aenstrians 

For  a  rime  in  the  mid  to  late  1 960s,  Warmin¬ 
ster,  Wiltshire,  was  the  focus  of  a  series  of  mys¬ 
terious  sightings  of  UFOs  and  hearings  of  ap- 
parendy  related  sounds.  The  excitement 
produced  what  was  called  the  “Warminster 
mystery,”  which  was  also  the  title  of  a  popular 
book  by  Arthur  Shuttlewood,  a  reporter  for  the 
Warminster  Journal.  Shuttlewood,  who  led  sky 
watches  and  became  the  leading  publicist  of 
the  phenomena,  also  reported  receiving  phone 
calls  from  self-identified  extraterrestrials,  as  well 
as  a  personal  visit  from  one.  The  aliens  said 
they  were  from  a  planet  named  Aenstria. 

The  first  calls  came  in  early  September 
1965.  The  calls  continued  for  a  period  of 
seven  weeks,  according  to  Shuttlewood.  The 
callers  were  three  Aenstrians:  Caellsan  (the 
senior  spacecraft  commander),  Selorik  (an  in¬ 
terpreter),  and  Traellison  (the  queen  of  Aens¬ 
tria).  In  each  case  they  phoned  from  a  public 
booth  in  a  particular  district  in  the  city, 
though  Shuttlewood  wrote  that  he  never 
heard  the  sound  of  coins  dropping  before  the 
voices  began  to  speak. 


Aetherius  1 1 


The  messages  were  standard  contactee  fare. 
Earth  is  in  trouble  because  of  atomic  weapons 
and  environmental  pollution.  Human  beings — 
the  product  of  special  creation,  not  evolutionary 
processes — should  return  to  simpler,  more  spiri¬ 
tual  ways.  The  Aenstrians  lived  long  lives  and 
suffered  few  illnesses.  Traellison,  for  example, 
was  450  years  old,  a  fairly  young  age  on  her 
home  planet.  The  Aenstrians  were  communi¬ 
cating  with  Shuttlewood  so  that  he  could  pass 
on  their  information  to  Earths  “councils.” 

On  May  24,  1967,  Shuttlewood’s  The 
Warminster  Mystery  was  published.  In  it  he  rel¬ 
egated  the  story  of  the  Aenstrians  s  phone  calls 
to  an  appendix,  where  he  suggested  that  they 
were  no  more  than  an  interesting  hoax.  On  the 
afternoon  of  the  twenty-sixth,  the  phone  rang 
at  the  Shuttlewood  residence.  It  was  an  Aens- 
trian  named  Karne,  expressing  displeasure  at 
what  the  author  had  said  of  his  colleagues’ 
trustworthiness.  Shuttlewood  responded  that 
if  Karne  wanted  to  prove  he  was  who  he 
claimed  to  be,  he  should  pay  a  personal  visit. 
Karne  took  up  the  challenge  and  showed  up  at 
Shutdewood’s  door  seven  seconds  later. 

Karne,  who  spent  a  total  of  nine  minutes 
with  the  journalist,  looked  like  an  ordinary  man 
in  most  ways,  except  for  an  apparent  absence  of 
pupils  in  his  eyes,  which  were  covered  by  thick 
glasses.  He  also  had  blue  blotches  on  his  cheek¬ 
bones  and  lips.  He  also  had  a  manner  that  un¬ 
nerved  Shuttlewood,  who  felt  that  the  ostensi¬ 
ble  extraterrestrial  had  powers  that,  if  provoked, 
could  instantly  destroy  him.  Karne  said  that 
Traellison,  Caellsan,  and  Selorik  had  returned 
to  their  home  “cantel”  (planet).  He  spoke  of  an 
imminent  war  in  the  Middle  East — the  Six-Day 
War  erupted  the  following  June — and  of  fur¬ 
ther  UFO  appearances,  this  time  of  cross¬ 
shaped  craft,  in  the  fall.  He  said  a  Third  World 
War  was  almost  inevitable  at  some  point  in  the 
not-distant  future.  If  it  was  fought  with  nuclear 
weapons,  he  hinted,  extraterrestrials  would  in¬ 
tervene  in  some  unspecified  fashion.  A  new 
order,  in  which  earthlings  would  be  trained  to 
become  cosmic  citizens,  would  be  put  in  place. 

“I  noticed  that  Karne  sometimes  had  diffi¬ 
culty  with  his  breathing,”  Shuttlewood  wrote. 


“From  time  to  time,  as  I  shot  questions  at 
him  ...  he  glanced  at  the  pale  gold  disc  on  his 
wrist.  He  replied  to  certain  queries  immedi¬ 
ately,  shaking  his  head  in  the  negative  over 
others,  after  looking  at  his  ‘watch’”  (Shuttle- 
wood,  1978).  At  one  point  Shuttlewood 
asked  if  George  Adamski’s  contact  claims  were 
genuine.  Karne  replied  sternly  that  he  could 
not  answer  that  question,  though  he  hinted 
that  the  late  California  contactee  was  not  of 
earthly  origin.  At  the  conclusion  of  the  meet¬ 
ing,  Shuttlewood  gripped  Karnes  wrist  and 
left  thumb  in  what  he  intended  as  a  gesture  of 
good  will,  but  the  visitor  winced  in  pain.  Ear¬ 
lier,  at  the  commencement  of  their  meeting, 
Karne  had  not  responded  to  Shuttlewood’s 
outstretched  hand. 

Shuttlewood  watched  him  walk,  turning 
stiffly  to  wave  farewell,  then  continue  up  the 
street.  “From  the  waist  up,”  Shuttlewood 
wrote,  “his  bearing  was  smart,  military,  almost 
arrogantly  proud.  From  the  waist  down,  how¬ 
ever,  his  movements  were  slow  and  deliberate. 
His  legs  seemed  weighted,  feet  slightly  drag¬ 
ging;  yet  to  a  casual  onlooker  he  would  have 
been  dismissed  as  an  old  gardener  type  or  old- 
fashioned  and  hard-worked  farm  laborer” 
(Shuttlewood,  1978). 

The  next  day  Shuttlewood’s  sixteen-year- 
old  son,  Graham,  saw  a  man  who  looked  like 
Karne  at  a  Warminster  park.  He  was  looking 
upward  as  military  jets  flew  by,  shaking  his 
head  in  disapproval.  His  left  hand  was  band¬ 
aged  as  if  it  had  been  recently  injured.  That 
was  the  last  either  saw  of  Karne. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Dewey,  Stephen,  1997.  “Arthur  Shuttlewood  and  the 
Warminster  Mystery.”  Strange  Magazine  18 
(Summer):  16-21,  56-58. 

Shuttlewood,  Arthur,  1967.  The  Warminster  Mystery. 
London:  Neville  Spearman. 

- ,  1978.  UFO  Prophecy.  New  York:  Global 

Communications. 


Aetherius 

Aetherius  is  one  of  the  Cosmic  Masters  who 
preside  at  the  Interplanetary  Parliament  on 


12  Affa 


Saturn.  In  1954  Aetherius  made  his  presence 
known  psychically  to  George  King,  a  London 
man  with  longstanding  occult  interests.  Soon 
King  was  channeling  other  space  people,  in¬ 
cluding  Jesus.  By  January  he  had  gone  public 
with  the  cosmic  gospel — essentially  earth- 
bound  occult  doctrines  ascribed  to  philosoph¬ 
ical  extraterrestrials — and  soon  was  issuing  a 
mimeographed  bulletin  titled  Aetherius  Speaks 
to  Earth  (later  Cosmic  Voice).  In  August  1956 
King  established  the  Aetherius  Society,  among 
the  most  successful  and  enduring  contactee 
groups.  King  died  on  July  12,  1997,  in  Los 
Angeles,  where  he  had  been  living  for  many 
years. 

In  the  theology  of  the  Aetherius  Society, 
good  and  evil  extraterrestrials  are  engaged  in 
constant  warfare.  From  time  to  time,  during 
crisis  situations,  the  Cosmic  B  rotherhood  will 
place  its  spaceships  above  Earth  and  direct 
positive  energy  downward.  Society  members 
receive  the  energy  and  make  sure  that  it 
reaches  its  targets.  Over  a  three  and  a  half  year 
period,  beginning  in  1958,  King  climbed  no 
fewer  than  eighteen  mountains  at  the  behest 
of  the  space  people. 

The  society  maintains  headquarters  in 
London  and  Los  Angeles,  as  well  as  chapters 
all  over  the  world. 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Aetherius  Society,  1995.  The  Aetherius  Society:  A  Cos  - 
mic  Concept.  Hollywood,  CA:  Aetherius  Society. 

Curran,  Douglas,  1985.  In  Advance  of  the  Landing: 
Folk  Concepts  of  Outer  Space.  New  York:  Abbeville 
Press. 

Saliba,  John  A.,  1995.  “Religious  Dimensions  of 
UFO  Phenomena.”  In  James  R.  Lewis,  ed.  The 
Gods  Have  Landed:  Neiv  Religions  from  Other 
Worlds,  15-64.  Albany,  NY:  State  University  of 
New  York  Press. 

Wallis,  Roy,  1974.  “The  Aetherius  Society:  A  Case 
Study  of  a  Mystagogic  Congregation.”  Sociologi  - 
cal  Review  22:  27—44. 


Affa 

Affa  first  appeared  in  1952  among  the  extra¬ 
terrestrials  who  communicated  to  a  small 
Prescott,  Arizona,  occult  group  headed  by 


George  Hunt  Williamson.  Affa,  identified  as 
being  from  the  planet  Uranus,  first  spoke 
through  automatic  writing,  then  later  al¬ 
legedly  by  radio,  warning  of  threats  to  Earth 
by  evil  humans  and  menacing  aliens  from  the 
“Orion  Solar  Systems.” 

Affa  later  surfaced  in  automatic-writing 
communications  to  Frances  Swan  of  Eliot, 
Maine,  beginning  in  1954.  Mrs.  Swan’s  Affa, 
like  Williamsons,  did  his  communicating 
from  a  giant  Uranian  spaceship.  Affa  urged 
Swan  to  alert  the  United  States  Navy  so  that  it 
could  receive  his  radio  messages.  Swan  told 
her  neighbor,  retired  navy  Adm.  Herbert  B. 
Knowles,  about  Affa’s  request.  Knowles,  a 
UFO  enthusiast,  sat  in  on  a  writing  session 
and  addressed  questions  to  Affa.  Impressed  by 
the  answers,  he  wrote  the  Office  of  Naval  In¬ 
telligence  (ONI),  which  on  June  8  sent  two 
officers  to  Swan’s  house.  They  also  asked  ques¬ 
tions  of  Affa,  who  promised  a  radio  transmis¬ 
sion  at  2  P.M.  on  June  10.  When  none  came, 
ONI  lost  interest  and  turned  the  letters  over 
to  the  navy’s  Bureau  of  Aeronautics.  John 
Hutson,  a  security  officer,  was  curious  enough 
to  fly  up  to  Eliot  for  two  days  in  late  July.  On 
his  return  he  spoke  with  an  FBI  agent,  but  the 
agency  chose  not  to  pursue  the  matter. 

In  the  summer  of  1959  navy  Commander 
Julius  Larsen,  an  ONI  liaison  officer  to  the 
CIA’s  Photographic  Intelligence  Center  in 
Washington,  DC,  stumbled  upon  a  file  on  the 
incident.  Larsen,  a  navy  pilot  who  harbored  a 
private  fascination  with  spiritualism,  called  on 
Swan  and  Knowles.  At  one  point  Larsen  tried 
automatic  writing  and  believed  he  had  com¬ 
municated  with  Affa,  though  Swan  insisted  he 
had  not  contacted  her  Affa. 

Back  in  Washington  Larsen  talked  with 
Center  Director  Arthur  Lundahl  and  Lun- 
dahl’s  assistant,  Lt.  Cmdr.  Robert  Neasham,  a 
navy  officer.  In  their  presence  Larsen  entered  a 
trance  state  and  supposedly  contacted  Affa 
while  Lundahl  and  Neasham  peppered  him 
with  questions.  At  one  point,  challenged  to 
prove  his  existence,  Affa  replied,  “Go  to  the 
window.”  Lundahl  saw  nothing  but  clouds, 
though  Neasham  seemed  convinced  that  a 


Agharti  13 


spaceship  was  hiding  in  them.  Neasham 
would  also  claim  that  radar  operators  at 
Washington  National  Airport  told  him  that 
that  particular  portion  of  the  sky  was  mysteri¬ 
ously  “blocked  out.”  No  independent  evi¬ 
dence  supported  that  allegation. 

Neasham  notified  Major  Robert  Friend, 
head  of  the  air  forces  UFO-investigative 
agency,  Project  Blue  Book.  For  Friend’s  bene¬ 
fit  Larsen  even  related  telepathic  messages 
from  Affa  and  other  space  people,  but  the 
aliens  refused  his  request  for  a  flyover.  Friend 
wrote  a  memo  on  the  episode  and  sent  it  to 
his  superiors.  Nothing  further  was  done.  The 
incident  remained  buried  in  Pentagon,  FBI, 
and  CIA  files  until  the  early  1970s,  when 
Friend  shared  his  notes  with  UFO  historian 
David  M.  Jacobs.  Subsequently,  some  exag¬ 
gerated  accounts  of  the  episode  were  pub¬ 
lished  in  the  UFO  literature,  a  few  even 
claiming  that  the  CIA  itself  had  communi¬ 
cated  with  extraterrestrials. 

See  Also:  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Emenegger,  Robert,  1974.  UFOs  Past,  Present  and 
Future.  New  York:  Ballantine  Books. 

Fitzgerald,  Randall,  1979.  “Messages:  The  Case  His¬ 
tory  of  a  Contactee.”  Second  Look  1,  12  (Octo¬ 
ber):  12-18,  28-29. 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  1975.  The  UFO  Controversy  in 
America.  Bloomington:  Indiana  University  Press. 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  and  Alfred  C.  Bailey, 
1954.  The  Saucers  Speak! A  Documentary  Report  of 
Interstellar  Communications  by  Radiotelegraphy. 
Los  Angeles:  New  Age  Publishing  Company. 

Agents 

“Agents”  are  human  beings  whom  extraterres¬ 
trials  have  contacted  and  who  have  agreed  to 
help  the  space  people  in  their  benevolent  mis¬ 
sion  to  Earth.  George  Flunt  Williamson  wrote 
that  agents,  who  come  from  all  social  and  eco¬ 
nomic  backgrounds,  sometimes  have  a 
“strange,  far-away,  glassy  look  in  their  eyes.” 
Their  necks  may  throb  or  jump  spasmodically, 
indicating  that  they  are  receiving  telepathic  in¬ 
structions.  The  Agents  conduct  a  variety  of 
tasks.  They  introduce  persons  who  are  of  po¬ 
tential  use  to  them  to  each  other,  recommend 


books,  ask  provocative  questions,  and  in  other 
ways,  subtle  or  obvious,  get  people  thinking 
about  space  visitors  and  spiritual  reform.  They 
also  minister  to  the  needy  and  have  a  particu¬ 
lar  interest  in  orphaned  children. 

Extraterrestrials  get  in  touch  with  Agents  in 
assorted  ways.  Sometimes  it  is  through  a  car  or 
ham  radio,  sometimes  via  thought  waves,  on 
occasion  by  direct,  physical  encounter. 

See  Also:  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1953.  Other  Tongue — 
Other  Flesh.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 


Agharti 

Agharti  is  a  subterranean  kingdom,  which  al¬ 
legedly  exists  in  Tibet  or  Mongolia.  It  is,  de¬ 
pending  on  whom  one  believes,  a  paradisiacal 
realm  or  a  sinister  lair  of  sorcerers  and  other 
evildoers — mostly,  however,  the  former.  The 
legend  of  Agharti  seems  loosely  based  on  the 
Buddhist  realm  of  Shambhala,  a  city  of  adepts 
and  mystics  said  to  be  located  in  a  hidden  val¬ 
ley  (called  “Shangri-La”  in  James  Hilton’s 
popular  novel  Lost  Horizon  [1933]  and  in  the 
movie  of  the  same  name).  Shambhala  first  ap¬ 
peared  in  a  1922  Polish  book,  soon  afterward 
translated  into  English  as  the  best-seller  Beasts, 
Men  and  Gods. 

The  author,  Ferdinand  Ossendowski 
(1876-1945),  fled  Russia  in  the  wake  of  the 
Bolshevik  revolution.  An  anti-Communist, 
Ossendowski  participated  in  the  White  Rus¬ 
sian  government,  that  nation’s  short-lived  ex¬ 
periment  in  democracy  between  the  over¬ 
throw  of  the  tsar  and  the  triumph  of  the 
Communists.  He  wandered  through  Mongo¬ 
lia,  itself  torn  by  political  unrest  and  bloody 
conflict.  There  he  learned,  he  said,  of  a  myste¬ 
rious  “King  of  the  World.”  A  lama  in  the 
town  of  Narabanchi  took  him  into  a  temple 
in  which  there  was  a  throne.  Ossendowski  was 
told  that  in  1890  horsemen  had  ridden  into 
town  and  instructed  all  the  local  lamas  to 
come  to  the  temple.  One  of  the  horsemen  sat 
on  the  throne,  at  which  point  all  present  “fell 
to  their  knees  as  they  recognized  the  man  who 


The  hidden  world  of  “Shangri-La”  as  depicted  in  the  film  Lost  Horizon,  directed  by  Frank  Capra,  1937  (Photofest) 


had  been  long  ago  described  in  the  sacred 
bulls  of  the  Dalai  Lama,  Tashi  Lama,  and 
Bodgo  Khan.  He  was  the  man  to  whom  the 
whole  world  belongs  and  who  has  penetrated 
into  all  the  mysteries  of  Nature.  He  pro¬ 
nounced  a  short  Tibetan  prayer,  blessed  all  his 
hearers  and  afterwards  made  predictions  for 
the  coming  half  century.  This  was  thirty  years 
ago  and  in  the  interim  all  his  prophecies  are 
being  fulfilled”  (Ossendowski,  1922).  The 
King  of  the  World  lived  in  an  underground 
realm  called  Agharti. 

Whether  this  King  of  the  World,  or  even 
the  author’s  supposed  informant,  ever  existed, 
he  and  his  kingdom  soon  entered  occult  lore. 
In  Darkness  over  Tibet  (1935)  Theodore  Illion 
recounted  his  allegedly  true  adventures  in  an 
underground  city  in  a  distant  valley.  At  first 
he  thought  he  had  entered  a  utopia,  but  soon 
he  realized  that  the  inhabitants,  for  all  their 


advanced  spiritual  knowledge  and  supernatu¬ 
ral  powers,  were  cannibals.  Illion  wrote  that 
his  reported  experiences  proved  the  existence 
of  Agharti.  In  1946  Vincent  H.  Gaddis,  a  reg¬ 
ular  contributor  to  Amazing  Stories  who  later 
achieved  a  degree  of  fame  as  the  inventor  of 
the  concept  of  the  Bermuda  Triangle,  picked 
up  on  the  theme,  depicting  Agharti  as  a  city  of 
evil  that  was  linked  to  tunnels  all  over  the 
world.  He  incorporated  Agharti  into  the 
Shaver  mystery,  the  subject  of  a  series  of  tales 
Amazing  Stories  was  running  about  an  alleged 
underground  realm  populated  by  deros,  de¬ 
monic  entities  in  possession  of  a  fantastic  At- 
lantean  technology,  which  they  used  to  tor¬ 
ment  surface  humans. 

In  a  variant  of  the  legend,  Robert  Ernst 
Dickhoff’s  Agharta:  The  Subterranean  World 
(1951)  contended  that  two  and  a  half  million 
years  ago  Martians  landed  at  Antarctica,  then 


Akon  15 


a  tropical  region,  and  created  the  first  hu¬ 
mans.  Then  reptoid  (that  is,  biped  reptilian) 
Venusians  attacked,  forcing  the  Martians  and 
their  human  associates  to  create  two  huge  un¬ 
derground  cities,  connected  by  tunnels  of  vast 
length,  in  order  to  protect  themselves.  One  of 
these  cities  was  Shambhala,  under  Tibet,  and 
the  other  Agharta,  under  Chinas  Tzangpo 
Valley.  Eventually,  the  Venusians  conquered 
Agharta,  sending  their  evil  minions  into  the 
world  until  1948,  when  the  Martian/human 
alliance  reclaimed  the  city  and  slew  its  ruler, 
the  King  of  the  World,  and  many  of  his 
troops. 

There  is  no  real-life  Central  Asian  tradition 
of  Agharti,  though  Chinese  and  Tibetan 
equivalents  to  Western  fairy  lore  spoke  of  mag¬ 
ical  caves,  on  the  other  side  of  which  the  trav¬ 
eler  would  find  a  beautiful  land  and  lovely  but 
ultimately  treacherous  supernatural  beings. 

See  Also:  Reptoids 

Further  Reading 

Dickhoff,  Robert  Ernst,  1965.  Agharta.  New  York: 
Fieldcrest. 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
100,000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwarf,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

Ossendowski,  Ferdinand,  1922.  Beasts,  Men  and 
Gods.  New  York:  Dutton. 


A  hah 

On  a  camping  trip  through  eastern  Oregon  in 
the  summer  of  1975,  a  young  married  couple 
identified  as  Darryl  and  Toni  M.  stopped 
along  the  banks  of  the  Owyhee  River  to  cool 
their  truck.  They  spotted  an  odd  object 
parked  on  a  nearby  hillside.  The  next  thing 
they  knew,  it  was  two  hours  later,  and  their 
truck  started  as  if  it  had  long  since  cooled  off. 
Later,  under  hypnosis,  they  recounted  the  ex¬ 
perience  of  wandering  into  the  UFO  in  a 
trance  state.  Hairless  humanoids  with  slits  for 
eyes,  mouth,  and  nose,  with  gray,  wrinkled 
skin  assured  them  via  telepathy  that  they 
meant  no  harm.  As  Toni  watched,  the  aliens, 
who  communicated  with  each  other  with  a 
“buzzing  bee”  sound,  subjected  Darryl  to  an 


apparent  physical  examination  by  light  beam. 
Sometime  later  Toni  awoke  to  find  a  figure 
with  a  skull-like  face  and  a  small  mouth 
standing  at  the  foot  of  her  bed.  He  spoke  to 
her,  but  all  she  could  remember  was  that  he 
had  told  her  his  name  was  Ahab. 

Further  Reading 

Hartman,  Terry  A.,  1979.  “Another  Abduction  by 
Extraterrestrials.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal  141 
(November):  3—4. 


Akon 

Akon  appeared  to  Elizabeth  Klarer  on  April  6, 
1956,  when  his  spaceship  landed  in  the  Drak¬ 
ensberg  Mountains  of  Natal,  South  Africa. 
She  was  flown  to  a  waiting  mother  ship, 
where  she  met  other  friendly  space  people  and 
learned  that  they  came  from  the  beautiful 
planet  Meton  in  the  orbit  of  Alpha  Centauri 
four  light  years  away.  The  Metonites,  she 
learned,  are  vegetarians  who  live  in  a  utopian 
society  without  conflict  or  disease.  They  are 
also  a  passionate  people,  and  in  due  course,  as 
the  contacts  continued,  Klarer  and  Akon  be¬ 
came  lovers.  She  bore  him  a  son,  Ayling,  dur¬ 
ing  a  four-month  stay  on  Meton. 

Klarer  became  well  known  in  saucer  and  oc¬ 
cult  circles  in  South  Africa  and  Europe  where 
she  lectured  from  time  to  time.  She  distributed 
photographs  of  Akon’s  spacecraft  and  showed 
inquirers  a  ring  she  said  he  had  given  her. 
Though  many  dismissed  her  stories  and  evi¬ 
dence  as  bogus,  her  friend  Cynthia  Hind,  a 
well-known  ufologist  from  Zimbabwe,  be¬ 
lieved  her  to  be  sincere  and  has  helped  keep  her 
name  and  story  alive.  On  the  occasion  of  her 
death  in  February  1994,  Hind  wrote,  “Eliza¬ 
beth  Klarer  died  in  comparative  poverty.  .  .  . 
Her  incredible  story  brought  her  some  fame  (or 
more  accurately,  notoriety!)  but  certainly  no 
riches”  (Hind,  1994). 

Further  Reading 

Hind,  Cynthia,  1982.  UFOs — African  Encounters. 
Salisbury,  Zimbabwe:  Gemini. 

- ,  1994.  “MUFON  Forum:  Contactee 

Klarer.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal  315  (July):  18. 

- ,  1999.  “Ufology  Profile:  Elizabeth  Klarer.” 

MUFON  UFO  Journal  379  (November):  10-11. 


16  Alien  diners 


Klarer,  Elizabeth,  1980.  Beyond  the  Light  Barrier. 

Cape  Town,  South  Africa:  Howard  Timmins. 

Alien  diners 

An  alien  family  ate  at  a  restaurant  and  stayed 
overnight  in  a  motel  in  suburban  St.  Louis  in 
May  1970,  according  to  ufologist  John  E. 
Schroeder,  who  interviewed  employees  and 
heard  a  strange  and  comic  tale.  Dorothy 
Simpson,  a  front  desk  clerk  at  the  motel  and  a 
fellow  member  of  the  UFO  Study  Group  of 
Greater  St.  Louis,  tipped  Schroeder  off  to  the 
incident  soon  after  its  occurrence. 

Simpson  was  examining  billing  documents 
at  her  desk  at  10:30  A.M.  on  May  15  when  a 
“whistling  sigh”  sounded.  She  looked  up,  and 
on  the  other  side  of  the  desk  stood  four  tiny 
people,  apparently  members  of  a  family:  a 
couple  and  their  two  children.  All  looked 
strikingly  alike.  All  were  youthful  in  appear¬ 
ance,  and  the  children  were  nearly  the  height 
of  the  ostensible  parents.  They  were  so  short 
that  they  barely  reached  the  level  of  the  desk. 
They  were  all  expensively  dressed,  the  males 
in  tailored  suits,  the  females  in  pastel  peach 
dresses.  Their  hair  did  not  look  real.  Odd  as  it 
seemed,  Simpson  suspected  that  they  were 
wearing  wigs. 

In  a  falsetto  voice  the  man  said,  “Do  you 
have  a  room  to  stay?  Do  you  have  a  room  to 
stay?”  She  told  him  what  the  charges  would 
be,  but  he  seemed  not  to  understand  what  she 
had  said.  He  turned  to  his  female  companion 
as  if  expecting  her  to  clarify  matters,  but  she 
remained  silent.  An  uncomfortable  period  of 
silence  followed,  broken  finally  when  the  man 
reached  into  his  pocket  and  pulled  out  a  thick 
wad  of  bills,  many  of  large  denomination. 
The  bills  were  so  crisp  and  new  that  Simpson 
wondered  if  they  were  counterfeit,  but  some 
quick  informal  testing  suggested  they  were 
not.  She  took  two  twenty-dollar  bills  from  the 
stack  and  gave  the  rest  back. 

Because  the  man  was  too  small  to  reach  up 
to  fill  out  the  reservation  form,  Simpson  said 
she  would  do  it  for  him.  He  said  his  name  was 
“A.  Bell.”  As  he  stepped  forward  she  got  a  bet¬ 


ter  look  at  him  and  was  able  to  compare  his 
face  with  his  companions’.  According  to 
Schroeder,  whose  composite  description 
comes  from  his  interviews  with  Simpson  and 
other  motel  employees  who  saw  them,  they 
were  “wide  at  eye  level,  their  faces  thinned 
abruptly  to  their  chins.  Their  eyes  were  large, 
dark  and  slightly  slanted.  .  .  .  Their  noses  had 
practically  no  bridges  and  two  slits  for  nos¬ 
trils,  and  their  mouths  were  tiny  and  lipless — 
no  wider  than  their  nostrils.  All  look  uni¬ 
formly  pale.  (Color  descriptions  varied  from 
pearl  to  pale  pink  to  light  grey.)” 

“And  where  are  you  from?”  Simpson  asked. 
At  that  the  man’s  arm  shot  upward  as  if  point¬ 
ing  to  the  sky,  and  he  said,  “We  come  from  up 
there.  Up  there.”  The  woman  pushed  his  arm 
down  and  spoke  for  the  first  time.  She  said 
they  were  from  Hammond,  Indiana,  and  she 
gave  a  street  address.  The  man  signed  the  reg¬ 
ister  but  did  it  so  awkwardly  that  Simpson 
thought  he  seemed  not  to  know  how  to  use  a 
pen.  The  woman  wanted  to  know  where  they 
could  eat.  Simpson  indicated  the  direction  of 
the  motel  restaurant. 

Meanwhile,  the  bellhop  came  over  to  store 
their  bags  while  they  ate.  At  the  manager’s  in¬ 
sistence  Simpson  checked  the  Indiana  address 
and  learned  that  both  the  name  and  the  ad¬ 
dress  were  bogus.  The  bellhop  checked  the 
parking  lot  for  a  car  with  an  Indiana  license 
plate  but  found  none. 

The  hostess  who  led  the  strange  family  to  a 
table  in  the  restaurant  noticed  that  the  chins 
of  even  the  adults  barely  reached  the  top  of 
the  table.  The  man  read  aloud  from  the  menu 
and  kept  asking  odd  questions  about  where 
milk,  vegetables,  and  other  common  foods 
come  from.  The  woman  ordered  peas  and 
milk  for  herself  and  the  children,  and  for  the 
man  peas,  a  small  steak,  and  water.  Their  eat¬ 
ing  was  similarly  peculiar.  Each  picked  up  a 
single  pea  with  a  knife,  brought  it  to  his  or  her 
tiny  mouth,  and  inhaled  it  with  a  sucking 
sound.  The  father  was  unable  to  get  even  a 
small  piece  of  steak  through  his  slit  of  a 
mouth.  They  stopped  eating  all  at  the  same 
time.  The  man  produced  a  twenty-dollar  bill 


Alien  DNA  17 


and  gave  it  to  the  waitress,  who  went  to  get 
change;  when  she  returned,  they  were  gone. 

When  the  bellhop  saw  them,  he  retrieved 
their  baggage  and  stepped  into  the  elevator  to 
lead  them  to  their  room.  When  the  elevator 
door  opened,  though,  the  family  recoiled  in 
fright  and  confusion.  The  bellhop  had  to  as¬ 
sure  them  that  there  was  no  danger.  After  let¬ 
ting  them  into  the  room,  he  turned  on  the 
lights.  Suddenly  the  man  began  shouting  at 
him  that  the  light  would  hurt  the  children’s 
eyes.  Suddenly  frightened  himself,  the  bellhop 
fled  without  waiting — one  suspects  futilely,  in 
any  case — for  a  tip. 

The  bellhop,  the  manager,  and  Simpson 
vowed  to  watch  for  the  little  people’s  depar¬ 
ture  in  the  morning,  but  they  were  never  seen 
again,  though  the  front  door  was  the  only 
door  they  could  pass  through  without  setting 
off  a  security  alarm.  The  alarms  were  checked, 
and  nothing  was  amiss.  Schroeder  interviewed 
all  five  employees  who  had  interacted  with  the 
family.  All  seemed  sincerely  bewildered  by  the 
curious  series  of  events. 

See  Also:  Extraterrestrials  among  us 

Further  Reading 

Schroeder,  John  E.,  1987.  “The  Strangers  among 
Us.”  The  UFO  Enigma  7,  7  (June):  36. 


Alien  DNA 

Physical  evidence  of  abduction  experiences  is 
hard  to  come  by,  and  physical  evidence  of  ac¬ 
tual  aliens  is  all  but  nonexistent.  A  case  from 
Australia  may  be  an  exception.  Biochemists 
were  able  to  analyze,  with  curious  results,  a 
strand  of  what  was  reported  to  be  the  hair  of 
an  alien  woman. 

The  events  that  led  to  the  analysis  began 
on  the  night  of  July  12,  1988,  when  Peter 
Khoury,  a  Sydney  resident  of  Lebanese  back¬ 
ground,  was  awakened  suddenly  when  he 
sensed  that  something  had  grabbed  his  ankles. 
A  numbness  crept  up  his  body  from  the  feet, 
and  soon  his  entire  body  except  for  his  eyes 
was  paralyzed.  To  his  right  he  spotted  three  or 
four  small  hooded  figures  with  wrinkled, 
shiny  black  faces.  Through  telepathy  they  as¬ 


sured  him  he  would  not  be  harmed.  Khoury 
then  saw  two  other  figures  on  his  left.  “These 
two,”  he  later  told  investigator  Bill  Chalker, 
“were  thin,  tall  with  big  black  eyes  and  a  nar¬ 
row  chin.”  They  were  “gold-yellow  in  color.” 
One  of  these  beings  shoved  a  needle  into  the 
left  side  of  his  forehead,  and  he  passed  out. 

The  next  day  he  showed  the  puncture 
wound  to  his  fiancee.  Later  he  showed  it  to 
his  doctor,  who  thought  he  had  walked  into  a 
nail.  When  Khoury  told  him  what  had  hap¬ 
pened,  the  physician  laughed  at  him.  He 
found  that  this  was  a  typical  response  and 
grew  despondent  and  anxious,  worried  about 
the  strange  nature  of  the  experience,  about 
the  future,  about  his  inability  to  communi¬ 
cate  with  anyone  who  would  listen  to  him. 
Eventually,  his  fiancee  found  a  copy  of  Whit¬ 
ley  Strieber’s  Communion  (1987),  detailing 
the  author’s  personal  abduction  experiences. 
In  time  he  heard  about  and  joined  a  local 
UFO  group  but  left  it  still  unsatisfied.  In 
April  1993  he  founded  the  UFO  Experience 
Support  Association. 

On  July  23,  1992,  Khoury  had  a  second, 
even  stranger  encounter.  He  was  suffering  from 
the  effects  of  an  assault  by  three  men  at  his  job, 
and  as  a  consequence  he  was  on  strong  medica¬ 
tion  and  mostly  bed-ridden.  On  the  morning  in 
question,  he  managed  with  considerable  diffi¬ 
culty  to  drive  his  wife — he  was  now  married — 
to  the  train  station  so  that  she  could  get  to 
work.  Once  home  he  crawled  back  into  bed  and 
passed  out,  only  to  awaken  a  few  minutes  later. 
He  was  sitting  straight  up  and  staring  at  two 
nude  women  sitting  on  the  bed. 

They  were  strange-looking,  with  a  weird, 
glassy-eyed  expression.  One  looked  generally 
Asian,  something  like  an  East  Indian;  the 
other  was  blond,  with  eyes  two  or  three  times 
larger  than  normal.  Their  cheekbones  seemed 
abnormally  high.  The  dark  woman  was  watch¬ 
ing  her  companion  closely,  as  if  the  blond  were 
demonstrating  something  to  her.  The  blond 
pulled  Khoury  toward  her  breasts,  apparently 
initiating  a  sex  act.  He  tried  to  resist,  but  she 
was  too  strong  for  him.  As  he  struggled,  he  bit 
her  nipple  so  hard  that  he  bit  it  off.  He  could 


18  Aliens  and  the  dead 


feel  it  in  his  throat.  The  woman  only  looked  at 
him  in  puzzlement.  She  did  not  act  as  if  she 
were  in  pain,  and  there  was  no  blood.  At  that 
point  the  two  vanished. 

The  nipple  was  caught  in  his  throat,  caus¬ 
ing  him  to  cough  persistently  for  hours.  Even¬ 
tually,  he  was  able  to  swallow  it.  In  the  mean¬ 
time,  feeling  pain  in  his  genital  region,  he 
examined  his  penis.  There  he  found  two  hairs 
wrapped  tightly  around  it.  He  had  no  idea 
how  they  had  gotten  there,  unless  they  had 
been  placed  on  his  penis  as  he  was  sleeping. 
As  he  untangled  them,  he  felt  enormous  pain. 
He  preserved  the  strands — one  about  twelve 
centimeters  long,  the  other  about  six — in  a 
plastic  bag. 

Though  many  abductees  have  reported  sex¬ 
ual  experiences  with  aliens  (or,  as  some  re¬ 
searchers  think,  alien/human  hybrids),  none 
have  come  out  of  the  experience  with  a  sup¬ 
posed  part  of  an  alien  body. 

In  1999  Chalker,  a  chemist  by  profession 
and  a  well-regarded  UFO  investigator  by  avo¬ 
cation,  brought  the  strands  to  a  group  of  bio¬ 
chemists  for  analysis.  The  analysis  reads  in 
part: 

The  blonde  hair  provides  for  a  strange  and  un¬ 
usual  DNA  sequence,  showing  five  consistent 
substitutions  from  a  human  consensus  .  .  . 
which  could  not  easily  have  come  from  anyone 
else  in  the  Sydney  area  except  by  the  rarest  of 
chances;  is  not  apparently  due  to  any  sort  of 
laboratory  contamination;  and  is  found  only  in 
a  few  other  people  throughout  the  whole 
world.  .  .  . 

While  it  may  not  be  impossible  for  him  to 
have  had  sexual  contact  with  some  fair¬ 
skinned,  nearly  albino  female  from  the  Syd¬ 
ney  area,  such  an  explanation  is  ruled  out  by 
the  DNA  evidence,  which  fits  only  a  Chinese 
Mongoloid  as  a  donor  of  the  hair.  Further¬ 
more,  while  it  might  be  possible  to  find  a  few 
Chinese  in  Sydney  with  the  same  DNA  as 
seen  in  just  4%  ofTaiwanese  women,  it 
would  not  be  plausible  to  find  a  Chinese 
woman  here  with  thin,  almost  clear  hair,  hav¬ 
ing  the  same  rare  DNA.  Finally,  that  thin 
blonde  hair  could  not  plausibly  represent  a 


chemically-bleached  Chinese  (including  the 
root)  because  then  its  DNA  could  not  easily 
have  been  extracted. 

The  most  probable  donor  of  the  hair  must 
therefore  be  as  the  young  man  claims:  a  tall 
blonde  female  who  does  not  need  much  color 
in  her  hair  or  skin  as  a  form  of  protection 
against  the  sun,  perhaps  because  she  does  not 
require  it.  Could  this  young  man  really  have 
provided,  by  chance,  a  hair  sample  which  con¬ 
tains  DNA  from  one  of  the  rarest  human  line¬ 
ages  known  .  .  .  that  lies  further  from  the 
mainstream  than  any  other  except  for  African 
Pygmies  and  aboriginals?  (Chalker,  1999). 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Hybrid  beings; 
Strieber,  Whitley 

Further  Reading 

Chalker,  Bill,  1999.  “Strange  Evidence.”  Interna  - 
tional  UFO  Reporter  24,  1  (Spring):  3-16,  31. 
Strieber,  Whitley,  1987.  Communion:  A  True  Story. 
New  York:  Beach  Tree/William  Morrow. 


Aliens  and  the  dead 

In  the  view  of  UFO-abduction  investigator 
David  M.  Jacobs,  aliens  sometimes  take  on 
the  form  of  deceased  relatives  in  the  interest  of 
keeping  their  activities  secret. 

He  recounts  the  experience  of  a  woman  to 
whom  he  gives  the  pseudonym  Fily  Martin¬ 
son.  Vacationing  with  her  mother  in  the  Vir¬ 
gin  Islands  in  1987,  Martinson  woke  up  in 
her  hotel  room  to  observe  the  apparition  of 
her  dead  brother  watching  her  from  the  foot 
of  the  bed.  The  experience  comforted  her. 
Eater,  however,  when  Jacobs  put  her  under 
hypnosis,  Martinson  saw  the  individual  she 
had  thought  was  her  brother  as,  in  Jacobs’s 
words,  “a  person  without  clothes,  small,  thin, 
no  hair,  and  large  eyes.”  He  calls  such  indi¬ 
viduals  as  Martinson  “unaware  abductees.” 
Unaware  abductees  “explain  their  strange  ex¬ 
periences  in  ways  acceptable  to  society,  inter¬ 
preting  the  entities  they  see  as  ghosts,  angels, 
demons,  or  even  animals.” 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs 

Further  Reading 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  1998.  The  Threat.  New  York: 

Simon  and  Schuster. 


Alpha  Zoo  Loo  19 


Allingham’s  Martian 

According  to  Flying  Saucer  from  Mars  (1954), 
Englishman  and  author  Cedric  Allingham 
witnessed  the  landing  of  an  extraterrestrial 
spacecraft  while  vacationing  in  Scotland  in 
February  1954.  A  tall  man,  human  in  all  ways 
except  for  an  unusually  broad  forehead, 
stepped  out  of  the  vehicle.  The  occupant,  who 
indicated  that  he  was  from  Mars,  spoke  in  a 
friendly  fashion,  saying  that  he  had  earlier  vis¬ 
ited  Venus  and  the  moon.  He  asked  if  earth¬ 
lings  would  soon  visit  the  latter  world,  and 
when  Allingham  replied  yes,  the  Martian 
acted  concerned.  He  wanted  to  know  if  a  war 
would  soon  erupt  on  Earth.  After  this  conver¬ 
sation,  which  occurred  mostly  by  gestures,  the 
Martian  reentered  his  craft  and  flew  away, 
though  not  before  Allingham  had  pho¬ 
tographed  him  (from  the  back)  and  his  ship. 
The  book  asserted  that  a  man  named  James 
Duncan  had  witnessed  the  entire  encounter. 

A  year  earlier  George  Adamski  had  pub¬ 
lished  his  account  of  a  meeting  with  the 
Venusian  Orthon  in  the  southern  California 
desert.  Allingham’s  tale  thrilled  British  sauce- 
rians,  who  now  felt  they  had  their  own  con¬ 
tact.  Waveney  Girvan,  who  had  published  the 
British  edition  of  Adamski  and  Desmond 
Leslie’s  book,  wrote,  “If  Allingham  is  telling 
the  truth,  his  account  following  so  soon  upon 
Adamski’s  amounts  to  final  proof  of  the  exis¬ 
tence  of  flying  saucers”  (Girvan,  1956). 

Allingham  proved  strangely  elusive,  how¬ 
ever,  making  only  one  public  appearance.  He 
showed  up  in  the  company  of  a  virulently  anti- 
UFO  science  writer  and  media  personality 
Patrick  Moore.  That,  plus  the  failure  of  inquir¬ 
ers  to  find  the  alleged  witness  to  Allingham’s 
contact,  should  have  warned  British  saucerians 
that  all  was  not  well  with  the  story  told  by  their 
native  Adamski.  In  1956  Allingham’s  pub¬ 
lisher — also  the  publisher  of  Moore  s  books — 
released  a  statement  asserting  that  the  contactee 
had  died  of  tuberculosis  in  a  Swiss  sanitarium. 

In  a  book  on  British  UFOs  published  thir¬ 
teen  years  later,  journalist  Robert  Chapman 
reported  that  he  had  found  no  evidence  that  a 
Cedric  Allingham  had  ever  existed.  In  his 


judgment,  Flying  Saucer  from  Mars  amounted 
to  “probably  the  biggest  UFO  leg-pull  ever 
perpetrated  in  Britain”  (Chapman,  1969).  It 
was  an  open  secret  among  Moore’s  friends 
that  he  and  a  friend,  Peter  Davies  (the  “Mart¬ 
ian”  in  the  photograph),  had  written  the  book 
as  a  spoof  on  those  gullible  enough  to  believe 
Adamski’s  contact  tales.  Moore,  well  known  as 
a  practical  joker,  once  had  regaled  a  contactee 
magazine  with  letters,  written  under  an  as¬ 
sortment  of  absurd  pseudonyms  (including 
“L.  Puller”),  claiming  scientific  confirmation 
of  the  contactee  cosmos. 

Eventually  word  of  Moore  and  Davies’s  in¬ 
volvement  trickled  down  to  British  ufologists. 
Two  of  them,  Christopher  Allan  and  Steuart 
Campbell,  interviewed  Davies  who  admitted 
the  hoax  and  added  that  he  had  rewritten  the 
original  manuscript  to  disguise  Moore’s  dis¬ 
tinctive  literary  style.  After  the  hoax  was  ex¬ 
posed  for  the  first  time  in  print  in  the  London 
ufology  journal  Magonia,  Moore  professed  to 
be  outraged,  threatened  legal  retaliation,  and 
then  retreated  into  telling  silence. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Brown’s  Martians;  Den- 
tons’s  Martians  and  Venusians;  Hopkins’s  Mar¬ 
tians;  Khauga;  Martian  bees;  Mince-Pie  Mar¬ 
tians;  Monka;  Muller’s  Martians;  Orthon;  Shaw’s 
Martians;  Smead’s  Martians;  Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Allan,  Christopher,  and  Steuart  Campbell,  1986. 
“Flying  Saucer  from  Moore’s?”  Magonia  23 
(July):  15-18. 

Allingham,  Cedric  [pseud,  of  Patrick  Moore  and 
Peter  Davies],  1954.  London:  Frederick  Muller. 

Chapman,  Robert,  1969.  Unidentified  Flying  Objects. 
London:  Arthur  Barker. 

Girvan,  Waveney,  1956.  Flying  Saucers  and  Common 
Sense.  New  York:  Citadel  Press. 

Leslie,  Desmond,  and  George  Adamski,  1953.  Flying 
Saucers  Have  Landed.  New  York:  British  Book 
Centre. 

“News  Briefs,”  1956/1957.  Saucer  News  4,1  (De¬ 
cember/January):  12. 

Tory,  Peter,  1986.  “I  See  No  Hoax,  Says  Patrick.” 
The  [London]  Star  (July  28). 

Alpha  Zoo  Loo 

Trucker  Harry  Joe  Turner  allegedly  met  an 
alien  named  Alpha  Zoo  Loo  during  a  fright- 


20  Alyn 

ening  encounter  on  a  Virginia  highway.  The 
first  incident  reportedly  took  place  on  the 
night  of  August  28,  1979,  when  a  UFO  hov¬ 
ered  over  his  truck.  Even  though  the  truck 
was  moving  at  seventy  miles  per  hour,  an  alien 
figure  opened  the  door,  and  a  terrified  Turner 
fired  several  pistol  shots  at  it,  without  appar¬ 
ent  effect.  Turner  blacked  out,  returning  to 
consciousness  in  the  Fredericksburg  ware¬ 
house  that  had  been  his  destination. 

Turner  noted  other  anomalies.  His  odome¬ 
ter  indicated  that  he  had  traveled  seventeen 
miles  though  he  knew  that  Winchester,  his 
starting  point,  and  Fredericksburg  were 
eighty  miles  apart.  An  odd,  filmy  substance 
covered  the  truck,  and  parts  of  his  CB  and 
AM/FM  antennae  were  missing,  as  if  they 
had  been  melted  or  cut  off.  He  also  com¬ 
plained  of  a  burning  sensation  in  his  eyes. 
While  trying  to  enter  his  truck  to  resume  his 
journey,  Turner  passed  out  and  was  taken  to  a 
hospital.  After  a  short  stay  he  was  released 
and,  on  returning  home,  suddenly  “remem¬ 
bered”  that  the  UFO  had  lifted  both  him  and 
the  truck  inside  it. 

Turner  also  recalled  that  the  craft  carried  a 
crew  of  white-clad,  humanlike  beings  who 
wore  caps.  When  they  took  the  caps  off, 
Turner  could  see  a  series  of  numbers  stamped, 
or  otherwise  impressed,  on  their  heads.  They 
spoke  in  a  squeaky,  high-pitched  tone.  Only 
when  one  of  them,  Alpha  Zoo  Loo,  slowed  his 
speech  could  Turner  understand  it. 

As  they  traveled  through  space,  Alpha  Zoo 
Loo  asked  Turner  questions  about  his  truck. 
Eventually  they  arrived  at  a  planet  two  and  a 
half  light  years  beyond  Alpha  Centauri,  where 
dome-covered  cities  dotted  an  otherwise  dev¬ 
astated  landscape.  Turner  had  the  impression 
that  the  civilization  had  experienced  a  nuclear 
war  in  its  not-distant  past. 

Back  on  Earth,  Turner  later  claimed  other 
contacts  with  Alpha  Zoo  Loo  and  assorted 
aliens.  His  erratic  behavior,  however,  undercut 
his  credibility,  leading  friends,  family  mem¬ 
bers,  and  onlookers  to  wonder  about  his  psy¬ 
chological  stability.  Investigators  also  learned 
of  Turner’s  reputation  for  yarn-spinning. 


Further  Reading 

Hendry,  Allan,  1980.  “Abducted!  Four  Startling  Sto¬ 
ries  of  1979.”  Frontiers  of  Science  2,  4  (July/Au¬ 
gust):  25-31,  36. 

Whiting,  Fred,  1980.  “The  Abduction  of  Harry  Joe 
Turner.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal  145  (March): 
3-7. 


Alyn 

“Alyn”  is  the  name  Constance  Weber,  who 
wrote  under  the  name  Marla  Baxter,  gives 
Howard  Menger  in  her  book  My  Saturnian 
Lover  (1958).  Weber/Baxter  relates  that  after 
being  widowed,  she  devoted  herself  to  an  in¬ 
terest  in  flying  saucers.  In  the  summer  of 
1956,  she  joined  a  group  headed  by  Alyn  R., 
who  “was  said  to  have  had  contacts  with  peo¬ 
ple  from  other  worlds.”  Alyn  eventually  re¬ 
veals  his  secret  to  her:  “I  am  not  of  this  world! 
I  am  a  volunteer  to  Earth  from  the  planet  Sat¬ 
urn.”  On  Saturn,  he  tells  her,  he  was  the  spiri¬ 
tual  teacher  Sol  da  Naro.  In  the  meantime,  on 
Earth,  the  two  become  lovers.  She  writes,  “My 


Howard  and  Connie  Menger  (August  C.  Roberts/ Fortean 
Picutre  Library) 


Andra-o-leeka  and  Mondra-o-leeka  21 


Saturnian  lover  did  wonderful  things  for 
me.  .  .  .  My  body  seemed  to  grow  more  softly 
contoured  through  this  pygmalion  transfor¬ 
mation  as  the  Saturnian  sculptor,  by  his 
unique  artistry,  molded  me  by  his  every  elec¬ 
tric  touch  and  caress.”  At  the  end  of  the  book, 
she  learns  that  in  a  previous  incarnation  she 
had  been  Marla,  a  Venusian  beauty  in  love 
with  Sol  da  Naro. 

During  the  time  period  covered  by  the 
book,  Howard  Menger,  a  sort  of  East  Coast 
counterpart  to  California’s  George  Adamski, 
left  his  wife,  Rose,  for  Connie  Weber.  At 
one  point  during  their  affair,  but  before 
Menger  had  ended  his  marriage,  four  disil¬ 
lusioned  followers  accused  Weber  of  imper¬ 
sonating  a  spacewoman  who  was  supposed 
to  be  granting  them  an  audience  in  an  un¬ 
lighted  room.  The  couple  survived  the  scan¬ 
dal,  however,  and  were  married  in  due 
course.  Eventually,  they  moved  to  Florida, 
where  they  live  now. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George 

Further  Reading 

Baxter,  Marla  [pseud,  of  Constance  Weber  Menger] , 
1958.  My  Saturnian  Lover.  New  York:  Vantage 
Press. 

‘“Very  Sincere  Fellow’  Howard  Menger  Returns  to 
Long  John  Program,”  1957.  CSI  News  Letter  21 
(November  1):  14—16. 

Ameboids 

A  professional  woman  writing  under  the 
pseudonym  Lisa  Oakman  claims  that  from 
childhood  into  her  early  twenties  she  experi¬ 
enced  many  encounters  with  nonhuman  be¬ 
ings.  Most  were  generally  humanlike  in  ap¬ 
pearance,  but  the  most  exotic  she  calls 
“ameboids.” 

The  ameboids  were  “horrible”  and  “night¬ 
marish”  entities,  shaped  like  amoebas,  with 
the  colors  of  bruises.  They  attached  their  wet 
snouts  to  the  fleshy  areas  of  her  body,  sucked, 
and  left  round,  red  marks  in  their  wake.  Some 
seemed  to  be  taking  energy,  others  blood. 
They  would  come  into  her  bedroom  at  night, 
and  she  was  too  terrified  to  resist  them.  She 
lay  paralyzed  while  they  did  their  work,  and 


she  did  not  resume  activity — in  this  case, 
screaming — until  they  were  gone. 

Further  Reading 

Oakman,  Lisa  [pseud.],  1999.  “UFO  Beings,  Folk¬ 
lore,  and  Mythology:  Personal  Experiences.”  Ln  - 
ternational  UFO  Reporter  24,  4  (Winter):  7-12. 

Andolo 

Andolo  was  a  being  channeled  by  contactee 
Trevor  James  Constable.  Andolo,  a  member  of 
the  Council  of  Seven  Lights,  a  kind  of  cosmic 
governing  board  consisting  of  wise  space  peo¬ 
ple,  communicated  from  a  vast  extraterrestrial 
satellite,  Shan-Chea,  in  orbit  around  Earth. 

In  the  mid-1950s,  concerned  about  myste¬ 
rious  disappearances  of  airplanes  and  their 
crews,  Constable  asked  Andolo  if  he  and  his 
associates  ever  abducted  or  killed  human  be¬ 
ings  in  this  way.  Andolo  assured  him  that  the 
“Universal  plan”  kept  them  from  causing  “a 
physical  death  wittingly  under  any  circum¬ 
stance.”  He  warned,  however,  that  “dark  ones” 
did  not  recognize  these  laws.  They  would  steal 
earthly  aircraft  in  order  to  learn  about  earthly 
technology,  and  “they  may  desire  the  entities 
[persons]  in  the  airplane  for  purposes  of  their 
own,  regarding  which  I  shall  presently  tell  you 
nothing”  (James,  1958). 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

James,  Trevor  [pseud,  of  Trevor  James  Constable], 
1958.  They  Live  in  the  Sky  Los  Angeles:  New  Age 
Publishing  Company. 

Andra-o-leeka  and  Mondra-o-leeka 

Chief  Frank  Buck  Standing  Horse,  an  Ottawa 
Indian  from  Oklahoma,  met  Andra-o-leeka 
and  Mondra-o-leeka  onboard  a  spaceship  that 
took  him  to  several  planets  in  July  1959.  The 
ship,  called  Vea-o-mus,  landed  around  10  P.M. 
on  the  evening  of  the  twelfth.  Piloted  by 
Andra-o-leeka,  the  ship  took  off  again,  this 
time  going  to  Mars,  then  to  Venus.  After  a 
short  stay  there,  a  female  pilot,  Mondra-o- 
leeka,  a  Venusian,  relieved  Andra-o-leeka,  and 
the  ship  went  on  to  Clarion,  a  planet  hidden 
on  the  other  side  of  the  sun.  (Clarion  first  ap- 


22  Angel  of  the  Dark 


pears  in  contactee  stories  after  Truman  Bethu- 
rum  reported  meeting  a  “scow”  [a  small  space¬ 
craft]  and  its  pilot,  the  beautiful  Aura  Rhanes, 
who  hailed  from  that  planet.)  After  a  short 
stop  on  Clarion,  Vea-o-mus  took  a  two-hour 
journey  to  a  planet  called  Oreon  (as  opposed 
to  “Orion,”  a  constellation).  Standing  Horse 
stayed  there  for  two  days. 

Oreon,  he  reported,  was  a  beautiful  planet, 
so  lovely  that  as  a  man  of  the  gospel  he  won¬ 
dered  if  he  were  in  heaven.  “Heaven  is  a  long 
way  from  here,”  he  was  told  (Dean,  1964). 
While  there,  he  ate  well,  mostly  fish  as  well  as 
fresh  fruit  from  giant  plants. 

Several  years  later  on  December  22,  1962, 
Standing  Horse  entered  a  spacecraft  near  Bak¬ 
ersfield,  California,  and  was  taken  to  Jupiter 
where  he  saw  a  magnificent  building  made  of 
marble.  He  witnessed  the  dancing  of  “five 
tribes  of  Indians.”  In  a  Jupiter  city,  at  the 
Church  of  the  Open  Door,  he  heard  a  concert 
in  which  Handel’s  The  Messiah  was  sung.  At 
one  point  he  saw  a  screen  that  recorded  scenes 
from  Earth.  According  to  Standing  Horse,  the 
people  of  Jupiter  are  better-looking  versions 
of  earthlings,  with  the  races  living  together  in 
harmony. 

The  chief  was  returned  to  Earth  three  days 
later,  on  the  evening  of  Christmas  Day.  His 
hosts  drove  him  back  to  a  Hollywood  bus  sta¬ 
tion  in  a  car  without  wheels  and  powered  by 
electromagnetic  energy.  “Two  cops  were  ar¬ 
resting  two  men  on  the  corner,”  Standing 
Horse  wrote  to  John  W.  Dean,  “and  were  they 
dumbfounded  when  they  saw  the  car  come 
down  and  let  me  out!” 

Standing  Horse  claimed  to  have  met  Mon- 
dra-o-leeka  one  more  time  on  the  streets  of 
Cedko,  California,  on  October  11,  1962. 

See  Also:  Aura  Rhanes;  Bucky;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Dean,  John  W.,  1964.  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Scrip  - 
tures.  New  York:  Vantage  Press. 


Angel  of  the  Dark 

On  several  occasions,  New  Age  writer  Alice 
Bryant  has  encountered  the  Angel  of  the 


Dark,  who  sometimes  calls  herself  “an  Angel 
of  the  Divine  Plan.”  The  angel  stands  nearly 
three  stories  tall.  “Large,  matte-dark  feathers 
with  iridescent  tips”  cover  her.  She  wraps  her 
wings  around  herself  like  a  cloak  and  wears  a 
wooden  bird  mask  from  which  a  long,  sharp 
beak  extends. 

She  is  here  to  take  away  all  those  feelings 
and  fears  that  impede  spiritual  progress.  Her 
bird  mask  symbolizes  her  connection  with  the 
vulture,  which  removes  carrion,  and  the  eagle, 
which  soars  toward  the  light.  “I  cleanse  the 
shadow  side  into  perfection,”  she  says. 

Further  Reading 

Bryant,  Alice,  and  Linda  Seebach,  1997.  Opening  to 
the  Infinite:  Htiman  Multidimensional  Potential. 
Mill  Spring,  NC:  Wild  Flower  Press. 


Angelucci,  Orfeo  (1912-1993) 

Orfeo  Angelucci  was  among  the  most  inter¬ 
esting  of  the  early  contactees.  Unlike  many  of 
his  contemporaries,  he  was  generally  deemed 


UFO  contactee  Orfeo  Angelucci  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Anoah  23 


sincere,  even  by  skeptics  who  tended  to  see 
him  as  something  of  a  religious  visionary  in  a 
flying-saucer  context  rather  than  as  a  cynical 
exploiter  of  the  credulous.  Angelucci's  initial 
contact  allegedly  occurred  on  May  24,  1952, 
in  Burbank,  California.  Driving  home  from 
work  at  an  aircraft  factory,  he  saw  a  saucer, 
which  emitted  two  small  globes.  The  globes 
approached  him,  and  a  masculine  voice  as¬ 
sured  him  that  he  had  nothing  to  fear.  An- 
gelucci  saw  a  crystal  cup  materialize,  and  he 
drank  a  delicious,  healing  liquid  from  it.  A 
screen  appeared  before  him,  showing  a  strik¬ 
ing-looking  man  and  woman  who  seemed  to 
read  his  mind.  Another  visionary  experience, 
initiated  like  the  first  time  by  a  “dulling  of 
consciousness”  (Angelucci,  1955),  occurred 
two  months  later.  On  August  2,  he  had  a 
physical  encounter  with  space  people  for  the 
first  time. 

Angelucci  soon  went  public  with  his  expe¬ 
riences,  warning  that  a  world  war  was  immi¬ 
nent.  From  the  ruins  of  the  world,  a  “New 
Age  of  Earth”  would  arise.  He  also  related 
that  after  six  months  of  unusual  psychologi¬ 
cal  symptoms,  as  well  as  “vivid  dreams  of  a 
hauntingly  beautiful,  half-familiar  world,”  he 
was  transported  to  a  beautiful  otherworld. 
He  learned  that  he  had  lived  there  in  another 
life,  when  he  was  known  as  “Neptune.”  An¬ 
gelucci  wrote  two  books  on  his  experiences 
and  became  a  prominent  figure  on  the  con- 
tactee  circuit.  With  the  passing  of  the  initial 
wave  of  enthusiasm  about  contactees,  An¬ 
gelucci  became  little  more  than  a  distant 
memory  of  saucerdom’s  heady  early  days.  His 
death  in  Los  Angeles  on  July  24,  1993,  was 
little  noted. 

In  his  time,  however,  his  claims  attracted 
the  attention  of  the  celebrated  psychologist 
and  philosopher  C.  G.  Jung,  who  wrote  about 
them  in  one  of  his  last  books.  Jung  observed, 
“The  individuation  process,  the  central  prob¬ 
lem  of  modern  psychology,  is  plainly  depicted 
.  .  .  in  an  unconscious,  symbolic  form  ...  al¬ 
though  the  author  with  his  somewhat  primi¬ 
tive  mentality  has  taken  it  quite  literally  as  a 
concrete  happening”  (Jung,  1959). 


Thtt  SECRET 

of  ilio 

SAUCERS 


h 

GRflO 

ANGILUCC! 


ik  .4 1  -j (_-  . : 1 1 1 r.4  .>r-J  in- 
iuu  —  ih-  icu  jc- 
wjm  fl  *  p«|«i 

sncc  yrJl  Etc  muilci  Lawn 
fiiii*r  ijoii’  mtiB-  ji'i  il  our 
burden  p**  «  ■■ 
iifr  c4  h ; f-r. 


The  cover  of  The  Secret  of  the  Saucers  by  Orfeo 
Angelucci  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


See  Also:  Contactees 
Further  Reading 

Angelucci,  Orfeo,  1955.  The  Secret  of  the  Saucers. 
Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

- ,  1959.  Son  of  the  Sun.  Los  Angeles:  DeVorss 

and  Company. 

Jung,  C.  G.,  1959.  Flying  Saucers:  A  Modern  Myth  of 
Things  Seen  in  the  Skies.  New  York:  Harcourt, 
Brace  and  Company. 


Anoah 

Anoah,  associated  with  the  Melchizedek 
Order  of  the  White  Brotherhood,  consisting 
of  wise  extraterrestrial  and  spiritual  entities, 
channeled  through  Austin,  Texas,  psychic 
medium  Jann  Weiss  in  the  1980s.  The  Plane¬ 
tary  Light  Association,  which  at  its  peak  had 
some  3,200  members  around  the  world,  dis¬ 
tributed  books  and  tapes  of  these  channeling 
sessions.  It  also  held  workshops  at  which  en¬ 
thusiasts  listened  to  Anoah  discuss  the  transi- 


24  Anthon 


tion  from  an  old  age  to  a  new  age  of  expanded 
consciousness  and  cosmic  awareness. 

See  Also:  Channeling 
Further  Reading 

Ached,  Fretter,  1963.  Melchizedek:  Truth  Principles. 

Phoenix,  AZ:  Lockhart  Research  Foundation. 
Weiss,  Jann,  1986.  Reflections  by  Anoah.  Austin,  TX: 
Planetary  Light  Association. 


Anthon 

At  the  contactee-oriented  Rocky  Mountain 
Conference  on  UFO  Investigation  held  in 
Laramie,  Wyoming,  in  May  1982,  Ken 
McLean  read  a  statement  from  “a  Mr.  Watan- 
abe,”  who  claimed  to  be  an  extraterrestrial  liv¬ 
ing  in  a  human  body.  His  true  name  was  An¬ 
thon,  and  he  was  in  his  third  earthly 
incarnation.  The  first  was  during  the  Revolu¬ 
tionary  War,  he  said.  He  was  one  of  150,000 
“incarnate  beings”  living  on  our  planet  and 
observing  our  activities.  These  beings  tele- 
pathically  communicated  their  findings  to 
space  people  both  on  the  surface  of  our  planet 
and  in  our  upper  atmosphere. 

According  to  Anthon,  we  are  now  entering 
the  end  of  an  age  that  began  with  Jesus’  ap¬ 
pearance,  though  Anthon  believes  Jesus  was 
not  the  Son  of  God  but  “the  only  human 
being  to  have  incarnated  through  enough  life¬ 
times  and  enough  karmic  experiences  to  tran¬ 
scend  death.  .  .  .  He  is  in  charge  of  the  transi¬ 
tion  into  a  ‘New  Age’  which  will  occur 
sometime  in  the  near  future.” 

Anthon  claimed  that  many  incarnate  be¬ 
ings  do  not  know  their  true  identity;  thus  they 
have  to  be  awakened  to  it. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  ed.,  1982.  Proceedings:  Rocky 
Mountain  Conference  on  UFO  Investigation. 
Laramie:  School  of  Extended  Studies,  University 
of  Wyoming. 

Antron 

Driving  along  a  section  of  highway  between 
Jacksonville  and  Callahan,  Florida,  one  Au¬ 
gust  night  in  1974,  businesswoman  Lydia 


Stalnaker  saw  a  bright,  flashing  light  just 
above  some  nearby  treetops.  A  suffocating 
sensation  enfolded  her,  and  she  lost  con¬ 
sciousness.  When  she  awoke,  she  was  still  be¬ 
hind  the  wheel,  but  on  a  different  road.  Soon 
she  learned  that  three  hours,  for  which  she 
could  not  account,  had  passed.  Under  hypno¬ 
sis  in  May  1975,  she  “recalled”  being  taken 
into  a  spacecraft,  where  aliens  told  her  that 
another  woman  would  be  placed  inside  her 
body.  She  saw  the  woman  sitting  on  the  other 
side  of  a  table  from  her.  Stalnaker’s  head  was 
placed  inside  some  kind  of  mechanical  device, 
and  she  passed  out.  When  she  revived,  a 
spaceman  told  her  she  was  now  one  of  them. 
He  escorted  her  out  of  the  ship,  and  she  re¬ 
turned  to  her  car. 

Subsequently,  Stalnaker  claimed,  she  found 
that  she  had  extraordinary  psychic  gifts  that 
allowed  her  to  read  other  people’s  minds  and 
to  practice  paranormal  healing.  Before  long 
Stalnaker  was  channeling  the  alien  woman, 
who  called  herself  Antron.  Antron  reported 
that  she  was  from  a  “star  galaxy.”  She  had 
come  to  prepare  earthlings  for  a  great  cata¬ 
clysm.  “We  want  to  take  the  good  people  with 
us  to  recolonize  elsewhere,”  she  said  (Beckley, 
1989). 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  1989.  Psychic  and  UFO 
Revelations  in  the  Last  Days.  New  Brunswick,  NJ : 
Inner  Light  Publications. 

Gansberg,  Judith  M.,  and  Alan  L.  Gansberg,  1980. 
Direct  Encounters:  The  Personal  Histories  of  UFO 
Abductees.  New  York:  Walker  and  Company. 

Anunnaki 

Ancient-astronaut  theorist  Zecharia  Sitchin, 
author  of  a  series  of  books  under  the  rubric 
The  Earth  Chronicles,  argues  that  a  race  of  hu¬ 
manlike  beings,  the  Anunnaki,  live  on  the 
planet  Nibiru  (also  known  as  Maldek),  the  al¬ 
leged  twelfth  planet  of  our  solar  system. 
Though  unknown  to  astronomers,  Nibiru,  on 
an  elliptical  orbit,  circles  our  sun  every  3,600 
years.  According  to  Sitchin,  Nibiru  will  be  in 
our  immediate  planetary  space  in  the  near  fu- 


Apol,  Mr.  25 


ture  and  will  be  detected  between  Mars  and 
Jupiter.  When  that  happens,  the  Anunnaki 
will  make  their  presence  known  by  appearing 
on  Earth. 

Sitchin’s  ideas  are  based  on  his  reading  of 
ancient  Sumerian  documents.  In  his  view 
they  confirm  that  the  Anunnaki — a  Sumer¬ 
ian  term — created  humans  in  their  image, 
via  genetic  engineering  with  the  DNA  of  na¬ 
tive  anthropoids,  after  their  arrival  some 
four-hundred  thousand  five-hundred  years 
ago.  These  original  earthlings  were  created  so 
that  they  could  work  as  slaves  in  the  Anun- 
naki’s  terrestrial  gold  mines;  the  extraterres¬ 
trials  needed  the  gold  to  preserve  the  atmos¬ 
phere  of  their  home  world.  Many  thousands 
of  years  later,  they  returned  to  give  the 
Sumerians  and  Egyptians  their  respective 
civilizations  and  actually  lived  among  these 
people  for  a  thousand  years.  One  visitor 
from  Nibiru,  Enki,  reportedly  saved  the 
human  race.  When  a  hostile  alien,  Enlil, 
tried  to  keep  the  Anunnaki  from  warning 
humans  that  the  passing  near  Earth  of 
Nibiru  would  cause  an  immense  tidal  wave, 
which  would  sweep  over  Earth  and  destroy 
its  inhabitants,  Enki  resisted.  He  told  Noah, 
of  biblical  fame,  about  the  coming  deluge, 
and  Noah  set  to  work  on  his  ark,  thus  ensur¬ 
ing  the  survival  of  earthly  life. 

The  Anunnaki  supposedly  live  a  very  long 
time  because  one  year  to  them  is  the  number 
of  earthly  years  it  takes  their  planet  to  go 
around  the  sun.  Their  technology  is  so  ad¬ 
vanced  that  they  developed  space  flight  half  a 
million  years  ago.  They  are  also  able  to  revive 
the  dead. 

One  critic  has  written,  “Clearly,  Sitchin  is  a 
smart  man.  He  weaves  a  complicated  tale 
from  the  bits  and  pieces  of  evidence  that  sur¬ 
vive  from  ancient  Sumeria  to  the  present  day. 
Just  as  clearly,  Sitchin  is  capable  of  academic 
transgressions  (fracturing  quotes,  ignoring 
dissenting  facts)  .  .  .  and  flights  of  intellectual 
fancy.  .  .  .  Worst  of  all,  he  is  almost  utterly  in¬ 
nocent  of  astronomy  and  other  assorted  fields 
of  modern  science”  (Hafernik,  1996). 

See  Also:  Greater  Nibiruan  Council 


Further  Reading 

Hafernik,  Rob,  1996.  “Sitchin’s  Twelfth  Planet.” 
http://www.geocities.com/Area5 1 /Corridor/ 
8 1 48/hafernik.html 

Schultz,  Dave.  “The  Earth  Chronicles:  Time  Chart.” 
http://www.geocities.com/Area5  1  /  Corri¬ 
dor/  8 1 48/zchron.html 

Sitchin,  Zecharia,  1976.  The  Twelfth  Planet.  New 
York:  Stein  and  Day. 

- ,  1980.  The  Stairtmy  to  Heaven.  New  York: 

St.  Martins  Press. 

- ,  1985.  The  Wars  of  Gods  and  Men.  New 

York:  Avon  Books. 


Apol,  Mr. 

In  the  mid  to  late  1960s,  while  researching 
material  for  a  series  of  books,  occult  jour¬ 
nalist  John  A.  Keel  allegedly  received  a  se¬ 
ries  of  phone  calls  from  “Mr.  Apol,”  a  badly 
confused,  interdimensional  entity.  Apol  did 
not  know  where  he  was  in  time,  often  con¬ 
fusing  past  and  future,  and  traveling 
through  both  involuntarily.  According  to 
Keel,  “he  and  all  his  fellow  entities  .  .  . 
[played]  out  their  little  games  because  they 
were  programmed  to  do  so”  (Keel,  1975). 
In  the  fashion  of  psychic  vampires,  they 
lived  off  the  energies  of  contactees  and 
other  experients  of  the  paranormal.  Keel  be¬ 
lieved  Apol  to  be  an  ultraterrestrial  as  op¬ 
posed  to  an  extraterrestrial,  because  in 
Keel’s  view  such  entities  come  from  other 
realities  rather  than  other  planets. 

Though  Keel  did  not  meet  Apol  himself,  a 
Long  Island  woman  saw  him  pull  up  to  her 
house  in  a  black  Cadillac,  a  vehicle  favored  by 
the  enigmatic  men  in  black,  earthly  agents  for 
unearthly  intelligences.  Keel  reported  that  the 
woman  thought  Apol  looked  “Hawaiian.” 
When  he  introduced  himself,  he  shook  her 
hand.  His  own  hand  was  “as  cold  as  ice.” 

Keel  dedicated  his  book  Our  Haunted  Planet 
(1971)  to  “Mr.  Apol,  wherever  you  are.” 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Keel,  John  Alva;  Time  travel¬ 
ers;  Ultraterrestrials 

Further  Reading 

Keel,  John  A.,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New 
York:  Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and 
Company. 


26  Arna  and  Parz 


Arna  and  Parz 

Between  1976  and  1980  a  family  at  Oaken- 
holt  in  northern  Wales  underwent  a  complex 
series  of  extraordinary  experiences.  Perhaps 
the  first  event  involved  six-year-old  Gaynor 
Sunderland,  who,  while  playing  in  a  field  one 
summer  afternoon,  spotted  a  cigar-shaped 
craft  resting  on  the  ground.  She  saw  a  man  in 
a  spacesuit  walking  in  front  of  the  object, 
using  a  gunlike  device  to  burn  holes  into  the 
ground.  Apparently  caught  by  surprise,  the 
being  stared  at  her,  and  Gaynor  had  the  im¬ 
pression  that  he  was  probing  her  mind.  An 
angry-looking  woman  appeared  alongside 
him,  and  Gaynor  felt  the  same  sensation  of 
mind-intrusion.  Hearing  noises  from  within 
the  craft,  the  woman  returned  to  the  space¬ 
craft,  and  the  young  girl  took  the  opportunity 
to  flee.  Many  other  bizarre  UFO  incidents  in¬ 
volving  all  five  Sunderland  children  as  well  as 
their  parents  took  place  subsequently. 

In  February  1979  Gaynor  glimpsed  two 
smiling  beings  who  had  appeared  in  some 
nearby  bushes  and  then  vanished  when  she 
turned  away.  On  June  24  she  encountered  the 
same  alien  couple  in  a  sort  of  out-of-body  ex¬ 
perience.  Lying  in  bed  at  1 1  P.M.,  she  saw  the 
ceiling  open  into  a  tunnel,  sucking  her  in  to¬ 
ward  a  distant  light.  Once  she  reached  the  end 
of  the  journey,  the  couple — now  accompanied 
by  a  small  boy — greeted  her.  The  woman  was 
named  Arna,  the  man  Parz.  They  gave  her  a 
tour  of  their  world,  showing  her  a  stream  as 
well  as  some  vegetation  unlike  anything  on 
Earth.  Their  manner  was  courteous  but  not 
particularly  warm.  When  Arna  touched 
Gaynor’s  hand,  the  visitor  witnessed  a  great 
city  under  a  red  sun  and  unclouded  blue  sky. 
All  of  the  people  in  the  city  looked  young. 
After  the  vision  faded,  Arna  said  good-bye  via 
telepathy  and  promised  another  meeting. 
Gaynor  returned  to  the  tunnel  and  ended  up 
in  her  bed. 

A  few  weeks  later,  in  August,  Arna  reap¬ 
peared  to  display  images  of  a  destroyed  Earth. 
She  asked  Gaynor  for  her  assistance  in  direct¬ 
ing  an  energy  being  back  to  its  proper  resi¬ 
dence.  Gaynor,  her  brother  Darren,  and  her 


parents  walked  to  a  field  and  meditated  until 
they  sensed  that  the  intruder  was  gone. 

On  the  night  of  September  14,  Arna  and 
Parz  appeared  and  took  Gaynor  into  their 
spacecraft.  Besides  the  couple  she  knew,  there 
were  three  others.  One  looked  so  close  to 
being  purely  human  that  Gaynor  wondered  if 
the  young  woman,  who  looked  to  be  about 
nineteen  years  of  age,  was  some  kind  of  hy¬ 
brid.  Gaynor  noticed  a  picture  on  the  wall  of 
a  male  being  like  Parz,  only  older.  He  was 
standing  by  a  globe  of  a  planet  that  clearly  was 
not  Earth.  The  ship  flew  into  space.  Half  an 
hour  later  Arna  and  Parz  told  her  that  it  had 
reached  its  destination,  which  turned  out  to 
be  a  kind  of  zoo  full  of  bizarre  creatures,  all  of 
them  in  twos.  The  animals  were  not  in  cages 
and  had  a  great  deal  of  space  in  which  to  wan¬ 
der.  Finally,  the  sights  were  too  unsettling  for 
Gaynor,  and  her  hosts  permitted  her  to  return 
to  the  ship.  Before  they  parted,  however, 
Gaynor  learned  that  Arna  and  Parz  were 
“about  3500  of  your  years  old”  (Randles  and 
Whetnall,  1981). 

Gaynor  sensed  somehow  that  she  had  not 
really  been  in  space.  What  she  had  experi¬ 
enced  were  vivid  mental  images  that  the  aliens 
had  beamed  into  her  brain.  At  the  same  time, 
she  was  certain  that  she  had  not  dreamed  any 
of  this;  it  was  much  too  real  and  had  none  of 
the  distinguishing  characteristics  of  dreams. 

See  Also:  Hybrid  beings 

Further  Reading 

Randles,  Jenny,  and  Paul  Whetnall,  1981.  Alien  Con  - 
tact:  Window  on  Another  World.  London:  Neville 
Spearman. 


Artemis 

Artemis  hails  from  the  planet  Miranda,  lo¬ 
cated  in  an  uncharted  region  of  the  Milky 
Way  galaxy.  He  and  the  thirteen  thousand  be¬ 
ings  on  his  team  orbit  Earth  in  a  giant  space 
platform,  focusing  their  attention  on  most  of 
the  North  American  continent.  Other  space¬ 
ships  from  other  places  attend  to  the  rest  of 
Earth.  Artemis,  who  channeled  through  An¬ 
thony  and  Lynn  Volpe  in  1981,  said  that  he 


Ashtar  27 


seeks  to  raise  humanity’s  collective  vibration. 
Coming  cataclysms  will  radically  alter  the 
population  and  surface  of  the  planet.  Certain 
chosen  earthlings  who  are  advanced  spiritually 
will  be  taken  up  just  before  the  disasters.  Oth¬ 
ers  will  be  left  on  the  surface  for  a  time  as  they 
help  suffering  Earth  people.  Eventually,  spiri¬ 
tually  unenlightened  but  otherwise  harmless 
persons  will  be  taken  up  and  resettled  on  un¬ 
inhabited  planets,  while  the  truly  evil  will  be 
left  on  Earth.  Most,  though  not  all,  will  per¬ 
ish.  All  of  this,  Artemis  said  in  1981,  will  hap¬ 
pen  “sooner  than  most  people  think”  (Beck- 
ley,  1989). 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  1989.  Psychic  and  UFO 
Revelations  in  the  Last  Days.  New  Brunswick,  NJ: 
Inner  Light  Publications. 

Ascended  Masters 

Ascended  Masters  are  human  beings  who 
achieved  pure  spiritual  enlightenment  before 
their  deaths.  Along  with  that  enlightenment, 
they  attained  mystical  powers  that  set  them 
apart  from  their  fellows.  When  their  physical 
bodies  died  (“ascended”),  they  continued  to 
oversee  the  affairs  of  humanity.  They  channel 
wisdom  to  those  who  will  listen  to  them. 

One  source  observes,  “It  is  important  for 
students  and  people  to  come  to  realize  that  all 
Ascended  Beings  are  Real,  Tangible  Beings. 
Their  Bodies  are  not  physical  but  They  can 
make  them  as  tangible  as  our  physical  bodies 
are”  (“Ascended  Masters”).  The  Great  White 
Brotherhood,  a  spiritual  council  that  exists  in 
the  supernatural  realm,  consists  of  Ascended 
Masters. 

Further  Reading 

“Ascended  Masters.”  http://www.ascension-research. 
org/masters.html. 

Ashtar 

Ashtar  is  among  the  most  popular  and  most 
powerfully  positioned  of  all  channeling  enti¬ 
ties.  As  (according  to  most  contactees  who 
have  dealings  with  him)  head  of  the  Ashtar 
Command  he  is,  in  the  words  of  his  sponsor 


Lord  Michael,  “Supreme  Director  in  charge  of 
all  of  the  Spiritual  program”  for  Earth.  From 
his  giant  starship  in  Earth’s  general  vicinity  he 
gives  orders  to  millions  of  extraterrestrial  and 
inter-dimensional  beings  who  are  trying  to  re¬ 
form  and  enlighten  earthlings.  His  home  is  in 
the  etheric  realm,  which  means  that  to  visit 
our  physical  universe  he  must  descend  the  vi¬ 
bratory  scale,  or  we  would  not  be  able  to  hear 
or  perceive  him  at  all.  He  explains  his  mission 
thus: 

“  We  have  come  to  fulfill  the  destiny  of  this 
planet,  which  is  to  experience  a  short  period  of 
‘cleansing’  and  then  to  usher  in  a  NEW 
GOLDEN  AGE  OF  LIGHT.  We  are  here  to  lift 
off  the  surface,  . .  .  during  this  period  of  cleans¬ 
ing,  those  souls  who  are  walking  in  the  Light  on 
the  Earth.  .  .  .  The  souls  of  Light  are  you  people 
of  Earth  who  have  lived  according  to  universal 
truths  and  have  put  the  concerns  of  others  be¬ 
fore  your  own.  .  .  .  The  short  period  of  cleans¬ 
ing  the  planet  is  LMMINENT—EVEN  THE 
MIDNIGHT  HOUR!"  (Tuella,  1989). 

Officially,  Ashtar  came  into  the  world  on 
July  18,  1952,  when  George  W.  Van  Tassel,  an 
early  and  influential  contactee  from  southern 
California,  took  a  telepathic  message  from 
“Portia,  712th  projection,  16th  wave,  realms 
of  Schare”  (pronounced  Share-ee).  Portia  pro¬ 
nounced,  “Approaching  your  solar  system  is  a 
ventla  [spaceship]  with  our  chief  aboard,  com¬ 
mander  of  the  station  Schare  in  charge  of  the 
first  four  sectors.  .  .  .  We  are  waiting  here  at 
72,000  miles  above  you  to  welcome  our  chief, 
who  will  be  entering  this  solar  system  for  the 
first  time.”  Soon  the  chief  spoke,  introducing 
himself  with — “Ashtar,  commandant  quadra 
sector,  patrol  section  Schare,  all  projections, 
all  waves.”  He  addressed  an  emerging  concern 
among  occultists  of  the  period:  that  the  hy¬ 
drogen  bomb,  then  in  development,  would 
set  off  a  chain  reaction  that  would  destroy  the 
planet.  Ashtar  warned  that  if  scientists  did  not 
stop  their  work  on  the  device  immediately, 
“we  shall  eliminate  all  projects  connected  with 
such”  (Van  Tassel,  1952). 

Though  Van  Tassel  would  claim  contacts 
with  many  other  curiously  named  other- 


28  Ashtar 


worldly  entities,  only  Ashtar  would  make  a 
wider  mark  in  the  contactee  subculture.  Before 
long  other  channelers  were  receiving  material 
from  Ashtar  as  well  as  his  associates,  such  as 
Sananda  (Jesus),  Korton,  Soltec,  Athena, 
Monka,  and  others.  So  many  Ashtar  channel¬ 
ings  occurred  that  soon  Ashtar  was  warning 
some  communicants  that  evil  astral  entities 
were  impersonating  him.  He  was  also  forced  to 
deny  allegations  that  he  was  “some  form  of 
giant  mechanical  brain”  (Constable,  1958).  In 
the  1970s  and  beyond,  as  fundamental  Chris¬ 
tians  began  writing  books  on  UFOs,  Ashtar 
was  represented  as  a  servant  of  Satan. 

Though  to  nearly  all  who  experienced  him, 
Ashtar  existed  only  as  a  disembodied  voice,  a 
very  few  claimed  to  have  seen  him.  One 
woman,  Adele  Darrah,  even  alleged  that  she 
saw  him  before  she  had  ever  heard  of  an 
Ashtar.  One  night  in  the  early  1960s,  after  she 
had  gone  to  bed,  Darrah  found  herself  sud¬ 
denly  awake  and  in  her  downstairs  living 
room,  where  a  striking-looking  stranger  stood 
in  front  of  the  fireplace.  He  was  tall,  slim,  and 
erect  and  was  wearing  a  uniform  with  a  high 
collar.  “His  eyebrows  were  slim  and  delicate, 
the  nose  was  thin,  the  mouth  was  rather 
straight,  the  lips  thin,”  she  reported.  “His  eyes 
were  brilliant  and  penetrating,  almond- 
shaped  with  a  slight  oriental  appearance.” 
When  she  introduced  herself,  he  smiled  and 
indicated  that  he  already  knew  her  name. 
Then  he  squared  his  shoulders  and  an¬ 
nounced,  “I  am  Ashtar.”  Everything  that  fol¬ 
lowed  faded  from  her  memory,  and  only  a  few 
years  later,  Darrah  claimed,  would  she  learn 
that  others  knew  such  an  entity. 

Typically,  however,  contactees  and  chan¬ 
nelers  report  seeing  Ashtar  in  psychic  percep¬ 
tion  or  in  out-of-body  journeys  to  his  star- 
ship.  Perhaps  not  surprisingly,  descriptions 
vary,  some  calling  him  dark,  others  fair,  some 
estimating  his  height  at  less  than  six  feet,  oth¬ 
ers  at  more  than  seven. 

In  the  1980s  and  1990s,  more  and  more  of 
the  messages  from  Ashtar  and  his  associates 
focused  on  the  “Ascension,”  the  removal  of 
“Lightworkers” — those  doing  the  Command’s 


work  on  Earth,  many  if  not  all  of  them  extra¬ 
terrestrials  in  earlier  incarnations — from 
Earth  just  prior  to  the  Cleansing  (the  natural 
and  other  catastrophes  that  will  afflict  Earth, 
killing  millions,  before  the  space  people  land). 
The  failure  of  either  the  Ascension  or  the 
Cleansing  to  take  place  discouraged  many  fol¬ 
lowers.  In  a  channeling  in  the  1990s,  Ashtar 
explained  that,  in  fact,  the  Lightworkers  had 
effected  huge  changes,  which,  though  now  in¬ 
visible,  will  become  apparent  in  due  course. 
In  the  meantime,  according  to  Ashtar  associ¬ 
ate  Soltec,  the  human  race  will  continue  to  be 
educated  subtly  through  dreams,  popular  cul¬ 
ture,  and  growing  numbers  of  spacecraft 
sightings.  Unfortunately,  “there  will  be  many 
ones  who  will  confuse  us  with  negative  ET 
encounters.  Indeed,  the  greys  will  take  advan¬ 
tage  of  the  opportunity  to  confuse  the  popu¬ 
lace  and  attempt  to  tarnish  our  image.  Ones 
must  be  made  aware  of  the  distinction  be¬ 
tween  the  ships  of  Light  and  the  ships  of  ab¬ 
duction”  (Soltec,  n.d.). 

In  2000,  Brianna  Wettlaufer  of  Van  Tassel’s 
organization,  the  Ministry  of  Universal  Wis¬ 
dom  (Van  Tassel  himself  died  in  1978),  put 
out  a  statement  that  sought  to  separate  Ashtar 
from  the  Ashtar  Command.  Van  Tassel,  it  was 
said,  communicated  only  with  Ashtar;  the 
Ashtar  Command,  on  the  other  hand,  was  a 
concept  promulgated  by  another  early  con¬ 
tactee,  Robert  Short.  He  and  Van  Tassel  had 
been  friends  but  parted  company  when  Short 
decided  to  make  Ashtar’s  communications 
“commercial  and  mainstream,  in  order  for 
personal  notoriety,  not  for  a  truth  to  the  pub  - 
lie.”  Wettlaufer  insisted  that  “Ashtar  is  not  a 
metaphysical  philosopher  or  rambler”  and 
moreover,  he  cannot  be  reached  via  channel¬ 
ing  (though  Van  Tassel’s  own  method  of  com¬ 
munication  seemed  indistinguishable  from 
channeling  to  most  observers).  The  statement 
goes  on,  “The  Ashtar  of  Ashtar  Command  is  a 
real  personality ...  a  clone  of  the  original 
Ashtar,  and  is  dangerous ...  a  disobedient 
angel”  (Wettlaufer,  2000). 

The  name  “Ashtar”  may  owe  its  inspiration 
to  a  nineteenth-century  work,  Oahspe,  the 


Asmitor  29 


product  of  alleged  angelic  dictation  to  New 
York  occultist  John  Ballou  Newbrough.  In 
this  complex  alternative  history  of  Earth  and 
the  universe,  “ashars”  are  guardian  angels  who 
sail  the  cosmos  in  etheric  ships.  Oahspe  had  a 
wide  readership  among  devotees  of  the  early 
contactee  movement. 

See  Also:  Athena;  Contactees;  Korton;  Monka; 
Portia;  Sananda;  Van  Tassel,  George  W. 

Further  Reading 

Alnor,  William  M.,  1992.  UFOs  in  the  New  Age:  Ex  - 
traterrestrial  Messages  and  the  Truth  of  Scripture. 
Grand  Rapids,  MI:  Baker  Book  House. 

James,  Trevor  [pseud,  of  Trevor  James  Constable], 
1958.  They  Live  in  the  Sky  Los  Angeles:  New  Age 
Publishing  Company. 

King,  Beti,  1976.  Diary  from  Outer  Space.  Mojave, 
CA:  self-published. 

- ,  1976.  A  Psychics  True  Story.  Mojave,  CA: 

self-published. 

Soltec,  n.d.  ‘Ashtar  Command  and  Popular  Culture.” 
http :  // www.eagleswings  .com/ au/soltec  1 .  html 

Tuella  [pseud,  of  Thelma  B.  Turrell],  ed.,  1989. 
Ashtar:  A  Tribute.  Third  edition.  Salt  Lake  City, 
UT:  Guardian  Action  Publications. 

Van  Tassel,  George  W.,  1952.  I  Rode  a  Flying  Saucer! 
The  Mystery  of  Flying  Saucers  Revealed.  Los  Ange¬ 
les:  New  Age  Publishing  Company. 

Wettlaufer,  Brianna,  2000.  “A  Brief  Background  be¬ 
tween  Ashtar  and  Ashtar  Command.”  http://www. 
georgevantassel.com/Pages/ 005.1  ashtar.html 


Asmitor 

In  Revelation:  The  Divine  Fire  (1973)  Brad 
Steiger  reports  a  story  related  to  him  by 
Robert  Shell  of  Roanoke,  Virginia,  concern¬ 
ing  a  malevolent  entity  that  attached  itself  to  a 
young  man  experimenting  with  psychedelic 
drugs.  The  being  called  itself  “Asmitor”  even 
as  it  explained  that  this  was  not  precisely  its 
name,  but  the  closest  approximation  that  the 
human  voice  could  manage  to  pronounce. 

Shell  said  that  he  met  Mark  while  both 
were  living  in  an  apartment  building  in  Rich¬ 
mond,  Virginia,  in  1969.  Shell  and  a  friend 
were  pursuing  an  interest  in  ritual  magic. 
Mark,  then  eighteen  years  old,  expressed  no 
interest  in  such  things;  his  interests  were  in 
electronics  and  occasional  use  of  hallucino¬ 
gens.  Thus,  Shell  was  surprised  and  skeptical 


when  Mark  began  speaking  of  contact  he  was 
beginning  to  experience  with  what  he  called 
an  “entity”  that  gave  him  certain  things  in  ex¬ 
change  for  periodic  occupation  of  his  physical 
body.  Around  this  time  Shell  and  his  wife  ob¬ 
served  poltergeistlike  manifestations  in  their 
apartment. 

These  experiences  led  Shell  to  be  more 
open-minded  about  Mark’s  claims.  Mark  con¬ 
fided  that  the  entity  was  a  multidimensional 
energy  being.  It  extended  across  the  entire 
universe,  though  by  force  of  will  it  could 
focus  on  a  particular  place  for  purposes  of 
communication.  It  never  explained  why  it 
sought  such  contacts,  but  Mark  came  to  sense 
that  it  had  a  deep  interest — again  for  reasons 
it  would  not  clearly  divulge — in  this  level  of 
reality.  As  time  went  by,  Mark  came  to  see  the 
entity,  now  calling  itself  Asmitor,  as  evil  and 
deceitful.  It  also  would  not  let  him  alone  and 
more  or  less  possessed  him. 

Before  that  happened,  however,  Shell  ac¬ 
cepted  Mark’s  endorsement  of  Asmitor’s  es¬ 
sentially  benign  intentions  and  asked  for  a 
personal  contact.  One  night  he  underwent  a 
frightening  experience  in  which  he  awoke 
with  a  crushing  sensation  on  his  chest,  which 
he  interpreted  as  a  visitation  from  Asmitor, 
though  the  sensations  he  describes  are  classic 
characteristics  of  sleep  paralysis.  The  next  day 
Mark,  passing  on  Asmitor’s  words,  told  Shell 
that  Asmitor  had  found  him — Shell — unfit 
for  contact. 

Asmitor  claimed  to  be  in  conflict  with  an¬ 
other  entity,  with  the  climactic  battle  immi¬ 
nent.  The  other  entity  was  just  as  malevolent 
as  Asmitor,  but  the  two  were  deadly  enemies, 
their  conflict  having  been  set  up,  for  in¬ 
scrutable  reasons,  by  a  “higher  ruling  force.” 
Mark  was  to  create  a  “landmark” — a  “specific, 
easily  accessible  point  for  it  to  hold  onto” — 
consisting  of  a  pentagram  with  symbols 
drawn  around  it. 

Though  Asmitor  had  promised  Mark  com¬ 
plete  physical  protection,  the  young  man 
learned  otherwise  when  he  was  arrested  for 
possession  of  LSD  and  marijuana  and  sen¬ 
tenced  to  jail.  After  serving  three  months,  he 


30  Athena 


was  released.  By  this  time  Shell  had  moved  to 
another  city  and  out  of  direct  contact  with 
Mark,  though  the  two  exchanged  some  letters 
and  talked  on  the  phone  on  occasion.  Mark 
expressed  growing  desperation  about  his 
plight.  He  was  certain  now  that  he  could  es¬ 
cape  Asmitor’s  grip  only  by  destroying  him¬ 
self.  Thus,  Shell  said,  “It  came  as  a  shock,  but 
not  really  a  surprise,  to  hear  from  a  mutual 
friend  .  .  .  that  on  April  1,  1970,  Mark  had 
committed  suicide.” 

Shell  noted  that  not  long  afterward,  while 
perusing  a  book  of  medieval  magic,  he  came 
upon  the  name  Asmitor,  though  he  could  not 
tell  Steiger  exactly  where.  “I  am  convinced 
that  Mark  had  never  read  this  book,”  he  re¬ 
marked,  “and  I  am  also  convinced  that  Mark 
did  not  simply  make  up  this  name.”  Steiger, 
on  the  other  hand,  suspected  that  the  tragic 
episode  came  out  of  “paranoid  schizophrenia, 
or  some  other  illness.” 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1973.  Revelation:  The  Divine  Fire.  En¬ 
glewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 


Athena 

In  Project  Alert,  a  self-published  monograph, 
an  Indiana  contactee  known  as  Tuieta  provides 
a  transcript  of  a  three-day  conference  held  at 
“the  Tectonic  base  that  is  on  planet  Earth.” 
The  gathering  brought  together  “specific  com¬ 
manders  .  .  .  under  the  immediate  supervision, 
guidance,  and  counsel  of  Commander  Ash- 
tar.”  Among  the  speakers,  who  included  such 
familiar  figures  in  the  Ashtar  Command  as 
Korton,  Monka,  and  Soltec,  was  the  hereto¬ 
fore  obscure  Commander  Athena.  Athena 
spoke  of  the  role  of  Earth  women  in  the  com¬ 
ing  “period  of  great  tribulation.”  During  this 
crisis  many  people  would  not  survive.  The 
woman  most  likely  to  get  through  the  cata¬ 
strophic  Earth  changes,  according  to  Athena, 
was  one  who  recognized  “the  importance  of 
providing  for  loved  ones  and  providing  for 
those  that  need  nurturing  and  counsel.” 

Athena  is  described  as  a  small,  reddish-gold¬ 
haired,  beautiful  woman  with  deep  blue  eyes. 


Maren  Jensen  as  space  commander  Athena  in  the  1978— 
1979 ABC  TV  series  Battlestar  Galactica  (Photofest) 

She  exudes  “great  love  and  great  compassion 
and  tremendous  strength.”  Her  name,  coinci¬ 
dentally  or  otherwise,  is  the  same  as  that  of  the 
Greek  goddess  of  wisdom,  the  arts,  and  war¬ 
fare.  Athena  was  also  the  name  of  a  space  com¬ 
mander  in  the  television  series  Battlestar  Galac  - 
tica,  which  aired  on  ABC  in  1978  and  1979. 

According  to  the  late  Thelma  B.  Turrell 
(who  was  also  known  as  Tuella,  a  name  given 
her  by  the  Ashtar  Command),  “Athena  is  the 
twin  flame  of  Ashtar.  He  has  said  to  me  that 
he  could  turn  over  the  whole  command  to  her 
and  no  one  would  even  miss  him”  (Beckley, 
1989). 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Contactees;  Korton;  Monka 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  1989.  Psychic  and  UFO 
Revelations  in  the  Last  Days.  New  Brunswick,  NJ: 
Inner  Light  Publications. 

Tuieta,  1986.  Project  Alert.  Fort  Wayne,  IN:  Portals 
of  Light. 


Atlantis  3 1 


Atlantis 

Atlantis,  the  fabled  lost  continent,  almost  cer¬ 
tainly  never  existed  in  the  real  world,  but  it  has 
long  captured  the  imaginations  of  human  be¬ 
ings.  A  vast  literature — scholars  estimate  con¬ 
servatively  that  more  than  two  thousand  books 
address  the  subject — has  tackled  Atlantis  from 
a  wide  range  of  perspectives.  Some  writers 
have  sought  to  establish,  with  what  most 
scholars  hold  to  be  inconclusive  results,  that 
the  legend  arose  from  the  mythologizing  of  a 
real  event,  though  almost  every  theorist  has 
proposed  a  different  one.  Most  writing,  how¬ 
ever,  has  taken  an  alternative-history  approach, 
paying  little  heed  to  mainstream  archaeology, 
history,  and  science,  while  taking  Atlantis  into 
the  realm  of  unfettered  speculation. 

The  legend  of  Atlantis  begins  in  two  works, 
Timaeus  and  Critias  (written  circa  355  B.C.), 
by  the  great  Greek  philosopher  Plato.  As  in 
his  earlier  work  The  Republic,  Plato  wrote 
these  works  as  dialogues  among  four  wise 
men,  including  Plato’s  teacher  Socrates.  In  the 
course  of  a  long  discourse  on  philosophical  is¬ 
sues  of  various  kinds,  Critias,  a  historian  and 


Plato’s  great-grandfather,  tells  of  a  story  that 
he  ascribes  to  his  grandfather,  who  heard  it 
from  his  father.  Around  600  B.C.,  while  trav¬ 
eling  in  Europe,  Solon  (a  historical  figure  re¬ 
membered  for  his  legal  and  poetic  genius) 
learned  of  a  great  civilization  that  existed  nine 
thousand  years  earlier.  It  was  located  in  the 
Atlantic  Ocean  beyond  the  Pillars  of  Hercules 
(the  present-day  Straits  of  Gibraltar)  on  an  is¬ 
land  larger  than  North  Africa  and  Asia  com¬ 
bined.  According  to  Solon’s  informant,  an 
Egyptian  priest,  Atlantis  had  grown  arrogant 
and  warlike.  It  ruled  many  other  islands  and 
parts  of  what  is  now  Europe.  But  when  it  at¬ 
tacked  Athens  and  other  Greek  city-states, 
those  communities  joined  forces  to  repel  the 
invaders  and  drive  them  back  to  Atlantis,  free¬ 
ing  other  islands  from  Atlantis’s  tyranny  in  the 
process.  But  when  the  battle  was  brought  to 
Atlantis’s  own  shores,  cataclysmic  earthquakes 
and  floods  destroyed  the  island  continent  over 
a  single  night  and  day.  The  Greek  soldiers 
died  along  with  the  Atlanteans,  and  Atlantis 
sank  to  the  bottom  of  the  ocean,  to  rise  no 
more. 


Illustration  of  the  location  of  the  empire  of  Atlantis  from  Atlantis:  The  Antediluvian  World  by  Ignatius  Donnelly,  1 882 
(Library  of  Congress) 


32  Atlantis 


That  is  not  all  the  dialogues  have  to  say, 
however.  Most  of  the  discussion,  much  of  it 
intricately  detailed,  describes  a  civilization 
that  was  nearly  perfect  before  pride  corrupted 
it.  Atlantis  is  supposed  to  be  the  place  of 
model  governance.  In  its  prime  it  operated  by 
the  principles  set  forth  in  The  Republic. 

No  other  ancient  document  contains  an  in¬ 
dependent  treatment  of  Atlantis.  All  refer¬ 
ences  to  the  lost  continent  cite  Plato  as  the 
source.  Some  accept  Plato’s  account  as  histori¬ 
cal,  while  others  see  it  as  an  allegory  never 
meant  to  be  taken  literally.  Plato’s  own  stu¬ 
dent  Aristotle  took  the  latter  view. 

During  the  sixteenth  and  seventeenth  cen¬ 
turies,  as  European  explorers  found  their  way 
to  the  Americas,  several  writers,  most  promi¬ 
nently  Sir  Francis  Bacon  (1551-1626),  re¬ 
vived  the  myth  of  Atlantis  and  theorized  that 
its  remains  could  be  found  in  the  New  World. 
That  would  be  only  the  beginning  of  a  new 
round  of  speculation.  “At  one  time  or  an¬ 
other,”  a  modern  chronicler  of  the  legend  ob¬ 
serves,  “Atlantis  has  been  located  in  the  Arctic, 
Nigeria,  the  Caucasus,  the  Crimea,  North 
Africa,  the  Sahara,  Malta,  Spain,  central 
France,  Belgium,  the  Netherlands,  the  North 
Sea,  the  Bahamas,  and  various  other  locations 
in  North  and  South  America”  (Ellis,  1998). 

Among  the  most  influential  books  ever 
written  on  the  subject,  Atlantis:  The  Antedilu  - 
vian  World  (1882)  was  the  creation  of  a  for¬ 
mer  Minnesota  congressman  named  Ignatius 
Donnelly  (1831-1901).  Donnelly  surveyed 
what  he  presented  as  evidence  from  such  dis¬ 
ciplines  as  archaeology,  geology,  biology,  lin¬ 
guistics,  history,  and  folklore  to  argue  vigor¬ 
ously  for  the  proposition  that  Atlantis  not 
only  existed  but  was  the  place  where  human 
beings  became  civilized.  Atlantis  sent  its  peo¬ 
ple  all  over  the  world  and  seeded  the  earth. 
The  great  gods  and  goddesses  of  the  ancient 
world  were  based  on  the  leaders  and  heroes  of 
Atlantis;  worldwide  legends  of  a  mighty  del¬ 
uge  owe  their  origins  to  dim  memories  of  the 
catastrophe  that  overwhelmed  Atlantis.  The 
historical  civilization  influenced  most  directly 
by  Atlantis  was  ancient  Egypt. 


These  revelations  sparked  international 
interest,  and  Donnelly’s  book  went  through 
many  printings.  For  a  time  even  some  rep¬ 
utable  scientists  were  willing  to  consider  the 
possibility  that  the  legend  was  true,  after  all. 
Indeed,  Donnelly  was  elected  to  the  Ameri¬ 
can  Association  for  the  Advancement  of  Sci¬ 
ence.  Before  long,  however,  as  critics  exposed 
the  book’s  errors,  exaggerations,  and  assorted 
scholarly  shortcomings,  belief  in  Atlantis 
moved  to  the  occult  fringes,  to  be  champi¬ 
oned  by  the  likes  of  Theosophy  founder  He¬ 
lena  Petrovna  Blavatsky  and  other  philoso¬ 
phers  of  the  esoteric.  Before  the  end  of  the 
nineteenth  century,  a  growing  body  of  occult 
literature  attested  that  Atlantis  was  ad¬ 
vanced,  not  just  by  the  standards  of  their 
time,  but  by  modern  times  as  well;  it  pos¬ 
sessed  a  super  science  that,  among  other 
marvelous  accomplishments,  had  invented 
airplanes  and  television. 

The  Scottish  folklorist  and  occultist  Lewis 
Spence,  who  took  a  relatively  more  conserva¬ 
tive  approach,  wrote  five  books  on  Atlantis 
between  1924  and  1943,  citing  Donnelly  and 
his  methodology  as  his  principal  inspiration. 
Bowing  to  the  consensus  view  of  historians 
and  archaeologists,  who  held  that  human  be¬ 
ings  were  living  in  caves  nine  thousand  years 
before  Plato’s  time,  Spence  held  that  Atlantis 
had  existed  nine  hundred  years  before  Plato. 
Meanwhile,  allegations,  rumors,  and  outright 
hoaxes  of  archaeological  “discoveries”  of  At- 
lantean  artifacts  filled  the  popular  press  and 
kept  the  “mystery”  alive. 

The  much-circulated  channelings  of  Edgar 
Cayce  (1877-1945),  called  the  “sleeping 
prophet”  because  of  the  state  of  consciousness 
in  which  he  vocalized  his  psychic  readings, 
often  concerned  Atlantis.  Many  who  came  to 
him  for  psychic  guidance  learned  that  they  had 
been  Atlanteans  in  previous  lives.  In  Cayce’s 
comprehensive  re-envisioning  of  the  lost  con¬ 
tinent,  Atlantis  was  essentially  where  Plato  had 
placed  it:  between  the  Gulf  of  Mexico  and  the 
Mediterranean.  Unlike  Plato’s,  Cayce’s  Atlantis 
was  as  advanced  as  mid-twentieth-century 
America,  and  in  a  number  of  ways  more  ad- 


Atlantis  33 


vanced.  The  Atlanteans,  according  to  Cayce,  at 
first  were  spiritual  beings.  They  eventually 
evolved  into  flesh- and-blood  ones.  Their  soci¬ 
ety  came  undone  when  civil  war  erupted.  A 
combination  of  natural  disasters  and  the  mis¬ 
use  of  Atlantean  technology  caused  the  conti¬ 
nent  to  break  apart  and  sink  under  the  ocean 
waters.  But  by  the  late  1960s,  Cayce  predicted, 
the  western  part  of  Atlantis  would  reemerge  in 
the  vicinity  of  Bimini,  in  the  Bahamas.  When 
the  time  came,  more  than  two  decades  after 
Cayce’s  death,  several  expeditions  searched  for 
Atlantean  ruins  in  the  area,  at  one  point  trum¬ 
peting  what  proved  to  be  natural  undersea 
rock  formations  as  roadways  and  architectural 
artifacts. 

Atlantis  has  been  thoroughly  absorbed 
into  fringe  belief,  theory,  and  practice.  In  the 
age  of  flying  saucers,  some  writers  tied  UFOs 
to  an  extraterrestrial  technology  that  the  At¬ 
lanteans  knew  because  of  their  frequent  inter¬ 
actions  with  friendly  space  people.  Hollow- 
earth  enthusiasts  believed  that  Atlantean 
machinery  and  even  Atlanteans  themselves 
could  be  found  inside  certain  cavern  en¬ 
trances  around  the  world.  New  Age  channel- 
ers  communicated  with  hundreds,  perhaps 
thousands,  of  disembodied  Atlanteans.  A 
century  of  occult  lore  holds  that  Atlanteans 
and  Lemurians  (from  Lemuria,  the  Pacific 
equivalent  of  Atlantis)  maintain  colonies  in¬ 
side  Mount  Shasta  on  the  California-Oregon 
border. 

With  the  rise  of  the  Internet,  web  sites  de¬ 
voted  to  Atlantis  and  related  materials  have 
proliferated.  One  such  site,  run  by  the 
Hawaii-based  Department  of  Interplanetary 
Affairs,  provides  a  densely  detailed  overview 
of  the  Atlantis  myth  as  it  had  evolved  by  the 
end  of  the  twentieth  century.  In  this  version, 
Atlantis  was  literally  a  golden  civilization  in 
which  gold  was  so  plentiful  that  it  was  as 
common  as  steel  is  today  in  construction  and 
infrastructure.  The  Atlanteans  traveled 
around  the  globe  in  fantastic  flying  ships. 
These  same  ships  took  them  to  other  planets, 
including  Mars,  where  they  left  evidence  of 
their  presence  in  a  gigantic  structure  (the 


“Mars  face”)  and  a  number  of  pyramids  on 
the  Martian  surface.  The  moon  was  also  a 
colony  of  Atlantis.  Modern-day  astronauts 
found  ruins  of  walls  and  roads  there  but  were 
silenced  by  a  government  determined  to  keep 
the  truth  about  Atlantis  from  the  public. 

The  Department  of  Interplanetary  Affairs 
describes  Atlanteans  as  living  lives  of  leisure 
and  prosperity,  while  a  “national  work  force  of 
robots,  androids,  and  humanoids  from  ge¬ 
netic  engineering”  did  the  empires  heavy  lift¬ 
ing.  “Atlantean  science  then  fostered  some 
bizarre  genetic  creations — they  discovered 
ways  to  cross-breed  species  to  create  mermaids 
and  mermen,  Cyclops,  unicorns  and  other 
creatures.”  That  same  genetic  engineering 
gave  Atlanteans  huge  size  and  great  strength. 

It  all  came  crashing  down,  in  both  a  literal 
and  figurative  sense,  when  the  population 
surrendered  itself  to  the  pursuit  of  hedonistic 
pleasures;  in  the  meantime,  evil  Atlantean 
scientists  cracked  the  secret  of  mind  control 
and  tried  to  dominate  the  world  and  even  the 
solar  system.  In  due  course  the  abuse  of  both 
psychic  and  material  technology  led  to  the 
geophysical  cataclysms  that  destroyed  the 
continent. 

But  that  was  not  all.  According  to  the  De¬ 
partment  of  Interplanetary  Affairs,  Atlantis’s 
problems  generated  a  world  war  that  spread 
into  space.  Atomic  blasts  decimated  the  moon 
colony.  Antimatter  rays  vaporized  nearly  all  of 
Atlantis’s  buildings  and  cities.  “It  is  said,”  the 
department  reports,  “that  one  of  these  anti¬ 
matter  rays  is  still  operating  in  the  Bermuda 
Triangle  and  has  been  causing  planes  and 
ships  to  disappear.  Today  that  ray  is  out  of 
control”  (Omar,  1996). 

For  all  the  allure  of  the  Atlantis  legend, 
nothing  of  substance  has  come  to  light  in  the 
nearly  twenty-five  centuries  that  separate  us 
from  Plato’s  account  to  lead  reasonable  people 
to  conclude  that  such  a  lost  continent  ever 
graced  the  Atlantic  Ocean.  In  Imagining  At  - 
lantis  (1998)  Richard  Ellis  writes,  “Plato’s  de¬ 
scription  of  Atlantis  was  of  a  rich  and  power¬ 
ful  society  that  was  swallowed  up  by  the  sea  in 
a  great  cataclysm,  and  every  remnant  of  it  de- 


34  Aura  Rhanes 


stroyed.  Like  the  Iliad  and  the  Odyssey,  it  has 
managed  to  survive  for  more  than  two  millen¬ 
nia.  But  unlike  Homer’s  epic  poems,  Plato’s 
tale — rarely  considered  an  important  part  of 
his  voluminous  output — has  not  only  sur¬ 
vived  as  a  demonstration  of  the  storyteller’s 
art,  but  also  has  become  a  part  of  our  own 
mythology.” 

See  Also:  Bermuda  Triangle;  Channelings;  Hollow 
earth;  Lemuria;  Mount  Shasta;  Shaver  mystery 

Further  Reading 

Cayce,  Edgar,  1968.  Edgar  Cayce  on  Atlantis.  New 
York:  Paperback  Library. 

De  Camp,  L.  Sprague,  1970.  Lost  Continents:  The  At  - 
lantis  Theme  in  History,  Science,  and  Literature. 
New  York:  Dover  Publications. 

Donnelly,  Ignatius,  1882.  Atlantis:  The  Antediluvian 
World.  New  York:  Harper. 

Ellis,  Richard,  1998.  Imagining  Atlantis.  New  York: 
Alfred  A.  Knopf. 

Omar,  Steve,  1996.  “History  of  the  Golden  Ages, 
Volume  I.”  http://www.nii.net/-obie/history- 
gold.htm 

Spence,  Lewis,  1924.  The  Problem  of  Atlantis.  Lon¬ 
don:  Rider. 

Steiner,  Rudolf,  1968.  Cosmic  Memory:  Prehistory  of 
Earth  and  Man.  West  Nyack,  NY:  Paperback  Li¬ 
brary. 


Aura  Rhanes 

Heavy-equipment  operator  Truman  Bethu- 
rum  encountered  the  beautiful  Aura  Rhanes, 
captain  of  a  “scow”  (spaceship)  from  the  idyl¬ 
lic  planet  Clarion,  on  the  other  side  of  the 
moon,  in  the  early  morning  hours  of  July  28, 
1952,  in  the  Nevada  desert.  When  male  crew 
members  ushered  him  inside  the  craft,  parked 
in  an  area  known  locally  as  Mormon  Mesa, 
Bethurum  saw  Aura  Rhanes  for  the  first  time. 
She  was  small,  had  an  olive  complexion,  and 
wore  a  black  and  red  beret.  The  two  engaged 
in  an  extended  conversation,  during  which 
they  asked  each  other  about  their  respective 
worlds.  The  spacewoman  spoke,  Bethurum 
would  write,  “in  a  swinging,  rhythmic  tone  of 
voice”  (Bethurum,  1954).  When  daylight 
came,  Bethurum  was  asked  to  leave,  but  they 
were  to  meet  again.  There  were  eleven  meet¬ 
ings  between  July  and  November  alone.  Only 
on  the  occasion  of  the  third  meeting,  on  Au¬ 


gust  18,  did  she  reveal  her  name.  Once  he 
spotted  her  walking  down  a  street  in  Las 
Vegas,  but  she  refused  to  speak  with  him,  ap¬ 
parently  not  wanting  to  be  recognized. 

Bethurum  participated  actively  in  the 
1950s  contact  movement.  Most  outside  ob¬ 
servers  believed  him  to  be  a  hoaxer.  His  wife, 
Mary,  apparently  felt  otherwise.  She  divorced 
him  in  1956  on  the  grounds  that  he  was  hav¬ 
ing  sexual  relations  with  Aura  Rhanes.  As  with 
many  other  contactees  from  that  period,  it  is 
impossible  to  judge  just  what  Bethurum  be¬ 
lieved  or  did  not  believe  about  his  reported  in¬ 
teractions  with  extraterrestrials.  A  privately 
kept  scrapbook  published  after  his  death  car¬ 
ried  a  poem  titled  “Third  Visit  to  Mormon 
Mesa  Aug  18  1952”  commemorating  the 
meeting  in  which  Aura  Rhanes  let  him  touch 
her  to  convince  him  of  her  physical  reality. 
Other  items  in  the  scrapbook  consist  of  clip¬ 
pings  about  himself  and  of  materials  lending 
support  to  his  story.  Though  a  skeptic  of  con¬ 
tact  claims,  British  writer  Hilary  Evans  re¬ 
marks  that  “we  still  have  no  yardstick  whereby 
we  can  separate  contactees  into  ‘genuine’  and 
‘fake’,  and  until  we  can  establish  some  such 
criteria,  we  must  provisionally  extend  the  ben¬ 
efit  of  the  doubt  even  to  poor  old  Truman 
Bethurum  and  cute  little  Aura  Rhanes  from 
the  far  side  of  the  Sun”  (Evans,  1987). 

See  Also:  Bethurum,  Truman;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Bethurum,  Truman,  1954.  Aboard  a  Flying  Saucer. 
Los  Angeles:  DeVorss  and  Company. 

- ,  1982.  Personal  Scrapbook.  Scotia,  NY:  Arc- 

turus  Book  Service. 

Evans,  Hilary,  1987.  Gods,  Spirits,  Cosmic  Guardians. 
Wellingborough,  Northamptonshire,  England: 
Aquarian  Press. 

Aurora  Martian 

An  article  in  the  April  19,  1897,  edition  of  the 
Dallas  Morning  News  told  an  extraordinary 
story  in  a  very  few  words.  Datelined  Aurora, 
forty-five  miles  northwest  of  Dallas,  it  related 
that  a  mysterious  “airship”  had  crashed  into  a 
local  windmill  at  6  A.M.  two  days  earlier.  On 
colliding,  “it  went  to  pieces  with  a  terrific  ex- 


Ausso  35 


plosion,  scattering  debris  over  several  acres  of 
ground,  wrecking  the  windmill  and  tower  and 
destroying  [windmill  owner  Judge  J.  S.  Proc¬ 
tor’s]  flower  garden,”  correspondent  S.  E. 
Haydon  wrote.  Haydon  went  on  to  report 
that  citizens  who  rushed  to  the  scene  found 
the  body  of  a  “badly  disfigured”  being  whom 
one  observer  identified  as  a  Martian.  The 
story  concluded  with  the  news  that  the  fu¬ 
neral  would  occur  the  next  day. 

The  story  appeared  in  the  midst  of  a  wave 
of  what  today  would  be  called  UFO  sightings, 
which  had  begun  in  northern  California  in 
November  1896  and  moved  eastward  by  the 
following  spring,  when  newspapers  all  over 
America  were  full  of  strange  and  often  fanciful 
stories.  The  Morning  News  carried  no  follow¬ 
up,  suggesting  it  did  not  take  the  tale  seriously 
enough  to  dispatch  one  of  its  own  reporters  to 
the  site.  In  any  event,  it  wasn’t  the  only  wild 
airship  yarn  the  paper  was  carrying.  The  day 
before  it  printed  the  Aurora  story,  it  recounted 
a  Kaufman  County  sighting  of  a  “Chinese  fly¬ 
ing  dragon.  .  .  .  The  legs  were  the  propellers.” 
At  Farmersville,  the  paper  stated,  the  occu¬ 
pants  of  an  airship  sang  “Nearer  My  God  to 
Thee”  and  distributed  temperance  tracts. 

The  episode  of  the  Aurora  Martian  was  for¬ 
gotten  until  the  1960s,  when  public  fascina¬ 
tion  with  UFOs  led  to  research  into  the  phe¬ 
nomenon’s  early  history.  In  1966  a  Houston 
Post  writer  revived  the  Aurora  story,  which  he 
apparently  took  at  face  value.  Investigators 
went  to  the  tiny  town  and  spoke  with  elderly 
residents.  Most,  if  they  remembered  the 
episode  at  all,  dismissed  it  as  a  joke.  One  said 
that  FFaydon  had  concocted  the  tale  to  draw 
attention  to  the  town,  which  in  the  1890s  was 
suffering  a  serious  decline  in  its  fortunes. 

Still,  rumors  persisted  that  a  grave  in  the 
Aurora  cemetery  housed  an  unknown  occu¬ 
pant,  perhaps  the  Martian.  As  late  as  1973, 
ufologist  FFayden  FFewes  was  trying  to  per¬ 
suade  local  people  to  let  him  exhume  the 
grave,  a  notion  that  Aurora’s  residents  vehe¬ 
mently  rejected.  Confusing  matters  further, 
two  elderly  residents  were  now  claiming  that 
they  had  known  persons  who  saw  the  wreck¬ 


age.  Analysis  of  metal  samples  allegedly  of  the 
airship,  however,  proved  it  was  an  aluminum 
alloy  of  fairly  recent  vintage. 

There  is  no  reason  to  believe  that  a  Martian 
died  in  Aurora,  Texas,  late  in  the  nineteenth 
century.  Still,  the  legend  inspired  the  1985 
film  Aurora  Encounter,  a  low-budget  ET  set  in 
the  Old  West,  and  it  remains  one  of  Texas’s 
more  exotic  folktales. 

See  Also:  Allingham’s  Martian;  Brown’s  Martians; 
Dead  extraterrestrials;  Dentons’s  Martians  and 
Venusians;  Hopkins’s  Martians;  Khauga;  Martian 
bees;  Mince-Pie  Martians;  Monka;  Muller’s  Mar¬ 
tians;  Shaw’s  Martians;  Smead’s  Martians; 
Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Chariton,  Wallace  O.,  1991.  The  Great  Texas  Airship 
Mystery.  Plano,  TX:  Wordware  Publishing. 

Cohen,  Daniel,  1981.  The  Great  Airship  Mystery:  A 
UFO  of  the  1890s.  New  York:  Dodd,  Mead  and 
Company. 

Masquelette,  Frank,  1966.  “Claims  Made  of  UFO 
Evidence.”  Houston  Post  (June  13). 

Randle,  Kevin  D.,  1995.  A  History  of  UFO  Crashes. 
New  York:  Avon  Books. 

Simmons,  H.  Michael,  1985.  “Once  upon  a  Time  in 
the  West.”  Magonia  43  (July):  3-1 1. 

Ausso 

Ausso  is  an  extraterrestrial  allegedly  encoun¬ 
tered  by  Wyoming  elk  hunter  E.  Carl  Hig¬ 
don,  Jr.,  on  October  25,  1974.  Five  hours 
after  he  called  for  help,  authorities  found  Hig¬ 
don  inside  his  pickup  in  an  area  inaccessible 
to  all  but  four-wheel-drive  vehicles.  Taken  to  a 
nearby  hospital,  the  shaken  and  disoriented 
Higdon  claimed  to  have  encountered  a 
strange  being  named  Ausso  who  flew  him  in  a 
spaceship  to  another  world  where  he  was 
taken  to  a  mushroom-shaped  tower.  While  in¬ 
side  the  tower,  Higdon  saw  what  looked  like 
normal  human  beings,  who  paid  no  attention 
to  him.  Ausso  explained  that  he  was  a 
hunter/explorer,  and  he  and  his  people  were 
visiting  Earth  to  collect  animals  for  breeding 
purposes  and  for  food.  Soon  Higdon  was 
flown  back  to  Earth  and  put  back  in  his  truck. 

Polygraph  tests  given  Higdon  in  1975  and 
1976  produced  ambiguous  results,  but  psy¬ 
chological  inventories  suggested  that  he  did 


36  Avinash 


not  suffer  from  mental  illness.  Higdon  did 
not  seek  to  exploit  his  alleged  experience  and 
soon  returned  to  private  life.  University  of 
Wyoming  psychologist  and  ufologist  R.  Leo 
Sprinkle,  who  investigated  the  incident, 
judged  Higdon  sincere,  even  if  it  had  proved 
impossible  to  establish  the  “validity  of  the 
UFO  experience”  (Sprinkle,  1979). 

Further  Reading 

Gansberg,  Judith  M.,  and  Alan  L.  Gansberg,  1980. 
Direct  Encounters:  The  Personal  Histories  of  UFO 
Abductees.  New  York:  Walker  and  Company. 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  1979.  “Investigation  of  the  Alleged 
UFO  Experience  of  Carl  Higdon.”  In  Richard  F. 
Haines,  ed.  UFO  Phenomena  and  the  Behavioral 
Scientist,  225-357.  Metuchen,  NJ:  Scarecrow 
Press. 


Avinash 

On  March  3,  1986,  an  extraterrestrial  spirit 
entered  the  body  of  a  man  identified  only  as 
John.  Till  then,  John,  a  channeler  from  Belle¬ 
vue,  Washington,  had  been  communicating 
with  another  entity,  Elihu.  However,  on  this 
date  the  space  being  Avinash  took  control  of 
John’s  consciousness.  Soon  thereafter,  Avinash 
moved  to  Hawaii  with  another  walk-in  (a  per¬ 
son  under  the  control  of  a  spirit  or  other-in¬ 
telligence  that  has  claimed  his  or  her  body),  a 
woman  named  Alezsha.  In  due  course,  a  third 
walk-in,  Ashtridia,  joined  them.  Avinash, 
however,  did  the  channeling,  teaching  a  doc¬ 
trine  that  said  essentially  that  conscious  could 
affect  reality;  thus,  both  personal  and  societal 
reality  can  be  altered  if  one  rearranges  one’s 
perceptions. 

Overseen  by  an  immense  extradimensional 
spaceship,  the  three  moved  to  the  popular 
New  Age  community,  Sedona,  Arizona,  where 
Avinash  met  Arthea,  and  the  two  became  a 
couple.  They  were  brought  together,  they  be¬ 
lieved,  by  divine  guidance.  The  walk-in  group 
expanded  to  a  dozen  members  in  1987,  but  as 
most  members  eventually  moved  away,  only 
three  remained  by  the  end  of  the  year.  Those 
three,  Avinash,  Arthea,  and  Alana,  began  to 
host  new  occupying  entities  that  would  mani¬ 
fest  for  a  time,  then  depart.  While  the  entities 


occupied  them,  the  humans  would  take  on 
their  names.  Other  members  who  later  came 
into  the  group,  now  calling  itself  Extraterres¬ 
trial  Earth  Mission,  experienced  the  same  (to 
outsiders)  bewildering  change  of  names  and 
identities. 

Extraterrestrial  Earth  Mission  became  an 
international  movement.  Outside  the  United 
States,  it  was  particularly  successful  in  Aus¬ 
tralia.  The  organization’s  headquarters  are 
now  in  Hawaii. 

See  Also:  Walk-ins 

Further  Reading 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  American 
Religions.  Fifth  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale  Re¬ 
search. 


Ayala 

Ayala  is  a  deva,  a  divine  energy,  who  claims 
to  represent  the  animal  kingdom  and,  be¬ 
yond  that,  “All  That  Is.”  She  appeared  first 
on  February  2,  1994,  to  two  Sedona,  Ari¬ 
zona,  New  Age  women,  both  of  them  chan- 
nelers.  Subsequently,  she  directed  other 
devas,  including  Shiva  and  Gaia,  who  com¬ 
municated  psychically  on  the  subject  of 
human-animal  relations. 

Ayala  made  her  presence  known  when  two 
psychics,  Toraya  (Carly)  Ayres  and  a  woman 
identified  only  as  Sarafina,  happened  to  be  en¬ 
gaged  in  a  discussion  of  nature  spirits.  Sud¬ 
denly,  Sarafina  started  shivering  and  breathing 
oddly.  Then  she  lapsed  into  a  trance,  during 
which  she  voiced  animal-like  sounds.  Soon 
Ayala  was  speaking  through  her,  proposing 
that  she  and  the  two  women  work  together  on 
a  project.  The  project  required  Ayres  to  be  at 
her  computer  at  three  o’clock  each  afternoon 
to  write  down  the  messages  as  they  came 
forth.  When  Ayres  protested  that  this  was  not 
a  good  time  for  her  in  terms  of  her  job  re¬ 
sponsibilities,  Ayala  insisted  that  that  was  the 
only  time  the  communication  could  be  ef¬ 
fected,  owing  to  the  vagaries  of  planetary  vi¬ 
brations.  She  said,  “We  will  meet  you  in  your 
dreamtime,  and  you  will  be  more  aware  of 
what  your  role  is  in  the  inter-planetary  con- 


Azelia  37 


nection  with  All  That  Is.  .  .  .  There  is  an  en¬ 
ergy  that  needs  to  form.  We  have  to  contact 
all  the  devas,  and  it  is  not  always  up  to  us  just 
which  time  we  can  do  this.” 

For  the  next  two  days  Ayala  communicated 
with  Ayres  before  relinquishing  her  spot  to 
another  entity,  Shiva,  “the  blood,  the  muscle, 
fur,  bone,  and  spirit  of  animals.”  Ayala  told 
Ayres  that  animals  are  evolving  spirits  just  as 
human  beings  are.  Once  love  and  trust  had 
existed  between  people  and  animals.  Then  the 
ice  ages  came,  and  animals  became  wild,  and 
humans  began  using  them  for  food.  Then  hu¬ 
mans  started  mistreating  animals  in  all  kinds 
of  other  ways,  and  they  also  abused  nature 
generally.  Even  so,  after  enduring  thousands 
of  years  of  cruelty,  animals  continue  to  love 
humans,  “whether  in  this  dimension  or  any 
other.”  Humans  and  animals  will  be  recon¬ 
ciled  during  this  time  of  transition,  when  peo¬ 
ple  are  beginning  the  process  that  will  take 
them  out  of  the  third — physical — dimension 
into  higher  dimensions. 

In  the  meantime,  Ayala  urged  human  be¬ 
ings  to  communicate  through  meditation 
with  animal  devas.  For  example,  someone 
having  trouble  with  ants  should  visualize  the 
ant  deva  and  express  a  polite  request,  first 
stressing  reverence  for  ants  and  all  they  do  for 
the  world,  then  asking  the  ants  to  leave  the 
building.  If  human  beings  interact  with  ani¬ 
mals  in  this  fashion,  there  will  be  no  need  for 
environment-damaging  poisons  or  needless 
slaughter  of  wild  creatures. 

See  Also:  Shiva 

Further  Reading 

Ayres,  Toraya,  1997.  “Messages  from  the  Animal 
Kingdom.”  http://www.spiritweb.org/Spirit/ani- 
mal-kingdom-ayres.html 


Azelia 

Azelia  is  allegedly  the  half-extraterrestrial  off¬ 
spring  of  a  Brazilian  man  and  an  alien  being 
with  whom  he  was  forced  to  undergo  sexual 
intercourse. 

Just  after  returning  home  from  work 
around  3  A.M.  on  June  18,  1979,  night 


watchman  Antonio  Carlos  Ferreira  of  Mira- 
sol,  Sao  Paulo,  was  startled  to  see  a  UFO  land 
outside  his  house.  Three  humanoids  entered 
and  paralyzed  him  with  red  lights  that  em¬ 
anated  from  boxes  they  carried  on  their 
chests.  They  and  he  floated  into  the  craft, 
which  eventually  took  off.  Ferreira  passed  out. 
Later  he  vaguely  recalled  a  mother  ship. 
Under  hypnosis  his  “memories”  grew  sharper, 
and  he  saw  himself  inside  a  mother  ship,  look¬ 
ing  at  the  distant  Earth  through  a  porthole. 
Approximately  twelve  different  aliens,  of  two 
different  but  seemingly  related  types,  occu¬ 
pied  the  same  room.  One  group  consisted  of 
green-skinned  humanoids  with  smooth  dark 
hair,  thin  lips  and  noses,  big  eyes,  and  pointed 
ears.  The  others  looked  somewhat  similar  ex¬ 
cept  they  had  brown  skin,  thick  lips,  and  red, 
crinkly  hair.  All  stood  four  feet  tall  and  were 
clad  in  white  uniforms  and  gloves.  A  green 
being  seemed  to  be  in  charge. 

Ferreira  was  taken  into  another  room, 
which  was  dimly  lit,  and  made  to  lie  on  a 
couch.  A  naked  female  walked  in  and  ap¬ 
proached  him  as  the  other  beings  tried  to  re¬ 
move  his  clothing  over  the  abductee’s  resist¬ 
ance.  The  woman,  about  a  foot  taller  than  the 
others,  was  essentially  human,  with  a  larger 
than  usual  head,  thin  lips,  chocolate  skin,  and 
narrow  nose.  Her  breath  was  foul.  Ferreira  in¬ 
ferred  that  the  beings  wanted  him  to  engage 
in  sex  with  the  woman,  a  notion  he  found  re¬ 
pellent.  Only  after  the  humanoids  subdued 
him  with  a  sharp-smelling  chemical  were  they 
able  to  disrobe  him.  Even  then,  he  continued 
to  fight,  until  one  of  his  arms  was  placed  in  a 
device  and  the  other  numbed  with  an  injec¬ 
tion.  The  beings  spread  an  oily  liquid  all  over 
him,  and  intercourse  followed.  At  the  conclu¬ 
sion  of  the  act,  oil  was  spread  over  him  again, 
and  they  removed  him  from  the  apparatus 
and  redressed  him. 

The  beings,  who  addressed  him  via  telepa¬ 
thy  but  spoke  an  “incomprehensible”  lan¬ 
guage  to  each  other,  explained  that  they  had 
conducted  an  experiment.  He  would  father  a 
male  child.  At  some  point,  after  three  unspec¬ 
ified  signals  had  been  given,  they  would  re- 


38  Azelia 


turn  to  show  him  his  offspring.  After  giving 
him  an  unpleasant-tasting  liquid  to  quell  his 
appetite,  they  took  him  to  the  disc  that  had 
brought  him  to  the  mother  ship  and  flew  him 
home.  Ferreira  suffered  from  a  variety  of  small 
punctures  and  wounds,  and  for  the  next 
twenty  days  he  had  a  burning  sensation  in  his 
eyes. 

There  were  other  incidents.  In  one  he  was 
shown  the  child.  In  another,  on  board  a  UFO, 


he  saw  the  child  with  its  mother.  On  March 
30,  1983,  one  being  came  to  his  workplace  to 
inform  him — notwithstanding  what  they  had 
told  him  earlier — that  the  child  was  a  girl. 
Her  name  was  Azelia. 

Further  Reading 

Granchi,  Irene,  1984.  “Abduction  at  Mirasol.”  Flying 
Saucer  Review  30,  1  (October):  14-22. 

Marsland.  Robert,  1983.  “Two  Claimed  Abductions 
in  Brazil.”  The  APRO  Bulletin  (November):  1—2. 


Back 

In  the  1970s,  a  middle-aged  Italian  woman, 
Germana  Grosso,  told  a  Turin  newspaper 
about  her  two  decades  of  contact  with  an 
alien  race  that  calls  itself  Back.  She  became 
aware  of  its  existence  twenty  years  earlier, 
when  a  Tibetan  lama’s  telepathic  messages  ex¬ 
plained  to  her  how  she  could  communicate 
with  extraterrestrials.  Soon  the  Back  were 
showing  her  scenes  of  themselves  and  their 
lovely  home  planet,  Lioaki.  Grosso  “saw” 
them  as  images  on  a  sort  of  mental  television 
screen.  They  also  informed  her  that  they  have 
bases  on  Earth:  under  the  Atlantic  Ocean,  in 
the  Gobi  Desert,  and  in  a  valley  in  northern 
Italy.  Earth  is  nearing  disaster,  and  the  Back 
are  here  not  to  interfere  but  to  warn  those 
who  will  listen. 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  1989.  Psychic  and  UFO 
Revelations  in  the  Last  Days.  New  Brunswick,  NJ: 
Inner  Light  Publications. 


Bartholomew 

The  channeling  entity  Bartholomew  first  spoke 
through  Mary-Margaret  Moore  in  the  mid- 
1970s.  She  was  visiting  friends  in  Socorro, 
New  Mexico,  and  undergoing  hypnosis  in  an 
effort  to  relieve  back  pain.  Suddenly,  somebody 


was  speaking  through  her.  For  the  first  year  of 
their  association,  Moore  feared  that  Bartholo¬ 
mew  was  a  dramatic  delusion.  But  over  time 
she  became  convinced  of  his  wisdom  and 
prophetic  talents.  She  came  to  think  of  him  as 
“the  energy  vortex”  or  “the  higher  and  wiser 
level  of  energy”  (Moore,  1984). 

During  the  New  Age  boom  of  the  1980s, 
Bartholomew — known  for  his  gentle,  kind 
manner — was  something  of  a  channeling  su¬ 
perstar;  his  messages  of  comfort  and  self-love 
were  taken  to  heart.  He  addressed  a  wide  range 
of  subjects,  from  sex  and  AIDS  to  prayer  and 
ego  surrender.  Before  his  popularity  waned,  he 
was  the  subject  of  two  books  by  Moore. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Moore,  Mary-Margaret,  1984.  /  Come  as  a  Brother:  A 
Remembrance  of  Illusions.  Taos,  NM:  High  Mesa 
Press. 

- ,  1987.  From  the  Heart  of  a  Gentle  Brother. 

Taos,  NM:  High  Mesa  Press. 

Bashar 

After  two  close  encounters  with  large,  trian¬ 
gle-shaped  UFOs  over  the  course  of  one  week 
in  1973,  Californian  Darryl  Anka — the 
brother  of  singer  and  composer  Paul  Anka — 
began  reading  UFO  literature  in  search  of  an¬ 
swers.  Through  his  reading  about  UFOs,  he 


39 


40  Being  of  Light 


was  led  to  paranormal  subjects  such  as  psychic 
phenomena,  channeling,  and  spirit  communi¬ 
cation.  In  1983,  Anka  sat  in  with  a  channeler 
and  spent  several  months  absorbing  informa¬ 
tion  from  discarnate  sources.  The  entity  of¬ 
fered  to  teach  whoever  might  be  interested  in 
learning  how  to  channel,  and  Anka  decided  to 
take  a  course  from  the  channeler.  Midway 
through  the  course,  Anka  first  heard  from 
“Bashar,”  who  said  he  was  the  pilot  of  the 
spaceship  Anka  had  seen  a  decade  earlier. 

Bashar  claimed  to  have  come  from  a  planet 
where  all  communication  is  done  through 
telepathy.  The  people  there  do  not  have  names 
as  such.  He  called  himself  Bashar — Arabic  for 
“commander” — for  Anka’s  convenience. 

After  a  period  of  telepathic  communication 
with  Bashar,  Anka  started  to  channel — in 
other  words,  to  speak  with  his  (or  Bashar’s) 
voice  so  that  others  could  hear.  In  due  course, 
Anka  has  become  an  internationally  known 
channeler  who  has  taken  Bashar  (as  well  as  an¬ 
other  entity,  Anima)  to  a  variety  of  nations  on 
several  continents.  Bashar  has  told  Anka  that 
he  and  his  people  live  on  the  planet  Essassani, 
five  hundred  light  years  from  Earth  but  in  a 
different  dimension.  Bashar  was  speaking  not 
just  for  himself  but  collectively  expressing  his 
society’s  sentiments. 

“I  have  no  way  of  proving  ‘Bashar’s’  exis¬ 
tence  to  anyone,”  Anka  concedes.  “The  most 
important  thing  is  that  the  information,  wher¬ 
ever  it’s  coming  from,  had  made  a  difference  in 
many  people’s  lives,  including  my  own”  (Anka, 
n.d.).  Anka’s  organization,  Interplanetary 
Connections,  coordinates  the  channeling  ef¬ 
forts  and  circulates  tapes  of  their  recordings. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Anka,  Darryl,  1990.  Bashar:  Blue  Print  for  Change,  A 
Message  for  Our  Ftiture.  Simi  Valley,  CA:  New  So¬ 
lutions  Publishing. 

“A  Message  from  Darryl  Anka,”  n.d.  http://www. 
bashartapes.com/ about/ message2.html 

Being  of  Light 

In  his  best-selling  Life  after  Life  (1976)  Ray¬ 
mond  A.  Moody  writes  of  near-death  experi¬ 


ences  in  which  persons  undergo  visionary  en¬ 
counters  of  what  seems  to  be  a  kind  of  heav¬ 
enly  realm.  In  out-of-body  states,  according  to 
testimony  Moody  collected,  percipients  ob¬ 
serve  a  brilliant  light  at  the  end  of  a  tunnel¬ 
like  passage.  A  telepathic  message  from  the 
light  asks  the  observer  something  like,  “Are 
you  prepared  to  die?”  or  “What  have  you 
done  with  your  life?”  Immediately  afterward, 
the  dying  person  experiences  a  “life  review”  in 
which  significant  events  are  rapidly  played  out 
either  in  order  of  their  occurrence  or  all  at 
once  in,  as  Moody  puts  it,  “a  display  of  visual 
imagery  .  .  .  incredibly  vivid  and  real.” 

The  percipient  feels  great  love  and  warmth 
emanating  from  this  being,  who  is  usually  in¬ 
terpreted  as  a  divine  figure  from  the  individ¬ 
ual’s  own  religious  tradition.  Some  see  it  as 
God  or  Christ,  others  as  an  angel.  All,  how¬ 
ever,  feel  that  the  being  is  “an  emissary,  or  a 
guide.” 

Moody  characterized  the  meeting  with  the 
being  of  light  as  “perhaps  the  most  incredible 
common  element  in  the  accounts.”  Other  re¬ 
searchers  who  followed  in  Moody’s  wake, 
however,  only  ambiguously  replicated  this 
particular  finding.  Kenneth  Ring,  Margot 
Grey,  and  others  found  fewer  such  encounters 
in  their  own  samples  of  people  who  had  un¬ 
dergone  near-death  experiences.  Many  near¬ 
death  accounts  described  the  observation  of 
an  overwhelmingly  loving,  beautiful  light  sur¬ 
rounding  them  and  suffusing  the  landscape, 
but  only  a  small  minority  of  reports  had  that 
light  as  a  “being.”  A  typical  expression  of  the 
light  was  more  like  one  offered  by  an  English¬ 
woman  who  encountered  it  while  her  heart 
stopped  as  she  was  anesthetized  during  dental 
surgery:  “The  light  is  brighter  than  anything 
possible  to  imagine.  There  are  no  words  to  de¬ 
scribe  it,  it’s  a  heavenly  light”  (Grey,  1985). 
Frequently,  percipients  encounter  recogniza¬ 
ble  figures,  usually  either  Christ  or  deceased 
friends  and  relatives. 

Further  Reading 

Grey,  Margot,  1985.  Return  from  Death:  An  Explo  - 
ration  of  the  Near-Death  Experience.  Boston,  MA: 
Arkana. 


Bermuda  Triangle  41 


Moody,  Raymond  A.,  Jr.,  1976.  Life  after  Life:  The 
Investigation  of  a  Phenomenon — Survival  of  Bodily 
Death.  Harrisburg,  PA:  Stackpole  Books. 

Ring,  Kenneth,  1980.  Life  at  Death:  A  Scientific  In  - 
vestigation  of  the  Near-Death  Experience.  New 
York:  Coward,  McCann  and  Geoghegan. 

Rogo,  D.  Scott,  1989.  The  Return  from  Silence:  A 
Study  of  Near-Death  Experiences.  Wellingbor¬ 
ough,  Northamptonshire,  England:  Aquarian 
Press. 


Bermuda  Triangle 

The  three  points  of  the  “Bermuda  Triangle”  are 
Florida,  Bermuda,  and  Puerto  Rico.  In  modem 
legend,  the  Triangle  is  more  than  an  arbitrary 
geometric  shape;  its  three  points  comprise  the 
boundaries  of  a  passage  into  a  mysterious  oth- 
erworld.  In  the  Bermuda  Triangle,  the  laws  of 
nature  are  suspended,  and  ships,  planes,  and 
people  disappear  without  a  trace. 

A  key  event  in  the  genesis  of  the  legend  was 
a  real-life  tragedy  off  the  coast  of  Florida  on 


December  5,  1945.  That  afternoon,  five 
Avenger  torpedo  bombers  flew  out  of  the 
Naval  Air  Station  at  Fort  Lauderdale.  Flight 
19,  consisting  of  fourteen  men  (thirteen  of 
them  students  in  the  last  stage  of  training), 
headed  on  an  eastern  course  toward  the  Ba¬ 
hamas,  intending  to  participate  in  a  practice 
bombing  at  Hens  and  Chickens  Shoals,  fifty- 
six  miles  away.  After  completing  that  part  of 
the  mission,  the  aircraft  were  to  proceed  to 
the  east  for  another  sixty-seven  miles,  turn 
north  for  seventy-three  miles,  then  head  west- 
southwest  for  the  remaining  one  hundred 
twenty  miles  back  to  their  home  base.  Head¬ 
ing  the  mission — the  only  nonstudent — was 
the  relatively  inexperienced  Lt.  Charles  Tay¬ 
lor,  who  did  not  know  the  area  well. 

By  late  afternoon,  the  planes  were  lost.  Tay¬ 
lor  thought  they  were  flying  over  the  Keys  off 
Florida’s  south  coast,  and  he  made  a  fatal  mis- 
judgment:  he  flew  north.  If  he  and  his  men 
had  been  over  the  Keys,  of  course,  they  would 


A  reward  poster  at  a  marina  for  the  yacht  Saba  Bank,  which  went  missing  in  the  Bermuda  Triangle  March  10,  1974 
(Bettmann/Corbis) 


42  Bermuda  Triangle 


have  arrived  over  land  and  to  safety.  Because 
they  were  over  the  Bahamas,  however,  flying 
northward  only  put  them  over  the  ocean. 
With  weather  conditions  deteriorating  rap¬ 
idly,  their  radio  contact  with  land,  already 
sporadic,  grew  ever  more  difficult.  Mean¬ 
while,  amid  growing  alarm  about  the  planes’ 
situation,  a  Dumbo  flying  boat — a  large  res¬ 
cue  aircraft  built  for  flight  over  large  bodies  of 
water — was  dispatched  from  a  seaplane  base 
in  Miami  and  sent  on  a  blind  search.  Soon 
other  planes  joined  it  and  flew  through  the 
ever  more  turbulent  weather.  One  of  them,  a 
Martin  Mariner,  also  disappeared. 

None  of  the  missing  craft  were  ever  found. 
The  navy’s  investigation  determined  that  Tay¬ 
lor’s  confusion  about  his  location,  coupled 
with  dangerous  air  and  sea  conditions,  caused 
the  planes  under  his  command  to  run  out  of 
gas,  crash,  and  get  chewed  up  by  the  immense 
waves  the  storm  had  summoned.  At  7:50  that 
evening,  a  ship’s  crew  saw  a  plane  explode.  A 
search  for  survivors  and  bodies  was  unsuccess¬ 
ful,  though  the  vessel  passed  through  a  large 
oil  slick  from  the  craft.  The  navy  believed  that 
the  Mariner,  a  notoriously  dangerous  aircraft 
that  was  sometimes  called  a  “flying  gas 
bomb,”  had  blown  up. 

If  the  facts  seemed  relatively  straightfor¬ 
ward,  the  legend  that  would  grow  in  the  wake 
of  Flight  1 9’s  disappearance  would  be  far 
more  convoluted  and  fantastic.  Flight  1 9’s 
transformation  from  aviation  tragedy  to  para¬ 
normal  mystery  would  begin  in  September 
1950,  when  Associated  Press  writer  E.V.W. 
Jones  wrote  a  story  about  what  he  called  the 
“limbo  of  the  lost,”  an  area  bordered  by 
Florida,  Bermuda,  and  Puerto  Rico,  where 
strange  things  happened.  None,  he  wrote,  was 
stranger  than  the  unexplained  fate  of  five 
Avengers  and  one  Mariner  on  the  evening  of 
December  5,  1945. 

Soon  books  and  magazines  dealing  with 
UFOs  and  other  anomalous  phenomena — 
and  even  mainstream  publications  such  as  The 
American  Legion  Magazine — were  picking  up 
the  stories,  which  grew  in  the  telling.  The 
term  “Bermuda Triangle”  was  the  invention  of 


longtime  Fortean  and  paranormal  writer  Vin¬ 
cent  H.  Gaddis;  his  article  on  the  subject  in 
the  February  1964  issue  of  Argosy  was  titled 
“The  Deadly  Bermuda  Triangle.”  The  next 
year  he  incorporated  it  into  a  popular  book, 
Invisible  Horizons,  on  “true  mysteries”  of  the 
seas.  In  Invisible  Residents  (1970)  Ivan  T. 
Sanderson  pointed  to  the  Bermuda  Triangle 
and  comparable  places  on  Earth  as  evidence 
that  “OINTS” — Other  Intelligences — live 
under  the  oceans,  sometimes  snatching 
planes,  ships,  and  their  unlucky  crews. 

By  the  1970s,  the  groundwork  had  been 
laid  for  a  popular  craze.  The  1970  release  of  a 
low-budget  documentary,  The  Devil’s  Triangle, 
stirred  interest  outside  the  core  audience  of 
paranormal  enthusiasts.  Four  years  later, 
Charles  Berlitz’s  The  Bermuda  Triangle,  a 
compilation  of  lore  that  had  already  quietly 
circulated  for  years,  became  a  major  best¬ 
seller.  That  same  year  two  paperbacks,  The 
Devil’s  Triangle  by  Richard  Winer  and  Limbo 
of  the  Lost  by  John  Wallace  Spencer,  fueled 
public  fascination  and  speculation.  But  the 
next  year,  in  1975,  Larry  Kusche’s  in-depth 
inquiry  into  the  incidents  that  underlay  the 
legend,  The  Bermuda  Triangle  Mystery — 
Solved,  undercut  the  myth-making  by  docu¬ 
menting  the  prosaic  explanations  that  would 
have  been  apparent  if  the  pro-Triangle  writers 
had  done  original  research  and  not  simply 
rewritten  each  other’s  books.  The  silence  of 
the  writers  whom  Kusche  criticized  effectively 
ended  the  discussion. 

See  Also:  OINTS 

Further  Reading 

Begg,  Paul,  1979.  Into  Thin  Air:  People  Who  Disap  - 
pear.  North  Pomfret,  VT:  David  and  Charles. 

Berlitz,  Charles,  with  J.  Manson  Valentine,  1974. 
The  Berrmida  Triangle.  Garden  City,  NY:  Dou¬ 
bleday  and  Company. 

Eckert,  Allan  W.,  1962.  “The  Mystery  of  the  Lost 
Patrol.”  The  American  Legion  Magazine  (April): 
12-23,39-41. 

Gaddis,  Vincent  H.,  1965.  Invisible  Horizons:  True 
Mysteries  of  the  Sea.  Philadelphia,  PA:  Chilton 
Books. 

Kusche,  Larry,  1975.  The  Bermuda  Triangle  Mys  - 
tery — Solved.  New  York:  Harper  and  Row,  Pub¬ 
lishers. 


Bethurum,  Truman  43 


- ,  1980.  The  Disappearance  of Flight  19.  New 

York:  Harper  and  Row,  Publishers. 

Sand,  George  X.,  1952.  “Sea  Mystery  at  Our  Back 
Door.”  Fate  5,  7  (October):  1 1-17. 

Sanderson,  Ivan  T.,  1970.  Invisible  Residents:  A  Dis  - 
qnisition  upon  Certain  Matters  Maritime,  and  the 
Possibility  of  Intelligent  life  under  the  Waters  of 
This  Earth.  New  York:  World  Publishing  Com¬ 
pany. 


Bethurum,  Truman  (1898-1969) 

Truman  Bethurum  was  one  of  the  stars  of  the 
1950s  contactee  movement.  In  a  1953  issue  of 
Saucers  magazine,  Bethurum  reported  that  in 
the  early  morning  hours  of  July  28,  1952,  he 
met  eight  little  men  of  “Latin”  appearance  and 
was  led  to  a  nearby  flying  saucer.  There  he 
met  the  captain,  a  beautiful  woman  named 
Aura  Rhanes  from  Clarion,  a  planet  never  vis¬ 
ible  to  humans  because  it  is  always  on  the 
other  side  of  the  moon.  Clarion,  Bethurum 
was  informed,  is  a  peaceful,  utopian  world; 
fear  of  nuclear  war  on  Earth  had  led  the  Clar- 
ionites  to  visit  and  observe  earthlings  at  first 


UFO  contactee  Truman  Bethurum  (Fortean  Picture 
library) 


Cover  fyAboard  a  Flying  Saucer  by  Truman  Bethurum 
(Fortean  Picture  library) 


hand.  Bethurum  claimed  further  contacts.  In 
the  mid-1950s,  Bethurum  established  a  com- 
munelike  “Sanctuary  of  Thought”  in  Prescott, 
Arizona.  He  was  a  regular  at  the  Giant  Rock 
Interplanetary  Spacecraft  Convention  and 
other  contactee  venues.  He  remained  active 
on  the  circuit  until  his  death  in  Landers,  Cali¬ 
fornia,  on  May  21,  1969. 

Two  early  chroniclers  of  the  contactee  sub¬ 
culture  found  themselves  “favorably  and  very 
deeply  impressed  with  Mr.  Bethurum’s 
unimaginative  sincerity”  (Reeve  and  Reeve, 
1957).  Another  apparent  believer  was  Mary 
Bethurum,  his  first  wife,  who  divorced  him 
on  the  grounds  that  he  was  engaged  in  a  sex¬ 
ual  relationship  with  Aura  Rhanes.  More  cyn¬ 
ical  observers,  such  as  Saucer  News  editor 
James  W.  Moseley,  judged  Bethurum  to  be  a 
liar,  motivated  by  a  desire  to  enrich  himself  at 
believers’  expense.  Bethurum  refused  to  un¬ 
dergo  polygraph  examination  to  verify  his 
story,  and  when  asked  to  submit,  for  scientific 
analysis,  a  letter  said  to  have  been  composed 
by  Aura  Rhanes,  he  declined,  explaining  that 
“paper  on  Clarion  is  made  out  of  just  the 


44  Bird  aliens 


same  kind  of  trees  we  have  on  earth”  (Davis, 
1957). 

See  Also:  Aura  Rhanes;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  ed.,  1970.  The  People  of  the 
Planet  Clarion.  Clarksburg,  WV:  Saucerian 
Books. 

Bethurum,  Truman,  1954.  Aboard  a  Flying  Saucer. 
Los  Angeles:  DeVorss  and  Company. 

- ,  1953.  “I  Was  Inside  a  Flying  Saucer.” 

Saucers  1,  2:  4-5. 

Davis,  Isabel  L.,  1957.  “Meet  the  Extraterrestrial.” 

Fantastic  Universe  8,  5  (November):  31-59. 
Moseley,  James  W,  1961.  “Recent  News  Stories: 
1961  Giant  Rock  Convention  Is  Disappointing.” 
Saucer  News  8,  4  (December):  12-13. 

Reeve,  Bryant,  and  Helen  Reeve,  1957 '.  Flying  Saucer 
Pilgrimage.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 


Bird  aliens 

A  French  businessman  who  insisted  on 
anonymity  confided  a  strange  tale  to  ufologist 
Lyonel  Trigano  about  a  decidedly  unsettling 
encounter  on  a  rural  road  in  Var  one  dark, 
rainy  night  in  November  1962.  As  he 
rounded  a  curve,  he  saw,  some  fifty  to  sixty 
feet  ahead  of  him,  a  group  of  figures  standing 
close  to  one  another  in  the  middle  of  the 
highway.  He  slowed  down,  and  as  he  did  so, 
the  group  “jerkily”  broke  into  two  parts. 

“My  window  was  down,”  he  related,  “and  I 
leaned  my  head  out  slightly  to  see  what  was 
the  matter;  it  was  then  that  I  saw  beasts,  some 
kind  of  bizarre  animals,  with  the  heads  of 
birds,  and  covered  in  some  sort  of  plumage, 
which  were  hurling  themselves  from  two  sides 
toward  my  car.” 

Shocked  and  frightened,  he  quickly  rolled 
up  the  window  and  accelerated.  After  moving 
a  few  hundred  feet  to  what  he  thought  was  a 
safe  distance,  he  looked  back  to  see  these 
“nightmarish  beings”  flapping  what  looked  to 
be  wings  and  heading  toward  a  glowing,  dark- 
blue  object  hovering  over  a  field  on  the  other 
side  of  the  road.  The  UFO  looked  like  two 
upside-down  plates  placed  over  each  other. 

When  the  creatures  or  beings  reached  the 
UFO,  they  “were  literally  sucked  into  the  un¬ 
derpart  of  the  machine  as  if  by  a  whirlwind.” 


A  dull  thudding  sound  followed,  and  the 
UFO  streaked  away. 

The  witness  told  Trigano  that  he  had  said 
little  to  others  about  the  experience  for  fear  of 
being  thought  mad. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind;  Moth- 
man 

Further  Reading 

Trigano,  Lyonel,  1968.  “Strange  Encounter  in  Var.” 
Flying  Saucer  Review  14,  6  (November/Decem¬ 
ber):  18. 

Birmingham’s  ark 

A  bizarre  experience  is  recorded  in  a  fifteen- 
page  document  left  by  a  nineteenth-century 
Australian,  Frederick  William  Birmingham, 
who  lived  in  Parramatta,  New  South  Wales. 
Birmingham  was  an  engineer,  surveyor,  and 
alderman  for  the  city,  today  a  suburb  of  Syd¬ 
ney.  His  tale  is  reminiscent  in  some  ways  of 
the  flying-saucer  contactee  tales  that  would 
circulate  decades  later. 

The  document  came  into  the  hands  of  a 
well-known  Australian  ufologist,  Bill  Chalker, 
in  1975.  Investigating  its  background,  he 
traced  it  to  a  teacher  named  Haywood,  who 
lived  at  the  location  where  Birmingham 
(whose  existence  and  occupation  Chalker  was 
able  to  verify)  was  dwelling  when  his  en¬ 
counter  occurred.  Haywood,  apparently,  later 
gave  it  to  another  family,  which  had  had  the 
manuscript  in  its  possession  since  at  least  the 
early  1 940s  and  showed  it  to  Chalker.  Chalker 
could  find  no  evidence  that  it  was  a  recent  lit¬ 
erary  or  historical  hoax. 

Birmingham  wrote  that  on  the  evening  of 
July  25,  1868,  “I  had  a  wonderful  dream,  a  vi¬ 
sion,”  while  standing  under  the  verandah  of 
the  cottage  he  rented.  Looking  up  into  the  sky, 
he  saw  “the  Lord  Bishop  of  Sydneys  head  in 
the  air  looking  intently  upon  me  in  a  frowning 
half  laughing  mood.”  As  it  passed  in  an  east¬ 
erly  direction,  it  faded  out,  then  reappeared 
briefly  twice  more.  “I  retraced  the  course  the 
head  had  taken  and  just  in  the  spot  where  I 
first  saw  the  head  I  saw  an  Ark,’”  he  wrote.  As 
he  stood  and  studied  it,  he  said  aloud  to  him¬ 
self,  “Well,  that  is  a  beautiful  vessel.” 


Blowing  Cave  45 


At  that  moment  he  heard  a  voice  to  his 
right  and  just  a  little  behind  him.  It  said, 
“That’s  a  machine  to  go  through  the  air.”  The 
speaker  was  someone  Birmingham  thought  of 
as  a  “spirit,”  looking  like  a  “neutral  shade  and 
the  shape  of  a  man.”  The  ark  was  brown  in 
color  “with  faint,  flitting  shades  of  steel 
blue  .  .  .  like  .  .  .  magnified  scales  on  a  large 
fish.”  After  a  while  Birmingham  replied  to 
the  spirit.  He  remarked  that  the  ark  looked 
more  like  a  ship  meant  for  sailing  on  water; 
in  any  event,  he  had  never  seen  anything  so 
beautiful. 

He  accepted  an  invitation  to  board  the  ve¬ 
hicle.  He  found  himself  floating  through  the 
air  in  the  spirits  company.  When  they  reached 
the  upper  part  of  the  ark,  they  entered  the 
“pilot  house”  by  walking  down  three  steep 
steps.  Inside  the  barely  furnished  room  was  a 
table  situated  two  feet  from  the  wall.  Some¬ 
thing  like  an  oilskin  covered  the  table.  Birm¬ 
ingham  stood  at  the  rear  end,  and,  not  far 
away,  the  spirit  held  papers  in  its  hand.  One 
paper  was  covered  with  “figures  and  formu¬ 
lae.”  After  Birmingham  asked  if  the  papers 
were  for  him,  the  spirit  replied  slowly  and  em¬ 
phatically,  “It  is  absolutely  necessary  that  you 
should  know  these  things,  but  you  can  study 
them  as  you  go  on.” 

Birmingham,  apparently  not  knowing 
what  to  say,  looked  down  at  his  hands.  When 
he  raised  his  head,  the  spirit  was  gone.  He 
stood  alone  inside  the  strange  ship.  In  his 
manuscript  he  recorded  this  ambiguous  con¬ 
clusion  to  the  encounter;  “So  I  fell,  I  suppose, 
into  my  usual  sleeping  state,  and  waking  next 
morning  deeply  impressed  with  that  vision  of 
the  night.” 

The  following  January,  at  work  on  an  engi¬ 
neering  problem,  Birmingham  was  surprised 
to  see  a  formula  that  he  had  first  seen  on  the 
paper  the  spirit  had  shown  him.  It  had  to  do 
with  centrifugal  pumps. 

One  day  in  1873,  at  sunset,  Birmingham 
saw  three  small  “clouds”  suddenly  appear.  Two 
“screws”  extended  from  one.  Between  them,  a 
shape  “like  two  flat  necks  on  a  turtle-shaped 
body”  came  into  view,  then  disappeared,  only 


to  reappear  soon  afterward.  Finally,  “the  two 
big .  .  .  screws  folded  up  like  the  arms  of  a 
bear  and  lost  their  shape  in  the  middle  cloud” 
(Chalker,  1996). 

The  manuscript  indicates  that  Birmingham 
had  become  obsessed  with  the  ark  and  its  se¬ 
crets.  He  died  in  1893,  however,  without  ever 
being  able  to  unlock  them. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Chalker,  Bill,  1996.  The  Oz  Files:  The  Australian 
UFO  Story.  Potts  Point,  New  South  Wales,  Aus¬ 
tralia:  Duffy  and  Snellgrove. 

- ,  1992.  “UFOs  in  Australia  and  New  Zealand 

through  1959.”  In  Jerome  Clark.  The  Emergence 
of  a  Phenomenon:  UFOs  from  the  Beginning 
Through  1959 — The  UFO  Encyclopedia,  Volume 
Tivo,  333-356.  Detroit,  MI:  Omnigraphics. 


Blowing  Cave 

One  of  the  odder  stories  related  to  hollow 
earth  lore  is  set  in  Blowing  Cave,  near  Cush¬ 
man,  Arkansas,  where  a  man  named  George 
D.  Wight  is  said  to  have  found  a  subterranean 
civilization  and  proven  the  Shaver  Mystery. 
Though  Wight  disappeared,  his  story  survives 
in  a  diary  he  allegedly  wrote. 

In  the  1950s,  Wight  was  a  UFO  buff  from 
Michigan.  Wight  knew  of  Richard  Shaver’s 
claims,  published  in  the  1940s  in  the  Ziff- 
Davis  science-fiction  magazines  Amazing  Sto  - 
ries  and  Fantastic  Adventures,  that  the  rem¬ 
nants  of  two  advanced  races,  tero  and  dero 
(good  and  evil  respectively),  lived  in  vast  cav¬ 
erns  under  Earth’s  surface.  Though  Wight  was 
skeptical  of  these  claims,  he  had  an  interest  in 
cave-exploring  that  he  indulged  with  David 
L.,  for  whose  mimeographed  saucer  newslet¬ 
ter  Wight  contributed  a  regular  column.  They 
did  their  spelunking  with  three  other  men.  All 
of  them  were  acquainted  with  Charles  A. 
Marcoux,  another  columnist  for  the  maga¬ 
zine.  Unlike  the  others,  Marcoux  was  an  ob¬ 
sessed  believer  in  Shaverian  concepts,  to  the 
extent  that  he  gave  occasional  public  lectures 
on  the  subject.  The  spelunkers  sometimes  at¬ 
tended  those  lectures  but  considered  his  be¬ 
liefs  absurd. 


46  Blowing  Cave 


In  1966,  the  group,  now  consisting  of 
twelve  persons,  went  down  to  Arkansas  to  ex¬ 
plore  Blowing  Cave  on  a  week-long  expedi¬ 
tion.  On  their  return,  members  wrote  letters 
to  Ray  Palmer,  once  editor  of  Amazing  Stories 
and  Shaver’s  principal  promoter,  claiming  that 
they  had  encountered  intelligent  beings — 
Shaver’s  teros — deep  inside  the  cavern.  Palmer 
did  not  reply.  Apparently  a  few  months  later, 
Wight  went  back  and  chose  to  stay  with  the 
underearth  people.  He  returned  in  1967  to 
give  a  written  account  to  David  L.,  who  by 
this  time  had  left  the  UFO  field  and  no  longer 
wanted  to  be  publicly  associated  with  it. 
Wight  asked  L.  to  pass  on  the  diary  to  Charles 
Marcoux.  Wight  felt  that  in  ridiculing  his  be¬ 
liefs  he  had  wronged  him  and  wanted  to  pro¬ 
vide  him  with  the  proof  that  Shaver  was  right. 
He  then  returned  to  his  tero  friends  and  has 
not  been  seen  since. 

David  L.,  however,  had  long  since  lost 
track  of  Marcoux,  and  it  was  not  until  thir¬ 
teen  years  later  that  he  came  upon  his  name. 
He  tracked  him  down  and  handed  him  the 
manuscript.  Its  effect  on  Marcoux  was  electri¬ 
fying,  and  it  set  in  motion  the  events  that 
would  eventually  lead  to  his  premature  death. 

The  manuscript  related  that  while  explor¬ 
ing  Blowing  Cave,  the  group  spotted  a  light  at 
the  end  of  a  tunnel.  As  the  spelunkers  ap¬ 
proached  it,  Wight  noticed  a  narrow  crevice, 
just  big  enough  for  him  to  squeeze  inside  it. 
There  he  found  clearly  artificial  steps.  He 
called  to  his  friends,  and  they  climbed 
through  the  opening.  On  the  other  side  of  it, 
the  opening  expanded,  and  they  were  able  to 
walk  upright.  “Suddenly,”  Wight  wrote,  “we 
came  into  a  large  tunnel/corridor,  about 
twenty  feet  wide  and  just  as  high.  All  the  walls 
and  the  floor  were  smooth,  and  the  ceiling 
had  a  curved  dome  shape.  We  know  that  this 
was  not  a  freak  of  nature,  but  manmade.  We 
had  accidentally  stumbled  into  the  secret  cav¬ 
ern  world”  (Toronto,  n.d.). 

Soon  they  encountered  blue-skinned  but 
otherwise  humanlike  individuals.  The  strangers 
said  that  they  had  permitted  the  crew  to  find 
the  tunnel  and  enter  it  because  they  had  instru¬ 


ments  that  measured  people’s  emotions;  the  ex¬ 
plorers  were  determined  to  have  good  inten¬ 
tions.  They  learned  that  the  tunnels  went  on 
for  hundreds  of  miles  and  led  to  underearth 
cities  populated  by  entities  that  included  ser¬ 
pentlike  creatures  and  Sasquatchlike  hairy 
bipeds.  Soon  after  their  initial  conversation, 
Wight  and  his  companions  were  taken  to  a 
kind  of  elevator  that  led  them  to  the  under- 
earthers’  place  of  residence,  a  city  made  of  glass. 
It  turned  out  that  their  guides  were  Noah’s  di¬ 
rect  descendants,  who  had  found  their  way  un¬ 
derground  in  the  wake  of  the  flood.  There  they 
found  supertechnology  and  the  remains  of  an 
advanced  civilization,  along  with  teros.  Appar¬ 
ently  at  some  point,  Wight’s  group  met  the 
teros  who  had  been  there  all  along. 

This  was  not  the  only  trip  the  group  took 
to  Blowing  Cave.  Unable  to  get  anybody  on 
the  surface  to  believe  their  story,  Wight  and 
his  friends  vowed  to  return  with  conclusive 
proof.  During  one  expedition,  they  captured  a 
giant  cave  moth,  preserved  it  in  a  bag,  and 
brought  it  up  with  them.  When  they  opened 
the  bag,  however,  the  sunlight  disintegrated 
the  insect  into  a  fine  dust. 

Not  long  afterward,  Wight  decided  to  stay 
with  the  underearth  people.  According  to  one 
source,  “all  evidence  of  [his]  ever  existing 
began  to  mysteriously  disappear  from  the  sur¬ 
face.  Birth  certificates,  school  records,  com¬ 
puter  records,  bank  records,  etc.,  all  seemed  to 
vanish,  apparently  the  work  of  someone  in  a 
very  influential  position”  (Untitled,  n.d.). 
Other  members  of  the  group  made  another 
trip  into  the  cave,  where  they  saw  their  friend 
for  the  last  time.  Wight  returned  once  to  the 
surface  to  meet  David  L. 

In  1980,  Marcoux  saw  the  manuscript  and 
read  Wight’s  words  addressed  to  him:  “Yes, 
Charles,  all  that  you  told  us  is  true.  ...  I  owe 
you  a  debt  of  gratitude,  because  the  Teros 
healed  my  crippled  leg,  instantly.  I  am  grateful 
for  more  than  just  that,  and  I  have  left  these 
notes  and  somewhere  a  map  so  that  you,  too, 
can  .  .  .  visit  with  these  people.  .  .  .  Maybe  we 
will  meet  here  some  day”  (Toronto,  n.d.). 
Marcoux  set  about  organizing  an  expedition, 


Boys  from  Topside  4 7 


soliciting  members  in  such  small-circulation 
hollow-earth  publications  as  Shavertron  and 
The  Hollow  Hassle. 

Marcoux  and  his  wife  moved  to  Cushman 
in  1983.  There,  in  November,  as  he  was  visit¬ 
ing  the  land  around  the  cave,  a  swarm  of  bees 
descended  on  him.  The  resulting  shock  and 
trauma  precipitated  a  heart  attack,  and  he 
died  on  the  spot. 

Some  hollow-earth  enthusiasts  speculated 
that  sinister  forces  that  wanted  to  keep  the 
caves  a  secret  had  caused  the  attack.  Others 
saw  it  as  just  a  tragic  accident.  In  any  case, 
Marcoux’s  death  ended  efforts  to  explore 
Blowing  Cave  in  search  of  underearthers. 

See  Also:  Hollow  earth;  Shaver  mystery 

Further  Reading 

Toronto,  Richard,  n.d.  “The  Shaver  Mystery.”  http:// 
www.parascope.com/ nb/ articles/ shaver/Mystery. 
htm. 

Untitled,  n.d.  http://www.rcbbs.com/docs/empire7. 
txt. 

Bonnie 

In  1977,  William  Hamilton,  a  California  man 
interested  in  UFOs,  met  “a  young,  very  pretty 
blond  girl  with  almond-shaped  eyes  and  per¬ 
fect  small  teeth.”  Bonnie,  whom  Hamilton 
judged  sincere  and  sane,  told  him  she  was 
born  in  1951  in  the  Lemurian  city  ofTelos, 
located  inside  an  artificial  domelike  cavern  a 
mile  beneath  Mount  Shasta  on  California’s 
northern  border. 

Bonnie  told  him  that  she,  her  parents,  her 
two  sisters,  and  her  two  cousins  move  freely 
back  and  forth  between  our  society  and  their 
native  city.  They  also  travel  to  other  subter¬ 
ranean  Lemurian  and  Atlantean  cities,  via  a 
tube  transit  train  system  that  travels  as  fast  as 
2,500  miles  per  hour.  The  Lemurians  are  also 
able  to  fly  into  outer  space  in  saucerlike  vehi¬ 
cles,  and  they  interact  with  visiting  extrater¬ 
restrials.  Telos  has  a  population  of  one  and  a 
half  million  who  live  a  communal  existence 
without  money.  She  warned  Hamilton  that  by 
the  end  of  the  century,  Earths  axis  will  shift. 
The  result  will  be  massive  devastation  and 
huge  loss  of  life.  On  the  other  side  of  this  ter¬ 


rible  event,  human  beings  would  come 
together  as  one  and  fashion  a  utopian  society 
“on  a  higher  plane  of  vibrations”  (Beckley, 
1993). 

In  Bonnie’s  account  the  Lemurians  came  to 
Earth  two  hundred  thousand  years  ago  from 
the  planet  Aurora.  Atlantis  (in  the  Atlantic) 
and  Lemuria  (in  the  Pacific)  fought  a  war 
against  each  other  twenty-five  thousand  years 
ago,  but  it  was  a  natural  catastrophe  that 
brought  Lemuria  to  the  ocean  bottom  ten 
thousand  years  later.  Atlantis  was  destroyed  a 
few  centuries  later  when  Atlantean  scientists 
conducted  irresponsible  experiments  with 
cosmic,  energy-generating  “fire  crystals.” 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Lemuria;  Mount  Shasta 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  ed.,  1993.  The  Smoky  God 
and  Other  Inner  Earth  Mysteries.  New  Brunswick, 
NJ:  Inner  Light  Publications. 


Boys  from  Topside 

Wilbert  B.  Smith  (1910—1962),  an  engineer 
who  worked  for  Canada’s  Department  of 
Transport  (DOT),  believed  himself  to  be  in 
contact  with  philosophically  and  scientifically 
inclined  extraterrestrials.  He  called  them  the 
“Boys  from  Topside.” 

It  is  unclear  when  these  psychic  messages 
began,  but  it  could  have  been  as  early  as  1950. 
Smith  was  at  first  circumspect  about  them, 
though  he  was  willing  to  acknowledge  an  in¬ 
terest  in  UFO  investigation.  In  late  1950,  he 
secured  access  to  use  DOT  laboratory  and 
field  facilities  during  off-hours  in  an  effort  to 
gather  technical  data  about  UFO  sightings. 
(According  to  one  source,  Smith  was  acting 
under  the  guidance  of  space  people  all  the 
while,  though  he  said  nothing  about  them  to 
his  superiors.)  Smith  hoped  for  a  break¬ 
through  sufficient  to  overthrow  conventional 
technology  and  put  in  its  place  a  wholly  new 
one.  He  called  his  work  “Project  Magnet,”  re¬ 
flecting  his  conviction  that  flying  saucers  flew 
along  magnetic  fields.  In  1952  Smith  partici¬ 
pated  in  a  small  UFO  study  group  put 
together  by  the  Canadian  government’s  De- 


48  Brodies  deros 


fense  Research  Board.  The  following  year, 
Smith  released  Project  Magnet’s  findings, 
which  were — perhaps  not  surprisingly — that 
UFOs  performed  in  ways  that  are  “difficult  to 
reconcile  .  .  .  with  the  capabilities  of  our  tech¬ 
nology”;  thus,  “we  are  forced  to  the  conclu¬ 
sion  that  the  vehicles  are  probably  extra-ter¬ 
restrial”  (Smith,  1953). 

He  urged  his  superiors  to  set  up  a  monitor¬ 
ing  station  that  would  check  for  UFO  activity 
over  a  twenty-four-hour  period.  They  agreed 
to  the  proposal  and  provided  a  DOT-owned 
hut  on  Shirley’s  Bay,  some  ten  miles  west  of 
Ottawa.  The  installation  contained  an  ionos¬ 
pheric  reactor,  an  electronic  sound-measure¬ 
ment  device,  a  gamma-ray  detector,  a 
gravimeter,  a  magnetometer,  and  a  radio.  If  a 
passing  UFO  set  off  any  of  these,  an  alarm 
would  sound.  Two  government  scientists  and 
two  civilian  astronomers  worked  with  Smith. 
This  work  was  done  on  their  own  time,  but 
the  “flying  saucer  observatory”  garnered  much 
embarrassing  publicity  for  the  Canadian  gov¬ 
ernment.  It  was  closed  at  the  end  of  August 
1954.  Even  so,  Smith  was  privately  assured 
that  he  could  continue  UFO  research  so  long 
as  it  was  not  at  the  taxpayer’s  expense;  he  was 
also  welcome  to  use  government  equipment. 

Because  of  his  credentials  and  his  employer, 
conservative  ufologists  who  otherwise  avoided 
persons  associated  with  contact  claims  wel¬ 
comed  Smith  into  their  ranks,  ignoring,  as 
much  as  possible,  his  private  assertions  about 
the  Boys  from  Topside.  Through  his  own  and 
others’  psychic  contacts,  he  conversed  with  ex¬ 
traterrestrials  and  attempted  to  learn  from 
them.  In  a  letter  to  the  prominent  (and  out¬ 
spokenly  anticontactee)  ufologist  Donald  E. 
Keyhoe  on  December  11,  1955,  Smith  wrote, 
“I  have  learned  a  great  deal,  but  I  am  a  small 
child  attempting  to  assimilate  a  college 
course.  Believe  me,  I  have  been  shown 
glimpses  of  a  philosophy  and  technology  al¬ 
most  beyond  comprehension.” 

By  now,  Smith  had  largely  abandoned 
more  conventional  techniques  of  UFO  inves¬ 
tigating,  and  he  was  entirely  focused  on  con- 
tactees,  whom  he  quizzed  intensely  and  whose 


stories  he  compared  before  deciding  on  their 
validity.  At  least  some  of  them,  he  thought, 
were  telling  the  truth.  He  was  gratified  that 
the  space  people  were  patient  enough  to  put 
up  with  his  methods.  In  an  article  in  En¬ 
gland’s  Flying  Saucer  Review,  after  he  went 
public  with  his  extraterrestrial  connections,  he 
declared,  “I  began  for  the  first  time  in  my  life 
to  realize  the  basic  ‘Oneness’  of  the  Universe 
and  all  that  is  in  it”  (Smith,  1958). 

In  1956,  Smith  formed  the  contactee-ori- 
ented  Ottawa  Flying  Saucer  Club.  When  not 
grilling  contactees  or  taking  direct  messages 
himself,  he  occupied  himself  with  sky  watches 
in  parks  and  rural  areas  with  like-minded 
friends.  He  lectured  and  wrote  about  his  be¬ 
liefs  in  saucer  magazines,  and  he  even  spoke 
openly  with  reporters.  He  died  of  intestinal 
cancer  on  December  27,  1962. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  and  Ottawa  New  Sciences 
Club,  eds.,  n.d.  The  Boys  from  Topside.  New  York: 
UFO  Review. 

Cooper,  Philip,  1959.  “Men  from  Mars  among  Us — 
He’s  Talked  to  Them!”  Ottawa  Citizen  (April  14). 

“Flying  Saucers  Project  Denied,”  1953.  New  York 
Times  (November  14). 

Gross,  Loren  E.,  1982.  UFOs:  A  History — 1950:  Au  - 
gust— December.  Fremont,  CA:  self-published. 

Nixon,  Stuart,  1973.  “W.  B.  Smith — The  Man  be¬ 
hind  Project  Magnet.”  UFO  Quarterly  Review  1, 

1  (January/March):  2-11. 

Smith,  Wilbert  B.,  1953.  Project  Magnet  Report.  Ot¬ 
tawa,  Ontario:  Department  of  Transport. 

- ,  1954.  Project  Magnet,  the  Canadian  Flying 

Saucer  Study.  Ottawa,  Ontario:  self-published. 

- ,  1958.  “The  Philosophy  of  the  Saucers.”  Fly  - 

ing  Saucer  Review  4,  3  (May/June):  10-11. 

Brodies  deros 

In  the  mythology  of  the  Shaver  mystery,  the 
creation  of  Richard  Sharpe  Shaver,  deros  are 
cannibalistic,  sadistic  idiots  who  live  in  caves 
underneath  the  earth.  As  the  degenerated  de¬ 
scendants  of  an  advanced  race  of  extraterres¬ 
trials  that  thousands  of  years  ago  colonized 
our  planet,  they  have  access  to  the  elders’  ad¬ 
vanced  technology.  They  use  it,  however,  for 
destructive  and  even  perverted  purposes  on 


Brodies  deros  49 


each  other  and,  most  of  all,  on  surface  hu¬ 
mans,  whom  they  sometimes  kidnap  for  tor¬ 
ture  and  other  unpleasant  purposes.  The  bulk 
of  the  Shaver  mystery  material  was  published, 
mostly  as  true,  in  two  science-fiction  maga¬ 
zines,  Amazing  Stories  and  Fantastic  Adven  - 
tures,  in  the  mid-  to  late  1940s. 

Few  other  people  claim  to  have  encoun¬ 
tered  deros.  The  late  John  J.  Robinson,  a  New 
Jersey  man  with  a  longstanding  interest  in 
UFOs  and  the  paranormal,  often  told  the 
story  of  Steve  Brodie,  who  had  his  own  horri¬ 
fying,  and  possibly  ultimately  fatal,  dealings 
with  the  deros. 

According  to  Robinson,  in  1944  he  was 
living  on  the  third  floor  of  a  Jersey  City 
house.  Directly  beneath  him  on  the  second 
floor  was  a  reclusive  individual,  Steve  Brodie, 
who  claimed  to  be  an  artist.  Over  time, 
Robinson  won  his  trust,  and  the  two  often 
spoke.  Among  Brodies  quirks  was  his  aver¬ 
sion  to  meat;  and  more  unusual,  as  Robinson 
recalled,  “he  seemed  to  be  afraid  that  some¬ 
one  might  be  attempting  to  sneak  up  behind 
him.”  When  he  walked  on  the  street,  he 
walked  in  the  middle  of  the  street,  appar¬ 
ently  out  of  fear  that  someone  might  jump 
out  of  an  alley  or  a  doorway.  On  several  oc¬ 
casions,  Robinson  watched  Brodie  paint. 
Sometimes  the  artist  would  enter  a  trancelike 
state  and  create  weird,  otherworldly  land¬ 
scapes  that  looked  nothing  like  the  paintings 
he  did  in  ordinary  consciousness.  Asked 
where  these  images  came  from,  Brodie 
replied,  “I  don’t  know.  I  feel  as  if  I  paint 
these  pictures  from  memory.  It’s  like  I  can 
close  my  eyes  and  let  it.” 

Once  Brodie  seemed  startled  when  he  saw 
Robinson  with  an  issue  of  Amazing  Stories  in 
his  coat  pocket.  Robinson,  who  was  closely 
following  the  Shaver  mystery  tales  the  maga¬ 
zine  was  running,  launched  into  an  explana¬ 
tion  of  Shaver’s  claims.  When  he  heard  the 
word  “dero,”  Brodie  blanched.  “Fie  writes  of 
the  dero!”  he  exclaimed.  Robinson  persuaded 
Brodie  to  explain  his  remark.  Reluctantly, 
after  securing  assurances  that  Robinson  would 
not  ridicule  him,  he  related  something  that 


had  happened  to  him  and  a  friend  seven  years 
before. 

The  two  had  gone  to  a  western  state  in 
search  of  semiprecious  stones.  Local  people 
warned  them  to  stay  away  from  a  certain 
desert  mesa  because  several  individuals  who 
had  gone  there  were  never  seen  again.  Disre¬ 
garding  these  words  of  caution,  the  young 
men  repaired  to  the  site  and  spent  the  next 
few  days  energetically  stone-hunting.  Finally, 
one  day,  hearing  his  companion  shout,  Brodie 
looked  up  to  see  a  figure  in  a  black  cowl 
standing  at  the  base  of  the  mesa.  Another  fig¬ 
ure  joined  the  first.  The  first  of  them  pointed 
a  rodlike  device  at  Brodie,  who  abruptly  felt 
himself  paralyzed.  His  friend  began  to  run, 
and  the  other  figure  pointed  a  rod  at  him.  To 
his  horror  the  smell  of  burning  human  flesh 
rose  up  in  Brodies  nostrils.  He  never  saw  his 
friend  again. 

A  third  figure,  holding  what  looked  like 
earphones,  approached  Brodie  and  then 
walked  past  him.  He  felt  something  being 
placed  just  beneath  his  ears  just  before  he  lost 
consciousness.  “At  this  point  in  his  narrative,” 
Robinson  said,  “Steve  showed  me  why  he 
wore  his  hair  long  at  the  back  of  his  head.  Be¬ 
hind  each  ear  at  the  base  of  the  parietal  bones 
of  his  skull  were  bare,  seared,  scarred  patches 
of  skin  upon  which  no  hair  could  grow.  Both 
of  these  areas  behind  the  ears  were  a  little 
smaller  than  the  size  of  a  silver  dollar  and  were 
perfectly  circular.  Steve  said  they  were  the 
marks  of  a  dero  slave!” 

In  the  ordeal  that  followed,  Brodie  was 
only  intermittently  conscious.  On  three  or 
four  occasions,  he  awoke  to  find  himself  in  a 
cage  with  other  human  beings.  They  told  him 
that  he  was  “in  the  caves,”  and  they  were 
under  the  control  of  the  “deros,”  who  could 
snatch  any  human  being  off  the  face  of  the 
earth  if  they  so  chose.  Each  time  it  became  ev¬ 
ident  that  he  was  conscious,  a  black-cowled 
figure  would  zap  him  back  into  oblivion. 

Then  one  day  he  found  himself  walking 
down  a  street  in  New  York  City  with  no  idea 
how  he  had  gotten  there.  He  was  dressed  in 
his  prospecting  clothes.  His  personal  items 


50  Brown’s  Martians 


were  still  in  his  pockets,  including  a  hundred 
dollars  in  bills.  Though  to  his  awareness  only 
a  day  had  passed,  he  soon  learned  that  it  was 
two  years  later. 

Brodie  said  that  ever  since  he  could  not  eat 
meat.  The  very  scent  of  it  nearly  made  him  ill. 

Robinson  had  observed  that  Brodie  was 
not  a  reader,  and  he  was  certain  that  he  had 
not  concocted  a  tale  from  reading  the  Shaver 
series. 

Not  long  afterward,  business  concerns 
forced  Robinson  to  move  from  his  Jersey  City 
apartment.  He  fell  out  of  contact  with  Brodie 
for  six  months.  When  he  came  back  for  a 
visit,  Brodie  was  gone.  Robinson  talked  with  a 
mutual  acquaintance  who  had  his  own  strange 
story.  He  said  he  had  seen  Brodie  on  a  train  in 
Arizona.  When  he  had  spoken  to  Brodie,  he 
had  not  responded  or  even  acknowledged  his 
presence.  He  seemed  to  be  in  a  “stupor,”  the 
man  thought,  though  Robinson  knew  Brodie 
was  not  a  drinker.  The  train  stopped  at  a  small 
town,  and  when  the  train  resumed  its  journey 
Brodie  was  no  longer  on  it.  Robinson  saw  this 
as  evidence  that  the  deros  had  reclaimed  their 
victim. 

After  relating  this  anecdote  on  Long  John 
Nebel’s  popular  radio  talk  show  on  New 
York’s  WOR  one  night  in  March  1957, 
Robinson  went  to  work  the  next  day  and  was 
surprised  when  a  business  associate  confided 
his  own  experience.  He  said  that  maybe 
Brodies  experience  explained  something  that 
had  happened  to  him  in  1942,  when  he  was 
seventeen  years  old.  He  had  been  visiting  his 
friend  Fred  when  they  decided  to  go  to  a 
“haunted  mine”  nearby.  Supposedly,  it  had  a 
long  history  of  accidents,  disasters,  and  unex¬ 
plained  disappearances  of  miners.  Undeterred, 
the  two  climbed  over  a  pile  of  debris  to  get  to 
one  side  of  the  entrance.  There  they  were 
shocked  to  observe  a  grotesque  entity,  four 
and  a  half  feet  tall,  with  a  bulky  body.  It  let 
out  a  soul-chilling  scream  and  chased  the  boys 
back  to  town.  They  took  refuge  in  a  movie 
theater.  Even  so,  they  swore  they  could  see 
dark  forms  moving  up  and  down  the  aisles  as 
if  looking  for  them.  That  night  they  thought 


they  saw  the  figure  sitting  in  a  tree  near  the 
house. 

Later,  Fred  vanished  without  a  trace. 
Searchers  came  upon  his  bicycle  near  the 
haunted  mine,  and  nothing  further  was 
learned  of  his  fate.  “To  this  day,”  the  man  told 
Robinson,  “I  am  afraid  that  whoever  or  what¬ 
ever  it  was  that  got  Fred  will  find  me.” 

See  Also:  Shaver  mystery 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  and  Joan  Whritenour,  1968.  New 
UFO  Breakthrough.  New  York:  Award  Books. 


Brown’s  Martians 

Clairvoyant  Courtney  Brown  reports  that  his 
psychic  probing  of  Mars  has  uncovered  the 
startling  truth  that  Mars  was,  and  is,  inhab¬ 
ited.  Brown  came  to  this  conclusion  while 
using  psychic  talents  to  explore  the  Cydonia 
region  of  the  planet’s  surface,  where  some  have 
felt  that  enigmatic  artifacts,  including  the  so- 
called  Martian  Face — an  alleged  structure  said 
to  depict  human  features — are  situated. 

The  Martians  now  live  underground.  Mil¬ 
lions  of  years  ago,  they  lived  on  the  surface 
but  were  nearly  driven  to  extinction  when  an 
immense  asteroid  passed  through  the  atmos¬ 
phere  and  severely  damaged  it.  The  atmos¬ 
phere  continued  to  deteriorate  until  what  lit¬ 
tle  was  left  of  it  was  sucked  into  space.  Many 
Martians  died,  but  their  race  was  preserved 
when  Grays — the  gray-skinned  humanoid 
reported  in  UFO  abduction  cases — inter¬ 
vened.  They  collected  the  Martian  DNA  and 
stored  it  and  genetically  altered  the  surviving 
inhabitants  of  the  Red  Planet.  They  put 
them  into  underground  cities,  where  they 
live  now. 

The  Martians’  problems  are  far  from  over, 
however.  The  genetic  alterations  have  not  en¬ 
tirely  worked,  and  their  own  technology  has 
not  been  able  to  overcome  the  existing  short¬ 
comings.  More  and  more  Martians  are  look¬ 
ing  to  Earth  as  their  potential  home.  Accord¬ 
ing  to  Brown,  the  Martians  are  much  like 
human  beings  in  appearance  but  different 
enough  so  that  humans  and  Martians  would 


Bucky  5 1 


never  be  confused.  They  have  light  skin,  eyes 
bigger  than  humans’  and  no  hair. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Allingham’s  Mart¬ 
ian;  Aurora  Martian;  Dentons’s  Martians  and 
Venusians;  Hopkins’s  Martians;  Khauga;  Martian 
bees;  Mince-Pie  Martians;  Monka;  Shaw’s  Mar¬ 
tians;  Smead’s  Martians;  Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Brown,  Courtney,  1996.  Cosmic  Voyage:  Scientific  Re  - 
mote  Viewing,  Extraterrestrials,  and  a  Message  for 
Mankind.  New  York:  Dutton  Books. 


Bucky 

Buck  Nelson,  a  sixty-five-year-old  bachelor 
who  lived  on  a  remote  farm  in  the  Ozark 
Mountains  of  Missouri,  met  Bucky  of  Venus 
on  March  5,  1955.  But  his  first  sighting  of 
spaceships  took  place  when  three  of  them 
hovered  over  his  farm  on  July  3,  1954,  and 
one  shot  a  beam  of  light  at  him,  healing  his 
lumbago  and  restoring  his  eyesight  to  the  de¬ 
gree  that  he  no  longer  needed  glasses.  The  fol¬ 
lowing  year  on  February  1,  a  saucer  returned. 
This  time  a  voice,  speaking  in  clear  English, 
came  through  a  loudspeaker  to  ask  if  Nelson 
were  friendly.  The  voice  went  on  to  explain 
that  the  saucer’s  crew  was  from  Venus.  Nelson 
glimpsed  three  human-looking,  muscular 
men  inside  the  craft.  Around  midnight  on 
March  5,  the  three  men,  with  their  dog,  385- 
pound  Big  Bo,  entered  Nelson’s  house  and 
conversed  with  him.  All  three  men  were  nude, 
carrying  their  clothes  on  their  shoulders;  be¬ 
fore  putting  their  uniforms  back  on,  they  ex¬ 
plained  that  they  wanted  to  assure  Nelson 
that  except  for  their  place  of  origin  they  were 
normal  men.  One  of  them  said  his  name  was 
Bucky. 

Bucky — sometimes  referred  to  in  subse¬ 
quent  accounts  as  “Little  Bucky”  to  distin¬ 
guish  him  from  the  much  older  Buck — said 
he  had  been  born  nineteen  years  earlier  on  a 
Colorado  farm.  In  1940,  a  Venusian  spaceship 
landed  on  the  family  property,  and  members 
of  the  crew  offered  to  fly  the  whole  family  to 
their  home  planet  for  a  visit.  Only  Bucky, 
then  four  years  old,  wanted  to  go.  The  Venu¬ 
sians  agreed  to  return  one  day  when  he  was 


old  enough  to  make  a  mature  decision  on  the 
matter.  They  came  back  in  1953,  and  Bucky 
accompanied  them  to  Venus,  where  he  had 
resided  for  two  years  before  Buck  Nelson  met 
him.  Besides  Bucky,  Nelson’s  visitors  included 
Bob  Solomon,  a  two-hundred-year-old  Venu¬ 
sian,  and  an  old  man  who,  his  age  notwith¬ 
standing,  was  a  trainee  learning  how  to  fly  a 
spacecraft.  After  an  hour  the  visitors  left,  but 
not  before  telling  Nelson  that  they  would  fly 
him  to  other  planets,  Nelson  wrote  later,  “if  I 
would  tell  about  it  to  the  world”  (Nelson, 
1956). 

Around  midnight  on  April  24,  Bucky  and 
his  friends  arrived  to  take  Nelson  into  space. 
He  and  his  dog,  Teddy,  went  to  Mars.  There 
Nelson  ate  a  delicious  meal  and  talked  with 
the  friendly  human  inhabitants,  and  then  the 
ship  went  on  to  the  Moon  for  another  meal 
and  a  good  rest.  He,  Teddy,  and  Big  Bo  went 
for  a  short  walk  before  embarking  for  Venus. 
During  one  brief  stop  they  saw  the  “ruler”  of 
the  region  engaged  in  painting.  He  was  clad, 
like  Nelson  himself,  in  bib  overalls.  Venus, 
like  Mars  and  the  Moon,  turned  out  to  be  a 
pleasant  place  without  war  or  conflict,  where 
people  lived  in  harmony  under  the  Twelve 
Laws  of  God  (essentially  the  Ten  Command¬ 
ments  and  a  couple  of  verses  from  the  New 
Testament).  On  Venus,  the  races  were  strictly 
segregated.  Nelson  also  was  told  that  his  own 
parents  were  Venusians. 

Bucky  became  a  regular  visitor  at  Nelson’s 
house.  They  spent  Christmas  1956  together. 
On  another  occasion,  he  brought  a  fully 
cooked  Venusian  turkey  with  him.  On  yet  an¬ 
other  Christmas,  Bucky  took  Nelson  to  his 
home  on  Venus. 

In  the  late  1950s  and  early  1960s,  Nelson 
was  a  minor  celebrity  on  the  contactee  scene. 
At  one  point,  he  sold  packets  of  hair  reported 
to  be  from  Big  Bo,  who,  he  said,  had  been  left 
in  his  custody  for  a  time.  New  York  City  radio 
personality  Long  John  Nebel,  who  met  Nel¬ 
son  at  the  Fourth  Interplanetary  Spacecraft 
Convention  at  Giant  Rock,  California,  in 
1957,  said:  “It  is  my  impression  that  Buck 
Nelson  has  made  very  little  money  out  of  his 


52  Buff  Ledge  abduction 


wild,  if  somewhat  crude,  stories,  but  there  are 
those  who  believe  in  him,  many  for  just  that 
reason.  Frankly,  I  suspect  that  he  would 
change  this  aspect  of  his  activities  if  he  could” 
(Nebel,  1961). 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Dean,  John  W.,  1964.  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Scrip  - 
tures.  New  York:  Vantage  Press. 

Nebel,  Long  John,  1961.  The  Way  OutWorld.  Engle¬ 
wood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Nelson,  Buck,  1956.  My  Trip  to  Mars,  the  Moon,  and 
Venus.  Mountain  View,  MO:  self-published. 

- ,  1955.  “A  Strange  Tale  from  Missouri.”  Fly  - 

ing  Saucer  Review  1,  2  (May/June):  4-5. 


Buff  Ledge  abduction 

The  UFO  abduction  that  reportedly  oc¬ 
curred  at  Buff  Ledge,  north  of  Burlington, 
Vermont,  is  unusual  in  that  it  involved  two 
persons  who,  though  separated  by  years  and 
distance,  provided  strikingly  similar  accounts 
to  an  investigator. 

The  incident  took  place  at  Buff  Ledge 
Camp,  a  since-closed  girls’  camp.  The  two 
witnesses  have  never  been  publicly  identified, 
but  astronomer  and  ufologist  Walter  N. 
Webb,  who  spent  years  probing  the  episode, 
gives  them  the  pseudonyms  Michael  Lapp 
and  Janet  Cornell.  On  the  evening  of  August 
7,  1968,  Lapp  and  Cornell,  who  worked  as 
counselors,  were  relaxing  on  an  L-shaped 
dock  that  jutted  one  hundred  feet  out  into 
Lake  Champlain  and  which  was  largely  con¬ 
cealed  by  the  bluff  from  the  view  of  others. 
The  camp  was  nearly  deserted;  most  campers 
and  counselors  were  off  on  a  trip  elsewhere. 

Lapp  and  Cornell  witnessed  the  approach 
of  a  bright  light  that  soon  resolved  into  a 
white,  glowing,  cigar-shaped  object.  Soon 
three  smaller  white  lights  emerged  from  the 
bottom  right  side.  As  the  last  light  came  into 
view,  the  cigar-shaped  object  sailed  away.  The 
small  UFOs  executed  various  maneuvers 
through  the  sky,  moving  close  enough  so  that 
the  observers  could  see  that  they  were  domed 
and  disc-shaped.  After  five  minutes,  two  of 


them  departed  in  opposite  directions,  to  the 
north  and  south,  emitting  sounds  like  “thou¬ 
sands  of  tuning  forks,”  as  Lapp  would  put  it. 
The  remaining  UFO  flew  toward  them,  and 
now  it  looked  the  size  of  a  small  house. 
Abruptly  it  streaked  upward,  vanished,  then 
reappeared  to  plummet  into  the  water  about  a 
mile  away. 

Soon  the  UFO  came  back  to  the  surface 
and  flew,  at  an  altitude  of  fifteen  feet  above 
the  water,  toward  the  witnesses  again.  It 
stopped  some  sixty  feet  from  them,  and  now 
it  was  so  near  that  Lapp  could  see  right  into 
its  transparent  dome,  where  he  was  shocked 
to  observe  two  large-headed  figures,  short  in 
stature  with  big  eyes  and  small  mouths,  who 
were  clad  in  gray  or  silver  uniforms. 

Turning  to  his  companion,  Lapp  saw  a 
woman  in  an  apparent  trance.  She  did  not  act 
as  if  she  had  heard  him  when  he  spoke  to  her. 
At  that  point  Lapp  decided  to  try  an  experi¬ 
ment,  and  he  addressed  the  entities.  Who 
were  they,  he  asked,  and  why  were  they  here? 
To  his  surprise  a  voice  with  a  “feminine  qual¬ 
ity”  spoke  inside  his  head  to  assure  him  they 
meant  no  harm.  Over  the  next  few  minutes, 
as  Lapp  spoke  his  questions  aloud,  and  the 
alien  woman  replied  telepathically,  he  was 
told  that  the  aliens  had  “returned  after  the 
first  atomic  bomb  exploded”  and  that  they 
were  seeking  some  form  of  energy  about 
which  the  voice  provided  no  details.  They 
were  also  engaged  in  war  with  others  of  their 
race,  characterizing  these  enemies  as  “evil.” 
When  Lapp  asked  where  they  came  from,  he 
heard  a  name  he  could  not  pronounce  or  sub¬ 
sequently  remember. 

Finally,  with  the  two  beings  disappearing 
below  the  deck,  the  UFO  positioned  itself  ten 
feet  above  the  witnesses’  heads.  A  beam  shone 
down  on  them,  a  kind  of  “liquid  light”  that 
felt  weirdly  as  if  it  were  shining  inside  Lapp’s 
head.  Fie  and  Cornell  fell  down  on  the  deck 
as  voices  and  machine  sounds  echoed. 

The  next  thing  they  knew,  it  was  dark. 
They  were  lying  on  the  deck  as  two  girls  atop 
the  bluff  were  shouting  about  a  UFO.  The 


Bunians  53 


object  was  ascending  and  shooting  beams  of 
light  toward  the  girls. 

The  following  evening  Lapp  drove  home  to 
tell  his  parents,  who  responded  with  skepti¬ 
cism,  about  his  sighting.  He  also  informed  his 
girlfriend,  who  was  similarly  unreceptive.  He 
did  not  discuss  the  incident  with  Cornell  and 
soon  lost  contact  with  her.  In  the  years  ahead, 
he  had  dreams  about  being  onboard  the  UFO 
and  developed  an  interest  in  mysticism  and 
religion.  In  1978  he  discussed  his  experience 
with  Webb,  then  an  astronomer  employed  by 
Boston’s  Hayden  Planetarium. 

Subsequently,  Webb  traced  Cornell  to  At¬ 
lanta.  She  confirmed  the  sighting  though  all 
she  could  recall  of  it  was  that  a  “big  light”  had 
approached  them,  they  had  fallen  down,  and 
some  sort  of  mental  block  had  ensued.  Webb 
had  refrained  from  sharing  the  details  Lapp 
provided  him;  still,  Cornells  account  matched 
Lapp’s  to  the  extent  that  her  memory  allowed. 

Separately  placed  under  hypnosis,  the  two 
recounted  an  abduction  experience.  Lapp 
“remembered”  standing  on  the  deck  with 
one  of  the  humanoids  looking  into  space  and 
observing  Earth,  Moon,  stars,  and  the  cigar¬ 
shaped  craft.  Cornell  was  stretched  on  a  table 
in  the  lower  level  as  two  aliens  conducted 
what  seemed  to  be  a  physical  examination  on 
her.  Lapp  was  put  on  a  table  next  to  hers  and 
lost  consciousness.  On  recovering,  he  found 
that  the  ship  had  entered  a  hangar  that  was 
inside  yet  a  larger  one.  He  and  an  alien  com¬ 
panion  sailed  on  a  beam  of  light  through  a 
wall.  An  elevator  took  them  to  an  enormous 
domed  room  occupied  by  many  humanoids, 
who  were  watching  something  out  of  Lapp’s 
line  of  vision.  Taken  into  another  room,  he 
had  a  vision  of  an  unknown  landscape  occu¬ 
pied  by  distraught,  weeping  human  beings. 
He  passed  out.  When  he  awoke,  he  seemed 
to  be  falling  through  space,  while  a  globe  full 
of  television  screens  with  his  picture  on  each 
appeared  in  front  of  him.  He  stepped 
through  one  of  the  screens,  and  on  the  other 
side  of  it,  he  and  Cornell  were  back  on  the 
dock. 


Cornell’s  story  was  less  detailed  than 
Lapp’s.  She  remembered  being  suddenly 
aboard  the  UFO  and  described  the  entities 
nearly  exactly  as  her  companion  had.  Her  “re¬ 
call”  of  the  vehicle’s  interior  matched  Lapp’s. 

Webb  devoted  five  years  to  the  investiga¬ 
tion  in  an  effort  to  substantiate  anything  that 
could  be  substantiated.  To  his  disappoint¬ 
ment,  he  found  no  one,  who  had  been  at  the 
camp  in  August  1968,  who  could  corroborate 
the  UFO  sighting.  Background  checks  and 
psychological  tests  attested  to  Lapp’s  and  Cor¬ 
nell’s  sincerity  and  honesty. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs 

Further  Reading 

Webb,  Walter  N.,  1994.  Encounter  at  Buff  Ledge:  A 
UFO  Case  History.  Chicago:  J.  Allen  Hynek  Cen¬ 
ter  for  UFO  Studies. 


Bunians 

Ahmad  Jamaludin,  a  ufologist  and  veterinary 
surgeon  who  lives  in  Malaysia,  says  that  noth¬ 
ing  precisely  like  the  abduction  phenomenon 
known  to  his  Western  colleagues  seems  to  be 
occurring  in  his  country,  but  there  are  tradi¬ 
tions  of  kidnappings  by  what  are  called  the 
“Bunian  people.”  The  Bunians  are  the 
Malaysian  version  of  fairies.  Like  fairies  else¬ 
where,  the  Bunians  exist  not  only  in  oral  tra¬ 
dition,  but  also  in  what  are  alleged  to  be  ac¬ 
tual  experiences. 

One  such  incident  is  said  to  have  taken 
place  in  June  1982.  A  twelve-year-old  girl, 
Maswati  Pilus,  had  gone  one  morning  to  the 
river  behind  her  house,  intending  to  wash 
clothes  there.  She  encountered  a  small  female 
being  whose  sudden  appearance  had  a  strange 
effect  on  the  girl’s  consciousness.  She  felt  as  if 
only  she  and  the  being  existed.  There  were  no 
other  sounds  or  sights.  The  being  offered  to 
take  her  to  another  land,  and  Maswati,  who 
felt  no  fear,  found  herself  looking  at  a  bright, 
beautiful  landscape.  She  sensed  that  time  was 
passing,  but  the  events  that  occurred  during 
her  experience  were  blurred  and  vague  in  her 
memory. 


54  Bunians 


Meanwhile,  her  relatives  were  looking  fran¬ 
tically  for  her.  Two  days  later,  they  came  upon 
her  in  a  location  near  her  house  where  they 
had  already  searched  more  than  once.  She  was 
unconscious  but  soon  recovered. 


See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Fairies  encountered 

Further  Reading 

Randles,  Jenny,  1988.  Abduction:  Over  200  Docu  - 
mented  UFO  Kidnappings  Investigated.  London: 
Robert  Flale. 


Calf-rustling  aliens 

On  April  23,  1897,  a  Kansas  newspaper,  the 
Yates  Center  Farmers  Advocate,  printed  an  affi¬ 
davit  attesting  to  an  instance  of  interplanetary 
calf-rustling.  There  were  three  witnesses,  the 
most  prominent  of  whom  was  Alex  Hamil¬ 
ton,  a  rancher  from  LeRoy,  who  soberly  re¬ 
lated  the  following: 

We  were  awakened  by  a  noise  among  the 
cattle.  .  .  .  Upon  going  to  the  door  I  saw  to  my 
utter  amazement  that  an  airship  was  slowly  de¬ 
scending  upon  my  cow  lot  about  forty  rods  [six 
hundred  feet]  from  the  house.  Calling  my  ten¬ 
ant,  Gid  Heslip,  and  my  son  Wall,  we  seized 
some  axes  and  ran  to  the  corral.  Meanwhile  the 
ship  had  been  gently  descending  until  it  was 
not  more  than  thirty  feet  above  the  ground  and 
we  came  within  fifty  yards  of  it.  It  consisted  of  a 
great  cigar-shaped  portion,  possibly  three  hun¬ 
dred  feet  long,  with  a  carriage  underneath.  The 
carriage  was  made  of  glass  or  some  other  trans¬ 
parent  material.  It  was  brightly  lighted  within 
and  everything  was  plainly  visible — it  was  occu¬ 
pied  by  some  of  the  strangest  beings  I  ever  saw. 
There  were  two  men,  a  woman,  and  three  chil¬ 
dren.  They  were  jabbering  together  but  we 
could  not  understand  a  syllable  they  said. 

The  occupants  suddenly  turned  a  search¬ 
light  on  the  trio,  and  the  ship  got  closer  to 


them.  The  witnesses  then  noticed  a  calf 
caught  in  the  fence,  with  “a  cable  .  .  .  fastened 
in  a  slip  knot  around  her  neck  one  end  pass¬ 
ing  up  to  the  vessel  and  tangled  in  wire.”  They 
tried  to  cut  the  cable,  but  when  they  failed, 
they  watched  as  it  and  the  ship  sailed  away. 
The  following  day  a  neighbor  found  the  calf’s 
butchered  remains  in  a  field  where  there  was, 
Hamilton  said,  no  “track  of  any  kind  on  the 
soft  ground.” 

Appended  to  the  published  account  was  a 
statement  by  some  of  the  county’s  leading  cit¬ 
izens  who  attested  to  Hamilton’s  truthfulness 
and  good  character.  The  story  was  published 
during  a  nationwide  wave  of  sightings  of  mys¬ 
terious  “airships”  (UFOs).  Some  newspapers 
had  speculated,  seriously  or  otherwise,  that 
extraterrestrial  visitors  were  flying  the  ships. 
When  Hamilton’s  story  was  rediscovered 
decades  later,  after  UFOs  had  entered  popular 
consciousness,  it  was  widely  published  in  the 
UFO  literature,  which  cited  it  as  an  example 
of  an  early  close  encounter  of  the  third  kind. 

In  1976,  however,  writer  Jerome  Clark  col¬ 
lected  testimony  from  an  elderly  woman  who 
had  known  the  Hamilton  family.  She  recalled 
hearing  the  elder  Hamilton  tell  his  wife  that 
he  and  his  friends  from  a  local  liars’  club,  one 
of  them  the  newspaper  editor,  had  made  up 
the  story.  Several  years  later  UFO  historian 


55 


An  example  of  cattle  mutilation  at  Morrill  Farm,  Piermont,  New  Hampshire,  September  27,  1978  (Loren 
Coleman/Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Thomas  E.  Bullard  came  upon  a  letter  Hamil¬ 
ton  had  written  to  a  Missouri  paper,  the 
Atchison  County  Mail  (May  7,  1897),  cheer¬ 
fully  confessing  that  there  was  no  truth  to  the 
story. 

Many  years  later,  psychologist  Susan  Marie 
Powers  studied  the  claims  of  a  woman  who 
claimed  to  have  been  abducted  by  extraterres¬ 
trials  on  a  number  of  occasions.  Once,  while 
aboard  a  UFO,  the  occupants  would  lasso  a 
cow,  take  it  inside  the  craft,  and  extract  blood 
from  it.  “I  watched  [as]  the  blood  went  into  a 
tube  and  then  into  a  big  tank,”  the  woman  re¬ 
ported.  “The  cow’s  eyes  would  glaze  over. 
Then  I  knew  she  was  dead.  We  would  fly  back 
and  drop  her  in  the  pasture  with  the  other 
cows.  The  little  people  do  not  eat  meat.  They 
take  the  blood  home  with  them”  (Powers, 
1994). 

Another  abductee,  a  Texas  woman  named 
Judy  Doraty,  related  under  hypnosis  her  al¬ 
leged  observation  of  a  levitation  of  a  calf  into 
a  UFO  one  night  in  1973.  The  gray-skinned 
humanoid  crew  cut  up  the  animal  while  still 


alive,  apparently  as  part  of  its  study  of  the  ef¬ 
fects  of  pollution  on  earthly  creatures.  Myrna 
Hansen  told  a  similar  story  under  hypnosis,  of 
an  abduction  in  New  Mexico  in  1980,  during 
which  a  calf  was  brought  into  a  UFO  and  mu¬ 
tilated  while  still  alive. 

According  to  ufologist  Linda  Moulton 
Howe,  a  rancher  near  Waco,  Texas,  came 
upon  two  greenish  humanoids  with  almond 
eyes  and  big,  egg-shaped  heads  as  they  were 
carting  away  one  of  his  calves.  Terrified,  he 
fled  the  scene.  When  he  had  recovered  his 
nerve  a  couple  of  days  later,  he,  his  wife,  and 
his  son  went  to  the  scene.  There  they  found, 
in  Howe’s  words,  “the  calf’s  hide  pulled  back 
over  the  skull  and  folded  inside  out  on  the 
ground.  .  .  .  About  a  foot  from  the  empty 
hide  was  a  complete  calf  backbone  without 
ribs”  (Howe,  1989). 

In  July  1983,  Ron  and  Paula  Watson,  a 
Missouri  farm  couple,  spotted  a  landed  UFO 
in  a  pasture.  A  bipedal  “lizard-type  crea¬ 
ture” — known  to  ufologists  as  a  reptoid — 
stood  nearby.  Through  binoculars  the  Wat- 


Captive  extraterrestrials  57 


sons  watched  as  two  other  beings,  white¬ 
skinned  humanoids  in  silver  suits,  ran  their 
fingers  over  a  black  cow,  which,  though  alive, 
was  immobile  as  if  paralyzed.  Suddenly  the 
cow  floated  up  the  ramp  into  the  UFO,  which 
then,  weirdly,  seemed  to  fade  into  the  hill, 
along  with  the  three  aliens. 

See  Also:  Aurora  Martian;  Close  encounters  of  the 
third  kind;  Hopkins’s  Martians;  Michigan  giant; 
Reptoids;  Shaw’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  ed.,  1982.  The  Airship  File:  A 
Collection  of  Texts  Concerning  Phantom  Airships 
and  Other  UFOs,  Gathered  from  Neivspapers  and 
Periodicals  Mostly  during  the  Flundred  Years  Prior 
to  Kenneth  Arnold’s  Sighting.  Bloomington,  IN: 
self-published. 

Clark,  Jerome,  1977.  “The  Great  Airship  Hoax.” 
Fate  30,  2  (February):  94-97. 

Howe,  Linda  Moulton,  1989.  An  Alien  Harvest:  Fur  - 
ther  Evidence  Linking  Animal  Mutilations  and 
Human  Abductions  to  Alien  Life  Forms.  Littleton, 
CO:  Linda  Moulton  Howe  Publications. 

Powers,  Susan  Marie,  1994.  “Thematic  Content 
Analyses  of  the  Reports  of  UFO  Abductees  and 
Close  Encounter  Witnesses:  Indications  of  Re¬ 
pressed  Sexual  Abus e.”  Journal  of  UFO  Studies  5 
(n.s.):  35-54. 


Captive  extraterrestrials 

Along  with  rumors  of  dead  extraterrestrials 
supposedly  found  in  or  near  crashed  space¬ 
craft,  there  is  a  persistent  lore  of  aliens  who 
are  held  in  captivity. 

Ufologist  William  L.  Moore  claims  to  have 
heard  one  such  account  from  anonymous  mil¬ 
itary  and  official  sources  said  to  be  privy  to 
highly  classified  UFO  secrets.  In  1949,  the 
sources  asserted,  a  male  humanoid  was  discov¬ 
ered  alive  in  the  southwestern  desert,  the  sur¬ 
vivor  of  the  crash  of  an  extraterrestrial  space¬ 
craft.  Authorities  housed  the  being,  called 
EBE  (ee-buh,  after  extraterrestrial  biological 
entity),  at  the  atomic  installation  at  Los 
Alamos,  New  Mexico.  An  air  force  captain 
was  assigned  the  job  of  watching  over  the 
being.  Communication  with  the  alien  proved 
impossible  until  a  speech  device  was  invented 
and  implanted  into  his  throat,  enabling  him 
to  speak  a  kind  of  broken  but  understandable 


English.  EBE  said  he  had  been  the  equivalent 
of  a  mechanic  on  the  crashed  craft.  EBE  died 
of  unknown  causes  in  1952. 

Moore’s  sources  alleged  that  EBE  later  was 
called  EBE-1,  because  two  other  aliens — 
EBE-2  and  EBE-3 — later  fell  into  U.S.  gov¬ 
ernment  hands.  The  three  captives  revealed 
that  nine  alien  races  were  visiting  Earth.  One 
in  particular,  the  little  gray-skinned  beings, 
had  been  especially  active.  This  group  had 
been  monitoring  human  activities  for  twenty- 
five  thousand  years  and  had  manipulated  our 
religious  beliefs. 

In  his  book  UFO  Crash  at  Aztec  (1986), 
William  S.  Steinman  reports  another  alleged 
1948  incident,  this  one  involving  a  physician 
from  Bishop,  California,  named  Claude  E. 
Steen,  Sr.  (Elsewhere  in  his  book  Steinman 
gives  the  year  as  1 949  and  spells  the  last  name 
“Steene.”)  A  “member  of  a  special  military 
unit”  contacted  Steen  and  led  him  and  his 
nurse  to  a  location  where  an  alien  was  being 
kept  alive.  It  was  in  a  chamber  with  a  con¬ 
trolled  environment.  The  being  appeared  to 
be  some  kind  of  reptile.  Its  appearance  so 
upset  the  nurse  that  she  said  it  looked  like 
something  “from  the  pits  of  hell.” 

On  July  23,  1952,  a  Colorado  newspaper, 
the  Pueblo  Chieftain,  related  a  peculiar  story. 
Speaking  to  the  local  Chamber  of  Commerce, 
Joseph  Rohrer,  president  of  Pikes  Peak  Broad¬ 
casting,  said  he  knew  of  three  saucer  crashes 
in  Montana.  One  of  the  occupants  that  had 
survived,  a  three-foot-tall  humanoid,  was  still 
being  kept  alive  in  an  incubator  in  California, 
where  efforts  were  being  made  to  communi¬ 
cate  with  him.  In  April  2000,  ufologist  Kenny 
Young  conducted  inquiries  into  these  curious 
claims,  eventually  learning  that  Rohrer  was  a 
prankster  with  a  sense  of  humor.  Even  though 
the  paper  had  treated  his  story  seriously,  its 
audience  understood  that  he  was  speaking 
tongue  in  cheek. 

See  Also:  Dead  extraterrestrials;  Extraterrestrial  Bio¬ 
logical  Entities 

Further  Reading 

Moore,  William  L.,  1987.  Personal  communication 
to  Jerome  Clark. 


58  Cetaceans 


Steinman,  William  S.,  with  Wendelle  C.  Stevens, 
1986.  UFO  Crash  at  Aztec:  A  Well  Kept  Secret. 
Tucson,  AZ:  UFO  Photo  Archives. 

Young,  Kenny,  2000.  “Talk  Startles  Crowd’:  Investi¬ 
gation  of  Strange  1952  Newspaper  Article.” 
http://home.fuse.net/ufo/ rohrer.html 

Cetaceans 

The  Cetaceans  are  a  “One  Group  Mind”  con¬ 
sisting  of  the  worlds  whales  and  dolphins. 
They  channel  through  Rochester,  New  York, 
psychic  Dianne  Robbins,  who  also  receives 
messages  from  Adama,  a  resident  of  the 
Lemurian  city  Telos  under  California’s 
Mount  Shasta.  The  Cetaceans  monitor  events 
on  Earth — in  the  ocean,  on  the  land,  and  in 
the  skies — and  keep  human  beings  from 
harmful  extraterrestrials.  They  also  seek  to 
protect  the  earth  from  pollution  and  other 
destructive  forces  because  human  beings  have 
neglected  their  responsibilities  as  “the 
Guardians  of  Love  that  Earth  needs  as  she 
floats  along  her  path  through  space”  (“We 
Are,”  n.d.).  The  human  race,  like  the 
Cetaceans  themselves,  came  to  Earth  long 
ago  from  other  star  systems  with  the  specific 
task  of  taking  care  of  this  planet.  Unfortu¬ 
nately,  memories  of  that  distant  event  have 
faded  among  humans,  and  the  Cetaceans  are 
working  with  space  intelligences  to  reawaken 
humanity’s  sleeping  consciousness. 

If  intruders  enter  Earth’s  atmosphere  and 
violate  cosmic  ethical  standards,  the  Ce¬ 
taceans  telepathically  notify  the  Galactic 
Command,  with  which  they  are  in  constant 
contact.  Often  the  Cetaceans  will  project  their 
consciousness  into  the  command’s  spacecraft. 

Earth  will  soon  enter  the  Photon  Belt, 
which  will  have  the  effect  of  bringing  humans 
out  of  the  darkness  and  into  the  light,  restor¬ 
ing  them  to  their  cosmic  destiny.  “We  came 
here  especially  for  this  time  when  the  Earth 
would  be  transiting  into  a  higher  dimen¬ 
sions,”  the  Cetaceans  say. 

Channeling  through  a  California-based 
metaphysical  group,  the  Council  of  Nine 
from  the  planet  Sirius  B,  this  area’s  branch  of 
the  Galactic  Federation,  put  it  this  way: 


“Guardianship  by  the  Cetaceans  can  best  be 
described  by  observing  the  use  of  their  ener¬ 
gies.  Through  the  use  of  their  rituals,  their 
sonar  songs  and  their  ocean  travels,  they  vivify 
the  biosphere.  Whale  song  has  been  found 
throughout  all  the  oceans  of  the  world.  It  is 
also  found  in,  and  resonates  throughout,  the 
skies  of  the  Earth.  It  exists  even  in  the  deepest 
parts  of  Africa,  the  Americas,  Asia,  and  Eu¬ 
rope.  Because  the  energies  of  the  Cetaceans 
can  be  found  both  in  the  sky  and  in  the  water, 
those  great  energies  they  bring  forth  in  their 
song  create  the  resonance  that  sustains  life” 
(Nidle  and  Essene,  1994). 

See  Also:  Adama;  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Nidle,  Sheldon,  and  Virginia  Essene,  1994.  You  Are  Be  - 
coming  a  Galactic  Human.  Santa  Clara,  CA:  Spiri¬ 
tual  Education  Endeavors  Publishing  Company. 

“We  Are  the  Cetaceans,”  n.d.  http://onelight.com/ 
ceta  /  cetabook/  cetmonitor.htm 

Chaneques 

Traditional  belief  holds  that  little  people 
known  as  Chaneques  live  in  the  forests  and 
jungles  of  Mexico  and  Central  America, 
guarding  the  spirits  of  wild  animals  and  some¬ 
times  causing  harm  to  unlucky  human  beings. 
The  Chaneques  are  one  variant  of  the  beings 
known  under  many  names,  including  fairies 
and  elves.  As  with  these  traditions,  Chaneque 
lore  consists  not  just  of  distant  legends  and 
rumors  but  of  claims  of  firsthand  experiences. 

Two  English  teachers  from  Mexico  City  in¬ 
vestigated  some  of  these  claims  in  the  early 
1970s.  In  the  state  of  Veracruz,  they  inter¬ 
viewed  sixteen  persons  who  had  alleged  en¬ 
counters,  either  direct  or  through  family 
members  (usually  children),  with  these  be¬ 
ings.  One  woman,  for  example,  told  them 
that  one  day  in  March  1973,  her  son  Ramiro, 
three  and  a  half  years  old,  wandered  from  his 
home  in  the  village  of  La  Tinaja.  Searches 
went  on  for  six  days  without  success.  Finally, 
the  Chaneques  informed  a  six-year-old  neigh¬ 
bor  that  Ramiro  was  safe  in  a  cave  ten  miles 
away.  When  rescued  at  the  designated  place, 
the  boy  was  in  excellent  health,  neither  hun- 


Channeling  59 


gry  nor  thirsty.  Though  the  entrance  to  the 
cave  was  accessible  only  with  difficulty,  and 
the  searchers  were  scratched  and  bruised  by 
the  time  they  got  to  him,  the  barefoot  Ramiro 
had  no  marks  on  him.  He  explained  that 
while  playing  by  the  river,  he  got  lost.  Five  lit¬ 
tle  men  found  him  and  fed  him  “sweet  food” 
and  milk.  He  then  fell  asleep  and  woke  up  in 
the  cave,  with  one  of  the  men  still  with  him. 
He  and  his  companions,  who  came  to  the 
cave  on  occasion,  played  together  until  the 
rescue  was  accomplished. 

Ricardo  Gutierrez  related  that  while  walk¬ 
ing  through  a  forest  one  day  in  June  1970,  his 
six-year-old  nephew,  Arturo,  who  had  been 
accompanying  him,  abruptly  vanished.  When 
the  boy  failed  to  reappear,  the  local  authorities 
arrested  Gutierrez  for  murder.  Thirty-three 
days  later,  as  the  man  awaited  trial,  a  healthy- 
looking,  unconcerned  Arturo  entered  his 
house.  Asked  where  he  had  been,  he  said  he 
had  been  living  with  the  little  men.  They  fed 
him  food  and  honey-flavored  milk  and  played 
games  with  him.  The  investigators  inter¬ 
viewed  local  police,  who  confirmed  the  mys¬ 
terious  disappearance  and  the  equally  enig¬ 
matic  reappearance. 

Driving  a  six- ton  truck  between  La  Tinaja 
and  Tierra  Blanca  at  8  A.M.  on  May  22,  1973, 
Manuel  Angel  Gonzalez  suddenly  saw  five 
small  figures  standing  in  the  road  in  front  of 
him,  holding  their  arms  up  in  the  air.  He 
slammed  on  the  brakes  barely  in  time  to  keep 
from  running  into  what  he  assumed  were 
small  children.  As  he  sat  in  his  cab  trying  to 
recover  his  wits,  he  had  a  chance  to  look  more 
closely  at  the  figures.  Now  they  looked  like 
adults,  only  two  feet  tall,  perfectly  propor¬ 
tioned,  with  light  brown  complexions  and 
black  hair.  He  also  realized  that  they  had  not 
stepped  out  onto  the  road,  but  had  material¬ 
ized  there. 

After  a  time  he  stepped  out  of  the  truck 
and  approached  the  figures.  His  action  appar¬ 
ently  frightened  them  because  they  scattered 
into  the  dense  undergrowth  and  fled  in  the  di¬ 
rection  of  a  nearby  mountain.  When  Gonza¬ 
lez  turned  around  to  return  to  his  vehicle,  he 


was  dismayed  to  see  blue  flames  consuming  it. 
Within  half  an  hour  it  and  its  cargo — asbestos 
sheeting,  sacked  cement,  and  reinforcing 
steel — had  been  reduced  to  fused  metal  and 
ash. 

The  story  made  the  Mexican  newspapers. 
Soon  afterward,  the  two  investigators  inter¬ 
viewed  Gonzalez  and  his  boss,  who  confirmed 
the  truck’s  destruction,  which  neither  could 
explain;  neither  could  the  police  officer  who 
was  on  the  scene  within  an  hour.  Gonzalez 
thought  that  the  little  men  were  not 
Chaneques  but  “space  travelers  from  some 
other  planet,”  since  Chaneques  were  not 
known  to  cause  pointless  destruction. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind;  Fairies 
encountered 

Further  Reading 

Pantoja  Lopez,  Ramon  A.,  and  Robert  Freeman 
Bound,  1974.  “Chaneques:  Mexican  Gnomes  or 
Interplanetary  Visitors?”  Fate  27,  11  (Novem¬ 
ber):  51-57. 

Channeling 

Channeling  is  new  in  name  only.  It  refers  to 
the  process  whereby  disembodied  entities 
communicate  ideas  and  information  through 
human  beings  who  are  either  in  full  waking 
consciousness  or  in  an  altered  state.  The  com¬ 
municating  entities  may  be  deceased  persons, 
gods,  angels,  extraterrestrials,  extradimen- 
sional  intelligences,  “ascended  masters”  (mys¬ 
tical  adepts  who  have  transcended  physical  ex¬ 
istence),  nature  spirits,  and  more.  In  earlier 
times,  channeling  was  called  “revelation,”  or 
“mediumship.”  Whatever  the  name,  it  is  often 
accompanied  by  visions  of  otherworldly  enti¬ 
ties  or  unearthly  realms.  Some  channelers  be¬ 
lieve  that  through  their  consciousness  alone, 
they  can  travel  through  the  universe  and  into 
other  dimensions. 

In  ancient  times  oracles  and  priests  com¬ 
municated  with  the  gods.  The  resulting  divine 
messages  formed  the  basis  of  religious  and 
mystical  faiths.  Such  communications  often 
involved  prophecies  as  well.  In  the  Judeo- 
Christian  tradition,  the  Bible  documents  vi¬ 
sions  and  messages  recognizably  related  to  the 


60  Channeling 


Gerry  Bowman  channeling  the  spirit  of  John  the  Baptist,  August  15,  1987,  Shasta  National  Forest,  California  (Roger 
Ressmeyer/Corbis) 


phenomenon  of  channeling.  Channeling 
seems  ubiquitous  in  human  experience.  His¬ 
torically  prominent  practitioners  include  Nos¬ 
tradamus,  Emanuel  Swedenborg,  Helena 
Petrovna  Blavatsky  (founder  of  the  theosophi- 
cal  movement),  and  Anna  Lee  (founder  of  the 
Quaker  sect  known  as  the  Shakers).  In  the  lat¬ 
ter  half  of  the  nineteenth  century,  spiritualism 
became  the  rage,  and  hundreds  of  mediums 
claimed  to  be  in  contact  with  dead  people 
who,  through  the  mediums,  spoke  with  the 
living.  The  communicators  were  not  always 
the  deceased,  however;  in  some  cases  space 
people  and  other  nonhuman  intelligences 
came  through.  Some  mediums  spoke  of  oth¬ 
erworldly  journeys  in  their  astral  bodies. 

After  World  War  II,  when  flying  saucers 
entered  the  popular  imagination,  benevolent 
extraterrestrial  entities  such  as  Ashtar  and 
Monka — starship  commanders  who  came 
here  to  oversee  the  transformation  of  the 
human  race  into  cosmic  citizenship — chan¬ 
neled  through  individuals  who  became 


known  as  contactees.  As  the  channeling 
movement  grew,  reaching  its  peak  in  the 
1970s  and  1980s  during  the  height  of  the 
New  Age  movement,  channelers  created  a  vast 
alternative-reality  literature,  fusing  traditional 
occultism  with  modern  science  and  pseudo¬ 
science.  Some  channeling  entities  made  pre¬ 
dictions,  often  of  some  cataclysmic  or  other¬ 
wise  seminal  events,  which  inevitably  went 
unfulfilled.  More  typically,  however,  channel¬ 
ing  consists  of  spiritual  platitudes,  self-help 
suggestions,  and  unverifiable  pronouncements 
about  the  nature  of  spirit  and  cosmos. 

To  its  critics,  it  is  nothing  more  than  a  form 
of  automatism,  “automatic  behavior  over 
which  an  individual  denies  any  personal  con¬ 
trol”  (Alcock,  1996).  Its  sources  are  within,  not 
outside,  the  channelers  psyche.  Parapsycholo¬ 
gist  Rodger  I.  Anderson  writes,  “It  has  been  in¬ 
creasingly  evident  to  researchers  that  automa¬ 
tism  of  whatever  kind  is  neither  a  psychic 
ability  nor  a  pathway  to  higher  knowledge.  Ap¬ 
pearances  notwithstanding,  it  is  only  too  clear 


Chung  Fu  61 


in  most  cases  that  all  the  various  elements  that 
go  to  make  up  the  act  of  automatism  are  owed 
solely  to  the  automatist  and  his  or  her  experi¬ 
ence  in  .  .  .  life”  (Anderson,  1988).  On  the 
other  hand,  a  skeptical  but  sympathetic  ob¬ 
server,  Brown  University  anthropologist 
Michael  F.  Brown,  defends  channeling  as,  at  its 
best,  “a  lively  arena  for  the  free  play  of  the  reli¬ 
gious  imagination.  ...  It  is  likely  to  remain  a 
site  of  emotional  and  spiritual  renewal  in  a  cul¬ 
ture  that,  perhaps  more  than  any  in  human  his¬ 
tory,  promotes  the  continuous  reinvention  of 
the  self”  (Brown,  1997). 

See  Also:  Ascended  Masters;  Ashtar;  Contactees; 
Monka 

Further  Reading 

Alcock,  James  E.,  1996.  “Channeling.”  In  Gordon 
Stein,  ed.  The  Encyclopedia  of  the  Paranormal, 
153—160.  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 

Anderson,  Rodger  I.,  1988.  “Channeling.”  Parapsy  - 
chology  Review  19,  5  (1988):  6-9. 

Brown,  Michael  F„  1997.  The  Channeling  Zone: 
American  Spirituality  in  an  Anxious  Age.  Cam¬ 
bridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Klimo,  Jon,  1987.  Channeling:  Investigations  on  Re  - 
ceiving  Information  from  Paranormal  Sources.  Los 
Angeles:  Jeremy  R  Tarcher. 

Riordan,  Suzanne,  1990.  “Channeling.”  In  J.  Gor¬ 
don  Melton,  Jerome  Clark,  and  Aidan  A.  Kelly, 
eds.  New  Age  Encyclopedia,  97-104.  Detroit,  MI: 
Gale  Research. 


Chief  Joseph 

In  life,  Chief  Joseph  (1840-1894)  led  a  group 
of  Nez  Perce  Indians  and  was  admired  in  his 
time  by  his  people  and  whites,  alike,  for  his  wis¬ 
dom  and  courage.  According  to  a  Reston,  Vir¬ 
ginia,  channeler  named  John  Cali,  Joseph  has 
been  communicating  from  beyond  the  grave 
since  1992.  Joseph  delivers  the  familiar  message 
that  Earth  is  going  through  physical  and  spiri¬ 
tual  changes.  Each  individual  must  find  the 
God  in  him-  or  herself.  Through  Cali,  Joseph 
gives  personal  psychic  readings  to  those  seeking 
guidance  in  their  personal  lives  or  metaphysical 
odysseys.  Joseph’s  current  messages  are  recorded 
in  an  occasional  e-newsletter,  Sentinels  of  the  Sky. 

Further  Reading 

“Who  Are  Chief  Joseph  and  John  Cali?”  http://www. 
claimyourpower.com/sentinels/thechief.htm 


Christopher 

Jackie  Altisi,  also  known  as  Jackie  White  Star, 
channels  messages  from  a  variety  of  other¬ 
worldly  entities,  including  the  spirit  of  mar¬ 
tyred  contactee  Gloria  Lee,  who  died  in  1 962 
while  fasting  under  the  direction  of  space  peo¬ 
ple.  A  principal  communicator  is  Christopher, 
an  aide  to  the  King  of  the  Moon  and 
spokesman  for  the  lunarian  station  of  United 
Cosmic  Planets.  According  to  Christopher, 
the  moon  is  a  “complete  authority  in  itself, 
but  working  with  an  interplanetary  confeder¬ 
ation.”  These  messages  are  circulated  through 
the  Star  Light  Fellowship,  established  in  1962. 
See  Also:  J.W. 

Further  Reading 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  American 
Religions.  Fifth  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale  Re¬ 
search. 

Chung  Fu 

Sometime  in  the  1960s,  Marshall  Lever,  then  a 
student  at  a  Presbyterian  seminary,  began  ex- 


Photograph  of  Chief  Joseph  by  Edward  Curtis  ( Corbis) 


62  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 


perimenting  with  trance  mediumship.  In  this 
state  he  heard  from  Chung  Fu,  a  spirit  guide 
who  in  his  last  physical  incarnation  was  a  stu¬ 
dent  of  Lao-Tzu  in  China.  In  1970,  Lever  and 
his  wife,  Quinta,  established  the  Circle  of 
Inner  Truth  to  facilitate  Chung  Fu’s  teachings, 
which  focused  on  spiritual  development  as  the 
way  to  break  out  of  the  reincarnation  cycle. 
These  efforts  included  such  quotidian  matters 
as  diet,  health  care,  and  psychological  well¬ 
being,  on  which  Chung  Fu  would  offer  guid¬ 
ance  in  sittings  with  individuals. 

The  Levers  traveled  widely,  abandoning 
any  permanent  residence,  to  work  for  Chung 
Fu.  Inner  Circles  took  roots  in  several  Ameri¬ 
can  cities,  and  one  operated  out  of  London. 
Finally,  Chung  Fu  was  heard  from  no  more, 
and  by  the  latter  1980s,  the  movement  no 
longer  existed. 

Further  Reading 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  American 
Religions.  Fifth  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale  Re¬ 
search. 


Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 

In  The  UFO  Experience  (1972),  J.  Allen 
Hynek,  a  Northwestern  University  as¬ 
tronomer  and  former  scientific  consultant  to 
the  U.S.  Air  Force’s  Project  Blue  Book,  pro¬ 
posed  a  classification  system  for  UFO  sight¬ 
ings,  including  three  varieties  of  close  encoun¬ 
ters.  He  defined  “close  encounters  of  the  third 
kind”  as  those  “in  which  the  presence  of  ani¬ 
mated  creatures  is  reported.”  Prior  to  the 
coining  of  the  phrase  (shortened  to  “CE3”), 
ufologists  had  called  these  “occupant  reports.” 

The  modem  UFO  phenomenon  is  two 
centuries  old.  In  the  early  nineteenth  century 
the  first  reports  of  arguably  UFO-like  phe¬ 
nomena  were  recorded  in  scientific  journals, 
newspaper  accounts,  and  other  sources, 
though  such  stories  were  relatively  rare  until 
late  in  the  century,  when  alleged  sightings  of 
mysterious  “airships”  filled  American  newspa¬ 
pers  between  November  1896  and  May  1897. 
Many  were  hoaxes,  some  concocted  by  the 
press  itself.  Among  them  were  claims  that  the 


airships  had  landed.  Reflecting  a  widely  held 
belief  that  an  ingenious  American  inventor 
had  built  the  ships  and  that  the  occupants 
were  human,  some  reports  even  gave  the  in¬ 
ventor  a  name,  Wilson.  Other  accounts,  how¬ 
ever,  described  grotesque  aliens,  sometimes 
thought  to  be  from  Mars.  “Hoax”  probably  is 
too  strong  a  word  to  characterize  these  tall 
tales,  which  were  apparently  meant  as  jokes  to 
amuse  a  readership  that  was  not  fooled. 

After  1947 — the  year  “flying  saucers”  and 
“unidentified  flying  objects”  entered  popular 
consciousness — a  number  of  seemingly  sin¬ 
cere  individuals  came  forward  to  speak  of  en¬ 
counters  they  had  experienced  in  earlier 
years,  some  reaching  as  far  back  as  1893, 
when  a  man  in  the  Australian  state  of  New 
South  Wales  told  a  newspaper  that  he  had 
seen  a  saucer-shaped  structure  land  on  his 
farm.  When  he  went  to  investigate,  an  oddly 
dressed  man  stepped  out  of  the  craft  holding 
a  device  that  resembled  a  “torch”  (flashlight). 
He  aimed  the  device  at  the  witness,  who  saw 
a  light  shoot  out  from  it  and  hit  his  hand. 
He  was  knocked  unconscious.  When  he 
awoke,  the  object  and  occupant  were  gone. 
For  the  rest  of  his  life,  he  claimed,  his  hand 
was  paralyzed. 

New  Zealand  newspapers  of  1 909  recorded 
a  local  airship-sighting  wave,  including  an  in¬ 
cident  in  which  a  witness  saw  three  figures  in 
a  craft  passing  overhead.  One  shouted  at  him 
in  an  unfamiliar  language.  In  the  United 
States,  early  on  the  morning  of  February  29, 
1916,  according  to  a  report  in  the  Superior 
Telegram  that  same  day,  workers  along  the 
Lake  Superior  dock  in  Wisconsin  saw  a  “big 
machine  ...  50  feet  wide  and  1 00  feet  long” 
fly  by  at  a  high  rate  of  speed  about  six  hun¬ 
dred  feet  in  the  air.  Workers  said  they  had 
seen  three  “men”  inside  the  craft.  This  is  the 
first  known,  seemingly  credible,  CE3  to  be 
published  at  the  time  of  its  occurrence. 

A  newspaper  referred  to  these  mysterious 
craft  by  the  name  “flying  saucers”  for  the  first 
time  on  June  26,  1947,  two  days  after  private 
pilot  Kenneth  Arnold  saw  nine  discs  maneu¬ 
vering  over  the  Cascade  Mountains.  This  re- 


Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind  63 


ported  account  ushered  in  the  UFO  age.  The 
same  afternoon  as  Arnold’s  sighting,  Oregon 
farmer  Bill  Schuening  claimed  to  have  seen  a 
spherical  object  hovering  five  or  six  feet  above 
a  field.  Just  beneath  it  were  “two  little  guys  in 
green  suits  with  white  helmets”  (McCune, 
1987).  They  were  no  more  than  three  feet  tall. 
A  few  seconds  later  they  vanished.  Schuening 
did  not  see  them  enter  the  craft,  which  then 
flew  off  toward  the  Cascades. 

In  the  early  UFO  era,  however,  such  re¬ 
ports,  relatively  rare  but  hardly  nonexistent, 
received  little  attention.  In  1950,  when  the 
first  book  with  “flying  saucers”  in  its  title, 
Donald  E.  Keyhoe’s  paperback  The  Flying 
Saucers  Are  Real,  saw  print,  the  occupants  of 
the  vehicles — Keyhoe  believed  them  to  be 
peaceable  extraterrestrials  who  deliberately  re¬ 
frained  from  contact — could  only  be  specu¬ 
lated  about.  Another  book  published  that 
same  year,  Frank  Scully’s  Behind  the  Flying 
Saucers,  asserted  that  the  U.S.  government 
had  recovered  crashed  spacecraft,  containing 
the  bodies  of  little  men  “dressed  in  the  style  of 
the  1890s”  and  believed  to  be  from  Venus. 
(Subsequent  investigations  determined  that 
two  veteran  confidence  artists  had  concocted 
these  tales  in  order  to  peddle  bogus  oil-detec¬ 
tion  devices  tied  to  advanced  extraterrestrial 
technology.)  Scully’s  notorious  book  had  the 
effect  of  leading  some  early  ufologists — as  op¬ 
posed  to  the  saucerians  who  embraced  the 
contactee  movement — to  shy  away  from  any 
reports  of  humanoids,  whatever  the  source. 

A  significant  proportion  of  the  reports  de¬ 
scribed  the  occupants  as  humanoids.  The  spe¬ 
cific  descriptions  may  have  varied,  but  wit¬ 
nesses  mostly  testified  that  UFO  occupants 
had  two  arms,  two  legs,  and  generally  human¬ 
like  head  and  facial  features.  Usually  the  be¬ 
ings  were  small.  Sometimes  they  were 
grotesque-looking.  Sometimes  they  looked 
like  small  humans.  A  minority  were  of  normal 
human  height,  and  a  few  were  said  to  be  more 
than  that,  seven  or  eight  feet  tall.  Such  reports 
came  from  all  over  the  world,  including  re¬ 
mote  Third  World  locations  where  UFOs 
were  little  known  and  the  occupants  were 


sometimes  taken  to  be  American  or  Russian 
pilots.  A  wave  of  humanoid  and  other  en¬ 
counters  in  France  in  the  fall  of  1954  received 
international  attention  and  caused  even  the 
most  cautious  UFO  researchers  to  reconsider 
their  bias  against  CE3  reports.  In  the  summer 
of  1955,  the  air  force’s  Project  Blue  Book  in¬ 
vestigated  a  bizarre  episode  in  which  members 
of  a  rural  Kentucky  family  claimed  to  have 
spent  a  night  besieged  by  floating,  big-eared 
humanoid  entities  from  a  UFO. 

CE3s  were  different  from  the  contact 
claims  of  George  Adamski,  Floward  Menger, 
George  Van  Tassel,  and  other  1950s  con- 
tactees  in  some  important  ways.  For  one,  the 
beings  seldom  looked  much  like  the  golden¬ 
haired,  angelic  spacemen  and  spacewomen 
who  figured  in  the  contactees’  tales.  For  an¬ 
other,  they  had  little  if  anything  to  say.  Com¬ 
munication,  if  any  (and  there  seldom  was), 
was  brief,  sometimes  enigmatic,  and  always 
devoid  of  inspirational  content.  Unlike  con¬ 
tactees,  CE3  witnesses  fit  the  profile  of  wit¬ 
nesses  to  less  exotic  UFO  phenomena;  in 
other  words,  they  were  ordinary  citizens  with¬ 
out  a  background  in  occultism  and  other  eso¬ 
teric  pursuits,  as  contactees  tended  to  be. 
They  also  did  not  embark  on  lecture  tours  or 
write  books,  as  the  more  flamboyant  con¬ 
tactees  did. 

A  spectacular  CE3  took  place  over  Boianai, 
Papua  New  Guinea,  in  late  June  1959.  The 
best-known  witness,  the  Rev.  William  Booth 
Gill,  was  an  Anglican  missionary  from  Aus¬ 
tralia.  On  the  evening  of  June  26,  thirty-eight 
persons  observed  a  large,  disc-shaped  craft 
with  four  legs  hovering  in  the  northwestern 
sky.  Gill  estimated  its  apparent  size  to  be  that 
of  five  full  moons  lined  up  end  to  end.  At  the 
top  of  the  UFO,  behind  a  glass-covered  cock¬ 
pit,  four  humanlike  figures,  surrounded  by  il¬ 
lumination,  moved  back  and  forth,  appar¬ 
ently  working  at  an  unknown  task.  The  object 
and  its  crew  ascended  into  gathering  clouds 
after  forty-five  minutes.  Other  UFOs,  though 
not  their  occupants,  were  intermittently  visi¬ 
ble  over  the  next  three  and  a  half  hours. 
Twenty  five  of  the  witnesses  signed  a  state- 


64  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 


ment  attesting  to  what  they  had  seen  that 
night.  At  6  P.M.  the  next  day,  the  original 
UFO  and  its  crew  returned.  At  one  point  dur¬ 
ing  the  observation,  Gill  and  others  waved  to 
the  occupants,  who  waved  back.  The  objects 
showed  up  for  the  last  time  the  next  night, 
though  no  beings  were  visible. 

Interviewed  in  1973  byj.  Allen  Hynek,  na¬ 
tive  witnesses  stuck  by  the  story.  Gill,  who  left 
the  country  in  September  1959,  stands  by  the 
report  even  today.  It  remains  among  the  most 
impressive  and  puzzling  of  CE3s. 

Far  stranger  and  much  harder  to  believe 
was  the  testimony  of  a  young  Brazilian,  Anto¬ 
nio  Villas-Boas.  Villas-Boas  came  to  the  atten¬ 
tion  of  ufologists  in  November  1957,  when  he 
wrote  a  letter  to  a  journalist  who  had  written 
about  UFOs.  Soon  afterward,  the  journalist, 
Joao  Martins,  brought  Villas-Boas  to  Rio  de 
Janeiro,  where  he  and  physician/ufologist 
Olavo  T.  Fontes,  of  the  National  School  of 
Medicine  of  Brazil,  interviewed  and  examined 
him.  The  young  man  claimed  that  in  the  early 
morning  hours  of  October  16,  occupants  of  a 
UFO  took  him  into  the  ship  and  left  him 
alone  in  a  room.  A  naked,  essentially  human¬ 
looking  young  woman  soon  joined  him  there, 
eventually  engaging  with  him  in  two  sex  acts. 
Before  leaving,  she  made  a  gesture  that  led 
Villas-Boas  to  believe  she  would  bear  his  child 
on  another  world. 

Martins  and  Fontes  judged  Villas-Boas  to 
be  sane  and  sincere.  His  intelligence  and  re¬ 
fusal  to  speculate  on  the  incident  made  a  posi¬ 
tive  impression.  “In  spite  of  this,”  Fontes 
wrote,  “the  very  substance  of  his  story  be¬ 
comes  the  heaviest  argument  against  it” 
(Lorenzen  and  Lorenzen,  1967).  In  1962  two 
representatives  of  a  Brazilian  UFO  group 
went  to  Villas-Boas’s  village  to  speak  with 
him.  Though  desiring  no  publicity,  he  spoke, 
if  reluctantly,  about  the  experience.  The  inves¬ 
tigators  published  an  account  of  the  interview 
in  an  English-language  version  of  their  bul¬ 
letin,  but  it  attracted  little  notice.  Fontes’s 
1958  report  circulated  privately  among  a  few 
English-speaking  ufologists,  but  because  of  its 
sexual  nature  no  one  would  publish  it.  For 


Antonio  Villas-Boas  being  medically  examined following 
his  abdtiction  by  a  UFO  in  Brazil,  October  15,  1957 
(Fortean  Picture  Library) 

most  ufologists,  the  Villas-Boas  episode  was 
only  a  vague  rumor,  if  that,  until  England’s 
widely  read  Flying  Saucer  Review  carried  a  se¬ 
ries  of  articles  on  it,  beginning  in  its  Janu¬ 
ary/February  1965  issue. 

The  Villas-Boas  case  anticipated  an  escala¬ 
tion  of  the  strangeness  quotient  of  the  CE3 
phenomenon.  On  April  18,  1961,  Joe  Simon- 
ton  of  rural  Eagle  River,  Wisconsin,  was  eat¬ 
ing  lunch  when,  so  he  would  assert,  a  flying 
saucer  landed  on  his  driveway.  He  went  out¬ 
side  just  as  a  hatchway  opened.  A  short,  dark- 
featured  man,  dressed  in  a  black,  two-piece 
suit  and  wearing  a  tight-fitting  cap  on  his 
head,  held  a  jug.  From  his  gestures  Simonton 
inferred  that  he  wanted  the  jug  to  be  filled 
with  water.  He  complied.  As  he  handed  the 
filled  jug  back  to  the  man,  he  glanced  inside 
the  ship  and  saw  two  other  men.  One  was  sit¬ 
ting  in  front  of  a  flameless  grill,  cooking 
something.  When  Simonton  asked  if  they 
were  eating,  the  man  with  the  jug  handed  him 
four  fresh  “pancakes,”  and  then  the  flying 
saucer  departed.  Simonton  took  a  bite  of  one 


Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind  65 


of  the  pancakes.  It  tasted  like  cardboard,  he 
thought. 

The  story  of  the  Eagle  River  pancakes  at¬ 
tracted  national  attention  and  a  torrent  of 
ridicule.  Even  UFO  groups  disagreed  on  its 
significance,  some  championing  Simonton  as  a 
na'ive,  sincere  witness  to  an  extraordinary 
event,  while  the  conservative  National  Investi¬ 
gations  Committee  on  Aerial  Phenomena 
(NICAP)  sneeringly  dismissed  the  story  as  an 
absurd  contact  claim.  Even  Project  Blue  Book 
got  drawn  into  the  case,  sending  Dr.  Hynek  to 
the  site  to  interview  Simonton  and  local  peo¬ 
ple.  Few  of  Simonton’s  friends  and  acquain¬ 
tances  deemed  him  a  hoaxer  or  even  a  man 
with  sufficient  imagination  to  make  up  such 
an  outlandish  tale.  Still,  laboratory  analysis 
found  nothing  out  of  the  ordinary  in  the  pan¬ 
cake  sample  it  examined.  In  common  with  just 
about  everybody  else  who  looked  closely  at  the 
claim,  the  air  force  ended  up  confused,  stating 
at  one  point  that  Simonton  was  a  “balanced 
person  of  good  mental  health,”  and,  at  an¬ 
other,  that  he  had  suffered  “an  hallucination 
followed  with  delusion”  (Malian,  1967).  Sepa¬ 
rately,  a  lone  witness  and  a  nearby  farm  family 
reported  seeing  a  UFO  over  Simonton’s  resi¬ 
dence,  in  the  first  case,  at  the  time  of  the  sup¬ 
posed  landing;  in  the  second,  the  next  evening. 

Cases  such  as  Villas-Boas’s  and  Simonton’s 
suggested  a  degree  of  communication  be¬ 
tween  witnesses  and  UFO  beings.  To  some 
ufologists,  many  never  very  enthusiastic  about 
CE3s  to  start  with,  that  suggested  the  de¬ 
spised  contactees,  even  if  neither  man  acted 
much  like  one.  These  ufologists  were  more 
comfortable  with  a  CE3  report  from  Socorro, 
New  Mexico,  on  April  24,  1964,  from  Lonnie 
Zamora,  a  police  officer  of  undisputed  relia¬ 
bility.  Around  6  P.M.  Zamora  spotted  a  small, 
egg-shaped  UFO  resting  in  an  isolated  area  on 
the  city’s  outskirts.  Close  to  the  object  were 
two  small  figures  dressed  in  white  coveralls, 
apparently  examining  the  craft.  On  seeing 
Zamora,  they  ran  behind  the  craft  and  disap¬ 
peared.  The  flame-spewing  UFO  departed 
with  a  roar.  Police,  Project  Blue  Book,  and 
civilian  investigators  found  burn  marks  and 


impressions  at  the  site.  Despite  its  hostility  to 
UFOs  and  its  tendency  to  reach  for  some¬ 
times  far-fetched  “conventional”  explanations 
for  reports,  Project  Blue  Book  declared  the 
case  an  “unknown.”  It  has  since  become  a 
classic  UFO  incident,  often  cited  by  those 
who  argue  for  the  anomalous  nature  of  the 
phenomenon. 

If  Zamora’s  experience  seemed  relatively 
straightforward,  Gary  Wilcox’s  claimed  en¬ 
counter  of  the  same  day  and  a  few  hours  ear¬ 
lier  appeared  as  bizarre  as  Villas-Boas’s  and  Si¬ 
monton’s,  though  not  much  like  either  in  any 
other  context.  Wilcox,  a  young  Newark  Val¬ 
ley,  New  York,  dairy  farmer,  asserted  that  he 
had  spoken  with  two  short,  spacesuit-clad 
UFO  occupants  for  two  hours.  They  said  that 
they  were  part  of  a  Martian  expedition, 
Wilcox  said,  engaged  in  Earth  exploration. 
Wilcox’s  story  did  not  come  to  light  until  a 


Police  Officer  Lonnie  Zamora,  who  saw  a  UFO  land  near 
Socorro,  Neiv  Mexico,  April 24,  1964  (Fortean  Picture 
Library) 


66  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 


few  days  later,  since  he  had  sought  no  public¬ 
ity  and  discussed  it  only  with  friends  and  fam¬ 
ily  members,  who  eventually  leaked  it  to  the 
local  press.  Like  Simonton,  Wilcox  had  an 
unimpeachable  reputation  among  locals,  and 
psychological  testing  revealed  no  abnormali¬ 
ties.  Wilcox  made  no  subsequent  attempt  to 
exploit  his  story.  Though  his  testimony  made 
no  sense — even  in  1964  scientists  had  aban¬ 
doned  the  hope  of  an  inhabited  Mars — 
Wilcox  seemed  neither  crazy  nor  dishonest. 

As  comparable  claims  came  to  the  fore, 
some  ufologists  speculated  that  UFO  occu¬ 
pants  were  lying  to  hide  their  true  identity 
and  purpose.  At  the  extreme  this  led  theorists 
such  as  John  A.  Keel  and  Jacques  Yallee  to 
move  beyond  ufology’s  venerable  extraterres¬ 
trial  hypothesis  (ETH)  and  into  quasi-de- 
monological  speculation  about  earthbound  el- 
ementals  and  other  occult  entities. 


As  if  to  compound  the  confusion,  by  the 
mid-1960s  ufologists  were  confronting  a  new 
level  of  confrontation  and  contact  between 
humans  and  UFO  beings.  In  1965,  under 
hypnosis  conducted  by  a  Boston  psychiatrist, 
a  New  Hampshire  couple,  Barney  and  Betty 
Hill,  turned  a  consciously  recalled  CE3  (an 
observation  of  figures  aboard  a  hovering  UFO 
one  night  in  September  1961)  into  an  on¬ 
board  experience,  including  medical  examina¬ 
tion  by  gray-skinned  aliens  and  conversation 
with  the  ship’s  captain.  All  of  this  took  place 
during  a  two-hour  period  of  which  the  Hills 
had  no  conscious  memory  and  for  which  they 
had  never  been  able  to  account;  to  them  it 
had  always  been  a  puzzling  period  of  seem¬ 
ingly  inexplicable  amnesia.  “Missing  time,” 
hypnotic  regressions,  gray  aliens,  and  medical 
examinations  would  play  large  roles  in  the 
emerging  abduction  phenomenon. 


A  drawing  by  a  pupil  at  Ariel  Primary  School  in  Ruwa,  Zimbabwe,  where  a  group  of  children  saw  a  UFO  and  aliens  land 
on  September  16,  1994  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Cocoon  people  67 


In  time,  such  abduction  reports — the  sub¬ 
ject  of  a  separate  entry — would  overwhelm 
CE3s  as  historically  understood.  Nonabduc¬ 
tion  CE3s  would  diminish  in  number  and,  in 
time,  slow  to  a  trickle,  though  they  would  not 
entirely  disappear. 

One  particularly  well-documented  inci¬ 
dent  reportedly  occurred  in  the  early  morn¬ 
ing  hours  of  January  12,  1975,  when  sev- 
enty-two-year-old  George  O’Barski  was 
driving  home  past  New  York  City’s  North 
Hudson  Park.  He  observed  a  glowing  pan¬ 
cake-shaped  object  hovering  above  the  park 
ground.  A  door  opened,  a  ladder  emerged, 
and  about  ten  small  figures,  dressed  in  one- 
piece  suits  and  helmets,  climbed  down  to 
collect  soil  and  grass  samples,  which  they 
scooped  up  with  “little  shovels”  (Hopkins, 
1981).  An  extensive  investigation  by  three 
New  York-based  ufologists  uncovered  a  body 
of  apparent  confirming  testimony  from  an 
assortment  of  witnesses. 

In  the  most  remarkable  CE3  of  the  1990s, 
a  large  group  of  children  at  Ariel  School, 
Ruwa,  Zimbabwe,  while  on  recess  on  the 
morning  of  September  16,  1994,  reportedly 
observed  the  landing  of  a  UFO  just  beyond 
the  playground.  They  also  saw  one  or  two  oc¬ 
cupants,  small  figures  (slightly  more  than 
three  feet  tall)  with  large,  slanted  eyes  and 
long  black  hair.  They  were  wearing  tight  black 
suits.  Though  teachers  were  alerted  while  the 
incident  was  in  progress,  none  believed  the 
children  and  refused  to  go  outside.  Later,  they 
changed  their  minds  as  the  children  produced 
remarkably  uniform  accounts  and  drawings. 
A  British  Broadcasting  Corporation  journal¬ 
ist,  accompanied  by  Zimbabwe  ufologist  Cyn¬ 
thia  Hind,  interviewed  the  witnesses  within  a 
few  days  of  the  incident. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Adamski,  George; 
Contactees;  Keel,  John  Alva;  Menger,  Howard; 
Van  Tassel,  George  W;  Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Basterfield,  Keith,  1997.  UFOs:  A  Report  on  Aus  - 
tralian  Encounters.  Kew,  Victoria,  Australia:  Reed 
Books. 

Bowen,  Charles,  ed.,  1974.  The  Humanoids.  Lon¬ 
don:  Futura  Publications. 


Clark,  Jerome,  1998.  “Close  Encounters  of  the  Third 
Kind.”  In  Jerome  Clark.  The  UFO  Encyclopedia: 
The  Phenomenon  from  the  Beginning,  207-239. 
Detroit,  MI:  Omnigraphics. 

- ,  2000.  “The  Extraterrestrial  Hypothesis  in 

the  Early  UFO  Age.”  In  David  M.  Jacobs,  ed., 
UFOs  and  Abductions:  Challenging  the  Borders  of 
Knowledge,  122-140.  Lawrence:  University  Press 
of  Kansas. 

Fuller,  John  G.,  1966.  The  Interrupted  Journey:  Two 
Lost  Hours  “Aboard  a  Flying  Saucer.  ”  New  York: 
Dial  Press. 

Hind,  Cynthia,  1996.  UFOs  over  Africa.  Madison, 
WI:  Horus  House  Press. 

Hopkins,  Budd,  1981.  Missing  Time:  A  Documented 
Study  of  UFO  Abductions.  New  York:  Richard 
Marek  Publishers. 

Hynek,  J.  Allen,  1972.  The  UFO  Experience:  A  Scien  - 
tific  Inquiry.  Chicago:  Henry  Regnery  Company. 

Hynek,  J.  Allen,  and  Jacques  Vallee,  1975.  The  Edge 
of  Reality:  A  Progress  Report  on  Unidentified  Flying 
Objects.  Chicago:  Henry  Regnery  Company. 

Keyhoe,  Donald  E.,  1950.  The  Flying  Saucers  Are 
Real.  New  York:  Fawcett  Publishers. 

Lorenzen,  Coral,  and  Jim  Lorenzen,  1967.  Flying 
Saucer  Occupants.  New  York:  Signet. 

McCune,  Hal,  1987.  “Man  Sticks  to  His  Report.” 
Pendleton  East  Oregonian  (June  24). 

Malian,  Lloyd,  1967.  “UFO  Hoaxes  and  Hallucina¬ 
tions.”  Science  and  Mechanics  38,  3  (March): 
48-52,  82-85. 

Scully,  Frank,  1950.  Behind  the  Flying  Saucers.  New 
York:  Henry  Holt  and  Company. 


Cocoon  people 

In  her  book  Taken  (1994),  the  late  psycholo¬ 
gist  and  abductee  Karla  Turner  recounts  the 
experiences  of  a  woman  identified  only  as  Pat, 
at  the  time  a  fifty-year-old  divorcee  living  in 
Florida.  Her  abduction  experiences  began  in 
1954  on  the  family  farm  near  Floyd’s  Knob, 
Indiana.  Over  the  years  other  experiences  oc¬ 
curred.  All  of  these  were  repressed  in  con¬ 
scious  memory  until  1986,  when  they  came 
flooding  into  her  thoughts.  One  memory — 
Pat  could  not  put  a  specific  time  frame  on 
it — concerned  “cocoon  people.” 

She  found  herself  inside  a  large  room  with 
soft  white  lighting.  A  gray-skinned  humanoid 
stood  near  her.  “I  vaguely  recall  seeing  a 
human  male  there,”  she  would  tell  Turner, 
“but  not  what  he  was  doing.”  The  room  con- 


68  Contactees 


tained  a  number  of  boxes  that  looked  like  sar¬ 
cophagi  (stone  coffins).  Inside  them  she  could 
see  what  looked  like  human  forms,  alive  but 
not  moving,  covered  with  “white  misty  stuff,” 
which  somehow  she  knew  kept  them  alive.  In 
a  telepathic  communication,  the  being  asked 
if  she  wanted  to  see  “yours.”  When  she  said 
yes,  the  being  showed  her  a  container  with  a 
human  female  inside. 

“Don’t  ask  how  I  knew  it  was  female,”  she 
said.  “I  just  felt  it.  I  saw  a  little  bit  of  human 
face  through  the  mist,  like  a  nose,  mouth,  eyes, 
definitely  human.  I  knew  this  was  connected 
with  the  1954  visit,  because  I  remembered 
they  told  me  they  were  making  a  ‘new  me.’” 
When  she  and  the  others  were  resurrected  or 
reanimated,  she  thought,  “we  will  all  be  able  to 
see  and  talk  with  them  here  in  the  body.  ...  If 
I  were  to  die  now,  I  believe  that  my  ‘other 
body’  will  house  my  soul  when  Jesus  says  it  is 
time,  and  I,  too,  will  come  back.” 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs 

Further  Reading 

Turner,  Karla,  1994.  Taken:  Inside  the  Alien-Human 
Abduction  Agenda.  Roland,  AR:  Kelt  Works. 


Contactees 

Contactees  are  people  who  claim  a  regular, 
ongoing  relationship  with  benevolent  extra¬ 
terrestrials,  sometimes  called  Space  Brothers. 
These  aliens — essentially  angels  in  space- 
suits — are  nearly  always  human  in  appear¬ 
ance,  except  better  looking  than  humans  are. 
They  espouse  an  occult  philosophy  with  rec¬ 
ognizably  terrestrial  origins,  notably  in  Theos¬ 
ophy.  Contact  occurs  in  a  variety  of  fashions. 
Much,  perhaps  most,  of  it  is  through  channel¬ 
ing.  Other  psychic  communications  are  ef¬ 
fected  through  automatic  writing,  dreams,  vi¬ 
sions,  or  astral  (out-of-body)  travel.  A  third 
group,  the  most  controversial,  alleges  physical 
contacts,  including  trips  in  flying  saucers  to 
other  worlds.  Physical  contactees  frequently 
offer  “evidence”  of  their  experiences  in  the 
form  of  artifacts  or  photographs.  Persons  who 
follow  contactees  and  embrace  their  message 
are  sometimes  called  “saucerians.” 


The  contactee  movement  overlaps  to  a  de¬ 
gree  with  the  UFO  movement — ufology — 
but  the  two  differ  in  fundamental  ways.  To 
saucerians,  there  are  no  unidentified  flying  ob¬ 
jects.  Flying  saucers’  nature,  origin,  and  pur¬ 
pose  are  known;  they  are  here  to  educate  hu¬ 
mans  to  their  larger  cosmic  destiny,  to  prepare 
them  for  the  coming  Earth  changes  generated 
by  nuclear  war,  geological  upheavals,  polar 
shifts,  or  combinations  thereof.  To  ufologists, 
UFOs  are  unknowns,  probably  of  extraordi¬ 
nary  origin,  but  fundamentally  a  phenome¬ 
non  that  will  eventually  yield  its  secrets  to  sci¬ 
ence  via  conventional  investigative  and 
analytic  procedures.  Another  way  to  express 
the  difference  is  to  see  saucerianism  as  a  kind 
of  popular  religious  movement,  ufology  as  a 
popular  (if  often  naive)  attempt  at  scientific 
inquiry.  Traditionally,  ufologists  have  func¬ 
tioned  as  the  contactee  movement’s  fiercest 
critics. 

The  contactee  movement  envisions  a 
densely  populated  cosmos  with  hosts  of  ad¬ 
vanced,  wise  space  people  linked  in  a  kind  of 
celestial  United  Nations,  usually  called  the 
Galactic  Federation  or  something  like  it.  A 
minority  of  evil  extraterrestrials  opposes  the 
Federation’s  benevolent  mission.  Both  sides 
have  representatives  on  Earth,  individuals 
who  pass  as  normal  earthlings  but  who  are  in 
fact  aliens.  Many  were  placed  here  generations 
ago  and  have  lived  on  this  planet  through 
many  incarnations,  patiently  waiting  to  be  ac¬ 
tivated  when  the  time  of  transition — which 
will  include  mass  landings  of  spaceships — 
comes. 

There  were  contactees  before  there  were 
flying  saucers.  Perhaps  the  first  of  them  was 
the  Swedish  scientist  and  mystic  Emanuel 
Swedenborg  (1688-1772).  In  Earths  in  the 
Solar  World  (1758),  Swedenborg  wrote  of  his 
astral  travels  to  the  moon  and  other  planets. 
Each  of  these  worlds,  Swedenborg  asserted, 
is  inhabited,  and  he  described,  at  length,  the 
people  and  civilizations  there.  In  the  nine¬ 
teenth  century,  with  the  rise  of  the  spiritual¬ 
ist  movement,  psychic  communications  with 
extraterrestrials,  most  often  Martians,  were 


Contactees  69 


recorded  on  occasion.  The  most  famous  such 
case  became  the  subject  of  a  pioneering  book 
in  the  emerging  discipline  of  abnormal  psy¬ 
chology,  Theodore  Flournoys  From  India  to 
the  Planet  Mars  (1899).  In  various  states  of 
altered  consciousness,  a  woman  given  the 
pseudonym  Helene  Smith  (Catherine  Elise 
Muller)  interacted  with  persons  from  the 
Red  Planet,  which  she  also  visited  astrally. 
She  produced  a  Martian  language  that 
Flournoy  identified  as  an  “infantile  travesty 
of  French”  (Flournoy,  1963). 

Reflecting  a  belief  popularized  by  Ameri¬ 
can  astronomer  Percival  Lowell,  Smith/Muller 
“saw”  canals  on  the  Martian  surface.  Her 
story,  like  those  of  Swedenborg  and  the  con¬ 
tactees  of  the  saucer  era,  mirrored  astronomi¬ 
cal  and  other  scientific  theories  of  the  period. 
Within  a  few  years,  the  notion  of  a  Martian 
canal  system  would  be  thoroughly  debunked. 
In  the  late  1940s  and  into  the  1950s,  it  was 
still  vaguely  possible,  some  astronomers 
thought,  that  some  neighboring  planets  (most 
likely  Mars  and  Venus)  could  harbor  intelli¬ 
gent  life.  Perhaps  not  surprisingly,  the  aliens 
in  contact  lore  often  hailed  from  our  immedi¬ 
ate  vicinity.  After  space  probes  in  the  1960s 
established,  beyond  further  rational  discus¬ 
sion,  that  beyond  Earth  there  are  no  planets 
hospitable  to  life  in  this  system,  the  extrater¬ 
restrials  in  contact  claims  were  placed  farther 
out  in  the  cosmos.  Either  that,  or  the  Venus, 
Mars,  Saturn,  and  other  solar  planets  said  to 
harbor  advanced  civilizations  became  etheric 
counterparts,  existing  on  a  higher  vibratory 
rate  and  distinct  from  the  lifeless  worlds  we 
know. 

Another  influential  early  book  was  Oahspe 
(1882),  the  product  of  automatic  writing  at 
the  guidance  of  angels,  or  so  New  York  oc¬ 
cultist  John  Ballou  Newbrough  asserted. 
Written  between  January  and  December 
1881,  the  book  is  a  mystical  account  of  the 
cosmos,  its  history,  and  its  inhabitants.  The 
book  stayed  in  print  for  decades  and  was 
widely  read  in  contactee  circles,  where 
ashars — guardian  angels  who  fly  spirit  ships — 
became  extraterrestrials  in  spacecraft.  Indeed, 


the  ubiquitous  starship  commander  and  chan¬ 
neling  entity  Ashtar  may  owe  his  name  and 
occupation  to  Newbrough’s  creation. 

Helena  Petrovna  Blavatsky  (1831-1891), 
who  founded  Theosophy,  wrote  of  a  hierarchy 
of  “ascended  masters,”  including  the  Venus- 
based  “Lords  of  the  Flame.”  In  the  1930s  the 
flamboyant,  fascist-oriented  Guy  Warren  Bal¬ 
lard  marketed  a  simplified,  popular  version  of 
Blavatsky’s  doctrine.  He  spoke  of  his  own 
meeting  with  twelve  Venusian  “masters”  in  the 
Teton  mountains  in  Wyoming.  Religious 
studies  scholar  J.  Gordon  Melton  identifies 
Ballard  (who  died  in  1939)  and  his  I  AM 
movement  as  crucial  to  the  development  of 
the  later  contactee  movement.  “Not  only  did 
Ballard  become  the  first  to  actually  build  a  re¬ 
ligion  on  contact  with  extraterrestrials,”  he 
writes,  “but  his  emphasis  was  placed  upon  fre¬ 
quent  contact  with  the  masters  from  whom  he 
received  regular  messages  to  the  followers  of 
the  world  contactee  movement.  The  move¬ 
ment  took  over  the  I  AM  [spiritual]  hierarchy 
and  changed  it  into  a  space  command  hierar¬ 
chy”  (Melton,  1995). 

In  The  Book  of  the  Damned  (1919),  the  first 
volume  ever  written  on  the  subject  that  would 
eventually  be  called  ufology,  Charles  Fort 
(1874-1932)  speculated  that  strange  lights 
and  constructions  observed  in  the  sky  and 
space  during  the  previous  century  could  be 
evidence  of  visitation  from  other  worlds.  He 
also  advanced  the  possibly  tongue-in-cheek 
speculation  that,  perhaps,  some  human  beings 
were  secretly  in  contact  with  the  occupants  of 
such  vehicles. 

The  first  explicit  contact  in  the  context  of  a 
UFO  sighting  occurred  on  the  evening  of  Oc¬ 
tober  9,  1946,  over  San  Diego.  Many  resi¬ 
dents  had  gone  outside  in  anticipation  of  a 
predicted  meteor  shower.  Among  them  was 
medium  Mark  Probert,  who  channeled  cos¬ 
mic  philosophy  from  a  group  of  discarnates, 
including  a  500,000-year-old  Tibetan  named 
the  Yada  Di’  Shi’ite.  He  worked  with  occult 
theorist  N.  Meade  Layne,  who  the  year  before 
had  founded  Borderland  Sciences  Research 
Associates.  Probert  and  many  others  wit- 


70  Contactees 


nessed  something  that,  whatever  else  it  may  or 
may  not  have  been,  was  not  a  meteor.  Ob¬ 
servers  would  describe  it  as  resembling  a  huge 
bullet-shaped  object  with  batlike  wings  and  a 
searchlight  that  it  occasionally  swept  over  the 
ground.  Dark,  except  for  two  red  lights  along 
its  side,  it  stayed  in  view  for  an  hour  and  a 
half,  moving  at  both  slow  and  fast  speeds. 

During  the  sighting,  Probert  phoned 
Layne,  who  urged  him  to  see  if  the  craft’s  oc¬ 
cupants  were  interested  in  a  telepathic  ex¬ 
change.  According  to  Probert,  the  experiment 
succeeded.  The  crew  members  revealed  them¬ 
selves  as  peaceful  people  with  lightweight,  il¬ 
luminated  bodies.  They  had  been  trying  to 
contact  earthlings  for  many  years.  Though 
they  were  afraid  to  land  openly,  they  would 
meet  with  scientists  in  some  isolated  area  or 
on  a  mountaintop.  They  had  mastered  anti¬ 
gravity,  and  their  ship  was  called  the  Kareeta. 
The  San  Diego  Union  carried  a  humorous 
piece  on  the  sighting,  including  Probert’s  as¬ 
sertions,  in  its  October  18  issue. 

The  UFO  age  began  the  next  year  with 
private  pilot  Kenneth  Arnold’s  June  24  sight¬ 
ing  of  nine  shiny  objects  that  the  press  would 
soon  call  “flying  saucers.”  In  the  wake  of 
Arnold’s  report,  many  other  people  came  for¬ 
ward  to  recount  their  own  encounters  with 
unknown  aerial  phenomena.  Among  the 
most  outlandish  claims  to  see  print  was  one 
told  by  Ole  J.  Sneide.  In  a  letter  to  the  San 
Francisco  Chronicle  appearing  in  the  July  3 
issue,  Sneide  stated  that  the  flying  discs,  also 
known  as  flying  saucers,  were  spaceships  from 
other  planets.  (This  is  one  of  the  very  earliest 
public  attempts  to  link  the  new  public  sensa¬ 
tion  with  extraterrestrial  visitors.  Nearly  all 
other  speculation  held  the  saucers  to  be  natu¬ 
ral  phenomena  or  advanced  terrestrial  air¬ 
craft.  The  association  of  flying  saucers  as 
spaceships  did  not  take  widespread  hold  until 
the  early  to  mid-1950s.)  Sneide  also  said  the 
saucers  had  a  base  on  the  dark  side  of  the 
moon.  He  knew  as  much  because  he  regularly 
teleported  himself  around  the  galaxy.  A  fol¬ 
low-up  article  in  the  Chronicle  determined 
that  Sneide,  a  student  of  occultism,  was  seri¬ 


ous.  Though  nothing  more  is  known  about 
Sneide,  he  may  have  been  something  of  a 
contactee  before  the  word  and  concept  had 
come  into  currency. 

The  contact  movement,  however,  did  not 
emerge  into  cultural  visibility  until  January 
1952,  when  aircraft  mechanic  George  W  Van 
Tassel  began  holding  open  weekly  meetings  in 
the  high-desert  country  of  southern  Califor¬ 
nia.  At  these  gatherings  Van  Tassel  would 
channel  messages  from  starship  (“ventla”) 
commanders,  introducing,  among  others,  the 
destined-to-be  ubiquitous  Ashtar.  That  same 
year,  Van  Tassel  published  I  Rode  a  Flying 
Saucer!,  the  first  modern  contactee  book  (al¬ 
beit  with  a  misleading  title;  it  would  not  be 
until  the  next  year  that  Van  Tassel  would 
claim  his  first  physical  contact  and  spaceship¬ 
boarding).  The  year  1952  saw  a  flurry  of  con¬ 
tact  activity.  In  Prescott,  Arizona,  George 
Hunt  Williamson,  his  wife,  Betty,  and  com¬ 
panions  were  communicating  with  Martians, 
Uranians,  and  other  extraterrestrials  from  the 
solar  system  via  ouija  board,  radio,  and  men¬ 
tal  telepathy.  In  July,  in  the  Nevada  desert, 
Truman  Bethurum  met  the  crew  of  a  “scow” 
from  the  planet  Clarion,  invisible  to  earthly 
eyes  because  it  is  always  on  the  opposite  side 
of  the  sun  from  Earth. 

Though  arguably  Van  Tassel  was  the  most 
influential  of  the  first  generation  of  contactees, 
the  most  famous  was  George  Adamski. 
Adamski  had  a  long  history  in  California — 
going  back  to  the  1930s — as  a  kind  of  minor 
guru.  When  flying  saucers  rose  to  prominence 
in  the  late  1940s,  Adamski  produced  photo¬ 
graphs  of  spaceships  in  the  atmosphere  and 
near  the  moon.  On  November  20,  1952,  ac¬ 
companied  by  six  associates,  including  George 
Hunt  Williamson,  he  went  out  into  the  desert 
to  meet  a  landed  saucer  and  its  pilot,  a  blond¬ 
haired,  angelic  figure  whom  Adamski  would 
call  Orthon.  Adamski  went  on  to  write  books, 
lecture  all  over  the  world,  and  become  the 
single  most  controversial  saucer  personality  of 
the  1950s.  Though  despised  by  conservative 
ufologists,  who  charged  that  his  accounts  of 
meetings  with  Venusians,  Martians,  and  Satur- 


Contactees  71 


UFO  contactee  George  Adamski  (left)  being  interviewed  on  television  by  Long  John  Nebel  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


nians  amounted  to  bad  science  fiction,  he  was 
also  widely  revered. 

In  August  1953,  more  than  ten  thousand 
persons  attended  the  Interplanetary  Spacecraft 
Convention  at  Van  Tassel’s  residence  in  Giant 
Rock,  California.  The  speakers  were  mostly 
the  new  contactee  stars.  The  movement  was 
growing  rapidly,  becoming  a  worldwide  phe¬ 
nomenon.  It  also  produced  a  small  library  of 
books  and  newsletters.  Over  the  course  of  the 
next  few  years,  other  contactees  rose  to  occult 
celebrity.  Many  were  physical  contactees,  but, 
in  time,  channelers  and  automatic  writers — 
most  of  whom  did  not  seek  publicity  or 
profit — dominated  the  ranks. 

Not  everyone  was  willing  to  take  the  space 
people  at  their  word.  Channeling  contactee 
Trevor  James  Constable  warned  that  some  of 
them  were  demons  in  disguise.  Some  years 
later,  occult-oriented  ufologist  John  A.  Keel 
wrote,  “The  demons,  devils,  and  false  angels 
were  recognized  as  liars  and  plunderers  by 


early  man.  These  same  impostors  now  appear 
as  long-haired  Venusians”  (Keel,  1970). 
Christian  fundamentalist  authors  of  UFO 
books  expressed  similar  suspicions. 

Adamski  s  death  in  April  1965  marked  the 
passing  of  the  era  of  the  physical  contactees. 
Even  so,  the  most  successful  contactee  of  later 
years  was  himself  a  physical  contactee,  Eduard 
“Billy”  Meier,  a  rural  Swiss  man  with  a  back¬ 
ground  in  the  esoteric.  Like  Adamski  and  his 
first-generation  counterparts,  Meier  put  forth 
photographs,  artifacts,  and  allegedly  confir¬ 
matory  testimony  to  back  up  his  stories  of  in- 
the-flesh  meetings  with  space  people  and  of 
rides  in  their  spacecraft.  Meier’s  extraterrestri¬ 
als  are  from  the  Pleiades  star  system.  But  like 
Adamski’s  Venusians,  they  are  handsome  and 
beautiful,  with  blond  hair  and  a  generally 
northern  European  appearance.  Unlike  Adam¬ 
ski’s  and  just  about  everybody  else’s  space  peo¬ 
ple,  Meier’s  have  a  specifically  antireligious 
message;  the  Pleiadeans,  according  to  Meier, 


72  Cosmic  Awareness 


believe  only  in  the  laws  of  nature.  It  is  also 
safe  to  say  that  unlike  other  contactees, 
Meier — a  keen  businessman — has  reaped  a 
significant,  and  continuing,  financial  reward 
from  his  supposed  experiences.  He  has  also 
been  at  the  receiving  end  of  criticism  and  de¬ 
bunking  efforts.  After  divorcing  him,  his  ex- 
wife  told  investigators  that  his  claims  are 
without  factual  basis. 

In  the  United  States,  a  major  force  in  the 
movement  has  been  the  annual  Rocky  Moun¬ 
tain  Conference  on  UFO  Investigation,  which 
has  taken  up  where  the  Giant  Rock  conven¬ 
tions  (the  last  held  in  1977)  left  off.  Started  in 
1980  by  R.  Leo  Sprinkle,  a  psychologist  and 
counselor  at  the  University  of  Wyoming,  it 
meets  once  a  year,  usually  in  the  summer,  and 
attracts  contactees  from  all  over,  though  most 
are  from  ranches,  farms,  and  small  towns  of 
the  Great  Plains,  underscoring  the  folk  or 
ground-level  nature  of  the  movement. 

Contactees  are  different  from  abductees — 
whose  experiences  became  known  only  in  the 
1960s  and  did  not  become  a  major  part  of  the 
UFO  controversy  until  the  1980s — in  several 
ways.  A  principal  difference  is  that  abductees 
tend  to  fit  the  profile  of  ordinary  citizens,  in 
other  words,  people  without  a  background  in 
occultism;  in  that  way,  they  are  also  like  most 
witnesses  to  UFOs.  Abductees  also  report 
being  taken  against  their  will,  and  many  con¬ 
sider  the  experience  traumatic.  Most  do  not 
claim  to  have  attained  superior  wisdom  from 
the  experience,  and  most  assert  that  their 
communications  with  their  captors  were  de¬ 
void  of  messages  of  cosmic  uplift.  Yet  in  time 
contactee-oriented  writers  and  investigators 
began  to  see  abductions  as  contacts  by  other 
means.  Some  abductees  come  to  accept  their 
experiences  as  painful  but  necessary  learning 
experiences.  Harvard  University  psychiatrist 
John  E.  Mack,  whose  study  of  abduction  re¬ 
ports  has  convinced  him  that  the  aliens  have 
benevolent  intentions,  has  stated,  “If,  in  fact, 
the  alien  beings  are  closer  to  the  divine  source 
or  anima  mundi  than  human  beings  generally 
seem  to  be  .  .  .  their  presence  among  us,  how¬ 
ever  cruel  and  traumatic  in  some  instances, 


may  be  part  of  a  larger  process  that  is  bringing 
us  back  to  God”  (Mack,  1994). 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Adamski,  George; 
Ascended  Masters;  Ashtar;  Bethurum,  Truman; 
Channeling;  Keel,  John  Alva;  Meier,  Eduard 
“Billy”;  Orthon;  Sprinkle,  Ronald  Leo;  Van  Tas¬ 
sel,  George  W;  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Adamski,  George,  1955.  Inside  the  Space  Ships.  New 
York:  Abelard-Schuman. 

Bartholomew,  Robert  E.,  and  George  S.  Howard, 
1998.  UFOs  and  Alien  Contact:  Two  Centuries  of 
Mystery.  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 

Bord,  Janet,  and  Colin  Bord,  1991.  Life  beyond 
Planet  Earth?  Man’s  Contacts  with  Space  People. 
London:  GraftonBooks. 

Curran,  Douglas,  1985.  In  Advance  of  the  Landing: 
Folk  Concepts  of  Outer  Space.  New  York:  Abbeville 
Press. 

Flournoy,  Theodore,  1963.  From  India  to  the  Planet 
Mars:  A  Study  of  a  Case  of  Somnambulism.  Trans¬ 
lated  reprint  of  1899  edition.  New  Hyde  Park, 
NY:  University  Books. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  UFOs:  Operation  Trojan  Horse. 
New  York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 

Mack,  John  E„  1994.  Abdtiction:  Human  Encounters 
with  Aliens.  New  York:  Charles  Scribners  Sons. 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1995.  “The  Contactees:  A  Sur¬ 
vey.”  In  James  R.  Lewis,  ed.  The  Gods  Have 
Landed:  New  Religions  from  Other  Worlds,  1-13. 
Albany,  NY:  State  University  of  New  York  Press. 

Reeve,  Bryant,  and  Helen  Reeve,  1957.  Flying  Saucer 
Pilgrimage.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

Stupple,  David  W,  1994.  “Historical  Links  Between 
the  Occult  and  Flying  Saucers.”  Journal  of  UFO 
Studies  5  (new  series):  93-108. 


Cosmic  Awareness 

“Cosmic  Awareness”  first  spoke  in  1962 
through  a  retired  army  officer,  William 
Durby,  who  harbored  metaphysical  interests. 
When  asked  who  or  what  it  was,  Cosmic 
Awareness  said  it  was  a  “total  mind  that  is  not 
any  unity  other  than  that  of  universality” 
(Melton,  1996).  The  following  year  an  organ¬ 
ization  was  formed  around  the  communica¬ 
tions  in  response  to  specific  instructions  from 
Awareness  to  that  effect. 

After  Duby  died  in  1967,  the  organization 
split  into  seven  factions,  all  at  odds  over  which 
heretofore-secret  teachings  should  be  made 
public  and  which  should  be  kept  only  among 


Cottingley  fairies  73 


members.  Out  of  the  strife  Cosmic  Awareness 
Communications,  which  had  the  strongest 
links  to  the  earliest  group,  emerged  the 
strongest.  Based  in  Olympia,  Washington,  it 
survives  today  and  maintains  a  sometimes 
controversial  presence  on  the  New  Age  scene. 

Its  head,  Paul  Shockley,  continues  to  chan¬ 
nel  teachings  from  Awareness.  His  organiza¬ 
tion  characterizes  Awareness  as  “the  Force  that 
expressed  Itself  through  Jesus  of  Nazareth,  the 
Buddha,  Krishna,  Mohammed  and  other 
great  avatars  who  served  as  ‘Channels’  for 
what  is  commonly  known  as  ‘God,’  and 
which  expresses  Itself  once  again  as  the  world 
begins  to  enter  the  New  Age  of  spiritual  con¬ 
sciousness  and  awareness”  (“Cosmic  Aware¬ 
ness  Communications,”  1994). 

Awareness  teaches  that  the  United  States  of 
America  came  into  being  through  interven¬ 
tion  with  the  Founding  Fathers.  The  motive 
was  to  allow  personal  freedom,  which  would 
accelerate  the  process  of  change  through 
which  human  beings  must  go  to  be  reunited 
with  Awareness.  The  result  will  be  a  “United 
States  of  Awareness,  where  entities  no  longer 
feel  trapped  by  the  physical  plane,  but  may  re¬ 
alize  their  true  identity  as  being  cosmic  beings 
of  life,  light  and  energy”  (“Cosmic  Awareness 
Introduces  Itself,”  n.d.). 

Further  Reading 

“Cosmic  Awareness  Communications,”  1994.  http:// 
net.info.nl/cosmic.html 

“Cosmic  Awareness  Introduces  Itself  to  the  World,” 
n.d.  http://www.transactual.com/cac/intro.html 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  Ameri  - 
can  Religions.  Fifth  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale 
Research. 

Cottingley  fairies 

The  Cottingley  fairies  came  into  being  in 
1917  as  images  on  photographs  produced  by 
two  Yorkshire  girls,  Frances  Griffiths,  ten,  and 
her  cousin  Elsie  Wright,  thirteen.  The  inci¬ 
dent  began  as  a  childish  trick  to  settle  a  score 
with  adult  authority  figures  but  ended  as  one 
of  the  more  bizarre  episodes  in  the  history  of 
both  photography  and  occultism.  It  would 
take  six  decades  for  the  truth  to  emerge. 


Frances  and  her  mother  and  Elsie  and  her 
parents  shared  a  house  in  Cottingley,  near 
Bradford,  Yorkshire,  while  Frances’s  father 
served  in  World  War  I.  When  Frances  fell  into 
a  brook,  one  day,  and  came  home  soaking 
wet,  she  explained  that  the  mishap  had  oc¬ 
curred  while  she  was  playing  with  the  fairies 
who  lived  there.  She  was  punished  anyway. 
Offended  at  her  friend’s  treatment,  Elsie  sug¬ 
gested  that  they  borrow  her  father’s  camera, 
take  pictures  of  fairies,  persuade  their  parents 
of  the  fairies’  authenticity,  then  later  an¬ 
nounce  that  they  were  fake.  They  would  then 
clinch  their  case  by  reminding  their  parents 
that  the  adults  had  lied  to  them  about  Father 
Christmas. 

Knowing  nothing  of  the  scheme,  of  course, 
Arthur  Wright  loaned  his  daughter  his  camera 
and  provided  her  with  a  single  plate.  An  hour 
later  the  girls  returned  from  the  brook  and 
told  Wright  that  they  had  photographed  a 
fairy.  He  did  not  believe  them,  but  when  he 
developed  the  picture,  he  saw  four  tiny, 
winged  women  in  front  of  Frances.  The  fig¬ 
ures  looked  like  paper  cutouts,  but  the  skepti¬ 
cal  elders  could  not  extract  an  admission  from 
the  children.  A  month  later,  a  reluctant 
Wright  gave  Elsie  access  to  the  camera  once 
more.  The  result  was  a  second  picture,  this 
one  of  a  gnome  whom  Elsie  appeared  to  be 
inviting  to  jump  into  her  lap.  Annoyed  at 
what  he  took  to  be  a  continuing  joke,  Wright 
kept  the  camera  out  of  his  daughter’s  hands 
thereafter. 

That  would  have  been  that;  however,  in 
1920,  Polly  Wright,  Elsie’s  mother,  attended  a 
lecture  on  fairy  lore.  Afterward,  she  brought 
up  the  photographs  to  the  speaker,  who  im¬ 
mediately  asked  if  he  could  see  prints.  These 
prints  soon  found  their  way  into  the  hands  of 
Theosophist  Edward  Gardner,  a  believer  in 
fairies.  The  Wrights  provided  him  with  copies 
of  the  originals,  which  Gardner  showed  to  an 
acquaintance  knowledgeable  in  photography. 
The  expert  stated,  guardedly,  that  he  could  see 
no  evidence  of  fraud.  Excited,  Gardner  dis¬ 
cussed  the  pictures  in  a  lecture  that  May,  and 
soon  Sir  Arthur  Conan  Doyle,  the  revered  au- 


74  Cottingley  fairies 


Frances  Griffiths  with  “fairies,  ’’photographed  at  Cottingley,  West  Yorkshire,  July  191 7  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


thor  of  rhe  Sherlock  Holmes  stories  and  then 
an  avid  spiritualist,  heard  about  the  matter. 
Doyle  had  Gardner  take  the  pictures  to  the 
Kodak  laboratory  in  London,  where  two  ex¬ 
perts  neither  endorsed  nor  repudiated  them. 
In  the  summer,  when  Gardner  met  the 
Wrights  for  the  first  time,  he  provided  Elsie 
with  a  modern  camera.  In  short  order,  she  and 
Frances  had  three  new  fairy  photographs. 

Doyle  wrote  two  articles  for  the  popular 
magazine  The  Strand  (December  1920  and 
March  1921  issues),  declaring  the  pictures  as 
proof  of  the  existence  of  fairies.  Doyle  en¬ 
dured  a  great  deal  of  ridicule  for  his  advocacy 
of  what  many  saw  as  a  transparent  hoax,  but 
that  did  not  stop  him  from  elaborating  on  the 
matter  in  a  revealingly  titled  book,  The  Com  - 
ing  of  the  Fairies  (1922).  The  year  before,  in 
1921,  a  self-described  clairvoyant  named 
Geoffrey  Hodson,  also  a  Theosophist,  had  ac¬ 
companied  the  girls  to  the  beck  where  the 
fairies  lived.  He  claimed  to  have  observed 


many  of  them,  though  the  girls  saw  nothing 
and  attempts  to  photograph  the  entities  came 
to  naught. 

Two  and  a  half  decades  later,  Gardner 
wrote  a  memoir  of  the  episode.  He  was  still 
convinced  of  the  authenticity  of  the  Cotting¬ 
ley  fairies.  Occultists  who  championed  the 
pictures  noted  that  the  two  girls,  now  grown 
women,  had  never  admitted  to  hoaxing,  even 
when  prompted  to  do  so.  Still,  their  answers 
tended  to  be  more  equivocal  than  their  advo¬ 
cates  seemed  to  understand;  when  they  said, 
for  example,  that  these  were  photographs  of 
“figments  of  our  imaginations,”  the  occultists 
assumed  they  were  talking  about  “thought 
forms” — paranormal  projections  from  the 
mind  to  photographic  film.  But  in  a  1975  in¬ 
terview  for  Woman  magazine,  the  two  old 
women  appeared  to  respond  more  positively 
to  the  inevitable  questions.  The  following 
year,  when  asked  by  Yorkshire  Television  if 
the  photos  were  fakes,  Frances’s  response  was 


Curry  75 


simple — “Of  course  not” — spoken  as  if  the 
question  were  a  foolish  and  impertinent  one. 

That,  however,  was  the  last  time  the 
women  would  maintain  the  pretense.  In 

1982,  The  Unexplained,  a  British  magazine, 
revealed  that  the  two  had  confessed.  In  early 

1983,  they  provided  a  signed  statement  to 
British  Journal  of  Photography  editor  Geoffrey 
Crawley,  who  then  wrote  a  long,  definitive  ac¬ 
count  of  the  curious  episode.  The  women  did 
not  tell  Crawley  quite  everything;  they  said 
they  wanted  to  keep  some  of  the  details  to 
themselves  for  a  book  they  intended  to  write. 
Neither  lived  long  enough,  however,  to  pro¬ 
duce  the  proposed  volume.  In  a  final,  curious 
footnote,  Frances  insisted  to  her  death  that 
though  the  pictures  did  not  show  real  fairies, 
she  had  seen  real  fairies  in  the  beck  when  she 
and  Elsie  were  friends  and  playmates. 

A  well-reviewed  1997  film,  Fairy  Tale:  A 
True  Story  dramatized  the  story,  with  Peter 
O’Toole  playing  Doyle. 

See  Also:  Fairies  encountered 

Further  Reading 

Clapham,  Walter,  1975.  “There  Were  Fairies  at  the 
Bottom  of  the  Garden.”  Woman  (October): 

42-43,  45. 

Cooper,  Joe,  1982.  “Cottingley:  At  Last  the  Truth.” 
The  Unexplained  117:  2238-2340. 

Crawley,  Geoffrey,  1982,  1983.  “That  Astonishing 
Affair  of  the  Cottingley  Fairies.”  British  Journal  of 
Photography  Pt.  I  (December  14):  1375-1380; 
Pt.  II  (December  31):  1406—1411,  1413—1414; 
Pt.  Ill  (January  7):  9-15;  Pt.  IV  (January  21): 
66-71;  Pt.  V  (January  28):  91-96;  Pt.  VI  (Febru¬ 
ary  4):  117-121;  Pt.  VII  (February  11): 

142-145,  153,  159;  Pt.  VIII  (February  18): 
170-171;  Pt.  IX  (April  1):  332-338;  Pt.  X  (April 
8):  362-366. 

Doyle,  Sir  Arthur  Conan,  1922.  The  Coming  of  the 
Fairies.  New  York:  George  H.  Doran  Company. 

Gardner,  Edward  L.,  1945.  Fairies:  The  Cottingley 
Photographs  and  Their  Sequel.  London:  Theo- 
sophical  Publishing  blouse. 

Hitchens,  Christopher,  1997.  “Fairy  Tales  Can 
Come  True.  .  .  .”  Vanity  Fair  446  (October):  204, 
206,  208,210. 

Hodson,  Geoffrey,  1925.  Fairies  at  Work  and  at  Play. 
London:  Theosophical  Publishing  House. 

Sanderson,  S.  F.,  1973.  “The  Cottingley  Fairy  Pho¬ 
tographs:  A  Re-Appraisal  of  the  Evidence.”  Folk  - 
lore  84  (Summer):  89-103. 


Smith,  Paul,  1991.  “The  Cottingley  Fairies:  The  End 
of  a  Legend.”  In  Peter  Narvaez,  ed.  The  Good  Peo  - 
pie:  New  Fairylore  Essays,  371-405.  Lexington: 
University  Press  of  Kentucky. 

The  Council 

William  LePar  of  North  Canton,  Ohio,  chan¬ 
nels  the  Council,  a  single  voice  speaking  for 
twelve  souls  communicating  from  the  Celes¬ 
tial  Level  of  the  God-Made  Heavenly  Realms. 
This,  the  Council  says,  is  the  only  time  in  all 
of  history  that  human  beings  have  been  con¬ 
tacted  in  this  way.  Since  the  original,  involun¬ 
tary  contact  in  the  early  1970s,  the  Council 
has  generated  hundreds  of  thousands  of  words 
of  discourse. 

LePar  heads  the  SOL  Association  for  Re¬ 
search,  a  nonprofit,  tax-exempt  organiza¬ 
tion.  It  publishes  a  newsletter,  tapes,  videos, 
and  books  and  sponsors  lectures  and  a  lend¬ 
ing  library. 

Further  Reading 

“Biographical  Sketch  of  William  Allen  LePar,”  n.d. 
http://www.solarpress.com/about/BIO-BILL. 
HTM 

Curry 

In  a  published  letter  to  author  and  UFO  ab- 
ductee  Whitley  Strieber,  an  anonymous  man 
recounts  an  otherworldly  encounter  he  experi¬ 
enced  at  the  age  of  eight,  while  living  on  an 
Indian  reservation  in  South  Dakota.  The  cor¬ 
respondent  said  he  found  himself  inexplicably 
outside  the  house  in  the  middle  of  the  night, 
where  he  saw  a  smiling  man  who  was  some¬ 
how  “different,”  with  larger  than  normal  eyes 
and  a  small  amount  of  hair  on  his  head.  In¬ 
stinctively,  the  boy  knew  the  stranger’s  name 
was  Curry,  though  later  in  life  he  learned  that 
curry  is  “actually  a  sort  of  spice  from  India.” 

The  stranger  led  the  boy  to  an  odd-looking 
black  car.  Inside  it  was  a  man  who  looked  to 
be  twenty  years  old  or  so.  The  man  resembled 
Curry,  and  somehow  the  boy  understood  that 
he  was  to  comfort  him  because  the  man  was 
frightened.  The  “car”  ascended  and  flew  rap¬ 
idly  to  a  remote  location  where  there  was  a 


76  Cyclopeans 


crossroads.  A  “ship  or  shuttle”  then  took  the 
boy  and  his  charge  apparently  into  space,  but 
Strieber’s  correspondent  had  no  memory  of 
anything  except  being  dropped  off  and  seeing 
Curry  again.  Now  Curry  was  wearing  a  hood 
that  covered  everything  but  his  eyes. 

This  was  only  the  first  of  a  number  of  para¬ 
normal  encounters  the  correspondent  would 
have  over  the  years,  though  this  one,  appar¬ 
ently,  was  his  last  with  Curry.  He  refers  to 
them  as  “dreams,  or  experiences,  depending 
on  how  you  want  to  look  at  it.” 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Strieber,  Whitley 

Further  Reading 

Strieber,  Whitley,  and  Anne  Strieber,  eds.,  1997.  The 
Communion  Letters.  New  York:  HarperPrism. 


Cyclopeans 

Argentine  ufologist  Fabio  Picasso  coined  the 
term  “Cyclopeans”  to  characterize  one-eyed 
aliens  whose  alleged  presence  is  the  subject  of 
a  handful  of  South  American  press  accounts. 
Picasso  acknowledges  that  some  accounts  are 
certain  or  likely  hoaxes,  and  others  have  not 
been  well  investigated.  Nonetheless,  as  of 
1992,  he  had  found  eleven  such  reports. 

One  such  case  is  said  to  have  occurred  on 
August  28,  1963,  at  Sagrada  Familia,  Brazil. 
Three  boys  witnessed  the  sudden  appearance 
of  a  beam  of  light  in  their  backyard.  Inside 
the  light,  a  transparent,  ball-shaped  object 
hovered.  Inside  it,  four  one-eyed  entities, 
three  males  and  one  female,  clad  in  tight  cov¬ 
eralls,  were  visible.  One  stepped  out  of  the 
UFO  and  floated  in  the  air,  communicating 
first  by  gestures,  then  by  telepathy,  to  the 
children  (the  content  of  the  message  is  not 
specified).  The  being  returned  to  the  craft, 
which  then  departed. 

At  Torrent,  Argentina,  in  February  1965, 
farm  laborers,  returning  home  late  at  night 
from  hunting,  noticed  five  small  figures. 
When  one  of  the  hunters  acted  in  a  threaten¬ 
ing  matter,  the  shapes  suddenly  grew  larger 
until  they  were  around  eight  feet  tall.  The  be¬ 
ings  chased  the  hunters  to  a  house.  Later,  one 
man  escaped  from  the  house  with  the  one¬ 


eyed  entities  in  hot  pursuit.  One  managed  to 
grab  him  with  its  hairy  hands,  but  the  man 
broke  loose  and  got  away.  Subsequently,  the 
others  effected  an  escape  by  van. 

“Cyclopean  beings  can  be  classified  into  two 
subtypes,”  Picasso  writes.  “There  are  short  Cy¬ 
clopeans  . .  .  and  tall  ones.  .  .  .  The  latter  beings 
often  behave  aggressively”  (Picasso,  1992). 

Further  Reading 

Picasso,  Fabio,  1992.  “Infrequent  Types  of  South 
American  Humanoids.”  Strange  Magazine  9 
(Spring/Summer):  34-35,  55. 


Cymatrili 

Enid  Brady  was  a  spiritualist  medium  who  led 
a  small  church  in  Holly  Hill,  Florida.  In  the 
early  1950s,  she  began  to  experience  tele¬ 
pathic  communications  from  the  “master 
teachers  of  Venus.”  One  of  them  was  Cyma¬ 
trili.  He  and  his  companions  were  based  in  a 
giant  ship  in  orbit  above  the  southeastern 
United  States.  Venusians  look  much  like  hu¬ 
mans  but  are  finer  featured.  Their  civilization 
is  advanced,  peaceful,  and  free  of  disease, 
poverty,  and  conflict.  Venusians  live  to  be  sev¬ 
eral  hundred  years  old. 

Brady  was  little  noted  outside  contactee 
circles  until  the  summer  of  1957,  when  a  re¬ 
tired  army  major,  Wayne  S.  Aho,  took  tape 
recordings  to  Washington,  DC,  of  Brady’s 
communications  from  Cymatrili,  Huma 
Matra,  Mandall,  and  John  (the  latter  two 
“ventla” — saucer — pilots).  Aho  visited  the 
Pentagon.  He  persuaded  Defense  Depart¬ 
ment  personnel  to  listen  to  an  hour  and  a 
half’s  worth  of  the  tapes.  A  spokesman  pro¬ 
nounced  the  messages  “unimpressive  and  un¬ 
convincing”  (“Pentagon,”  1957).  Aho  later 
played  the  tape  for  a  United  Press  Interna¬ 
tional  reporter,  who  wrote  a  tongue-in-cheek 
piece  on  the  experience. 

In  other  channelings,  Brady’s  Venusians  re¬ 
lated  that  in  1955,  Martians  had  landed  at 
Edwards  Air  Force  Base  in  southern  Califor¬ 
nia  and  were  taken  into  custody.  Engineers 
from  the  air  force  learned  a  great  deal  about 
extraterrestrial  technology  from  studying  the 


Cymatrili  77 


saucer  the  Martians  had  arrived  in,  and  that 
technology  was  incorporated  into  later,  flying¬ 
wing,  experimental  aircraft. 

Bradys  space  informants  also  told  her  that 
landings  would  begin  in  November  1957,  and 
that  in  1962,  Earth  would  enter  a  New  Age 
under  the  guidance  of  friendly  extraterrestrials. 


See  Also:  Channeling;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Bryant,  Larry  W.,  1983.  “Enid  Brady’s  E-T  Contact 
Legacy.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal  179  (January): 
12-13. 

“Pentagon  Hears  ‘Voices  from  Venus’  but  Fails  to  Be 
Excited  about  Them,”  1957.  The  Saucers  Report 
2,  3  (October/November):  8-9. 


David  of  Landa 

David  of  the  planet  Landa,  a  distant  world 
not  recognized  by  conventional  astronomy, 
channeled  through  Keith  Macdonald  (d. 
1999),  a  Grayslake,  Illinois,  car  mechanic  who 
lived  a  quiet  life  outside  the  public  spotlight. 
Macdonald  is  typical  of  the  sorts  of  persons 
ufologist/occultist  John  A.  Keel  has  called 
“silent  contactees.”  Unlike  the  flamboyant  fig¬ 
ures  who  seek  attention  and  audiences,  Mac¬ 
donald  confided  his  experiences  only  with 
family  and  trusted  friends. 

Macdonald  became  aware  of  David  while 
undergoing  hypnotic  regression  directed  by 
his  close  friend  Ron  Owen.  In  1974,  Mac¬ 
donald,  his  wife,  and  two  sons  saw  what  they 
believed  to  be  a  UFO  hovering  over  a  field 
across  the  street  from  their  townhouse.  Four 
years  later,  reliving  the  experience  through 
hypnosis,  he  “recalled”  being  taken  into  the 
object  and  undergoing  a  terrifying  abduction 
at  the  hands  of  gray-skinned  humanoids. 
Macdonald  pursued  recalling  the  experience 
through  further  hypnosis  sessions  until  one 
session  suddenly  ended  with  his  declaring 
that  they  could  go  no  further  because 
“they’re  here — right  in  the  room  with  us!” 
(Clark,  1986).  Then  an  entity  who  identified 
himself  as  “David”  began  speaking  through 
Macdonald. 


From  then  on  David  appeared  in  regular 
channelings.  During  these  channelings,  Mac¬ 
donald  would  lapse  into  a  trance  state  and 
speak  in  David’s  voice.  Afterward  he  could 
not  recall  any  of  the  content  and  would  de¬ 
pend  on  Owen  to  explain  what  words  had 
passed  through  his  mouth.  When  David 
wished  to  communicate  only  with  Macdon¬ 
ald,  however,  no  trance  was  necessary.  A 
“voice”  inside  his  head  would  speak,  and 
sometimes  Macdonald  would  psychically  per¬ 
ceive  David  and  other  people  of  Landa.  Mac¬ 
donald  described  the  men  as  strikingly  hand¬ 
some,  the  women  beautiful.  All  wore  robes 
and  reminded  Macdonald  of  Greek  gods  and 
goddesses.  Sometimes  David  came  through 
spontaneously  when  Macdonald  was  speaking 
with  Owen  over  the  phone.  At  first,  the  chan¬ 
nelings — a  word  Macdonald  and  Owen  had 
not  heard  until  they  attended  a  Wyoming 
contactee  conference  sponsored  by  psycholo¬ 
gist/ contactee  R.  Leo  Sprinkle — were  rela¬ 
tively  infrequent.  With  the  passing  of  time, 
they  occurred  more  often,  on  occasion,  as 
many  as  three  or  four  times  a  week. 

Other  extraterrestrials  soon  were  speaking 
through  Macdonald.  There  was  Corinthian, 
David’s  wife.  Others  were  Pauline,  Lenoir, 
Chieftain,  and  Isaiah.  Some  would  not  give 
their  names,  insisting  names  were  unimpor- 


79 


80  David  of  Landa 


tant.  David,  however,  did  most  of  the  com¬ 
municating.  Whenever  a  particular  question 
was  asked,  he  would  excuse  himself  and  say  he 
had  to  clear  the  answer  with  higher  authority 
After  a  pause,  from  a  few  seconds  to  a  few 
minutes,  he  would  return  either  to  answer  the 
question  or  to  announce  he  was  not  permitted 
to  answer  it.  Other  times,  though  rarely,  the 
entity  with  whom  David  had  conferred,  the 
Master,  would  speak,  always  briefly.  The  Mas¬ 
ter’s  voice  had  an  odd,  eerie  quality  and  a  tone 
of  absolute  authority. 

Over  many  dozens  of  hours  of  channeling, 
this  story  emerged: 

Just  before  Moses  was  given  the  Ten  Com¬ 
mandments,  seven  citizens  of  Landa  were 
elected  by  the  Masters  for  a  mission  on  Earth. 
The  leader  of  the  Seven  Select,  also  called  the 
Habanas  or  the  Warriors  of  God,  was  Daniel 
(pronounced  Dan  -yell),  the  son  of  David  and 
Corinthian.  Once  on  Earth,  the  Habanas’s 
souls  occupied  human  bodies.  With  the  pass¬ 
ing  of  centuries,  during  which  the  Habanas 
reincarnated  repeatedly,  other  Habanas  ar¬ 
rived,  filling  Earth  with  extraterrestrial  agents 
who  with  each  life  gained  new  knowledge  that 
would  be  useful  when  the  day  of  reckoning — 
the  cleansing  of  the  human  race  and  the  final 
showdown  with  the  evil  forces  of  the  uni¬ 
verse — came.  This  climax  would  occur  within 
the  lifetimes  of  most  living  people.  In  this  life, 
Daniel  was  Keith  Macdonald. 

David  said,  “Keith  has  now  graduated  and 
become  a  prophet.  He  is  a  prophet  of  Christ. 
He  is  a  prophet  of  God.”  The  people  of 
Landa,  devout  Christians,  practice  a  form  of 
Roman  Catholicism.  Raised  a  Protestant, 
Macdonald  knew  little  of  Catholicism  until 
the  Landanians  contacted  him. 

According  to  a  channeling  from  the  Master 
in  1985,  “soon  there  will  be  forty  craft  of 
Landa  truly  visible  to  the  eyes  of  all  humans. 
Three  more  craft  shall  come  down  to  receive 
Keith.  This  will  be  done  to  gain  the  attention 
of  the  many,  for  Keith  has  a  job.  His  first  job 
will  be  to  be  received  by  us  of  Landa,  to  be 
taken  there  for  forty  days  and  nights.  During 
that  time  forty  craft  of  Landa  will  travel  to 


every  nation  to  show  Keith  has  been  received. 
When  the  meeting  is  over,  Keith  will  return  to 
meet  with  the  leaders  of  the  churches  and  the 
nations.  He  will  demand  the  release  of  the 
Scrolls  for  all  human  beings  to  see  and  under¬ 
stand.”  The  Master  explained  that  earthlings 
cannot  now  tell  the  difference  between  good 
and  evil  because  the  Scrolls — suppressed  an¬ 
cient  religious  documents — have  not  been 
available  to  them. 

The  Scrolls  contain  the  hidden  history  of 
humanity,  revealing  all  the  truths  that  God, 
Jesus,  and  Mary  wanted  humans  to  know  but 
were  concealed  because  they  did  not  suit  the 
purposes  of  earthly  political  leaders  and 
church  authorities.  Keith  himself,  the  Master 
asserted,  had  this  knowledge  within  himself, 
though  it  had  not  yet  been  released  into  his 
conscious  mind. 

At  the  time  of  the  Lifting — which  is  what 
the  Landanians  called  the  occasion  that  Mac¬ 
donald  would  be  taken  aboard  a  spacecraft 
(one  of  three  that  would  appear  in  the  same 
empty  field  where  evil  aliens  had  kidnapped 
him  in  1974)  and  flown  home  to  Landa — 
there  would  be  thousands  of  witnesses.  On 
September  22,  1985,  Macdonald  encountered 
the  apparitional  forms  of  David  and 
Corinthian,  who  informed  him  that  an  earth¬ 
quake  would  devastate  San  Francisco  soon. 
Upset,  he  pleaded  for  the  innocent  lives  that 
would  be  lost,  but  his  space  friends/parents 
soberly  replied,  “It  is  inevitable.  You  must 
pray  for  the  souls  of  those  who  will  be  lost  and 
for  those  who  will  miss  them.” 

Convinced  that  the  earthquake  would 
occur  any  day,  Macdonald  waited  gloomily 
and  anxiously.  Nothing  happened.  But  then 
on  the  morning  of  October  7,  as  Macdonald 
was  letting  the  dog  out,  a  blinding  light  shot 
out  of  the  sky  and  struck  him  in  the  face.  He 
took  this  to  mean  that  the  first  of  the  three 
Landanian  craft  that  would  carry  him  away 
was  in  place. 

The  following  day,  while  talking  with 
Owen  on  the  phone,  David  took  over.  He  said 
that  a  physical,  in-the-flesh  meeting  between 
Keith  and  David  would  occur  in  two  days  in 


Dead  extraterrestrials  81 


Keith’s  house.  David  and  Corinthian  did  not 
keep  their  appointment. 

In  the  days  and  weeks  that  followed,  Mac¬ 
donald  experienced  a  series  of  unusually  vivid 
dreams.  One  night  he  dreamed  that  he  had 
been  accepted  back  into  the  military.  To  him 
this  symbolized  his  role  as  a  Warrior  of  God 
about  to  “fight.”  Another  night  he  dreamed 
that  he  was  on  a  college  campus,  knowing 
where  every  building,  every  door,  every  room 
was.  He  heard  professors  lecturing  and  knew 
every  word  they  were  saying.  He  understood 
that  he  had  “graduated”  to  a  level  more  ad¬ 
vanced  than  college.  In  yet  another  dream,  he 
was  gazing  over  a  crowd  of  hundreds  of  peo¬ 
ple,  seeing  deep  inside  each  and  recognizing 
each  one  as  a  fellow  Warrior  of  God,  brother 
and  sister  Habanas  who  would  be  coming 
together  in  the  great  events  yet  to  occur  as 
Earth  met  its  cosmic  destiny.  A  voice  inside 
the  dream  told  him  that  this  was  a  “reunion.” 
A  blinding  light  cut  through  the  dream,  and 
when  Macdonald  sat  bolt  upright  in  bed,  it 
continued  to  shine.  It  was  so  bright  that  he 
had  to  put  his  arm  over  his  face. 

Strange,  ominous  events  seemed  to  point 
to  the  imminent  Lifting.  Twice  on  the  evening 
of  October  23,  as  Macdonald  and  Owen  were 
talking,  the  phone  suddenly  disconnected, 
each  time  with  a  peculiar  squealing  sound.  It 
happened  just  as  they  were  discussing  key 
points  about  Landanian  objectives.  Macdon¬ 
ald  saw  odd  lights  both  inside  the  house  and 
in  the  sky.  Landanians  appeared  with  increas¬ 
ing  frequency,  but  only  Macdonald  could  see 
them.  They  were  invisible  to  his  wife.  Mac¬ 
donald  tried  to  capture  them  on  film,  but  all 
that  the  resulting  photographs  showed  was 
the  interior  of  the  house,  nothing  more. 

Early  in  December,  the  date  of  the  San 
Francisco  earthquake  that  was  to  prefigure  the 
Lifting  appeared  before  his  eyes  in  brilliant 
light:  DECEMBER  22.  He  could  not  only  see 
the  date  but  also  experience  the  sensations  of 
being  in  the  quake.  As  the  days  passed,  the  vi¬ 
sion  of  the  date  recurred  along  with  scenes  of 
devastation.  When  December  22  came  and 
went  with  no  earthquake,  David  told  Keith 


that  the  real  date  was  January  3;  the  twenty- 
second  was  the  date  on  which  the  craft  would 
begin  to  show  themselves.  David  said  that 
Macdonald  should  always  remember,  “There 
is  more  than  one  meaning  to  a  sentence.” 

The  failure  of  assorted  prophecies  never 
entirely  diminished  Keith  Macdonald’s  be¬ 
lief — a  palpably  sincere  one — that  people 
from  Landa  were  communicating  with  him. 
He  learned,  however,  to  be  cautious  about 
their  predictions,  including  promises  of  in- 
the-flesh  meetings  prior  to  the  Lifting.  In  the 
years  that  followed,  growing  health  problems 
forced  Macdonald  into  retirement.  In  his  last 
years,  he  spent  considerable  time  in  the  hospi¬ 
tal.  During  that  period  contacts  occurred 
more  often  in  unusually  lucid  dreams  than 
they  did  via  channeling. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Channeling;  Con- 
tactees;  Keel,  John  Alva;  Sprinkle,  Ronald  Leo 

Further  Reading 

Clark,  Jerome,  1986.  “Waiting  for  the  Space  Broth¬ 
ers.”  Fate  Pt.  I.  39,  3  (March):  47-54;  Pt.  II.  39, 
4  (April):  81-87;  Pt.  III.  39,  5  (May):  68-76. 

Owen,  Ron,  2000.  Private  communication  to 
Jerome  Clark  (January  6). 

Dead  extraterrestrials 

Claims  that  the  bodies  of  extraterrestrials  have 
been  found  in  the  wreckage  of  spacecraft  are 
older  than  the  post-World  War  II  UFO  age. 
As  long  ago  as  1864,  a  French  newspaper  (La 
Pays,  June  17)  reported  the  discovery,  by  two 
American  geologists,  of  a  hollow,  egg-shaped 
rock.  Inside  it  were  various  odd  artifacts.  They 
also  found  the  mummified  remains  of  a  tiny 
humanoid — about  three  feet  tall — with  a  bald 
head  and  an  elephantlike  trunk  growing  out 
of  its  forehead.  On  October  13,  1877,  a 
provincial  paper  in  Argentina  set  the  identical 
tall  tale  in  that  country,  adding  the  detail  that 
the  discoverers  had  taken  the  body  and  arti¬ 
facts  to  a  local  saloon  to  put  on  display. 

In  1897,  during  a  wave  of  UFO  (or,  in  the 
terminology  of  the  time,  “airship”)  sightings, 
ships  crashed  and  Martians  died  in  Illinois 
and  Texas.  In  the  latter  instance,  the  pilot  was 
reportedly  buried  in  a  cemetery  in  a  small 


82  Dead  extraterrestrials 


north  Texas  town.  When  the  latter  tale  was  re¬ 
vived  in  the  late  1960s  and  early  1970s,  hope¬ 
ful  investigators  rushed  to  the  scene,  only  to 
learn  eventually  that  no  such  corpse  or  grave 
had  ever  existed  outside  the  imagination  of  a 
turn-of-the-century  prankster. 

Though  it  did  not  come  to  wider  attention 
until  many  years  later,  a  killing  of  a  tiny  hu¬ 
manoid  reportedly  took  place  in  1913  near 
Farmersville,  Texas.  Three  young  brothers 
were  chopping  cotton  on  their  farm  when 
they  heard  the  family  dogs  barking  and  then 
howling.  On  investigating,  the  boys  saw  the 
dogs  attacking  a  strange  little  man  “no  more 
than  eighteen  inches  high  and  kind  of  a  dark 
green  color,”  one  witness,  an  old  man,  recalled 
in  a  1978  interview.  “His  arms  were  hanging 
down  just  beside  him,  like  they  was  growed 
down  the  side  of  him.  He  had  on  a  kind  of 
hat  that  reminded  me  of  a  Mexican  hat.  .  .  . 
Everything  looked  like  a  rubber  suit  including 
the  hat.”  The  dogs  tore  him  to  pieces,  leaving 
human-looking  organs  and  blood  on  the 
ground.  The  peculiar  tale  was  known  within 
the  family  for  decades.  Though  he  had  a  hard 
time  believing  the  story,  the  investigator 
thought  there  was  no  question  of  the  old 
man’s  sincerity. 

Rumors  of  dead  aliens,  however,  did  not 
enter  popular  culture  in  any  significant  way 
until  1947,  after  Kenneth  Arnolds  June  24 
observation  of  nine  discs  over  Mount  Rainier, 
Washington,  brought  “flying  saucers”  into 
common  currency.  After  initial  theories  that 
tied  the  sightings  to  secret  aviation  experi¬ 
ments  proved  groundless,  those  who  contin¬ 
ued  to  take  the  reports  seriously  slowly  began 
to  wonder  if  visitors  from  other  planets  were 
responsible  for  the  phenomenon.  By  1949, 
rumors  of  recovered  extraterrestrial  bodies 
began  to  see  print,  notably  in  the  entertain¬ 
ment  industry  newspaper  Variety.  Columnist 
Frank  Scully  wrote  that  on  three  occasions  the 
previous  year,  beginning  with  an  incident  in 
Aztec,  New  Mexico,  in  March,  U.S.  Air  Force 
personnel  had  recovered,  at  various  desert 
sites,  the  remains  of  crashed  spacecraft  and 
bodies.  He  expanded  these  allegations  into  a 


book  destined  for  lasting  notoriety,  Behind  the 
Flying  Saucers  (1950).  In  it,  he  identified  his 
source  as  the  pseudonymous  “Dr.  Gee,”  said 
to  be  a  leading  scientific  expert  on  magnetism 
(brought  into  the  investigation  of  the  recovery 
because  it  was  believed  that  the  ships  “proba¬ 
bly  flew  on  magnetic  lines  of  force”).  The 
dead  crews,  human  in  every  respect  except  for 
their  perfect  teeth  and  unfashionable  1890s- 
style  clothes,  were  surmised  to  be  of  Venusian 
origin.  A  subsequent  expose  in  True  magazine 
revealed  that  “Dr.  Gee”  was  veteran  confi¬ 
dence  artist  Leo  GeBauer.  With  his  longtime 
partner-in-crime,  Silas  Newton,  GeBauer  had 
concocted  the  tale  to  sell  bogus  oil-detection 
devices  allegedly  tied  to  advanced  interplane¬ 
tary  technology. 

As  a  result  of  the  episode,  even  persons  oth¬ 
erwise  sympathetically  disposed  to  the  idea  of 
space  visitation  were  deeply  skeptical  of 
crash/retrieval  claims.  Still,  the  claims  circu¬ 
lated  in  a  significant  body  of  saucer  folklore, 
only  a  little  of  which  surfaced  in  the  UFO  lit¬ 
erature.  In  1952,  Jim  and  Coral  Lorenzen  of 
the  newly  formed  Aerial  Phenomena  Research 
Organization  (APRO) — which  would  prove 
among  the  most  influential  and  durable  of  all 
UFO  groups — spoke  with  an  airman  who 
swore  that  four  years  earlier  he  and  others 
from  a  military-scientific  team  had  been  dis¬ 
patched  to  a  New  Mexico  crash  site.  There  he 
had  seen  a  disc  and  learned  that  dead,  little 
men  had  been  taken  from  its  cabin.  Not  long 
afterward,  a  “young  meteorologist”  told  the 
Lorenzens  that  in  1948,  while  visiting  Wright 
Air  Development  Center  (soon  to  be  renamed 
Wright-Patterson  Air  Force  Base)  in  Dayton, 
Ohio,  he  had  spoken  with  an  old  friend,  an 
air  force  man.  The  friend,  in  Coral  Lorenzens 
words,  showed  him  “space  suits  ranging  from 
three  to  about  five  and  a  half  feet  in  height 
and  diagrams  of  a  circular  ship  that  bore  a 
strong  resemblance  to  a  ‘flying  saucer.’  He  said 
that  people  who  laughed  about  flying  saucers 
were  going  to  get  a  big  jolt  some  day — these 
suits  had  been  taken  off  the  bodies  of  men 
who  had  apparently  perished  in  the  crash  of 
their  saucer-shaped  ships”  (Lorenzen,  1962). 


Dead  extraterrestrials  83 


On  May  7,  1955,  a  Caracas,  Venezuela, 
newspaper,  El  Universal,  carried  a  sensational 
story  of  an  incident  supposed  to  have  taken 
place  almost  exactly  five  years  earlier.  A  man 
claimed  that  while  driving  down  a  rural  high¬ 
way  in  Argentina,  he  spotted  a  flying  saucer 
that  had  landed  on  the  side  of  the  road.  Curi¬ 
ous,  he  stopped  his  car,  approached  the  craft, 
and  eventually  boarded  it.  Inside,  he  found 
the  bodies  of  three  little  men  lying  near  an  in¬ 
strument  panel.  After  touching  one,  he  pan¬ 
icked  and  fled,  to  return  the  next  day  to  see 
UFOs  hovering  over  the  site.  Where  the  origi¬ 
nal  craft  had  been  there  was  only  a  pile  of 
warm,  gray  ashes.  Years  later,  a  retrospective 
investigation  by  Argentine  ufologists  deter¬ 
mined  that  the  “witness”  had  made  up  the 
story. 

More  intriguing  was  an  account  given  in 
confidence  to  Isabel  L.  Davis,  one  of  the  most 
intelligent,  hard-headed,  first-generation  ufol¬ 
ogists  and  a  fierce  critic  of  the  more  out¬ 
landish  saucer  tales.  Davis  never  published  the 
account  in  her  lifetime,  but  she  found  it  in¬ 
triguing,  given  that  the  informant,  a  medical 
scientist,  seemed  serious  and  credible.  Even 
so,  the  scientist  s  claim  was  a  fantastic  one.  In 
the  late  1950s,  she  told  Davis,  she  was  di¬ 
rected  to  a  secure,  government-run  facility 
and  ordered  to  examine  body  parts  that  she 
quickly  recognized  as  humanlike  but  not 
human.  Her  superiors  provided  no  explana¬ 
tions  or  further  details,  and  when  her  work 
was  completed,  they  instructed  her  to  tell  no¬ 
body.  As  she  remarked  to  Davis,  she  would 
not  have  done  so  anyway,  since  no  one  would 
have  believed  her. 

Another  tale — this  one  circulated  by  saucer 
personality  and  publisher  Gray  Barker — con¬ 
cerned  Nicholas  von  Poppen,  an  Estonian 
refugee  who  had  fled  his  native  country  when 
Soviet  troops  overran  it  and  slaughtered  his 
family.  That  much  of  the  story  seems  true  (the 
real  Von  Poppen  died  in  Los  Angeles  in 
1976).  Beyond  that,  however,  Barker  and 
truth  parted  company.  He  took  an  unpub¬ 
lished  science-fiction  manuscript  written  by  a 
subscriber  to  his  magazine  The  Saucerian  and 


transformed  it  into  a  “true”  story.  In  the  origi¬ 
nal,  the  wri ter/ subscriber  had  taken  a  colorful, 
real  acquaintance,  Von  Poppen,  and  placed 
him  inside  a  fantasy  in  which  Von  Poppen 
took  photographs  in  New  Mexico  of  a  crashed 
UFO  and  its  occupants.  Barker  took  this  story 
and  embellished  it  further,  then  marketed  it  as 
an  account  of  an  authentic  incident — not  the 
only  hoax  Barker  would  perpetrate  on  his  im¬ 
pressionable  readers. 

In  the  1970s,  ufologist  Leonard  H.  String- 
field,  in  the  face  of  criticism  and  skepticism 
from  some  colleagues,  began  collecting 
crash/retrieval  claims  and  rumors  and  pub¬ 
lishing  them  in  a  series  of  monographs.  None 
amounted  to  much  as  evidence,  though  some 
were  undeniably  interesting,  such  as  the  testi¬ 
mony  of  a  Presbyterian  pastor.  This  man — 
Stringfield  protected  the  names  of  his  inform¬ 
ants — alleged  that  when  he  was  a  boy,  he  and 
his  father  (also  a  clergyman)  visited  the  Mu¬ 
seum  of  Science  and  Industry  in  Chicago. 
During  one  visit,  they  got  lost.  In  their  search 
for  an  exit,  they  accidentally  entered  a  room 
where  a  number  of  humanoid  beings  lay  pre¬ 
served  under  a  glass-covered  case.  Before  they 
could  fully  grasp  what  they  were  seeing,  they 
were  discovered.  The  father  was  pressured  to 
sign  papers  swearing  him  to  silence. 

In  another  alleged  instance,  said  to  have 
taken  place  at  a  New  Jersey  air  force  base  in 
January  1978,  a  sergeant — who  insisted  on 
anonymity — told  Stringfield  that  in  the  early 
morning  hours  a  military  policeman  had  shot 
and  killed  a  humanoid  being  that  he  had  en¬ 
countered  while  chasing  a  UFO  in  his  car. 
The  body  was  then  shipped  off  to  Wright-Pat- 
terson  Air  Force  Base.  The  sergeant  eventually 
provided  an  official-looking  “incident  report,” 
with  the  names  of  witnesses  and  investigators 
inked  out.  Stringfield’s  informant  talked  and 
acted  in  a  manner  that  he  and  fellow  ufologist 
Richard  Hall,  who  interviewed  the  man  in 
person  on  two  occasions,  deemed  sincere,  but, 
despite  a  serious  effort,  they  uncovered  noth¬ 
ing  that  conclusively  verified  the  claim. 

Perhaps  the  most  interesting  of  Stringfield’s 
informants  were  several  “medical  people”  who 


84  Dead  extraterrestrials 


had  performed  autopsies  on  alien  corpses. 
One,  a  physician  who  “served  on  the  staff  of  a 
major  hospital”  (Stringfield,  1980),  provided 
a  detailed  account  of  an  autopsy,  in  the  early 
1950s,  of  a  humanoid  reminiscent  of  the 
gray-skinned,  big-eyed  entities  that  would  fig¬ 
ure  in  abduction  lore  in  later  years.  String- 
field,  who  died  in  December  1994,  never  re¬ 
vealed  the  names  of  these  individuals,  so 
independent  investigation  of  their  stories  and 
status  proved  impossible.  Nor  would  his  fam¬ 
ily  provide  investigators  with  Stringjield’s  files. 
None  disputed  Stringfield’s  integrity,  though 
some  questioned  his  judgment  in  taking  such 
extraordinary  testimony  at  face  value. 

Lecturing  in  London  on  April  14,  1979, 
American  occultist  and  channeler  James  Hur- 
tak  declared  that  a  flying  saucer  had  crashed 
as  early  as  1946.  His  source,  he  said,  was  a 
colleague  who  had  participated  in  the  re¬ 


trieval.  The  crash  occurred  near  Great  Falls, 
Montana.  “The  bodies  were  shipped  to  the 
Edwards  Air  Force  Base  facility  in  Califor¬ 
nia,”  Hurtak  claimed.  “It  was  determined 
that  the  green  hue  on  the  bodies  was  due  to 
the  nature  of  the  chemistry  of  the  fuel  sys¬ 
tem.  After  extensive  studies  the  bodies  were 
put  on  ice  and  sealed  in  aluminum  canisters” 
(Hurtak,  1979). 

In  the  late  1970s,  a  Minnesota  school¬ 
teacher,  William  L.  Moore,  and  a  nuclear  sci¬ 
entist  and  UFO  lecturer,  Stanton  T.  Fried¬ 
man,  got  interested  in  an  incident  that  to 
most  was  an  obscure  footnote:  a  brief  flurry  of 
excitement  in  early  July  1947  over  the  sup¬ 
posed  recovery  of  a  “flying  disc”  near  Roswell, 
New  Mexico.  The  story  had  hit  the  presses 
only  to  be  contradicted  in  a  matter  of  a  few 
hours,  when  the  U.S.  Army  Air  Force  an¬ 
nounced  that  it  had  all  risen  out  of  an  absurd 


Display  showing  a  dead  alien  autopsy  ( with  models)  at  the  UFO  Museum  in  Roswell,  New  Mexico  (Peregrine 
Mendoza/Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Dead  extraterrestrials  85 


misunderstanding  about  a  downed  weather 
balloon.  During  his  travels,  Friedman  met  a 
retired  air  force  officer  who,  at  the  time,  had 
been  stationed  at  Roswell  Army  Air  Field;  the 
officer,  Major  Jesse  A.  Marcel,  had  been  the 
first  uniformed  officer  on  the  site,  and  his  ob¬ 
servation  and  experience  over  the  next  few 
days  put  into  question  the  long- accepted  bal¬ 
loon  explanation.  Friedman  also  interviewed  a 
woman  who  had  worked  at  an  Albuquerque 
radio  station.  She  vividly  remembered  how 
the  U.S.  Air  Force  had  squelched  coverage  of 
the  story.  Both  she  and  Marcel  believed  that 
some  kind  of  extraordinary  event  that  had 
badly  rattled  the  military  had  happened. 

Moore’s  The  Roswell  Incident  (1980), 
written  with  Bermuda  Triangle  popularizer 
Charles  Berlitz,  would  be  only  the  first  of 
many  books  to  address  the  subject.  As  inves¬ 
tigators  spoke  with  a  growing  number  of  in¬ 
formants,  military  and  civilian,  they  estab¬ 
lished  that  a  cover-up,  maintained  in  part  by 
the  threatening  of  witnesses,  had  been  put 
into  place  and  that  the  official  story  was  not 
the  real  story.  Some  witnesses  even  asserted 
that  the  military  had  recovered  bodies  of  lit¬ 
tle  men  at  either  the  original  crash  site  or 
another,  related  one  some  miles  away.  In 
time,  the  Roswell  incident,  as  everyone 
called  it,  was  no  longer  an  arcane  fascination 
of  ufologists  but  a  much-discussed  item  of 
pop  culture,  influencing  any  number  of  tele¬ 
vision  shows,  documentaries,  movies,  jokes, 
and  more. 

After  years  of  denying  that  the  air  force  had 
covered  up  the  Roswell  incident,  the  General 
Accounting  Office,  at  the  behest  of  New  Mex¬ 
ico  Congressman  Steven  Schiff,  searched  offi¬ 
cial  archives  for  relevant  documents,  uncover¬ 
ing  little  of  interest.  Around  the  same  time,  in 
1994,  the  U.S.  Air  Force  declared  that  there 
had  indeed  been  a  cover-up;  it  had  been  of 
Project  Mogul,  a  highly  classified  project  in 
which  balloons  were  sent  aloft  to  monitor 
possible  Soviet  atomic  tests  over  the  horizon. 
A  Mogul  balloon  had  come  down  near 
Roswell,  and  the  military’s  effort  to  keep  it  a 
secret  sparked  the  legend  of  a  UFO  crash.  In 


the  face  of  press  and  popular  skepticism 
(much  of  it  focused  on  the  explanation’s  fail¬ 
ure  to  account  for  reports  of  bodies)  the  U.S. 
Air  Force  renewed  its  inquiries.  On  June  24, 
1997,  it  contended  that  the  supposedly  alien 
bodies  were  in  fact  “anthropomorphic  test 
dummies  that  were  carried  aloft  by  U.S.  Air 
Force  high  altitude  balloons  for  scientific  re¬ 
search”  ( The  Roswell  Report,  1997).  The  prob¬ 
lem  with  this  theory  was  that  tests  involving 
such  dummies  did  not  occur  until  1953,  leav¬ 
ing  the  air  force  with  the  rationalization — un¬ 
persuasive  to  many — that  the  informants  sim¬ 
ply  had  their  time  mixed  up. 

Still,  many  ufologists,  as  much  out  of  frus¬ 
tration  as  firm  intellectual  conviction,  ac¬ 
cepted  the  Mogul  explanation,  whatever  its 
imperfections.  The  Roswell  incident  had 
spawned  an  industry  and  generated  a  huge 
body  of  often  confusing,  contradictory  (and 
sometimes  demonstrably  false)  testimony.  It 
even  generated  documents  (most  notably  the 
notorious  and  deeply  suspect  “MJ-12”  pa¬ 
pers,  purportedly  from  the  supersecret  proj¬ 
ect  overseeing  the  UFO  cover-up).  On  the 
whole,  it  did  not  accomplish  a  great  deal  ex¬ 
cept  to  line  the  pockets  of  opportunists  who 
didn’t  much  care  about  the  truth — which,  in 
any  event,  seemed  irrecoverable  so  many 
years  past  the  original  event.  Roswell  also  in¬ 
spired  one  of  the  most  brazen  hoaxes  in  UFO 
history,  the  so-called  alien  autopsy  film  that 
aired  on  the  Fox  Network  in  the  mid-1990s, 
purporting  to  show  the  dismemberment  of 
an  extraterrestrial  body  by  government  scien¬ 
tists  in  1947. 

The  failure  of  the  Roswell  story  to  come  to 
firm  resolution  after  two  decades  of  furious 
controversy  sobered  many  once-enthusiastic 
or  hopeful  ufologists.  But  as  long  as  questions 
remain,  the  mystery  will  stay  open  to  those 
who  are  sufficiently  determined  to  keep 
thinking — or,  perhaps,  thinking  wishfully — 
about  it.  And  Roswell  or  no,  rumors,  tall  tales, 
and — on  rare  occasion — genuinely  intriguing 
reports  of  dead  extraterrestrials  in  our  midst 
are  likely  to  entertain  live  humans  for  some 
time  to  come. 


86  Dead  extraterrestrials 


A  photo  from  the  U.S.  Air  Force’s  Roswell  Report  about  the  1947  UFO  incident  at  Roswell,  New  Mexico,  released  June 
24,  1997,  and  intended  to  eliminate  long-standing  rumors.  Air  force  personnel  supposedly  used  stretchers  and  gurneys  to 
pick  up  these  200-pound  dummies  in  the  field  and  move  them  to  the  laboratory.  (Associated  Press! Air  Force) 


See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Aurora  Martian;  Cahn,  J.  P.,  1952.  “The  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Mys- 

Fossilized  aliens;  Oleson’s  giants  terious  Little  Men.”  True  (September):  17-19, 

Further  Reading  102-112. 

Barker,  Gray,  1960.  “Chasing  the  Flying  Saucers.”  Carey,  Thomas  J.,  and  Donald  R.  Schmitt,  1999. 

Flying  Saucers  (November):  22-28.  “Mack  Brazel  Reconsidered.”  International  UFO 

Berlitz,  Charles,  and  William  L.  Moore,  1980.  Reporter  24,  4  (Winter):  12— 19. 

The  Roswell  Incident.  New  York:  Grosset  and  Evans,  Alex,  1978.  “Encounters  with  Little  Men.” 

Dunlap.  Fate  31,  11  (November):  83-86. 


Diane  87 


General  Accounting  Office,  1995-  Report  to  the  Hon  - 
orable  Steven  H.  Schiff,  House  of  Representatives: 
Restdts  of  a  Search  for  Records  Concerning  the  1947 
Crash  Near  Roswell,  New  Mexico.  Washington, 
DC:  General  Accounting  Office. 

Hurtak,  James  J.,  1979.  “The  Occupants  of  Crashed 
‘Saucers’.”  The  UFO  Register  10,  1  (December): 
2-3. 

Lorenzen,  Coral  E.,  1962.  The  Great  Flying  Saucer 
Hoax:  The  UFO  Facts  and  Their  Interpretation. 
New  York:  William-Frederick  Press. 

Pflock,  Karl  T.,  1994.  Roswell  in  Perspective.  Mount 
Rainier,  MD:  Fund  for  UFO  Research. 

- ,  2000.  “What’s  Really  Behind  the  Flying 

Saucers?  A  New  Twist  on  Aztec.”  The  Anomalist  % 
(Spring):  137-161. 

Randle,  Kevin  D.,  1995.  A  History  of  UFO  Crashes. 
New  York:  Avon  Books. 

Randle,  Kevin  D.,  and  Donald  R.  Schmitt,  1991. 
UFO  Crash  at  Roswell.  New  York:  Avon  Books. 

- ,  1994.  The  Truth  about  the  UFO  Crash  at 

Roswell.  New  York:  Avon  Books. 

The  Roswell  Report:  Case  Closed,  1997.  Washington, 
DC:  Defense  Department,  Air  Force,  Head¬ 
quarters. 

The  Roswell  Report:  Fact  versus  Fiction  in  the  New 
Mexico  Desert,  1995.  Washington,  DC:  Head¬ 
quarters,  United  States  Air  Force. 

Scully,  Frank,  1950.  Behind  the  Flying  Saucers.  New 
York:  Henry  Holt  and  Company. 

Stringfield,  Leonard  H.,  1980.  The  UFO  Crash/Re  - 
trieval  Syndrome.  Status  Report  II:  New  Sources, 
New  Data.  Seguin,  TX:  Mutual  UFO  Network. 

- ,  1987.  “The  Chase  for  Proof  in  a  Squirrel’s 

Cage.”  In  Hilary  Evans  with  John  Spencer,  eds. 
UFOs  1947—1987:  The  40-Year  Search  for  an  Ex  - 
planation,  145-155.  London:  Fortean  Tomes. 

Swords,  Michael  D.,  1997.  “Roswell:  Clashing  Vi¬ 
sions  of  the  Possible.”  International  UFO  Reporter 
22,  3  (Fall):  11-13,  33-35. 

Dentons’s  Martians  and  Venusians 

In  America  during  the  nineteenth  century, 
spiritualists  and  other  psychics  proliferated. 
Among  the  most  prominent  were  William 
Denton  and  his  son  Sherman.  They  called 
themselves  “psychometers,”  which  meant  that 
they  could  discern  any  truth,  however  distant 
in  time  and  space,  by  touching  a  physical  ob¬ 
ject  or,  if  it  were  out  of  reach,  at  least  focusing 
on  it.  In  this  way  they  learned  that  Mars  and 
Venus  were  inhabited. 

As  the  elder  Denton  put  it,  “A  telescope 
only  enables  us  to  see;  but  the  spiritual  facul¬ 


ties  enable  their  possessors  to  hear,  smell, 
taste,  and  feel,  and  become  for  the  time 
being,  almost  inhabitants  of  the  planet  they 
are  examining.” 

In  1866,  as  the  two  men  were  standing  out 
in  a  field  watching  Venus  rise  in  the  evening 
sky,  the  father  asked  the  son  to  study  the 
planet  and  tell  him  what  he  saw.  After  a  few 
minutes,  Sherman  described  trees,  water  that 
was  heavy  but  not  wet,  and  animals  that  had 
the  features  of  both  fish  and  muskrats. 

Other  experiments  soon  followed.  Sher¬ 
man  left  his  body  and  traveled  to  Mars,  where 
he  saw  a  thriving  civilization  consisting  of  a 
race  that  looked  much  like  humans.  “They 
soar  above  traffic  on  their  individual  fly- 
cycles,”  he  reported.  “They  seem  particularly 
fond  of  air  travel.  As  many  as  thirty  people  oc¬ 
cupy  some  of  the  large  flying  conveyances.” 
The  Martians  also  had  a  particular  fondness 
for  aluminum,  which  they  employed  in  build¬ 
ing  houses  and  machines. 

See  Also:  Allingham’s  Martian;  Aurora  Martian; 
Brown’s  Martians;  Hopkins’s  Martians;  Khauga; 
Martian  bees;  Mince-Pie  Martians;  Monka; 
Muller’s  Martians;  Shaw’s  Martians;  Smead’s  Mar¬ 
tians;  Thompson’s  Venusians;  Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1966.  Strangers  from  the  Skies.  New 
York:  Award  Books. 

Diane 

According  to  contactee  Dana  Howard,  Diane 
was  a  Venusian  who  began  appearing  to  hu¬ 
mans  in  1939.  She  returned  in  1955  and  was 
seen  many  times  after  that.  “Diane  came  in 
the  same  miraculous  manner  as  the  Lady  of 
The  Lourdes  and  Our  Lady  of  Fatima,” 
Howard  wrote.  “To  all  appearances  She  is  a 
physical  being  like  ourselves,  yet  She  is  obvi¬ 
ously  created  of  substances  not  of  this  earth ” 
(Howard,  1958). 

Howard,  who  claimed  to  have  visited 
Venus,  reported  that  on  October  3,  1957,  as 
she  was  lecturing  at  the  Women’s  Clubhouse 
in  Fontana,  California,  she  felt  a  strange 
warmth  come  over  her.  After  the  meeting,  sev¬ 
eral  audience  members  rushed  up  to  her  to  say 
that  they  had  seen  an  apparition  of  a  young 


88  Divine  Fire 


woman  transposed  over  Howard’s  body.  One 
audience  member,  Eleanor  Warner,  described 
“the  figure  of  a  beautiful  woman,  very  young, 
with  long  golden  hair,  a  very  slim  body,  and 
small  waistline.  She  seemed  to  glow  in  the 
golden  light.”  Another  witness,  Trudy  Allen, 
was  “overcome  by  the  transcendent  beauty 
that  was  shining  forth.” 

In  Howard’s  account,  Diane  appeared  to 
her,  in  full  view  of  twenty-seven  witnesses,  for 
the  first  time  on  April  29,  1955,  and  identi¬ 
fied  herself  as  a  Venusian.  That  same  week 
UFOs  appeared  on  four  occasions  over  Palm 
Springs,  California,  Howard’s  hometown. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Howard,  Dana,  1958.  “The  Drama  behind  the 
Space  Ships.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  4,  3 
(May/June):  21-23. 


Divine  Fire 

In  a  book  that  would  prove  influential  in 
1970s  New  Age  circles,  Brad  Steiger  wrote  of 
what  he  called  the  “Divine  Fire.”  He  believed 
that  a  dramatic  rise  was  occurring  in  visionary 
experience,  channeling,  and  other  contact  with 
ostensible  higher  intelligences.  “Clergymen, 
clerks,  professors,  public  relations  executives, 
housewives,  students,  servicemen,  and  factory 
workers  have  been  demonstrating  that  Pente¬ 
cost  was  not  just  a  one-shot  special  designed  to 
excite  the  Aposdes  and  their  kibitzers  in  Jeru¬ 
salem  of  A.D.  30,”  he  said  (Steiger,  1973). 

According  to  Steiger,  these  extraordinary 
experiences  and  communications  were  taking 
a  variety  of  forms,  but  the  message  was  the 
same  in  its  essence  as  those  given  to  prophets 
five  thousand  years  ago.  He  suggested  that 
“the  very  repetition  of  a  basic  message  may  be 
evidence  of  the  vital  relevancy  and  universality 
of  a  cosmic  truth.”  The  messages  came  from 
ostensible  angels,  extraterrestrials,  divinities, 
and  the  like,  but  all  spoke  of  a  “Higher  Being” 
from  whom  each  individual  could  draw  inspi¬ 
ration  and  wisdom.  These  messages  stated 
that  all  humans  have  the  power  within  them¬ 
selves  to  contact  this  Higher  Being.  All  things 


were  one;  everything  and  everybody  was  at 
once  individual  and  universal.  And  finally,  hu¬ 
mans  were  entering,  in  Steiger’s  summary,  “a 
New  Age,  another  progression  in  our  evolu¬ 
tion  as  spiritual  beings.  .  .  .  We  are  moving  to¬ 
ward  a  state  of  mystical  consciousness  wherein 
every  man  shall  be  priest.” 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1973.  Revelation:  The  Divine  Fire.  En¬ 
glewood  Cliffs,  NJ :  Prentice-Hall. 


Dual  reference 

“Dual  reference”  is  a  term  coined  by  Massa¬ 
chusetts  ufologist  Joseph  Nyman.  His  hyp¬ 
notic  investigations  of  abductees  have  led  him 
to  the  discovery  that  many  believe  themselves 
to  be  of  alien  origin.  They  have  no  conscious 
memories  of  such  a  personal  extraterrestrial 
link,  but  under  hypnosis  they  gradually  come 
to  understand  that  the  aliens  who  are  abduct¬ 
ing  them  are  actually  their  own  associates  and 
colleagues.  They  eventually  grasp  that  before 
their  human  selves  were  bom,  their  alien 
selves  made  the  decision  to  send  their  con¬ 
sciousnesses  into  human  fetal  bodies.  In  the 
very  first  years  of  their  human  lives,  memories 
of  their  homes  on  other  worlds  are  lost,  but 
over  the  years,  as  they  undergo  abduction  ex¬ 
periences,  they  learn — through  hypnotic  “re¬ 
call”  of  these  experiences — of  their  true  past 
and  their  mission  in  this  life  and  on  this 
planet.  Sometimes,  while  the  session  is  going 
on,  the  hypnotist  is  able  to  speak  directly  with 
the  alien  intelligence  in  the  subject’s  body. 

Similar  notions  are  not  uncommon  among 
contactees,  many  of  whom  are  convinced  that 
they  were  extraterrestrials  in  an  earlier  lives 
and  are  now  here  to  help  prepare  humans  for 
the  great  geophysical  and  spiritual  changes 
that  will  be  coming  soon.  Dual  reference  also 
is  somewhat  comparable  to  the  notion  of 
Walk-ins,  popularized  by  occult  writer  Ruth 
Montgomery,  except  that  Walk-ins  are  not  al¬ 
ways  (though  they  are  sometimes)  extraterres¬ 
trials.  Moreover,  they  are  so  intellectually  and 
spiritually  advanced  that  they  only  take  up  oc- 


Dual  reference  89 


cupancy  of  the  bodies  of  grown  adults,  so  as 
not  to  waste  valuable  time. 

Nyman  writes,  “We  strongly  suspect  that 
the  feeling  of  dual  reference  ...  is  uncon¬ 
sciously  present  in  all  [abduction]  experi¬ 
ences”  (Nyman,  1989).  Most  investigators  of 
the  abduction  phenomenon  disagree,  and  in¬ 
deed  when  Nyman  presented  his  ideas  at  a 
1 992  conference  held  at  the  Massachusetts  In¬ 
stitute  of  Technology,  some  questioners  ac¬ 
cused  him  of  leading  his  subjects  into  confab¬ 
ulation.  They  were  particularly  critical  of  his 
practice  of  asking  the  subjects  to  recall  “mem¬ 
ories”  of  their  lives  in  the  womb.  Among 
Nymans  defenders  was  Harvard  University 
psychologist  John  E.  Mack,  who  was  also  en¬ 
gaged  in  extensive  hypnotic  probing  of  osten¬ 
sible  abductees. 

In  a  book  published  two  years  later,  Mack 
told  the  story  of  a  young  man  he  identifies 
only  as  Paul,  “one  of  an  increasing  group  of 
abductees  .  .  .  who  have  discovered  that  they 
have  a  dual  identity  of  an  alien  (they  do  not 
use  that  word)  and  a  human  being.”  Paul 
was  convinced  that  he  was  on  Earth  to  show 
people  how  to  love  and  accept  love — this 
even  before  he  found  his  alien  identity 
under  hypnosis. 

Paul  had  gone  to  another  psychologist  to 
examine  some  of  his  life’s  problems,  including 
a  conviction  that  he  had  seen  a  weird  hu¬ 
manoid  creature.  Hypnotized,  he  spoke  of 
other  encounters  with  other  strange  beings, 
including  one  when  he  was  two  or  three  years 
old.  The  psychologist  did  not  know  what  to 
make  of  these  stories,  and  he  and  Paul  parted 
company;  Paul  eventually  found  his  way  to 
Mack. 

With  Mack,  Paul  explored  an  apparent 
memory  of  a  further  encounter,  this  one  when 
he  was  six  and  a  half.  He  spoke  of  seeing  a 
being  inside  his  house  and  of  sensing  that  the 
two  of  them  were  “linked  in  a  way.”  They 
went  outside  together,  where  they  met  two 
groups — four  or  five  each — of  humanoids. 
Though  they  did  not  look  human,  Paul  felt 
comfortable,  even  joyful,  to  be  in  their  com¬ 
pany.  They  apparently  felt  the  same;  they 


hugged  him  and  gave  every  indication  of  feel¬ 
ing  great  affection  for  him.  The  whole  experi¬ 
ence  felt  “like  home.”  Subsequently  he  was 
taken  aboard  a  ship,  an  experience  he  sensed 
he  had  undergone  in  other  lives.  One  of  the 
beings  told  him  that  he  was  from  their  planet. 
The  alien  spoke  of  human  beings’  inability  to 
“truly  open  up  to  another”  and  of  their  hostil¬ 
ity  to  the  visiting  extraterrestrials. 

During  the  session  Paul  alternated  between 
his  human  and  alien  selves.  In  the  latter,  he 
spoke  of  the  nature  of  higher  consciousness 
and  of  humans’  destructive  ways.  He  also  ex¬ 
pressed  homesickness  for  the  ship  and  the 
planet  from  which  he  had  come.  He  “remem¬ 
bered”  earlier  visits  to  Earth,  including  inter¬ 
actions — apparently  tens  of  millions  of  years 
ago — with  intelligent,  gentle  dinosaurs.  In  an¬ 
other  instance,  the  ship  on  which  he  was  trav¬ 
eling — in  earthling  guise — with  extraterres¬ 
trial  companions  rescued  the  surviving 
occupants  of  a  crashed  craft  that  went  down 
in  the  desert  after  being  shot  down  by  “men  in 
uniforms.”  Two  of  the  crew  died  and  had  to 
be  abandoned  in  the  face  of  advancing  sol¬ 
diers.  Paul  felt,  in  this  instance,  ashamed  to  be 
human;  yet,  in  a  broader  context,  he  felt  cer¬ 
tain  that  “peace  and  love”  were  slowly  spread¬ 
ing  over  the  Earth  and  that  he  had  a  role  to 
play  in  opening  up  human  beings  to  larger, 
benevolent  cosmic  truths. 

According  to  Mack,  Paul  has  learned  pow¬ 
erful  psychic  healing  powers  from  his  ongoing 
interactions  with  his  extraterrestrial  friends. 
He  has  been  given  a  great  deal  of  information 
on  their  “unbelievable”  technology  but  has 
been  forbidden  to  share  it  (Mack,  1994a). 

Mack  rejects  the  theory  that  such  attach¬ 
ments  of  abductee  to  abductor  are  analogous 
to  the  so-called  Stockholm  Syndrome,  in 
which  a  hostage  comes  to  identify  with  his  or 
her  captor.  There  is,  he  says,  “little  sense  that 
the  alien  identity  is  primarily  a  product  of 
‘identification  with  the  aggressor.’  .  .  .  Rather, 
the  dual  identity  appears  to  be  a  fundamental 
dimension  of  the  consciousness  expansion  or 
opening  that  is  an  intrinsic  aspect  of  the  ab¬ 
duction  phenomenon  itself”  (Mack,  1994b). 


90  Dugja 


See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Contactees;  Walk-ins 

Further  Reading 

Mack,  John  E.,  1994a.  Abduction:  Human  Encoun  - 
ters  with  Aliens.  New  York:  Charles  Scribner’s 
Sons. 

- ,  1994b.  “Post  Conference  Note.”  In  Andrea 

Pritchard,  David  E.  Pritchard,  John  E.  Mack, 
Pam  Kasey,  and  Claudia  Yapp,  eds.  Alien  Discus  - 
sions:  Proceedings  of  the  Abduction  Study  Confer  - 
ence,  146.  Cambridge,  MA:  North  Cambridge 
Press. 

Nyman,  Joseph,  1988.  “The  Latent  Encounter  Expe¬ 
rience — A  Composite  Model.”  MUFON  UFO 
Journal2A2  (June):  10-12. 

- ,  1989.  “The  Familiar  Entity  and  Dual  Ref¬ 
erence  in  the  Latent  Encounter.”  MUFON  UFO 
Journal  251  (March):  10-12. 

- ,  1994.  “Dual  Reference  in  the  UFO  En¬ 
counter.”  In  Andrea  Pritchard,  David  E. 
Pritchard,  John  E.  Mack,  Pam  Kasey,  and  Clau¬ 
dia  Yapp,  eds.  Alien  Discussions:  Proceedings  of  the 
Abduction  Study  Conference,  142-148.  Cam¬ 
bridge,  MA:  North  Cambridge  Press. 


Dugja 

According  to  members  of  a  small  group  called 
Elan  Vital  (Vital  Essence),  the  last  queen  of 
the  lost  continent  of  Lemuria,  Dugja  (pro¬ 
nounced  doo-ja),  reigns  as  “Spirit  of  the 
Mountain.”  The  mountain  is  Shasta,  in  far 
northern  California,  the  focus  of  many  occult 


beliefs  and  legends.  Dugja  materializes  when¬ 
ever  her  mood  or  the  situation,  calls  for  it. 

One  member  claimed  that  in  1963,  while 
meditating  on  Mount  Shasta’s  Grey  Butte,  he 
sensed  an  “astral  man,”  with  thin  hair,  white 
beard,  and  pink  skin,  warning  him  telepathi- 
cally  to  turn  back.  When  he  ignored  the  threats 
and  entreaties,  other  astral  entities  joined  with 
the  first  one.  Nonetheless,  undaunted,  the  man 
ended  his  meditation  and  continued  his  trek 
up  the  mountain.  Soon  he  encountered  Dugja, 
who  greeted  him  warmly  and  invited  him  to 
stay  for  a  time.  He  returned  to  Shasta  three 
years  later.  Since  then,  he  told  reporter  Emilie 
A.  Frank  in  the  1970s,  he  had  visited  the  queen 
on  many  occasions  in  both  physical  and  out- 
of-body  states.  “I  am  also  responsible  for  clean¬ 
ing  negative  light  forces  around  Mount  Shasta 
and  elsewhere  in  the  world,”  he  said.  “These 
light  forces  affect  the  population,  and  in  order 
to  make  the  world  a  better  place  ...  I  polarize 
their  negative  influences.  Eventually  they  will 
all  be  pure.  In  the  meantime,  I  make  many  as¬ 
tral  trips  to  Mount  Shasta  in  order  to  purify  the 
lights”  (Frank,  1998). 

See  Also:  Lemuria;  Mount  Shasta 

Further  Reading 

Frank,  Emilie  A.,  1998.  Mt.  Shasta:  California’s  Mys  - 
tic  Mountain.  Hilt,  CA:  Photografix  Publishing. 


Earth  Coincidence  Control  Office 

Scientist  John  Lilly,  best  known  for  his  pio¬ 
neering  researches  into  dolphins  and  into  al¬ 
tered  states  of  consciousness,  was  on  an  air¬ 
liner  approaching  Los  Angeles  when  he  had 
his  first  communication  from  an  intelligence 
he  would  come  to  call  Earth  Coincidence 
Control  Office.  He  received  a  psychic  message 
that  said,  “We  will  now  make  a  demonstra¬ 
tion  of  our  power  over  the  solid-state  control 
systems  upon  the  planet  Earth.  In  thirty  sec¬ 
onds,  we  will  shut  off  all  electronic  equipment 
in  the  Los  Angeles  airport.  Your  airplane  will 
be  unable  to  land  there  and  will  have  to  be 
shunted  to  another  airport”  (Lilly,  1978).  Sure 
enough,  the  power  blackout  occurred,  forcing 
Lilly’s  plane  to  land  at  Burbank;  another  plane 
crashed. 

In  a  visionary  experience  not  long  after¬ 
ward,  Lilly  witnessed  the  future  of  the  human 
race.  A  solid-state  intelligence,  consisting  of 
all  computers  and  electronic  systems,  will  as¬ 
sume  control  of  everything  and  become  too 
powerful  for  human  beings  to  do  anything 
about.  By  the  2500s  this  intelligence  will  be  in 
communication  with  its  counterparts  else¬ 
where  in  the  Milky  Way. 

Lilly  believed  himself  to  be  in  contact  with 
the  water-based — as  opposed  to  solid-state — 
entities  in  the  universe.  The  two  intelligences, 


the  latter  always  the  creation  of  the  former,  are 
in  conflict  all  through  the  universe.  Water- 
based  beings  from  elsewhere  are  paying  close 
attention  to  developments  on  Earth  and  send¬ 
ing  humans  constant  telepathic  messages  that 
usually  register,  at  least  where  humans  are  con¬ 
cerned,  only  on  a  subliminal  level.  These  be¬ 
ings  (the  Earth  Coincidence  Control  Office,  in 
Lilly’s  phrasing)  seek  to  influence  human  evo¬ 
lution  in  such  a  way  that  humans  do  not  be¬ 
come  enslaved  to  their  technology.  The  other 
intelligences  that  share  our  planet — dolphins 
and  whales — are  more  psychically  attuned  to 
these  messages  and  receive  them  clearly.  Lilly 
holds  that  “whales  and  dolphins  quite  naturally 
go  in  the  direction  we  call  spiritual,  in  that  they 
get  into  meditative  states  quite  simply  and  eas¬ 
ily.  .  .  .  Dolphins  have  a  highly  developed  con¬ 
sciousness,  and  a  powerful  connection  to 
higher  realities”  (Lilly,  1972). 

Beginning  in  the  1950s,  Lilly  had  experi¬ 
mented  with  sensory  deprivation.  He  would 
place  himself  in  a  tank  of  water  in  a  totally 
dark,  silent  room.  In  due  course  he  would  un¬ 
dergo  vivid  hallucinations.  To  him  these  hal¬ 
lucinations  became  more  real  than  reality.  He 
came  to  believe  that  through  them  he  entered 
other  dimensions  of  existence  and  grew  aware 
that  this  dimension  and  others  harbor  innu¬ 
merable  varieties  of  intelligent  entities. 


91 


92  Elder  Race 


Further  Reading 

Lilly,  John  C.,  1972.  The  Center  of  the  Cyclone:  An 
Atitobiography  of  Inner  Space.  New  York:  Julian 
Press. 

- ,  1978.  The  Scientist:  A  Novel  Autobiography. 

New  York:  J.  B.  Lippincott. 


Elder  Race 

The  Elder  Race,  also  known  as  Els,  was  the 
first  extraterrestrial  group  ever  to  arrive  on 
Earth.  They  showed  up  one  billion  years  ago 
after  already  having  colonized  a  considerable 
portion  of  the  galaxy.  But  on  Earth,  these  be¬ 
ings — originally  twelve  feet  tall,  male  and  fe¬ 
male  (though  “not  as  we  think  of  sex  differen¬ 
tiation  today”  [Williamson,  1959]),  and  many 
one-eyed — radically  changed.  Earth  would  be 
the  last  planet  in  which  they  existed  in  physi¬ 
cal  bodies.  During  their  stay  on  Earth,  they 
conquered  matter,  energy,  space,  and  time, 
becoming  “the  legendary  ‘gods’”  able  to  proj¬ 
ect  via  mental  powers  “any  amount  of  matter 


in  any  degree  of  density  or  intensity  to  any 
place  on  Earth  at  any  time.”  In  their  under¬ 
ground  city  near  Lake  Titicaca,  along  what  is 
now  the  Peru-Bolivia  border,  they  built  a  vast 
control  room,  a  kind  of  “Earth  Center.” 

In  this  and  other  underground  realms,  they 
left  vast  libraries  on  which  the  history  of  the 
universe  is  recorded  on  crystal  devices  encased 
in  magnetic  fields.  On  occasion,  a  psychically 
sensitive  individual  is  able  to  tap  into  these 
records. 

Further  Reading 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1959.  Road  in  the  Sky. 

London:  Neville  Spearman. 

Elvis  as  Jesus 

In  a  book  published  in  2000,  Cinda  Godfrey 
concludes  that  Elvis  Presley  was  the  Mes¬ 
siah — the  returned  Jesus  Christ.  She  writes 
that  she  began  her  research  in  1992,  deter¬ 
mined  to  disprove  any  connection  between 
the  two,  only  to  find  “mind-boggling  evidence 


Stephanie  G.  Pierce,  Celebrity  Spokesminister  for  the  24  Hour  Church  of  Elvis,  stands  inside  the  church’s  inner  sanctum. 
(Macduff Everton/CORBIS) 


Emmanuel  93 


that  the  prophecies  throughout  the  [Bible]  fit 
both  Elvis  and  Jesus  like  a  glove.” 

Among  the  similarities:  Both  Jesus  and 
Elvis  are  called  The  King.  Jesus  was  the 
Rock;  Elvis  (at  least  according  to  Godfrey) 
invented  rock.  Jesus  was  the  Son,  and  Elvis 
began  his  recording  career  on  the  Sun  label. 
“The  name  numbers  for  Jesus  and  Elvis  both 
equal  nine,”  she  says.  “In  fact,  their  name- 
numbers  match  exactly,  letter  for  letter  and 
number  for  number:  Jesus  =  15363,  Elvis  = 
53613.”  Their  followers  worshipped  and 
adored  them.  Both  could  heal  and  read 
minds,  and  both  had  powerful  enemies  who 
sought  to  stop  them.  Godfrey  claims  that 
like  Jesus,  Elvis  was  Jewish. 

She  also  notes  that  the  Bible  frequently 
refers  to  the  Voice  of  God  on  many  occasions. 
“Is  there  any  voice  more  spectacular  than  Elvis 
Presley’s?”  she  asks.  The  Psalms  even  predict 
that  Presley  one  day  would  disappear:  “I  am 
shut  up  and  I  cannot  come  forth”  (Psalms 
88:8)  and  “Plow  long,  Lord?  Wilt  thou  hide 
thyself  forever?”  (Psalms  89:46).  Isaiah  4:2 
states  that  when  the  Messiah  comes,  “In  that 
day  shall  the  branch  [Messiah]  of  the  Lord  be 
beautiful  and  glorious.”  Godfrey  remarks, 
“Now,  picture  Elvis  at  his  Aloha  from  Hawaii 
concert,  resplendent  in  his  jeweled  American 
Eagle  jumpsuit.  Curiously  enough,  the  eagle 
is  also  a  symbol  for  Christ”  (Godfrey,  2000). 

According  to  Godfrey  (as  well  as  more 
mainstream  Presley  biographers  such  as  Peter 
Guralnick),  Presley  had  a  religious  vision  in 
the  Arizona  desert  in  March  1965.  Just  out¬ 
side  Flagstaff,  as  Presley  was  driving  his  bus 
with  his  spiritual  advisor  Larry  Geller  sitting 
next  to  him,  he  saw  a  cloud  in  a  clear  sky  and 
swore  that  he  could  see  the  face  of  the  late  So¬ 
viet  dictator  Josef  Stalin  in  it.  The  image  faded 
as  the  cloud’s  shape  changed,  so  Presley  imag¬ 
ined,  into  the  face  of  Jesus.  He  pulled  the  bus 
over  to  the  side  of  the  road  and  ran  into  the 
desert,  feeling  a  sense  of  deep  spiritual  trans¬ 
formation.  Geller  would  claim  that  Presley 
later  wondered  if  maybe  he  was  indeed  Christ. 

Godfrey  contends  that  Elvis  Aron  Presley’s 
own  name  proves  his  godhood.  “El”  means 


God,  “vis”  from  power — thus  “God  Power.” 
“Presley”  derives  from  “priestly.”  She  goes  on, 
“In  fact,  all  three  of  Elvis’  major  residences 
contain  the  prophetic  ‘EL’:  Gracc/and,  Tupc/o 
and  B el  Air.  Furthermore,  according  to  the 
Bible,  since  Jesus’  crucifixion,  we  are  living  in 
the  Dispensation  of  ‘Grace’ — that  2,000  year 
period  of  time  when  sins  are  pardoned  by  the 
sacrificial  death  of  Christ.  The  name  of  Elvis 
Presley’s  mansion:  ‘GRACE-LAND’!”  And, 
she  adds,  did  not  Jesus  say,  “I  am  Alpha  and 
Omega,  the  beginning  and  the  ending,”  just 
as  Elvis  said,  “I  am  and  I  was”? 

Godfrey  goes  outside  Scripture  to  delve 
into  esoteric  literature  for  further  evidence, 
citing  among  other  sources  the  prophecies  of 
Nostradamus  and  Edgar  Cayce.  Noting  one 
occultist  interpretation  of  the  Great  Pyramid 
(not  shared  by  Egyptologists),  she  writes  that 
the  Great  Pyramid  was  a  monument  to 
Christ,  allegedly  known  to  the  Egyptians  as 
“Orion.”  The  pyramid’s  structure,  read  prop¬ 
erly,  foretells  the  return  of  Christ  sometime 
around  2000.  “Elvis  Presley  has  been  men¬ 
tioned  in  connection  with  the  name  Orion  on 
many  occasions,”  she  observes,  “including 
Gail  Giorgio’s  1978  bestseller,  Orion,  about  a 
godlike  singer  who  faked  his  death  and  disap¬ 
peared”  (Godfrey,  2000). 

Further  Reading 

Godfrey,  Cinda,  2000.  The  Elvis-Jesus  Mystery — The 
Shocking  Scriptural  and  Scientific  Evidence  That 
Elvis  Presley  Coidd  Be  the  Messiah  Anticipated 
throughout  History.  New  Philadelphia,  OH:  Reve¬ 
lation  Press. 

Guralnick,  Peter,  1999.  Careless  Love:  The  Unmaking 
of  Elvis  Presley.  Boston,  MA:  Back  Bay  Books. 

Emmanuel 

First  seen  clairvoyantly  as  a  “being  of  golden 
light”  (Rodegast  and  Stanton,  1985),  Em¬ 
manuel  was  a  popular  channeling  entity  dur¬ 
ing  the  New  Age  boom  of  the  1980s.  Em¬ 
manuel,  who  spoke  through  Pat  Rodegast,  did 
not  ever  explain  exactly  who  or  what  he  was, 
insisting  only  that  he  was  physically  real  but 
hinting  that  he  had  a  body  that  human  beings 
might  not  be  comfortable  seeing.  He  made  a 


94  Eunethia 


particular  impression  on  psychologist  and 
guru  Baba  Ram  Dass  (the  former  Richard 
Alpert,  who  worked  with  Timothy  Leary  on 
early  LSD  research  and  advocacy). 

Emmanuel  taught  that  “the  separation”  of 
human  beings  from  God  was  only  temporary, 
and  it  served  a  larger  purpose.  Through  it, 
human  beings  have  gained  the  knowledge 
they  need  to  reunite  with  the  divine  and  be¬ 
come  cocreators  with  God. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Rodegast,  Pat,  and  Judith  Stanton,  eds.,  1985. 
Emmanuel’s  Book:  A  Manual  for  Living  Com  - 
fortably  in  the  Cosmos.  New  York:  Some  Friends 
of  Emmanuel. 


Eunethia 

Eunethia,  who  channels  through  Yvonne 
Cole,  commands  the  starship  Venusia,  serving 
the  Ashtar  Command.  She  and  her  crew  orig¬ 
inally  came  from  Venus  but  now  live  in  a  large 
ship  that  orbits  Earth.  Their  purpose  is  to  ob  - 
serve  and  to  teach  humans.  They  are  also  here 
to  prepare  humans  for  the  great  upheavals 
that  will  soon  occur  in  response  to  their  long 
abuse  of  the  Earth. 

According  to  Eunethia,  more  than  fourteen 
planetary  species  are  involved  in  the  Earth 
project.  “When  the  call  went  out  for  volun¬ 
teers  to  assist  planet  Earth,”  she  says,  “the  re¬ 
sponse  came  from  all  areas  of  the  Universe. 
Most  interaction  is  in  the  form  of  telepathic 
contact”  (Bryant  and  Seebach,  1991),  though 
relatively  few  humans  are  sufficiently  devel¬ 
oped  in  their  psychic  powers  to  communicate. 

See  Also:  Ashtar 

Further  Reading 

Bryant,  Alice,  and  Linda  Seebach,  1991.  Healing 
Shattered  Reality:  Understanding  Contactee 
Trauma.  Tigard,  OR:  Wildflower  Press. 

Extraterrestrial  biological  entities 

According  to  a  body  of  modern  folklore,  the 
United  States  government  has  established  se¬ 
cret  contact  with  space  people,  whom  it  calls 
“extraterrestrial  biological  entities,”  or  EBEs 


(ee-buhs).  It  also  has  retrieved  the  bodies  of 
dead  EBEs  from  crashed  UFOs  such  as  the 
one  that  came  down  near  Roswell,  New  Mex¬ 
ico,  in  early  July  1947. 

Such  rumors  have  been  in  circulation  since 
the  earliest  days  of  the  UFO  controversy, 
which  began  with  a  sighting  by  private  pilot 
Kenneth  Arnold  of  nine  “flying  saucers”  over 
Mount  Rainier,  Washington,  on  June  24, 
1947.  One  of  the  first  rumors  alleged  that  a 
giant  spacecraft  landed  not  far  from  Juneau, 
Alaska,  in  mid- 1948,  and  in  the  first  inter¬ 
planetary  conference,  President  Harry  Tru¬ 
man,  along  with  his  top  aides  and  high-rank¬ 
ing  military  officers,  met  with  its  occupants, 
who  were  friendly  and  humble.  In  the  1950s, 
George  FFunt  Williamson,  a  contactee  and 
popular  author  of  saucerian  books,  wrote  that 
“a  highly  secret  operation  known  as  Project 
NQ-707,”  headquartered  at  Edwards  Air 
Force  Base  in  the  California  desert,  had  estab¬ 
lished  radio  contact  with  flying  saucers  and 
was  trying  to  get  them  to  “land  at  a  ren¬ 
dezvous  point  near  Salton  Sea  in  Southern 
California”  (Williamson,  1953).  Williamson’s 
friend  George  Adamski  insisted  that  the  U.S. 
government  and  space  people  regularly  spoke 
with  one  another.  Fie  would  even  claim  that 
in  1962  he  boarded  an  alien  spaceship  at  an 
air  force  base  on  his  way  to  a  conference  on 
Saturn. 

In  1956,  England’s  Flying  Saucer  Review 
published  startling  revelations  by  a  contribu¬ 
tor  identified  only  as  a  “special  correspon¬ 
dent.”  The  correspondent  asserted  that  a 
highly  placed  American  official  had  confided 
to  him  that  UFOs  were  known  to  contain 
friendly  space  visitors  who  were  trying  to  find 
a  way  to  breathe  Earth’s  atmosphere  before 
landing  and  declaring  themselves.  The  maga¬ 
zine  revealed  nine  years  later  that  its  unnamed 
informant  was  one  “Rolf  Alexander,  M.D.,” 
and  that  the  official  was  the  late  general  and 
diplomat  George  C.  Marshall.  It  did  not  men¬ 
tion  that  “Alexander”  was  in  fact  an  ex-convict 
whose  real  name  was  Allan  Alexander  Stirling. 
“Alexander”  claimed  vast  psychokinetic  pow¬ 
ers  that  allowed  him  to  break  up  clouds. 


Extraterrestrials  among  us  95 


A  related  rumor  held  that  the  government 
did  not  dare  to  release  its  knowledge  of  extra¬ 
terrestrial  visitation  for  fear  of  panic.  There¬ 
fore,  it  had  embarked  on  an  indoctrination 
program  through  which,  by  judicious  leaks 
and  UFO-themed  movies  and  television 
shows,  the  public  would  get  used  to  the  no¬ 
tion  and  therefore  be  able  to  handle  the  news 
when  it  was  time  to  deliver  it. 

In  the  early  1980s,  a  darker  version  of  the 
legend  came  to  the  fore.  This  time  it  was  tied 
to  nightmarish  conspiracy  theories,  in  which  a 
malevolent  “secret  government”  worked  with 
hostile  aliens  to  enslave  the  world’s  population. 
Via  abductions  the  aliens  received  certain  bio¬ 
logical  materials  they  needed  to  survive,  and 
the  secret  government,  in  turn,  got  access  to 
advanced  extraterrestrial  technology.  These 
speculations  were  tied  to  traditional  conspiracy 
theories,  sometimes  with  barely  concealed 
anti-Semitic  overtones.  One  of  the  move¬ 
ment’s  critics,  Jerome  Clark,  coined  the  phrase 
“Dark  Side”  to  characterize  it.  One  principal 
Dark  Sider,  Milton  William  Cooper,  claimed 
to  have  read  highly  classified  documents  that 
reported  that  alien  technology  made  time 
travel  possible.  Both  the  space  people  and  the 
secret  government  had  learned  that  World  War 
III  would  erupt  in  1995  and  escalate  into  nu¬ 
clear  conflict  in  1999,  preparing  Earth  for  the 
Second  Coming  of  Christ  in  20 1 1 . 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Adamski,  George; 
Contactees;  Holloman  aliens;  Williamson,  George 
Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Andrews,  George  C.,  1986.  Extra-TerrestrialsAmong 
Us.  St.  Paul,  MN:  Llewellyn  Publications. 

Clark,  Jerome,  1998.  “Dark  Side.”  In  The  UFO  Ency  - 
clopedia.  Second  Edition:  The  Phenomenon  from  the 
Beginning,  301-319.  Detroit,  MI:  Omnigraphics. 

Cooper,  Milton  William,  1991.  Behold  a  Pale  Horse. 
Sedona,  AZ:  Light  Technology  Publishing. 

Ellis,  Bill,  1991.  “Cattle  Mutilation:  Contemporary 
Legends  and  Contemporary  Mythologies.”  Con  - 
temporary  Legend  1:  39-80. 

“Let’s  Talk  Space:  ‘Flying  Saucers  Are  Real,”’  1956. 
Flying  Saucer  Review!,  1  (January):  2-5. 

“Report  Tells  of  ‘  Top  Brass’  Attending  Saucer  Land¬ 
ing,”  1955.  Flying  Saucer  News-Service  Research 
Bulletin  1,  9  (August  20):  3. 


“Rolf  Alexander,  M.D.,”  and  “Thoughts  on  UFOs 
by  Dr.  Rolf  Alexander,”  1965.  Flying  Saucer  Re  - 
view  (March/ April):  9. 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1953.  Other  Tongues — 
Other  Flesh.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

Extraterrestrials  among  us 

According  to  flying-saucer  contactees,  hu¬ 
manlike  beings  from  other  planets  walk  the 
streets  of  the  Earth,  undetected  and  unsus¬ 
pected  by  oblivious  earthlings. 

George  Hunt  Williamson,  for  example,  de¬ 
clared  that  the  program  to  infiltrate  Earth 
began  in  the  late  nineteenth  century.  “Space 
visitors  were  actually  deposited  and  left  on  our 
world  to  mix,  mate,  and  marry  with  us,”  he 
wrote.  “The  new  ideas  and  theories  first  came 
out  in  book  form  [in  various  scientific  and  oc¬ 
cult  texts] ,  and  this  was  the  prelude  to  the  ap¬ 
pearance  of  spacecraft  in  the  skies  of  Earth” 
(Williamson,  1953).  In  our  time,  the  extrater¬ 
restrial  agents,  whom  Williamson  called  the 
Wanderers,  have  helped  turn  our  attention  to 
science  fiction  and  space  travel,  among  other 
things.  In  a  subsequent  book,  Williamson 
would  argue  that  the  Hopi  and  Navajo  tribes 
long  ago  came  to  Earth  from  Mars  and  Lu- 
cifer-Maldek  (a  destroyed  planet  whose  re¬ 
mains  comprise  what  we  now  call  the  asteroid 
belt). 

In  February  1953  Williamson’s  friend 
George  Adamski  met  a  Martian  on  the  streets 
of  Los  Angeles.  The  Martian  told  him,  “At 
our  work  and  in  our  leisure  time,  we  mingle 
with  people  here  on  Earth,  never  betraying 
the  secret  that  we  are  inhabitants  of  other 
worlds”  (Adamski,  1955).  Those  who  knew 
Adamski  took  his  claims  of  Earthbound  extra¬ 
terrestrials  seriously  because  they  believed  that 
on  occasion  they  had  seen  these  beings.  Lou 
Zinsstag  was  Adamski’s  most  energetic  Euro¬ 
pean  supporter,  and  she  accompanied  him 
during  much  of  a  lecture  tour  he  conducted 
on  the  continent  in  1959.  Adamski  confided 
to  her  that  Venusian  men — he  called  them 
“boys” — regularly  had  been  meeting  with  him 
in  his  hotel  rooms  on  mornings.  One  after¬ 
noon,  Zinsstag  recalled,  she  was  sitting  in  a 


96  Extraterrestrials  among  us 


sidewalk  cafe  outside  Adamski’s  hotel  when 
she  happened  to  notice  a  handsome  young 
man  wearing  sun  glasses.  She  was  unable  to 
place  his  nationality.  Shortly  thereafter, 
Adamski,  who  had  been  resting  in  his  room, 
came  outside,  smiling  broadly,  “his  eyes 
sparkling  with  pleasure.”  He  was  also  smiling 
at  the  young  man,  who  smiled  back.  Adamski 
was  unable  to  keep  his  eyes  off  the  man,  who 
eventually  departed,  “greeting  George  and  me 
with  a  most  friendly  and  prolonged  smile” 
(Zinsstag,  1990).  When  Zinsstag  asked 
Adamski  if  this  were  one  of  the  Venusian 
“boys,”  he  said  yes. 

Another  account  comes  from  Adamski  as¬ 
sociate  C.  A.  Honey,  who  recalled,  “I  was 
with  Adamski  in  1958  during  a  meeting 
with  three  little  people  who  he  claimed  had 
come  to  Earth  from  Venus.  I  saw  them  and 
talked  with  one  of  them  but  I  don’t  know  if 
they  were  anything  other  than  what  I  saw — 
little  people”  (Honey,  1979).  In  an  earlier 
version  of  the  story,  Honey  told  of  seeing  a 
small,  blond  woman  in  a  roadside  cafe  while 
he  and  Adamski  were  on  a  trip  to  Oregon. 
Noticing  that  Adamski  appeared  “shocked,” 
Honey  studied  her  carefully.  From  a  dis¬ 
tance,  he  said,  she  looked  to  be  no  more 
than  twelve  years  old,  but  up  close  she  ap¬ 
peared  middle-aged.  She  “let  me  know  she 
was  reading  my  thoughts”  (Honey,  1959). 
The  next  day,  when  Honey  told  Adamski  he 
thought  she  was  a  spacewoman,  Adamski 
agreed  and  later  asserted  that  space  people 
had  informed  him  that  she  was  the  sister  of 
Kalna,  a  Venusian  spacewoman  friend  of 
Adamski’s. 

Another  prominent  1950s  contactee,  Tru¬ 
man  Bethurum,  claimed  to  have  encountered 
his  spacewoman  friend  Aura  Rhanes  on  a 
sidewalk  in  Las  Vegas.  When  he  greeted  her, 
she  “turned  around  but  did  not  seem  to  want 
to  be  recognized,  for  she  shook  her  head  and 
just  walked  across  the  street  and  joined  a 
crowd  waiting  for  a  bus,”  according  to  Bethu¬ 
rum  (Bethurum,  1954). 

Much  contactee  doctrine  concerning  earth- 
bound  extraterrestrials  focuses  more  on  the 


souls  of  these  beings  than  on  the  particular 
bodies  they  happen  to  inhabit.  Within  the 
contactee  underground,  many  people  believe 
they  themselves  were  space  people  in  previous 
incarnations;  a  lifetime  or  lifetimes  ago  they 
made  the  decision  to  be  born  as  earthlings  so 
to  work  toward  the  changes  that  will  prepare 
humankind  for  membership  in  the  Galactic 
Federation.  In  the  1970s  and  1980s,  the  con¬ 
cept  of  “Star  People,”  championed  by  writer 
Brad  Steiger,  gained  popularity  in  New  Age 
circles.  Steiger  wrote  that  Star  People  were  os¬ 
tensible  humans  but  in  fact  reincarnated  ex¬ 
traterrestrials;  Star  People  shared  certain  phys¬ 
ical  and  psychological  features  with  each 
other,  and  they  also  had  experienced  other¬ 
worldly  realities  all  their  lives,  even  if  con¬ 
sciously  they  did  not  recognize  their  signifi¬ 
cance.  Less  benignly,  some  writers  have 
suggested  that  the  menacing  men  in  black 
who  threaten  investigators  and  witnesses  are 
evil  aliens. 

In  the  era  of  UFO  abductions  some  re¬ 
searchers  reported  that  their  female  subjects 
had  undergone  mysteriously  terminated  preg¬ 
nancies,  only  to  be  abducted  at  a  later  date  to 
be  shown  an  alien-human  hybrid  child  who, 
they  were  led  to  believe,  was  their  own.  These 
hybrids  had  both  human  and  alien  features  in 
varying  proportions.  On  occasion,  abductees 
would  encounter  the  more  human-looking 
hybrids  in  real-life  situations.  David  M.  Ja¬ 
cobs,  in  The  Threat  (1998),  proposed  the 
alarming  theory  that  hybrids  are  being  bred  to 
replace  the  human  race  at  some  point  in  the 
not-distant  future. 

The  abduction  era  also  produced  a  story 
told  by  a  man  whose  credentials  seem  impec¬ 
cable,  a  New  York  book  editor  and  former 
Washington  correspondent  for  Newsweek. 
There  was  also  a  confirmatory  witness,  the 
man’s  wife.  In  January  1987,  the  publishing 
house  William  Morrow  had  just  released  the 
destined-to-be  bestseller  Communion,  Whit¬ 
ley  Strieber’s  account  of  his  personal  abduc¬ 
tion  experiences.  The  editor,  Bruce  Lee, 
claimed  that  just  as  the  book  was  starting  to 
show  up  on  the  stalls,  he  and  his  wife  ven- 


Extraterrestrials  among  us  97 


tured  into  Womrath’s  bookstore  on  Manhat¬ 
tan’s  Lexington  Avenue.  As  he  related  to  New 
York  writer  Tracy  Cochran,  the  two  noticed  a 
very  short  couple,  bundled  up  in  winter 
clothes,  looking  over  a  copy  of  Communion 
and  complaining  about  how  Strieber  had  got¬ 
ten  things  wrong.  They  spoke  “rapidly  in 
what  sounded  like  educated  Upper  East  Side 
Jewish  accents.”  When  Lee  introduced  him¬ 
self  as  a  William  Morrow  employee  and  asked 
politely  what  it  was  they  did  not  like  about 
the  book,  the  man  ignored  him,  but  the 
woman  communicated  such  “complete 
loathing,  hatred”  that  the  Lees  retreated  in 
shock  (Conroy,  1989).  They  noticed  that  the 
strange  couple  were  wearing  large  tinted 
glasses  that  did  not  entirely  hide  large  “dark, 
almond-shaped  eyes.”  Lee  later  took — and 
passed — a  polygraph  test. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Adamski,  George; 
Alien  diners;  Aura  Rhanes;  Bethurum,  Truman; 
Contactees;  Hybrid  beings;  Men  in  black;  Star 
People;  Strieber,  Whitley;  Wanderers;  William¬ 
son,  George  Hunt 


Further  Reading 

Adamski,  George,  1955.  Inside  the  Space  Ships.  New 
York:  Abelard-Schuman. 

Bethurum,  Truman,  1954.  Aboard  a  Flying  Saucer. 

Los  Angeles:  DeVorss  and  Company. 

Cochran,  Tracy,  1987.  “Invasion  of  the  Strieber 
Snatchers.”  New  York  (March  30):  26. 

Conroy,  Ed,  1989 .  Report  on  “Communion”:  An  Inde  - 
pendent  Investigation  of  and  Commentary  on  Whit  - 
ley  Strieber’s  “ Communion .  ”  New  York:  William 
Morrow. 

Honey,  C.  A.,  1959.  “Mail  Bag:  Belief  Confirmed.” 
Flying  Saucer  Review  5,  2  (March/April):  32-33. 

- ,  1979.  “Report  from  the  Readers.”  Fate  32, 

5  (May):  113-115. 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  1998.  The  Threat.  New  York: 
Simon  and  Schuster. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  UFOs:  Operation  Trojan  Horse. 

New  York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 

Steiger,  Brad,  1976.  Gods  of  Aquarius:  UFOs  and  the 
Transformation  of  Man.  New  York:  Harcourt 
Brace  Jovanovich. 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1959.  Road  in  the  Sky. 

London:  Neville  Spearman. 

Zinsstag,  Lou,  1990.  UFO...  George  Adamski: 
Their  Man  on  Earth.  Tucson,  AZ:  UFO  Photo 
Archives. 


Fairies  encountered 

Traditions  of  fairy  folk  can  be  found  anywhere 
in  the  world,  but  they  are  usually  spoken  of  in 
the  past  tense.  What  is  less  well  known  is  that 
such  beliefs  derive  not  just  from  distant  folk¬ 
lore  but  from  perceived  experiences  of  a  sort 
that  are  still  reported  from  time  to  time  even 
today.  British  anomalist  Janet  Bord  writes, 
“Today  the  knowledge  of  and  belief  in  fairies 
has  all  but  died  out  among  country 
people.  .  .  .  However [,]  the  changes  that  have 
occurred  this  century  have  not  resulted  in  the 
complete  extinction  of  the  fairies:  they  have 
survived,  because  people  still  see  them”  (Bord, 
1997).  Though  Victorian  popular  culture  per¬ 
petrated  the  notion  that  fairies  are  gauzy¬ 
winged  creatures,  the  fairies  of  tradition  have 
no  wings.  Beyond  that,  they  vary  in  appear¬ 
ance  from  region  to  region,  though  most  are 
small  and  humanlike,  sometimes  with  brown 
or  green  skin.  They  are  of  uncertain  tempera¬ 
ment  and,  thus,  best  avoided. 

Collectors  of  folklore — a  notion  and  disci¬ 
pline  that  came  into  existence  around  1800 — 
came  upon  many  firsthand  accounts.  These 
can  be  found  in  any  number  of  scholarly  texts 
on  fairy  lore.  Though  sometimes  puzzled  by 
the  apparent  sincerity  of  their  informants,  few 
folklorists  were  willing  to  take  the  leap  of  faith 
required  to  embrace  actual  belief  in  fairies. 


One  who  did,  however,  was  the  well-regarded 
W.  Y.  Evans-Wentz,  an  anthropologist  of  reli¬ 
gion  who  had  a  Ph.D.  from  Oxford  Univer¬ 
sity.  In  the  first  decade  of  the  twentieth  cen¬ 
tury,  Evans-Wentz  traveled  through  the  Celtic 
regions  of  the  British  Isles  as  well  as  Brittany 
(on  France’s  northwest  coast).  The  result  was  a 
folklore  classic,  The  Fairy  Faith  in  Celtic 
Countries  (originally  published  in  1911). 
Aside  from  its  worth  as  a  record  of  surviving 
fairy  beliefs  and  associated  superstitions,  it  is 
unique  in  its  championing  of  an  underlying 
reality  behind  the  tradition.  Like  the  pioneer¬ 
ing  Rev.  Robert  Kirk,  a  Scottish  clergyman 
whose  The  Secret  Common-Wealth  (1691)  pre¬ 
served  fairy  lore  in  the  Highlands,  Evans- 
Wentz  deduced  that  fairies  live  in  an  other- 
world  that  overlaps  with  the  human  world. 
He  went  so  far  as  to  claim  that  “we  can  postu¬ 
late  scientifically,  on  the  showing  of  the  data 
of  psychical  research,  the  existence  of  such  in¬ 
visible  intelligences  as  gods,  genii,  daemons, 
all  kinds  of  true  fairies,  and  disembodied 
men.” 

Not  all  purported  witnesses  were  the  uned¬ 
ucated  rural  folk  stereotypically  associated 
with  fairy  beliefs  and  encounters.  A  seven¬ 
teenth-century  Swedish  clergyman,  Peter 
Rahm,  gave  this  sworn  statement  to  legal  au¬ 
thorities: 


99 


A  man  is  prilled  back  before  he  enters  a  fairy  circle.  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


In  the  year  1660,  when  1  and  my  wife  had 
gone  to  my  farm,  which  is  three  quarters  of  a 
mile  from  Ragunda  parsonage,  and  we  were 
sitting  there  and  talking  awhile,  late  in  the 
evening,  there  came  a  little  man  in  at  the  door, 
who  begged  of  my  wife  to  go  and  aid  his  wife, 
who  was  just  in  the  pains  of  labor.  The  fellow 
was  of  small  size,  of  a  dark  complexion,  and 
dressed  in  old  gray  clothes.  My  wife  and  I  sat 
awhile,  and  wondered  at  the  man;  for  we  were 
aware  that  he  was  a  Troll,  and  we  had  heard  tell 
that  such  like,  called  by  the  peasantry  Vettar 
[spirits] ,  always  used  to  keep  in  the  farm¬ 
houses,  when  people  left  them  in  harvest-time. 
But  when  he  had  urged  his  request  four  or  five 
times,  and  we  thought  on  what  evil  the  coun¬ 
try  folk  say  that  they  have  at  times  suffered 
from  the  Vettar,  when  they  have  chance  to 
swear  at  them,  or  with  uncivil  words  bid  them 
to  go  to  hell,  I  took  the  resolution  to  read  some 
prayers  over  my  wife,  and  to  bless  her,  and  bid 
her  in  God’s  name  go  with  him.  She  took  in 
haste  some  old  linen  with  her,  and  went  along 
in  the  wind,  and  so  she  came  to  a  room,  on 
one  side  of  which  was  a  little  dark  chamber,  in 
which  his  wife  lay  in  bed  in  great  agony.  My 


wife  went  up  to  her,  and,  after  a  little  while, 
aided  her  till  she  brought  forth  the  child  after 
the  same  manner  as  other  human  beings.  The 
man  then  offered  her  food,  and  when  she  re¬ 
fused  it,  he  thanked  her,  and  accompanied  her 
out,  and  then  she  was  carried  along,  in  the 
same  way  in  the  wind,  and  after  a  while  came 
again  to  the  gate,  just  at  10  o’clock.  Mean¬ 
while,  a  quantity  of  old  pieces  and  clippings  of 
silver  were  laid  on  a  shelf,  in  the  sitting-room, 
and  my  wife  found  them  next  day,  when  she 
was  putting  the  room  in  order.  It  is  supposed 
that  they  were  laid  there  by  the  Vettar.  That  it 
in  truth  so  happened,  I  witness,  by  inscribing 
my  name.  Ragunda,  the  12th  of  April,  1671 
(Keightley,  1878). 

Another  cleric,  Edward  Williams,  a  British 
man  from  the  next  century,  recalled  a  strange 
experience  from  his  youth.  In  1757,  he  and 
his  fellow  schoolchildren,  playing  in  a  field  in 
Wales,  happened  to  notice  seven  or  eight  tiny 
couples.  Each  was  dressed  in  red,  and  each 
held  a  white  kerchief.  They  were  about  a  hun¬ 
dred  yards  away.  One  of  the  figures  suddenly 


Fairies  encountered  101 


took  after  a  child  and  nearly  caught  him.  Up 
close,  the  children  got,  in  Williams’s  words,  a 
“full  and  clear  view  of  his  ancient,  swarthy, 
grim  complexion.”  During  the  chase  another 
of  the  male  figures  shouted  at  the  pursuer  in 
an  unknown  language  (Jones,  1979).  Wil¬ 
liams,  who  went  on  to  become  a  prominent 
man  of  the  cloth,  never  forgot  the  incident 
but  was  never  able  to  explain  it.  “I  am  forced 
to  classify  it  among  my  unknowables,”  he 
wrote  (Jones,  1979). 

The  inherent  implausibility  of  fairies 
notwithstanding,  “sightings”  have  been  re¬ 
corded  even  in  recent  years.  On  August  10, 
1977,  while  patrolling  in  the  early  morning 
hours,  a  Hull,  England,  police  constable  came 
upon  a  fog  bank  in  a  nearby  field.  When  the 
fog  lifted,  he  saw  three  small  figures  dancing: 
a  man  dressed  in  a  “sleeveless  jerkin,  with 
tight-fitting  trousers”  and  two  women  clad  in 
“bonnets,  shawls  and  white  dresses” — hardly 
late  twentieth-century  clothing.  Assuming 
they  were  drunks,  the  officer  got  out  of  his  car 
and  walked  toward  them,  only  to  see  them 
vanish  in  front  of  his  eyes.  Many  fairy  ac¬ 
counts  describe  the  beings’  love  of  dancing. 
During  World  War  II,  for  example,  W.  E. 
Thorner,  making  his  way  with  great  difficulty 
through  a  furious  storm  along  a  clifftop  on 
Hoy  in  the  Orkney  Islands,  was  startled  to 
come  upon  small  creatures  “with  long,  dark, 
bedraggled  hair.”  They  were  dancing  wildly, 
“seeming  to  throw  themselves  over  the  cliff 
edge”  (Marwick,  1975). 

An  incident  in  County  Carlow,  Ireland,  in 
November  1959  claimed  four  witnesses.  In 
Dunroe,  a  man  named  John  Byrne  was  using 
a  bulldozer  to  move  a  large  bush  when  a  man 
no  more  than  three  feet  tall  abruptly  dashed 
out  from  underneath  it.  He  fled  across  a  field 
and  was  lost  to  view  after  he  jumped  over  a 
fence.  Three  other  men  observed  the  peculiar 
occurrence.  As  late  as  the  early  1990s,  fifteen- 
year-old  Brian  Collins,  vacationing  with  his 
parents  in  the  Aran  Islands  off  west  Donegal, 
was  taking  an  early  morning  walk  when  he 
spotted  two  men  fishing  in  the  sea  from  an 
overlooking  bank.  Three  and  a  half  feet  tall, 


dressed  in  green,  and  wearing  brown  boots, 
they  were  engaged  in  a  laugh-punctuated  con¬ 
versation  in  Gaelic.  Apparently  aware  of  his 
presence,  they  jumped  off  the  bank  and  were 
gone.  As  he  looked  for  them,  the  youth  found 
a  pipe  that  he  thought  was  one  of  theirs.  He 
put  it  in  a  locked  drawer,  from  which  it  subse¬ 
quently  disappeared.  He  saw  the  beings  again, 
and  this  time  he  tried  to  photograph  and 
tape-record  them,  but  nothing  of  them  devel¬ 
oped  on  either  film  or  tape. 

A  series  of  “sightings”  in  1938,  in  West 
Limerick,  began  when  schoolboy  John  Keely 
met  a  two-foot-tall  man,  dressed  in  red,  on  a 
road.  When  Keely  asked  him  where  he  was 
from,  the  strange  man  snapped,  “I’m  from  the 
mountains,  and  it’s  all  equal  to  you  what  my 
business  is.”  The  next  day  Keely  and  friends 
returned  to  the  scene.  The  friends  hid  in  the 
bushes  while  Keely  approached  a  group  of 
fairies.  One  took  his  hand,  and  they  walked 
together  for  a  short  distance.  The  fairies  ran 
away,  however,  when  they  saw  the  boys  in  the 
bushes.  Other  men  and  boys  reported  their 
own  encounters  in  the  same  area  at  the  same 
time,  and  the  Dublin-based  Irish  Press  carried 
stories.  The  men  had  chased  the  fairies,  but  as 
one  witness  put  it,  “they  jumped  the  ditches 
as  fast  as  a  greyhound.  .  .  .  Though  they 
passed  through  hedges,  ditches,  and  marshes, 
they  appeared  neat  and  clean  all  the  time.” 
Witnesses  said  the  beings  had  “hard,  hairy 
faces  like  men,  and  no  ears”  (Barry,  1938). 

On  a  casual  walk  along  the  shore  of  a 
peninsula  in  Scotland’s  Western  Highlands 
one  day  in  1972,  Artie  Traum,  an  American 
folk  singer,  heard  unusual  sounds.  As  he  lis¬ 
tened  more  carefully,  he  realized  they  were 
voices,  though  he  could  see  no  one  around. 
They  were  singing  “run,  man,  run”  in  a  weird 
harmony  while  fiddles  and  pipes  played  be¬ 
hind  them.  As  the  sounds  grew  ever  louder, 
Traum  panicked  and  fled  into  a  nearby 
woods.  Though  he  still  saw  nothing,  he  heard 
crackling  sounds  and  “great  motion”  as  if  he 
were  being  pursued.  As  all  this  was  happen¬ 
ing,  “my  head  was  swarming  with  thousands 
of  voices,  thousands  of  words  making  no 


102  Fairies  encountered 


sense.”  He  found  his  way  back  to  open  air, 
and  the  voices  and  the  music  ceased  (Traum, 
1972).  Traum’s  experience  is  like  many  re¬ 
counted  in  the  tradition.  Fairies  are  reputed  to 
drive  trespassers  off  their  home  turf  and,  also, 
to  love  music.  Both  folk  fiddlers  and  at  least 
one  classical  composer  (Thomas  Wood)  claim 
to  have  heard  fairy  music;  a  nineteenth-cen¬ 
tury  Manx  fiddler,  William  Cain,  was  not 
alone  in  learning  such  a  melody  and  incorpo¬ 
rating  it  into  his  repertoire. 

The  American  Indian  tribes  had  their  own 
versions  of  fairy  traditions,  but  the  Europeans 
who  settled  the  North  American  continent — 
except  for  places  where  Celtic  customs  took 
firm  root,  such  as  Newfoundland — fairly 
quickly  discarded  their  own.  Nonetheless,  oc¬ 
casional  incidents  in  which  fairylike  figures 
appeared,  even  if  not  identified  by  the  witness 
as  such,  have  allegedly  occurred.  All  of  his  life, 
Harry  Anderson  remembered  something  that 
had  happened  to  him  one  summer  night  in 
1919,  when  he  was  walking  alone  down  a 
rural  road  near  Barron,  Wisconsin.  To  his 
considerable  surprise,  his  solitary  stroll  was  in¬ 
terrupted  by  the  approach  of  twenty  little 
men  trooping  in  single  file  under  the  bright 
moonlight.  They  were  heading  in  his  direc¬ 
tion.  Everything  about  them  was  odd:  they 
were  shirtless,  bald,  pale-faced,  and  dressed  in 
leather  knee  pants.  “Mumbling”  sounds  came 
out  of  their  mouths;  yet  they  did  not  seem  to 
be  talking  with  each  other.  As  they  passed  the 
young  man,  they  seemed  oblivious  of  or  indif¬ 
ferent  to  his  presence.  By  now  Anderson  was 
so  unnerved  that  he  continued  on  his  way 
without  ever  looking  back. 

In  Canby,  Oregon,  one  day  in  April  1950, 
Ellen  Jonerson  was  working  on  her  lawn  when 
she  happened  to  glance  over  at  her  neighbor’s 
yard  and  saw  a  bizarre  sight:  a  twelve-inch  lit¬ 
tle  man  of  stocky  build  with  a  tanned  face;  he 
was  clad  in  overalls  and  plaid  shirt.  He  had 
what  looked  like  a  skullcap  on  his  head.  Jon¬ 
erson  ran  inside  to  make  a  quick  call  about  it 
to  a  friend.  When  she  returned,  the  figure  was 
walking  away  with  a  “waddling”  motion.  He 
passed  under  a  parked  car  and  was  seen  no 


more.  At  no  time  did  the  idea  that  she  was 
seeing  what  some  would  call  a  “fairy”  enter 
Jonerson’s  mind,  and  her  report  is  generally 
thought  of  as  a  UFO-related  close  encounter 
of  the  third  kind,  though  no  UFO  was  seen. 

Inevitably,  some  have  called  UFO  encoun¬ 
ters  a  modern  form  of  fairy  belief.  Among  the 
first  to  do  so  was  Jacques  Vallee,  author  of 
Passport  to  Magonia  (1969).Vallee  offered  an 
occult-oriented  interpretation  that  speculated 
that  an  incomprehensible  otherworld  has  in¬ 
teracted  with  humankind  for  thousands  of 
years,  producing  manifestations  that  are  fil¬ 
tered  through  human  consciousness  and  ex¬ 
pectation,  thus  changing  to  reflect  different 
times  and  cultures.  (Kirk  had  concluded  as 
much  in  the  late  seventeenth  century.  Fairies, 
of  a  “middle  nature  between  man  and  angel,” 
dress  and  speak  “like  the  people  and  country 
under  which  they  live”  [Sanderson,  1976].) 
Vallee  went  so  far  as  to  declare  flatly — if,  as 
critics  charged,  hyperbolically — that  “the 
modern,  global  belief  in  flying  saucers  and 
their  occupants  is  identical  to  an  earlier  belief 
in  the  fairy-faith.  The  entities  described  as  the 
pilots  of  the  craft  are  indistinguishable  from 
the  elves,  sylphs,  and  lutins.”  Debunkers  such 
as  Robert  Sheaffer  have  employed  a  different 
sort  of  argument  to  the  effect  that  flying 
saucers  and  their  occupants  are  as  much  a 
delusion  as  fairies  and  fairyland.  Neither  ap¬ 
proach,  however,  seems  a  wholly  adequate 
way  of  explaining  the  mysteries  inherent  in 
such  encounters,  which  paradoxically  offer  up 
“real”-seeming  encounters  with  things  that  al¬ 
most  certainly  do  not  exist  in  the  conven¬ 
tional  understanding  of  the  verb. 

Fairies  have  found  new  life  among  New 
Age  visionaries  and  channelers  and  other  ex¬ 
plorers  of  the  far  edges  of  consciousness.  One 
writer  remarks,  “There  are  two  major  differ¬ 
ences  between  the  old  oral  traditional  or  an¬ 
cestral  faery  contacts  and  those  of  contem¬ 
porary  humanity  removed  from  oral 
tradition.  .  .  .  The  first  is  that  while  our  ances¬ 
tors  often  sought  to  break  away  from  the  faery 
realm,  many  modern  contacts  are  intentional. 
They  are  induced  or  encouraged  by  various 


Fairy  captures  103 


means,  ranging  from  naive  New  Age  nuttiness 
to  expansions  and  willed  changes  of  awareness 
involving  techniques  handed  down  within  the 
old  traditions,  but  developed  and  applied  in  a 
modern  way”  (Stewart,  1995).  New  Age 
fairies  are  a  gentler  lot  than  their  harsh  coun¬ 
terparts  in  tradition.  Fairies  are  now  incorpo¬ 
rated  into  such  concerns  as  healing,  garden¬ 
ing,  Earth  awareness,  ritual  magic,  and 
personal  transformation — matters  far  re¬ 
moved  from  the  often  ill-tempered,  impa¬ 
tient,  anthrophobic  concerns  of  traditional 
fairies. 

See  Also:  Chaneques;  Close  encounters  of  the  third 
kind;  Cottingley  fairies;  Fairy  captures;  Magonia; 
Whites  little  people 

Further  Reading 

Barry,  John,  1938.  “Fairies  in  Eire.”  The  Living  Age 
355  (November):  265-266. 

Bord,  Janet,  1997.  Fairies:  Real  Encounters  with  Little 
People.  New  York:  Carroll  and  Graf  Publishers. 

Briggs,  Katharine,  1976.  An  Encyclopedia  of  Fairies: 
Hobgoblins,  Brownies,  Bogies,  and  Other  Supernat  - 
ural  Creattires.  New  York:  Pantheon  Books. 

Davis,  Isabel  L.,  1970.  Review  ofVallee’s  Passport  to 
Magonia.  UFO  Investigator  (June):  3. 

Evans,  Alex,  1978.  “Encounters  with  Little  Men.” 
Fate  31,11  (November) :  83-86. 

Evans-Wentz,  W.  Y.,  1966.  The  Fairy-Faith  in  Celtic 
Countries.  New  York:  University  Books. 

Galde,  Phyllis,  1993.  “I  See  by  the  Papers:  More 
Fairies  Seen.”  Fate  AG,  4  (April):  14-15. 

Jones,  T.  Gwynn,  1979.  Welsh  Folklore  and  Folk-Cus  - 
tom.  Totowa,  NJ :  Rowman  and  Littlefield. 

Keightley,  Thomas,  1878.  The  Fairy  Mythology.  Lon¬ 
don:  G.  Bell. 

MacManus,  D.  A.,  1959.  The  Middle  Kingdom:  The 
Faerie  World  of  Ireland.  London:  Max  Parrish. 

Marwick,  Ernest  W.,  1975.  The  Folklore  of  Orkney 
and  Shetland.  London:  B.  T.  Batsford. 

Narvaez,  Peter,  ed.,  1997.  The  Good  People:  New 
Fairylore  Essays.  Lexington:  University  Press  of 
Kentucky. 

Rojcewicz,  Peter  M.,  1984.  The  Boundaries  of  Ortho  - 
doxy:  A  Folkloric  Look  at  the  UFO  Phenomenon. 
Ph.D.  dissertation,  University  of  Pennsylvania. 

Sanderson,  Stewart,  ed.,  1976.  The  Secret  Common- 
Wealth  and  A  Short  Treatise  of  Charms  and  Spels  by 
Robert  Kirk.  Totowa,  NJ:  Rowman  and  Littlefield. 

Sheaffer,  Robert,  1981.  The  UFO  Verdict:  Examining 
the  Evidence.  Buffalo,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 

Stewart,  R.  J.,  1995.  The  Living  World  of  Faery. 
Glastonbury,  Somerset,  England:  Gothic  Image 
Publications. 


Traum,  Artie,  1972.  “Rollin’  and  Tumblin’:  The 
Cambridge  Festival.”  Crawdaddy  (November): 
20-22. 

Vallee,  Jacques,  1969.  Passport  to  Magonia:  From  Folk  - 
lore  to  Flying  Saucers.  Chicago:  Henry  Regnery. 

Wilkins,  Harold  T.,  1952.  “Pixie-Haunted  Moor.” 
Fate  5,  5  (July/ August):  110-116. 

Fairy  captures 

In  1 907,  Lady  Archibald  Campbell,  a  collec¬ 
tor  of  traditional  lore,  interviewed  a  blind 
man  and  his  wife  who  lived  in  conditions  of 
great  poverty  in  an  Irish  glen.  The  man  told 
her,  in  all  apparent  seriousness,  that  once  he 
had  captured  a  small  being  he  called  a  lep¬ 
rechaun.  It  was  two  feet  tall,  with  dark  but 
clear  skin  and  red  hair.  He  was  dressed  in  a 
red  cap,  green  clothes,  and  boots. 

“I  gripped  him  close  in  my  arms  and  took 
him  home,”  the  old  man  related.  “I  called  to 
the  woman  [his  wife]  to  look  at  what  I  had 
got.  ‘What  doll  is  it  that  you  have  there?’  she 
cried.  ‘A  living  one,’  I  said,  and  put  it  on  the 
dresser.  We  feared  to  lose  it;  we  kept  the  door 
locked.  It  talked  and  muttered  to  itself  queer 
words.  ...  It  might  have  been  near  on  a  fort¬ 
night  since  we  had  the  fairy,  when  I  said  to 
the  woman,  ‘Sure,  if  we  show  it  in  the  great 
city  we  will  be  made  up  [rich] .  So  we  put  it  in 
a  cage.  At  night  we  would  leave  the  cage  door 
open,  and  we  would  hear  it  stirring  through 
the  house.  .  .  .  We  fed  it  on  bread  and  rice  and 
milk  out  of  a  cup  at  the  end  of  a  spoon.” 

At  last  the  little  being  escaped,  and  after 
that  the  family’s  fortunes,  never  much  to 
begin  with,  declined  even  further.  The  man 
lost  his  sight,  and  the  couple  sank  ever  deeper 
into  poverty  and  despair. 

A  happier  story  recounts  not  so  much  the 
capture  of  a  fairy  as  the  domestication  of  one. 
Lady  Gregory  and  W.  B.  Yeats  heard  it  from 
an  old  couple,  the  Kellehers,  who  lived  in  the 
Wickland  Mountains  of  Ireland.  The  Kelle¬ 
hers  said  the  events  had  taken  place  years  be¬ 
fore,  when  they  were  newly  married. 

One  winter  day,  Mr.  Kelleher  encountered 
a  fairy  and,  in  some  unspecified  fashion,  got 
him  to  stay  in  the  house  for  the  next  week  or 


104  Fossilized  aliens 


two.  Dressed  in  a  red  cap  and  red  clothes,  the 
fairy  was  about  fifteen  inches  tall  and  seemed 
friendly,  though  he  kept  silent.  At  night  he 
slept  on  the  dresser.  The  Kellers  told  others  of 
their  unusual  guest,  and  sometimes  “when  the 
boys  at  the  public-house  were  full  of  porter, 
they  used  to  come  to  the  house  to  look  at 
him,  and  they  would  laugh  to  see  him,  but  I 
never  let  them  hurt  him.”  Kelleher  fed  him 
bread  and  milk  with  a  spoon.  As  the  days 
passed,  the  couple  noticed,  he  seemed  to  age, 
taking  on  “a  sort  of  wrinkled  look.” 

The  fairy  left  them  one  evening  after  an¬ 
other  of  its  kind  had  appeared  near  the  prop¬ 
erty.  Mr.  Kelleher  thought  it  was  a  fairy 
woman,  dressed  in  gray.  “And  that  evening,” 
he  related,  “when  I  was  sitting  beside  the  fire 
with  the  Missus  I  told  her  about  it,  and  the 
little  lad  that  was  sitting  on  the  dresser  called 
out,  ‘That’s  Geoffrey-a-wee  that’s  coming  for 
me,’  and  he  jumped  down  and  went  out  of 
the  door  and  I  never  saw  him.  I  thought  it  was 
a  girl  I  saw,  but  Geoffrey  wouldn’t  be  the 
name  of  a  girl,  would  it?  He  had  never  spoken 
before  that  time.” 

See  Also:  Fairies  encountered 

Further  Reading 

Gregory,  Lady,  1920.  Visions  and  Beliefs  in  the  West  of 
Ireland.  New  York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 


Fossilized  aliens 

Writing  in  Flying  Saucers  magazine  in  1970, 
Buffard  Ratliff,  the  head  of  a  Kentucky  UFO 
group,  reported  the  discovery  of  an  extrater¬ 
restrial  artifact:  a  fossilized  spacecraft  and  its 
tiny  crew. 

According  to  Ratliff,  two  years  earlier 
Melvin  Gray  of  Louisville  had  been  mowing 
his  lawn  when  he  came  upon  an  unusual 
stone.  He  kept  it  and  studied  it  for  months, 
eventually  concluding  that  it  was  living  proof 
of  a  prehistoric  space  visit.  Gray  handed  it  over 
to  ufologist  Ratliff,  who  also  examined  it  at 
length.  From  this  examination  he  was  able  to 
determine  what  the  stone  contained  and  what 
events  had  precipitated  its  creation.  It  was,  as 
he  would  write,  a  fossilized  craft  containing 


seven  very  small  creatures.  .  .  .  Three  ...  are 
ape-like  in  appearance.  The  other  four  are  hu¬ 
manoid.  .  .  .  All  creatures  are  approximately 
three  inches  in  height,  are  vertebrates,  and  have 
a  physical  build  that  indicates  they  were  very 
strong  for  their  size.  .  .  . 

The  [ape]  creatures  died  in  motion  as  if 
they  were  frozen  in  their  last  physical  action 
as  they  met  instant  death.  One  .  .  .  had  obvi¬ 
ously  been  critically  injured  and  two  of  his 
companions  are  trying  to  rescue  him.  .  .  .  Two 
of  [the  humanoids]  are  in  a  position  for  a 
crash  landing.  .  .  .  The  third  humanoid  is  sit¬ 
ting  in  what  looks  like  a  bucket  seat  with  one 
of  his  arms  extended  slightly  forward  and  up¬ 
ward  as  though  he  was  operating  a  control 
lever  or  device  to  try  to  bring  the  spaceship 
under  control. 

Ratliff  contended  that  the  crash  had  taken 
place  some  four  hundred  million  years  ago. 
The  fossil  survived  and  is  a  “permanent  record 
to  all  mankind  .  .  .  that  we  had  tiny  alien 
space  visitors  from  out  there  long,  long  ago.” 
Further  Reading 

Ratliff,  Buffard,  1970.  “A  Fossilized  Alien  Spaceship 
and  Its  Occupants.”  Flying  Saucers  (March):  6-7. 

Fourth  dimension 

In  occult  speculation  the  “fourth  dimension” 
is  a  parallel  universe  that  occupies  the  same 
space  as  ours  but  at  a  different  “vibrational” 
level.  Though  its  existence  has  never  been 
demonstrated  scientifically,  it  has  been  used  to 
explain  a  variety  of  ostensibly  mysterious  phe¬ 
nomena,  including  disappearances  in  the 
Bermuda  Triangle,  teleportation,  clairvoy¬ 
ance,  ghosts,  monsters,  UFOs,  and  more. 

The  concept  came  into  the  vocabulary  of 
occultism  through  Leipzig  astronomer  Johann 
F.  C.  Zollner,  a  student  of  Theosophy.  In  the 
1870s,  Zollner  worked  with  American 
medium  Henry  Slade,  who  claimed  the  ability 
to  materialize  or  teleport  objects  during 
seances.  As  Zollner  saw  it,  such  talents  indi¬ 
cated  that  mediums  can  move  things  out  of 
our  dimension  into  the  fourth  and  back  again. 
Unfortunately  for  Zellner’s  theory,  Slade  later 


Fry,  Daniel  William  105 


confessed  that  he  produced  the  effects  fraudu¬ 
lently.  Later  psychical  researchers,  however, 
used  variants  of  the  fourth-dimensional  idea 
to  explain  the  fate  of  the  soul  after  death. 

See  Also:  Bermuda  Triangle 

Further  Reading 

De  Camp,  L.  Sprague,  1980.  The  Ragged  Edge  of Sci  - 
ence.  Philadelphia,  PA:  Owlswick  Press. 

Layne,  N.  Meade,  1950.  The  Ether  Ship  and  Its  Solu  - 
tion.  Vista,  CA:  Borderland  Sciences  Research 
Associates. 


Frank  and  Frances 

Strolling  through  his  rural  property  near  Que¬ 
bec  City,  Quebec,  one  night  in  1941,  inventor 
Arthur  Henry  Matthews  encountered  two 
men,  each  six  feet  tall,  blue-eyed,  and  golden¬ 
haired.  After  introducing  themselves  as  Venu- 
sians,  they  expressed  interest  in  Matthews’s 
work  with  electrical  genius  Nikola  Tesla. 
Matthews  was  taken  to  a  waiting  spacecraft,  a 
giant  saucer-shaped  structure  called  “Mother 
Ship  X-12,”  which  housed  twenty-four 
smaller  craft  as  well  as  living  quarters  for  crew 
members.  At  one  point,  the  visitors  showed 
Matthews  the  control  room.  Contrary  to  his 
expectations,  it  was  bare  except  for  a  circular 
table  in  the  middle  and  four  “pilots,”  two  men 
and  two  women,  each  facing  one  of  the  four 
directions.  The  Venusians  explained  that  the 
craft  flew  on  mental  power  alone.  In  subse¬ 
quent  contacts,  Matthews  learned  that  one  of 
his  hosts  was  the  captain,  who  called  himself 
Frank.  He  also  met  Frank’s  “life  companion,” 
introduced  as  Frances.  Frank  said  the  names 
stood  for  “Truth.” 

Further  Reading 

Bord,  Janet,  and  Colin  Bord,  1991.  Life  beyond 

Planet  Earth?  Man’s  Contacts  with  Space  People. 

London:  GraftonBooks. 


Fry,  Daniel  William  (1908-1922) 

Daniel  Fry  was  among  the  leaders  of  the  early 
contactee  movement.  He  claimed  to  have  had 
his  first  contact  with  a  flying  saucer — a  “re¬ 
mote  controlled  cargo  carrier” — in  the  New 
Mexico  desert  on  July  4,  1950,  and  to  have 


Daniel  William  Fry  (Fortean  Picttire  Library) 

boarded  it  for  half  an  hour.  In  that  time  he 
was  whisked  to  and  from  New  York,  all  the 
while  conversing  with  the  voice  of  Alan,  a 
spaceman  communicating  from  a  mother  ship 
nine  hundred  miles  from  Earth.  When  Fry 
met  Alan  in  the  flesh  eleven  years  later,  the  ex¬ 
traterrestrial  turned  out  to  have  a  purely 
human  appearance.  Intelligent  and  articulate, 
Fry  was  often  described  by  his  followers  as  a 
“scientist,”  though  in  fact  he  had  been  no 
more  than  a  missile  mechanic  and  technician 
at  the  White  Sands  Proving  Ground  prior  to 
his  contactee  career.  He  founded  Understand¬ 
ing,  Inc.,  a  forum  for  the  space  people’s  meta¬ 
physical  and  scientific  teachings.  After  the 
1950s,  when  the  initial  excitement  generated 
by  the  first  contactees  had  waned,  Fry  became 
less  visible,  though  he  remained  quietly  active 
until  his  death  in  Alamogordo,  New  Mexico, 
in  1992. 

Fry  recounted  his  early  saucer  adventures 
in  the  widely  read  The  White  Sands  Incident 
and  Alan’s  Message:  To  Men  of  Earth,  both  pub¬ 
lished  in  1954.  That  same  year,  he  spoke  at 


106  Fry,  Daniel  William 


A  UFO  supposedly  photographed  by  Daniel  Fry  at  Merlin, 
Oregon,  May  1964  (Fortean  Picture  Library ) 


the  First  Annual  Flying  Saucer  Convention  in 
Los  Angeles.  At  a  press  conference,  a  reporter 
asked  him  if  he  would  take  a  lie-detector  test 
to  verify  his  claims.  When  Fry  agreed,  a  local 
television  station  arranged  a  polygraph  exami¬ 
nation.  The  examiner  concluded  that  Fry  was 
being  deceptive  in  his  answers.  Forever  after, 
Fry’s  critics  cited  the  allegedly  failed  test,  as 
well  as  a  dubious  Ph.D.  from  a  London-based 
diploma  mill,  to  argue  that  he  was  no  more 
than  a  hoaxer.  Still,  Fry  seemed  to  many  to  be 
sincere  about  his  metaphysical  beliefs,  perhaps 
using  fanciful  saucer  yarns  as  a  way  of  attract¬ 
ing  an  audience. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Fry,  Daniel  W.,  1954.  Alan’s  Message:  To  Men  of  Earth. 
Los  Angeles:  New  Age  Publishing  Company. 

- .  1954.  The  White  Sands  Incident.  Los  Ange¬ 
les:  New  Age  Publishing  Company. 

- .  1954.  “My  Experience  with  the  Lie  Detec¬ 
tor.”  Saucers  2,  3  (September):  6-8. 

National  Investigations  Committee  on  Aerial  Phe¬ 
nomena,  1967.  Information  Sheet  on  Daniel  Fry. 
Washington,  DC,  August. 

Reeve,  Bryant,  and  Helen  Reeve,  1957 '.  Flying  Saucer 
Pilgrimage.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 


Gabriel 

In  Christian  and  Islamic  tradition,  Gabriel  is 
one  of  the  two  mightiest  angels.  He  is  the 
only  angel  mentioned  in  the  Old  Testament, 
as  the  destroyer  of  Sodom  and  Gomorrah.  He 
is  said  to  sit  on  God’s  left  hand  and  to  preside 
over  Paradise.  Mohammed  credits  Gabriel 
with  dictating  the  Koran  to  him.  In  more  re¬ 
cent  times,  an  entity  named  Gabriel,  identify¬ 
ing  himself  as  an  archangel,  channels  through 
a  New  York  City  man  named  Robert  Baker. 

Gabriel  has  spoken  through  Baker  since 
1990.  His  principal  platform  is  the  weekly 
meeting  of  the  Communion  of  Souls  medita¬ 
tion  group.  Baker  has  a  cable-access  show, 
Gabriel  Speaks,  on  a  New  York  television  sta¬ 
tion  every  Monday  afternoon.  Gabriel,  who 
speaks  of  himself  in  the  plural,  says,  “We 
come  to  you  at  this  most  important  time  in 
the  evolution  of  your  planet,  a  time  of  unity 
of  Soul  and  Spirit  in  the  physical  body 
through  the  Light  and  Power  of  your  being. 
We  encourage  you  to  stand  in  the  Power  of 
One,  as  the  individual  Light  that  you  are,  to 
create  a  new  vision  for  your  world,  a  new 
Heaven  on  Earth  through  your  individual  ex¬ 
pression  of  unconditional  love  for  yourselves 
and  one  another.  We  challenge  you  to  act 
upon  life  as  creators  rather  than  having  life  act 
upon  you”  (“Gabriel  Speaks,”  n.d.). 


Further  Reading 

Davidson,  Gustav,  1967.  A  Dictionary  of  Angels  In  - 
eluding  the  Fallen  Angels.  New  York:  Free  Press. 
“Gabriel  Speaks,”  n.d.  http://childrenoflight.com/ 
gabriel.htm 


Gef 

Gef  is  the  central  character  in  an  episode  that 
psychical  researcher  Hereward  Carrington 
called  “preposterous” — a  “palpable  absurdity” — 
even  while  conceding  that  it  baffled  him.  Ac¬ 
cording  to  one  of  the  most  peculiar  stories  ever 
told  as  true,  Gef  was  a  talking  animal — a  self- 
identified  mongoose — who  plagued  a  family  on 
the  Isle  of  Man  between  1931  and  1938.  Nu¬ 
merous  investigators  came  to  the  site  and,  de¬ 
spite  suspicions  of  trickery,  left  empty-handed. 
Thirty  years  later,  when  located  and  inter¬ 
viewed,  the  one  surviving  member  of  the  family 
swore  to  Gef ’s  authenticity. 

In  1931,  the  Irving  family — father  James, 
mother  Margaret,  and  twelve-year-old  daugh¬ 
ter  Viorrey — lived  on  a  small  farm  known  as 
Doarlish  Cashen  (Cashen’s  Gap  in  English) 
on  the  Isle  of  Man  on  the  Irish  Sea  to  the 
northwest  of  England.  Facing  the  sea  and  750 
feet  above  it,  sat  their  two-story  stone  house. 
Inside,  the  walls  were  lined  with  dark  match- 
wood  paneling  set  a  few  inches  from  the 


107 


108  Gef 


Archangel  Gabriel  painted  by  Pietro  Vannucci  (Arte  &  Immagini  srl/Corbis) 


stone.  This  particular  construction  detail 
would  be  crucial  to  what  would  follow. 

One  evening  in  September  of  that  year,  so 
he  would  assert,  James  Irving  heard  a  tapping 
noise  from  the  boarded-up  attic.  The  next 
morning,  when  he  went  into  the  attic,  he 
found  a  wood  carving  that  he  recognized  as 
his  own.  He  had  no  idea  how  it  got  there,  but 
when  he  dropped  it,  he  heard  the  same  noise 
that  had  sounded  earlier.  That  evening  there 
were  more  sounds,  only  louder,  followed  by 
apparent  running.  As  Irving  would  tell  re¬ 
searcher  Nandor  Fodor,  “We  heard  animal 


sounds:  barking,  growling,  hissing,  spitting 
and  blowing”  (Carrington  and  Fodor,  1951). 
Suddenly  a  crack  shook  the  building  so  hard 
that  the  pictures  on  the  wall  moved.  Puzzled 
and  frightened,  the  family  listened  to  gurgling 
sounds  that  they  presumed  came  from  the  un¬ 
known  animal  but  which  could  as  easily  have 
come  from  a  baby  learning  to  speak.  A  bark 
“with  a  pleading  note  in  it”  came  next.  When 
Irving  made  barking  and  meowing  sounds 
himself,  apparently  in  an  effort  to  determine 
whether  the  animal  was  a  dog  or  cat,  the  crea¬ 
ture  imitated  him. 


Gef  109 


The  sounds  were  high-pitched  and  ap¬ 
peared  to  be  emanating  from  a  very  small 
throat. 

The  knockings  continued  for  the  next  few 
weeks.  Then  one  day,  Irving  asked  his  wife, 
“What  in  the  name  of  God  can  he  be?”  From 
the  walls  a  squeaky  voice  echoed,  “What  in 
the  name  of  God  can  he  be?”  These  were  the 
first  recognizable  words  from  Gef,  as  the  ani¬ 
mal  said  it  wanted  to  be  called.  As  time 
passed,  Gef,  whose  voice  was  said  to  be  two 
octaves  above  a  normal  woman’s,  appeared  to 
learn  more  and  more  words,  accumulating  a 
vocabulary  from  listening  to  the  family.  He 
also  claimed  to  travel  widely  throughout  the 
island,  overhearing  others  and  learning  from 
them.  He  also  brought  news  and  gossip  and 
regaled  family  members  with  information 
they  otherwise  would  not  have  known  and 
sometimes  did  not  want  to  know. 

For  his  part,  Gef  would  assert  that  for  a 
long  time  he  had  understood  what  people 
were  saying,  but  it  was  not  until  he  took  up 
residence  with  the  Irvings  that  he  learned  how 
to  speak  words  himself.  When  he  was  there, 
he  knew  everything  that  went  on  in  the 
house.  His  favorite  place,  however,  was  in  the 
walls  ofViorrey’s  room. 

Irving’s  first  impulse  was  to  kill  Gef,  who 
frightened  the  family  with  his  temper  and  his 
penchant  for  throwing  things  such  as  stones. 
First,  he  tried  to  poison  him,  then  to  shoot 
him,  but,  in  response,  Gef  caused  property 
damage  and  screeched  out  threats.  According 
to  Irving,  Gef  said,  “If  you  are  kind  to  me,  I 
will  bring  you  good  luck.  If  you  are  not  kind, 
I  shall  kill  all  your  poultry.  I  can  get  them 
wherever  you  put  them.”  The  family  decided 
to  do  its  best  to  get  along  with  its  strange 
guest. 

Asked  who  he  was,  Gef  first  identified  him¬ 
self  as  a  “ghost  in  the  form  of  a  weasel”  but 
later  denied  that  he  was  a  ghost  or  a  polter¬ 
geist.  He  was  highly  temperamental,  his  be¬ 
havior  unpredictable,  his  speech  often  pro¬ 
fane.  The  family  left  food  out  for  him.  He  ate 
the  same  food  as  the  daughter,  a  detail  that 
skeptics  would  later  remark  on.  In  return,  he 


would  provide  the  Irvings  with  dead  rabbits 
that  would  show  up  on  the  doorstep.  The  rab¬ 
bits  appeared  to  have  been  strangled  rather 
than  bitten  to  death. 

As  Gef  became  known  and  feared  through¬ 
out  the  island,  someone  suggested  that  he 
might  be  a  mongoose,  though  at  that  point  no 
one  had  ever  seen  him.  Mongooses  (mammals 
ordinarily  found  in  India)  are  not  native  to 
the  isle,  but  in  1914  a  local  farmer  had  im¬ 
ported  them  to  kill  rabbits.  When  asked  if  he 
was  a  mongoose,  Gef  said  he  was.  At  other 
times,  though,  he  boasted,  “Thou  wilt  never 
know  who  I  am.  I  am  a  freak.  I  have  hands, 
and  I  have  feet.”  On  another  occasion  he  said, 
“I  am  the  fifth  dimension.  I  am  the  eighth 
wonder  of  the  world.  I  can  split  the  atom.” 
Still,  the  idea  took  hold  that  Gef  was  a  mon¬ 
goose,  and  he  took  to  calling  himself  one. 

But  if  eyewitness  testimony  is  to  be  be¬ 
lieved,  he  could  not  have  been  a  mongoose. 
Those  who  saw  him,  according  to  investigator 
Walter  McGraw,  “said  he  had  a  bushy  tail  like 
a  squirrel’s,  yellow  to  brownish  fur,  small  ears 
and  a  pushed-in  face.  His  most-often  de¬ 
scribed  features  were  his  front  paws,  which  ac¬ 
cording  to  Irving  were  handlike  with  three 
fingers  and  a  thumb”  (McGraw,  1970).  Mc¬ 
Graw  adds,  “he  fitted  the  description  of  a 
mongoose  about  as  well  as  he  did  that  of  ‘part 
of  the  fifth  dimension’.”  Irving  estimated  that 
he  was  no  more  than  five  or  six  inches  long 
and  weighed  no  more  than  a  pound  to  a 
pound  and  a  half.  Sightings  of  him  were  al¬ 
ways  fleeting,  and  on  rare  occasion  the  Irvings 
saw  him  in  silhouette  as  a  shadow  in  the  wall. 
Gef  said  he  did  not  want  to  be  seen  because 
he  was  terrified  of  being  captured  or  killed.  A 
photograph  Yiorrey  took  of  him  at  a  distance 
of  five  hundred  feet  showed  little  except  a 
furry  blur. 

By  early  1932,  news  of  Gef’s  doings  had 
spread  past  the  isle.  In  a  dispatch  dated  Janu¬ 
ary  10,  a  Manchester  Daily  Dispatch  reporter 
wrote  that  on  a  visit  to  Doarlish  Cashen  he 
had  heard  “a  voice  I  never  imagined  could 
issue  from  a  human  throat,”  leaving  him  in  “a 
state  of  considerable  perplexity .  .  .  The  peo- 


110  Gef 


pie  here  at  the  farm  .  .  .  seem  sane,  honest  and 
responsible  folk.  ...  I  find  that  others,  too, 
have  had  my  strange  experience”  (Wilkins, 
1952).  As  the  publicity  spread,  an  American 
promoter  offered  the  family  fifty  thousand 
dollars  for  the  right  to  exhibit  Gef  commer¬ 
cially.  He  was  refused.  Other  investigators 
heard  Gef  s  voice  and  witnessed  apparent  evi¬ 
dence  of  his  activities,  including  stone-throw¬ 
ing  and  knowledge  of  events  at  a  distance,  but 
none  saw  him.  Others,  such  as  psychical  re¬ 
searcher  Nandor  Fodor,  who  spent  some  days 
with  the  Irvings,  could  only  collect  testimony. 
Gef  tended  to  go  into  hiding  when  investiga¬ 
tors  showed  up.  In  an  amusing  sidelight,  after 
one  investigator,  BBC  journalist  R.  S.  Lam¬ 
bert,  declared  that  Gef  might  well  exist,  a 
critic  called  him  “crazy.”  Lambert  took  him  to 
court  and  presented  a  sufficiently  persuasive 
case  that  he  was  awarded  seven  thousand 
pounds  in  damages. 

Beyond  anecdotal  testimony,  evidence  of 
Gef  s  physical  existence  was  slight.  Harry 
Price,  the  famous  “ghost  hunter”  who  later 
wrote  a  book  on  the  case,  saw  liquid  dripping 
from  the  wall  and  was  told  that  this  was  Gef 
urinating.  Hair  said  to  be  from  Gef  turned 
out  to  be  from  a  dog  curiously  like  the  Irvings’ 
sheepdog,  Mona.  The  prints  he  allegedly  al¬ 
lowed  the  Irvings  to  preserve  in  clay  were  not 
at  all  like  a  mongoose’s  or,  for  that  matter,  any 
known  animal’s. 

Over  time,  so  the  Irvings  related,  Gef ’s  vis¬ 
itations  became  rarer  and  rarer.  By  1938  or  so 
he  was  heard  from  for  the  last  time.  By  then 
the  whole  outlandish  affair  had  fallen  into  ob¬ 
scurity.  It  was  too  much  even  for  the  most 
sensationalistic  newspapers;  and  parapsychol¬ 
ogists,  who  first  took  it  to  be  an  exotic  polter¬ 
geist  case,  did  not  know  what  to  make  of  it. 
The  only  precedent  for  something  like  Gef 
was  a  witch’s  familiar  (an  animal  form  in 
which  witches  are  sometimes  said  to  appear), 
and  on  the  Isle  of  Man  in  the  1930s,  belief  in 
witchcraft  had  largely  passed. 

Though  investigators  looked  carefully  for 
it,  only  one  caught  the  Irvings  in  anything 
that  looked  like  suspect  activity.  From  the  be¬ 


ginning,  skeptics  wondered  if  “Gef’  weren’t  a 
fiction  created  by  skilled  ventriloquism.  Early 
in  the  course  of  the  episode,  a  reporter  for  the 
Isle  of  Man  Examiner  thought  he  caught  Vior- 
rey  making  a  squeaking  sound,  though  her  fa¬ 
ther  insisted  the  sound  was  coming  from  the 
other  side  of  the  room.  Aside  from  this  am¬ 
biguous  episode,  investigators  on  site  ex¬ 
pressed  doubts  that  so  complex  a  hoax  could 
be  accomplished  so  simply,  even  if  it  were 
physically  possible,  which  struck  them  as  al¬ 
most  out  of  the  question.  Locally,  the  Irvings 
were  regarded  as  reliable,  honest  people.  If 
they  were  hoaxers,  their  motives  were  clearly 
not  financial.  They  made  practically  no 
money  from  their  participation  in  the  matter. 

The  Irvings  eventually  moved  away  from 
Doarlish  Cashen  and  dropped  into  obscurity. 

Skeptical  theories  have  focused  on  Vior- 
rey’s  role.  In  1983,  Melvin  Harris  speculated 
that  she  had  first  tricked  her  parents  with 
ventriloquism.  Later,  even  after  they  realized 
that  they  had  been  fooled,  her  parents  got 
caught  up  in  the  hoax  and  played  along  with 
it.  Harris  writes,  “Gef  never  had  a  personality 
or  existence  independent  of  Yiorrey.  He 
brought  home  rabbits,  as  did  Yiorrey.  His  fa¬ 
vorite  foods  were  also  Viorrey’s  favorites.  He 
shared  her  strong  interests  in  mechanical 
things.” 

In  the  late  1960s,  after  thirty  years  of  si¬ 
lence,  Viorrey  was  located  and  interviewed 
somewhere  in  England  (she  insisted  that  her 
place  of  residence  be  kept  confidential).  She 
told  Walter  McGraw  that  she  despised  Gef, 
who  she  thought  had  ruined  her  life.  She  said 
that  he  had  caused  her  pain  and  embarrass¬ 
ment,  and,  even  at  the  time,  she  and  her 
mother  had  hated  the  publicity.  “It  was  not  a 
hoax,”  she  said,  “and  I  wish  it  had  never  hap¬ 
pened.  .  .  .  We  were  snubbed.  ...  I  had  to 
leave  the  Isle  of  Man,  and  I  hope  that  no  one 
where  I  work  now  ever  knows  the  story.  Gef 
has  even  kept  me  from  getting  married.  How 
could  I  ever  tell  a  man’s  family  about  what 
happened?”  She  complained  bitterly  that  Gef 
“made  me  meet  people  I  didn’t  want  to  meet. 
Then  they  said  I  was  ‘mental’  or  a  ventrilo- 


Gordon  111 


quist.  Believe  me,  if  I  was  that  good  I  would 
jolly  well  be  making  money  from  it  now!” 
(McGraw,  1970). 

Further  Reading 

Carrington,  Hereward,  and  Nandor  Fodor,  1951. 
Haunted  People:  Story  of  the  Poltergeist  down  the 
Centuries.  New  York:  E.  E  Dutton  and  Company. 
Harris,  Melvin,  1983.  “The  Mongoose  That  Talked 
and  Lost  for  Words.”  In  Peter  Brookesmith,  ed. 
Open  Files,  19—27.  London:  Orbis  Publishing. 
McGraw,  Walter,  1970.  “Gef — The  Talking  Mon¬ 
goose  ...  30  Years  Later.”  Fate  23,  7  (July): 
74-82. 

Wilkins,  Harold  T„  1952.  “History  of  the  Talking 
Mongoose.”  Fate  5,  4  (June):  58-69. 


Germane 

Germane  channels  through  Lyssa  Royal.  “He” 
is  neither  male  nor  female,  and  he  does  not 
have  a  name;  Germane  is  simply  an  identifica¬ 
tion  of  convenience.  He  is  from  “a  realm  of 
integration  that  does  not  have  a  clear-cut  den¬ 
sity/dimensional  level.”  He  is  not  even  an  en¬ 
tity  as  such  but  a  kind  of  personification  of  a 
group-consciousness  energy.  In  the  distant  fu¬ 
ture,  once  human  beings  have  been  fully  inte¬ 
grated  spiritually,  physically,  emotionally,  and 
mentally,  they  will  be  like  him. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

“ET  Civilizations — Germane,”  1994.  http://www. 
lemuria.net/article-et-civilizations.html 


Goblin  Universe 

Goblin  Universe  is  a  kind  of  catchall  phrase 
some  people  use  to  characterize  the  realm  of 
fantastic  but,  according  to  some,  real  entities 
and  creatures  that  seem  out  of  place  in  our  or¬ 
dinary  understanding  of  reality.  The  Goblin 
Universe  is  said  to  house  everything  from 
demons  and  fairies  to  ghosts,  humanoids,  and 
monstrous  beasts.  It  is  an  explicitly  paranor¬ 
mal  or  occult  concept,  rejected  by  some 
anomalists  who  insist  that  the  objects  of  their 
investigations — whether  UFOs  or  unknown 
animals  such  as  Sasquatch  or  the  Loch  Ness 
monster — are  simply  so  far  undocumented  as¬ 
pects  of  this  universe  or  planet. 


To  its  proponents,  however,  the  Goblin 
Universe  is  a  deeply  mysterious,  elusive  place. 
The  late  F.  W.  Holiday  called  it  “a  hall  of  dis¬ 
torting  mirrors.  ...  It  will  not  be  ignored.  Pol¬ 
tergeists  often  throw  objects  at  utter  skeptics. 
Members  of  the  Phantom  Menagerie  appear 
in  front  of  bored  cops  who  want  only  to  scrib¬ 
ble  their  daily  reports  and  go  home.  UFOs 
swoop  over  cities  like  Washington,  Rome  and 
London  to  thumb  their  noses  at  bureau¬ 
crats.  .  .  .  Like  it  or  lump  it,  we  are  all  in  that 
damned  Hall  of  Mirrors”  (Holiday,  1986). 

See  Also:  Fairies  encountered 

Further  Reading 

Holiday,  F.  W,  1986.  The  Goblin  Universe.  St.  Paul, 
MN:  Llewellyn  Publications. 


Gordon 

“Gordon”  is  the  name  of  an  ostensible  extra¬ 
terrestrial  whom  two  Alaska  women  claim  to 
have  encountered  while  traveling  through 
western  Canada  in  October  1974.  Their  story 
amounts  to  a  UFO-age  variant  of  the  venera¬ 
ble  legend  of  the  “vanishing  hitchhiker.” 

Edmoana  Toews  of  Anchorage  and  her 
friend  Nuria  Hanson  were  returning  from  a 
convention  of  the  Coptic  Christian  Fellowship 
of  America  in  Kalamazoo,  Michigan.  On  Oc¬ 
tober  18,  they  were  driving  on  the  summit  of 
Steamboat  Mountain  in  British  Columbia 
when  they  spotted  two  lights.  One,  three  times 
the  apparent  size  of  the  moon,  approached 
them,  then  shot  away  to  hover  in  the  sky.  The 
other  light  resting  on  the  mountainside, 
looked,  on  closer  examination,  like  a  derby  hat 
with  portholes.  The  two  women  pulled  into  an 
abandoned  driveway  and  watched  the  two  ob¬ 
jects  for  forty-five  minutes.  At  one  point,  the 
landed  UFO  rose  and  flew  one  hundred  to  one 
hundred  fifty  feet  before  resettling  on  the 
ground.  During  the  sighting,  a  truck  stopped, 
and  the  driver  emerged  to  look  at  the  UFOs, 
but  the  women  would  not  approach — one  of  a 
number  of  actions  (or  inactions)  they  were 
later  unable  to  understand. 

When  they  resumed  their  journey  along  an 
icy,  fog-covered  highway,  something  seemed 


112  Gray  Face 


to  take  control  of  the  car,  even  managing 
curves  perfectly.  But  no  matter  what  Toews 
did,  the  vehicle  traveled  at  no  more  than 
twenty-five  miles  per  hour.  She  and  her  friend 
also  became  aware  of  a  bright  light  shining 
through  the  mist.  It  was  coming  from  a  white 
cloud  twenty  to  thirty  feet  above  them.  As 
their  trip  went  on,  Toews  was  shocked  to  see 
that  no  matter  how  far  they  went,  the  gas 
gauge  did  not  move. 

Late  that  night,  they  stopped  at  a  lodge  at 
Muncho  Lake.  It  was  closed,  but  they  got  out 
of  their  car  to  stretch  their  legs.  A  young  man, 
dark-haired  and  bearded,  stepped  out  of  the 
darkness.  Though  the  temperature  was  barely 
above  zero,  the  man  was  dressed  only  in  shirt, 
pants,  and  shoes.  The  car  was  packed,  and  the 
women  insisted  there  was  no  room  for  him, 
but  he  still  persuaded  them  to  drive  him  to 
the  next  lodge,  some  eighty  miles  away,  where 
he  said  he  worked.  The  space  was  so  cramped 
that  he  had  to  sit  on  Hansons  lap.  Strangely, 
she  could  feel  no  weight.  When  she  remarked 
on  it,  he  responded  humorously  but  vaguely. 

Toews  asked  his  name.  He  leaned  toward 
her  and  stared  into  her  eyes  before  saying, 
“Gordon.”  Both  women  thought  he  looked 
familiar,  but  neither  could  place  him.  He  was 
pleasant  and  friendly  in  his  manner.  After  the 
UFO  reappeared  above  trees  along  the  high¬ 
way,  Gordon  inquired  about  their  views  of  life 
in  the  universe  and  of  angels.  In  time,  Toews 
understood  why  Gordon  didn’t  seem  to  weigh 
anything:  he  was  hovering  about  two  inches 
in  the  air.  She  even  covertly  ran  her  hand 
under  him  to  make  sure. 

When  they  stopped  for  the  night  at  an  inn 
in  northern  British  Columbia,  Gordon  sud¬ 
denly  was  no  longer  there.  The  women  looked 
and  called  for  him,  but  he  had  not  even  left 
tracks  in  the  snow.  They  were  sure  that  he  had 
stepped  out  of  the  car  with  them  and  that  he 
couldn’t  have  been  out  of  their  sight  for  more 
than  a  few  seconds. 

The  inn  was  closed,  so  they  stayed  in  the 
lounge  with  a  truck  driver,  who  refused  to  be¬ 
lieve  that  they  could  have  come  all  the  way 
from  Steamboat  Mountain — one  hundred 


sixty-five  miles  away — under  existing  road 
and  weather  conditions.  The  strangeness  of 
their  situation  did  not  hit  them  until  the  next 
night,  when  they  were  staying  at  another 
lodge.  Toews  suddenly  realized  that  Gordon 
reminded  her  of  her  husband,  Jim,  who  had 
the  same  hair  color,  eyes,  mannerism,  body 
shape.  And  her  husband’s  middle  name  was 
Gordon. 

The  following  morning  they  set  off.  At  first 
conditions  were  good,  but  soon  a  storm  came 
down.  Weirdly,  though,  the  road  ahead  of 
them  remained  dry,  even  as  snow  fell  and 
swirled  on  either  side.  They  looked  up  to  see 
the  mysterious  cloud  they  had  observed  ear¬ 
lier.  Later,  their  car  engine  failed,  and  two 
mysterious  men  who  seemed  to  know  things 
about  the  women  that  strangers  could  not 
have  known  helped  them  restart  it.  The  cloud 
left  only  as  Toews’s  car  got  to  Anchorage  and 
four  blocks  away  from  her  house. 

The  women  came  to  believe  that  Gordon 
was  either  a  spaceman  or  an  angel.  Eventually, 
Joseph  J.  Brewer,  Judge  of  the  District  Court 
in  Anchorage,  heard  of  their  experience  and 
interviewed  them.  He  and  Toews  wrote  an  ac¬ 
count  of  it  in  Fate,  a  popular  magazine  on  the 
paranormal  and  occult. 

Further  Reading 

Toews,  Edmoana,  with  Joseph  J.  Brewer,  1977.  “The 
UFOs  That  Led  Us  Home.”  Fate  Pt.  I.  30,  6 
(June):  38-45;  Pt.  II.  30,  7  (July):  63-65,  68-69. 


Gray  Face 

“Gray  Face”  was  the  name  Clyde  Preston,  a 
North  Carolina  truck  driver,  gave  to  one  of  a 
number  of  extraterrestrials  who  visited  him 
over  a  nearly  two-decade-long  period.  In 
1993,  under  hypnosis,  Preston  recalled  being 
abducted  into  a  UFO  in  the  course  of  a  (con¬ 
sciously  remembered)  close  encounter  with  a 
UFO  while  he  was  on  a  run  to  South  Dakota. 
While  aboard  the  UFO,  he  encountered  a  hu¬ 
manoid  being  he  calls  “Gray  Face.” 

Even  before  the  abduction  memories  sur¬ 
faced,  however,  Preston  underwent  a  series  of 
strange  experiences  that  he  believed  were  tied 


Great  Mother  113 


to  his  close  encounter.  He  suffered  serious  mi¬ 
graine  headaches  in  the  wake  of  that  sighting. 
They  left  only  after  he  discussed  his  encounter 
with  a  ufologist.  Soon  afterward,  he  developed 
psychic  abilities  that  would  come  and  go  errat¬ 
ically.  They  so  disrupted  his  life  that  his  wife, 
fearing  he  had  lost  his  sanity,  left  him.  He  un¬ 
derwent  out-of-body  episodes  and  found  him¬ 
self  doing  automatic  writing  at  a  furious  pace. 
These  writings  covered  many  subjects,  from 
Earth’s  ancient  history  to  future  geological  cat¬ 
aclysms.  Much  of  the  material  had  to  do  with 
the  Bible.  The  writing  claimed  that  the  Ten 
Commandments  were  a  kind  of  universal  code 
that  must  be  deciphered,  then  obeyed. 

One  night  in  1993,  Preston  awoke  and 
spotted  a  beam  of  light  going  through  his 
chest.  He  felt  intense  pain,  then  had  the  sen¬ 
sation  that  he  was  being  pulled  out  of  his 
body.  Two  shadowy  beings,  reeking  of  evil  and 
menace,  had  him  by  the  arms  and  were  forc¬ 
ing  him  to  a  black  abyss.  This  abyss,  he 
thought,  was  the  entrance  to  hell.  He  began  to 
pray,  and  the  next  thing  he  knew,  a  beautiful 
blue  sky  surrounded  him.  A  soothing  light, 
emanating  apparently  from  God,  gave  him  a 
feeling  of  peace  and  ecstasy.  Though  he  did 
not  wish  to  return  to  his  body,  something  told 
him  that  he  must  do  so,  and  he  did.  He  lay 
awake  the  rest  of  the  night  reflecting  on  all 
that  had  happened  to  him,  and  in  the  morn¬ 
ing  he  vowed  to  find  a  hypnotist  who  could 
help  him  fill  in  the  gaps  in  his  memory. 

While  hypnotized,  he  recounted  the  1977 
abduction  as  well  as  others.  These  abductions 
occurred  in  a  foggy,  dreamlike  environment. 
Besides  Gray  Face,  there  was  White  Face, 
which  looked  like  a  carving  of  an  Egyptian 
deity.  Another  entity,  this  one  especially 
frightening,  wore  a  mask  with  a  face  like  a 
Mayan  or  Aztec  god.  A  week  after  the  hypno¬ 
sis  session,  this  being  appeared  in  Preston’s 
bedroom  and  removed  the  mask.  Preston  was 
somewhat  relieved  to  see  that  it  resembled 
Gray  Face  with  slightly  heavier  features. 

In  each  case,  telepathic  contact  occurred, 
but  it  was  always  one-sided,  coming  from  the 
aliens  to  Preston. 


He  also  had  two  encounters,  only  an  hour 
apart,  with  Mr.  Brown  Robe,  as  he  called  a  fig¬ 
ure  clad  in  such  a  garment.  It  had  no  facial  fea¬ 
tures,  but  it  was  able  to  communicate  men¬ 
tally.  It  stressed  the  importance  of  Matthew  24 
in  the  New  Testament,  the  chapter  in  which 
Jesus  discusses  the  events  that  will  take  place 
just  prior  to  the  Second  Coming.  Preston  no¬ 
ticed  that  Mr.  Brown  Robe,  Gray  Face,  and 
the  others  never  used  the  word  “God”  but  did 
talk  of  a  “universal  intelligence.”  Still,  he 
linked  his  visitors  with  Bible  figures.  He  be¬ 
lieved  Brown  Robe,  for  example,  to  be  a  kind 
of  angel,  Gray  Face  a  “Watcher”  from  the  Old 
Testament’s  Daniel  4. 

Preston’s  last  abduction  occurred  one  night 
in  1995  when  a  group  of  gray-skinned,  large¬ 
eyed  humanoids — the  classic  “grays”  of  ab¬ 
duction  lore — took  him  into  a  UFO,  where 
he  was  subjected  to  an  apparent  medical  ex¬ 
amination.  On  his  return  at  2:50  A.M.,  he 
heard  a  mechanical  voice  speaking  to  him.  It 
said  that  the  world’s  governments  not  only 
knew  about  the  presence  of  extraterrestrials 
but  also  had  contact  with  them.  The  aliens 
warned  the  governments  about  the  dangers  of 
nuclear  testing  and  environmental  destruc¬ 
tion.  By  their  blundering,  humans  had  un¬ 
knowingly  caused  trouble  with  forces  beyond 
their  comprehension.  One  consequence  was 
that  Earth’s  magnetism  had  been  altered. 

Preston’s  contacts  ended  with  that  experi¬ 
ence.  In  retrospect,  he  concluded  that  the 
aliens  had  not  always  told  him  the  straight 
truth,  that  much  of  what  they  told  him  was 
not  strictly  accurate.  He  thought  that  some 
had  been  agents  of  Satan,  while  others,  such 
as  Gray  Face  and  Mr.  Brown  Robe,  had  be¬ 
nign  intentions. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs 

Further  Reading 

Davis,  Carolyn,  1998.  “The  UFO  Messenger.”  Fate 
51,  11  (November):  22-24. 


Great  Mother 

In  Escape  from  Destruction  (1955),  which  was 
later  reprinted  as  Escape  to  the  Inner  Earth, 


114  Great  White  Brotherhood 


Raymond  Bernard — the  pseudonym  of  Wal¬ 
ter  Siegmeister — wrote  of  his  association  with 
a  Puerto  Rican  psychic  known  as  Mayita, 
“whose  body  functions  as  an  interplanetary 
radio.”  From  extraterrestrial  sources,  Mayita 
learned  that  an  atomic  war  would  erupt  on 
Earth  between  1965  and  1970  and  that  by 
2000,  the  planet’s  surface  would  be  devoid  of 
any  kind  of  life.  Those  few  humans  of  suffi¬ 
ciently  pure  body  and  spirit  would  be  lifted 
from  Earth  and  flown  by  flying  saucers  to  a 
safe  haven  on  Mars.  Mayita’s  principal  contact 
was  the  Great  Mother,  who  lived  on  the 
sun — not,  she  informed  the  psychic,  the  un- 
endurably  hot  star  we  believe  it  to  be.  The 
Great  Mother,  described  as  having  a  beautiful 
face,  long  golden  hair,  and  deep  blue  eyes,  re¬ 
lated  to  her  the  story  of  humankind’s  secret 
past. 

One  hundred  fifty  thousand  years  ago,  the 
Great  Mother,  then  living  on  Uranus,  gave 
birth,  via  parthenogenesis  (self-fertilization), 
to  the  first  members  of  a  race  of  superwomen. 
For  the  next  fifty  thousand  years  they  lived  in 
a  utopian  society.  That  ended  when  a  mutant 
named  Lucifer  came  into  the  world.  Lucifer 
was  a  “defective  .  .  .  sterile  female” — a  man,  in 
other  words.  Filled  with  resentment,  he  even¬ 
tually  convinced  himself  of  his  superiority. 
Using  electromagnetic  waves  (sexual  inter¬ 
course  did  not  yet  exist),  he  persuaded  some 
of  his  sisters  to  let  him  impregnate  them  so 
that  they  would  give  birth  to  males  as  well  as 
females.  Outraged  that  more  mutants  were 
being  brought  into  the  world,  the  Great 
Mother  exiled  Lucifer,  his  wives,  and  their 
children  to  Saturn.  On  that  planet,  Lucifer 
changed  his  name  to  Satan  and  used  his  male 
aggressiveness  and  propensity  for  anger  and 
violence  to  institute  harsh  rule.  His  children 
thrived,  however.  After  another  fifty  thousand 
years  Lucifer/Satan  turned  his  eyes  on  the  one 
planet  the  Great  Mother’s  daughters  had  yet 
to  colonize:  the  Earth. 

A  fleet  of  spaceships  landed  on  Earth,  and 
Satan’s  reign  began.  Many  of  the  immigrants 
from  Saturn  settled  in  Lemuria  and  Atlantis, 
finally  destroying  them  both  in  the  course  of 


nuclear  conflict.  After  that,  the  human  race’s 
degeneration  went  on  at  an  alarming  pace. 
War,  cruelty,  and  suffering  have  continued 
unabated  over  many  centuries.  Earth’s  male 
and  female  inhabitants  commit  the  great 
abomination  of  meat-eating,  and  they  also  en¬ 
gage  in  the  loathsome  practice  of  sexual  inter¬ 
course.  Men  dominate  women,  even  though 
the  latter  are  superior  to  the  former,  because 
of  sexual  desire  and  painful,  nonpartheno- 
genetic  birth.  Even  when  they  think  they  are 
worshipping  God,  they  are  worshipping 
Satan. 

Only  those  human  beings  who  abstain 
from  sex,  meat,  caffeine,  alcohol,  and  tobacco 
can  hope  to  restore  moral  and  intellectual 
order  to  their  existence.  Flying  saucers  will 
rescue  them  at  the  last  moment.  On  their  ar¬ 
rival  on  Mars,  men  and  women  will  be  sepa¬ 
rated  and  will  live  chaste,  segregated  lives.  In 
this  new  paradise,  they  will  go  beyond  vege¬ 
tarianism  and  learn  to  subsist  on  air  and  the 
perfume  of  certain  flowers. 

In  his  book,  Bernard  urged  readers  to  come 
to  San  Francisco  Island,  off  the  coast  of  Brazil, 
where  he  had  gone  to  establish  a  utopian 
colony.  Coincidentally  or  otherwise,  Mayita 
was  preaching  a  doctrine  Bernard  had  advo¬ 
cated  for  the  previous  two  decades.  In  it,  sex¬ 
ual  intercourse  is  vile  and  unclean,  women  are 
superior,  and  men  are  a  dangerous  mutation. 
Critic  Walter  Kafton-Minkel  observes  that 
this  “story  of  our  origins  sounds  much  like  a 
mythology  devised  by  a  community  of  mod¬ 
ern  radical  feminists”  (Kafton-Minkel,  1989). 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Lemuria 

Further  Reading 

Bernard,  Raymond  [pseud,  of  Walter  Siegmeister] , 
1974.  Escape  to  the  Inner  Earth.  Clarksburg,  WV: 
Saucerian  Press. 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
1 00, 000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwarfs,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

Great  White  Brotherhood 

The  Great  White  Brotherhood  figures  in  such 
schools  of  occultism  as  Theosophy  and  Rosi- 


Grim  Reaper  115 


crucianism.  The  Brotherhood  is  thought  to 
consist  of  ascended  masters  who  oversee  the 
spiritual  and  physical  evolution  of  the  human 
race. 

Greater  Nibiruan  Council 

The  Greater  Nibiruan  Council  (GNC)  is  de¬ 
scribed  as  the  “main  governing  arm  of  the 
Galactic  Federation,”  comprising  the  smaller 
Nibiruan  Councils  (NC)  in  the  various  di¬ 
mensions  of  the  universe.  The  GNC’s  respon¬ 
sibilities  are  many.  It  sponsors  emissaries  and 
ambassadors  from  the  many  planetary  civiliza¬ 
tions  and  provides  courts  and  oversight  for 
disputes.  It  also  gives  military  protection  to 
threatened  peoples  and  trains  races  for  mem¬ 
bership  in  the  federation. 

On  an  even  larger  scale  the  GNC  oversees 
the  divine  evolution  of  each  planet  and  every 
individual  soul  in  the  galaxy.  It  works  with 
every  level  of  the  spiritual  hierarchy  to  ensure 
that  all  work  effectively  together.  It  maintains 
the  galactic  structure  and  interacts  with  other 
galactic  federations.  These  are  only  a  few  of  its 
many  tasks,  conducted  with  the  assistance  of 
innumerable  smaller,  dimensional  councils. 
The  oldest  of  these  is  the  9D  Nibiruan  Coun¬ 
cil,  also  known  as  “The  Ancient  Ones”  and 
the  “Pelegians.”  This  council  is  headed  by 
Devin  and  his  half-brother  Jehowah,  members 
of  the  two  royal  houses  of  Ain  and  Avyon. 

In  the  human  dimension — the  third — the 
3D  Nibiruan  Council  (3DNC)  began  in 
Kansas  City,  Missouri,  in  January  1997, 
under  the  direction  of  channeler  Jelaila  Starr 
and  associates  Terry  Spears  and  Dermot 
Kerin.  A  year  and  a  half  later,  it  relocated  to 
Los  Angeles.  Starr  is  its  sole  owner,  and  the 
council  functions  as  a  tax-paying  small  busi¬ 
ness.  According  to  Starr,  the  3DNC  repre¬ 
sents  the  GNC  on  Earth  and  upholds  its  di¬ 
rectives  as  they  apply  to  this  world.  Other 
responsibilities  include  “providing  the  9D 
Tools  of  Integration  to  the  people  of  Earth 
along  with  support  and  training  for  using 
them  in  the  form  of  books,  tapes,  videos, 
workshops,  seminars,  etc.;  providing  a  living 


example  of  the  Ascension  Tools  in  action 
through  their  actions;  relaying  messages  in  the 
form  of  updates  and  perspectives  to  the  peo¬ 
ple  of  Earth  for  the  purpose  of  education, 
support  and  enlightenment;  supporting  the 
work  of  other  groups  and  individuals  involved 
in  the  ascension  of  earth  and  its  people”  (“The 
Greater  Nibiruan  Council  Section,”  2000). 

The  concept  of  “Nibirua”  comes  from  the 
writings  of  ancient- astronaut  theorist  Zecha- 
ria  Sitchin,  from  his  reading  of  ancient 
Sumerian  literature.  Sitchin,  however,  believes 
Nibirua  to  be  an  inhabited  but  undetected 
planet  in  our  solar  system.  Its  people,  who 
have  an  extraordinarily  advanced  technology, 
created  the  human  race  in  their  image  using 
genetic  engineering.  Nibirua  orbits  Earth 
every  thirty-six  hundred  years.  In  Sitchin’s  as¬ 
sessment,  the  planet  is  due  to  pass  between 
Mars  and  Jupiter  in  the  near  future,  and  the 
Nibiruans — known  as  the  Annunaki — will 
visit  us  again. 

Further  Reading 

“The  Greater  Nibiruan  Council  Section,”  2000. 
http://www.nibiruancouncil.com/html/greater_ 
nibiruan_council_secti.html 

Sitchin,  Zecharia,  1976.  The  Twelfth  Planet.  New 
York:  Stein  and  Day. 

Grim  Reaper 

The  folkloric  figure  of  the  Grim  Reaper  is  al¬ 
most  universally  assumed  to  be  wholly  imagi¬ 
nary  and  symbolic.  Anomalist  Mark  Chorvin- 
sky,  however,  insists  that  apparently  sincere, 
sane  persons  have  seen,  in  death  or  near-death 
contexts,  apparitional  forms  that  match  in 
most  or  all  particulars  the  robed,  skeletal  fig¬ 
ure.  Chorvinsky  has  collected  a  number  of  re¬ 
ports  and  published  some  representative  ac¬ 
counts  in  his  Strange  Magazine. 

One  case  came  from  a  retired  nurse  who 
years  earlier  had  worked  at  a  hospital  in  Hous¬ 
ton.  While  running  down  the  hallway  on  a 
very  hot  day  on  her  way  to  replacing  another 
nurse  on  duty,  she  passed  a  room  and  glanced 
inside.  She  walked  on  past  five  other  rooms 
before  what  she  had  seen  sank  in  and  she  re¬ 
turned  to  look  more  carefully.  An  old  woman 


116  Grim  Reaper 


The  Vision  of  Death,  an  image  of  the  Grim  Reaper  in  an  engraving  by  Gustave  Dore  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 

lay  in  a  bed  while  beside  it  stood  a  tall  figure  “His  face  was  a  skull  with  tiny  red  fires  for 

in  a  monk’s  robe,  its  head  covered.  Apparently  eyes.  His  hands,  skeletal,  were  patiently  folded 

aware  of  the  nurse’s  presence,  the  figure  over  each  other  inside  the  dark  sleeves.  My 

turned  to  look  at  her.  She  told  Chorvinsky,  impression  was  [that]  he  was  very  patient, 


Gyeorgos  Ceres  Hatonn  117 


waiting”  (Chorvinsky,  1997).  A  terrible  death 
smell,  like  something  rotting  in  the  sun,  hung 
in  the  air. 

The  nurse  felt  a  literal  freezing  sensation 
when  the  figure  stared  at  her.  She  quickly  re¬ 
treated.  By  the  time  she  got  to  her  original 
destination,  the  male  nurse  on  duty  saw  that 
she  was  cold.  He  wrapped  her  in  blankets  and 
gave  her  hot  chocolate.  It  was  two  hours, 
however,  before  she  felt  herself  able  to  speak 
about  what  she  had  seen. 

Another  retired  nurse  claimed  to  have 
seen  the  Grim  Reaper  on  a  number  of  occa¬ 
sions.  “Usually,”  she  said,  “I  just  see  a  dark 
figure,  robed,  standing  near  the  nurses’  sta¬ 
tion,  or  perhaps  in  the  hall.  Very  rarely,  the 
figure  will  be  white.  I’ve  never  heard  it  speak, 
but  someone  always  dies  within  a  few  days  of 
its  appearance.” 

A  man  identified  only  as  A.  L.  told  a  story 
with  a  different  ending.  Late  one  evening  in 
1974,  he  was  sitting  in  his  Yonkers,  New 
York,  apartment  while  his  three  children  slept 
in  their  rooms.  His  wife  was  in  their  bath¬ 
room.  When  he  happened  to  glance  to  his 
right,  he  was  startled  to  observe  a  black- 
hooded  figure  holding  a  scythe,  its  face  a  lu¬ 
minous  white  skull.  It  was  staring  at  him  as  it 
glided  slowly  backward  and  disappeared 
through  the  door.  Fearing  that  the  Reaper  had 
come  for  someone,  A.  L.  banged  on  the  bath¬ 
room  door.  When  he  got  no  response,  he  en¬ 
tered  and  found  his  wife  lying  on  the  floor 
next  to  an  empty  bottle  of  pills.  With  the  as¬ 
sistance  of  his  sister  and  her  husband,  who 
lived  close  by,  he  was  able  to  revive  his  wife 
and  take  her  to  the  hospital.  “The  encounter 
has  left  me  with  the  feeling  that  the  Reaper  is 
a  special  friend,”  he  told  Chorvinsky.  “He  ap¬ 
peared  to  me  and  gave  warning  instead  of  tak¬ 
ing  someone.” 

Someone  else  claimed  that  the  Grim  Reaper 
saved  his  life  when  he  was  eight  years  old. 
Dennis  Wardrop  was  skating  on  a  pond  when 
the  ice  gave  way  under  his  feet,  and  he 
plunged  into  the  frigid  water.  He  tried  desper¬ 
ately  to  find  a  way  out  as  his  lungs  filled  with 
the  water.  He  felt  something  poking  him  and 


grabbed  onto  it  as  it  lifted  him  to  safety.  After 
he  wiped  the  water  from  his  eyes,  he  was  terri¬ 
fied  to  learn  that  he  was  holding  the  blunt  end 
of  a  long  scythe  in  the  hands  of  a  tall,  large  fig¬ 
ure  with  the  face  of  a  decomposing  corpse.  It 
wore  a  black  robe  and  a  hood  over  its  head.  In¬ 
side  the  eye  sockets  were  “swirling  whirlpools 
of  black  and  dimly  glowing  reds.”  An  “odor  of 
death”  permeated  the  air.  Perhaps  sensing  his 
fear,  the  figure  assured  him  (whether  telepathi- 
cally  or  orally  is  not  explained)  that  he  would 
be  okay,  that  it  was  not  yet  his  time.  The  boy 
collapsed  from  exhaustion.  When  he  revived 
soon  thereafter,  the  figure  was  gone,  and  he 
felt  curiously  warm  even  though  it  was  only 
fourteen  degrees  above  zero. 

Chorvinsky  writes,  “I  have  investigated 
particularly  intriguing  cases  in  which  the 
Reaper  has  been  seen  by  multiple  witnesses. 
And  ...  I  know  of  incidents  in  which  the 
Reaper  was  reported  to  have  actually  healed 
injuries  and  assisted  the  ill  and  the  dying.” 

Further  Reading 

Chorvinsky,  Mark,  1997.  “Encounters  with  the 
Grim  Reaper.”  Strange  Magazine  18  (Summer): 
6-12. 


Gyeorgos  Ceres  Hatonn 

Gyeorgos  Ceres  Hatonn — usually  addressed 
and  referred  to  simply  as  Hatonn — speaks 
through  Doris  Ekker  (known  as  Dharma). 
George  and  Desiree  Green  and  others  associ¬ 
ated  with  the  Phoenix  Project  distribute  Ha- 
tonn’s  messages  through  a  magazine  called  the 
Phoenix  Journal.  Hatonn  describes  himself  as 
“Commander  in  Chief,  Earth  Project  Transi¬ 
tion,  Pleiades  Sector  Flight  command,  Inter- 
galactic  Federation  Fleet-Ashtar  Command; 
Earth  Representative  to  the  Cosmic  Council 
and  Intergalactic  Federation  Council  on  Earth 
Transition”  (“Who  Is  Hatonn?”). 

Hatonn  denies  that  the  process  through 
which  he  communicates  is  channeling.  It  is, 
he  says,  more  like  radio  transmission  directly 
from  spaceship  to  contactee.  “We  travel  and 
act,”  he  says,  “in  the  direct  service  and  under 
Command  of  Esu  Jesus  Immanuel  Sananda. 


118  Gyeorgos  Ceres  Hatonn 


Sananda  is  aboard  my  Command  Craft  from 
whence  He  will  direct  all  evacuation  and  tran¬ 
sition  activities  as  regards  the  period  you  ones 
call  the  End  Prophecies  of  Armageddon.” 

In  contrast  to  the  benign  words  of  most  oth¬ 
erworldly  beings  who  speak  through  con- 
tactees,  Hatonn  and  his  fellows  preach  a 
fiercely  expressed  conspiracy  theory  with 
openly  anti-Semitic  elements.  For  example: 
“Anarchy  is  something  that  the  Jew  promotes 
relentlessly.  While  in  complete  control  of  the  fi¬ 
nancial  powers  of  the  state,  they  promote  in¬ 
ternecine  strife”  (Ecker,  1992).  Hatonn  also  de¬ 
nies  that  the  Holocaust  ever  occurred.  Hatonn 
refers  to  Jews  who  are  working  with  the  anti- 


Christ,  Satan,  and  the  “evil  leaders”  of  the  New 
World  Order  to  control  the  world.  The  plotters 
call  it  Plan  2000.  The  space  people  and  their 
earthly  allies  such  as  those  in  the  Phoenix  Proj¬ 
ect  are  working  to  thwart  the  conspiracy  and  to 
create  a  new  Earth  after  wars  and  natural  disas¬ 
ters  have  reshaped  the  face  of  the  planet. 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Channeling;  Contactees;  Sananda 

Further  Reading 

Ecker,  Don,  1992.  “Hatonn’s  World.”  UFO  7,  4 
(July/August):  30-31. 

Heard,  Alex,  1999.  Apocalypse  Pretty  Soon:  Travels  in 
End-Time  America.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton  and 
Company. 

“Who  Is  Hatonn?”  http://www.fourwindslO.com/ 
information.html 


Hierarchal  Board 

The  Hierarchal  Board  communicates  through 
Pauline  Sharpe  (also  known  as  Nada-Yolanda) 
via  channeling  and  automatic  writing.  The 
board  is  the  solar  systems  spiritual  govern¬ 
ment,  and  its  members  include  Sananda 
(Jesus),  who  has  orbited  Earth  in  a  spacecraft 
since  1885.  Right  now  he  is  in  etheric  form 
but  will  enter  the  physical  realm  as  the  planet 
is  cleansed  and  transformed  for  the  coming 
New  Age,  due  to  arrive  sometime  around 
2000.  Sharpe’s  organization  is  called  Mark- 
Age,  “commissioned  by  the  Hierarchal  Board 
to  implant  a  prototype  of  spiritual  govern¬ 
ment  on  Earth,  the  I  Am  Nation.  The  I  Am 
Nation  is  a  government  of,  for  and  by  the  I 
Am  Selves  of  all  people  on  Earth.  ...  It  is  not 
a  political  government,  but  is  a  spiritual  con¬ 
gregation  of  all  souls  who  seek  to  serve  God, 
first  and  foremost,  and  the  I  Am  Selves  of  all 
people  on  Earth”  (Mark  Age,”  n.d.). 

Mark- Age  came  into  being  in  I960, 
though  communications  from  the  board  had 
begun  four  years  earlier  through  Charles  Boyd 
Gentzel.  Over  the  years,  several  persons  re¬ 
ceived  the  messages,  but  in  time  Sharpe  be¬ 
came  the  organization’s  guiding  personality.  It 
has  published  a  large  amount  of  channeled 
material,  including  communications  from 
Gloria  Lee,  a  1950s-era  contactee. 


See  Also:  Channeling;  Contactees;  J.  W.;  Sananda 

Further  Reading 

“Mark-Age:  Love  in  Action  for  the  New  Age.” 
http://www.islandnet.com/-arton/markage.html 

One  Thousand  Keys  to  the  Truth,  1976.  Miami,  FL: 
Mark-Age  MetaCenter. 

Holloman  aliens 

A  modern  legend,  widely  circulated  but  never 
verified,  holds  that  aliens  once  landed  at  Hol¬ 
loman  Air  Force  Base  in  New  Mexico  and 
conferred  with  representatives  of  the  govern¬ 
ment  and  military.  The  event  is  variously  set 
on  April  1964  or  May  1971. 

The  story  emerged  under  curious  circum¬ 
stances.  Robert  Emenegger  and  Allan  Sandler, 
two  wealthy  Los  Angeles  businessmen,  had 
gone  to  Norton  Air  Force  Base  in  California 
where  they  were  to  discuss  the  production  of  a 
documentary  film  dealing  with  advanced  re¬ 
search  projects.  The  discussion  soon  expanded 
to  include  other  possible  subjects,  one  dealing 
with  the  air  force  and  UFOs.  Emenegger  and 
Sandler  expressed  interest  in  the  UFO  project, 
and  their  contacts — the  head  of  the  base’s 
U.S.  Air  Force  Office  of  Special  Investigations 
(AFOSI)  and  audio-visual  director  Paul  Shar- 
tle — began  laying  plans.  They  told  the  civil¬ 
ians  that  in  May  1971  cameras  at  Holloman 
AFB  had  recorded  an  extraordinary  event.  A 


119 


120  Holloman  aliens 


A  government  employee  photographed  a  possible  UFO  as  it  hovered for  fifteen  minutes  near  Holloman  Air  Force  Base,  New 
Mexico.  (Bettmann/Corbis) 


flying  saucer  had  landed  at  the  base,  and  three 
beings  had  stepped  outside. 

Shartle,  who  claimed  to  have  seen  this 
16mm  film,  said  on  national  television  in  Oc¬ 
tober  1988  that  the  beings  were  the  size  of  hu¬ 
mans  but  had  gray  complexions  and  large 
noses.  They  wore  tight-fitting  suits  and  “thin 
headdresses  that  appeared  to  be  communica¬ 
tion  devices,  and  in  their  hands  they  held  a 
translator’”  (Howe,  1989).  The  Holloman 
commander  and  other  officers  had  met  with 
the  aliens  over  the  next  several  days. 

Emenegger  claims  to  have  been  taken  to 
Holloman  and  shown  the  buildings  where  the 
saucer  was  stored  and  the  meetings  con¬ 
ducted.  He  and  Sandler  were  promised  thirty- 
two  hundred  feet  of  the  landing  film,  but  they 
never  saw  it  because  permission  to  view  it, 
much  less  reproduce  it,  was  subsequently 
withdrawn.  They  went  on  to  make  a  UFO 
documentary,  and  Emenegger  wrote  a  paper¬ 
back  based  on  it.  In  it  he  mentions  the  Hollo¬ 
man  incident  but  not  as  something  that  had 
actually  happened,  merely  as  something  that 


could  happen  in  the  future.  In  a  section  of 
photographs  and  illustrations,  however,  there 
is  a  drawing  clearly  intended  to  be  a  Hollo¬ 
man  alien,  said  only  to  be  “based  on  eyewit¬ 
ness  descriptions”  (Emenegger,  1974). 

In  1982,  Colorado-based  ufologist  and 
documentary  filmmaker  Linda  Moulton 
Howe  met  with  Sergeant  Richard  Doty,  an 
AFOSI  agent,  at  Kirtland  Air  Force  Base  in 
New  Mexico.  Asked  about  the  Holloman  in¬ 
cident,  Doty  asserted  that  it  had  indeed  oc¬ 
curred  but  on  April  25,  1964,  seven  years  ear¬ 
lier  than  Emenegger  had  been  led  to  believe. 
Doty  showed  her  a  document  that  purported 
to  detail  the  U.S.  government’s  interaction 
with  aliens  and  its  recovery  of  extraterrestrial 
wreckage  and  bodies.  He  mentioned  films, 
one  of  them  taken  at  Holloman.  Despite  re¬ 
peated  promises,  Doty  never  produced  any 
film  or  other  documentation  for  Howe.  He 
later  emerged  as  a  suspect  in  a  notorious, 
forged  paper  concerning  a  secret  group,  Ma- 
jestic-12,  which  supposedly  studies  alien  re¬ 
mains  and  supervises  the  cover-up. 


Hollow  earth  121 


In  the  1980s,  the  legend  grew  as  a  right- 
wing  conspiracy  theorist  named  Milton 
William  Cooper  claimed  to  have  seen  super¬ 
secret  documents  attesting  to  an  agreement 
between  the  U.S.  government  and  malevolent 
aliens.  According  to  Cooper,  the  first  Hollo¬ 
man  meeting  happened  in  1954.  Officials  and 
aliens  agreed  that  in  exchange  for  the  freedom 
to  abduct  humans  without  interference,  the 
extraterrestrials  (from  a  dying  planet  that  or¬ 
bits  Betelgeuse)  would  provide  the  govern¬ 
ment  with  advanced  technology,  so  long  as  it 
kept  silent  about  it.  Subsequently,  Cooper 
would  write  in  a  wild  book  allegedly  docu¬ 
menting  the  sinister  machinations  of  the  “se¬ 
cret  government”  that  the  agreement  broke 
down;  according  to  Cooper,  aliens  and  gov¬ 
ernment  entered  into  conflict  over  who  would 
get  to  control  and  manipulate  the  human 
race.  Among  other  bizarre  allegations,  Cooper 
stated  that  President  Kennedy  was  assassi¬ 


nated  because  he  planned  to  expose  the 
scheme  to  the  American  people. 

Further  Reading 

Brookesmith,  Peter,  1996.  UFO:  The  Government 
Files.  New  York:  Barnes  and  Noble  Books. 

Cooper,  Milton  William,  1991.  Behold  a  Pale  Horse. 

Sedona,  AZ:  Light  Technology  Publishing. 
Emenegger,  Robert,  1974.  UFOs  Past,  Present  and 
Future.  New  York:  Ballantine  Books. 

Howe,  Linda  Moulton,  1 989.  An  Alien  Harvest:  Fur  - 
ther  Evidence  Linking  Animal  Mutilations  and 
Human  Abductions  to  Alien  Life  Forms.  Littleton, 
CO:  Linda  Moulton  Howe  Productions. 

Jones,  William  E.,  and  Rebecca  D.  Minshall,  1991. 
Bill  Cooper  and  the  Need  for  More  Research  (UFOs, 
Conspiracies,  and  the  JFK  Assassination).  Dublin, 
OH:  MidOhio  Research  Associates. 


Hollow  earth 

A  long  mythological  tradition  holds  that  su¬ 
pernatural  beings  dwell  beneath  our  feet,  ei¬ 
ther  in  caves  and  caverns  or  in  the  earths  inte- 


Books  on  the  holloiu-earth  theory  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


122  Hollow  earth 


rior.  Some  beliefs  have  it  that  the  spirits  of  the 
unsaved  dead  live  on  in  gloom  or  torment  be¬ 
neath  our  feet.  The  most  famous  scientific 
proponent  of  a  hollow  earth,  Edmond  Halley 
(1656-1743),  best  remembered  for  the  comet 
named  after  him,  argued  that  within  the 
earths  sphere  there  were  three  other,  smaller 
ones,  all  harboring  intelligent  beings.  Theories 
about  a  hollow  earth,  while  dismissed  as  phys¬ 
ically  impossible  by  scientists,  continue  on  the 
fringes  into  modern  times. 

John  Cleeves  Symmes  (1779-1829)  be¬ 
came  a  notorious  figure  in  early  American  his¬ 
tory  as  a  vigorous  publicist  for  the  notion  first 
proposed  by  Halley,  of  an  earth  whose  interior 
consisted  of  concentric  spheres.  According  to 
Symmes,  the  interior  could  be  entered 
through  four-thousand-mile-wide  holes  at  ei¬ 
ther  pole.  Symmes  hoped  to  lead  an  expedi¬ 
tion  into  the  earth,  and  he  lectured  widely,  all 
the  while  lobbying  for  funding.  In  the  face  of 
national  ridicule,  he  argued  that  the  people  of 
the  interior  amounted  to  a  vast  new  market 
for  American  goods.  Symmes  inspired  Edgar 
Allan  Poe  to  write  the  classic  proto-science- 
fiction  novella  The  Narrative  of  Arthur  Gordon 
Pym  (1838).  Symmes’s  son  Americus  kept  the 
faith  after  his  father  had  passed  on.  As  late  as 
1878  he  published  a  collection  of  the  elder 
Symmes’s  writings  and  lectures. 

The  1870s  and  1880s  saw  a  hollow-earth 
revival  with  the  publication  of  still  other  books 
championing  the  notion,  including  M.  L. 
Sherman’s  The  Hollow  Globe  (1871),  a  chan¬ 
neled  work,  and  Frederick  Culmer’s  The  Inner 
World  (1886).  Helena  Blavatsky  incorporated 
the  hollow  earth  into  her  two  popular  and  in¬ 
fluential  occult  texts  Isis  Unveiled  (1877)  and 
The  Secret  Doctrine  (1888).  Another  important 
book,  William  Reed’s  The  Phantom  of  the  Poles, 
was  published  in  1906,  the  first  of  a  small  li¬ 
brary  of  hollow-earth  volumes  to  be  issued 
through  the  twentieth  century. 

By  the  late  nineteenth  century,  a  religion 
based  on  the  hollow  earth  was  formed  by  Cyrus 
Teed  (1839-1908),  after  a  vision  in  which  the 
Mother  of  the  Universe  told  him  he  would  save 
the  world.  He  went  on  to  lead  a  utopian  com- 


An  illustration  of  the  hollow  earth  from  Phantoms  of  the 
Poles  by  William  Reed,  1906  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


munity  in  Fort  Myers,  Florida,  devoted  to  “Ko- 
reshanity.”  Koreshanity  held  that  not  only  is  the 
earth  hollow,  humans  live  inside  it,  orbiting  the 
sun,  which  is  at  the  center  of  the  world.  The 
stars,  planets,  and  moon  are  also  within  the 
earth’s  shell.  Marshall  B.  Gardner’s  book  A  Jour  - 
ney  to  the  Earth’s  Interior  (1913)  agreed  with 
Teed’s  views  to  the  extent  that  Gardner  was  will¬ 
ing  to  acknowledge  an  interior  sun,  though  it 
was  not  the  sun,  and  another  race,  not  humans, 
get  their  heat  and  light  from  it.  This  other-race 
lives  in  a  pleasant,  tropical  climate. 

Other  fringe  thinkers,  notably  H.  Spencer 
Fewis  and  Guy  Warren  Ballard,  wrote  that 
Mount  Shasta  in  northern  California  is  an  en¬ 
trance  to  the  interior,  where  a  colony  of  sur¬ 
vivors  from  the  lost  continent  Femuria  live 
on.  Ballard  claimed  to  have  personally  met 
super  beings  under  the  mountain,  including 
golden-haired,  angelic  Yenusians  such  as  those 
George  Adamski  and  later  flying-saucer  con- 
tactees  would  claim  to  know.  Ballard,  his  wife 
Edna,  and  their  son  Donald  founded  a  popu¬ 
lar  Theosophy-based  (and  fascist)  movement 
around  these  experiences  and  doctrines.  Bal¬ 
lard  died  in  1939,  but  his  organization,  the  “I 
AM”  still  exists. 

In  the  1940s  the  pages  of  the  science-fic¬ 
tion  pulps  Amazing  Stories  and  Fantastic  Ad  - 


Honor  123 


ventures  carried  the  allegedly  true,  intensely 
controversial  experiences  of  Richard  S.  Shaver 
Shaver  asserted  that  he  had  been  inside  vast 
subterranean  caverns,  where  remnants  of  an 
advanced  race  that  had  once  populated  the 
surface  still  lived.  There  were  two  groups,  the 
deros — sadistic  idiots  who  used  the  ancients’ 
advanced  technology  to  harm  surface- 
dwellers — and  the  teros — the  embattled  mi¬ 
nority  of  good  guys  who  tried,  mostly  without 
success,  to  stop  the  deros’  schemes. 

When  flying  saucers  and  UFOs  entered 
popular  consciousness  in  the  years  after  World 
War  II,  inevitably,  speculation  tied  them  to 
inner-earthers.  Flying  Saucers,  a  magazine  ed¬ 
ited  by  Ray  Palmer,  who,  as  editor  of  Amaz  - 
ing,  had  championed  what  he  called  the 
Shaver  mystery,  brought  the  concept  of  holes 
in  the  poles  and  the  notion  of  hollow  earth 
into  its  pages.  Perhaps  the  most  widely  read 
book  in  the  literature,  The  Hollow  Earth 
(1964)  by  Raymond  Bernard  (the  pseudonym 
of  Walter  Siegmeister,  a  man  with  a  decades- 
long  association  with  fringe  beliefs),  stated 
that  flying  saucers  come  in  and  out  the  pole 
holes.  The  Canadian  neo-Nazi  Ernst  Zundel, 
writing  as  Christof  Friedrich,  contributed  the 
book  UFOs — Nazi  Secret  Weapons  (1976), 
which  alleged  that  Hitler  and  his  Last  Battal¬ 
ion  had  fled  to  Argentina,  then  to  Antarctica. 
From  there  they  entered  the  earth  and  dedi¬ 
cated  their  energies  to  the  construction  of  an 
advanced  technology.  Nazi  technology  is  re¬ 
sponsible  for  what  we  call  UFOs.  Zundel — 
and  later  the  Missouri-based  International  So¬ 
ciety  for  a  Complete  Earth — tried  to  raise 
funds  to  fly  through  the  hole  in  the  pole  in  ve¬ 
hicles  prominently  displaying  swastikas  to  en¬ 
sure  that  they  got  a  friendly  reception. 

Some,  though  not  all,  current  hollow-earth 
advocacy  is  tied  to  explicit  or  implicit  pro- 
Nazi  sympathies.  For  example,  Norma  Cox’s 
virulently  anti-Semitic  Kingdoms  within  Earth 
(1985)  blamed  an  international  Zionist  con¬ 
spiracy  for  suppressing  the  truth  about  a  hol¬ 
low  globe;  she  also  openly  praised  Hitler.  A 
more  benign,  good-humored  approach  to  the 
subject  of  a  hollow  earth  can  be  found  in 


Dennis  G.  Crenshaw’s  occasional  periodical 
The  Hollow  Earth  Insider. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees;  King  Leo; 
Lemuria;  Mount  Shasta;  Rainbow  City;  Shaver 
mystery 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  G  reen,  ed.,  1993.  The  Smoky  God 
and  Other  Inner  Earth  Mysteries.  New  Brunswick, 
NJ:  Inner  Light  Publications. 

Bernard,  Raymond  [pseud,  of  Walter  Siegmeister] , 
1964.  The  Hollow  Earth:  The  Greatest  Geographi  - 
cal  Discovery  in  History.  New  York:  Fieldcrest 
Publishing. 

Cox,  Norma,  1985.  Kingdoms  within  Earth.  Mar¬ 
shall,  AR:  self-published. 

Crabb,  Riley,  1960.  The  Reality  of  the  Underground. 
Vista,  CA:  Borderland  Sciences  Research  Associ¬ 
ates. 

Fitch,  Theodore,  1960.  Our  Paradise  inside  the  Earth. 

Council  Bluffs,  IA:  self-published. 

Friedrich,  Christof  [pseud,  of  Ernest  Zundel],  1976. 
UFOs — Nazi  Secret  Weapons ?  Toronto,  Ontario: 
Samisdat. 

- ,  1978.  Secret  Nazi  Polar  Expeditions. 

Toronto,  Ontario:  Samisdat. 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
1 00, 000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwarfs,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

Michell,  John,  1984.  Eccentric  Lives  and  Peculiar  No  - 
tions.  San  Diego,  CA:  Harcourt  Brace  Jovanovich. 
Trench,  Brinsley  le  Poer,  1974.  Secret  of  the  Ages:  UFOs 
from  inside  the  Earth.  London:  Souvenir  Press. 
Walton,  Bruce  A.,  1983.  A  Guide  to  the  Inner  Earth. 

Jane  Lew,  WV:  New  Age  Books. 

X,  Michael  [pseudonym  of  Michael  X.  Barton], 
1960.  Rainbow  City  and  the  Inner  Earth  People. 
Los  Angeles:  Futura. 


Honor 

In  early  January  1978,  according  to  a  West 
German  newspaper,  a  twelve-year-old  Iranian 
girl,  identified  only  as  Sara,  underwent  a  series 
of  contacts  with  an  extraterrestrial  creature 
named  Honor.  The  contacts  took  place  over  a 
seven-day  period.  Covered  with  black  hair  or 
fur,  Honor  stood  six  and  a  half  feet  tall  and 
hailed  from  a  world  ten  light  years  “ahead”  of 
Earth.  Sara  said  that  the  extraterrestrial  had 
given  her  psychokinetic  powers  that  allowed 
her  to  move  household  appliances  with  mind 
power  alone. 


124  Hopkins,  Budd 


Further  Reading 

Bartholomew,  Robert  E.,  and  George  S.  Howard, 
1998.  UFOs  and  Alien  Contact:  Two  Centuries  of 
Mystery.  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 


Hopkins,  Budd  (1931-  ) 

Bom  in  Wheeling,  West  Virginia,  Budd  Hop¬ 
kins  graduated  from  Oberlin  College  in  1953. 
He  moved  to  New  York  City  to  embark  on  a 
successful  career  as  a  painter,  sculptor,  and 
writer  on  the  arts.  One  day  in  1964,  he  and 
two  other  persons  witnessed  the  appearance  of 
a  disc-shaped  object  that  remained  in  view  for 
two  or  three  minutes.  The  experience  sparked 
Hopkins’s  interest  in  UFOs.  Though  for  the 
next  years  that  interest  was  confined  to  the  oc¬ 
casional  reading  of  UFO  literature,  in  1975 
he  participated  in  the  investigation  of  a  mul¬ 
tiply  witnessed  close  encounter  of  the  third 
kind  in  a  New  Jersey  park  directly  across  the 
Hudson  River  from  Eighty-eighth  Street  in 
Manhattan.  Hopkins  went  on  to  become  ac¬ 
tively  involved  in  research  on  abductions.  He 
also  became  hugely  influential  in  bringing 
wider  attention  to  the  subject  and  shaping  at¬ 
titudes  toward  it. 

Hopkins  brought  mental-health  profes¬ 
sionals  into  his  work,  which  often  involved 
the  use  of  hypnosis  to  retrieve  ostensible 
memories  of  abductions  masked  by  amnesia. 
His  first  book  on  the  subject,  Missing  Time 
(1981),  detailed  his  case  studies.  A  sequel,  In  - 
truders  (1987),  brought  forth  an  expanded  vi¬ 
sion  of  the  abduction  experience,  highlighting 
the  sexual  aspects  and  apparent  genetic  exper¬ 
iments  involving  mysteriously  terminated 
pregnancies  and  human/alien  hybrids.  He  also 
argued  that  abductions  are  usually  not  one¬ 
time  encounters  but  events  that  occur  period¬ 
ically  over  abductees’  lifetimes.  Hopkins  had 
also  become  convinced  that  abductions  are  far 
more  widespread  than  anyone  had  suspected. 
He  helped  devise  a  survey  conducted  by  the 
Roper  Poll.  In  Hopkins’s  view  the  results — 
which  proved  controversial  and  were  read  dif¬ 
ferently  by  some  others — demonstrated  that 
millions  of  persons  in  the  United  States  alone 


Budd  Hopkins,  1997  (Lisa  Anders/Fortean  Picture 
Library) 

are,  whether  they  are  consciously  aware  of  it 
or  not,  abductees. 

A  third  Hopkins  book,  Witnessed  (1996), 
recounted  a  monumentally  complex,  ex¬ 
tremely  bizarre  abduction  allegedly  involving 
a  number  of  participants,  including  an  un¬ 
named  prominent  international  political  fig¬ 
ure.  (Published  accounts  have  since  identified 
the  man  as  Javier  Perez  de  Cuellar,  the  Secre¬ 
tary-General  of  the  United  Nations.  Perez  de 
Cuellar  denies  the  story.)  The  claim  sparked 
an  intense  and  often  bewildering  series  of 
charges  and  countercharges,  though  critics 
were  unable  to  uncover  conclusive  evidence  to 
support  hoax  allegations.  Even  so,  the  story 
was  so  extreme,  even  by  the  standards  of  high¬ 
strangeness  close  encounters,  that  even  sym¬ 
pathetic  observers  found  it  difficult  to  believe. 
Hopkins  wrote,  “This  abduction  event  so 
drastically  alters  our  knowledge  of  the  alien 
incursion  in  our  world  that  it  is  easily  the 
most  important  in  recorded  history”  (Hop¬ 
kins,  1996). 


Hweig  125 


Though  some  abduction  proponents  have 
argued  that  abducting  aliens  are  benignly  in- 
tentioned,  Hopkins  holds  that  they  are  indif¬ 
ferent  to  human  beings  and  are  coldly  unemo¬ 
tional.  Their  purpose  in  coming  here  is  to 
study  humans  as  if  they  were  lab  animals,  and 
they  are  particularly  interested  in  our  genetic 
makeup. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Close  encounters  of 
the  third  kind;  Hybrid  beings 

Further  Reading 

Bloecher,  Ted,  Aphrodite  Clamar,  and  Budd  Hop¬ 
kins,  1985.  Final  Report  on  the  Psychological  Test  - 
mg  of  UFO  “Abductees.  ”  Mount  Rainier,  MD: 
Fund  for  UFO  Research. 

Hopkins,  Budd,  1981.  Missing  Time:  A  Documented 
Study  of  UFO  Abductions.  New  York:  Richard 
Marek  Publishers. 

- ,  1987.  Intruders:  The  Incredible  Visitations  at 

Copley  Woods.  New  York:  Random  House. 

- ,  1996.  Witnessed:  The  True  Story  of  the 

Brooklyn  Bridge  UFO  Abductions.  New  York: 
Pocket  Books. 

Unusual  Personal  Experiences:  An  Analysis  of  the  Data 
from  Three  National  Surveys,  1992.  Las  Vegas, 
NV:  Bigelow  Holding  Corporation. 

Hopkins’s  Martians 

In  a  letter  published  in  the  April  19,  1897, 
issue  of  the  St.  Louis  Post-Dispatch,  a  traveling 
salesman  named  W.  H.  Hopkins  reported  that 
while  strolling  through  hills  east  of  Spring- 
field,  Missouri,  three  days  earlier,  he  encoun¬ 
tered  two  beautiful,  unclad  Martians. 

The  alleged  incident  occurred  as  newspa¬ 
pers  throughout  America  were  chronicling 
often  sensationalistic  accounts  of  unidentified 
aerial  objects  generally  referred  to  as  “air¬ 
ships,”  though  today  they  would  be  called 
UFOs.  Most  people  who  took  the  reports  seri¬ 
ously  believed  that  the  ships  were  the  secret 
creations  of  American  inventors  who  soon 
would  reveal  all,  but  there  was  also  some  spec¬ 
ulation  that  Martians  might  be  touring  Earth. 
Dubious  tales  of  encounters  with  extraterres¬ 
trials  appeared  in  some  newspapers. 

Hopkins  claimed  that  he  had  seen  an  air¬ 
ship  landed  in  a  clearing.  The  most  “beautiful 
being  I  ever  beheld,”  a  naked  young  woman 
with  hair  falling  to  her  waist,  stood  next  to  the 


craft.  She  was  picking  flowers,  speaking  all  the 
while  in  a  musical  voice  in  a  language  Hop¬ 
kins  did  not  recognize.  She  was  also  vigor¬ 
ously  fanning  herself  even  though  the  day  was 
hardly  warm.  In  the  shade  cast  by  the  ship,  a 
naked  man  with  shoulder-length  hair  and  a 
beard,  fully  as  long  as  the  woman’s  hair,  lay  on 
the  ground,  also  working  a  fan. 

Until  Hopkins  stepped  forward,  the  couple 
did  not  know  they  were  being  observed.  The 
man  leaped  to  his  feet,  and  the  woman  threw 
herself  into  his  arms.  As  Hopkins  tried  to  as¬ 
sure  them  of  his  good  intentions,  they  glared 
back  at  him,  clearly  unable  to  understand 
what  he  was  saying.  In  time,  however,  the  ten¬ 
sion  dissipated,  and  a  kind  of  conversation, 
mostly  involving  gestures,  ensued.  When  he 
inquired  about  their  place  of  origin,  they 
“pointed  upwards,  pronouncing  a  word 
which,  to  my  imagination,  sounded  like 
Mars.”  They  studied  him  “with  great  curios¬ 
ity.  ..  .  They  felt  of  my  clothing,  looked  at  my 
gray  hair  with  surprise  and  examined  my 
watch  with  the  greatest  wonder.” 

After  he  was  given  a  tour  of  the  interior, 
the  ship  flew  away  with  the  occupants  waving 
farewell  to  Hopkins,  “she  a  vision  of  loveliness 
and  he  of  manly  vigor.” 

See  Also:  Allingham’s  Martian;  Aurora  Martian; 
Brown’s  Martians;  Demons  s  Martians  and  Venu- 
sians;  Khauga;  Martian  bees;  Michigan  giant; 
Mince-Pie  Martians;  Monka;  Mullers  Martians; 
Oleson’s  giants;  Shaw’s  Martians;  Smead’s  Mar¬ 
tians;  Thompson’s  Venusians;  Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  ed.,  1982.  The  Airship  File:  A 
Collection  of  Texts  Concerning  Phantom  Airships 
and  Other  UFOs,  Gathered  from  Newspapers  and 
Periodicals  Mostly  during  the  Hundred  Years  Prior 
to  Kenneth  Arnold’s  Sighting.  Bloomington,  IN: 
self-published. 

Clark,  Jerome,  1981.  “The  Coming  of  the  Venu¬ 
sians.”  Fate  34,  1  (January  1981):  49-55. 

Hweig 

Hweig  is  an  extraterrestrial  who  channels 
through  an  Oregon  woman  named  Ida  M. 
Kannenberg.  She  believes  that  she  first  en¬ 
countered  aliens  in  the  California  desert  in 


126  Hybrid  beings 


1940.  According  to  testimony  elicited  under 
hypnosis  in  1980,  aliens  placed  implants  in¬ 
side  her  head  to  facilitate  communication 
later  between  them  and  her.  In  1978,  she 
began  to  hear  from  Hweig  on  a  regular  basis, 
after  a  failed  1968  experiment  that  so  terrified 
her  that  she  ended  up  in  a  mental  hospital. 
She  was  released  when  no  evidence  of  psy¬ 
chopathology  could  be  uncovered. 

Hweig  and  his  associates  are  here  to  rejuve¬ 
nate  Earth  and  its  inhabitants.  They  plan  to  ac¬ 
complish  these  changes  via  communication 
with  contactees,  who  will  be  led  to  “certain  dis¬ 
ciples  and  .  .  .  specific  discoveries”  that  will  im¬ 
prove  humanity’s  lot  and  Earth’s  environment. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  1999.  Soul  Samples:  Personal  Explo  - 
rations  in  Reincarnation  and  UFO  Experiences. 
Columbus,  NC:  Granite  Publishing. 


Hybrid  beings 

Hybrid  beings  are  entities  who  are  part 
human  and  part  humanoid.  They  figure  in  a 
number  of  accounts  of  UFO  abductions.  Fe¬ 
male  abductees  sometimes  report  anomalous 
pregnancies  that  are  enigmatically  terminated, 
typically  in  association  with  a  missing-time 
experience  of  the  sort  in  which  the  abductions 
allegedly  took  place.  In  a  subsequent  onboard 
UFO  encounter,  the  aliens  present  the  ab- 
ductee  with  a  child  who  has  the  features  both 
of  the  human  mother  and  of  the  abducting 
entities,  most  often  described  as  thin,  gray-  or 
white-skinned,  with  oversized  heads  and  large, 
hypnotic  eyes. 

As  early  as  the  late  1960s,  paranormal 
writer  John  A.  Keel,  investigating  reports  of 
UFOs  and  other  strange  occurrences  in  New 
York  City  and  on  Fong  Island,  noted  that 
some  female  witnesses  experienced  what  he 
called  “hysterical  pregnancies”  (Keel,  1975). 
Keel’s  observation  was  little  noted  and  soon 
forgotten.  In  the  1980s,  however,  abduction 
specialist  Budd  Hopkins  independently  came 
upon  the  same  phenomenon.  Mostly  through 
the  use  of  hypnosis,  the  women  “recalled”  in¬ 


stances  in  which  a  kind  of  suction  device  re¬ 
moved  fetuses  from  their  wombs.  In  later  ab¬ 
ductions  the  women  would  be  shown  babies, 
toddlers,  and  older  children  and  told  to  touch 
and  interact  with  them  in  other  ways.  Though 
generally  human  in  appearance,  the  children 
often  appeared  to  be  lacking  the  emotional 
makeup  of  human  beings. 

In  time,  abductees  reported  encounters 
with  young  adult  hybrids.  These  hybrids, 
among  those  sufficiently  human-looking  to 
pass  unnoticed  on  the  street,  would  some¬ 
times  have  sexual  relationships  with  younger 
abductees,  who  may  or  may  not  have  given 
their  consent.  David  M.  Jacobs,  who  has  writ¬ 
ten  extensively  on  the  issue  of  hybrids,  be¬ 
lieves  these  particular  beings  are  from  a  late 
stage  of  the  process.  His  investigations  lead 
him  to  believe  that  first-stage  hybrids  are  half- 
human/half- alien.  These  entities  tend  to  look 
“almost  alien.”  In  the  next  stage,  Jacobs  specu¬ 
lates,  “the  aliens  join  a  human  egg  and  sperm 
and  assimilate  genetic  material  from  the  first- 
stage  hybrid  .  .  .  into  the  zygote”  (Jacobs, 
1998).  The  third-stage  hybrid,  created  from 
human  sperm  and  egg  and  genetic  material 
from  a  second-stage  individual,  looks  more 
human.  Only  in  the  latest  stages,  the  fifth  or 
sixth,  do  the  hybrids  resemble  humans 
enough  to  walk  among  us  and,  just  as  impor¬ 
tant,  reproduce.  They  retain  the  strong  mental 
and  telepathic  powers  of  their  alien  heritage, 
however.  In  Jacobs’s  view,  based  on  testimony 
from  abductees  whom  he  has  hypnotized,  the 
aliens  are  preparing  to  replace  the  human  race 
with  a  hybrid  population.  The  aliens  them¬ 
selves  are  unable  to  reproduce,  but  through 
hybrids,  their  species  will  survive — at  the  ex¬ 
pense  of  humanity’s.  Jacobs  holds  that  this 
takeover  could  occur  at  any  time  and  is  more 
likely  to  occur  sooner  than  later. 

Hybrids  are  a  relatively  new  concept 
among  ufologists  and  in  the  accounts  of  al¬ 
leged  UFO  experiencers.  In  retrospect,  some 
have  suggested  that  the  presence  of  human  or 
humanlike  beings  in  early  close  encounters  of 
the  third  kind  suggests  hybrids  were  being 
seen  before  they  were  being  recognized.  In  a 


Hybrid  beings  127 


famous  October  1957  Brazilian  abduction 
case,  a  young  man  allegedly  had  sexual  inter¬ 
course  with  an  alien  woman  who,  were  she  to 
have  been  reported  in  a  more  recent  episode, 
would  probably  be  judged  a  hybrid.  Through 
hand  gestures,  the  woman  seemed  to  indicate 
that  the  fruit  of  their  union  would  be  born  on 
another  planet. 

On  the  other  hand,  critics  point  out,  hard 
evidence  for  the  existence  of  hybrids  simply 
does  not  exist.  Most  of  the  testimony  to  their 
presence  owes,  moreover,  to  accounts  elicited 
under  hypnosis,  a  state  in  which  unconscious 
fantasizing  frequently  occurs.  Scientific  critics 
have  stated  flatly  that  hybridization  proce¬ 
dures  of  the  sort  described  are  biologically  im¬ 
possible.  Though  there  is  no  shortage  of  anec¬ 
dotal  testimony,  no  medically  documented 


instances  of  anomalously  terminated  pregnan¬ 
cies  have  ever  been  demonstrated. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Close  encounters  of 
the  third  kind;  Hopkins,  Budd;  Keel,  John  Alva 

Further  Reading 

Hopkins,  Budd,  1987.  Intruders:  The  Incredible  Visi  - 
tations  at  Copley  Woods.  New  York:  Random 
House. 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  1992.  Secret  Life:  Firsthand  Ac  - 
counts  of  UFO  Abductions.  New  York:  Simon  and 
Schuster. 

- ,  1998.  The  Threat.  New  York:  Simon  and 

Schuster. 

Neal,  Richard,  1991.  “Missing  Embryo/Fetus  Syn¬ 
drome.”  UFO  6,  4  (July /August):  18-22. 

Schnabel,  Jim,  1994.  Dark  White:  Aliens,  Abduc  - 
tions,  and  the  UFO  Obsession.  London:  Hamish 
Hamilton. 

Swords,  Michael  D.,  1988.  “Extraterrestrial  Hy¬ 
bridization  Unlikely.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal 
247  (November):  6-10. 


Imaginal  beings 

University  of  Connecticut  psychologist  Ken¬ 
neth  Ring  theorizes  that  an  “imaginal  realm” 
exists  somewhere  between  reality  and  fantasy. 
In  this  “third  kingdom,”  entered  through 
(Ring’s  italics)  “certain  altered  states  of  con  - 
sciousness  that  have  the  effect  of  undermining 
ordinary  perception  and  conceptual  thinking” 
(Ring,  1992),  one  encounters  magical  yet 
semireal  entities  such  as  UFO  beings,  angels, 
and  various  otherworldly  intelligences.  Ring’s 
imaginal  realm  is  much  like  the  “interdimen- 
sional  mind”  of  another  parapsychological 
theorist,  Michael  Grosso. 

To  test  certain  aspects  of  the  hypothesis, 
Ring  and  a  colleague,  Christopher  J.  Rosing, 
conducted  extensive  psychological  testing  of 
several  groups.  They  found  that  persons  who 
report  UFO-abduction  experiences  and  those 
who  have  undergone  near-death  experiences 
are  psychologically  indistinguishable.  Though 
not  fantasy-prone  in  the  clinical  sense,  they 
have  felt  a  connection  with  nonordinary  real¬ 
ities  since  childhood.  Moreover,  those  child¬ 
hoods  were  troubled  with  episodes  of  abuse, 
trauma,  or  serious  illness.  Because  of  these 
difficulties,  these  individuals  have  developed 
a  “dissociative  response  style  as  a  means  of 
psychological  defense .”  This  causes  them  to  be 


so  focused  on  their  internal  state  that  their 
consciousness  has  changed  in  radical  ways. 
This  expanded  consciousness  allows  them  to 
enter  the  imaginal  realm,  there  to  meet  ex¬ 
traordinary  beings  and  undergo  positive  life 
changes. 

UFO  abductees  and  near-death  experients, 
in  Ring’s  view,  are  prophets — modern 
shamans — who  are  picking  up  coded  mes¬ 
sages  from  the  otherworld.  Abductees  see 
“small,  gray,  sickly  looking”  aliens  whose 
heads  are  too  big  for  their  bodies.  They  look, 
in  other  words,  like  starving  children.  Ring 
reads  this  to  mean,  “The  future  of  the  human 
race — symbolized  by  the  archetype  of  the 
child — is  menaced  as  never  before.”  Our 
planet  is  experiencing  a  “near-death  crisis,” 
and  we  need  to  listen  to  what  these  “extraordi¬ 
nary  experiences”  are  telling  us.  They  are 
leading  us  to  a  “cosmic-centered  view  of  our 
place  in  creation,  a  myth  that  has  the  power  to 
ignite  the  fires  of  a  worldwide  planetary  re¬ 
generation  and  thus  to  save  us  from  the  icy 
blasts  ofThanatos’s  nuclear  winter.” 

See  Also:  Psychoterrestrials 

Further  Reading 

Ring,  Kenneth,  1992.  The  Omega  Project:  Near-Death 
Experiences,  UFO  Encounters,  and  Mind  at  Large. 
New  York:  William  Morrow  and  Company. 


129 


130  Insectoids 


Insectoids 

Some  UFO  abductees  report  onboard  en¬ 
counters  with  entities  that  resemble  giant 
praying  mantises.  These  beings,  typically 
dressed  in  capes  with  long  robes  and  high  col¬ 
lars,  are  seen  in  association  with  the  smaller, 
humanoid  grays,  though  they  appear  to  have  a 
higher  rank  than  their  colleagues.  “Other 
aliens  appear  to  act  somewhat  subservient  to 
the  insectlike  beings,”  abduction  investigator 
David  M.  Jacobs  has  written. 

Insectoids  seldom  participate  direcdy  in  the 
physical  examinations  of  humans,  though  they 
may  engage  in  what  Jacobs  calls  “staring  proce¬ 
dures,”  wherein  an  alien  puts  its  face  close  to 
an  abductees,  telepathically  probes  the  con¬ 
tents  of  the  individual’s  mind,  stimulates  emo¬ 
tions  (everything  from  fear  to  love  to  sexual 
arousal)  and  conjures  up  hallucinatory  images 
into  it.  Though  the  grays  have  little  to  say  to 
abductees,  insectoids  sometimes  are  commu¬ 
nicative.  In  one  of  Jacobs’s  cases,  a  woman  re¬ 
ported  being  told  that  it  was  the  aliens’  inten¬ 
tion  to  take  over  the  Earth  with  the  insectoids 
in  charge  of  this  new  world  order. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  aliens;  MU  the  Mantis 
being;  Nordics 

Further  Reading 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  1998.  The  Threat.  New  York: 
Simon  and  Schuster. 

Lewels,  Joe,  1997.  The  God  Hypothesis:  Extraterres  - 
trial  Life  and  Its  Implications  for  Science  and  Reli  - 
gion.  Mill  Spring,  NC:  Wild  Flower  Press. 

Intelligences  from  Beyond 
(Intelligences  du  Dehors) 

Intelligences  du  Dehors — “intelligences  from 
beyond”  in  English  translation — allegedly 
channeled  through  French  contactee  Jean- 
Pierre  Prevost.  Prevost,  a  heretofore-obscure 
street  merchant,  had  risen  to  public  attention 
through  his  involvement  in  a  sensational  inci¬ 
dent  said  to  have  occurred  on  the  morning  of 
November  26,  1979,  in  a  Paris  suburb.  Prevost 
and  another  business  associate  reportedly  wit¬ 
nessed  the  disappearance  of  their  friend  Franck 
Fontaine  in  the  wake  of  a  close  encounter  with 
a  UFO.  Fontaine  showed  up  a  week  later, 


claiming  not  to  remember  anything  that  hap¬ 
pened  in  the  interim.  Police  and  civilian  UFO 
investigators  suspected  a  hoax. 

Nonetheless,  French  science-fiction  writer 
Jimmy  Guieu  rushed  into  print  with  a  book 
on  the  case,  but  with  a  difference.  In  the 
book,  Contacts  OVNI  Cergy-Pontoise  (1980), 
Prevost  became  the  central  figure  in  the 
episode,  the  intended  target  of  the  alien  ab¬ 
duction.  Within  months,  Prevost’s  own  book 
recounted  his  extraterrestrial  contacts  with  a 
strong  emphasis  on  the  usual  contactee  mes¬ 
sage  about  noble  space  visitors  and  confused, 
destructive  earthlings.  His  principal  contact 
was  a  wise  space  being  named  Haurrio.  Read¬ 
ers  inclined  to  doubt  all  of  this  could  only 
wonder  at  Prevost  statements  such  as  this  one: 
“What  does  it  matter  to  know,  at  the  factual 
level,  where  real  life  ends  and  imagination 
takes  over?  Isn’t  it  more  important  to  take  into 
consideration  the  content  of  the  messages?” 
(Bonabot,  1983). 

In  a  July  7,  1983,  newspaper  interview, 
Prevost  confessed  that  both  the  Fontaine  ab¬ 
duction  and  his  own  space  contacts  were  fake, 
concocted,  he  said,  to  attract  an  audience  to 
his  philosophical  messages  by  putting  them  in 
the  mouths  of  advanced  intelligences.  Even 
so,  he  still  tried  to  start  a  group  with  him  at 
the  head,  but  it  failed,  as  did  a  publishing  en¬ 
terprise  and  an  FM  radio  station.  Interviewed 
by  ufologist  Jacques  Vallee  in  1989,  Fontaine 
stuck  to  his  story  but  charged  that  Prevost  was 
lying  about  his. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Bonabot,  Jacques,  1983.  “1979  Fontaine  Case  in 
France  Now  Admitted  to  Be  a  Hoax.”  MUFON 
UFO  Journal  190  (December):  10. 

Evans,  Hilary,  with  Michel  Piccin,  1982.  “Who 
Took  Who  [sic]  for  a  Ride?”  Fate  35,  10  (Octo¬ 
ber):  51-58. 

Vallee,  Jacques,  1991.  Revelations:  Alien  Contact  and 
Human  Deception.  New  York:  Ballantine  Books. 


Ishkomar 

Ishkomar,  an  extraterrestrial,  began  channeling 
for  the  first  time  in  late  September  1966 


Ishkomar  131 


through  a  Phoenix  man  identified  only  as 
Charles — “a  blue-collar  worker  of  modest  edu¬ 
cation”  (Steiger,  1973).  Ishkomar  said  he  was 
speaking  via  telepathic  light  beamed  from  a 
spaceship  in  Earths  atmosphere.  He  himself 
had  lived  long  enough  so  that  he  was  able  to 
discard  a  physical  body,  though  the  ship  “con¬ 
tains  others  of  us  who  are  in  human  form.” 
Ishkomar  began  his  Earth  mission  some  thirty 
thousand  years  ago  to  accelerate  evolution  so 
that  human  beings  could  develop  more  quickly 
and  be  able  to  accept  guidance — though  not 
control,  which  galactic  law  forbids — from  wise 
space  people  like  himself.  “You  must  reach  a 
high  level  of  mental  development  and  knowl¬ 
edge  to  be  able  to  understand  our  purposes,” 
he  said,  so  the  work  continues. 

Ishkomar  also  warned  that  another  group 
also  worked  in  Earth’s  space.  This  group,  while 
not  necessarily  evil  in  itself,  had  purposes  at 
odds  with  humanity’s  best  interests,  and  its 
members  sought  to  control  human  destiny. 
Ishkomar  refused  to  condemn  these  beings, 
saying  only  that  their  purpose  “conflicts  with 
our  purpose.  This  does  not  mean  that  their  in¬ 
tentions  are  not  good  or  honorable.” 

Soon  there  would  be  “great  upheavals”  on 
Earth’s  surface,  and  there  would  be  much  suf¬ 
fering  and  death.  Only  those  who  were  men¬ 


tally  and  physically  prepared  would  survive. 
The  extraterrestrials  did  not  plan  any  massive 
rescue  operation,  since  “you  are  of  no  use  to 
us  in  the  Outer  Reaches.”  But  they  would 
help  those  human  beings  who  heeded  their 
words  to  make  their  planet  improved  and  liv¬ 
able  after  the  changes. 

Ishkomar  said  his  people  were  not  con¬ 
cerned  solely  with  Earth.  They  were  galactic 
travelers  and  were  involved  with  the  fates  of 
many  worlds  throughout  the  cosmos. 

Charles  told  Brad  Steiger  that  he  had  no 
idea  why  he  had  been  chosen,  unless  it  was 
because  of  a  sighting  of  what  he  took  to  be  a 
UFO  in  Michigan  in  1956.  While  observing 
the  object,  he  beamed  a  mental  message  to  its 
presumed  occupants  and  told  them,  “I  would 
like  to  be  your  friend.” 

After  the  Ishkomar  messages  started  com¬ 
ing  a  decade  later,  Charles  and  his  wife,  Lois, 
formed  a  small  group.  As  Charles  channeled, 
members  asked  questions  and  learned  lessons. 
Ishkomar  firmly  instructed  them  never  to  re¬ 
veal  Charles’s  full  name,  lest  his  life  be  endan¬ 
gered  by  unfriendly  forces. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1973.  Revelation:  The  Divine  Fire.  En¬ 
glewood  Cliffs,  NJ :  Prentice-Hall. 


J.w 

In  1953,  a  voice  in  her  head  identified  itself  to 
Gloria  Lee,  a  former  child  actress  and  model, 
as  that  of  “J.  W.,”  an  inhabitant  of  Jupiter. 
Not  quite  convinced,  Lee  demanded  physical 
evidence  of  J.  W.’s  existence.  Some  days  after¬ 
ward,  J.  W.  alerted  her  to  the  presence  of  a  fly¬ 
ing  saucer  passing  over  her  backyard  in 
Westchester,  California.  Lee  went  on  to  form 
the  Cosmon  Research  Foundation,  which  at¬ 
tracted  as  many  as  two  thousand  members,  as 
a  forum  for  the  distribution  of  J.  W.’s  teach¬ 
ings,  essentially  a  variation  of  Theosophy.  She 
also  wrote  Why  We  Are  Here  (1959),  a  book 
widely  read  in  early  contactee  circles. 

Lee  became  a  martyr  to  the  contact  move¬ 
ment  in  1962  through  tragic  circumstances. 
J.  W.  had  provided  her  with  spaceship  blue¬ 
prints  and  instructed  her  to  take  them  to 
Washington,  DC,  to  show  officials.  But  when 
she  and  associate  Hedy  Hood  went  there,  no 
one  was  interested  in  meeting  them.  Lee  told 
her  friend  that  J.  W.  had  now  informed  her, 
“The  space  people  are  going  to  invade  the 
earth  and  establish  a  peace  program”  (Barker, 
1965).  She  was  also  ordered  to  go  on  a  fast  for 
peace  that  would  end  when  a  “light  elevator” 
(spaceship)  arrived  to  transfer  her  to  J.  W.’s 
home  planet.  The  fast  began  on  September  23 
and  lasted  till  November  28,  when  Lee’s 


alarmed  husband  had  her  rushed  to  a  hospital. 
She  died  there  on  December  7. 

In  less  than  two  months,  according  to  a 
Florida-based  contactee  group,  Mark-Age 
MetaCenter,  Lee  herself  was  sending  psychic 
messages  from  Jupiter.  She  promised  that 
spaceships  would  land  on  Earth  within  six 
months  if  they  were  received  in  peace  and  good 
will.  She  also  mentioned  that  the  recently  de¬ 
ceased  Marilyn  Monroe  had  just  arrived.  Over 
the  years,  Mark- Age  would  publish  five  vol¬ 
umes  of  Lee-generated  channeled  material. 

See  Also:  Contactees 
Further  Reading 

Barker,  Gray,  1965.  Gray  Barker’s  Book  of  Saucers. 

Clarksburg,  WV:  Saucerian  Books. 

Lee,  Gloria,  1959.  Why  We  Are  Here:  By  J.  W,  a  Being 
from  Jupiter  through  the  Instrumentation  of  Gloria 
Lee.  Los  Angeles:  DeVorss  and  Company. 

- ,  1962.  The  Changing  Conditions  of  Your 

World,  by  J.  W.  of  Jupiter,  Instrumented  by  Gloria 
Lee.  Los  Angeles:  DeVorss  and  Company. 

Mark- Age  MetaCenter,  1963.  Gloria  Lee  Lives!  My 
Experiences  since  Leaving  Earth.  Miami,  FL: 
Mark-Age  MetaCenter. 

- ,  1969-1972.  Cosmic  Lessons:  Gloria  Lee 

Channels  for  Mark-Age.  Miami,  FL:  Mark-Age 
MetaCenter. 

Jahrmin  and  Jana 

In  1940,  according  to  an  account  he  would  re¬ 
late  many  years  later,  Jananda  Korsholm,  a 


133 


134  Janus 


seven-year-old  Danish  boy,  was  playing  with  a 
friend  when  a  thunderstorm  erupted.  As  he 
ran  home,  he  saw  his  sister  looking  out  of  the 
window  of  the  family’s  apartment.  Just  as  he 
was  waving  at  her,  he  felt  a  golden  light  sur¬ 
rounding  him  and  an  intense  heat  surging  all 
through  his  body.  He  found  himself  ascending 
inside  the  light  until,  suddenly,  a  gold  and  sil¬ 
ver  spaceship  appeared  just  above  him.  It  had 
no  door,  but  he  entered  it  by  passing  through  a 
wall.  Inside  a  circular  room  he  encountered  a 
hairless,  androgynous-looking  figure  who  Ja- 
nanda  sensed  was  male.  The  figure,  dressed  in 
a  silver  uniform  with  a  pyramid  logo  on  his 
chest,  said  his  name  was  Jahrmin  (pronounced 
“Yarmin”).  A  tall  blond  woman  approached 
him,  touched  his  hand,  and  let  him  know  via 
telepathy  that  her  name  was  Jana. 

Through  her  touch,  the  boy  found  himself 
transformed  into  a  young  man.  Jana  told  him 
that  he  had  a  mission  on  Earth.  It  would  not 
be  easy  because  ill-intentioned  persons  and 
forces  would  resist  him.  She  would,  however, 
be  there  to  protect  him  with  her  energy,  and 
they  would  be  reunited  at  the  conclusion  of 
his  mission.  Jananda  knew  that  he  had  found 
his  soul  mate,  that  no  earthly  love  would  ever 
fulfill  him  as  the  love  he  shared  with  Jana. 

On  a  television  screen  in  the  middle  of  the 
room,  he  saw  scenes  from  the  solar  systems 
past,  when  meteors,  comets,  and  other  objects 
falling  from  space  drastically  altered  the  sur¬ 
faces  of  planets,  and  their  inhabitants  had  to 
be  evacuated.  He  saw  himself  just  about  to  be 
evacuated  from  Earth,  leaving  a  wife  behind. 
He  also  saw  Earths  changed  landscape  hun¬ 
dreds  of  years  in  the  future. 

Jananda  Korsholm  eventually  moved  to  the 
United  States  and  found  his  way  to  Sedona, 
Arizona,  where  he  works  as  a  channeler, 
healer,  and  spiritual  counselor. 

Further  Reading 

Korsholm,  Jananda,  1995.  “UFO’s,  Close  Encoun¬ 
ters  of  the  Positive  Kind.”  http://spiritweb.org/ 
Spirit/ufo-positive-negative-jananda.html 

Janus 

In  his  memoirs,  Air  Marshal  Sir  Peter  Horsley, 
onetime  Deputy  Commander-in-Chief  of  the 


Royal  Air  Force’s  Strike  Command,  later 
Equerry  for  the  Royal  Family,  recounts  a  meet¬ 
ing  with  a  self-identified  extraterrestrial  who 
was  introduced  to  him  as  “Janus.”  He  says  the 
incident  took  place  one  winter  day  in  1954, 
after  an  acquaintance,  a  high-ranking  military 
officer  interested  in  UFOs  and  convinced  of 
their  friendly  intentions,  phoned  him  with  a 
curious  message:  to  go  that  evening  to  a  house 
in  London’s  Chelsea  district.  A  woman  met 
him  at  the  door  and  led  him  into  a  dimly  lit 
room,  where  he  was  introduced  to  a  “Mr. 
Janus.”  The  stranger  immediately  asked  him  to 
tell  him  what  he  knew  about  UFOs.  After¬ 
ward,  Mr.  Janus  expressed  a  desire  to  meet 
Prince  Philip,  then  launched  into  a  two-hour 
discourse  on  space  travel,  visitors  from  other 
worlds,  cosmology,  and  philosophy.  Janus 
stressed  the  human  race’s  immaturity  and  its 
potential  to  destroy  itself.  In  the  course  of  this 
conversation,  Horsley  came  to  believe  that  the 
stranger  was  reading  his  mind. 

Janus  said  that  advanced  “observers”  from 
distant  planets  are  watching  Earth,  contacting 
a  select  few  trustworthy  terrestrials  while  try¬ 
ing  not  to  interfere  directly  in  human  affairs. 
Once  human  beings  have  learned  interstellar 
travel,  he  said,  “it  is  of  paramount  importance 
that  you  have  learnt  your  responsibilities  for 
the  preservation  of  life  elsewhere”  (Horsley, 
1997).  In  the  meantime,  the  visitors  also  want 
to  ensure  that  they  leave  no  conclusive  proof 
of  their  presence. 

Horsley  wrote  that  there  was  an  odd  se¬ 
quel.  Shortly  after  the  meeting  he  prepared  a 
memo  and  gave  it  to  Lieutenant  General  Sir 
Frederick  Browning,  Treasurer  to  Prince 
Philip.  Browning  pressed  Horsley  to  arrange 
another  encounter.  Horsley  tried  repeatedly 
and  unsuccessfully  to  reach  the  woman  at 
whose  flat  he  had  spoken  with  Janus.  After  a 
few  days  he  personally  went  to  her  residence, 
only  to  learn  that  she  had  suddenly  moved 
out.  The  general  who  had  set  up  the  en¬ 
counter  became  “distant  and  evasive”  when 
Horsley  got  in  touch  with  him.  He  never  saw 
him,  the  woman,  or  Janus  again. 

Interviewed  by  British  ufologist  Timothy 
Good,  Horsley  thought  it  “strange”  that  he 


Jinns  135 


had  only  a  general  impression  of  Janus’s  ap¬ 
pearance.  He  remembered  only  a  normal¬ 
looking  man,  approximately  forty-five  to  fifty 
years  old,  thinning  gray  hair,  and  dressed  in 
suit  and  tie. 

When  Horsley’s  book  was  published,  the 
London  Times  ran  an  article  by  Dr.  Thomas 
Stuttaford,  who  suggested  that  Horsley  was 
suffering  from  hallucination.  Horsley  in¬ 
sists,  however,  that  the  incident  occurred  as 
reported. 

Further  Reading 

Good,  Timothy,  1998.  Alien  Base:  Earth’s  Encounters 
with  Extraterrestrials.  London:  Century. 

Horsley,  Sir  Peter,  1997.  Sounds  from  Another  Room: 
Memories  of  Planes,  Princes  and  the  Paranormal. 
London:  Leo  Cooper. 

Stuttaford,  Thomas,  1997.  “Air  Marshal’s  Flight  of 
Fancy.”  London  Times  (August  14). 

Jerhoam 

Jerhoam  is  a  “State  of  Consciousness”  who 
channels  through  John  Oliver.  He  is  here,  he 
says,  to  help  humans  “incorporate  the  Great 
Knowledge  of  the  Soul  into  life  to  become 
more  aware  ...  to  become  more  awake,  to  be¬ 
come  more  loved,  and  to  know  how  to  express 
love  in  many  ways.”  He  also  seeks  to  recon¬ 
nect  with  students  from  that  time,  persons 
who  have  reincarnated  and  live  on  Earth  now. 

Many  centuries  ago — thousands  of  years 
before  the  Great  Pyramid  was  constructed — 
Jerhoam  occupied  a  physical  body,  teaching  at 
the  Great  School  of  Ancient  Wisdom. 

Further  Reading 

“An  Introduction:  Who  Is  Jerhoam?”  http://www. 
jerhoam.com/whoisjer.html. 


Jessup’s  “little  people” 

Morris  Ketchum  Jessup  (1900-1959)  wrote 
four  books  on  UFOs  between  1955  and 
1957.  His  book  The  Case  for  the  UFO  (1955) 
was  the  first  to  use  “UFO”  in  its  title;  hereto¬ 
fore,  publishers  preferred  the  then  more  fa¬ 
miliar  “flying  saucers.”  Jessup  also  was  an  ear¬ 
lier  theorist  in  what  would  be  called  the 
“ancient  astronaut”  genre,  though  his  particu¬ 
lar  interpretation  remains  unique.  He  believed 


that  the  “little  people”  sometimes  reported  in 
connection  with  UFOs  are  literally  that:  pyg¬ 
mies  of  earthly  origin  and  the  creators  of  an 
extraordinary  technology  that  gave  them 
space  flight  long  ago. 

Jessup  first  hinted  at  his  theory  in  UFO 
and  the  Bible  (1956),  asserting  that  all  UFO 
evidence  pointed  to  the  presence  of  “space-in¬ 
telligence,  relatively  near  the  earth,  but  yet 
away  from  it  and  in  open  space  .  .  .  using  nav- 
igatable  contrivances.”  In  his  earlier  life,  he 
had  done  graduate-level  work  in  astronomy  at 
the  University  of  Michigan.  In  the  course  of 
his  studies,  and  later  in  his  adult  life,  he  trav¬ 
eled  in  Africa  and  South  America,  often  stop¬ 
ping  to  examine  archaeological  artifacts.  He 
became  convinced  that  only  an  advanced  civi¬ 
lization,  with  a  technology  that  encompassed 
teleportation,  levitation,  and  space  flight, 
could  have  created  such  structures. 

Eventually,  he  came  to  believe  that  about 
100,000  years  ago,  “in  the  pre-cataclysmic  era 
which  developed  a  first  wave  of  civilization  . .  . 
space  flight  originated  on  this  planet.  .  .  .  We 
may  assume  that  the  Pygmies  .  .  .  developed  a 
civilization  which  discovered  the  principle  of 
gravitation  and  put  it  to  work”  (Jessup,  1957). 
When  Atlantis  and  Mu  sank  into  the  oceans, 
the  “little  people”  fled  in  their  spaceships. 
They  now  reside  on  the  moon  and  in  floating 
structures  in  a  “gravity  neutral”  zone  between 
Earth  and  its  satellite. 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Lemuria 

Further  Reading 

Jessup,  M.  K.,  1955.  The  Case  for  the  UFO.  New 
York:  Citadel  Press. 

- ,  1956.  UFO  and  the  Bible.  New  York: 

Citadel  Press. 

- ,  1957.  The  Expanding  Case  for  the  UFO. 

New  York:  Citadel  Press. 

Jinns 

In  traditional  Arabic  and  Persian  belief,  jinns 
are  demonic,  shape-shifting  entities.  Over  the 
centuries,  the  idea  evolved  that  a  few  jinns  are 
good.  There  are  five  kinds  of  jinns,  and  only 
one  has  occasional  benevolent  qualities.  Typi¬ 
cally,  jinns  take  the  shapes  of  insects,  toads, 
scorpions,  and  other  animals  deemed  unap- 


136  Joseph 


pealing  or  obnoxious.  The  tradition  bears 
some  resemblance  to  traditions  of  fairy  folk  in 
other  societies.  At  least  two  prominent  writers 
on  the  UFO  phenomenon,  Gordon  Creighton 
and  Ann  Druffel,  are  convinced  that  UFO  be¬ 
ings  are  jinns  in  disguise. 

Under  the  editorship  of  Charles  Bowen, 
England’s  Flying  Saucer  Review,  then  a  widely 
read  UFO  journal,  moved  the  publication 
away  from  speculations  about  extraterrestrial 
visitation  toward  interpretations  that  cast 
UFOs  in  paranormal  terms.  No  other  contrib¬ 
utor  did  so  as  enthusiastically  as  Creighton,  a 
retired  British  diplomat  with  a  keen  interest  in 
demonology.  After  Bowens  illness  and  subse¬ 
quent  death  in  the  1980s,  Creighton  assumed 
editorship  of  the  magazine  and  promptly  de¬ 
clared  that  he  had  identified  the  intelligences 
behind  UFO  sightings,  encounters,  and  ab¬ 
ductions:  jinns.  In  an  article  in  a  1983  issue, 
he  pointed  out  that  jinns  materialize  and  de- 
materialize,  switch  between  visibility  and  in¬ 
visibility,  change  shape,  kidnap  humans,  lie, 
control  minds,  and  engage  their  victims  in 
sexual  intercourse — behaviors  associated  with 
UFO  entities. 

FJe  was  convinced  that  the  jinns  are  up  to 
no  good.  In  follow-up  writings,  he  contended 
that  these  sinister  supernatural  powers  secretly 
control  Earth,  using  thought  control  to  get 
humans  to  do  their  bidding.  They  are  behind 
crime  and  violence,  and  they  have  brought 
AIDS  and  other  deadly  diseases  into  the  pop¬ 
ulation.  “Another  great  World  War  may  be  in 
the  making,”  he  wrote  in  1990,  engineered 
for  cosmic  purposes  we  cannot  understand; 
humans  are  merely  property  and  playthings 
and  are  soon  to  be  removed  from  the  face  of 
the  Earth. 

Ufologists  responded  to  these  notions  with 
a  tactful  silence  with  one  exception:  Ann 
Druffel,  an  abduction-research  specialist  who 
finds  “startling  similarities  between  reports  of 
abduction  scenarios  in  the  Western  world  and 
Gordon  Creightons  excellent  research  on  the 
jinns”  (Druffel,  1998).  Druffel,  a  Californian, 
investigated  the  experiences  of  an  Iranian- 
American  she  calls  Timur.  Timur  encountered 


humanoids  in  out-of-ordinary  states  of  con¬ 
sciousness — sleep  paralysis,  meditation,  astral 
travel — and  recognized  them  as  the  jinns  he 
had  heard  of  in  his  native  country. 

Druffel  concludes  that  “our  own  faeries 
and  jinns  are  merely  an  old  human  problem, 
shape-shifted  and  wearing  space  garb  to  fool 
us.  They  can  be  fended  off  by  stouthearted, 
determined  individuals.” 

See  Also:  Fairies  encountered 

Further  Reading 

Creighton,  Gordon,  1983.  “A  Brief  Account  of  the 
True  Nature  of  the  ‘UFO  Entities’.”  Flying  Saucer 
Review  29,  1  (October):  2-6. 

- ,  1989.  “AIDS.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  34,  1 

(March  Quarter):  12. 

- ,  1990.  “Grave  Days.”  Flying  Saucer  Review 

35,  3  (September):  1. 

Druffel,  Ann,  1998.  Flow  to  Defend  Yourself  against 
Alien  Abduction.  New  York:  Three  Rivers  Press. 


Joseph 

A  Todmorden,  Yorkshire,  England,  police  of¬ 
ficer  named  Alan  Godfrey  was  on  patrol  at 
5:05  A.M.,  November  28,  1980,  when  he  en¬ 
countered  a  metallic  disc  with  a  dome  and  a 
row  of  windows.  When  he  attempted  to  alert 
headquarters,  he  found  that  his  radio  was  not 
working.  Suddenly,  he  found  himself  one 
hundred  yards  farther  down  the  road  than  he 
thought  he  was,  and  the  UFO  was  gone.  Fie 
vaguely  recalled  getting  out  of  his  car  and 
hearing  a  voice.  Under  hypnosis  later,  God¬ 
frey  “recalled”  that  he  lost  consciousness  after 
a  light  from  the  object  struck  him.  Then  he 
felt  himself  floating  into  the  craft  and  meeting 
a  humanlike  being  named  Joseph. 

Six  feet  tall,  friendly  in  manner,  Joseph  had 
a  thin  nose,  a  beard,  and  a  mustache.  FJe  woie 
a  skullcap  and  was  clad  in  a  sheet,  making 
him  look  something  like  a  prophet  from  the 
Bible.  A  large  black  dog  accompanied  him. 
The  room  also  contained  eight  robots,  each 
about  three  and  a  half  feet  tall,  making  a  sort 
of  murmuring  chatter.  When  they  touched 
Godfrey,  beeping  sounds  emanated  from 
them.  Joseph  directed  Godfrey  to  a  bed, 
where  he  lay  as  a  beam  of  light  from  the  ceil- 


Policeman  Alan  Godfrey,  who  was  allegedly  abducted  into  a  UFO  at  Todmorden,  Yorkshire,  drawing  a  picture  of  ‘Joseph, 
November  1980  (Janet  and  Colin  Bord/Fortean  Picture  Library) 


ing  shone  on  him.  Communicating  by  telepa¬ 
thy,  Joseph  touched  his  head,  and  Godfrey 
lapsed  into  unconsciousness  for  an  undeter¬ 
mined  period.  The  robots  took  off  Godfrey’s 
shoes  and  studied  his  toes.  Meanwhile,  instru¬ 
ments  placed  on  his  arms  and  legs  caused  him 
discomfort  to  the  point  of  sickness.  A  foul 
odor  permeated  his  nostrils.  Joseph  asked  him 
questions,  but  Godfrey  would  refuse  to  tell  in¬ 
vestigators  what  they  were.  The  alien  indi¬ 
cated  that  they  had  met  before,  apparently 
when  Godfrey  was  a  child. 

Godfrey  would  remember  an  earlier  inci¬ 
dent  from  1965,  when  he  was  18.  Around  2 


A.M.,  he  and  a  girlfriend  stopped  their  car 
abruptly  when  a  woman  and  a  dog  stepped 
out  in  front  of  them.  Certain  that  he  had  hit 
the  woman,  he  got  out  to  help  her,  but  there 
was  no  sign  of  her  or  the  animal.  When  he  got 
home,  he  found  that  two  hours  were  missing 
without  explanation.  Another  incident — his 
seeing  a  ball  of  light  in  his  room  when  he  was 
a  child — also  seemed  to  him  evidence  that  the 
1980  incident  was  not  his  first  encounter  with 
aliens. 

Further  Reading 

Randles,  Jenny,  1983.  The  Pennine  UFO  Mystery. 

London:  Granada. 


Kantarians 

For  four  nights  in  September  1961,  David 
Paladin’s  son  claimed  that  somebody  named 
Itan  was  coming  into  his  bedroom  and  taking 
him  away  in  a  big  “sky  car.”  Though  at  first 
Paladin  dismissed  this  as  a  child’s  fantasy,  a 
neighbor  claimed  that  he  had  seen  a  tall,  thin 
man  walking  the  boy  toward  a  waiting  flying 
saucer.  That  November  Itan  came  into  Pal¬ 
adin’s  own  bedroom  and  engaged  him  in  a 
telepathic  conversation.  Fie  and  his  people, 
the  Kantarians,  lived  on  a  planet  in  another 
dimension.  They  do  not  interfere  directly  in 
human  affairs,  but  they  have  contacted  certain 
human  beings  in  the  hope  that  they  could 
gently  push  the  human  race  in  a  more  mature, 
positive  direction.  They  had  been  observing 
humans  since  the  beginning  of  Homo  sapiens 
and  had  even  left  a  genetic  imprint  in  some 
humans. 

Paladin  claimed  years  of  psychic  connec¬ 
tion  with  the  Kantarian  Confederation.  Itan 
and  his  friends  have  told  him  that  if  human 
beings  destroy  themselves,  the  space  people 
can  do  nothing.  But  if  natural  cataclysms 
threaten  human  existence,  the  Kantarians  will 
perform  a  rescue  operation.  Mostly,  though, 
they  hope  that  humans  will  reform  them¬ 
selves,  develop  wisdom  and  kindness,  and  join 
their  Space  Brothers  in  the  cosmos  one  day. 


Further  Reading 

Montgomery,  Ruth,  1985.  Aliens  among  Us.  New 
York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 


Kappa 

In  traditional  Japanese  lore  the  Kappa  are  ma¬ 
licious  water  demons  shaped  like  monkeys 
with  scales.  They  lure  the  unsuspecting  into 
ponds  and  rivers,  then  devour  them.  One  Ja¬ 
panese  writer,  Komatsu  Kitamura,  has  theo¬ 
rized  that  the  Kappa  were  extraterrestrials  who 
came  to  Japan  sometime  between  the  ninth 
and  eleventh  centuries.  Others  have  picked  up 
on  this  speculation,  suggesting  that  the  osten¬ 
sibly  scaly  skin  was  actually  a  spacesuit.  Al¬ 
leged  sightings  continue  even  now.  In  No¬ 
vember  1978,  two  construction  workers 
fishing  off  the  coast  of  the  port  city  Yokosuka 
reported  seeing  a  creature  abruptly  emerge 
from  the  sea  to  glare  at  them.  “It  was  not  a 
fish,  an  animal,  or  a  man,”  one  said.  “It  was 
about  three  meters  [ten  feet]  in  height  and 
[was]  covered  with  thick,  scaly  skin  like  a  rep¬ 
tile.  It  had  a  face  and  two  large  yellow  eyes” 
(Picasso,  1991). 

Argentine  ufologist  Fabio  Picasso  has  col¬ 
lected  what  he  judges  to  be  more  or  less  com¬ 
parable  reports  from  his  country.  For  example, 
on  the  evening  of  April  22,  1980,  a  motorist 


139 


140  Karen 


A  Japanese  print  depicting  a  Kappa  (Victoria  and  Albert 
Museum,  London/Art  Resource,  NY) 


in  Santa  Rosa  noticed  something  falling  out 
of  the  sky.  At  that  moment,  his  car  engine 
suddenly  ceased  functioning.  When  he  got 
out  to  check  the  motor,  he  noticed  a  cold 
breeze  at  foot  level.  Looking  down,  he  saw  the 
legs  of  something  that  clearly  was  not  human. 
Looking  up,  he  saw  two  humanoid  creatures, 
approximately  seven  feet  in  height,  approach¬ 
ing  him.  They  had  webbed  hands  and  were 
clothed  in  black,  shiny  diving  suits.  Their 
faces  were  “skull-like.”  Though  their  protrud¬ 
ing  mouths  were  moving,  no  words  were 
coming  out  of  them.  One  put  its  cold  hands 
around  the  witness’s  head,  and  he  passed  out. 
He  revived  a  few  minutes  afterward,  but  a  half 
mile  from  where  he  had  been. 

Further  Reading 

Picasso,  Fabio,  1991.  “Infrequent  Types  of  South 
American  Humanoids.”  Strange  Magazine  8 
(Fall):  21-23,  44. 

Karen 

Late  at  night,  on  the  highway  between  Matias 
and  Barbosa,  Brazil,  on  January  21,  1976,  a 
couple  in  a  car  saw  a  blue  light  envelope  the 
landscape.  The  light  moved  toward  them  until 
it  covered  their  vehicle.  The  car  “was  absorbed 


as  if  through  a  chimney”  into  a  brilliandy  lumi¬ 
nous  circular  object.  Two  dark-featured  figures, 
male  and  more  than  six  feet  tall,  approached 
and  signaled  that  the  two  humans  should  step 
out  of  their  car.  The  ground  seemed  to  move 
under  them,  and  the  woman  said  she  felt 
drunk  even  though  she  had  consumed  no  alco¬ 
hol.  The  couple  could  not  understand  the 
aliens’  strange  language  until  one  gave  each  of 
them  a  headset  and  plugged  it  into  a  device.  At 
that  moment,  the  words  became  understand¬ 
able.  The  being  introduced  himself  as  Karen 
and  urged  them  to  remain  calm. 

The  woman  underwent  a  series  of  medical 
tests.  She  and  her  husband  also  drank  a  liquid 
with  an  unappealing  taste.  Other  aliens,  one  of 
them  female,  appeared  as  Karen  explained  to 
them  that  he  and  his  people  were  conducting 
medical  research,  even  though  on  their  world 
they  had  conquered  all  illness,  and  no  one  ever 
died  anymore.  He  warned  them  not  to  talk 
about  their  experience,  since  people  would 
think  they  were  insane.  If  they  wished,  he 
added,  they  could  have  their  memories  erased. 
The  couple  turned  down  that  offer.  The  woman 
claimed  some  subsequent  psychic  contacts. 

Further  Reading 

Bartholomew,  Robert  E.,  and  George  S.  Howard, 
1998.  UFOs  and  Alien  Contact:  Two  Centuries  of 
Mystery.  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 


Karmic  Board 

All  living  entities  must  pass  before  the  Karmic 
Board  before  they  can  be  incarnated  on  Earth. 
Each  entity  receives  its  assignment,  and  at  the 
end  of  that  assignment  (bodily  death)  the  en¬ 
tity  appears  before  the  board  once  more,  this 
time  to  have  its  performance  reviewed.  The 
Karmic  Board  “dispenses  justice  to  this  system 
of  worlds,  adjudicating  karma,  mercy  and 
judgment  on  behalf  of  every  lifestream” 
(“Lords  of  Karma,”  n.d.). 

Members  of  the  Karmic  Board  include  the 
Great  Divine  Director,  the  Goddess  of  Lib¬ 
erty,  Ascended  Lady  Master  Nada,  Cyclopea 
(Elohim  of  the  Fifth  Ray),  Pallas  Athena 


Kazik  141 


(Goddess  of  Truth),  Portia  (Goddess  of  Jus¬ 
tice),  and  Kuan  Yin  (Goddess  of  Mercy). 
Further  Reading 

“Lords  of  Karma,”  n.d.  http://www.ascension- 
research.org/karma.html 


Kazik 

In  September  1953,  Albert  K.  Bender  of 
Bridgeport,  Connecticut,  suddenly  shut  down 
his  International  Flying  Saucer  Bureau 
(IFSB),  confiding  to  a  few  close  friends  that 
three  men  in  black  had  threatened  him  and 
given  him  the  frightening  answer  to  the  UFO 
mystery.  Though  Bender  would  provide  few 
details,  he  hinted  that  the  visitors  were  agents 
of  the  U.S.  government.  His  alleged  experi¬ 
ence  led  an  associate,  Gray  Barker,  to  write  a 
sensational  and  paranoia-drenched  book, 
They  Knew  Too  Much  About  Flying  Saucers 
(1956),  about  Bender  and  other  supposedly 
silenced  UFO  researchers.  Eventually,  Barker, 
who  had  started  a  small  West  Virginia-based 
publishing  company,  persuaded  Bender  to  re¬ 
veal  what  had  happened  to  him.  In  Flying 
Saucers  and  the  Three  Men  (1962),  Bender 
wrote  that  he  had  run  afoul,  not  of  a  terres¬ 
trial  intelligence  agency,  but  of  extraterrestrial 
intelligences  from  the  planet  Kazik. 

Benders  IFSB  had  come  into  existence  in 
April  1952  and  was  soon  among  the  most  suc¬ 
cessful  of  early  UFO  groups,  claiming  as 
many  as  six  hundred  members  in  a  number  of 
countries.  Bender  was  also  an  enthusiastic  sci¬ 
ence-fiction  fan.  A  bachelor,  he  lived  in  a 
house  full  of  artifacts  from  horror  films,  and 
at  night,  as  he  lay  in  bed,  he  would  imagine 
himself  sailing  out  of  his  body  and  into  deep 
space.  Soon,  according  to  Bender’s  book, 
weird  things  began  happening  to  him.  Strange 
lights  and  disembodied  footsteps  frightened 
him,  and  once  glowing  eyes,  accompanied  by 
a  stench  of  sulfur,  stared  at  him.  With  col¬ 
leagues  in  Australia  and  New  Zealand,  Bender 
speculated  about  a  saucer  base  inside  the 
South  Pole,  and  they  laid  plans  for  a  research 
project  to  study  that  possibility. 


Bender  urged  his  membership  to  try  to 
contact  the  saucers  telepathically  at  the  same 
hour  on  March  15,  1953.  While  participat¬ 
ing,  he  underwent  an  out-of-body  experience 
and  then  heard  a  voice  warning  him  to  “dis¬ 
continue  delving  into  the  mysteries  of  the 
universe.” 

A  few  weeks  later,  he  returned  home  from  a 
two-week  vacation  to  smell  the  sulfur  odor.  A 
few  hours  later,  three  shadowy,  apparitional 
figures  dressed  in  dark  suits  spoke  to  him. 
They  gave  him  a  device  with  which  he  could 
contact  them;  all  he  had  to  do  was  hold  it 
tightly  in  his  palm  and  say  “Kazik”  over  and 
over  again.  Two  days  later,  he  attempted  con¬ 
tact.  The  experience  initiated  a  series  of  en¬ 
counters  with  monstrous  beings  who  revealed 
that  “Kazik”  was  the  name  of  their  home 
planet.  They  took  Bender  to  their  antarctic 
base,  where  they  revealed  their  big  secret:  they 
had  come  to  Earth  to  gather  and  refine  sea 
water.  They  also  told  him  that  God  does  not 
exist  and  that  there  is  no  life  after  death. 

Bender  was  given  a  disc  that  monitored  his 
activities  and  ensured  his  silence  until  they 
completed  their  business,  which  was  in  I960 
when  they  departed  from  our  planet.  Bender 
was  free  to  tell  his  story,  which  he  did  in  a 
book  that  few,  including  (privately)  Barker, 
saw  as  anything  more  than  a  not  particularly 
interesting  science-fiction  novel.  Two  critics 
pointed  to  the  story’s  inherent  implausibility: 
“The  story  lacks  a  good  solid  motive  or  pur¬ 
pose.  .  .  .  Flow  could  Bender  or  anyone  else 
have  discovered  [the  Kazakians’]  secret  until 
they  chose  to  reveal  it;  and  if  they  wished  their 
secret  to  remain  unknown,  what  possible  pur¬ 
pose  could  they  have  had  in  revealing  it  delib¬ 
erately  to  Bender,  only  to  have  to  then  force 
silence  upon  him,  causing  him  physical  pain 
and  disturbing  his  peace  of  mind  for  the  next 
eight  years?  .  .  .  What  was  so  significant  about 
a  few  tons  of  sea  water? .  .  .  What  had  such 
entities  to  fear  from  anyone,  if  Bender  did 
publish  such  a  ‘secret’?  Who  would  believe  it, 
or  be  able  to  interfere  with  such  an  advanced 
civilization?”  (Beasley  and  Sampsel,  1963). 


142  Keel,  John  Alva 


Twelve  years  after  Three  Mens  publication, 
Barker  expressed  the  view  that  the  story  was 
something  Bender  had  conjured  up  “in  a 
trance  or  a  dream”  (Barker,  1976).  Most  ob¬ 
servers,  however,  suspected  it  to  be  conscious 
fiction.  One  fantastic  theory,  proposed  in 
1980  by  British  ufologist  Brian  Burden,  held 
that  an  intelligence  agency  had  subjected  Ben¬ 
der  to  a  thought-control  experiment  and 
caused  him  to  hallucinate  space  people. 

See  Also:  Men  in  black 

Further  Reading 

Barker,  Gray,  1956.  They  Knew  Too  Much  about  Fly  - 
ing  Saucers.  New  York:  University  Books. 

- ,  1976.  Interviewed  by  Jerome  Clark. 

Barker,  Gray,  ed.,  1962.  Bender  Mystery  Confirmed. 
Clarksburg,  WV:  Saucerian  Books. 

Beasley,  H.  P.,  and  A.  V.  Sampsel,  1963.  “The  Ben¬ 
der  Mystery — Still  a  Mystery?”  Flying  Saucers 
(May):  20-27. 

Bender,  Albert  K.,  1 962.  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Three 
Men.  Clarksburg,  WV:  Saucerian  Books. 

Burden,  Brian,  1980.  “MIBs  and  the  Intelligence 
Community.”  Awareness  9,  1  (Spring):  6-13. 


Young,  Jerry  A.,  and  Gray  Barker,  1976.  “Letters.” 

Gray  Barker’s  Newsletter  3  (January):  7-12. 

Keel,  John  Alva  (1930-  ) 

Born  Alva  John  Kiehl  in  Hornell,  New  York, 
on  March  25,  1930,  John  Keel  would  discover 
the  writings  of  anomalist  Charles  Fort 
(1874-1932)  at  an  early  age.  He  grew  up  to 
be  a  Manhattan-based  writer  who  eventually 
became  internationally  known  for  radical, 
neodemonological  interpretadons  of  UFO, 
anomalous  and  paranormal  phenomena.  Keel 
would  speculate  that  a  wide  range  of  other¬ 
worldly  entities,  none  of  which  regard  the 
human  race  with  favor  (“ultraterrestrials,”  to 
use  his  term),  emerge  from  an  alternative  real¬ 
ity  he  calls  the  “superspectrum.” 

Keel  claims  to  have  attended  the  first  fly¬ 
ing-saucer  convention  ever  held,  “in  the  old 
Labor  Temple  on  New  York’s  14th  Street” 
(Keel,  1991).  After  a  tour  of  duty  in  the  mil- 


John  Alva  Keel  (August  C.  Roberts/Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Kihief  143 


itary  in  the  early  1950s,  he  wandered  the 
East  and  wrote  his  first  book,  Jadoo  (1957), 
on  his  adventures  and  observations.  He 
wrote  that  while  in  the  Himalayas,  he  saw 
the  yeti  (“abominable  snowman”),  a  beast  he 
would  come  to  think  of  as  a  “demon” 
(Chorvinsky,  1990).  In  the  1960s,  he  em¬ 
barked  full  time  on  investigations  of  UFOs, 
men  in  black,  monsters  (including  Moth- 
man,  an  eerie  winged  humanlike  creature 
with  which  Keel’s  name  would  forever  after 
be  associated),  contactees,  and  more.  He 
even  reported  having  his  own  encounters 
with  unearthly  entities.  Borrowing  from  Cal¬ 
ifornia  occult  theorist  N.  Meade  Layne,  Keel 
became  convinced  that  there  are  no  visiting 
extraterrestrials,  only  shape-changing  super¬ 
natural  beings  “composed  of  energy  from  the 
upper  frequencies  of  the  electro-magnetic 
spectrum.  Somehow  they  can  descend  to  the 
narrow  (very  narrow)  range  of  visible  light 
and  can  be  manipulated  into  any  desirable 
form.  .  .  .  Once  they  have  completed  their 
mission  .  .  .  they  .  .  .  revert  to  an  energy  state 
and  disappear  from  our  field  of  vision — for¬ 
ever”  (Keel,  1969). 

Though  dismissed  by  some  as  a  crank,  Keel 
has  been  an  influential  theorist  in  some  ufo¬ 
logical  and  Fortean  circles.  His  critics  have 
charged  him  with  careless  writing  and 
credulity,  but  his  admirers  prefer  to  think  of 
him  as  a  bold,  even  outrageous,  iconoclast. 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Men  in  black;  Mothman;  Ul¬ 
traterrestrials 

Further  Reading 

Chorvinsky,  Mark,  1990.  “Cryptozoo  Conversation 
with  John  A.  Keel.”  Strange  Magazine  5:  35-40. 

Clark,  Jerome,  1997.  Spacemen,  Demons,  and  Con  - 
spiracies:  The  Evolution  of  UFO  Hypotheses. 
Mount  Rainier,  MD:  Fund  for  UFO  Research. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  UFOs:  Operation  Trojan  Horse. 
New  York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 

- ,  1971.  Our  Haunted  Planet.  Greenwich,  CT: 

Fawcett  Publications. 

- ,  1975.  The  Eighth  Tower.  New  York:  Satur¬ 
day  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and  Company. 

- ,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New  York: 

Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and  Company. 

- ,  1988.  Disneyland  of  the  Gods.  New  York: 

Amok  Press. 


- ,  1969.  “The  Principle  of  Transmogrifica¬ 
tion.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  15,  4  (July/August): 
27-28,  31. 


Khauga 

Khauga  is  a  “Celestial  Being”  whom  William 
Ferguson  met  in  an  out-of-body  state  while 
meditating  on  the  evening  of  January  12, 
1947.  Traveling  at  the  “speed  of  conscious¬ 
ness,”  he  found  himself  on  Mars  within  ten 
seconds.  Khauga  met  him  on  his  arrival,  re¬ 
marking  that  he  had  something  to  say  about 
“the  observations  that  we  have  made  of  your 
planet.”  He  also  wanted  Ferguson  to  pass  on 
some  messages  to  his  fellow  earthlings. 

According  to  Khauga,  a  great  network  of 
canals  covers  the  planet.  Electromagnetic 
fields  enclose  its  cities.  Martians  themselves, 
all  of  whom  have  red  hair,  red  complexions, 
and  broad  features,  float  through  the  air  via 
levitation.  They  are  a  foot  shorter  than  the 
typical  Earth  person.  Khauga  expressed  in¬ 
credulity  that  human  beings  kill  each  other  in 
battles.  Martians,  he  said,  are  twenty  thou¬ 
sand  years  ahead  of  earthlings  in  spiritual  evo¬ 
lution  and  scientific  development.  Concerned 
about  the  state  of  affairs  on  our  planet,  the 
Martians  had  decided  to  “release  positive  en¬ 
ergy  particles  into  the  earth’s  atmosphere  .  .  . 
to  counteract  the  negative  energy  particles 
that  man  himself  has  released”  (Ferguson, 
1954).  Khauga  asked  Ferguson  to  assure  the 
people  of  Earth  that  things  would  soon  be 
much  better  in  their  world. 

See  Also:  Allingham’s  Martian;  Aurora  Martian; 
Brown’s  Martians;  Dentons’s  Martians  and  Venu- 
sians;  Hopkins’s  Martians;  Martian  bees;  Mince- 
Pie  Martians;  Muller’s  Martians;  Shaw’s  Mar¬ 
tians;  Smead’s  Martians;  Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Ferguson,  William,  1954.  My  Trip  to  Mars.  Potomac, 
MD:  Cosmic  Study  Center. 

Kihief 

Kihief  was  the  spirit  guide  to  the  late  Francie 
Paschal  Steiger,  who  with  her  then-husband, 
Brad  Steiger,  spearheaded  the  Star  People 


144  King  Leo 


movement  of  the  late  1970s  and  early  1980s. 
Paschal  Steiger  believed  herself  to  be  a  reincar¬ 
nated  extraterrestrial.  Kihief,  who  guided  her 
through  her  life,  said  he  was  from  a  place  “like 
unto  Venus”  (Steiger  and  Steiger,  1981).  She 
took  his  words  to  mean  that  he  was  from  an 
otherdimensional  counterpart  to  Earth’s  (un¬ 
inhabitable)  sister  planet.  Throughout  her 
lifetime,  Paschal  Steiger  interacted  with  a  vari¬ 
ety  of  friendly,  spiritually  advanced  space  peo¬ 
ple.  She  met  the  first  of  them  when,  as  a  five- 
year-old  child,  she  saw  a  robed  being  whom 
she  took  to  be  an  “angel.” 

See  Also:  Star  People 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1976.  Gods  of  Aquarius:  UFOs  and  the 
Transformation  of  Man.  New  York:  Harcourt 
Brace  Jovanovich. 

Steiger,  Brad,  and  Francie  Steiger,  1981.  The  Star 
People.  New  York:  Berkley  Books. 

Steiger,  Francie,  1982.  Reflections  from  an  Angel’s  Eye. 
New  York:  Berkley  Books. 


King  Leo 

King  Leo  is  a  reptilian  being  who  is  descended 
from  the  dinosaurs.  He  and  his  fellows  live  in 
an  underground  kingdom,  where  they  have 
resided  since  just  before  the  catastrophe  that 
destroyed  other  life  from  the  Age  of  Reptiles. 
Some  have  met  him  in  person,  but  most  of  his 
communications  come  through  channeling. 

King  Leo  got  his  name  from  a  woman  who 
prefers  to  call  herself  Joy  D’Light  (sometimes 
JoyD Light).  Her  association  with  reptilian  be¬ 
ings  began  on  November  7,  1961,  when  she 
and  her  husband,  an  air  force  man,  were  liv¬ 
ing  in  Oregon.  Her  husband  had  left  town  on 
assignment,  and  it  was  her  first  night  alone. 
That  night,  from  her  open  bedroom  door  fac¬ 
ing  the  kitchen,  she  saw  three  bipedal  reptil¬ 
ian  beings  standing  next  to  her  refrigerator. 
Six  and  a  half  feet  tall,  they  had  scaly  skin  and 
spikes  down  their  backs;  their  eyes  were  yel¬ 
low.  Too  frightened  to  leave  her  bed,  she  even¬ 
tually  fell  asleep.  They  were  gone  when  she 
woke  up;  nonetheless,  they  appeared  every 
night  for  two  months  thereafter.  Often  they 
were  waiting  for  her  when  she  came  home 


from  work.  Eventually,  she  took  up  a  brief  res¬ 
idence  with  her  sister  and  returned  only  after 
some  days  had  passed.  The  entities,  who  had 
never  harmed  her  or  spoken  with  her,  were 
not  there. 

That  changed  in  1996  when  one  showed 
up  in  her  house.  She  was  wide  awake  and  not 
in  her  bedroom  this  time,  and  she  no  longer 
felt  the  terror  she  had  originally  experienced. 
The  being  spoke  for  the  first  time,  assuring 
her  that  he  and  his  companions  had  never 
meant  to  harm  her;  they  were  just  interested 
in  her.  He  vanished  after  a  few  moments.  On 
another  occasion  this  being  or  one  much  like 
it  showed  up  briefly  on  the  television  screen 
while  she  was  surfing  channels.  The  following 
year,  one  appeared  for  about  five  minutes  be¬ 
fore  disappearing  without  communicating. 

One  day  in  July  1998,  she  lay  down  to  rest 
when  instantly  she  found  herself  transported 
to  an  underground  kingdom.  The  ruler,  who 
was  standing  in  front  of  her,  initiated  a  con¬ 
versation,  during  which  he  told  her  that  origi¬ 
nally  the  reptilian  race  had  been  dinosaurs. 
Over  time  they  evolved  into  smaller  creatures, 
though  their  eating  habits — they  were  herbi¬ 
vores — had  not  changed.  Now  they  wanted  to 
return  to  the  surface  (“top  side,”  he  called  it) 
and  reclaim  their  rightful  roles  as  rulers  of 
Earth.  J  oy  explained  that  no  single  individual 
rules  the  surface,  that  there  are  many  nations 
and  many  leaders. 

When  she  inquired  as  to  his  name,  he 
replied  that  her  tongue  would  not  be  able  to 
pronounce  it.  He  suggested  that  she  make  up 
a  name  with  which  she  felt  comfortable.  She 
decided  to  call  him  “Leo,”  telling  him  that 
“Leo”  means  “king.”  From  then  on,  she  ad¬ 
dressed  him  as  King  Leo. 

King  Leo  wanted  to  know  what  love  feels 
like,  since  he  and  his  people  had  no  emo¬ 
tions — though  such  feelings  are  just  now 
starting  to  evolve  in  them.  They  have  a  reli¬ 
gion;  they  recognize  the  same  Creator  as  sur¬ 
face  humans  do. 

Joy  met  him  again  on  August  14,  1999, 
when  she  was  taken  into  the  kingdom  again. 
Leo  told  her  that  some  of  his  subjects  would 


Kuran  145 


like  to  live  on  the  top  again,  though  most 
would  be  staying  behind.  Those  who  wanted 
to  go  to  the  surface,  however,  were  concerned 
that  human  beings  would  not  accept  their  ap¬ 
pearance.  He  told  her  that  at  present  one  and 
a  half  million  reptilians  live  beneath  the  earth. 
According  to  Joyce’s  friend  Elliemiser,  “He  is 
very  congenial,  likable  and  pleasant  to  com¬ 
municate  with.  .  .  .  Now  they  are  waiting  to 
find  out  what  our  response  will  be.  .  .  .  They 
will  not  just  suddenly  pop  up  and  frighten  us” 
(“The  Reptilians,”  1999). 

King  Leo’s  reptilians  are  not  to  be  confused 
with  evil  reptoids  who  are  coming  to  Earth 
from  the  Draco  constellation.  These  beings 
are  violent  meat-eaters  who  seek  to  destroy 
humans  with  their  advanced  technology.  The 
reptilians,  on  the  other  hand,  do  not  have 
space  travel,  and  their  technology,  while  de¬ 
veloping,  is  still  relatively  primitive. 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Reptoids 

Further  Reading 

D’Light,  Joy,  and  Elliemiser,  1999.  “The  Reptilians 
and  King  Leo.”  http://www.greatdreams.com/ 
reptlan/repleo.htm 


Korton 

Commander  Korton  is  a  well-loved,  ubiqui¬ 
tous  channeling  entity.  He  is  also  a  leading 
light  in  the  Ashtar  Command,  a  close,  trusted 
associate  of  Ashtar.  According  to  a  common 
belief,  he  heads  the  Ashtar  Command  Kor 
Communications  Base,  located  in  an  other¬ 
dimensional  correlate  to  the  planet  Mars.  His 
task  is  to  initiate  contact  with  budding  chan- 
nelers  and  train  them  for  their  work.  He  also 
supervises  the  Eagles,  extraterrestrials  who  live 
on  Earth  and  pass  as  earthlings  while  per¬ 
forming  missions  for  the  Ashtar  Command. 
Some  contactees  have  reported  boarding  his 
ship  in  out-of-body  states  to  attend  briefings 
in  what  looks  like  a  large  amphitheater. 

One  psychic  who  observed  him  in  the 
course  of  an  interstellar  conference  describes 
him  as  clad  in  a  vanilla-colored  robe.  “His 
eyes  were  deep-set,”  the  observer  reported, 
and  blue  in  color.  “He  had  a  strong  straight 


nose,  slightly  high  cheek  bones,  firm  full 
mouth.  His  hair  was  golden-blond  .  .  .  but  his 
beard  was  lighter.  .  .  .  There  was  a  firmness 
with  this  individual,  but  there  was  also  a  great 
deal  of  warmth  vibration  also — the  warmth  of 
love,  of  acceptance,  of  ‘you’re  o.k.’”(Tuieta, 
1986). 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Channeling;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Tuella  [pseudonym  ofThelma  B.  Turrell],  ed.,  1989. 
Ashtar:  A  Tribute.  Third  edition.  Salt  Lake  City, 
UT:  Guardian  Action  Publications. 

Tuieta,  1986.  Project  Alert.  Fort  Wayne,  IN:  Portals 
of  Light. 

Kronin 

On  July  26,  1967,  near  Big  Tujunga  Canyon 
in  California,  a  man  and  a  woman  in  a  car 
heard  a  disembodied  voice  speaking.  It  alerted 
them  to  the  imminent  appearance  of  some¬ 
thing  out  of  the  ordinary.  They  spotted  a 
flash,  then  a  disc-shaped  UFO  that  landed 
nearby.  A  tall,  boneless,  eyeless  figure 
emerged.  He  was,  he  said,  Kronin,  head  of  the 
Kronian  race.  He  was  also  “a  space  robot  en¬ 
cased  in  a  time  capsule”  (Keel,  1975). 

When  she  arrived  home,  the  woman,  Maris 
DeLong,  took  a  phone  call.  It  was  from  Kro¬ 
nin,  the  first  of  several  in  which  he  discussed 
cosmic  matters. 

Further  Reading 

Keel,  John  A.,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New 
York:  Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and 
Company. 

Kuran 

Kuran  are  a  race  of  people  whom  an 
actress/writer  given  the  pseudonym  “Jessica 
Rolfe”  claims  to  have  met  over  a  period  of 
years,  beginning  in  her  childhood.  The 
Kuran,  who  are  described  as  beautiful, 
tanned,  golden-haired  people  who  look 
human,  would  materialize  in  her  Miami 
Beach,  Florida,  bedroom  and  teach  her  their 
secrets.  The  Kuran  communicate  telepathi- 
cally,  though  they  do  make  vocal  sounds  for  a 
few  simple  sentiments  such  as  “look  there,” 


146  Kurmos 


“watch  out,”  and  “wow.”  They  are  among 
twelve  alien  races  who  have  visited  Earth. 
They  have  bases  here,  some  off  the  coasts  of 
Florida  and  Argentina,  one  in  Brazil’s  Amazon 
basin,  and  they  have  lived  in  them,  unknown 
to  human  beings,  for  millions  of  years.  They 
still  do  not  understand  humanity’s  tendency 
to  be  violent  and  prejudiced. 

The  Kuran  told  Rolfe  that  the  human  race 
originally  occupied  a  planet  located  between 
Mars  and  Jupiter.  They  visited  this  planet  just 
before  natural  forces  were  set  to  destroy  it,  of¬ 
fering  to  remove  the  inhabitants  to  a  suitable 
place  if  they  agreed  to  live  by  Kuran  law.  The 
inhabitants  refused,  and  the  Kuran  withdrew. 
The  residents  of  the  doomed  planet  managed 
to  escape  on  their  own.  Some  went  to  a 
planet  in  the  constellation  of  Pegasus,  and  the 
other,  to  the  Kuran’s  displeasure,  colonized 
Earth  and  became  our  ancestors.  Earth 
proved  an  inhospitable  place,  not  sufficiently 
evolved  to  have  achieved  the  cosmic  har¬ 
monies  that  give  rise  to  peaceable,  well- 
adjusted  races.  The  new  colonists,  moreover, 
interfered  with  Earth’s  ecology,  forcing  its 
previous,  reigning,  intelligent  species  from 
the  land  into  the  oceans;  humans  now  know 
these  beings  as  dolphins.  Other  alien  races 
who  arrived  were  driven  off  or  forced  to  live 
in  remote  regions.  The  creatures  humans  call 
Bigfoot  or  Sasquatch  originally  came  from 
outer  space. 

Over  time,  the  new  inhabitants  forgot 
their  cosmic  heritage  and  their  true  history. 
Earth’s  surface,  once  a  single  land  mass  sur¬ 
rounded  by  ocean  (and  recalled  vaguely  as  the 
lost  continent  of  Mu),  broke  up,  and  the  peo¬ 
ple  were  scattered.  Cut  off  from  one  another, 
they  developed  different  cultures  and  differ¬ 
ent  languages.  Only  an  elite  group  called  the 
Magi  preserved  knowledge  of  the  true  past. 
Each  harbored  ambitions  for  himself  and  col¬ 
lected  followers.  They  used  their  knowledge 
to  abuse  Earth’s  natural  energies  and  to  har¬ 
ness  atoms  for  destructive  purposes.  Dis¬ 
turbed  by  these  developments,  the  Kuran  re¬ 
turned  to  Earth  and  tried  to  reform  its 


inhabitants.  With  their  followers,  they  con¬ 
structed  the  paradisiacal  land  of  Atlantis, 
only  to  have  the  Magi  destroy  it  with  atomic 
bombs.  The  nuclear  explosions  changed 
Earth’s  landscape  and  climate  and  created  the 
continents  we  know  today. 

Even  today  a  secret  conflict  continues  be¬ 
tween  the  Kuran  and  the  Magi.  On  occasion 
the  Kuran  have  tried  to  interfere  in  human  af¬ 
fairs,  each  time  with  negative  results.  Myths 
and  legends  of  the  gods  of  the  ancient  world 
recount,  in  distorted  form,  previous  Kuran  ef¬ 
forts  to  lead  us. 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Lemuria 

Further  Reading 

Gansberg,  Judith  M.,  and  Alan  L.  Gansberg,  1980. 
Direct  Encounters:  Personal  Histories  of  UFO  Ab  - 
ductees.  New  York:  Walker  and  Company. 

Kurmos 

In  March  1966,  a  mystically  inclined  Scots¬ 
man  named  R.  Ogilvie  (“Roc”)  Crombie,  vis¬ 
iting  Edinburgh’s  Royal  Botanic  Gardens, 
spotted  a  creature  that  looked  half  human  and 
half  animal.  Three  feet  tall,  it  had  cloven 
hoofs.  It  told  Crombie  that  its  name  was  Kur¬ 
mos.  It  was  a  nature  spirit  that  helped  trees  to 
grow. 

Kurmos  accompanied  Crombie  back  to  his 
apartment,  where  it  stayed  for  a  short  time. 
On  a  subsequent  trip  to  the  garden,  Crombie 
called  out  to  him,  and  Kurmos  appeared.  He 
learned  that  in  earlier  ages  Kurmos  had  been 
the  god  Pan. 

Further  Reading 

Ash,  David,  and  Peter  Hewitt,  1990.  Science  of  the 
Gods.  Bath,  England:  Gateway  Books. 

Kwan  Ti  Laslo 

Kwan  Ti  Laslo  channels  from  the  Blue  Dia¬ 
mond  Planet.  This  planet  is  not  in  orbit 
around  a  sun  (as  planets  are  virtually  by  defi¬ 
nition)  but  rather  is  a  sort  of  giant  spacecraft 
that  travels  all  over  the  universe  investigating 
conditions  there.  The  planet/spacecraft  re¬ 
ports  its  findings  to  the  Intergalactic  Council. 


Kwan  Ti  Laslo  147 


In  the  mid-1970s,  it  made  a  brief  visit  to 
Earths  vicinity.  Earthly  astronomers  mistook 
the  spacecraft  for  a  comet. 

Certain  advanced  human  beings — Kwan  Ti 
Laslo  mentioned  former  presidents  Harry 
Truman  and  John  F.  Kennedy  specifically — 
are  allowed  to  come  to  the  Blue  Diamond 
Planet  and  live  there.  The  planet  gives  off  blue 


light  from  its  many  waterways  and  temperate 
climate.  There  is  no  environmental  pollution. 
“All  highly  evolved  planets  have  almost  in¬ 
stantaneous  cleansing  of  air  and  waters,” 
Kwan  Ti  Laslo  explains. 

Further  Reading 

“The  Blue  Diamond  Planet,”  1976.  Other  World  Life 
Review  1,  9  (November):  7. 


Laan-Deeka  and  Sharanna 

In  February  or  early  March  1967  a  Puerto 
Rican  man  named  Lester  Rosas  received  sev¬ 
eral  telepathic  messages  from  two  Venusians, 
Laan-Deeka  and  Sharanna.  They  promised 
that  they  would  meet  with  him  face-to-face 
one  day  soon. 

On  the  evening  of  March  3 1 ,  acting  under 
a  strange  compulsion,  Rosas  boarded  a  bus 
and  took  it  to  the  end  of  the  line,  which  hap¬ 
pened  to  be  along  a  coastal  area.  He  kept 
walking  until  he  reached  a  deserted  part  of  the 
beach.  By  then  it  was  pitch  black,  and  he  was 
unsure  about  what  he  was  doing  there  and  for 
what,  or  for  whom,  he  was  waiting.  Then  he 
felt  an  odd  sensation  as  a  man  who  had  shoul¬ 
der-length  hair  and  was  dressed  in  a  close-fit¬ 
ting  garment  approached  him.  The  man  ex¬ 
tended  his  hand,  but  when  Rosas  tried  to 
shake  his  hand,  the  stranger  withdrew  it  after 
a  mild  pressing  of  palms.  He  said  in  Spanish, 
“Yes,  beloved  Earth  brother,  I  am  Laan- 
Deeka,  of  the  planet  Venus.”  He  went  on  to 
state  that  Venusians  had  been  keeping  human 
beings  under  surveillance  since  their  primitive 
origins  and  had  also  been  living,  unnoticed, 
among  them. 

Laan-Deeka  then  commenced  to  discuss 
reincarnation,  saying  that  advanced  earthlings 
who  obey  nature’s  laws  are  permitted  to  live 


their  next  lives  on  spiritually  developed  plan¬ 
ets.  In  the  universe,  he  said,  most  communi¬ 
cation,  even  interplanetary  and  interstellar 
communication,  occurs  by  telepathy.  Human 
beings  are  backward,  in  part,  because  they  fail 
to  realize  that  telepathy  is  even  possible. 

The  Venusian  led  Rosas  to  the  other  side  of 
a  small  nearby  wall,  where  they  witnessed  the 
materialization  of  a  flying  saucer.  A  door  slid 
open,  and  a  woman  emerged  to  engage  Rosas 
in  a  palm-to-palm  Venusian  handshake.  “She 
was  so  lovely  that  I  was  speechless  for  a  mo¬ 
ment,”  Rosas  recalled.  “Her  hair  was  long  and 
fair,  and  she  had  a  fantastic  figure. ...  I  esti¬ 
mated  her  measurements  at  5'4"  and  37-27- 
35.”  She  introduced  herself  to  Rosas  as  Sha¬ 
ranna,  Laan-Deeka’s  fiancee. 

Though  the  couple  looked  to  be  no  more 
than  twenty  years  old,  their  manner  suggested 
wiser,  older  persons.  They  had  high  foreheads 
and  slightly  slanted  eyes,  his  green,  hers  blue. 
There  was  a  musical  sound  to  their  voices,  a 
sense  of  joy  in  their  speech  and  action. 

The  three  entered  the  ship  and  flew  off  to 
Venus,  which  proved  to  be  the  paradisiacal 
world  reported  by  other  contactees.  On  their 
way  to  the  planet,  Sharanna  condemned  the 
war  in  Vietnam  as  “senseless  and  stupid — as 
are  all  wars.”  She  also  criticized  those  who  re¬ 
fused  to  believe  contact  stories.  If  contactees’ 


149 


150  Lady  of  Pluto 


reports  “are  sometimes  contradictory,”  she 
said,  “it  is  with  good  reason.  Your  Earth  people 
are  contacting  space  people  from  different 
planets  and  different  cultures,  in  different 
stages  of  advancement. .  .  .  Therefore  the  re¬ 
ports  could  hardly  be  the  same”  (Rosas,  1976). 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Rosas,  Lester,  1976.  “Visits  from  Venus.”  Other 
World  Life  Review  Pt.  I.  1,  8  (October):  4-5;  Pt. 
II.  1,  9  (December):  3-4. 


Lady  of  Pluto 

Kelvin  Rowe,  an  acquaintance  of  such  early 
contactees  as  George  Adamski  and  Truman 
Bethurum,  began  hearing  voices  in  his  head  in 
early  1953.  The  voices  were  mostly  indistinct, 
and  he  was  unsure  of  their  meaning.  On 
March  9,  1954,  while  driving  to  San 

Bernardino,  California,  the  word  “Pluto” 
sounded  inside  his  brain  three  times  in  succes¬ 
sion.  Later  that  month,  after  further  brief 
messages  from  beings  he  identified  as 
Guardians  from  Space,  he  requested  a  direct, 
in-person  meeting.  A  voice  replied  that  one 
would  happen,  but  he  might  not  recognize  it 
when  it  did. 

At  the  Giant  Rock  Interplanetary  Space¬ 
craft  Convention  in  the  California  desert  the 
following  year  on  April  4,  he  kept  company 
with  Truman  Bethurum,  whom  he  had 
known  four  years  before  Bethurum  began 
claiming  an  association  with  the  spacewoman 
Aura  Rhanes  of  Clarion.  He  met  three  young 
people,  a  woman  and  two  men,  who  looked 
normal  and  were  friendly.  It  was  only  later 
that  Rowe  realized  that  they  had  said  some¬ 
thing  to  him  that  they  could  not  have  known 
about  an  earlier  trip  he  had  taken  to  see 
Bethurum.  Rowe  wondered  if  they  had  been 
space  people,  and  soon  a  mental  message  con¬ 
firmed  that  they  had  been.  The  message  was 
from  the  young  woman,  whom  he  would  call 
the  Lady  of  Pluto. 

In  a  1958  book,  Rowe  recounted  the  con¬ 
versation  that  followed.  The  Lady  of  Pluto 
told  him  that  contact  with  space  people 


would  radically  alter  earthling  science  and  hu¬ 
mankind’s  beliefs  on  a  range  of  issues.  She  also 
said  that  earthwomen  would  be  more  recep¬ 
tive  than  earthmen,  that  by  the  time  the  open 
contact  occurred,  women  would  hold  posi¬ 
tions  of  authority  in  business  and  govern¬ 
ment.  Their  influence  would  ensure  that  the 
changes  took  place  without  undue  conflict 
and  destruction.  She  promised  that  in  time, 
when  he  was  ready,  he  would  be  permitted  to 
board  a  spacecraft. 

Mental  communication  with  various  space 
people  continued  over  the  next  months.  Even¬ 
tually,  a  spaceman  came  to  Rowe’s  house  late 
one  evening.  The  two  had  a  short  conversa¬ 
tion  via  telepathy  before  the  extraterrestrial 
disappeared  into  the  night.  Soon  Rowe  was 
regularly  seeing  flying-saucer  people.  A  week 
after  the  first  meeting,  the  same  Space  Brother 
and  a  companion  reappeared  at  his  door.  He 
invited  them  in  for  a  conversation  about  cos¬ 
mic  and  philosophical  issues.  According  to 
Rowe,  “They  were  fine  looking  men,  with 
smooth,  dark  sun-tan  complexions,  and  dark 
hair  styled  in  longer  length  than  our  modern 
cuts”  (Rowe,  1958).  Three  weeks  of  saucer 
sightings  and  psychic  contacts  took  place.  The 
communicators  were  a  man  and  woman  from 
Jupiter:  the  Brother  and  Sister,  Rowe  called 
them.  He  unexpectedly  met  them  in  the  flesh 
for  a  short  while. 

His  next  contact,  a  few  weeks  later  in  Janu¬ 
ary  1955,  was  with  the  Lady  of  Pluto,  the  first 
time  he  had  seen  her  since  Giant  Rock.  She 
was  accompanied  by  a  Space  Brother,  and 
Rowe  described  her  as  “mettlesome  and 
lovely.”  She  stood  five  feet  three  inches  tall, 
wore  a  blouse,  jacket,  and  slacks  “in  contrast¬ 
ing  tones  of  a  beautiful,  pansy-blue,  similar  to 
royal  blue,  and  a  shade  of  red-wine  in  a  scin¬ 
tillating,  deep  intensity.”  He  was  told  that  she 
was  the  earthly  equivalent  of  a  captain  on  a 
spacecraft.  She  also  said  that  an  asteroid  was 
passing  dangerously  close  to  Earth  but  that 
the  space  people  would  make  sure  it  did  not 
cause  damage. 

Some  weeks  later,  Rowe  met  the  Lady  of 
Pluto  again,  in  the  company  of  the  Brother 


Land  beyond  the  Pole  151 


and  Sister  of  Jupiter.  On  this  occasion  he  was 
finally  permitted  to  board  a  landed  ship  for  a 
few  minutes.  In  due  course,  Rowe  would  fly, 
more  than  once,  into  space  onboard  space¬ 
craft,  sometimes  with  the  Lady  of  Pluto,  more 
often  with  the  Sister  of  Jupiter.  “Some  there 
are  who  believe  UFO’s  are  the  greatest  mys¬ 
tery  of  our  century,”  Rowe  wrote.  “I  only 
hope  I  have  made  it  clear  that  there  is  no  mys¬ 
tery  connected  with  them.” 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Aura  Rhanes;  Bethu- 
rum,  Truman;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Rowe,  Kelvin,  1958 .A  Call  at  Dawn:  A  Message  from 
Our  Brothers  of  the  Planets  Pluto  and  Jupiter.  El 
Monte,  CA:  Understanding  Publishing  Com¬ 
pany. 

Land  beyond  the  Pole 

According  to  F.  Amadeo  Giannini,  author  of 
Worlds  beyond  the  Poles  (1959),  Admiral 
Richard  E.  Byrd  discovered  a  marvelous  new 
land  when  he  flew  1,700  miles  beyond  the 
North  Pole  during  an  expedition  in  1947.  Fie 
saw  ice-free  lakes,  mountains,  and  forests.  Fie 
even  caught  a  glimpse  of  an  enormous  animal 
walking  through  the  underbrush.  In  1956,  on 
a  second  expedition  to  the  Arctic,  he  wit¬ 
nessed  similar  sights.  Giannini  claimed  that 
the  U.S.  government  had  sworn  Byrd  to  si¬ 
lence  after  he  first  hinted  of  his  discoveries  in 
his  1 947  interviews  with  the  New  York  Times. 

Giannini,  characterized  as  the  “archetypal 
crank”  by  one  critic  (Kafton-Minkel,  1989), 
believed  that  Byrd’s  alleged  experience  verified 
his — Giannini’s — belief  that  the  Earth  is  not 
round  but  more  or  less  spindle-shaped;  at 
each  spindle  point  the  surface,  instead  of  end¬ 
ing,  curves  back  overhead.  The  universe  con¬ 
sists  not  of  space  but  of  vast  land,  “physical 
continuity”  he  called  it.  What  appear  to  hu¬ 
mans  as  stars,  planets,  galaxies,  and  other  phe¬ 
nomena  in  the  distant  cosmos  are  only  “glob¬ 
ular  and  isolated  areas  of  a  continuous  and 
unbroken  outer  sky  surface.”  FFis  original  in¬ 
spiration,  he  wrote,  was  a  mystical  vision  he 
experienced  while  strolling  through  a  New 
England  forest  one  day  in  1926. 


Published  as  a  vanity-press  (that  is,  at  the 
author’s  expense)  book,  Worlds  beyond  the 
Poles  would  have  passed  quickly  into  oblivion 
if  not  for  the  fact  that  Ray  Palmer,  editor  of 
Flying  Saucers  and  promoter  of  the  Shaver 
Mystery,  read  the  book  after  receiving  a  review 
copy.  Always  looking  for  an  issue  to  stir  up  his 
readers,  Palmer  wrote  of  Byrd’s  supposed  se¬ 
cret  flight  to  argue  that  the  Earth  is  hollow 
with  giant  holes  at  the  poles.  Anyone  entering 
the  holes  will  encounter  a  hidden  world  har¬ 
boring  an  intelligent  civilization  that  builds 
and  flies  superaircraft  that  are  called  UFOs. 
Palmer  got  the  Byrd  story  from  Giannini  but 
did  not  mention  him,  claiming  that  he  had 
gotten  his  information  from  “years  of  re¬ 
search”  (Palmer,  1959).  A  number  of  readers 
pointed  out  that  the  New  York  Times  stories 
about  Byrd’s  expedition  did  not  quote  him  as 
saying  anything  about  forests  or  a  giant  beast; 
even  worse,  in  1947  and  1956,  Byrd  was  at 
the  South,  not  the  North,  Pole.  Palmer  was 
forced  to  acknowledge  that  his  sole  source  was 
Giannini.  Unapologetic,  he  went  on  to  specu¬ 
late  that  perhaps  Byrd  had  made  a  secret  flight 
to  the  Arctic  in  1947;  either  that,  or  “a  delib¬ 
erate  effort  was  being  made  to  build  an  edifice 
which  could  be  toppled  IF  AND  WFFEN  THE 
TRUTH  CAME  OUT  ABOUT  THE  SOUTH 
POLE!”  (Palmer,  I960).  And  if  neither  of 
these  were  true,  the  question  of  which  pole 
Byrd  had  flown  over  was  moot  since  Byrd  had 
encountered  a  lush,  green  landscape  where 
none  should  have  existed  and  that,  in  the  end, 
was  all  that  mattered — notwithstanding  the 
nonexistence  of  any  documentation  that  Byrd 
had  made  any  such  claim  in  the  first  place. 
Giannini  soon  weighed  in  to  attack  Palmer’s 
hollow  earth  interpretation  and  to  argue  for  a 
secret  Arctic  expedition  by  Byrd  in  1947, 
which  was  followed  by  a  suppression  of  his 
discoveries. 

In  the  1970s,  a  Missouri-based  organiza¬ 
tion  called  the  International  Society  for  a 
Complete  Earth,  headed  by  retired  marine 
corps  officer  Tawani  Shoush,  who  was  also  a 
Modoc  Indian,  issued  what  it  claimed  was  a 
secret  diary  that  Byrd  kept  during  his  1947 


152 


I  >  JUNE,  II 370  •  -  -  I  .in  r  Nd  K4 

p"KO  75* 


MVST€RrES«F  THE  SPACE  ACE 


FIRST  PHOTOS  OF  THE  HOLE  AT  THE  ROLF  ! 
Satellites  ESSA  -  3  and  ESSA  -7  Penetrate  Cloud  Cover’ 
Mariners  Also  Photograph  Martian  Polar  Opening] 


Cover  of  Flying  Saucers  magazine,  June  1970,  with  a  November  1968  satellite  photo  allegedly  showing  the  hole  in  the 
North  Pole  leading  to  the  interior  of  hollow  earth  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Lanello  153 


North  Pole  expedition.  Written  in  an  ama¬ 
teurish,  pulpy  style,  strikingly  unlike  the  eru¬ 
dite  prose  found  in  Byrd’s  undisputed  pub¬ 
lished  works,  the  diary  has  Byrd  and  his  radio 
operator  passing  over  a  green  landscape  and 
spotting  a  “mammoth,”  while  the  temperature 
rises  to  seventy-four  degrees.  Soon  the  two 
men  spot  three  flying  saucers  with  swastika  in¬ 
signias  (perhaps  not  coincidentally,  Shoush’s 
group  held  that  the  inner-earthers,  a  Teutonic 
race  known  as  the  Arianni,  favor  the 
swastika).  The  saucers  take  control  of  Byrd’s 
plane  and  lead  it  to  a  city  “pulsating  with  rain¬ 
bow  hues  of  color.”  There  they  meet  the  Ari¬ 
anni  and  engage  in  conversation  with  an  aged, 
wise  man  known  as  the  Master.  The  Master 
warns  that  human  beings  are  insufficiently  ad¬ 
vanced  to  be  fooling  with  something  as  dan¬ 
gerous  as  atomic  energy.  The  diary’s  last  entry, 
supposedly  written  shortly  before  Byrd’s  death 
in  1957,  says,  “I  have  faithfully  kept  this  mat¬ 
ter  secret  as  directed  all  these  years.  It  has  been 
completely  against  my  values  of  moral  right.” 

Though  unsupported  by  any  evidence,  the 
story  of  Byrd’s  flight  beyond  the  pole  became  a 
staple  of  hollow-earth  literature.  As  late  as 
1993,  Timothy  Green  Beckley  was  asking, 
“Was  it  because  of  Admiral  Byrd’s  weird  flight 
into  an  unknown  Polar  land  in  1947  that  the 
International  Geophysical  Year  was  conceived 
in  that  year,  and  finally  brought  to  fruition  ten 
years  later,  and  is  actually  still  going  on?  Did 
his  flight  make  it  suddenly  imperative  to  dis¬ 
cover  the  real  nature  of  this  planet  we  live  on, 
and  solve  the  tremendous  mysteries  that  unex¬ 
pectedly  confronted  us?”  (Beckley,  1993). 

Dennis  G.  Crenshaw,  editor  of  The  Hollow 
Earth  Insider  Research  Report,  expresses  a  view 
that  is  at  once  skeptical  and  conspiratorial.  He 
notes  that  when  the  diary  quotes  some  of  the 
Master’s  words,  those  words  bear  an  unset¬ 
tling  resemblance  to  those  spoken  by  the 
Dalai  Lama  of  Shangri-La  in  the  classic  1937 
film  Lost  Horizon.  He  also  bluntly  charges  that 
Tawani  Shoush  and  his  group  forged  the 
diary.  Nonetheless,  he  sees  a  sinister  hand  in 
all  of  this.  Byrd’s  polar  expeditions  were  in  the 
service  of  the  “paymasters”  of  the  “Illuminati 


and ...  a  New  World  Order  .  .  .  John  D. 
Rocherfeller  [sic]  and  his  pals.”  Moreover,  Gi- 
annini  himself  consciously  served  the  conspir¬ 
acy.  From  uncertain  evidence,  Crenshaw  con¬ 
cludes  that  Giannini’s  family  “ owned  the  Bank 
of  Italy  and  the  Bank  of  America.”  He  goes 
on,  “If,  as  my  research  seems  to  indicate,  it  is 
the  One  Worlders’  plan  to  hide  what  is  going 
on  at  the  earth’s  poles,  what  better  way  to 
cloud  the  water,  so  to  speak,  than  to  have  one 
of  their  own,  an  admitted  member  of  an  in¬ 
ternational  banking  family,  toss  in  a  contro¬ 
versy — such  as  this  phony  trip  by  Admiral 
Byrd — to  make  hollow  earthers  appear  as 
ridiculous  [?]”  (Crenshaw,  1996). 

See  Also:  Hollow  earth;  Shaver  mystery 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  ed.,  1993.  The  Smoky  God. 
and  Other  Inner  Earth  Mysteries.  New  Brunswick, 
NJ:  Inner  Light  Publications. 

Crenshaw,  Dennis  G.,  1996.  “The  Missing  Diary  of 
Admiral  Byrd:  Fact  or  Fiction?”  The  Hollow  Earth 
Insider  Research  Report  A,  1:  8-15. 

- ,  1997.  “Admiral  Byrd’s  1939  Antarctic  Ex¬ 
pedition  and  the  Mysterious  Snow  Cruiser.”  The 
Hollow  Earth  Insider  Research  Report  4,  2:  4-16. 

A  Flight  to  the  Land  beyond  the  North  Pole,  or  Is  This 
the  Missing  Secret  Diary  of  Admiral  Richard  Evelyn 
Byrd ?  n.d.  Houston,  MO:  International  Society 
for  a  Complete  Earth. 

Giannini,  Amadeo  F.,  1959.  Worlds  beyond  the  Poles. 
New  York:  Vantage  Press. 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
1 00, 000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwarfs,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races,  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

Palmer,  Ray,  1959.  “Saucers  from  Earth!  A  Chal¬ 
lenge  to  Secrecy!”  Flying  Saucers  (December): 
8-21. 

- ,  1960.  “Editorial.”  Flying  Saucers  (Febru¬ 
ary):  4,  29-34. 

- ,  1961.  “‘Byrd  Did  Make  North  Pole  Flight 

in  Feb.,  1947!’ — Giannini.”  Flying  Saucers  (Feb¬ 
ruary):  4—11. 


Lanello 

In  his  most  recent  incarnation  on  Earth, 
Lanello,  an  Ascended  Master,  was  Mark  L. 
Prophet  (1918-1973),  married  to  Elizabeth 
Clare  Prophet  of  rhe  Church  Universal  and 
Triumphant.  Since  then,  as  Lanello,  he  has 


1 54  Laskon 


channeled  through  Prophet  and  Carolyn 
Shearer. 

Lanello  first  came  to  Earth  thousands  of 
years  ago  from  his  native  Venus  after  Sanat 
Kumara — the  brother  of  Sananda  (Jesus)  and 
sometimes  called  Earth’s  planetary  spirit — de¬ 
termined  to  save  the  human  race  from  de¬ 
stroying  itself.  Over  the  centuries  Lanello 
went  through  many  incarnations,  all  in  fulfill¬ 
ment  of  his  earthly  mission.  In  his  lives,  he 
has  been  an  Atlantean  priest,  Noah,  Lot, 
Amenhotep  IV,  Bodhidharma  (founder  of 
Zen  Buddhism),  Aesop,  Pericles,  Mark  the 
Evangelist,  Lancelot,  Saladin,  King  Louis  XIV 
(the  Sun  King),  Hiawatha,  and  Henry 
Wadsworth  Longfellow,  among  others. 

See  Also:  Ascended  Masters;  Sananda 

Further  Reading 

“Ascended  Master  Lanello:  ‘I  Am  Here  and  I  Am 
There!  I  Am  Everywhere  in  the  Consciousness  of 
God!’”  n.d.  http://www.ascension-research.org/ 
lanello.html. 

Laskon 

James  Hill,  who  lived  on  a  farm  near  Sey¬ 
mour,  Missouri,  experienced  numerous  fly¬ 
ing-saucer  sightings  and  contacts  with  their 
occupants,  beginning  in  1940.  The  contacts 
occurred  through  his  radio  or  via  mental 
telepathy.  Eventually,  a  saucer  landed,  and  as 
Hill  watched,  the  crew  let  out  a  large  dog, 
which  went  under  a  tree  and  gave  birth  to 
pups.  Hill  kept  one  of  the  Venusian  pups, 
named  Queenie.  Hill’s  principal  contact  over 
time  was  with  Brother  Laskon,  a  member  of 
the  Solar  Tribunal  on  Saturn. 

According  to  Laskon,  Jesus  is  a  frequent 
space  traveler  who  visits  the  many  inhabited 
planets.  When  he  is  in  our  system,  he  stays  on 
Mars  and  Saturn,  but  most  of  his  time  is  spent 
on  Venus  because  of  its  loveliness.  Laskon  knew 
Bucky,  an  earthman  living  on  Venus  and  the 
frequent  contact  of  another  Missouri  contactee 
(and  friend  of  Hill),  Buck  Nelson.  Laskon  also 
was  able  to  confirm  Chief  Prank  Buck  Standing 
Horse’s  trip  to  the  planet  Oreon  in  the  summer 
of  1959.  Saturn,  which  houses  the  Solar  Tri¬ 
bunal,  is  a  beautiful  planet  where  greatly  ad¬ 


vanced,  spiritually  wise  beings  reside.  The 
twelve  Elder  Ones  who  compose  the  tribunal 
“are  the  names  of  all  of  the  prophets  in  the  bib¬ 
lical  times,”  Laskon  has  said  (Dean,  1964).  Like 
Jesus,  a  senior  member  of  the  tribunal,  they  flew 
to  Earth  in  spaceships,  spent  their  time  here, 
and  then  departed  in  the  same  way.  Moses, 
however,  lives  on  Venus,  where  he  serves  on  the 
Supreme  Council.  John  the  Baptist  returned  to 
Earth  in  the  1950s  and  even  attended  a  con¬ 
tactee  convention  in  Los  Angeles  in  July  1959. 

See  Also:  Andra-o-leeka  and  Mondra-o-leeka;  Con- 
tactees 

Further  Reading 

Dean,  John  W,  1964.  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Scrip  - 
tures.  New  York:  Vantage  Press. 


Lazaris 

Lazaris  first  spoke  to  Jach  Pursel,  a  Plorida  re¬ 
gional  insurance  supervisor  with  no  interest  in 
the  New  Age  or  occult,  after  his  wife,  Peny, 
urged  him  to  meditate  as  a  way  of  easing  job- 
related  stress.  Instead  of  meditating,  Pursel  fell 
asleep.  Soon  an  oddly  accented  voice  was 
speaking  through  him.  Though  startled  and 
even  frightened,  Peny  grabbed  pen  and  paper 
and  started  asking  questions.  The  entity  said 
its  name  was  “Lazaris.” 

The  channeling  continued  for  years  with 
Lazaris  relating  a  philosophy  rather  like  that 
associated  with  other  popular  channeled  enti¬ 
ties  of  the  period,  including  Ramtha  and  Seth. 
In  this  philosophy,  humans  are  evolving  spiri¬ 
tual  beings  who  need  to  gain  access  to  the  di¬ 
vine  intelligence  that  is  within  each  of  them. 

Lazaris  became  hugely  popular,  and  at  the 
peak  of  Lazaris’s  fame  on  the  New  Age  circuit, 
Pursel  was  channeling  as  much  as  forty  hours  a 
week,  with  Peny — from  whom  he  was  now  di¬ 
vorced — and  her  new  husband  managing  the 
business.  Lazaris,  who  always  used  the  plural 
pronoun  when  speaking,  told  writer  Jon  Klimo, 
“We  are  always  in  a  state  of  expansion.  We  have 
no  boundary.  We  have  no  edge  of  who  we  are, 
and  yet  we  know  who  we  are.  We  know  where 
we  begin  and  end,  although  there  is  no 
form. .  .  .  We  have  always  been  and  we  will  al- 


Lemuria  155 


ways  be;  and  therefore,  we  are  always  constantly 
exploring  our  awareness,  gathering  data,  gather¬ 
ing  insight,  gathering  vibration  and  internaliz¬ 
ing  that  vibration.  We  are  always  everywhere 
and  nowhere  simultaneously”  (Klimo,  1987). 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Ramtha;  Seth 
Further  Reading 

Klimo,  Jon,  1987.  Channeling:  Investigations  on  Re  - 
ceiving  Information  from  Paranormal  Sources.  Los 
Angeles:  J.  P.  Tarcher. 

Martin,  Katherine,  1987.  “The  Voice  of  Lazaris.” 

New  Realities  7 ,  6  (July/ August):  26-33. 

Pursel,  Jach,  1987.  Lazaris,  The  Sacred  Journey:  You 
and  Your  Higher  Self.  Beverly  Hills,  CA:  Concept 
Synergy. 

- ,  1988.  Lazaris  Interviews.  Two  volumes. 

Beverly  Hills,  CA:  Concept  Synergy. 

Lemuria 

Lemuria  was  the  invention  of  British  zoolo¬ 
gist  Philip  L.  Schattler,  who  conceived  of  it  as 
an  Indian  Ocean  land  bridge  connecting 


Madagascar  and  extreme  southern  India. 
Schattler,  who  was  researching  animal  popu¬ 
lations,  sought  to  explain  why  these  two 
widely  separated  locations  shared  many  of  the 
same  flora  and  fauna.  (In  the  twentieth  cen¬ 
tury,  continental  drift  theory  rendered  Schat- 
tler’s  hypothesis  obsolete.)  He  called  the  pos¬ 
tulated  land  bridge  “Lemuria,”  after  the 
lemurs,  animals  that  the  two  areas  shared  in 
common.  Before  long,  however,  occultists 
and  mystics  would  incorporate  the  concept  of 
Lemuria — now  conceived  of  as  a  lost  conti¬ 
nent  in  the  Pacific  Ocean — into  their  own  al¬ 
ternative  histories. 

For  a  time,  however,  Lemuria  remained  a 
scientifically  respectable  hypothesis.  One 
major  champion,  German  evolutionary  biolo¬ 
gist  Ernst  Haeckel,  speculated  that  Homo  sapi  - 
ens  originated  on  Lemuria,  though  that  could 
not  be  proved  because  any  remains  had  sunk 
to  the  bottom  of  the  sea  along  with  the  land 


“I  Remember 
Lemuria*” 


By  KiCFlAfll}  EiflAVER 
cud  RAY  PALMES 

nxtx  T-r*™  nas  our  -ua?0«iarj,  'fop 
Aditiu  aasd  Ijkiiu.  Icdl  Lcmi=r='  ihn  mirth, 
1st  >a  n«w  twin*  on  a  duck  warid  In  ipa** 

H  SrtKUTOK  i:« 

PFftHA  I'-i  sir  pjjtcib  etvtt  lulicnJ  the  .=  >  nJi  fc  r"’  fe-' 
rll«d<-  it"  ■e-»pt  il»  y  rti  iictkJ  in-  9--  =  'I-  |- 

6tii«  cr  UiiJir  r^mm  rniT"*"  *  ■  |wi  i 

Ivrr.  ■(  Lnki4t^frrLi;r  Vu  Iikjiw  Ik  >Hiaiii|  rill  Jl  m 
j'iut  np  ptncf)  II*  ibc  lilr  ul  nwlIrT  pHit-n  Ii  :ii  i!r«  1 

in-jTidiliii  hjfil  fi>i  <if  in  ilm.-*:  oimirhr  i  iM  ni  make  pnif  b  wc 

■"tm IW. IrinraMy  I'  pp*  l*i' •  a.--l»ia-  muA 

dip  A.  :r^ulii  riJ  -jp  pt  c'J  !  1  Itt  ■  dv  il>i  n  Ike  t  ■ 

Mbi  4  fluped,  sCel  il?"  IL  <*.■  *  ah  a  nun  |H  4-  * 

■Her  ihuP 


A  science  fiction  novella  about  Lemuria  by  Richard  S.  Shaver  and  Ray  Palmer  in  Amazing  Stories,  March  1945  (Fortean 
Picture  Library) 


156  Lemuria 


bridge.  Others  theorized  that  Lemuria  was 
just  part  of  a  vast  continent,  called  Gond- 
wanaland,  which  had  circled  most  of  the 
Southern  Hemisphere,  leaving  only  a  patch  of 
the  Pacific  Ocean  uncovered.  None  of  the  sci¬ 
entists  argued  that  either  Lemuria  or  Gond- 
wanaland  had  survived  into  historical  time. 

Lemuria  entered  the  occult  tradition 
through  Helene  Petrovna  Blavatsky,  founder 
of  Theosophy.  In  The  Secret  Doctrine  (1889), 
Blavatsky  wrote  that  the  present  human  race 
evolved  through  a  series  of  “root  races.”  The 
third  root  race  lived  on  Lemuria.  These  beings 
had  three  eyes,  one  in  the  back  of  the  head, 
and  were  egg-laying  hermaphrodites  (possess¬ 
ing  attributes  of  both  sexes);  some  had  four 
arms.  Aside  from  these  features,  they  were 
generally  apelike  in  appearance. 

Other  occult  writers  went  on  to  create  their 
own  Lemurians.  Through  “astral  clairvoy¬ 
ance”  the  English  theosophist  W.  Scott-Elliot 
learned  that  it  was  on  Lemuria  that  human 
beings  entered  physical  bodies.  The  original 
Lemurians  were  twelve  to  fifteen  feet  tall,  had 
flat  faces  and  muzzles,  and  no  foreheads. 
Their  eyes  were  set  so  far  apart  that  their  vi¬ 
sion  extended  sideways,  and  they  had  a  third 
eye  behind  their  heads.  Eventually,  these  be¬ 
ings  began  to  practice  sex,  and  the  Lhas,  spirit 
entities  who  were  to  inhabit  the  bodies  and 
guide  them  through  evolution,  were  so  re¬ 
pulsed  that  they  refused  their  duty.  The  Lords 
of  the  Flame,  advanced  Venusians,  took  over 
and  guided  the  Lemurians  into  a  more  human 
and  spiritual  state.  During  the  Mesozoic  era 
Lemuria  began  to  break  up,  and  one  of  its 
peninsulas  became  Atlantis. 

In  the  late  nineteenth  century,  archaeolo¬ 
gist  Augustus  Le  Plongeon,  working  in  the 
Yucatan,  believed  he  had  discovered  how  to 
translate  Mayan  hieroglyphics.  His  transla¬ 
tions,  which  other  scholars  judged  dubious, 
led  him  to  believe  that  he  had  uncovered  evi¬ 
dence  of  a  lost  civilization  known  as  Mu.  He 
assumed  Mu  to  be  Atlantis.  After  his  death, 
however,  his  friend  James  Churchward,  who 
had  inherited  Le  Plungeon’s  papers,  argued 
that  Mu,  “the  motherland  of  man,”  had  been 


in  the  South  Pacific,  not  in  the  Atlantic.  Mu 
housed  a  white  population  of  some  sixty-four 
million  souls  who  had  built  great  cities  and 
worshipped  the  sun.  Mu  sank  beneath  the  sea 
ten  thousand  years  ago.  Churchward  claimed 
to  have  learned  about  Mu  from  tablets  written 
in  the  dead  Naacal  language.  He  had  been 
given  access  to  them,  he  said,  while  serving  in 
India  in  the  Bengal  Lancers.  Churchward 
wrote  about  his  “findings”  in  four  books,  be¬ 
ginning  with  The  Lost  Continent  of  Mu 
(1926).  His  failure  to  produce  any  evidence 
that  the  Naacal  tablets  existed  outside  his 
imagination  sparked  hoax  charges  that 
Churchward  never  successfully  refuted. 

Soon  Mu  and  Lemuria  were  assumed  to  be 
the  same  place,  and  thus  Lemuria  became  a 
Pacific  equivalent  to  the  Atlantic’s  Atlantis.  In 
the  early  years  of  the  twentieth  century,  specu¬ 
lation  grew  that  California  was  a  surviving 
fragment  of  Lemuria.  A  popular  occult  leg¬ 
end,  apparently  originating  in  a  1908  article 
in  The  Overland  Monthly,  held — and  still 
holds — that  a  surviving  Lemurian  colony  lives 
inside  Mount  Shasta,  on  the  California-Ore- 
gon  border.  According  to  Lemuria:  The  Lost 
Continent  of  the  Pacific  (1931),  by  H.  Spencer 
Lewis  (writing  as  Wishar  S.  Cerve),  when 
Lemuria  broke  up,  a  California-sized  part  of  it 
crashed  into  North  Americas  west  coast  and 
attached  itself.  In  1936,  Robert  Stelle  of 
Chicago  founded  the  Lemurian  Fellowship, 
based  on  his  channeled  messages  from 
Lemurians  living  inside  Mount  Shasta.  In  two 
books  published  between  1940  and  1952, 
Stelle  depicted  Lemuria  as  an  enormous  land 
mass  and  a  lost  paradise. 

In  the  mid- 1940s,  the  Ziff-Davis  science- 
fiction  magazines  Amazing  Stories  and  Fantas  - 
tic  Adventures  ran  a  series  of  stories  and  al¬ 
legedly  factual  articles  based  in  part  on 
Richard  S.  Shaver’s  “memories”  of  life  in 
Lemuria,  some  of  whose  inhabitants  still  re¬ 
side  under  the  earth.  Most  have  gone  mad  and 
use  the  advanced  technology  available  to  them 
to  torment  surface-dwellers. 

Lemuria  was  incorporated  into  the  flying 
saucer-based  alternative  realities  proposed  by 


Lethbridge’s  aeronauts  157 


the  contactees  and  channelers  who  came 
along  in  the  late  1940s  and  1950s  amid  popu¬ 
lar  speculation  about  visitation  from  other 
planets.  The  Pacific  lost  continent  played  a 
prominent  role  in  George  Hunt  Williamson’s 
speculative  books  Other  Tongues — Other  Flesh 
(1953),  Secret  Places  of  the  Lion  (1958),  and 
Road  in  the  Sky  (1959),  which  laid  out  an  an¬ 
cient  history  in  which  Lemurians  and  At- 
lanteans  interacted  freely  with  a  variety  of  ex¬ 
traterrestrial  races. 

Now  an  assumed  reality  in  just  about  any 
metaphysical,  New  Age,  hollow  earth,  or 
saucerian  worldview,  Lemuria  sooner  or  later 
enters  just  about  any  discussion  predicated  on 
the  assumption  that  everything  humans  think 
they  know  about  the  ancient  history  of  Earth 
and  the  human  race  is  wrong. 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Contactees;  Hollow  earth;  Mount 
Shasta;  Shaver  mystery;  Williamson,  George 
Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Blavatsky,  Helene  P.,  1889.  The  Secret  Doctrine.  Two 
volumes.  London:  Theosophical  Publishing 
Company. 

Churchward,  James,  1926.  The  Lost  Continent  of 
Mu.  New  York:  Ives  Washburn. 

De  Camp,  L.  Sprague,  1970.  Lost  Continents:  The  At  - 
lantis  Theme  in  History,  Science,  and  Literature. 
New  York:  Dover  Publications. 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
100,000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwafs,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

Scott-Elliot,  W.,  1925.  The  Story  of  Atlantis  and  the 
Lost  Lemuria.  London:  Theosophical  Publishing 
House. 

Shaver,  Richard  S.,  1945.  “I  Remember  Lemuria!” 
Amazing  Stories  19 ,  1  (March):  12-70. 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1953.  Other  Tongues — 
Other  Flesh.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

- ,  1958.  Secret  Places  of  the  Lion.  London: 

Neville  Spearman. 

- ,  1959.  Road  in  the  Sky.  London:  Neville 

Spearman. 

Lethbridge’s  aeronauts 

In  the  spring  of  1909,  the  British  Isles  were 
inundated  with  sightings  of  enigmatic  objects 
that  some  people  called  “airships.”  Popular 
and  official  opinion  concurred  that  German 


spies  were  involved,  though  it  is  now  known 
that  no  such  German  surveillance  was  occur¬ 
ring  or,  for  that  matter,  was  even  technically 
achievable.  One  man  claimed  to  have  seen  an 
airship  land  and  to  have  observed  its  crew. 

Press  accounts  identify  this  witness  as  C. 
Lethbridge,  described  in  a  press  account  as 
“an  elderly  man,  of  quiet  demeanor,  [who] 
did  not  strike  one  as  given  to  romancing.” 
During  the  winter,  Lethbridge  was  a  dock 
worker  in  Cardiff.  In  the  warmer  months,  he 
performed  puppet  shows  in  the  towns  and 
villages  of  Wales.  Around  11  on  the  evening 
of  May  18,  returning  home  across  remote 
Caerphilly  Mountain,  he  rounded  a  bend  at 
the  summit  and  was  taken  aback  to  see  some¬ 
thing  unusual  lying  along  the  side  of  the 
road.  His  first  impression  was  that  it  was 
“some  big  bird.”  Standing  next  to  it  were  two 
tall  men  clad  in  heavy  fur  coats  and  tight-fit¬ 
ting  fur  caps.  Their  bearing  and  smart  ap¬ 
pearance  led  him  to  think  of  them  as  military 
officers.  They  were  working  at  something, 
but  Lethbridge  was  not  close  enough  to  see 
what  it  was. 

When  he  got  within  twenty  to  thirty  yards 
of  them,  they  reacted  to  the  rattle  of  his 
spring-cart  and  jumped  up  as  if  startled.  They 
“jabbered  furiously  to  each  other  in  a  strange 
lingo — Welsh  or  something  else;  it  was  cer¬ 
tainly  not  English.”  Retrieving  something  on 
the  ground,  they  ran  to  a  carriage  underneath 
the  object,  which  then  ascended  in  a  zigzag 
motion.  Two  lights  on  its  side  suddenly  came 
on.  Emitting  an  “awful  noise,”  the  craft  flew 
higher  and  set  off  in  the  direction  of  Cardiff. 

After  Lethbridge  told  his  story  in  that  city, 
investigators  rushed  to  the  site.  If  not  for  that 
circumstance,  the  episode  would  have  the  ap¬ 
pearance  of  an  early  close  encounter  of  the 
third  kind.  Indeed,  it  is  published  in  some 
UPO  literature  as  just  that.  Most  accounts 
leave  out  what  the  investigators  found  at  the 
site:  a  variety  of  artifacts  including  parts  of  let¬ 
ters,  a  spare  part  for  a  tire  valve,  papier-mache 
wads,  blue  paper  containing  figures  and  let¬ 
ters,  and  clippings  about  airships.  All  of  this 
suggests,  or  at  least  seems  intended  to  convey, 


158  Li  Sung 


the  notion  that  the  airship  crew  consisted  of 
foreign  spies. 

Though  nothing  is  known  about  the  inci¬ 
dent  beyond  what  appears  in  Welsh  and  En¬ 
glish  newspapers  of  the  period,  the  story 
seems  suspect.  The  first  chronicler  of  the 
UFO  phenomenon,  Charles  Fort,  remarked 
that  “anybody  else  [who]  wants  to  think  that 
these  foreigners  were  explorers  from  Mars  or 
the  moon”  (Fort,  1941)  was  free  to  do  so,  but 
he  himself  suspected  a  hoax.  Because  no  for¬ 
eign  spies  were  engaged  in  aerial  surveillance 
of  Britain  in  1909,  it  is  hard  to  imagine  an¬ 
other  explanation. 

Coincidentally  or  otherwise,  during  a  wave 
of  UFO  reports  in  France  in  the  fall  of  1954, 
a  railroad  worker  at  Monlucon  claimed  that 
one  evening  he  encountered  a  tube-shaped 
craft.  Outside  it  stood  a  man  dressed  in  what 
looked  like  a  long,  hairy  overcoat.  When  the 
witness  addressed  the  figure,  the  latter  re¬ 
sponded  in  an  unknown  language.  The  wit¬ 
ness  left  the  scene  to  report  it  to  his  supervi¬ 
sor,  but  when  the  two  returned,  the  UFO  and 
the  hairy-coated  figure  were  gone. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 

Further  Reading 

Fort,  Charles,  1941.  The  Books  of  Charles  Fort.  New 
York:  Henry  Holt  and  Company. 

Grove,  Carl,  1971.  “The  Airship  Wave  of  1909.” 
Flying  Saucer  Review  17,  1  (January/February): 
17-19. 

Vallee,  Jacques,  1974.  “The  Pattern  behind  the  UFO 
Landings.”  In  Charles  Bowen,  ed.  The  Hu  - 
manoids,  27-76.  London:  Futura  Publications. 


Li  Sung 

Li  Sung,  said  to  be  the  spirit  of  a  village 
philosopher  who  lived  in  northern  China  in 
the  eighth  century,  channeled  through  Alan 
Vaughan.  Vaughan,  a  longtime  writer  on  psy¬ 
chic  phenomena,  first  experienced  Li  Sung  in 
1983,  but  sixteen  years  earlier,  three  British 
mediums  had  told  him  he  would  be  commu¬ 
nicating  with  this  Chinese  spirit.  Vaughan 
said  he  did  not  believe  them.  But  one  day, 
while  he  was  teaching  at  a  psychic  seminar  in 
Sedona,  Arizona,  a  couple  asked  him — he  was 


then  editing  a  publication  called  Reincarna  - 
tion  Report — if  he  could  divine  their  past  lives. 

“Suddenly  a  tremendous  energy  flooded 
over  the  top  of  my  head,”  he  would  recall.  “It 
was  like  watching  a  dream,  as  the  Chinese  en¬ 
tity  Li  Sung  began  to  speak  through  me.  He 
gave  them  some  detailed  information  about 
past  lives  and  how  they  fit  into  their  present  life 
paths.  For  me,  it  was  the  beginning  of  an  en¬ 
largement  of  consciousness”  (Shepard,  1991). 

Vaughan  went  on  to  channel  Li  Sung  in 
public  on  many  occasions.  Vaughan  contends 
that  anyone  can  channel  if  he  or  she  wants  to. 
It  is,  he  asserts,  as  easy  as  learning  how  to 
whistle. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Klimo,  Jon,  1987.  Channeling:  Investigations  on  Re  - 
ceiving  Information  from  Paranormal  Sources.  Los 
Angeles:  Jeremy  P  Tarcher. 

Shepard,  Leslie  A.,  1991.  Encyclopedia  of  Occultism 
and  Parapsychology:  A  Compendium  of  Informa  - 
tion  on  the  Occidt  Sciences,  Magic,  Demonology, 
Superstitions,  Spiritism,  Mysticism,  Metaphysics, 
Psychical  Science,  and  Parapsychology,  with  Bio  - 
graphical  and  Bibliographical  Notes  and  Compre  - 
hensive  Indexes.  Third  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale 
Research. 

Linn-Erri 

Linn-Erri  introduced  herself  to  Robert  P.  Re- 
naud  one  night  in  July  1961.  A  Pittsfield, 
Massachusetts,  ham-radio  buff  and  General 
Electric  technician,  Renaud  heard  beeping 
sounds  from  his  radio  and  then  heard  a  lovely 
female  voice  asking  him  to  stay  on  the  fre¬ 
quency  for  a  while.  She  told  him,  “I  am  called 
Linn-Erri,  and  my  associates  and  I  come  from 
the  planet  Korendor.  We  are  speaking  to  you 
from  our  spaceship  many  miles  above  your 
earth”  (Clark,  1986).  She  and  her  fellow  Ko- 
rendorians  had  chosen  to  contact  him  because 
they  knew  of  his  interest  in  UFOs,  world 
peace,  and  the  future  of  humankind.  After 
Linn-Erri  introduced  him  to  other  crewmem¬ 
bers,  she  explained  how  Renaud  could  con¬ 
struct  a  transmitter  for  easy  reception  of  fu¬ 
ture  messages  from  space.  Later  that  year,  the 
space  people  helped  him  convert  a  television 


Luno  159 


set  to  receive  their  transmissions.  For  the  first 
time,  he  saw  the  beautiful  Linn-Erri  and  was 
shocked  to  learn  that  she  was  seventy-four 
Earth  years  old. 

In  due  course,  Renaud  was  meeting  per¬ 
sonally  with  the  Korendorians,  riding  in  their 
ships,  and  learning  their  science  and  philoso¬ 
phy,  which  was  essentially  indistinguishable  in 
its  essentials  from  that  widely  recounted  in 
saucerian  literature.  He  stayed  away  from  the 
contactee  lecture  and  convention  circuit  and 
confined  his  public  activities  to  a  series  of  arti¬ 
cles  about  his  alleged  experiences  in  a  meta¬ 
physically  oriented  saucer  magazine.  He  also 
produced  dubious-looking  photographs  of 
supposed  spacecraft. 

To  outward  appearances,  nothing  distin¬ 
guished  Renaud  from  many  others  making 
outlandish  and  not  very  believable  claims. 
Still,  ufologist  Allan  Grise,  an  interested  but 
highly  skeptical  observer  of  the  contactee 
scene,  found  Renaud  a  fascinating  and  enig¬ 
matic  figure.  “If  Renaud  was  engaged  in 
fraud,”  he  said  years  later,  “it  was  preposter¬ 
ous,  unrewarding  fraud.” 

Grise  visited  Renaud  at  his  home  and 
found,  as  the  contactee’s  writings  asserted,  a 
basement  room  full  of  electronic  equipment, 
including  the  television  set  and  the  short-wave 
radio  over  which  the  communications  sup¬ 
posedly  were  effected.  Grise,  an  engineer  by 
profession  and  ham-radio  buff  by  avocation, 
found  that  “everything  seemed  to  make  sense. 
The  circuits  were  all  appropriate  to  extend  the 
receiving  range.”  In  other  words,  if  he  was 
getting  messages  from  an  aerial  source,  he  had 
the  equipment  with  which  to  receive  them. 

More  remarkable,  however,  were  the  books 
Renaud  was  writing  on  Korendorian  life  and 
philosophy.  There  were  a  dozen  or  so  of  them, 
all  single-spaced,  each  five  hundred  to  six 
hundred  pages  long.  There  were,  so  far  as 
Grise  could  discern  from  studying  their  con¬ 
tents,  no  typographical  errors.  But  that  was 
not  all. 

“When  he  wrote  those  books,”  Grise  re¬ 
called,  “it  was  like  his  hands  belonged  to 
someone  else.  Hed  sit  there  in  front  of  his 


typewriter  and  pay  no  attention  to  what  was 
coming  out  of  him.  He’d  be  on  the  phone  or 
talking  with  me,  and  all  the  while  his  hands 
are  going,  producing  this  perfectly  typed, 
clearly  written  stuff  on  alien  philosophy.  It 
was  just  unbelievable.”  Renaud  seemed  singu¬ 
larly  uninterested  in  promoting  himself  and 
volunteered  nothing,  though  he  would  answer 
questions. 

Renaud  also  had  a  large  collection  of  tapes 
allegedly  of  his  space  communications.  Grise 
listened  to  some  of  them  and  heard  what  was 
supposed  to  be  the  voice  of  Linn-Erri.  The 
recordings,  of  excellent  quality,  carried  a  voice 
with  “a  kind  of  hesitancy  in  speech  patterns 
suggesting  a  foreign  person  doing  well  in  En¬ 
glish.  It  had  a  singsong,  melodious  quality.” 

Soon  afterward,  Renaud  broke  off  his  brief 
association  with  Grise.  He  ceased  all  contact 
activities,  telling  his  publisher  that  he  had 
done  his  part  and  wanted  no  more  of  it.  By 
the  end  of  the  1960s,  Renaud  had  dropped 
out  of  sight.  In  1985,  Renaud  still  puzzled 
Grise.  “Something  quite  out  of  the  normal 
was  going  on,”  he  said.  “Whatever  it  was.” 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Clark,  Jerome,  1986.  “Waiting  for  the  Space  Broth¬ 
ers.”  Fate  Pt.  I.  39,  3  (March):  47-54;  Pt.  II.  39, 
4  (April):  81-87;  Pt.  III.  39,  5  (May):  68-76. 


Luno 

Luno  was  one  of  a  number  of  Space  Brothers 
who  communicated  through  Lorraine  Darr  of 
Rochester,  Minnesota.  In  the  mid-1970s,  she 
and  her  husband,  Victor,  performed  psychic 
healing  under  the  direction  of  friendly  extra¬ 
terrestrials  whom  the  couple  occasionally 
glimpsed  in  apparitional  form.  Vic  also  un¬ 
derwent  out-of-body  trips  that  took  him  into 
spaceships.  Sometimes  they  took  him  to 
Venus,  where  he  used  his  healing  talents  to 
cure  ailing  natives.  The  couple  also  believed 
that  while  in  meditative  states  they  entered 
other  dimensions.  Other  Space  Brothers  who 
helped  the  Darrs  included  Becovol,  Norbol, 
Muello,  Maynell,  and  Julo. 


160  Lyrans 


Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1976.  Gods  of  Aquarius:  UFOs  and  the 
Transformation  of  Man.  New  York:  Harcourt 
Brace  Jovanovich. 

Lyrans 

According  to  the  channeling  entity  Germane, 
human  ancestors  interacted  with  Lyrans, 
members  of  an  extraterrestrial  race  that  func¬ 
tioned  as  stern,  authoritarian  teachers.  Early 
humans  both  revered  and  feared  them.  They 
were  sturdy,  large,  light-skinned  people.  Their 
symbols  were  birds,  cats,  and  the  phoenix. 
The  phoenix  image  was  an  invention  of  theirs, 
intended  to  symbolize  the  indestructibility  of 
their  empire.  They  did  not  hold  earthlings  in 
high  regard  and  hoped  that  the  Great  Flood 


would  destroy  all  of  them,  so  that  the  Lyrans 
could  start  over  with  a  new,  improved  civiliza¬ 
tion.  Other,  more  kindly  disposed  extraterres¬ 
trials,  however,  warned  Noah  and  others,  and 
humanity  was  saved. 

Travel  to  Earth  from  the  Lyran  system  took 
generations.  Thus,  once  the  Lyrans  arrived 
here,  they  could  never  leave.  They  lost  all  con¬ 
tact  with  their  home  world  and  eventually  in¬ 
termarried  with  native  earthlings.  Back  on 
Lyra  the  inhabitants  continued  to  evolve  and 
advance  into  highly  spiritual  beings,  but  their 
cousins  stranded  on  Earth  did  not. 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Germane 

Further  Reading 

Royal,  Lyssa,  1994.  “ET  Civilizations — Germane.” 
http://www.lemuria.net/article-et-civilizations. 
html. 


Mafu 

Mafu  channeled  through  Penny  Torres  of  Los 
Angeles,  beginning  in  1986.  Thirty-two  thou¬ 
sand  years  old,  Mafu  claimed  to  have  passed 
through  seventeen  incarnations  on  Earth.  He 
taught  that  God  is  in  everything  and  everyone, 
and  everything  and  everyone  is  in  God.  Beyond 
that,  he  championed  a  macrobiotic  diet,  medi¬ 
tation,  and  the  adoption  of  a  spiritual  path. 

In  1989,  Torres,  now  Penny  Torres  Rubin, 
made  a  pilgrimage  to  Hardiwar,  India,  in  the 
Himalayan  foothills.  She  refashioned  herself 
with  the  title  and  name  of  Swami  Para- 
mananda  Saraswatti.  Back  in  the  United 
States  she  created  the  Foundation  for  the  Re¬ 
alization  of  Inner  Divinity  and  a  subsidiary, 
the  Center  for  God  Realization.  Through 
these  she  has  disseminated  Mafu’s  teachings. 

For  a  time  Mafu  was  among  the  most  pop¬ 
ular  channeling  entities  on  the  New  Age  scene 
of  the  late  1980s  and  early  1990s.  He  was 
sometimes  said  to  be  little  more  than  a  clone 
of  the  famous  Ramtha,  channeled  by  the  con¬ 
troversial  J.  Z.  Knight,  though  at  one  point 
Torres  Rubin  charged  that  Ramtha  was  noth¬ 
ing  more  than  a  fraud. 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Ramtha 

Further  Reading 

“Interview:  Penny  Torres  on  Mafu,”  1986/1987.  Life 
Times  1,  2  (Winter):  74-79. 


L’Ecuyer,  Michele,  1986/1987.  “Mafu.”  Life  Times  1, 
2  (Winter):  80-82. 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  American 
Religions.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale  Research. 


Magonia 

The  concept  of  Magonia  entered  the  literature 
of  ufology  in  a  1 964  issue  of  England’s  Flying 
Saucer  Review.  Ancient-astronaut  theorist 
W.  R.  Drake,  author  of  a  series  of  pieces  high¬ 
lighting  what  he  judged  to  be  evidence  of  ex¬ 
traterrestrial  visitation,  briefly  cited  a  ninth- 
century  French  account  of  a  “ship  in  clouds” 
from  a  place  called  “Magonia.”  A  slightly 
longer  version  appeared  in  Jacques  Vallee’s 
Passport  to  Magonia  (1969),  in  which  Yallee 
went  on  to  turn  “Magonia”  into  the  unknown 
realm  from  which  many  unexplained  phe¬ 
nomena — everything  from  elves  to  demons  to 
UFO  humanoids — emerge.  He  defined  Mag¬ 
onia  as  “a  sort  of  parallel  universe,  which  co¬ 
exists  with  our  own.  It  is  made  visible  and 
tangible  only  to  selected  people”  (Vallee, 
1969).  In  his  view,  each  culture  experiences 
Magonia  in  a  fashion  that  conforms  to  its  own 
expectations  concerning  supernatural  encoun¬ 
ters.  Thus,  rural  Ireland  experiences  fairies, 
while  Space  Age  America  has  its  ostensible  ex¬ 
traterrestrials.  Vallee  did  not  mean  to  imply 


161 


162  Marian  apparitions 


that  these  experiences  were  purely  hallucina¬ 
tory;  he  was  convinced  of  an  underlying  but 
impenetrable  reality  forever  disguised  under 
many  masks.  A  Bridsh  magazine,  still  pub¬ 
lished,  named  itself  Magonia  after  Yallee’s 
book,  though  the  magazine  rejects  paranor¬ 
mal  explanations  of  such  phenomena. 

The  Magonia  story  appeared  originally  in  a 
circa  833  manuscript  written  in  Latin  by  Ago- 
bard  (779-840),  the  Archbishop  of  Lyons. 
The  title  in  English  is  “Book  Against  False 
Opinions  Concerning  Hail  and  Thunder.” 
Agobard  was  fiercely  hostile  to  all  non-Chris¬ 
tian  beliefs.  One  that  particularly  infuriated 
him  was  the  “mad  and  blind”  belief  that 
“there  exists  a  certain  region  called  Magonia, 
from  which  ships,  navigating  on  clouds,  set 
sail  to  transport  back  to  this  same  region  the 
fruits  of  the  earth  ruined  by  hail  and  de¬ 
stroyed  by  the  storm.”  Agobard  tells  of  “sev¬ 
eral  of  these  senseless  fools”  who  held  in  cus¬ 
tody  “three  men  and  one  woman,  who  they 
said  had  fallen  from  these  ships.”  The  prison¬ 
ers  were  brought  in  front  of  an  assembly  to  be 
stoned  to  death,  but  the  archbishop  managed 
to  save  their  lives,  after  “the  truth  finally  tri¬ 
umphed”  and  he  had  shown  up  the  absurdity 
of  the  charges  (Brodu,  1995). 

In  a  critical  analysis  of  the  legend,  French 
anomalist  Jean-Fouis  Brodu  reviewed  Mago- 
nia’s  various  uses  over  the  centuries  as  well  as 
the  embellishments  that  attached  themselves 
to  it.  In  the  UFO  age,  the  sketchy  account 
was  variously  represented  as  a  landing  with 
aliens  or  an  early  abduction  case.  Some  ac¬ 
counts  twisted  details  and  reported  that  the 
captives  had  been  stoned  to  death,  Agobard’s 
explicit  words  to  the  contrary.  Surveying  the 
scholarly  literature  on  the  Magonian  tales, 
Brodu  argues  that  Agobard’s  account  makes 
no  sense  outside  the  context  of  the  period, 
which  included  the  belief  that  the  Earth  is  flat 
and  that  ships  can  sail  through  cloud  seas. 
“Magonia”  may  be  a  corruption  of  “Magoni- 
anus,”  meaning  “from  Port-Mahon,”  a  once- 
flourishing  harbor  on  the  Balearic  island  of 
Minorca. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Fairies  encountered 


Further  Reading 

Brodu,  Jean-Louis,  1995.  “Magonia:  A  Re-evalua- 
tion.”  In  Steve  Moore,  ed.  Fortean  Studies:  Volume 
2,  198-215.  London:  John  Brown  Publishing. 

Drake,  W.  R.,  1964.  “Spacemen  in  the  Middle 
Ages.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  10,  3  (May/June): 
11-13. 

Vallee,  Jacques,  1969.  Passport  to  Magonia:  From 
Folklore  to  Flying  Saucers.  Chicago:  Henry  Regn- 
ery  Company. 


Marian  apparitions 

Visions  of  the  Blessed  Virgin  Mary  (BVM) 
have  been  reported  since  at  least  the  third  cen¬ 
tury  of  the  Christian  era.  The  first  for  which 
there  is  anything  approximating  detailed 
knowledge  dates  back  to  1061  when  the  BVM 
provided  a  vision  of  Christ’s  residence  in 
Nazareth  and  directed  the  witness,  the  lady  of 
the  manor  in  Walsingham,  Norfolk,  to  see 
that  a  precise  copy  was  constructed  on  the 
spot.  A  few  visions  are  well  known,  and  the 
Roman  Catholic  Church  has  granted  official 
recognition  to  a  small  number,  though  it  has 
rejected  the  vast  majority  as  delusional.  BVM 
encounters  are  far  from  rare.  Every  year  sev¬ 
eral  occur  around  the  world.  With  very  few 
exceptions,  the  primary  witnesses  are 
Catholics,  and  usually  devout  followers  of  the 
faith.  Sometimes  other  supernatural  phenom¬ 
ena  accompany  the  BVM’s  manifestation  and 
become,  to  the  faithful,  veridical  evidence  that 
the  event  was  real. 

Undoubtedly  the  most  spectacular  such 
case  took  place  in  Fatima,  Portugal,  in  1917. 
The  incident  is  extraordinarily  complicated. 
What  follows  is  a  highly  abbreviated  account. 

Around  noon  on  May  13,  three  children, 
two  girls  and  a  boy,  tending  sheep,  saw  a  flash 
of  light  and  observed  a  brilliantly  illuminated 
figure  of  a  woman  standing  amid  the  branches 
of  an  oak  tree.  The  apparition  announced  that 
she  was  from  heaven  and  would  return  six 
times,  on  each  occasion  on  the  thirteenth  of 
each  succeeding  month.  On  the  last  visitation 
in  October,  she  would  tell  them  who  she  was 
and  why  she  had  come.  Soon  word  spread, 
and  by  June  13  some  sixty  persons  accompa- 


Marian  apparitions  163 


The  Vision  of  Our  Lady  of  Fatima  (Fortean  Picture 
Library) 

nied  the  children.  Though  the  BVM  ap¬ 
peared,  no  one  but  the  children  saw  her,  and 
the  communication,  which  predicted  the 
deaths  of  the  two  younger  children  in  the  near 
future  (they  died  in  1919  and  1920),  occurred 
through  the  oldest  child,  Lucia  de  Santos, 
who  was  told  that  she  would  live  long  as  a 
witness  to  the  living  reality  of  Mary. 

Ever  larger  groups  followed  the  children  to 
the  site  in  the  succeeding  months.  In  August, 
the  BVM  asked  that  a  chapel  be  built  at  the 
site  of  her  appearances.  On  September  13, 
some  members  of  the  crowd,  estimated  to  be 
between  twenty-five  and  thirty  thousand  per¬ 
sons,  reported  seeing  the  passage  from  east  to 
west  of  a  mysterious  globe-shaped  light.  A 
month  later,  the  number  of  pilgrims  had 
swelled  to  seventy  thousand.  The  BVM — as 


always,  visible  only  to  the  children — appeared 
at  noon  during  a  blinding  rainstorm.  The 
three  saw  her,  Joseph,  and  the  child  Jesus 
standing  in  the  sky  near  the  sun.  Meanwhile, 
some  in  the  crowd  saw,  or  thought  they  saw, 
the  sun  begin  to  “dance”  dramatically  through 
the  clouds,  spinning  and  shooting  colors,  as 
the  rain  let  up. 

In  the  1940s,  in  her  memoirs,  Lucia  de 
Santos,  since  1925  a  Carmelite  nun,  re¬ 
vealed  two  of  three  “secrets”  the  BVM  had 
imparted  to  her.  Although  open  to  other  in¬ 
terpretations,  the  prophecies  were  thought 
by  most  believers  to  refer  to  the  end  of 
World  War  I  and  the  start  of  World  War  II 
and  to  the  end  of  Soviet  Communism  and 
the  conversion  of  the  Russians  to  Catholi¬ 
cism.  The  third  secret  was  sent  to  the  Vati¬ 
can  in  the  1950s.  It  became  the  focus  of 
much  speculation,  most  of  it  alleging  that  it 
predicted  a  third  world  war.  In  May  2000, 
however,  as  Pope  John  Paul  II  embarked  on 
a  pilgrimage  to  Fatima,  during  which  he 
spoke  with  the  ninety-three-year-old  Lucia, 
the  Vatican  released  the  prophecy,  which  he 
believed  predicted  the  1981  assassination  at¬ 
tempt  on  the  pope  in  St.  Peter’s  Square — an 
interpretation  disputed  by  others. 

The  first  New  World  appearance  of  the 
BVM  is  said  to  have  taken  place  five  miles 
north  of  Mexico  City  just  after  dawn  on  De¬ 
cember  9,  1531.  A  fifty-seven-year-old  Aztec 
Indian,  Juan  Diego,  was  racing  along  a  hill¬ 
side  to  get  to  mass  in  a  nearby  village.  Passing 
a  site  at  the  foot  of  a  hill  called  Tepeyac,  which 
earlier  had  housed  a  temple  to  the  Aztec 
Mother  Goddess,  he  heard  a  feminine  voice 
calling  his  name.  He  saw  a  young  woman, 
looking  about  fourteen  years  old  and  having 
Mexican  features,  who  asked  that  a  chapel  be 
built  at  the  site.  She  also  told  him  that  he 
should  alert  the  bishop  in  Mexico  City  imme¬ 
diately.  With  some  difficulty,  he  got  an  audi¬ 
ence  with  the  bishop,  who  was  skeptical. 
Diego  returned  to  report  his  failure  to  the 
BVM,  who  was  waiting  for  him.  She  in¬ 
structed  him  to  return  the  next  day.  This  time 
the  bishop  asked  for  a  sign. 


164  Marian  apparitions 


That  same  day,  Diego’s  uncle,  who  was  se¬ 
riously  ill,  had  a  vision  of  the  BYM  and  was 
cured.  Meanwhile,  Diego  repeated  the 
bishops  request  to  the  apparition.  She  told 
him  to  pick  roses  from  the  hillside  (though 
they  should  have  been  out  of  season).  He  was 
instructed  to  wrap  them  in  his  long  outer  cape 
(known  as  a  tilma)  and  to  take  them  to  the 
bishop.  When  he  did  so,  he  unrolled  the  tilma 
and  was  as  shocked  as  the  bishop  and  his  asso¬ 
ciates  when  the  cape  turned  out  to  contain  a 
full-color  image  of  the  BVM.  To  this  day  the 
tilma  is  displayed  in  a  Mexico  City  church, 
where  thousands  of  pilgrims  come  to  see  it 
every  year. 

To  skeptics,  the  figure  gives  every  indica¬ 
tion  of  having  been  painted  on  the  cloth. 
They  also  point  out  that  the  figure  has  more 
to  do  with  conventional  iconography  of  the 
period  than  with  otherworldly  manifesta¬ 
tion.  They  have  also  raised  questions  about 
the  provenance  of  Juan  Diego’s  story,  sug¬ 
gesting  it  is  based  on  an  earlier  Spanish  leg¬ 
end.  Still,  whatever  the  truth,  the  story  and 
the  image  have  proved  equally  durable  and 
to  the  faithful  remain  powerful  symbols  of 
Mary’s  continuing  interest  in  the  Church 
and  its  believers. 

A  third  major  BYM  appearance  occurred  at 
Knock,  a  small  village  in  western  Ireland’s 
County  Mayo,  in  1879.  A  commission  of  in¬ 
quiry  set  up  by  John  McHale,  the  Archbishop 
of  Tuam,  investigated  it  soon  afterward.  On 
the  evening  of  August  21,  Mary  Beirne,  a  mid¬ 
dle-aged  housekeeper  for  the  local  priest,  was 
walking  by  the  chapel  when  she  was  surprised 
to  see  three  “beautiful”  figures,  one  resembling 
the  BVM,  the  other  St.  Joseph,  the  third  a 
bishop,  standing  motionlessly  near  an  altar.  A 
white  light  surrounded  them.  She  thought 
someone  had  put  on  a  display  of  statues.  She 
went  to  a  friend’s  house  and  stayed  for  half  an 
hour.  When  she  and  her  friend  Mary 
McLoughlin  were  on  their  way  back  to  the 
priest’s  house,  her  friend  remarked  on  the  fig¬ 
ures.  She  ran  off  to  notify  relatives.  Mean¬ 
while,  Beirne  watched  the  scene  carefully,  later 
providing  this  description  to  investigators: 


I  beheld  .  .  .  not  only  the  three  figures,  but  an 
altar  further  on  the  left  of  the  figure  of  the 
Blessed  Virgin  Mary,  and  to  the  left  of  the 
bishop  and  above  the  altar  a  lamb  about  the 
size  of  that  which  is  five  weeks  old.  Behind  the 
lamb  appeared  the  cross;  it  was  a  bit  away  from 
the  lamb,  while  the  latter  stood  in  front  from 
it,  and  not  resting  on  the  wood  of  the  cross. 
Around  the  lamb  a  number  of  gold-like  stars 
appeared  in  the  form  of  a  halo.  This  altar  was 
placed  right  under  the  window  of  the  gable 
and  more  to  the  east  of  the  figures,  all,  of 
course,  outside  the  church  at  Knock.  (Mc¬ 
Clure,  1983) 

The  other  witnesses  came  to  the  scene  and 
observed  the  motionless  figures.  Though  it 
was  raining  all  the  while,  they  would  report, 
the  ground  around  the  figures  remained  dry. 
Yet  when  Mary  Beirne’s  mother  approached 
to  kiss  the  BVM’s  feet,  she  felt  nothing.  She 
could  see  the  figures,  but  she  could  not  touch 
them.  Eventually,  the  figures  faded  away.  All 
in  all,  at  least  fifteen  persons  saw  them. 
Knock  is  now  a  major  destination  for  Marian 
pilgrims. 

The  tradition  of  Marian  apparitions  has 
continued  unabated  into  modern  times.  In 
1999,  on  the  eve  of  the  millennium,  visionar¬ 
ies  were  encountering  the  BVM  in  Germany, 
New  Hampshire,  Illinois,  El  Salvador,  On¬ 
tario,  and  elsewhere.  Most  prophecies  related 
with  these  visions  asserted  that  nuclear  war¬ 
fare  would  erupt  before  the  end  of  the  year. 
During  the  conflict  for  custody  of  six-year-old 
Cuban  refugee  Elian  Gonzalez,  some  of  Elian’s 
Miami  relatives  claimed  to  have  seen  the 
BVM,  manifesting,  they  asserted,  to  show  her 
support  for  their  belief  that  the  boy  should  be 
kept  in  their  custody  instead  of  his  Cuban  fa¬ 
ther’s. 

Secular  treatments  of  BVM  apparitions 
range  from  conventional  views — for  example, 
that  hysteria,  hoax,  and  hallucination  underlie 
the  accounts — to  more  expansive  theories. 
The  sightings  at  Fatima,  for  example,  figure  in 
some  UFO  literature,  in  which  they  are  said 
to  be  encounters  with  an  alien  being  disguised 
as  or  mistaken  for  the  BVM.  The  late  D.  Scott 


Mark  165 


Rogo,  a  writer  and  researcher  interested  in  a 
wide  range  of  anomalous  phenomena,  treated 
BYM  and  comparable  religious  miracles  as 
parapsychological  phenomena. 

Further  Reading 

Dash,  Mike,  1997.  Borderlands.  London:  Heinemann. 

Delaney,  John  J.,  ed.,  1960.  A  Woman  Clothed  with 
the  Sun:  Eight  Great  Appearances  of  Our  Lady  in 
Modern  Times.  Garden  City,  NY:  Hanover 
House. 

McClure,  Kevin,  1983.  The  Evidence forVisions  of  the 
Virgin  Mary.  Wellingborough,  Northampton¬ 
shire,  England:  Aquarian  Press. 

Nickell,  Joe,  with  John  F.  Fischer,  1988.  Secrets  of  the 
Supernatural:  Investigating  the  World’s  Occult  Mys  - 
teries.  Buffalo,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 

Rogo,  D.  Scott,  1982.  Miracles:  A  Parascientific  In  - 
quiry  into  Wondrous  Phenomena.  New  York:  Dial 
Press. 

Van  Meter,  David,  1999.  “Digest  of  Marian  Appari¬ 
tions  and  Catholic  Apocalypticism.”  http://mem- 
bers.aol.com/UticaCW/Mar- Review.html. 


Mark 

Mark  may  or  may  not  be  among  the  extrater¬ 
restrials  with  whom  George  Adamski  allegedly 
interacted.  He  figures  in  an  unusually  interest¬ 
ing  contact  claim  made  by  a  woman  identified 
only  as  “Joelle”  and  known  to  British  ufologist 
Timothy  Good,  who  told  her  story  for  the 
first  time  in  a  1998  book.  Joelle,  a  British 
woman  of  Russian  background,  never  publi¬ 
cized  her  reported  experiences,  which  oc¬ 
curred  between  1963  and  1964,  and  they  did 
not  see  print  until  after  her  death. 

Joelle  told  Good  that  the  contacts  were  initi¬ 
ated  when  she  was  doing  a  house-to-house 
marketing  survey  in  the  Sheffield  area  in  Sep¬ 
tember  1963.  At  one  house  she  noticed  a  vari¬ 
ety  of  gadgets,  none  of  which  she  recognized  as 
commercially  available.  The  woman  (given  the 
pseudonym  “Rosamund”)  whom  she  was  inter¬ 
viewing  said  her  husband  (“Jack”)  was  a  scien¬ 
tist,  inventor,  and  ham-radio  operator.  When 
Rosamund  stepped  briefly  out  of  the  room, 
Joelle  heard  a  message  come  through  the  radio 
transceiver  from  someone  named  “Mark,”  pro¬ 
posing  a  meeting  at  “Blue  John”  at  4:30  the 
next  afternoon.  On  Rosamunds  return,  when 


Joelle  mentioned  that  a  message  had  come 
through,  the  woman  acted  shocked  and 
quickly  turned  off  the  radio.  Subsequently, 
Joelle  determined  that  “Blue  John”  was  the 
Blue  John  Caves  near  Castleton  in  Derbyshire. 

Intrigued  by  Rosamund’s  reaction  (though 
Joelle  did  not  tell  her  what  the  message  had 
said),  Joelle  made  a  point  of  driving  through 
the  cave  area  on  her  way  back  to  London. 
Parking  her  car  in  an  out-of-the-way  place  at 
the  appointed  time,  she  watched  from  a  dis¬ 
tance  as  a  disc-shaped  aircraft  landed  and  a 
man  from  inside  the  craft  emerged  to  meet  a 
waiting  man,  apparently  Jack,  whose  car  she 
recalled  seeing  parked  in  front  of  the  house 
the  day  before.  As  the  two  drove  away,  the  air¬ 
craft  shot  off  at  high  speed.  Joelle  thought  she 
had  witnessed  spy  activity  and  assumed  the 
aircraft  to  be  an  advanced  Soviet  vehicle. 

Joelle  was  almost  ready  to  report  her  obser¬ 
vations  and  suspicions  to  the  police  but  felt 
compelled  to  call  on  the  couple  one  more 
time.  She  drove  directly  to  their  residence  and 
knocked  on  the  door,  explaining  to  Jack — 
who  had  barely  opened  the  door — that  she 
had  some  further  survey  questions  to  ask.  She 
was  admitted  into  the  house  at  the  insistence 
of  the  man  she  recognized  from  the  ren¬ 
dezvous  of  a  few  minutes  earlier.  The  stranger, 
no  longer  dressed  in  uniform  but  in  ordinary 
street  clothing,  identified  himself  as  “Mark.” 
Speaking  in  a  teasing,  good-natured  tone,  he 
said  he  knew  why  she  was  there. 

Thus  began  Joelle’s  interaction  with  space 
people.  Over  the  next  fifteen  months,  she 
spent  eight  and  a  half  hours  in  the  company 
of  Mark  and  another  human-looking  extrater¬ 
restrial  she  called  “Val.”  Mark  and  Val  proved 
vague  about  their  exact  place  of  origin,  except 
to  say  that  it  was  an  earthlike  planet  in  an¬ 
other  solar  system.  They  also  said  they  had 
played  a  role  in  speeding  up  human  evolution. 
They  were  here  to  work  secretly  with  scientists 
from  several  countries,  but  as  to  their  larger 
purpose,  they  would  only  state,  “We  are  not 
here  for  entirely  philanthropic  purposes.” 

On  one  occasion,  Joelle  was  allowed  to 
touch  a  spacecraft  and  to  watch  its  departure. 


1 66  Martian  bees 


Once  she  translated  a  Russian  manuscript  in 
the  British  Museum  for  Mark  and  Val,  and  at 
other  times  she  entertained  them  in  her 
home,  finding  them  to  be  pleasant  compan¬ 
ions  with  a  good  senses  of  humor  and  a  love 
of  earthly  food,  wine,  and  music.  She  was 
shown  devices  that  projected  holographic  im¬ 
ages  of  their  home  planet,  and  once  Val  him¬ 
self  showed  up  in  holographic  form. 

The  visitors  told  Joelle  that  they  and  their 
associates  had,  indeed,  contacted  Adamski, 
the  best-known  and  most  controversial  of  the 
early  contactees,  but  that  he  had  proved  un¬ 
trustworthy,  revealing  information  he  had 
been  given  in  confidence.  After  that  they  fed 
him  false  information  that  they  knew  would 
discredit  him,  and  Adamski  himself,  frus¬ 
trated  because  the  space  people  were  drawing 
away  from  him,  began  fabricating  encounters. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees;  Orthon 

Further  Reading 

Adamski,  George,  1955.  Inside  the  Space  Ships.  New 
York:  Abelard-Schuman. 

Good,  Timothy,  1998.  Alien  Base:  Earth’s  Encounters 
with  Extraterrestrials.  London:  Century. 


Martian  bees 

In  one  of  the  very  first  books  on  the  then-new 
phenomenon  of  UFOs,  British  writer  Gerald 
Heard  offered  a  theory  that  even  now,  more 
than  half  a  century  later,  is  a  distinctive  one. 
Heard,  who  in  1950  was  living  in  Los  Ange¬ 
les,  read  an  interview  in  the  Los  Angeles  Times 
with  astronomer  Gerard  Kuiper.  Though  ve¬ 
hemently  anti-UFO,  Kuiper  thought  it  at 
least  possible  that  intelligent  life  existed  on 
Mars.  He  added,  however,  that  conditions 
there  being  what  there  were  (or  at  least  as  they 
were  thought  to  be  at  the  time),  Martians 
would  likely  be  advanced  insects  of  some  sort. 
Possibly,  Kuiper  was  speaking  humorously, 
but  Heard,  a  mystically  inclined  individual, 
took  him  seriously.  He  proposed  that  just 
such  beings  were  piloting  the  flying  saucers. 

These  superbees  were  “perhaps  two  inches 
in  length  ...  as  beautiful  as  the  most  beautiful 
of  any  flower,  any  beetle,  moth  or  butterfly.  A 


creature  with  eyes  like  brilliant  cut-diamonds, 
with  a  head  of  sapphire,  a  thorax  of  emerald, 
an  abdomen  of  ruby,  wings  like  opal,  legs  like 
topaz — such  a  body  would  be  worthy  of  this 
‘super-mind.’  ...  It  is  we  who  would  feel 
shabby  and  ashamed,  and  may  be  with  our 
clammy,  putty-colored  bodies,  repulsive!” 

The  Martians  had  come  to  Earth,  Heard 
speculated,  because  they  feared  the  effect  hu¬ 
mans’  aggressive  ways  and  atomic  bombs 
could  have  on  them.  What  if  human  beings 
blew  up  the  Earth  and  huge  dust  clouds  cut 
off  the  sun’s  rays,  turning  Mars  into  an  even 
colder  planet?  It  was  also  possible  that  Earth’s 
“very  powerful  magnetic  field”  might  generate 
dangerous  sunspots  and  send  deadly  radiation 
into  Mars’s  atmosphere.  Perhaps  the  superbees 
were  here  in  what  amounted  to  a  police  ac¬ 
tion;  to  stop  us  from  causing  further  trouble 
to  them  and  to  the  rest  of  the  solar  system.  So 
far,  however,  Heard  said,  the  Martians  were 
acting  with  remarkable  patience,  in  the  fash¬ 
ion  of  “very  circumspect,  very  intelligent  gen¬ 
tlemen”  (Heard,  1950). 

See  Also:  Allingham’s  Martian;  Aurora  Martian; 
Brown’s  Martians;  Hopkins’s  Martians;  Khauga; 
Mince-Pie  Martians;  Monka;  Muller’s  Martians; 
Shaw’s  Martians;  Smead’s  Martians;  Wilcox’s 
Martians 

Further  Reading 

Heard,  Gerald,  1950.  The  Riddle  of  the  Flying 
Saucers:  Is  Another  World  Watching. ?  London:  Car- 
roll  and  Nicholson. 


Mary 

Mary  is  one  of  a  number  of  extraterrestrials 
who  are  alleged  to  have  made  appearances  at 
the  annual  Giant  Rock,  California,  Interplan¬ 
etary  Spacecraft  Convention  held  between 
1954  and  1977.  In  1959,  while  attending  the 
convention,  Harry  Mayer  observed  mysteri¬ 
ous  globes  of  light  hovering  over  the  runway 
at  Giant  Rock’s  tiny  airport.  As  he  was  run¬ 
ning  toward  them,  a  pretty,  young,  blond 
woman  suddenly  appeared  in  front  of  him, 
put  out  her  arm,  and  stopped  him  in  his 
tracks.  Though  she  was  barely  more  than  five 
feet  tall,  and  Mayer  was  well  over  six  feet,  she 


Meier,  Eduard  “Billy”  167 


had,  he  told  ufologist  William  Hamilton,  “the 
strength  of  many  men”  (Hamilton,  1996). 

They  spoke  long  enough  for  him  to  learn 
that  her  name  was  Mary  Under  her  coat,  she 
was  wearing  a  chocolate-brown  uniform  that 
looked  something  like  a  ski  suit.  She  was,  she 
said,  from  Venus.  Mayer  attended  at  least  one 
more  Giant  Rock  convention  hoping  to  see 
her  again,  but  this  turned  out  to  be  his  one 
and  only  contact  with  her. 

See  Also:  Van  Tassel,  George  W.;  Venudo 

Further  Reading 

Hamilton,  William  F.,  Ill,  1996.  Alien  Magic:  UFO 
Crashes — Abductions — Underground  Bases.  New 
Brunswick,  NJ:  Global  Communications. 


Meier,  Eduard  “Billy”  (1937-  ) 

Born  on  February  3,  1937,  in  Bulach, 
Switzerland,  Eduard  Albert  “Billy”  Meier 
would  become  an  international  contactee 
celebrity.  (His  nickname  stems  from  a  youth¬ 
ful  fascination  with  characters  from  the  Amer¬ 


ican  Old  West  such  as  Wild  Bill  Hickok  and 
Billy  the  Kid.)  Meier  claims  to  have  received  a 
mental  message  from  space  people  when  he 
was  five  years  old,  after  he  and  his  father 
watched  a  saucer-shaped  object  flying  near 
their  house.  In  1 944,  on  his  seventh  birthday, 
Meier  met  Sfath,  a  wise  elderly  extraterrestrial, 
who  took  him  for  a  ride  on  his  spacecraft.  In 
the  course  of  the  flight,  Sfath  placed  a  helmet 
over  young  Billy’s  head  and  filled  his  mind 
with  advanced  knowledge.  Periodic  contacts 
with  Sfath  continued  until  Meier  was  a  young 
adult.  Meier  wandered  through  Europe,  Asia, 
and  the  Middle  East.  Traveling  in  Turkey  in 
August  1965,  he  suffered  an  accident,  which 
cost  him  half  his  arm.  Soon  afterward,  he  met 
seventeen-year-old  Kaliope  (“Popi”)  Zafireou 
and  married  her.  Back  in  Switzerland,  the 
Meiers  settled  in  a  rural  village.  On  the  after¬ 
noon  of  January  28,  1975,  Meier  pho¬ 
tographed  a  spacecraft  and  had  an  hour-and- 
a-half  conversation  with  its  pilot,  a  beautiful 
spacewoman  named  Semjase  (pronounced 


Eduard  “Billy”  Meier,  one  of  the  most  controversial  contactees  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


168  Meier,  Eduard  “Billy 


sem-ya-see).  Meier  would  produce  many 
more  photographs,  claim  more  contacts,  re¬ 
count  trips  into  space  and  through  time,  and 
become  the  most  controversial  contactee  since 
George  Adamski. 

Meier’s  aliens  came  from  the  Pleiades  star 
system  and  from  a  planet  named  Erra,  one  of 
ten  planets  in  orbit  around  a  sun  known  as 
Tayget.  The  aliens  got  there  from  another 
planet  in  the  constellation  of  Lyra,  where 
thousands  of  years  ago  a  war  forced  much  of 
the  population  to  flee  to  other  worlds.  At  one 
point  2.8  million  years  ago,  as  they  were  ex¬ 
ploring  the  new  galactic  neighborhood,  the 
new  Pleiadians  found  Earth,  then  housing 
primitive  human  beings.  Some  Pleiadians  in¬ 
termarried  with  humans,  but  their  educa¬ 
tional  efforts  only  led  to  a  war  with  earthlings, 
who  used  the  newly  supplied  extraterrestrial 
technology  against  the  Pleiadians.  A  second 
wave  of  Pleiadians  was  destroyed  in  the  same 
way.  Semjase  was  part  of  a  third  wave.  She  and 
her  associates  hoped  to  move  human  beings  in 
a  positive  direction,  and  they  selected  Meier  as 
their  earthly  agent. 

Unlike  nearly  all  other  contacters,  Meier’s 
space  friends  were  hostile  to  religion,  though 
apparently  not  to  the  notion  of  God  as  such. 
Once,  when  Meier  was  aboard  a  spaceship 
(“beamship”  as  the  Pleiadians  called  them)  he 
was  able  to  photograph  the  “Eye  of  God”  in 
deep  space.  He  also  traveled  to  the  Pleiades 
and  into  another  dimension  and  secured  pic¬ 
tures  of  dinosaurs,  cavemen,  and  a  future 
earthquake  in  San  Francisco.  A  virtual  indus¬ 
try  of  Meier-related  publications,  photo¬ 
graphs,  videos,  and  other  materials  found  an 
audience  around  the  world.  Wendelle  C. 
Stevens,  an  American,  energetically  promoted 
Meier,  till  then  little  known  to  Americans.  He 
published  books  supporting  Meier  and  had 
the  non-English-speaking  Meier’s  work  trans¬ 
lated.  Stevens’s  efforts  encouraged  an  indepen¬ 
dent  journalist,  Gary  Kinder,  to  write  a  sur¬ 
prisingly  sympathetic  book  for  a  mainstream 
publisher. 

To  conservative  ufologists,  Meier  seemed 
like  a  shameless  hoaxer.  He  became  a  particu¬ 


lar  obsession  to  a  young  California  man,  Kal 
Korff,  who  spent  years  investigating  Meier’s 
claims.  He  published  two  intensely  critical 
books  published  between  1981  and  1995.  In¬ 
dependent  analyses  suggested  that  the  “beam- 
ships”  in  the  photographs  were  in  fact  small 
models,  some  suspended  on  fishing  wire,  oth¬ 
ers  apparently  held  in  hand.  Investigators 
traced  other  images  in  Meier’s  photos  to 
NASA  footage  and  (in  the  case  of  Semjase)  a 
picture  in  a  European  fashion  magazine.  In 
the  mid-1990s,  after  Popi  Meier  divorced  her 
husband,  she  told  European  ufologists  that 
her  former  husband’s  claims  were  bogus. 

According  to  Meier,  the  Pleiadians — who 
call  themselves  Plejarans — withdrew  all  of 
their  bases  on  Earth  in  February  1995  to 
protest  the  proliferation  of  phony  claims  of 
contact  with  them.  Since  then  Meier  has  ex¬ 
perienced  approximately  four  contacts  a  year 
with  Ptaah,  who  is  Semjase’s  father.  He  claims 
more  than  250  contacts  with  Pleiadians,  in 
general,  since  1975. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees;  Semjase 

Further  Reading 

Elders,  Lee  J.,  Brit  Nilsson-Elders,  and  Thomas  K. 
Welch,  1979.  UFO .  .  .  Contact  from  the  Pleiades, 
Volume  I.  Phoenix,  AZ:  Genesis  III  Productions. 

- ,  1983.  UFO .  .  .  Contact  from  the  Pleiades, 

Volume  II.  Phoenix,  AZ:  Genesis  III  Productions. 

FIGU — Los  Angeles  Study  Group,  n.d.  The  Official 
Billy  Meier  Web  Page.  http://www.billymeier. 
com/index-alt.  html. 

Kinder,  Gary,  1987.  Light  Years:  An  Investigation  into 
the  Extraterrestrial  Experiences  of  Eduard  Meier. 
New  York:  Atlantic  Monthly  Press. 

Korff,  Kal  K.,  1995.  Spaceships  of  the  Pleiades:  The 
Billy  Meier  Story.  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus 
Books. 

Korff,  Kal  K.,  with  William  L.  Moore,  1981.  The 
Meier  Incident — The  Most  Infamous  Hoax  in  Ufol  - 
ogy.  Fremont,  CA:  self-published. 

Maccabee,  Bruce,  1989.  “Pendulum  from  the 
Pleiades.”  International  UFO  Reporter  14,  1  (Jan¬ 
uary/February):  1 1-12,  22. 

Stevens,  Wendelle  C.,  1983.  UFO .  .  .  Cotttact  from 
the  Pleiades — A  Preliminary  Investigation  Re  - 
port — The  Report  of  an  Ongoing  Contact.  Tucson, 
AZ:  self-published. 

- ,  1989.  UFO  .  .  .  Contact  from  the  Pleiades:  A 

Supplementary  Investigation  Report — The  Report  of 
an  Ongoing  Contact.  Tucson,  AZ:  self-published. 


Me-leelah  169 


Stevens,  Wendelle  C.,  ed.,  1988.  Message  from  the 
Pleiades:  The  Contact  Notes  of  Eduard  “Billy” 
Meier,  Volume  I.  Phoenix,  AZ:  Wendelle  C. 
Stevens  and  Genesis  III  Publishing. 

- ,  ed.,  1990.  Message  from  the  Pleiades:  The 

Contact  Notes  of  Eduard  “Billy”  Meier,  Volume  II. 
Phoenix,  AZ:  Wendelle  C.  Stevens  and  Genesis 
III  Publishing. 

- ,  ed.,  1994.  Message  from  the  Pleiades:  The 

Contact  Notes  of Edtiard  “Billy”  Meier,  Volume  III. 
Phoenix,  AZ:  Wendelle  C.  Stevens  and  Genesis 
III  Publishing. 

Winters,  Randolph,  1994.  The  Pleiadian  Mission:  A 
Time  of  Awareness.  Atwood,  CA:  The  Pleiades 
Project. 


Me-leelah 

Me-leelah  is  a  Pleiadian  woman  who  figures 
in  an  abduction  incident  said  to  have  oc¬ 
curred  in  Johannesburg,  South  Africa,  in  the 
early  hours  of  July  19,  1988. 

Phyllis  and  her  adult,  married  daughter 
Diane  were  in  the  latter’s  car  (Diane  was 
driving  her  mother  home)  when  they  noticed 
an  unusual  starlike  object.  As  it  approached, 
they  could  see  inside  what  proved  to  be  an 
elongated  craft.  Through  its  lighted  win¬ 
dows,  they  glimpsed  its  interior  and  saw  six 
figures  inside.  Suddenly,  they  felt  a  presence 
inside  their  vehicle.  They  heard  a  clicking 
sound  and  abruptly  found  themselves  as¬ 
cending  a  ramp  into  the  UFO.  A  finely 
skinned,  short  woman  with  slightly  slanted 
eyes  and  no  hair,  yet  beautiful  nonetheless, 
guided  Diane.  The  alien  woman  wore  a  one- 
piece,  navy-blue  suit  such  as  a  jogger  might 
wear.  The  three  walked  through  an  aromatic 
“mist”  before  entering  the  main  part  of  the 
craft.  Their  guide  told  them,  “Greetings.  I 
am  from  the  Pleiades,  and  my  name  is  Me- 
leelah.  I  am  the  commander  of  the  craft” 
(Hind,  1996).  She  spoke  in  a  soft  but  high- 
pitched,  sing-song  voice. 

There  were  eight  persons — two  women 
and  six  men — inside  the  craft.  One  of  the 
men  helped  as  Me-leelah  put  the  two  women 
on  tables  and  subjected  each  to  a  physical  ex¬ 
amination,  including  an  X  ray  and  a  shot 
under  the  right  breast  (this,  it  was  explained, 


was  done  in  order  to  collect  DNA  and  RNA 
samples).  The  other  crewmembers  paid  no 
heed  to  the  abductees.  Afterward,  Me-leelah 
showed  them  what  looked  like  an  ordinary 
map  of  the  world.  She  told  them  that  giant 
waves  would  soon  destroy  much  of  South 
Africa’s  Cape  area.  Comparable  destruction 
would  occur  elsewhere  on  the  Earth  with  con¬ 
siderable  loss  of  life.  Those  who  wanted  to 
survive  should  flee  to  the  mountainous  areas 
of  Spain.  The  United  States  would  go  to  war 
in  the  Middle  East,  and  AIDS  would  kill 
many  people  everywhere. 

At  the  conclusion  of  the  examination,  the 
two  women  stepped  down  from  the  tables. 
Me-leelah  spoke  and  then  performed  some  act 
that  later  neither  Phyllis  nor  Diane  could  re¬ 
call.  All  they  knew  was  that  Me-leelah  was 
abruptly  wearing  a  different,  more  attractive- 
looking  jacket.  Soon  the  two  became  aware 
that  Me-leelah  was  reading  their  minds.  She 
would  verbally  answer  questions  they  had 
formed  only  in  their  minds.  At  one  point, 
after  Diane  had  answered  a  question  of  Me- 
leelah’s  less  than  truthfully,  the  Pleiadean 
brought  her  face  within  inches  of  Diane’s.  Her 
pupils  became  vertical,  disturbingly  reptilian. 
After  the  moment  of  anger  had  passed,  Me- 
leelah  told  them  they  could  go.  Two  of  the 
men  escorted  them  back  to  their  car,  but  not 
before  the  commander  had  promised  that 
they  would  meet  again  in  two  years’  time.  She 
added  that  this  was  two  years  in  Pleiadean 
time,  four  in  Earth  time. 

By  the  time  they  got  home,  neither  woman 
remembered  the  incident.  They  only  noted 
how  strangely  quiet  and  calm  everything 
seemed  to  be:  no  traffic,  no  birds,  no  sound. 
Over  time,  memories  of  the  experience  gradu¬ 
ally  returned.  May  1 992  came  and  went  with¬ 
out  a  further  contact. 

Cynthia  Hind,  a  ufologist  from  Harare, 
Zimbabwe,  who  investigated  the  story,  says 
the  women  were  unread  in  the  UFO  litera¬ 
ture.  They  had  not  heard  of  other  claims  of 
Pleiadean  contacts,  they  claimed. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Meier,  Eduard 
“Billy” 


170  Melora 


Further  Reading 

Hind,  Cynthia,  1996.  UFOs  over  Africa.  Madison, 
WI:  Horus  House  Press. 

- ,  2000.  “Highlights  from  an  African  Case 

Book.”  Ohio  UFO  Notebook  21:  1—10. 

Melora 

Melora  is  a  channeling  entity  who  communi¬ 
cates  through  Jyoti  Alla-An  of  Boulder,  Col¬ 
orado.  Alla-An  characterizes  Melora  as  a 
“higher-dimensional  group  consciousness” 
from  the  Sirius  system.  As  is  often  the  case 
with  such  beings,  “Melora” — Greek  for 
“golden  apple” — is  a  name  of  convenience, 
not  the  entity’s  actual  moniker;  real  names 
for  interdimensional  beings  are  either  nonex¬ 
istent  or  incomprehensible  to  humans. 
Melora  and  her  colleagues,  Alla-An  says,  ask 
us  to  call  them  names  “with  which  we  res¬ 
onate  or  which  trigger  us  to  remember  our 
soul  histories.” 

Melora  is  a  higher  member  of  Alla-An’s 
“soul  group.”  At  the  time  of  their  initial  con¬ 
tact,  Melora  was  serving  on  the  Council  of 
Four  with  Pallas  Athena,  Ocala  (an  angel), 
and  Bi-la  (a  Tibetan  guide).  The  Council  of 
Four  existed  to  help  people  express  their 
“Being-ness.”  Then  Ocala  and  Bi-la  merged 
into  Melora.  In  the  future,  it  appears  that 
Melora  and  Athena  will  merge.  Alla-An  says, 

During  these  years  of  my  association  with 
Melora,  it  has  been  clear  that  SHE  continues  to 
learn  and  grow  through  ME!  Her  flexibility,  her 
unconditional  love,  her  compassion — all  these 
have  taught  me  much  about  relationship  with 
the  Divine.  It  has  taught  me  how  critical  our 
consciousness  within  incarnation  is  to  the  spir¬ 
itual  development  of  non-physical  versions  of 
ourselves  in  higher  dimensions.  Most  impor¬ 
tantly,  working  with  Melora  has  taught  me 
about  how  honored  we  are  by  all  the  higher  be¬ 
ings  in  the  light,  who  fully  appreciate  the  diffi¬ 
culty  of  being  light  works  in  3rd  dimension. 
(Alla-An,  1998) 

See  Also:  Channeling 
Further  Reading 

Alla-An,  Jyoti,  1998.  “Melora.”  http://mhl02.infi. 
net/  -lightexp/Melora3  .html. 


Men  in  black 

According  to  legend  and  report,  strange  indi¬ 
viduals,  who  are  often  menacing  and  usually 
dressed  in  black  suits,  have  threatened  UFO 
witnesses  and  investigators  on  a  number  of 
occasions  since  the  beginning  of  the  UFO 
age.  The  men  in  black  (sometimes  called 
MIB)  are  variously  suspected  to  be  govern¬ 
ment  agents,  enforcers  for  powerful  secret 
groups  (“International  Bankers,”  the  New 
World  Order  by  another  name),  alien  entities, 
inner-earthers,  or  even  demons. 

In  this  last  context,  it  is  worth  noting  an 
episode  that  occurred  during  a  religious  re¬ 
vival  in  Wales  in  1905.  When  the  revival  was 
at  its  most  intense,  many  reported  divine  and 
demonic  supernatural  encounters,  and  some 
individuals,  both  believers  and  secular  jour¬ 
nalists  covering  the  revival,  witnessed  unusual 
aerial  phenomena  that  today  might  be 
thought  of  as  UFOs.  A  contemporary  account 
mentions  that  a  “man  dressed  in  black”  visited 
a  young  rural  woman  over  three  consecutive 
nights  to  deliver  “a  message .  .  .  which  she  is 
frightened  to  relate”  (Evans,  1905).  In  his 
book  on  traditions  of  Satan,  William  Woods 
writes  that  the  devil  “mostly ...  is  dressed  in 
black,  and  always  in  the  fashion  of  the  day” 
(Woods,  1974). 

Men  in  black  established  a  place  in  UFO 
lore  after  a  September  1953  incident.  A 
Bridgeport,  Connecticut,  man,  Albert  K. 
Bender,  headed  one  of  the  most  successful 
early  UFO  groups,  the  International  Flying 
Saucer  Bureau,  but  closed  it  down  suddenly. 
After  much  prodding  he  confided  to  close  as¬ 
sociates,  most  prominently  Gray  Barker,  that 
three  individuals  in  dark  suits  had  visited  him 
to  warn  that  he  had  come  too  close  to  the 
truth  about  UFOs.  They  passed  on  informa¬ 
tion  that  frightened  him  so  badly  that  he 
wanted  nothing  more  to  do  with  the  subject. 
Barker  later  wrote  a  sensationalistic,  paranoia- 
drenched  book,  They  Knew  Too  Much  about 
Flying  Saucers  (1956),  that,  more  than  any 
other  single  piece  of  writing,  launched  the 
MIB  legend.  Though  Bender  initially  hinted 
that  his  visitors  were  from  the  government,  he 


Men  in  black  171 


Albert  K.  Bender’s  sketch  of  one  of  the  three  “men  in  black” 
who  visited  his  Connecticut  house  in  September  1953  and 
gave  him  the  solution  to  the  UFO  mystery  (Fortean  Picture 
Library) 

eventually  wrote  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Three 
Men  (1962)  for  Barker’s  small  publishing 
company.  In  what  nearly  all  readers  saw  as  an 
amateurish  science-fiction  novel  passing  itself 
off  as  factual,  Bender  identified  the  three  men 
as  space  people  who  abducted  him  to  Antarc¬ 
tica,  where  Bender  met  monstrous  beings  at 
an  alien  base. 

The  dismal  reception  afforded  Bender’s 
book  would  likely  have  ended  MIB  talk  if  not 
for  the  emergence  in  the  latter  1960s  of  John 
A.  Keel,  who  coined  the  term  “MIB.”  Keel,  a 
freelance  writer  living  in  New  York  City,  se¬ 
cured  a  generous  book  contract  from  a  major 
New  York  publisher  to  write  what  was  in¬ 
tended  to  be  the  definitive  work  on  UFOs.  An 
occult  theorist  strongly  attracted  to  de¬ 
monology,  Keel  held  UFOs  and  their  occu¬ 
pants  to  be  shape-shifting  entities  from  a  sin¬ 
ister  otherworld.  Among  their  agents  were 
MIB  who,  in  common  with  their  brethren, 


sought  to  confuse,  manipulate,  and  even  de¬ 
stroy  those  who  encountered  them  or  sought 
to  uncover  the  truth  about  them.  Keel  col¬ 
lected  MIB  reports  from  several  states  and  fur¬ 
ther  claimed  that  he  had  interacted  with  them 
personally.  In  Keel’s  view,  MIB  have  played  a 
behind-the-scenes  role  in  much  of  human  his¬ 
tory  and  belief. 

For  the  most  part,  Keel’s  MIB  could  not 
have  passed  easily  for  human.  They  were  dark- 
featured  (or,  conversely,  unnaturally  pale), 
bug-eyed,  and  confused;  and  their  behavior 
betrayed  their  unfamiliarity  with  the  earthly 
environment  and  social  customs.  For  some 
reason,  they  usually  drove  black  limousines, 
frequently  Cadillacs. 

Other  investigators  collected  similar  reports 
from  around  the  world.  Some  suggested  that 
the  MIB  were  government  or  military  opera¬ 
tives,  others  that  they  were  aliens.  By  1966, 
even  the  U.S.  Air  Force  was  hearing  of  such  in¬ 
cidents  and  tried  to  run  them  down,  without 
success.  Colonel  George  P.  Freeman,  a  Penta¬ 
gon  spokesman  for  the  U.S.  Air  Force’s  UFO- 
investigating  Project  Blue  Book,  complained, 
“We  haven’t  been  able  to  find  out  anything 
about  these  men”  (Keel,  1975).  In  the  1990s, 
ufologist  William  L.  Moore  would  allege, 
though  without  providing  substantiating  evi¬ 
dence,  that  “Men  in  Black  are  really  govern¬ 
ment  people  in  disguise  .  .  .  members  of  a 
rather  bizarre  unit  of  Air  Force  intelligence 
known  currendy  as  the  Air  Force  Special  Ac¬ 
tivities  Center  (AFSAC)”  (Moore,  1993). 

In  recent  years,  Jenny  Randles,  a  well- 
regarded  English  ufologist,  has  looked  into 
MIB  cases  in  Britain.  In  her  view,  some  are 
genuinely  puzzling,  sometimes  involving  wit¬ 
nesses  who  have  never  heard  of  the  phenome¬ 
non  yet  describe  many  of  its  classic  features. 
From  interviews  and  official  documents,  Ran¬ 
dles  was  led  to  the  conclusion  that  a  secret  de¬ 
partment  of  the  Ministry  of  Defense  was 
monitoring  certain  kinds  of  UFO  reports. 

See  Also:  Kazik;  Keel,  John  Alva 

Further  Reading 

Barker,  Gray,  1956.  They  Knew  Too  Much  about  Fly  - 
ing  Saucers.  New  York:  University  Books. 


172  Menger,  Howard 


Bender,  Albert  K.,  1962.  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Three 
Men.  Clarksburg,  WV:  Saucerian  Books. 

Evans,  Beriah  G.,  1905.  “Merionethshire  Mysteries.” 
Occult  Review  1,  3  (March):  113-120. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New 
York:  Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and 
Company. 

Moore,  William  L.,  1993.  “Those  Mysterious  Men 
in  Black.”  Far  Out  (Winter):  27-29. 

Randles,  Jenny,  1997.  The  Truth  behind  Men  in 
Black:  Government  Agents — or  Visitors  from  Be  - 
yond.  New  York:  St.  Martin’s  Paperbacks. 

Woods,  William,  1974.  A  History  of  the  Devil.  New 
York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 


Menger,  Howard  (1922-  ) 

Howard  Menger  (pronounced  men- jer),  a 
New  Jersey  sign  painter  who  was  sometimes 
called  the  East  Coast  equivalent  of  George 
Adamski,  rose  to  prominence  in  flying-saucer 
contactee  circles  in  the  1950s.  In  his  first  pub¬ 
lic  appearance,  on  Long  John  Nebel’s  radio 
show  on  New  York’s  WOR,  on  October  29, 
1956,  Menger  claimed  lifelong  contacts  as 
well  as  “flashback”  memories  of  an  earlier  life 
as  an  extraterrestrial.  The  space  people  were 
mostly  from  Venus,  and  prominent  among 
them  were  beautiful,  blond  women.  In  early 
1956,  when  the  contacts  intensified,  Menger 
began  taking  photographs  of  alleged  space¬ 
craft.  He  also  claimed  interplanetary  flights  in 
the  company  of  “Aryan-type”  beings  and  pro¬ 
duced,  among  others,  pictures  of  the  lunar 
surface  taken  from  a  flying  saucer. 

Conservative  ufologists  scoffed  at  Menger’s 
tales  and  rejected  his  photographs  as  absurdly 
unconvincing.  Writing  in  Saucer  News,  Lonzo 
Dove  deemed  them  “so  evidently  faked  that  it 
is  almost  foolish  to  even  criticize  them” 
(Dove,  1959).  When  the  anticontactee  Na¬ 
tional  Investigations  Committee  on  Aerial 
Phenomena  challenged  Menger  and  other 
contactees  to  submit  to  polygraph  examina¬ 
tions,  Menger  declined. 

His  supporters  flocked  to  his  High  Bridge, 
New  Jersey,  farm,  where  some  reported  seeing, 
from  a  distance,  “spacemen”  in  luminous  uni¬ 
forms  and  other  oddities,  attributed  by  skep¬ 
tics  to  effects  engineered  by  Menger  confeder- 


Howard  Menger  with  a  “free  energy ”  machine  (Fortean 
Picture  Library) 

ates.  One  supporter  apparently  was  Connie 
Weber,  an  attractive  young  blond  woman  to 
whom  Menger,  a  married  man,  had  turned  his 
romantic  attentions.  Menger  declared  Weber 
to  be  the  sister  of  a  spacewoman  he  had  met 
in  1946.  For  her  part,  Weber  “recalled”  that  in 
previous  lives  she  had  been  a  Venusian  and 
Menger  had  been  a  Saturnian  (a  relationship 
she  documented  in  a  lurid  1958  book,  My 
Saturnian  Lover).  On  one  occasion,  four  fol¬ 
lowers  of  Menger’s  were  invited  separately 
into  a  dark  room,  where  each  had  a  brief  audi¬ 
ence  with  a  spacewoman  concealed  in  shadow. 
When  a  sliver  of  light  accidentally  caught  the 
supposed  spacewoman,  however,  one  of  them 
recognized  Weber.  Subsequently,  Menger  left 
his  wife  and  married  Weber. 

By  the  time  his  book  From  Outer  Space  to 
You  appeared  in  1959,  Menger  had  largely 
withdrawn  from  the  saucer  scene.  The  next 
year,  interviewed  on  Long  John  Nebel’s  televi¬ 
sion  show,  Menger  startled  his  host  and  audi¬ 
ence  by  seeming  to  disavow  his  former  claims. 
In  the  1960s,  he  changed  his  story,  now  as- 


Metatron  173 


serting  that  he  had  participated  in  an  elabo¬ 
rate  hoax  at  the  instigation  of  a  secret  govern¬ 
ment  agency  that  wanted  to  test  human  reac¬ 
tions  to  extraterrestrial  visitors. 

Howard  and  Connie  Menger  moved  to 
Vero  Beach,  Florida,  where  they  lived  qui¬ 
etly  for  more  than  two  decades.  In  1990, 
they  resurfaced  at  the  National  UFO  Con¬ 
ference  in  Miami  Beach  and  began  publish¬ 
ing  materials  that  again  presented  the  space 
contacts  as  authentic.  They  also  appeared  in 
the  1992  Discovery  Channel  documentary 
Farewell,  Good  Brothers.  They  make  occa¬ 
sional  appearances  on  the  saucer  and  New 
Age  scene. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Baxter,  Marla  [pseud,  of  Constance  Weber  Menger], 
1958.  My  Saturnian  Lover.  New  York:  Vantage 
Press. 

“Contactee  Letters,”  1957.  Confidential  Bulletin  to 
NICAP Members  (September  6). 

Dove,  Lonzo,  1957.  “Mengers  Adamski-Type 
Saucers.”  Saucer  News  4,  2  (February-March): 
6-7. 

Menger,  Howard,  1959.  From  Outer  Space  to  You. 
Clarksburg,  WV:  Saucerian  Books. 

Moseley,  James  W.,  1966.  “Strange  New  Ideas  from 
Howard  Menger.”  Saucer  News  Non-Scheduled 
Newsletter  26  (January  25). 

Nebel,  Long  John,  1961.  The  Way  Out  World.  Engle¬ 
wood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

Schwarz,  Berthold  E.,  1972.  “Beauty  of  the  Night.” 
Flying  Saucer  Review  18,  4  (August):  5-9,  17. 


Merk 

According  to  George  Hunt  Williamson, 
eighteen  thousand  years  ago  a  Venusian 
named  Merk  flew  a  “Light  Ship”  to  Telos,  an 
eastern  section  of  Lemuria  in  what  is  now  Ari¬ 
zona,  initiating  a  period  of  cordial  and  pro¬ 
ductive  relationships  between  Venusians  and 
Lemurians,  who  then  had  developed  flight 
but  not  space  flight.  The  Lemurians  built  a 
memorial  to  commemorate  the  spot  where 
Merk’s  craft  had  landed. 

See  Also:  Lemuria;  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1959.  Road  in  the  Sky. 

London:  Neville  Spearman. 


Mersch 

According  to  Colorado  contactee  Dave  Schultz, 
six  extraterrestrial  races  are  visiting  Earth.  One 
is  the  Mersch.  The  Mersch  are  six  feet  tall, 
weigh  two  hundred  pounds,  and  have  bald 
heads  and  slanted  eyes.  Their  home  planet  is  in 
the  constellation  Scorpio.  They  are  active  in  ab¬ 
ductions  and  mutilation  of  cattle  and  other  ani¬ 
mals  in  western  states. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Contactees;  Olliana 
Olliana  Alliano 

Further  Reading 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  ed.,  1982.  Proceedings:  Rocky 
Mountain  Conference  on  UFO  Investigation. 
Laramie,  WY:  School  of  Extended  Studies,  Uni¬ 
versity  of  Wyoming. 

Metatron 

Metatron  is  a  “divine  interface  between  God 
and  the  outer  worlds — meaning  us  on  the 
outer  layers  of  physical  creation — the  hard¬ 
ened  shell  around  the  cosmic  egg  of  Light” 
(Arvey,  1994).  Metatronic  energy  is  transmit¬ 
ted  once  a  week  to  the  Earth,  and  seekers  can 
gain  access  to  it  if  they  are  attuned  to  the 
proper  frequency.  Much  of  the  information 
Metatron  sends  is  of  a  densely  technical  na¬ 
ture.  A  good  part  of  the  channeled  material 
comes  through  James  J.  Hurtak,  who  records 
it  in  The  Book  of  Knowledge:  The  Keys  of  Enoch 
(1982).  Hurtak,  however,  is  far  from  the  only 
Metatron  channeler. 

The  most  famous  communicant  with 
Metatron  is  the  rock  guitarist  Carlos  Santana. 
Santana  claims  that  Metatron  was  responsible 
for  the  restoration  of  his  career  in  1 999  and 
2000.  During  a  meditation  session  Metatron 
told  him,  “We  want  to  hook  you  back  to  the 
radio-airwave  frequency”  and  to  “reconnect 
the  molecules  to  the  light,”  presumably  mean¬ 
ing  renewed  airplay  and  popular  attention 
(Gates  and  Gordon,  2000). 

The  name  Metatron  comes  out  of  tradi¬ 
tional  Jewish  mysticism,  where  Metatron  is 
depicted  as  an  archangel,  perhaps  the  highest 
of  them  all.  Some  mystics  believe  that  on 
Earth  he  was  the  prophet  Enoch  whom  God 
took  directly  to  heaven  without  the  transi- 


174  Michael 


Carlos  Santana,  the  most  famous  communicant  with 
Metatron,  performing  in  Munich,  Germany,  May  2000 
(AFP/Corbis) 


tional  detail  of  dying.  Other  sources  assert 
that  it  was  he  who  led  the  Israelites  through 
the  wilderness  after  the  Exodus. 

Further  Reading 

Arvey,  Michael,  1994.  “Metatron.”  http://www.spir- 
itweb.org/Spirit/metatron-arvey.html. 

Davidson,  Gustav,  1967.  A  Dictionary  of  Angels.  New 
York:  Free  Press. 

Gates,  David,  and  Devin  Gordon,  2000.  “Smooth  as 
Santana.”  Newsweek  (February  14):  66-67. 

Gilmore,  Robert  and  Laurie,  eds.,  n.d.  “The  Ascen¬ 
sion  Is  Life  Lived  from  Joy.”  http://www.nite- 
hawk.com/daydove/25metatr.html. 

Hurtak,  James  J.,  1982.  The  Book  of  Knowledge:  The 
Keys  of  Enoch.  Los  Gatos,  CA:  Academy  for  Fu¬ 
ture  Science. 

Stone,  Joshua  David,  1994.  The  Complete  Ascension 
Manual.  Sedona,  AZ:  Light  Technology  Publish¬ 
ing. 


Michael 

In  two  books,  Chelsea  Quinn  Yarbro  chroni¬ 
cled  the  channeling  experiences  of  a  young 
San  Francisco-area  woman  given  the  name 


Jessica  Lansing.  Yarbro  wrote  that  in  1970,  as 
Jessica  and  her  husband,  Walter  (also  a  pseu¬ 
donym),  played  with  a  ouija  board  after  din¬ 
ner,  they  began  receiving  communications 
from  an  entity  who  first  refused  to  answer  the 
question,  “Who  is  this?”  Eventually,  under 
prodding,  it  said,  “The  last  name  a  fragment 
of  this  entity  used  was  Michael.”  “Michael” 
went  on  to  say,  “We  are  of  the  mid-causal 
lane.  The  astral  plane  is  accessible  to  the  phys¬ 
ical  plane.  We  are  not”  (Yarbro,  1979). 
Michael  claimed  to  be  composed  of  more 
than  a  thousand  fragments  of  “old  souls.” 

In  later  automatic  writing  and  channeling, 
Michael — who  resisted  being  identified  by  a 
masculine  pronoun — taught  that  each  indi¬ 
vidual  must  go  through  seven  basic  soul 
stages  over  a  minimum  of  seven  reincarnated 
lives.  But  Michael  would  respond  impatiently 
if  someone  asked  a  question  about  his  or  her 
personal  life.  “We  are  not  the  Ann  Landers  of 
the  cosmos,”  Michael  snapped.  As  the 
Michael  phenomenon  grew,  however,  this 
changed,  and  Michael  would  speak  to  indi¬ 
viduals  about  themselves  and  offer  them 
guidance. 

Jessica  Lansing  herself  was  uncertain 
whether  Michael  was  an  independent  intelli¬ 
gence  or  some  manifestation  of  an  aspect  of 
her  psyche.  In  time,  others  reported  commu¬ 
nications  from  Michael.  In  1984,  two  follow¬ 
ers  founded  the  Michael  Educational  Founda¬ 
tion.  The  foundation  maintains  that  Michael 
is  a  collection  of  one  thousand  fifty  souls,  all 
of  whom  once  lived  lives  on  Earth.  It  sponsors 
other  Michael  groups  throughout  the  United 
States.  Michael  F.  Brown,  an  anthropologist 
who  has  studied  the  channeling  movement, 
calls  Michael  “as  close  to  a  channeling  fran¬ 
chise  as  one  can  find  in  the  United  States 
today”  (Brown,  1997). 

“According  to  Michael,”  the  foundation 
states,  “we  agree  to  come  into  each  lifetime 
with  a  basic  Role  that  we  play  to  best  support 
the  world  around  us.  In  addition  to  this  Role, 
we  have  numerous  ‘Overleaves’  or  personality 
traits  that  we  choose  to  play  from”  (“Who  Is 
Michael?”  n.d.). 


Mince-Pie  Martians  175 


See  Also:  Channeling 
Further  Reading 

Brown,  Michael  F.,  1997.  The  Channeling  Zone: 
American  Spirituality  in  an  Anxious  Age.  Cam¬ 
bridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  American 
Religions.  Fifth  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale  Re¬ 
search. 

“Who  Is  Michael?”  n.d.  http://amt.to/mef/mchan. 
html. 

Yarbro,  Chelsea  Quinn,  1979.  Messages  from  Michael. 
New  York:  Playboy  Paperbacks. 

- ,  1986.  More  Messages  from  Michael.  New 

York:  Berkley  Paperbacks. 


Michigan  giant 

According  to  the  Saginaw  Courier-Herald  of 
April  17,  1897,  a  “flying  machine”  landed  half 
a  mile  southwest  of  Reynolds,  Michigan,  at 
4:30  A.M.  on  the  fourteenth.  Witnesses  who 
had  seen  it  hovering  rushed  to  the  scene, 
where,  to  their  shock,  they  spotted  its  pilot, 
who  appeared  human  but  was  nine  and  a  half 
feet  tall.  His  “talk,  while  musical,  is  not  talk  at 
all,  but  seems  to  be  a  repetition  of  bellowing.” 
The  being  looked  hot  and  uncomfortable 
even  though  he  was  nearly  naked.  What 
looked  like  polar-bear  pelts  lay  nearby,  appar¬ 
ently  winter  clothing  for  which  the  traveler 
had  no  use  at  the  moment. 

One  farmer  made  the  mistake  of  approach¬ 
ing  the  figure  too  closely.  For  his  efforts  he 
found  himself  at  the  receiving  end  of  a  severe 
kick.  It  was  delivered  with  sufficient  ferocity 
and  velocity  that  the  man’s  hip  broke. 

The  article,  clearly  written  with  tongue  in 
cheek,  concludes,  “Great  excitement  prevails 
here,  and  lots  of  people  are  flocking  here  from 
Morley  and  Howard  City  to  view  the  strange 
being  from  a  distance,  as  no  one  dares  to  go  near. 
He  seems  to  be  trying  to  talk  to  the  people.” 

See  Also:  Aurora  Martian;  Close  encounters  of  the 
third  kind;  Oleson’s  giants;  Smith;  Wilson 

Further  Reading 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  ed.,  1982.  The  Airship  File:  A 
Collection  of  Texts  Concerning  Phantom  Airships 
and  Other  UFOs,  Gathered  from  Newspapers  and 
Periodicals  Mostly  during  the  Hundred  Years  Prior 
to  Kenneth  Arnold’s  Sighting.  Bloomington,  IN: 
self-published. 


Migrants 

In  George  Hunt  Williamson’s  alternative  his¬ 
tory  Other  Tongues — Other  Flesh  (1953),  “Mi¬ 
grants”  are  spirit  beings  from  the  Sirius  Star  sys¬ 
tem.  They  arrived  on  Earth  during  the  Miocene 
Epoch  (between  twenty-five  and  thirteen  mil¬ 
lion  years  ago)  with  the  intention  of  looking  for 
bodies  to  inhabit.  At  first,  they  gave  serious  con¬ 
sideration  to  cats,  but  after  due  reflection  they 
decided  that  apes  were  more  likely  to  evolve  to¬ 
ward  intelligence,  civilization,  and  technology. 
In  the  meantime,  employing  their  vast  paranor¬ 
mal  powers,  the  Migrants  conjured  up 
grotesque  material  forms  for  themselves.  This 
period  is  known  among  extraterrestrial  histori¬ 
ans  of  Earth  as  the  “Great  Abomination.” 

Williamson  reported,  “The  abomination 
was  so  vast  that  forms  were  fusing  together 
into  monsters  having  no  purpose  but  self-de¬ 
struction.  Men  and  animals  were  growing  in¬ 
terchangeable  of  spirit  and  structure.  Man  was 
beastly  and  beast  was  manlike.”  These  abom¬ 
inable  entities  took  the  forms  of  the  creatures 
remembered  in  legend  and  mythology  as 
griffins,  centaurs,  dragons,  and  sphinxes. 
Eventually  the  “Host  on  the  Sirian  planets” 
could  take  no  more  of  this  insubordination. 
Men  were  to  be  men,  beasts  were  to  be  beasts, 
the  Host  declared  before  setting  loose  a  kind 
of  global  warming  that  melted  the  poles  and 
sparked  huge  floods.  “Monsters  and  anom¬ 
alies  were  destroyed,”  the  channeled  entity 
Elder  Brother  informed  Williamson.  “No 
longer  could  they  propagate.  Pure  species 
were  saved  and  pronounced  sterile  unto  all 
but  themselves.”  The  Migrants  lost  all  their 
psychokinetic  powers  and  became  normal  pri¬ 
mates.  They  began  engaging  in  sexual  unions 
with  ape-women,  and  out  of  these  alliances 
modern  Homo  sapiens  eventually  emerged. 

See  Also:  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1953.  Other  Tongues — 
Other  Flesh.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

Mince-Pie  Martians 

The  so-called  Mince-Pie  Martians  appeared  in 
a  kitchen  in  Rowley  Regis,  in  England’s  West 


176  Mince-Pie  Martians 


Midlands,  on  January  4,  1979,  to  star  in  what 
may  well  be  Britain’s  most  bizarre  close  en¬ 
counter  of  the  third  kind. 

At  6  A.M.,  Jean  Hingley,  forty-five  years 
old,  had  just  sent  her  husband  off  to  work 
when  she  noticed  a  light  outside.  Thinking 
the  carport  light  was  still  on,  she  went  out  to 
check.  She  was  unsettled  to  see  a  large  orange 
sphere  hovering  over  the  carport  roof.  She 
hurried  back  inside  and,  with  her  dog  Hobo, 
watched  the  UFO.  As  she  was  doing  so,  she 
noticed  that  the  dog  seemed  to  be  frozen  as  if 
paralyzed.  Suddenly  he  fell  over  sideways  and 
lay  there  motionless. 

At  that  moment,  three  winged  figures 
zipped  past  her,  leaving  Mrs.  Hingley  feeling 
cold  and  weak.  She  managed  to  follow  them 
into  the  living  room,  where  two  of  them  were 
shaking  the  Christmas  tree  so  hard  that  the 
fairy  atop  it  fell  to  the  floor.  The  figures  them¬ 
selves  looked  almost  fairylike.  Three  and  a 
half  feet  tall,  they  were  humanoids  with  wide, 
white  faces,  big,  dark  eyes,  no  noses,  slitlike 
mouths,  and  large  oval  wings  covered  with 
glittering  dots  of  various  colors.  Each  wore  a 
transparent  helmet  on  its  head;  at  the  top  of 
the  helmet  a  light  shone.  There  were  no  fin¬ 
gers  on  the  hands  or  feet  on  the  legs;  each  just 
tapered  to  a  point.  The  wings  did  not  move 
like  a  bird’s  but  fluttered  gently  or  folded  in 
like  a  concertina. 

Hingley  found  herself  paralyzed,  unable  to 
speak  or  move,  until  the  beings  spoke  to  her, 
saying,  “Nice?”  They  spoke  in  unison  with 
what  sounded  like  a  gruff,  masculine  voice. 
Then  she  could  move  and  talk  again.  When 
she  asked  where  they  were  from,  they  were 
silent.  They  sailed  around  the  room,  then 
landed  and  bounced  up  and  down  on  the 
couch.  She  shouted  at  them  to  stop,  and  they 
did,  though  this  would  be  the  last  time  they 
did  what  she  asked  them  to  do. 

The  episode  lasted  for  an  hour.  It  was  often 
difficult,  trying,  and  even  painful.  If  they  did 
not  like  what  she  had  to  say,  a  beam  would 
shoot  from  the  light  at  the  top  of  their  hel¬ 
mets  and  hit  her  on  the  forehead  just  above 
the  bridge  of  the  nose.  Sometimes  she  would 


be  blinded.  At  other  times  she  would  be  para¬ 
lyzed.  And  at  yet  other  times,  when  she  had 
addressed  them  with  a  seemingly  inoffensive 
question,  the  light  would  not  hurt  her.  They 
would  not  tell  her  why  they  shot  the  light  at 
her,  or  why  they  would  quote  back  to  her  any 
question  she  asked  them.  The  experience 
made  her  eyes  sore,  and  when  she  com¬ 
plained,  the  beings  insisted  they  did  not  in¬ 
tend  to  harm  her. 

When  she  inquired  again  about  their  place 
of  origin,  they  replied  this  time,  “From  the 
sky.”  Seeing  a  picture  of  Jesus  on  the  wall, 
they  flew  up  to  it  and  engaged  her  in  a  con¬ 
versation  about  him,  then  went  on  to  banal 
subjects  (a  British  entertainment  figure,  the 
Queen,  the  role  of  the  housewife,  children) 
before  returning  to  Jesus.  Then  they  floated 
slowly  around  the  room  picking  up  small  ob¬ 
jects,  including  cassette  tapes.  Hingley  told 
investigators,  “They  touched  all  the  Christ¬ 
mas  cards  and  all  the  furniture.  ...  I  think 
they  had  magnets  in  their  hands,  ’cause  they 
kept  lifting  things  that  they  touched.”  They 
asked  for  water.  In  response  she  filled  four 
glasses  and  put  them  on  a  tray,  along  with  sev¬ 
eral  mince  pies.  She  lifted  a  glass,  and  the  be¬ 
ings  lifted  theirs,  but  when  they  saw  her 
watching  them,  they  blinded  her  with  the 
light  beam.  The  next  thing  she  knew,  they 
were  putting  empty  glasses  down.  Next  she 
thought  of  offering  them  cigarettes  and  cigars 
that  they  were  looking  at.  When  she  lit  one, 
however,  the  beings  recoiled  in  fright.  She 
thought  they  were  afraid  of  fire. 

A  loud  noise  brought  her  to  the  window, 
where  she  saw  that  the  orange  UFO  was  back. 
The  beings  “put  their  hands  to  their  sides,” 
she  recalled.  “They  lifted  themselves  up,” 
pressing  buttons  on  their  chests,  and  “they 
glided  themselves  out.”  Each  was  holding  its 
mince  pie.  They  sailed  out  the  back  door  and 
entered  through  an  opening  in  the  UFO, 
which  flew  away  and  was  soon  lost  to  view. 

At  that  moment,  Hingley  suffered  “agony, 
pure  agony.  .  .  .  My  legs,  I  couldn’t  feel  them, 
and  then  I  was  wobbly,  and  very,  very  weak.  I 
grabbed  the  table.  I  slid  my  feet  along  the 


Monka  177 


carpet,  and  I  got  on  the  settee,  and  I  didn’t 
know  how  long  I  was  there.  Ooh!  I  was 
dead!”  (Budden,  1988).  She  lay  incapacitated 
until  five  o’clock  that  afternoon.  Finally,  her 
strength  was  sufficiently  restored  so  that  she 
was  able  to  phone  her  husband,  a  neighbor, 
and  the  police. 

Investigators  found  an  oval-shaped  im¬ 
pression  in  the  backyard  snow.  Hingley  com¬ 
plained  that  her  clock,  radio,  and  television 
were  no  longer  functioning.  The  cassette 
tapes  that  she  said  the  beings  had  touched 
were  ruined.  She  suffered  a  range  of  physical 
discomforts  in  her  eyes,  ears,  and  jaw.  Her 
doctor  became  alarmed  enough  about  her 
well-being  that  he  ordered  her  to  stay  home 
from  work  for  two  weeks.  As  outlandish  as 
her  story  sounded,  investigators  did  not 
doubt  her  sincerity. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 

Further  Reading 

Budden,  Alfred,  1988.  “The  Mince-Pie  Martians: 
The  Rowley  Regis  Case.”  Fortean  Times  50  (Sum¬ 
mer):  40-44. 


Miniature  pilots 

One  day  in  1929,  according  to  a  story  she 
told  many  years  later,  a  five-year-old  girl  and 
her  eight-year-old  brother  were  playing  in  the 
garden  of  their  Hertford,  Hertfordshire,  En¬ 
gland,  home  when  they  heard  an  engine 
sound.  It  was  coming  from  a  nearby  orchard 
and  over  the  garden  fence.  As  its  source  came 
into  view,  the  children  saw  a  tiny  biplane, 
with  a  wingspan  of  no  more  than  twelve  to  fif¬ 
teen  inches,  descend  and  land  briefly  by  a 
garbage  pail.  During  the  few  seconds  that  it 
was  on  the  ground,  both  children  got  a  clear 
view  of  a  figure  they  described  as  a  “perfectly 
proportioned  tiny  pilot  wearing  a  leather  fly¬ 
ing  helmet,”  who  they  said,  “waved  to  us  as  he 
took  off.” 

The  sight  so  unsettled  the  two  that  it  wasn’t 
until  they  were  well  into  their  adult  lives, 
around  I960,  that  they  spoke  of  it  to  each 
other.  “I  have  no  explanation  to  offer,”  the 
woman  said,  “but  I  do  know  that  this  was  not 


a  figment  of  my  imagination”  (Creighton, 
1970). 

In  a  UFO-age  counterpart  to  this  strange 
story,  a  Seattle  woman  reported  that  around  2 
A.M.  one  night  in  late  August  1965  she  awoke 
paralyzed.  Unable  to  speak  or  move,  she 
watched  helplessly  as  a  football-shaped  gray 
object  sailed  through  her  open  window  and 
hovered  over  a  carpet  in  her  bedroom.  As  the 
tiny  UFO  prepared  to  land,  three  tripod  legs 
dropped  from  it.  Once  settled  on  the  floor, 
the  UFO  let  out  a  ramp,  down  which  stepped 
five  or  six  miniature  beings  clad  in  tight-fit¬ 
ting  uniforms.  They  then  engaged  in  what  ap¬ 
peared  to  be  repair  work  on  their  craft.  On 
completing  the  job,  they  walked  up  the  ramp 
and  into  the  ship  and  flew  away.  At  that 
point,  the  witness  found  that  she  had  regained 
normal  mobility. 

It  seems  likely  that  this  second  incident  was 
a  hallucination  of  a  kind  frequently  associated 
with  sleep  paralysis. 

Further  Reading 

Creighton,  Gordon,  1970.  “A  Weird  Case  from  the 
Past.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  16,  4  (July/August): 
30. 

Hufford,  David  J.,  1982.  The  Terror  That  Comes  in 
the  Night:  An  Experience-Centered  Study  of  Super  - 
natural  Assault  Traditions.  Philadelphia,  PA:  Uni¬ 
versity  of  Pennsylvania  Press. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  UFOs:  Operation  Trojan  Horse. 
New  York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 


Monka 

Monka  first  surfaced  as  the  disembodied  voice 
of  a  Martian  on  a  tape  owned  by  contactee 
Dick  Miller.  Miller  played  the  message  at  the 
April  1956  Giant  Rock  Interplanetary  Space¬ 
craft  Convention,  telling  the  audience  that 
the  voice  had  mysteriously  appeared  on  a  tape 
inside  a  sealed  can.  The  message  had  Monka 
(“I  am  what  you  would  call  the  head  of  my 
government”)  promising,  “On  the  evening  of 
November  7,  of  this  your  year  1956,  at  10:30 
P.M.  your  local  time,  we  request  that  one  of 
your  communications  stations  remove  its  car¬ 
rier  signal  from  the  air  for  two  minutes” 
(“Mon-Ka  of  Mars,”  1956).  From  ten  thou- 


178  Mothman 


sand  feet  the  occupants  of  a  brilliantly  illumi¬ 
nated  spacecraft  would  speak  to  the  people  of 
Los  Angeles. 

The  message  electrified  occultists  and 
saucerians  in  California  and  elsewhere.  When 
played  in  London  in  September,  it  had  the 
same  effect  on  their  British  counterparts. 
Newspaper  coverage  mocked  the  tape  and 
message,  and  conservative  ufologists  dismissed 
the  message  as  a  silly  hoax.  On  November  2, 
the  Los  Angeles  Mirror-News  reported  that 
some  months  before,  while  living  in  Detroit, 
Miller  had  been  caught  faking  a  radio  message 
from  a  spaceman.  All  this  notwithstanding, 
the  Monka  message  spurred  two  mass  rallies 
in  Los  Angeles,  and  Monka  enthusiast  and 
rally  organizer  Gabriel  Green  appeared  on  the 
widely  viewed  House  Party  television  show  to 
spread  the  word  that  friendly  extraterrestrials 
would  be  talking  to  southern  California  on 
November  7. 

As  a  publicity  stunt,  two  area  radio  stations 
went  off  the  air  for  two  minutes  on  the  night 
in  question  as  hundreds  of  believers  gathered 
on  rooftops.  No  UFO  appeared,  of  course, 
but  Monka  would  live  on  in  channeled  mes¬ 
sages  from  hundreds  of  contactees  up  to  the 
present.  No  longer  a  Martian,  he  is  now  usu¬ 
ally  taken  as  a  close  associate  of  the  most 
beloved  and  ubiquitous  of  interdimensional 
channeling  entities,  Ashtar. 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  1981.  Book  of  Space  Con  - 
tacts.  New  York:  Global  Communications. 

Garrison,  Omar,  1956.  “Time  Flew  by,  but  That  Fly¬ 
ing  Saucer  Didn’t.”  Los  Angeles  Mirror-News  (No¬ 
vember  8). 

“Mon-Ka  of  Mars  Gives  Saucer  Research  a  Black 
Eye,”  1956.  CSI  News  Letter  6  (December  15): 
3-5. 

Tuella  [pseud,  of  Thelma  B.  Turrell],  ed.,  1989. 
Ashtar:  A  Tribute.  Third  edition.  Salt  Lake  City, 
UT:  Guardian  Action  Publications. 

Mothman 

Mothman,  a  monstrous  creature  reported  by 
dozens  of  witnesses  in  towns  along  the  Ohio 
River  Valley,  got  its  name  from  a  villain  in  the 


then-popular  Batman  television  series.  Though 
their  stories  received  little  public  attention,  at 
least  one  witness  claimed  to  have  had  a  kind  of 
communication  with  it. 

Mothman  first  appeared  in  the  local  press 
in  November  1966,  after  two  young  couples 
spotted  it  around  11:30  P.M.  while  driving 
through  an  abandoned  World  War  II  muni¬ 
tions  complex  known  locally  as  the  “TNT 
area.”  Gray  in  color  with  humanlike  legs,  the 
creature  had  glowing  red,  “hypnotic”  eyes 
and,  witness  Roger  Scarberry  said,  “was 
shaped  like  a  man,  but  bigger.  Maybe  six  and 
a  half  feet  tall.  And  it  had  big  wings  against  its 
back”  (Keel,  1975).  Terrified,  the  witnesses 
fled  in  their  car  only  to  spot  the  same  or  a 
similar  creature  on  a  hill  by  the  road.  That 
creature  spread  its  batlike  wings  and  pursued 
the  vehicle  at  speeds  of  up  to  one  hundred 
miles  per  hour.  All  the  while,  it  made  a 
squeaking  sound.  As  they  sped  toward  Point 
Pleasant,  West  Virginia,  where  they  would  tell 
their  story  to  a  deputy  sheriff,  they  noticed  a 
large,  dead  dog  along  the  side  of  the  road. 

This  last  detail  would  seem  significant  to 
later  investigators  after  they  learned  of  the 
experience  that  had  happened  an  hour  before 
to  Newell  Partridge  from  rural  Salem,  West 
Virginia.  Partridge  had  been  watching  televi¬ 
sion  when  suddenly  he  saw  an  unfamiliar 
kind  of  interference  on  the  screen.  In  the 
meantime,  he  could  hear  his  dog  Bandit 
howling  strangely.  When  he  picked  up  a 
flashlight  and  stepped  outside,  he  was 
shocked  to  see — at  one  hundred  fifty  yards’ 
distance — the  dog  circling  a  shadowy  figure 
with  glowing  red  eyes  that  did  not  look  like 
an  animal’s.  Something  about  the  scene 
struck  Partridge  as  deeply  abnormal,  and  he 
felt  cold  chills  running  down  his  back.  Just 
as  he  was  about  to  go  inside,  Bandit  charged 
the  intruder,  ignoring  his  master,  who  was 
trying  to  restrain  him.  Partridge  went  inside 
to  get  a  gun  but  could  not  bring  himself  to 
go  outside  again.  He  went  to  sleep.  The  next 
morning  he  discovered  that  Bandit  was  miss¬ 
ing.  Later,  when  he  read  a  newspaper  ac¬ 
count  of  the  Point  Pleasant  incident,  the  ref- 


Mount  Lassen  179 


erence  to  a  dead  dog  struck  him.  Bandit  was 
never  seen  again. 

Other  witnesses  reported  seeing  “Moth- 
man,”  as  the  press  soon  dubbed  it,  in  the 
TNT  area  and  elsewhere.  Sightings  continued 
from  time  to  time  for  months  afterward.  Re¬ 
ports  consistently  described  a  gray  entity 
larger  than  a  man,  who  was  headless  and  had 
wings,  legs,  and  glowing  red  eyes  on  its  upper 
chest.  When  in  flight,  its  wings  did  not  flap. 
When  it  walked,  it  had  a  shambling  gait.  Ob¬ 
servers  seemed  especially  terrified  of  the  eyes. 
Because  of  the  witnesses’  manifest  sincerity 
and  terror,  no  one  argued  that  the  sightings 
were  hoaxes.  The  most  popular  conventional 
explanations  held  that  they  had  seen  owls  or 
sandhill  cranes.  The  episode  became  the  sub¬ 
ject  of  two  books. 

In  May  1976,  nearly  a  decade  after  the 
scare  had  run  its  course,  representatives  of  the 
Ohio  UFO  Investigators  League  looked  up 
some  of  the  witnesses.  All  stuck  by  their  orig¬ 
inal  testimony  and  insisted  that  they  had  not 
mistaken  ordinary  birds  for  Mothman.  The 
most  curious  testimony  came  from  early  wit¬ 
ness  Linda  Scarberry  (wife  of  Roger  Scar- 
berry),  who  said  that  she  and  her  husband 
had  seen  the  creature  “hundreds  of  times,” 
one  from  as  close  as  three  or  four  feet.  She 
went  on, 

It  seems  like  it  doesn’t  want  to  hurt  you.  It  just 
wants  to  communicate  with  you.  But  you’re 
too  afraid  when  you  see  it  to  do  anything.  .  .  . 
We  rented  an  apartment  down  on  Thirteenth 
Street,  and  the  bedroom  window  was  right  off 
the  roof.  It  was  sitting  on  the  roof  one  night, 
looking  in  the  window,  and  by  then  I  was  so 
used  to  seeing  it  that  I  just  pulled  the  blinds 
and  went  on.  I  felt  kind  of  sorry  for  it  [be¬ 
cause]  it  gives  you  the  feeling  like  it  was  sitting 
there  wishing  it  could  come  in  and  get  warm 
because  it  was  cold  out  that  night.  (Raynes, 
1976) 

A  Mothmanlike  creature  was  also  involved 
in  a  close  encounter  of  the  third  kind  from 
Sandling  Park,  near  Hyde,  Kent,  England,  on 
November  16,  1963.  That  evening  a  group  of 


young  people  saw  a  glowing  oval,  some  fifteen 
to  twenty  feet  in  diameter,  hovering  over  a 
field.  A  few  seconds  after  the  UFO  disap¬ 
peared  behind  a  clump  of  trees,  witness  John 
Flaxton  related,  “a  dark  figure  shambled  out.  It 
was  all  black,  about  the  size  of  a  human  but 
without  a  head.  It  seemed  to  have  wings  like  a 
bat  on  either  side  and  came  stumbling  towards 
us.  We  didn’t  wait  to  investigate”  (“The  Salt- 
wood  Mystery,”  1964).  This  is  the  only  known 
report  to  link  such  a  creature  with  a  UFO. 

Whatever  Mothman  may  or  may  not  have 
been,  no  encounters  with  it  have  been  re¬ 
ported  in  recent  years. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 

Further  Reading 

Barker,  Gray,  1970.  The  Silver  Bridge.  Clarksburg, 
WV:  Saucerian  Books. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  Strange  Creatures  from  Time  and 
Space.  Greenwich,  CT:  Fawcett  Gold  Medal. 

- ,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New  York: 

Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and  Com¬ 
pany. 

Raynes,  Brent  M.,  1976.  “West  Virginia  Revisited.” 
Ohio  Sky  Watcher  (January/February/March): 
9-10. 

“The  Saltwood  Mystery,”  1964.  Flying  Saucer  Revietv 
10,  2  (March/ April):  1 1-12. 

Mount  Lassen 

Mount  Lassen,  in  California’s  Tehama  County, 
houses  good  and  evil  beings  who  live  deep  in¬ 
side  caves  and  engage  in  conflict  with  ad¬ 
vanced  weapons,  according  to  the  testimony  of 
a  man  identified  as  Ralph  B.  Fields. 

At  some  unspecified  time,  apparently,  in 
the  latter  twentieth  century,  Fields  and  a  com¬ 
panion  named  Joe  (no  last  name  offered)  went 
to  the  mountain  in  search  of  guano  (bat 
dung),  which  they  hoped  to  market  as  fertil¬ 
izer.  On  their  first  night,  the  two  slept  at  the 
foot  of  the  mountain.  By  the  third  day,  they 
were  nearing  the  mountaintop  when  they  de¬ 
cided  to  make  camp  and  prepare  a  meal.  Joe 
went  off  to  collect  dead  scrub  bush  for  the 
fire.  Suddenly,  he  returned  in  a  state  of  high 
excitement.  He  had  found  a  big  cave  nearby, 
and  it  looked  like  a  promising  place  to  search 
for  the  object  of  their  quest. 


A  Morlock  (with  victim)  as  depicted  in  the  I960  movie  version  ofH.  G.  Wells’s  The  Time  Machine  (Photofest) 


The  deeper  the  two  went  into  the  cave,  the  yards  ahead  to  a  point  where  the  wall  bent, 

deeper  it  seemed.  Once  they  got  twenty  feet  They  followed  the  bend  off  to  the  left  and 

into  it,  the  walls  expanded  to  ten  feet  wide  down,  and  they  kept  going  until  suddenly,  re- 

and  eight  feet  high.  They  could  see  a  hundred  alizing  how  far  they  were  from  the  surface, 


Mount  Shasta  181 


they  began  to  get  nervous.  Besides  that,  there 
was  no  evidence  of  guano.  Still  curious,  they 
decided  to  plow  ahead  and  kept  walking  for 
another  mile  or  two.  Then,  with  the  aid  of 
their  flashlights,  they  made  an  amazing  dis¬ 
covery:  the  floor  was  worn  smooth,  and  the 
cavern  walls  and  ceiling  seemed  cut  artificially. 
What  had  seemed  a  cave  now  looked  more 
like  a  tunnel. 

A  light  flashed,  and  three  men  confronted 
Fields  and  Joe.  The  men  were  of  normal  ap¬ 
pearance,  seemingly  around  fifty  years  of  age, 
dressed  in  jeans  and  flannel  shirts.  Only  their 
shoes,  with  their  unusually  thick  soles,  looked 
out  of  the  ordinary.  One  of  the  strangers 
asked  what  they  were  doing  there,  but  he 
acted  as  if  he  did  not  believe  the  two  men’s  an¬ 
swer.  Two  more  strangers  showed  up.  The 
guano-hunters  were  badly  frightened,  con¬ 
vinced  that  they  had  fallen  into  the  hands  of  a 
criminal  gang  in  hiding.  Their  fears  only  rose 
when  one  of  the  band  told  them  that  they 
should  accompany  them  deeper  into  the  cave. 

About  two  miles  later,  they  came  to  a  spot 
where  the  walls  expanded.  There  they  encoun¬ 
tered  a  strange  device  that  looked  like  a  tobog¬ 
gan  with  a  seat  and  a  control  panel.  It  gave  off 
a  buzzing  sound.  The  group  sat  on  the  wide 
seat  and  flew  off  at  a  “terrific”  speed.  After  a 
journey  of  some  considerable  distance,  they 
saw  a  similar  machine  approaching  them. 
Suddenly  acting  nervous,  they  maneuvered 
their  machine  to  a  stop.  It  landed  two  feet 
from  the  other  one.  The  crew  of  the  first  ship 
leaped  out  and  tried  to  run  away,  but  the  crew 
of  the  second,  who  were  carrying  pencil-like 
weapons,  shot  them  down,  killing  all  of  them. 

Certain  of  their  imminent  doom,  Fields 
and  Joe  watched  as  the  new  group  approached 
them.  One  member  asked  if  they  were  “sur¬ 
face  people.”  After  telling  him  that  they  had 
come  from  there  just  recently,  the  stranger 
went  on  to  say  that  they  were  lucky  they  had 
been  rescued.  “You  would  have  also  become 
horloks,  and  then  we  would  have  had  to  kill 
you  also.”  The  man  spoke  in  a  friendly  man¬ 
ner,  giving  Fields  the  confidence  to  ask  what 
was  going  on.  All  the  man  would  say  was  that 


surface  people  “are  not  ready  to  have  the 
things  that  the  ancients  have  left. .  .  .  How¬ 
ever,  there  are  a  great  many  evil  people  here 
who  create  many  unpleasant  things  for  both 
us  and  the  surface  people.  They  are  safe  be¬ 
cause  no  one  on  the  surface  believes  that  we 
exist.” 

Ralph  and  Joe  were  flown  back  to  the  sur¬ 
face  and  warned  never  to  return.  Fields  says, 
“We  had  been  told  just  enough  for  me  to  be¬ 
lieve  that  down  there  somewhere  there  were 
and  are  things  that  might  baffle  the  greatest 
minds  of  this  Earth.  Sometimes  I  am  tempted 
to  go  back  into  that  cave  if  I  could  again  find 
it,  which  I  doubt,  but  then  I  know  the  warn¬ 
ing  I  heard  in  there  might  be  too  true”  (Com¬ 
mander  X,  1990). 

It  may  be  worth  noting  that  H.  G.  Wells’s 
famous  science-fiction  novel  The  Time  Ma  - 
chine  (1895)  features  a  race  of  violent  subter¬ 
ranean  humans  known  as  Morlocks. 

See  Also:  Brodies  deros;  Hollow  earth;  Mount 
Shasta;  Shaver  mystery 

Further  Reading 

Commander  X  [pseud,  of  Jim  Keith],  1990.  Under  - 
ground  Alien  Bases.  New  Brunswick,  NJ:  Abelard 
Publications. 

Mount  Shasta 

Mount  Shasta  in  northern  California,  near  the 
Oregon  border,  is  the  scene  of  occult  legends 
that  go  back  to  the  nineteenth  century.  Even 
before  white  settlers  arrived  in  the  region  in 
1827,  however,  local  Indian  tribes  believed 
that  giant  creatures,  apparently  of  the 
Sasquatch  variety,  lived  in  caves  on  the  moun¬ 
tain.  The  giants  were  feared  because  of  their 
habit  of  capturing  individuals  and  taking 
them  to  their  caves,  where  they  would  squeeze 
their  victims  to  death.  Another  race  of  beings, 
small,  usually  invisible  entities  akin  to  fairies, 
also  called  Shasta  their  home,  according  to 
tribal  traditions. 

But  it  took  Frederick  Spencer  Oliver  of 
nearby  Yreka,  California,  to  put  the  mountain 
on  the  mystical  map.  In  the  mid  1880s, 
Oliver,  then  in  his  teens,  produced  a  novel,  A 
Dweller  on  Two  Planets,  which  he  claimed  an 


A  nineteenth-century  engraving  of  Mount  Shasta,  California,  the  scene  of  occult  legends  from  far  back  in  the  past  (Library 
of  Congress) 


entity  named  Phylos  the  Tibetan  had  dictated 
to  him.  In  fact,  when  the  novel  was  published 
in  1899,  Phylos,  not  Oliver,  was  identified  as 
the  author.  Phylos  said  he  had  experienced 
several  incarnations,  including  one  in  Atlantis 
and  another  on  Venus.  In  his  most  recent  one, 
during  the  mid-century  California  gold  rush, 
he  (“he”  being  Walter  Pierson,  the  name  he 
held  during  that  lifetime)  met  Quong,  a  Chi¬ 
nese  man.  Quong,  a  knower  of  mystical  se¬ 
crets,  led  Pierson  into  Shasta  via  a  hidden  tun¬ 
nel.  Inside  the  mountain  they  found  huge 
chambers  and  treasures  belonging  to  a  secret 
brotherhood  of  advanced  beings  who  had 
lived  there  for  a  very  long  time,  devoting 
themselves  to  humanity’s  spiritual  betterment. 
In  his  astral  body,  Pierson  traveled  to  Venus, 
where  he  learned  many  secrets;  he  also  learned 
of  his  previous  lives.  Once  enlightened,  he 
was  rechristened  Phylos  and  became  a 
guardian  of  the  cosmos.  A  modem  chronicler 
remarks  that  the  “Tibetan”  part  of  his  title 
“seems  to  have  been  added  for  Mystery’s  sake” 
(Kafton-Minkel,  1989). 


Oliver’s  novel  owed  much  of  its  inspiration 
to  Madame  Blavatsky’s  theological  writings 
and  to  works  of  mystical  fantasy  such  as  Ed¬ 
ward  Bulwer-Lytton’s  Zanoni:  A  Rosicrucian 
Tale  and  Marie  Corelli’s  A  Romance  of  Two 
Worlds.  It  was  original,  however,  in  setting  a 
secret  civilization  within  Mount  Shasta.  The 
next  writer  to  do  so,  Harvey  Spencer  Lewis 
(writing  as  “Wishar  C.  Cerve”),  identified  the 
inhabitants  as  survivors  of  Lemuria,  the  Pa¬ 
cific  Ocean’s  version  of  Atlantis.  According  to 
Lewis’s  Lemuria:  Lost  Continent  of  the  Pacific 
(1931),  when  Lemuria  split  and  sank,  its  east 
coast  crashed  into  part  of  North  America’s 
west  coast  to  become  the  states  of  Washing¬ 
ton,  Oregon,  and  California.  Many  of  the  sur¬ 
viving  Lemurians  took  up  residence  inside 
Shasta. 

Lewis  claimed  that  persons  living  near 
Shasta  occasionally  encountered  distin¬ 
guished-looking  men  in  white  robes  as  they 
walked  out  of  the  forest.  Sometimes  these  be¬ 
ings,  who  stood  seven  feet  tall,  did  business  in 
local  stores,  using  gold  nuggets  to  make  their 


Mount  Shasta  183 


purchases  and  refusing  change.  The  strangers 
had  long,  curly  hair,  and  on  their  large  fore¬ 
heads  there  were  bulges  visible  with  “special 
decoration”  over  them  covering  their  third 
eyes.  Along  the  thick  forests  on  Shasta’s  east¬ 
ern  flank,  the  Lemurians  had  built  great  mar¬ 
ble  temples.  On  some  evenings  they  held  mys¬ 
tical  celebrations  at  which  they  lit  big  fires  and 
danced.  They  also  raised  odd-looking  cattle. 
They  flew  “peculiarly  shaped  boats  which 
have  flown  out  of  this  region  high  in  the  air 
over  the  hills  and  valleys  ...  to  the  waters  of 
the  Pacific  Ocean.”  Mostly,  however,  the 
Lemurians  managed  to  keep  themselves  and 
their  activities  invisible,  setting  up  energy 
walls  that  effectively  concealed  them  from 
prying  eyes. 

The  American  branch  of  the  Rosicrucians, 
headquartered  in  San  Jose,  published  Lewis’s 
book.  During  the  1930s,  it  also  sponsored  ex¬ 
peditions  that  sought  to  locate  the  secret  en¬ 
trances  to  Shasta.  Articles  in  Rosicrucian  Di  - 
gest  discussed  the  mountain’s  “mysteries.” 
Then  on  May  22,  1932,  the  Los  Angeles  Times’ 
Sunday  magazine  ran  a  destined-to-be-influ- 
ential  piece  by  Edward  Lanser.  Lanser  claimed 
that  while  taking  a  train  trip  on  the  Shasta 
Limited  on  his  way  to  Portland,  he  observed 
mysterious  lights  on  Shasta  in  the  early  dawn. 
The  conductor  told  him  that  “the  Lemurians” 
were  holding  ceremonies.  On  his  way  back  to 
Portland,  Lanser  wrote,  Lanser  spent  time  in 
the  Shasta  area  and  found  that  nearly  every¬ 
one  there  took  the  reality  of  the  Lemurians  for 
granted.  “Business  men,  amateur  explorers, 
officials,  and  ranchers  in  the  country  sur¬ 
rounding  Shasta  spoke  freely  of  the  commu¬ 
nity,  and  all  attested  to  the  weird  rituals  that 
are  performed  on  the  mountainside  after  sun¬ 
set,  midnight  and  sunrise,”  he  wrote  (De 
Camp,  1980).  The  Lemurians  performed 
these  rituals  to  celebrate  their  escape  to  “Gau¬ 
tama”  (North  America).  He  asserted  that 
“Prof.  Edgar  Lucien  Larkin,”  whom  he  char¬ 
acterized  as  a  famous  astronomer,  had  actually 
been  able  to  observe  Lemurians  and  their 
temples  through  a  telescope.  Larkin  was  in  re¬ 
ality  an  occult  buff  who  had  died  some  eight 


years  earlier.  Though  widely  quoted  since, 
Lanser’s  story  was  a  hoax  or — more  to  the 
point — a  tongue-in-cheek  exercise  satirizing 
the  curious  beliefs  the  mystically  minded  were 
circulating  about  a  beautiful  but  otherwise  or¬ 
dinary  natural  monument. 

In  Unveiled  Mysteries  (1934)  Guy  Warren 
Ballard,  writing  as  Godre  Ray  King,  reported 
that  in  1930,  while  working  as  a  mining  engi¬ 
neer  at  Shasta,  he  met  Saint  Germain,  an  im¬ 
mortal  being  who  gave  him  a  creamy  liquid  to 
drink.  The  liquid,  Saint  Germain  explained, 
was  “Life — Omnipresent  Life.”  Many  other 
encounters  followed,  and  Ballard  (who  died  in 
1939)  soon  formed  the  I  AM  Activity,  a  noto¬ 
rious  cultlike  organization  that  combined 
Theosophical  doctrine  with  fascist  ideology. 
Around  the  same  time,  occultist  Maurice  Do- 
real  was  detailing  his  own  Shasta  experiences, 
which  were  with  the  Atlanteans  who  lived  in  a 
colony  seven  miles  beneath  the  mountain. 
Though  the  colony  had  only  three  hundred 
fifty-three  inhabitants,  it  dominated  the 
Lemurians,  four  and  a  half  million  of  whom 
lived,  essentially,  as  prisoners  of  the  Atlanteans 
even  deeper  under  Shasta.  Doreal  was  unique 
in  his  depiction  of  the  Lemurians  as  evil  and 
dangerous. 

As  Shasta’s  legends  continued  to  expand,  it 
was  said  that  the  mountain’s  interior  housed 
two  magnificent  Lemurian  cities,  Uetheleme 
and  Yaktayvia.  The  latter,  some  said,  was  the 
source  of  beautiful  bell  sounds,  which  some 
had  professed  to  hear  emanating  from  the 
mountain.  The  Yaktayvians  are  master  bell 
builders.  All  the  while,  occult  pilgrims  were 
arriving  in  growing  numbers  to  the  area; 
many  would  stay.  Some  claimed  to  have  seen 
and  communicated  with  Lemurians  and 
other  extraordinary  beings.  Others  reported 
UFO  sightings  on  the  mountain.  Believers 
explained  the  phenomena  as  Lemurian  air¬ 
craft  or  visiting  extraterrestrial  spacecraft  call¬ 
ing  on  their  friends  inside  the  mountain.  At 
least  one  person,  Nola  Van  Valer,  swore  that 
she  had  met  Phylos  the  Tibetan  on  the 
mountain.  On  another  occasion  she  spoke 
with  Saint  Germain. 


184  Mr.  X 


See  Also:  Atlantis;  Bonnie;  Fairies  encountered; 
Lemuria;  Shaver  mystery 

Further  Reading 

Commander  X  [pseud,  of  Jim  Keith],  1990.  Under  - 
ground  Alien  Bases.  New  Brunswick,  NJ:  Abelard 
Productions. 

De  Camp,  L.  Sprague,  1980.  The  Ragged  Edge  of  Sci  - 
ence.  Philadelphia,  PA:  Owlswick  Press. 

Frank,  Emilie  A.,  1998.  Afo  Shasta,  California’s Mys  - 
tic  Mountain.  Hilt,  CA:  Photografix  Publishing. 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
1 00, 000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwarfs,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races,  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

Tierney,  Richard  L.,  1983.  “America’s  Mystical 
Mount  Shasta.”  Fate  36,  8  (August):  70-76. 


Mr.  X 

On  the  afternoon  of  November  5,  1957, 
Reinhold  Schmidt,  a  grain  buyer  with  a 
prison  record,  allegedly  encountered  the 
crew  of  a  landed  flying  saucer  along  the 
banks  of  Nebraska’s  Platte  River.  Two 
crewmembers  ushered  him  inside,  where  he 
met  two  other  men  and  two  women,  all  of 
whom  spoke  “high  German”  to  one  another 
and  German-inflected  English  to  Schmidt. 
Their  captain  identified  himself  as  “Mr.  X.” 
After  a  brief  conversation  about  America’s 
satellite  program,  Schmidt  left  the  craft, 
which  then  departed. 

When  Schmidt  reported  his  encounter  to 
the  sheriff’s  office  in  nearby  Kearney,  officers 
went  to  the  site  and  found  footprints  as  well 
as  a  greasy  substance  at  the  supposed  landing 
site.  They  also  located  two  empty  oil  cans  not 
far  away,  leading  them  to  suspect  a  hoax.  After 
being  held  overnight  in  jail,  Schmidt  was  ex¬ 
amined  by  two  psychiatrists  and  pronounced 
mentally  ill.  He  spent  a  few  days  in  the  Hast¬ 
ings  State  Hospital  before  being  released. 

Thereafter,  he  pursued  a  career  on  the  con- 
tactee  scene,  claiming  further  contacts  with 
Mr.  X  and  his  associates,  who  he  learned  were 
from  Saturn.  His  space  friends  flew  him 
around  the  world,  to  Egypt,  to  the  Antarctic, 
and  elsewhere.  It  all  ended,  however,  after  he 
told  a  California  widow  that  from  a  spaceship 
he  had  seen  quartz  crystals  with  healing  pow¬ 


ers  and  persuaded  her  to  invest  in  a  worthless 
mining  venture.  At  a  trial  in  Oakland  in  Oc¬ 
tober  1961,  a  young  astronomer  named  Carl 
Sagan  assured  the  jury  that  human  life  could 
not  exist  on  Saturn.  Schmidt  received  a  one- 
to  ten-year  sentence  for  grand  theft. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

‘“Flying  Saucer’  Figure  Convicted,”  1961.  Oakland 
[California]  Tribune,  October  27. 

“The  Kearney,  Nebraska,  ‘Contact’  Claim,”  1957. 
CSI News  Letter  10  (December  15):  12-13. 

Schmidt,  Reinhold  O.,  1963.  The  Edge  of  Tomorrow: 
A  True  Account  of  Experiences  with  Visitors  from 
Another  Planet.  Hollywood,  CA:  self-published. 

MU  the  Mantis  Being 

A  West  Virginia  woman  who  prefers  to  use 
the  pseudonym  Rebecca  Grant  says  she  has 
had  a  lifetime  of  paranormal  experiences,  in¬ 
cluding  missing-time  episodes  and  apparent 
UFO  abductions.  When  she  was  forty  years 
old,  aliens  revealed  themselves  to  her.  At  first 
the  communications  were  purely  telepathic. 
After  two  years  they  began  to  appear  physi¬ 
cally  to  her.  These  appearances,  always  brief, 
at  first  frightened  her,  but  in  due  course  she 
became  friendly  with  a  being  who  looked  like 
a  giant  praying  mantis,  a  kind  of  entity  some¬ 
times  reported  by  abductees.  The  mantis 
being,  apparently  possessing  a  sense  of  humor, 
conveyed  the  idea  that  he  would  like  to  be 
called  MU,  short  for  “Master  of  the  Uni¬ 
verse,”  though  Grant  said  she  would  prefer 
that  he  be  “MU-Bug ...  to  help  keep  things 
in  perspective.”  MU  communicates  telepathi- 
cally  and  is  not  physically  present  during  the 
communications. 

MU  told  her  that  he  and  his  race  had  helped 
life  evolve  on  Earth.  Close  to  one  hundred  dif¬ 
ferent  alien  groups  visit  Earth,  some  from  other 
places  in  the  galaxy,  some  from  parallel  uni¬ 
verses.  They  are  on  Earth  because  of  their  con¬ 
cern  about  what  human  beings  are  doing  to  the 
planet’s  environment.  Though  they  possess  the 
means  to  do  so,  they  are  not  repairing  the  dam¬ 
age  because  humans  have  to  learn  to  do  that 
themselves;  alien  help  would  only  prolong  hu- 


Muller’s  Martians  185 


manitys  existence.  “We  might  survive  long 
enough  to  find  an  even  grander  way  to  destroy 
ourselves,”  Grant  says  MU  has  observed,  “one 
that  could  harm  worlds  other  than  our  own. 
These  beings  feel  that .  .  .  they  would  be  con¬ 
demning  themselves  to  a  violent  confrontation 
with  us  in  the  future.”  The  aliens  have  taken  a 
middle  course.  They  abduct  people  and  remove 
some  of  their  DNA,  combining  it  with  the 
DNA  of  various  alien  races;  thus,  “something 
of  the  human  race  will  continue.”  Others  are 
trying  to  implant  spiritual  beliefs  and  psychic 
perceptions  into  the  brains  of  humans  in  the 
hope  that  greater  wisdom  will  lead  them  to  sur¬ 
vival  and  peace. 

According  to  MU,  alien  science  indicates 
that  Earth  faces  a  bleak  future  of  ecological 
collapse,  geophysical  cataclysms,  and  political 
and  social  upheaval,  which  may  lead  to 
atomic  and  biological  warfare.  None  of  this  is 
certain,  only  probable.  If  these  things  happen, 
MU  says,  the  aliens  may  “remove  a  group  of 
women  and  children  from  the  surface  of  the 
Earth  to  protect  them  for  the  purposes  of  pro¬ 
creation.”  These  would  all  be  abductees  whose 
genetic  make-up  had  already  been  altered. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Insectoids 

Further  Reading 

Lewels,  Joe,  1997.  The  God  Hypothesis:  Extraterres  - 
trial  Life  and  Its  Implications  for  Science  and  Reli  - 
gion.  Mill  Spring,  NC:  Wild  Flower  Press. 


Muller’s  Martians 

A  medium’s  contacts  with  Martians  are  the 
subject  of  a  classic  early  work  on  abnormal 
psychology,  Theodore  Flournoy’s  From  India 
to  the  Planet  Mars  (1899).  Flournoy,  a  promi¬ 
nent  Swiss  psychologist,  gives  the  medium  the 
pseudonym  Helene  Smith  in  his  book,  but 
her  real  name  was  Catherine  Elise  Muller. 


Born  in  1861,  Muller  possessed  a  consider¬ 
able  imagination  and  a  keen  intelligence.  She 
grew  up  in  a  family  in  which  psychic  and  vi¬ 
sionary  experiences  were  common,  and  she 
herself  had  a  number  of  them.  Friends  drew 
her  attention  to  spiritism,  and  soon  she  be¬ 
came  a  medium.  Through  her,  such  historical 
figures  as  the  great  novelist  Victor  Hugo  and 
the  legendary  occultist  Cagliostro  spoke,  spin¬ 
ning  what  Flournoy  characterizes  as  “complex 
sagas.”  Her  Martian  adventures  began  only 
after  a  friend  remarked,  in  her  presence,  on 
something  he  had  read  recently.  It  was  a  state¬ 
ment  by  the  popular  science  writer  Camille 
Flammarion  that  “Martian  humankind  and 
Earth  humankind  may  one  day  enter  into 
communication  with  the  other.”  The  friend 
expressed  the  hope  that  such  a  thing  would 
happen. 

Soon  afterward,  Muller  informed  him  that 
she  had  made  contact  with  Martians.  These 
encounters  occurred  in  a  variety  of  mental 
states,  including  sleep.  Flournoy  was  led  to 
the  conclusion  that,  at  least  at  some  level  of 
her  psyche,  Muller  was  always  living  with  the 
Martians.  The  communications  and  experi¬ 
ences  were  voluminous.  She  had  many  Mart¬ 
ian  friends  and  was  often  on  that  planet  inter¬ 
acting  with  them  and  observing  everything 
around  her.  She  even  produced,  albeit  in 
piecemeal  fashion,  a  Martian  language  that 
Flourney  recognized  as  an  “infantile  travesty 
of  French.” 

See  Also:  Allingham’s  Martian;  Aurora  Martian; 
Brown’s  Martians;  Flopkins’s  Martians;  Khauga; 
Martian  bees;  Monka;  Shaw’s  Martians;  Smead’s 
Martians;  Wilcox’s  Martians 

Further  Reading 

Flournoy,  Theodore,  1963.  From  India  to  the  Planet 
Mars:  A  Study  of  a  Case  of  Somnambidism  with 
Glossolalia.  New  Hyde  Park,  NY:  University 
Books. 


Noma 

In  1961,  investigating  the  Brown  Mountain 
lights  (believed  by  most  authorities  to  be  re¬ 
fractions  of  distant  light  sources  such  as  pass¬ 
ing  automobiles)  near  Morgan  ton,  North 
Carolina,  Ralph  Lael  discovered  that  if  he  sent 
telepathic  messages  to  the  lights,  they  would 
respond.  One  light  urged  him  to  enter  a  door 
concealed  on  the  mountainside,  where  the  en¬ 
tities  responsible  for  the  lights  operated.  Lael 
passed  into  an  eight-foot-square  room  with 
transparent  walls.  There  a  voice  told  him  that 
the  human  race  had  come  into  being  on  a 
planet  once  known  as  Pewam,  now  the  aster¬ 
oid  belt  between  Mars  and  Jupiter.  On  a  sub¬ 
sequent  visit  not  long  afterward,  Lael  boarded 
a  flying  saucer  and  was  taken  to  Venus.  There, 
besides  meeting  the  direct  descendants  of  Pe- 
wamites,  he  encountered  a  lovely,  scantily  clad 
woman  named  Noma.  His  hosts  also  showed 
him  footage  of  Pewam’s  destruction  and  of 
early  Earth  humans. 

Further  Reading 

Machlin,  Milt,  and  Timothy  Green  Beckley,  1981. 

UFO.  New  York:  Quick  Fox. 


Nordics 

Nordic  is  a  name  given  to  a  kind  of  alien 
being  reported  in  UFO  encounters  that  range 


from  contact  claims  to  close  encounters  of  the 
third  kind  to  abductions.  The  term  did  not, 
however,  come  into  general  use  among  ufolo¬ 
gists  until  the  1980s.  Nordics  are  said  to  re¬ 
semble  Scandinavians,  at  least  in  a  generic 
sense;  they  are  tall,  blond,  fair-skinned 
(though  sometimes  described  as  deeply 
tanned),  and  attractive-looking.  Witnesses 
often  claim  that  their  eyes  are  different  from 
northern  Europeans  in  being  somewhat 
slanted  or  even  almond-shaped. 

The  beings  that  would  later  be  called 
Nordics  were  first  known  as  Space  Brothers — 
often,  though  not  always,  from  Venus — when 
1950s  contactees  such  as  George  Adamski  and 
Howard  Menger  reported  meetings  with 
friendly  extraterrestrials,  with  whom  they 
traveled  into  space  and  had  other  adventures. 
Though  conservative  ufologists  rejected  these 
claims  as  absurd  hoaxes,  generally  similar  fig¬ 
ures  were  reported  in  the  testimony  of  wit¬ 
nesses  who  did  not  fit  the  contactees’  flam¬ 
boyant  profiles. 

In  one  such  incident,  a  farmer  near  Linha 
Vista,  Brazil,  while  working  in  a  field  heard  a 
sewing-machine  sound.  When  he  looked  to 
its  source,  it  turned  out  to  be  a  strange  craft, 
“shaped  like  a  tropical  helmet,”  hovering 
nearby.  A  man  could  be  seen  inside  the  UFO, 
another  stood  near  a  fence,  and  a  third  was 


187 


188  Nostradamus 


approaching  the  witness,  who  was  sufficiently 
startled  to  drop  his  hoe.  The  being  smiled  and 
picked  up  the  hoe,  handing  it  back  to  the 
farmer  before  he  and  his  companions  returned 
to  the  ship  and  flew  away.  The  beings,  clad  in 
light  brown  coveralls,  had  long  blond  hair, 
pale  skin,  and  slanted  eyes.  The  farmer,  who 
knew  nothing  of  flying  saucers,  thought  the 
craft  and  its  occupants  were  from  the  United 
States. 

Typically  in  these  kinds  of  close  encoun¬ 
ters,  the  Nordics  were  not  communicative, 
just  silent  and  distant;  they  were  not  un¬ 
friendly  but  not  forthcoming  either.  Ufolo¬ 
gists  collected  hundreds  of  such  accounts 
from  all  over  the  world.  As  abduction  reports 
rose  to  prominence  in  later  years,  Nordics 
showed  up  in  many  stories,  almost  always 
seen  in  association  with  little  gray  aliens  and 
in  circumstances  that  suggested  that  they  oc¬ 
cupied  a  higher  position  in  the  otherworldly 
chain  of  command  than  did  their  smaller  fel¬ 
lows.  One  writer  on  the  abduction  phenome¬ 
non,  David  M.  Jacobs,  believes  that  “the  evi¬ 
dence  clearly  suggests  that  the  Nordics  are 
most  probably  adult  hybrids,  the  products  of 
human/alien  mating”  (Jacobs,  1998). 

Nordics  live  on  in  current  contactee  lore, 
where  they  are  assumed  to  be  genuine  extrater¬ 
restrials,  perhaps  representing  the  race  that 
seeded  the  Earth  and  gave  rise  to  modern  Homo 
sapiens.  Nordics,  according  to  Billy  Meier  and 
other  post-Adamski  friends  of  the  space  people, 
come  from  the  Pleiades  star  system. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Adamski,  George; 
Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind;  Contactees; 
Hybrid  beings;  Meier,  Eduard  “Billy”;  Menger, 
Howard;  Waltons  abduction 

Further  Reading 

Adamski,  George,  1955.  Inside  the  Space  Ships.  New 
York:  Abelard-Schuman. 

Bowen,  Charles,  ed.,  1974.  The  Humanoids.  Lon¬ 
don:  Futura  Publications. 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  1998.  The  Threat.  New  York: 
Simon  and  Schuster. 

Menger,  Howard,  1959.  From  Outer  Space  to  You. 
Clarksburg,  WV:  Saucerian  Books. 

Randles,  Jenny,  1988.  Abduction:  Over  200  Docu  - 
mented  UFO  Kidnappings  Investigated.  London: 
Robert  Hale. 


Stevens,  Wendelle  C.,  1983.  UFO .  .  .  Contact  from 
the  Pleiades — A  Preliminary  Investigative  Report — 
The  Report  on  an  Ongoing  Contact.  Tucson,  AZ: 
Wendelle  C.  Stevens. 

Nostradamus 

Nostradamus — Michael  de  Nostradame  (1503— 
1566) — was  a  French  physician,  astrologer, 
and  counselor  to  Kings  Henry  II  and  Charles 
IX.  He  is  remembered  for  his  prophecies  of 
world  events,  culminating  in  the  Second 
Coming  of  Christ  in  2000.  According  to  an 
Indiana  woman,  he  returned  to  this  world  in 
1 996  as  a  channeled  entity  after  living  on  the 
Great  Central  Sun  since  his  death. 

A  woman  who  identifies  herself  only  as  Pati 
reports  that  on  a  Friday  night  in  July  1996, 
she  was  sitting  in  on  a  channeling  session  with 
like-minded  friends  when  a  message  came 
through  from  an  anxious-sounding  Nos¬ 
tradamus.  Though  Pati  had  never  paid  much 
attention  to  Nostradamus  or  his  prophecies 
before,  she  felt  a  strong,  immediate  connec¬ 
tion.  Nostradamus  communicated  only 
briefly,  but  before  he  withdrew,  the  channel¬ 
ing  group  assured  him  that  he  was  welcome  to 
come  back  anytime  he  wished  to  do  so. 

The  next  day,  while  on  a  long  drive  through 
the  country,  Pati  felt  Nostradamus’s  spirit  inside 
her,  seeing  and  hearing  all  that  passed  through 
her  eyes  and  ears.  He  asked  questions  about 
everything  around  them.  Over  the  next  two 
months,  Pati  felt  other  “energies”  enter  her.  She 
suspected  that  they  were  friends  and  associates 
of  Nostradamus’s  from  the  Great  Central  Sun. 
“Judging  by  the  questions  that  were  asked,”  Pati 
writes,  “these  energies  either  had  not  been  on 
this  planet  before  or,  if  they  had  been,  it  was  so 
long  ago  that  nothing  looked  familiar  apart 
from  the  trees,  rocks  and  water.  They  asked 
questions  about  how  houses  were  built,  why 
this  or  that  particular  shape?  What  materials  did 
we  use?  On  and  on,  they  went,  asking  about 
planes,  cars,  barns  and  llamas,  and  why  do  peo¬ 
ple  MOW  their  grass!”  (Pati,  1999). 

On  two  occasions,  Pati  verbally  channeled 
Nostradamus.  On  the  first,  he  expressed  satis¬ 
faction  with  his  life  now  and  praised  the  ef- 


Nostradamus,  shown  in  magicians  garb  in  his  laboratory,  writing  about  astrology  (Bettmann/Corbis) 


forts  of  Pad  and  like-minded  people  who  were 
making  life  on  Earth  better.  On  the  second, 
he  identified  two  women  in  the  channeling 
group  as  his  wife  and  servant  in  his  Earth  in¬ 
carnation.  Ele  apologized  for  treating  them  as 
less  than  his  equals. 


See  Also:  Channeling 
Further  Reading 

Pati,  1999.  “Nostradamus  Comes  Back...  And 
Likes  What  He  Sees!”  Planet  Lightivorker  (Sep¬ 
tember/October).  http://www.planetlightworker. 
com/ articlefarm/ pati/article  1  .htm. 


Octopus  aliens 

While  doing  chores  in  his  barnyard  at  6  A.M. 
on  August  16,  1968,  a  Serra  de  Almos,  Spain, 
farmer  noticed  a  light  about  half  a  mile  away 
Thinking  it  was  from  a  stalled  car,  he  walked 
over  to  help  what  he  assumed  to  be  a  stranded 
motorist.  The  “car”  turned  out  to  be  a  globe- 
shaped  object  hovering  just  above  the  ground. 
Nearby  were  two  bizarre-looking  creatures 
that  resembled  octopuses.  They  were  light  in 
color  and  three  feet  tall,  and  they  were  dash¬ 
ing  on  “four  or  five  legs”  toward  the  UFO, 
which  shot  away  as  soon  as  they  entered  it. 

Journalists  and  ufologists  who  examined 
the  site  soon  afterward  found  an  abundance 
of  burned  grass.  They  also  reported  that  their 
watches  had  abruptly  ceased  operating. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 

Further  Reading 

Ballester  Olmos,  Vicente-Juan,  1976.  A  Catalogue  of 
200  Type-I  UFO  Events  in  Spain  and  Portugal. 
Evanston,  IL:  Center  for  UFO  Studies. 


Ogatta 

Ogatta  is,  in  the  channeling  of  North  Car¬ 
olina  psychic  Greta  Woodrew,  one  of  five 
planets  in  a  “jorpah”  (solar  system)  in  another 
galaxy.  (The  other  planets  are  Oshan,  Archa, 
Mennon,  and  Tchauvi.)  Woodrew,  a  wealthy 


professional  woman  who  grew  up  and  lived 
much  of  her  life  in  New  York  City  and  Con¬ 
necticut,  discovered  her  connection  with 
Ogatta  while  exploring  her  paranormal  tal¬ 
ents,  prominently  including  metal-bending, 
with  noted  parapsychologist  Andrija  Puha- 
rich.  Under  hypnosis  on  December  17,  1976, 
she  underwent  an  out-of-body  experience,  in 
which  she  encountered  a  figure  with  both 
human  and  bird  features.  It  was  clad  in  a  silver 
suit  and  had  marvelous,  golden  eyes  with  a 
loving  expression.  Via  telepathy  she  learned 
that  he  was  Hshames  from  the  Ogatta  jorpah 
(his  actual  home  planet  was  Mennon). 

Soon,  under  hypnosis  and  then  by  chan¬ 
neling,  Woodrew  was  communicating  with 
other  entities,  one  named  Ogatta  after  the 
planet.  She  would  form  a  particularly  close  as¬ 
sociation  with  a  female  Ogattan  named  Tauri. 
She  learned  that  many  cosmic  civilizations, 
including  the  Ogattans,  are  visiting  the  Earth 
in  ships;  the  Ogattans  call  their  ships  “gattae.” 
Woodrew  herself  had  a  dual  existence.  In  one 
aspect  she  lived  on  Earth;  in  another  she  lived 
on  Ogatta  as  “Plura.”  Plura  had  made  the  de¬ 
cision  to  live — or  at  least  to  have  a  part  of  her 
life — on  Earth  in  order  to  prepare  earthlings 
for  the  coming  Earth  changes  that  will  devas¬ 
tate  much  of  the  planet  before  a  new  age 
brings  peace  and  harmony. 


191 


192  OINTS 


In  time  Woodrew  learned,  via  recovered 
“memories,”  that  she  had  been  interacting  with 
the  Ogattans  since  her  childhood.  Her  first 
contact  took  place  in  the  early  1930s  when  she 
was  three  and  a  half  years  old.  For  the  next  six 
years,  she  had  many  experiences  with  space 
people.  She  was  flown  to  a  beautiful  planet 
where  she  could  “hear  colors”  and  “see  music” 
because,  like  her  fellow  Ogattans,  she  was  free 
of  the  limitations  of  human  physiology;  thus, 
her  brain  processed  stimuli  differently. 

Though  her  contacts  were  overwhelmingly 
with  Ogattans,  on  occasion  she  met  beings 
from  other  worlds.  Once  she  had  an  out-of- 
body  encounter  with  beings  who  looked  half¬ 
human  and  half-fish.  These  entities  seemed 
friendly,  but,  on  a  handful  of  other  occasions, 
she  dealt  with  extraterrestrials  who  were  not  so 
amiable.  Some  believed  the  Earth  to  be  of  no 
significance,  thus  its  problems  were  of  no  con¬ 
cern  to  major  players  in  the  larger  cosmic  order. 

Woodrew  became  a  lecturer  on  the  New 
Age  circuit,  wrote  a  self-published  book,  and 
published  a  newsletter,  The  Woodrew  Update. 
After  the  Ogattans  warned  them  that  they 
would  have  to  move  to  preserve  their  safety 
during  the  coming  geological  upheavals, 
Woodrew  and  her  husband,  Dick  Smolowe, 
bought  a  property  in  western  North  Carolina 
in  1982.  They  moved  from  Westport,  Con¬ 
necticut,  to  the  survivalist  compound  they 
named  Reisha  Way.  In  1988,  Doubleday  re¬ 
leased  Woodrew’s  book  Memories  ofTomorrow. 
A  few  years  later,  Woodrow  and  Smolowe 
moved  to  Winston-Salem  for  health  reasons. 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Dual  reference 

Further  Reading 

Heard,  Alex,  1999.  Apocalypse  Pretty  Soon:  Travels  in 
End-Time  America.  New  York:  W.  W.  Norton  and 
Company. 

Woodrew,  Greta,  1981.  On  a  Slide  of  Light.  Black 
Mountain,  NC:  New  Age  Press. 

- ,  1988.  Memories  of  Tomorrow.  New  York: 

Dolphin/Doubleday. 

OINTS 

“OINTS”  are  “Other  Intelligences”  in  an 
acronym  coined  by  maverick  biologist  and 


anomalist  Ivan  T.  Sanderson.  To  Sanderson 
OINTS  are  any  beings  that  are  on  Earth  but 
are  not  human.  He  did  not  confine  his  defini¬ 
tion  simply  to  extraterrestrial  visitors,  who  in 
his  view  are  only  one  among  a  variety  of  be¬ 
ings  present  on  this  planet.  Poltergeists — in¬ 
visible,  destructive  spirits — are  one  kind  of 
OINT.  So  are  the  entities  who,  so  he  theo¬ 
rized  in  Invisible  Residents  (1970),  dwell  under 
the  oceans,  occasionally  snatching  ships, 
planes,  and  their  crews  in  places  such  as  the 
Bermuda  Triangle.  (“Could  there  have 
evolved  a  technological  civilization  .  .  .  under¬ 
water?  I  am  afraid  I  have  to  say  that .  .  .  there 
is  no  logical  reason  for  stating  that  there  could 
not  be.”)  He  also  believed  that  invisible  di¬ 
mensions  or  parallel  universes  surround  hu¬ 
mans.  From  these  other  dimensions,  entities 
pop  in  and  out  of  human  reality  with  regular¬ 
ity,  manifesting  as  everything  from  fairies  to 
UFOs.  They  shift  their  shapes  to  whatever 
form  may  be  appropriate  to  the  occasion  and 
the  circumstance. 

Curiously,  however,  Sanderson  held  a  dim 
view  of  all  such  visitors,  not  because  he  feared 
they  might  be  unfriendly  but  because  “the 
OINTS  are  .  .  .  incredibly  and  abysmally  stu  - 
pidf  He  suspected  that  they  were  so  advanced 
that  their  technology  now  controlled  them 
and  that  they  have  given  up  mental  activity, 
just  as  technology  has  caused  humans  to  re¬ 
duce  much  of  their  physical  activity.  “That 
they  are  for  the  most  part  overcivilized  and 
quite  mad,”  he  wrote,  “is,  in  my  opinion,  an 
open-ended  question  but  quite  probable.  Per¬ 
haps,  we  will  never  be  able  to  cope  with  them 
until  we,  too,  all  go  quite  mad.” 

See  Also:  Bermuda  Triangle;  Fairies  encountered 

Further  Reading 

Sanderson,  Ivan  T.,  1970.  Invisible  Residents:  A  Dis  - 
quisition  upon  Certain  Matters  Maritime,  and  the 
Possibility  of Intelligent  Life  under  the  Waters  of  the 
Earth.  New  York:  World  Publishing  Company. 


Old  Hag 

The  “Old  Hag”  is  a  folk  expression — popular, 
for  example,  in  Newfoundland — for  the  par- 


Henri  Fuseli,  The  Nightmare,  1781  (The  Detroit  Institute  of  the  Arts,  gift  of  Mr.  and  Mrs.  Bert  L.  Smokier  and  Mr.  and 
Mrs.  Lawrence  A.  Fleishman) 


ticular  experience  that  gave  rise  to  the  word 
“nightmare.”  Nightmare  has  come  to  be  a 
synonym  for  “bad  dream,”  but  traditionally 
nightmare  (from  the  Anglo-Saxon  nicht 
[night]  and  mara  [incubus  or  succubus])  re¬ 
ferred  to  a  specific  nocturnal  experience.  A 
menacing  supernatural  entity,  often  perceived 
as  an  ugly  witch,  enters  a  bedroom  and  sits  on 
the  witness’s  chest,  leaving  him  or  her  with  the 
sensation  of  being  crushed.  All  the  while  the 
victim  lies  paralyzed  and  helpless. 

Though  the  experience  occurs  frequently 
to  Americans — one  in  six,  according  to  a  sci¬ 
entist  who  has  studied  the  phenomenon — 
American  culture  has  no  name  for  it.  Thus, 
those  who  undergo  it  are  at  a  loss  to  under¬ 
stand  it  or  to  put  it  into  any  larger  context. 
Many,  having  never  heard  of  others’  experi¬ 
ences,  are  left  wondering  about  their  sanity. 


The  Old  Hag  is  the  subject  of  a  classic 
work,  The  Terror  That  Comes  in  the  Night 
(1982),  by  David  J.  Hufford,  a  medical  scien¬ 
tist  and  folklorist  at  Pennsylvania  State  Uni¬ 
versity.  Hufford  uses  the  experience,  among 
other  things,  to  scrutinize  the  way  psycholo¬ 
gists  have  dealt  with  such  reports  and  to  ex¬ 
amine  the  trustworthiness  of  eyewitness  testi¬ 
mony  to  anomalous  events.  Most  scientists 
and  scholars  have  sought  to  explain  Old  Hag 
attacks  as  the  result  of  perceptual  errors,  faulty 
memories,  lies,  psychotic  episodes,  or  halluci¬ 
nations  shaped  by  images  in  the  claimants’ 
cultural  environment.  According  to  Hufford, 
they  have  often  discarded  witness  testimony, 
resulting  in  what  Hufford  charges  was  an  ef¬ 
fort  to  reinvent  the  experience  so  that  it  could 
be  “explained.”  Referring  to  a  study  by  early 
psychoanalyst  and  Freud  biographer  Ernest 


194  Oleson’s  giants 


Jones,  Hufford  says  that  “one  can  hardly  dis¬ 
tinguish  the  experiences  themselves  from  their 
interpretations.” 

Hufford  argues  that  if  would-be  explainers 
had  listened  to  what  the  witnesses  reported 
about  the  particular  symptoms  of  Old  Hag 
experience,  they  might  have  been  able  to  ex¬ 
plain  it  sooner.  Research  in  the  1960s  and 
1970s  in  sleep  paralysis  both  underscores  the 
accuracy  of  the  testimony  and  explains  most 
of  it,  though,  so  far,  not  the  peculiar  fact  that 
the  contents  of  the  experience  are  consistent  no 
matter  to  whom  or  in  what  cultural  context 
they  occur. 

In  Hufford ’s  judgment,  too  much  scholarly 
writing  on  extraordinary  experience  reflects 
“unexamined  prejudices  and  makes  facile  as¬ 
sumptions  about  cultural  processes,”  thus 
confusing  rather  than  clarifying  issues. 

Old  Hag  sleep  paralysis  may  explain  at 
least  some  abduction  and  other  ostensibly 
UFO-related  “bedroom  visitations.”  For  ex¬ 
ample,  John  A.  Keel,  author  of  several  books 
on  UFOs,  has  written  of  his  own  encounters 
with  strange  entities,  including  one  in  which 
“I  woke  up  in  the  middle  of  the  night  to  find 
myself  unable  to  move,  with  a  huge  dark  ap¬ 
parition  standing  over  me”  (Keel,  1970). 

Addressing  the  abduction  phenomenon, 
Hufford  has  said,  “If  the  paralysis  attacks,  as 
described  by  abductees,  are  directly  linked  to 
abductions,  there  is  every  reason  to  believe 
that  the  abduction  phenomenon  has  great  his¬ 
torical  depth  and  is  associated  in  complex 
ways  with  other  classes  of  anomalous  experi¬ 
ence”  (Hufford,  1994). 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Keel,  John  Alva 

Further  Reading 

Hufford,  David  J.,  1982.  The  Terror  That  Comes  in 
the  Night:  An  Experienced-Centered  Study  of  Su  - 
pernatural  Assault  Traditions.  Philadelphia:  Uni¬ 
versity  of  Pennsylvania  Press. 

- ,  1994.  “Awakening  Paralyzed  in  the  Presence 

of  a  Strange  ‘Visitor’.”  In  Andrea  Pritchard, 
David  E.  Pritchard,  John  E.  Mack,  Pam  Kasey, 
and  Claudia  Yapp,  eds.  Alien  Discussions:  Proceed  - 
ings  of  the  Abdtiction  Study  Conference,  348-354. 
Cambridge,  MA:  North  Cambridge  Press. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  Strange  Creatures  from  Time  and 
Space.  Greenwich,  CT:  Fawcett  Gold  Medal. 


Oleson’s  giants 

On  May  2,  1897,  during  a  spate  of  mysteri¬ 
ous  “airship”  sightings  that  some  popular 
speculation  tied  to  possible  visitors  from 
other  planets,  the  Houston  Post  published  a 
letter  from  John  Leander  of  El  Campo,  Texas. 
Leander  related  the  story  of  a  local  man, 
identified  only  as  Mr.  Oleson,  an  elderly,  re¬ 
tired  sailor  who  once  served  on  Danish  ves¬ 
sels.  According  to  Leander,  in  September 
1862  Oleson  had  witnessed  the  crash  of  a 
mysterious  craft  and  seen  the  bodies  of  the 
giant  beings  who  had  flown  it. 

At  the  time  the  incident  took  place,  Oleson 
was  serving  as  mate  on  the  brig  Christine  on 
the  Indian  Ocean.  A  furious  storm  erupted 
and  raged  for  hours  until,  finally,  a  wave 
washed  over  the  ship,  and  Oleson  and  five 
companions  were  swept  onto  a  small,  rocky  is¬ 
land.  All  were  injured,  and  one  soon  died. 
The  island  was  devoid  of  life,  and  the  men  re¬ 
signed  themselves  to  their  deaths.  As  they  sat 
hopeless  at  the  base  of  a  cliff,  they  witnessed  a 
bizarre  and  terrifying  sight:  an  immense  flying 
ship,  apparently  out  of  control  and  about  to 
crash,  was  heading  directly  toward  them.  For¬ 
tunately,  the  wind  blew  it  off  course,  and  it 
smashed  against  the  rocks  a  few  hundred 
yards  away. 

Overcoming  their  deep  fear,  the  sailors 
made  their  way  to  the  wreckage.  The  ma¬ 
chine,  which  they  deduced  had  been  the  size 
of  a  battleship,  lay  in  a  shapeless  mass,  reveal¬ 
ing  little  except  that  the  craft  had  had  four 
large  wings.  There  were  things  that  looked 
like  tools  and  furniture,  evidently  from  the 
ship’s  interior,  and  the  men  opened  boxes  cov¬ 
ered  with  unusual  characters.  Inside  the 
boxes,  they  uncovered  nourishing  food. 

“But  their  horror  was  intensified,”  Leander 
wrote,  “when  they  found  the  bodies  of  more 
than  a  dozen  men  dressed  in  garments  of 
strange  fashion  and  texture.  The  bodies  were  a 
dark  bronze  color,  but  the  strangest  feature  of 
all  was  the  immense  size  of  the  men.  They  had 
no  means  of  measuring  their  bodies,  but  esti¬ 
mated  them  to  be  more  than  twelve  feet  high. 
Their  hair  and  beards  were  also  long  and  as 


Orthon  195 


soft  and  silky  as  the  hair  of  an  infant” 
(Bullard,  1982).  The  sight  so  unsettled  one  of 
the  men  that  he  was  driven  mad.  He 
promptly  hurled  himself  off  into  the  sea, 
where  he  drowned. 

The  survivors  retreated  from  the  scene,  and 
it  took  them  two  days  to  restore  their  courage 
sufficiently  to  return.  They  rummaged  for 
food  and  then  dragged  the  giants’  bodies  off 
the  cliff  and  into  the  water.  Using  pieces  of 
the  spaceship,  they  built  a  raft  and  set  out  on 
the  now-still  ocean.  Sixty  hours  later,  they 
came  upon  a  Russian  vessel  heading  for  Aus¬ 
tralia.  Before  they  could  reach  port,  however, 
three  more  of  Oleson’s  companions  died  from 
their  injuries  and  shock. 

“Fortunately  as  a  partial  confirmation  of 
the  truth  of  his  story,”  Leander  wrote,  “Mr. 
Oleson  took  from  one  of  the  bodies  a  finger 
ring  of  immense  size.  It  is  made  of  a  com¬ 
pound  of  metals  unknown  to  any  jeweler  who 
has  seen  it,  and  is  set  with  two  reddish  stones, 
the  names  of  which  are  unknown  to  anyone 
who  has  ever  examined  it.  The  ring  was  taken 
from  the  thumb  of  the  owner  and  measure 
two  and  one-quarter  inches  in  diameter.” 

Leander’s  yarn  was  one  of  many  told  in 
the  spring  of  1897  about  airships  and  their 
supposed  crews.  Newspapers  all  over  Amer¬ 
ica  carried  comparable  tall  tales,  including 
one  alleging  a  Martian’s  crash-landing  and 
his  subsequent  burial  in  a  small  north-Texas 
town. 

See  Also:  Aurora  Martian;  Michigan  giant;  Wilson 

Further  Reading 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  ed.  1982.  The  Airship  File:  A 
Collection  of  Texts  Concerning  Phantom  Airships 
and  Other  UFOs,  Gathered  from  Newspapers  and 
Periodicals  Mostly  during  the  Hundred  Years  Prior 
to  Kenneth  Arnold’s  Sighting.  Bloomington,  IN: 
self-published. 

Olliana  Olliana  Alliano 

Speaking  at  a  contactee  conference  in  1982, 
Dave  Schultz,  an  electrician  from  Louisville, 
Colorado,  related  a  lifetime  of  interactions 
with  extraterrestrials,  among  them  the  Olliana 
Olliana  Alliano.  The  Olliana  Olliana  Alliano 


are  forty  inches  tall,  humanlike  in  appearance 
except  for  a  slightly  larger  head.  Schultz  called 
them  “the  good  people,”  guardians  of  the 
Earth.  It  was  Olliana  Olliana  Alliano  who 
died  in  the  1948  spaceship  crash  at  Aztec, 
New  Mexico,  chronicled  in  Frank  Scully’s  Be  - 
hind  the  Flying  Saucers  (1950). 

This  alien  group  is  here  to  “get  the  vibra¬ 
tions  of  the  planet  up  to  a  level  in  which  we 
can  join  the  space  federation.”  Before  that 
happens,  humans  have  to  shed  their  violent, 
warlike,  greedy  ways.  The  Olliana  Olliana  Al¬ 
liano  have  contacted  every  political  leader  on 
Earth  to  deliver  this  message. 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Mersch 

Further  Reading 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  ed.,  1982.  Proceedings:  Rocky 
Mountain  Conference  on  UFO  Investigation. 
Laramie,  WY:  School  of  Extended  Studies,  Uni¬ 
versity  of  Wyoming. 

Orthon 

Orthon  was  the  name  George  Adamski — or, 
more  accurately,  his  ghostwriter  Charlotte 
Blodget — gave  to  the  Venusian  Adamski  met 
in  the  desert  of  southern  California  on  No¬ 
vember  20,  1952.  Space  people,  Adamski  ex¬ 
plained,  never  call  themselves  by  name  when 
interacting  with  human  beings  because  they 
have  “an  entirely  different  concept  of  names  as 
we  use  them”  (Adamski,  1955).  In  that  first 
encounter,  Adamski  communicated  with  the 
being  he  called  Orthon  via  gestures,  sign  lan¬ 
guage,  and  snatches  of  telepathy,  during 
which  the  Venusian  expressed  concern  about 
earthlings’  warlike  ways.  Adamski  saw  Orthon 
again  briefly  when  he  flew  overhead  in  his 
scout  craft  the  following  December  13. 

He  next  met  Orthon  in  the  early  morning 
hours  of  Februaryl4,  1953,  when  two  space¬ 
men  picked  him  up  at  a  Los  Angeles  hotel  and 
drove  him  into  the  desert  to  an  awaiting 
saucer.  As  he  approached  the  ship,  he  saw  Or¬ 
thon,  who  was  finishing  some  repair  work. 
Seeing  “a  very  small  amount  of  molten  metal 
that  he  had  thrown  out,”  Adamski  scooped  up 
the  object.  When  his  companions  asked  him 
why  he  was  doing  that,  he  said  he  wanted 


196  Oxalc 


concrete  proof  of  his  contacts.  Orthon  ex¬ 
plained,  though,  that  “you  will  find  that  this 
alloy  contains  the  same  on  all  planets” 
(Adamski,  1955).  They  boarded  the  ship 
together  and  flew  into  space,  where  Adamski 
and  Orthon — now  speaking  lucid  English,  as 
had  not  been  the  case  in  their  first  en¬ 
counter — engaged  in  extended  conversation. 

A  third  meeting  with  Orthon  took  place 
on  August  23,  1954,  after  the  same  two  space¬ 
men,  Firkon  of  Mars  and  Ramu  of  Saturn, 
picked  up  Adamski  at  his  home  and  took  him 
to  a  spacecraft.  Adamski  was  reunited  not 
only  with  Orthon  but  also  with  other  extra¬ 
terrestrials,  including  the  beautiful  women  11- 
muth  (a  Martian)  and  Kalna  (a  Venusian) 
who  had  been  aboard  the  ship  he  had  entered 
earlier.  This  time  Orthon  showed  Adamski 
scenes  from  the  Venusian  surface.  The  Venu- 
sians,  Orthon  said,  have  an  average  lifetime  of 
a  thousand  years. 

On  April  25,  1955,  Adamski  flew  into 
space  again  with  Orthon.  A  crewmember  used 
Adamski’s  camera  to  take  photographs  of  a 
nearby  Venusian  Mother  Ship  into  which 
Adamski  had  transferred.  Two  of  the  blurry 
results  are  reproduced  in  Inside  the  Space 
Ships.  One  of  them,  according  to  the  caption, 
shows  a  Venusian  looking  out  of  a  porthole, 
Adamski  out  of  a  second,  though  to  the  un¬ 
trained  eye  the  faces  look  like  no  more  than 
blobs  of  light.  Lou  Zinsstag,  a  Swiss  woman 
who  was  close  to  Adamski  and  eventually  be¬ 
came  his  biographer,  reported  that  one  day  in 
1959,  while  the  two  were  conversing,  he 
pulled  out  his  wallet  and  extracted  from  it  a 
photograph  of  Orthon  in  profile.  Zinsstag, 
who  was  allowed  to  study  it  briefly,  was  struck 
by  the  figure’s  pronounced  chin. 

In  the  early  1960s,  according  to  Adamski, 
a  new  group  of  space  people  replaced  the  old 
one.  In  later  years,  after  his  death,  old  associ¬ 
ates  such  as  Blodget,  Madeleine  Rodeffer, 
Fred  Steckling,  and  Steve  Within  made 
claims  of  having  met  Orthon,  but  Alice 
Wells,  Adamski’s  executor  and  head  of  the 
George  Adamski  Foundation,  rejected  their 
assertions. 


See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Ramu 

Further  Reading 

Adamski,  George,  1955.  Inside  the  Space  Ships.  New 
York:  Abelard-Schuman. 

Good,  Timothy,  1998.  Alien  Base:  Earth’s  Encounters 
with  Extraterrestrials.  London:  Century. 

Hallet,  Marc,  1997.  “Adamski  and  His  Believers:  A 
Reminiscence.”  In  Hilary  Evans  and  Dennis 
Stacy,  eds.  UFOs  1947—1997:  From  Arnold  to  the 
Abductees:  Fifty  Years  of  Flying  Saucers,  28-34. 
London:  John  Brown  Publishing. 

Leslie,  Desmond,  and  George  Adamski,  1953.  Flying 
Saucers  Have  Landed.  New  York:  British  Book 
Centre. 

Zinsstag,  Lou,  and  Timothy  Good,  1983.  George 
Adamski — The  Untold  Story.  Beckenham,  Kent, 
England:  Ceti  Publications. 


Oxalc 

Oxalc  is  from  the  planet  Morlen,  settled  long 
ago  by  human  beings  from  the  Orion  system. 
They  sought  to  establish  a  supercolony.  The 
planet  now  houses  six  large  cities  in  which  be¬ 
ings  from  many  worlds,  including  Earth,  cur¬ 
rently  reside.  Oxalc  oversees  forty-nine  extra¬ 
terrestrial  guides  involved  in  Mission  Rama. 
According  to  one  source,  “The  word  RAMA 
contains  a  vibratory  activator  and  was  chosen 
forty-two  hundred  years  ago.  RA  represents 
the  Sun  or  irradiation  and  MA  represents 
Mother  Earth.  The  mantra  Rama  means  Irra¬ 
diating  Light  on  Earth”  (Edilver,  n.d.).  Mis¬ 
sion  Rama’s  purpose  is  to  help  planets  in  tran¬ 
sition,  such  as  Earth  (also  known  as  Merla),  as 
they  enter  the  fourth  dimension. 

Oxalc’s  presence  on  Earth  became  known 
in  1973  after  a  group  of  Peruvian  flying-saucer 
enthusiasts  led  by  Sixto  Paz  Wells  decided  to 
try  to  establish  psychic  communications  with 
extraterrestrials.  The  initial  contacts  took  place 
through  automatic  writing  from  an  entity  who 
called  himself  Oxalc.  Oxalc  gave  a  specific  date 
and  place  where  he  would  meet  them  person¬ 
ally.  The  group  went  to  the  location,  a  coastal 
region  thirty-seven  miles  south  of  Lima,  and 
were  shocked  to  see  a  brilliantly  lighted,  ham- 
burger-shaped  metallic  craft  hovering  less  than 
three  hundred  feet  over  their  heads.  Their  fear 
and  excitement  were  so  intense  that  Oxalc, 


Oz  Factor  197 


communicating  telepathically,  informed  them 
that  no  meeting  would  take  place;  before  one 
could  happen,  they  would  have  to  learn  how 
to  control  their  emotions. 

The  messages  continued  and  began  to  circu¬ 
late  through  the  Spanish-speaking  world.  They 
described  the  nature  of  the  cosmos,  Earth’s  se¬ 
cret  history,  and  human  beings’  spiritual  na¬ 
ture.  The  teachings  were  circulated  under  the 
name  Mission  Rama,  organized  as  a  nonprofit 
corporation.  They  hold  that  there  are  three  dif¬ 
ferent  universes:  material  (Septennial),  mental 
(Eternal),  and  spiritual  (Mental).  Our  own 
Milky  Way  is  under  the  direction  of  twenty- 
four  highly  evolved  beings,  the  Elders  of  the 
Galaxy.  Beneath  them  are  advanced  civiliza¬ 
tions  which  actively  assist  lesser  but  developing 
races.  Each  of  these  takes  on  a  particular  task, 
as  Genetic  Engineers,  Keepers,  Guardians,  In¬ 
structors,  and  the  like.  “Galaxy  M-31,”  in  the 
Andromeda  constellation,  is  the  seat  of  an  ex¬ 
tremely  important  council  where  representa¬ 
tives  of  a  number  of  galaxies  in  our  region  of 
space  deliberate.  The  council  is  called  the 
Council  of  Nine,  and  the  beings  sitting  on  it 
are  the  Nine  of  Andromeda.  They,  along  with 
the  twenty-four  Elders  of  each  galaxy,  comprise 
the  Great  White  Brotherhood  of  the  Star. 

Members  of  the  Earth’s  Mission  Rama  have 
reported  extraordinary  experiences,  not  just 
UFO  sightings  but  otherworldly  journeys 
through  artificially  constructed  space-time 
portals  (Xendras).  “Many  others  received  their 
‘Cosmic  Names,’  whose  pronunciation  is  in 
tune  with  the  total  nature  of  each  individual’s 
soul,”  one  document  states  (Edilver,  n.d.). 

See  Also:  Great  White  Brotherhood 

Further  Reading 

Edilver  [pseud,  of  Giorgio  Piacenza],  1992.  “Mission 
Rama.”  Coral  Gables,  FL:  self-published. 


Oz  Factor 

“Oz  Factor”  is  a  phrase  coined  by  British  ufol¬ 
ogist  Jenny  Randles,  who  calls  it  the  “sensation 
of  being  isolated,  or  transported  from  the  real 
world  into  a  different  environmental  frame¬ 
work.”  Randles  noted  its  presence  in  a  number 


of  UFO  cases  she  investigated.  It  was  as  if,  she 
wrote,  witnesses  were  “being  transported  tem¬ 
porarily  from  our  world  into  another,  where 
reality  is  but  slightly  different.  ...  I  call  it  ‘the 
Oz  Factor,’  after  the  fairytale  land  of  Oz” 
(Randles,  1983).  She  suspects  that  in  many  os¬ 
tensibly  straightforward  UFO  encounters,  wit¬ 
nesses  are  in  an  altered  state  of  consciousness. 

In  Oz  Factor  incidents,  an  individual  may 
witness  a  spectacular  UFO  display  or  even 
landing  and  contact  in  a  public  space  at  a  time 
when  other  persons  should  be  about.  Yet 
other  people  will  be  weirdly  absent,  and  a 
zone  of  silence  will  surround  the  scene.  The 
witness  may  feel  as  if  he  or  she  has  been  “cho¬ 
sen”  to  view  the  object. 

Such  phenomena  have  also  been  reported 
in  the  context  of  men  in  black  encounters.  For 
example,  Peter  Rojcewicz  tells  of  an  experi¬ 
ence  he  underwent  one  afternoon  in  Novem¬ 
ber  1980,  when  he  was  doing  research  on  a 
Ph.D.  dissertation  in  folklore  at  the  Univer¬ 
sity  of  Pennsylvania  library.  His  subject  was 
UFOs.  A  strange  man  dressed  in  black  inter¬ 
rupted  his  work  and  engaged  him  in  a  dis¬ 
jointed  exchange  about  flying  saucers.  The 
stranger  then  seemed  to  disappear.  “I  was 
highly  excited  and  finally  walked  around  the 
stacks  to  the  reference  desk  and  nobody  was 
behind  the  desk,”  Rojcewicz  wrote.  He  could 
find  no  one  else  in  the  library  anywhere,  a  sit¬ 
uation  he  regarded  as  virtually  incomprehen¬ 
sible.  Fighting  panic,  he  returned  to  where  he 
had  been  sitting.  “In  about  an  hour  I  rose  to 
leave  the  library,”  he  recalled.  “There  were 
two  librarians  behind  each  of  the  two  desks!” 
(Rojcewicz,  1987). 

An  American  psychiatric  social  worker 
writing  under  a  pseudonym  recounts  a  life¬ 
time  of  encounters  with  a  range  of  other¬ 
worldly  beings.  She  says, 

I  apparently  entered  into  an  altered  state  when 
encounters  occurred.  It  seemed  to  be  an  altered 
energy  or  time  field  created  by  the  beings. 
Everything  fell  silent.  The  air  felt  heavy,  like 
liquid  crystal,  and  it  seemed  to  carry  nonverbal 
information  between  the  beings  and  myself. 


198  Oz  Factor 


From  left  to  right:  Peter  Brookesmith;  Jenny  Randles,  the  ufologist  who  coined  the  term  “Oz  Factor”;  and  Jerome  Clark  at 
Fortean  Times  UnConvention95  (Lisa  Anders/ Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Time  slowed  and  eddied  in  strange  ways.  Be¬ 
ings  usually  informed  me  (telepathically  in 
most  cases)  that  I  would  not  remember  the 
events  until  much  later.  As  they  communicated 
this,  an  opaque  screen  formed  in  my  mind, 
and  the  encounter  began  to  feel  dim,  even 
while  it  was  still  occurring.  Additionally,  when 
the  encounter  ended,  the  altered  field  also  dis¬ 
solved.  Merely  exiting  the  field  also  cloaked  the 
memory.  (Oakman,  1999) 


See  Also:  Men  in  black 

Further  Reading 

Oakman,  Lisa  [pseud.],  1999.  “UFO  Beings,  Folk¬ 
lore,  and  Mythology:  Personal  Experiences.”  In  - 
ternational  UFO  Reporter  24,  4  (Winter):  7-12. 

Randles,  Jenny,  1983.  UFO  Reality:  A  Critical  Look 
at  the  Physical  Evidence.  London:  Robert  Hale. 

Rojcewicz,  Peter  M.,  1987.  “The  ‘Men  in  Black’  Ex¬ 
perience  and  Tradition:  Analogues  with  the  Tra¬ 
ditional  Devil  Hypothesis.”  Journal  of  American 
Folklore  100  (April/June):  148-160. 


Paul  2 

Paul  Solem,  an  Idaho  rancher,  first  heard  from 
Paul  2 — though  he  did  not  know  his  name  at 
the  time — in  1948  when  a  mental  voice  from 
a  flying  saucer  told  him,  “You  will  hear  from 
us  later”  (Clark,  1971).  Four  years  later  Solem 
met  Paul  2,  a  self-identified  “angel”  from 
Venus.  Solem  was  informed  that  he  had  been 
a  Venusian  in  a  previous  life  and  that  his  mis¬ 
sion  in  the  present  incarnation  was  to  work 
with  North  and  South  American  Indians  to 
prepare  the  City  of  Zion.  A  great  cataclysm 
was  coming,  and  in  its  wake  a  utopian  society 
would  be  built  with  the  aid  of  space  people 
and  their  earthly  allies. 

Solem  surfaced  publicly  in  July  1969  at  the 
Fort  Flail  Indian  Reservation  in  Idaho,  where 
he  and  several  Indian  associates  declared  in  a 
series  of  campfire  meetings  that  flying  saucers 
had  arrived  to  fulfill  a  Flopi  prophecy  about 
the  Day  of  Purification.  According  to  Flopi 
tradition,  a  great  fiery  explosion  would  herald 
the  coming  of  the  True  White  Brother.  Only 
those  who  had  remained  true  to  the  ancient 
Hopi  ways  would  be  spared. 

Moving  his  operation  to  Flotevilla,  Ari¬ 
zona,  where  the  Hopi  Sun  Clan  was  head¬ 
quartered,  Solem  worked  with  the  106-year- 
old  Chief  Dan  Katchongva  to  integrate  flying 
saucers  into  the  tribe’s  traditional  faith. 


Katchongva  was  a  friend  of  contactee  and 
fringe  archaeologist  George  Hunt  William¬ 
son,  author  of  books  speculating  about  the  re¬ 
lationship  of  native  religions  and  visiting  ex¬ 
traterrestrials.  Younger  tribal  members  resisted 
Katchongva  and  Solem’s  efforts,  though  other 
residents  of  the  area  were  claiming  UFO 
sightings  that  they  took  to  be  evidence  of  the 
prophecy’s  imminent  fulfillment. 

Solem  announced  that  Paul  2  would  bring 
in  flying  saucers  for  all  to  see  on  four  occa¬ 
sions,  beginning  on  Easter  Sunday  1971. 
Their  failure  to  appear  on  the  first  scheduled 
date  destroyed  Solem’s  credibility,  and  soon 
afterward  Katchongva  was  ousted  from  his 
position  as  leader  of  the  Sun  Clan.  He  died 
the  following  year.  Solem  lapsed  into  obscu¬ 
rity.  His  last  known  public  appearance  was  on 
July  21,  1990,  in  the  resort  town  of  Lava  Hot 
Springs,  Idaho,  where  he  spoke  to  a  small 
crowd  and  tried  without  success  to  entice 
saucers  to  fly  overhead. 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Clark,  Jerome,  1971.  “Indian  Prophecy  and  the 
Prescott  UFOs.”  Fate 24,  4  (April):  54-61. 

Davis,  Rick,  1990.  “Would  You  Believe,  Flying 
Saucers  over  Lava?”  Idaho  State  Journal 
(Pocatello,  July  15). 

Katchongva,  Chief  Dan,  1970.  Hopi  Prophecy. 
Hotevilla,  AZ:  Hopi  Independent  Nation. 


199 


200  Philip 


Kimball,  Richard  W.,  1995.  “American  Indian 
Prophecies  Confirm  the  Reality  of  Flying 
Saucers.”  Prescott  [Arizona]  Daily  Courier  Gazette 
(December  24). 

Waters,  Frank,  1963.  Book  of  the  Hopi.  New  York: 
Viking  Press. 

Williamson,  George  Flunt,  1959.  Road  in  the  Sky. 
London:  Neville  Spearman. 

Philip 

“Philip”  is  an  imaginary  entity  said  to  have 
been  given  a  degree  of  physical  reality  when  a 
Toronto-based  parapsychological  group  con¬ 
sciously  “invented”  him.  He  was  part  of  an  ex¬ 
periment  intended  to  demonstrate  that  men¬ 
tal  energies  can  create  the  sorts  of  entities 
reported  in  spiritualist  seances  and  poltergeist 
episodes. 

In  September  1972,  members  of  the 
Toronto  Society  for  Psychical  Research  in¬ 
vented  Philip,  laying  out  a  detailed  personal 
biography.  A  pro-royal  aristocrat  during  En¬ 
gland’s  Civil  War,  Philip  fell  in  love  with  a 
Gypsy  woman  but  lost  her  when  authorities 
tried  and  burned  her  at  the  stake  as  a  witch. 
His  failure  to  find  a  way  to  save  her  filled  him 
with  guilt  and  grief  and  prevented  his  soul 
from  passing  on  to  the  afterlife,  leaving  it  an 
earthbound  spirit.  The  group,  whose  mem¬ 
bers  included  psychologist  A.R.G.  Owen  and 
his  wife  Iris,  began  to  meditate  on  Philip  in 
hopes  that  he  would  “appear”  to  them  in 
some  fashion.  Nothing  happened  for  a  year. 

Then  the  group  decided  to  try  a  different 
tactic.  Members  decided  to  imitate  the  meth¬ 
ods  of  nineteenth-century  spiritualist  circles, 
on  the  theory  that  skepticism  inhibited  the 
occurrence  of  paranormal  phenomena.  Like 
the  earlier  spiritualist  sitters,  they  sat  in  a  cir¬ 
cle,  sang,  or  otherwise  tried  to  create  an  at¬ 
mosphere  conducive  to  the  manifestation  of 
the  unknown.  Within  a  few  weeks,  they  began 
hearing  raps  from  the  table.  They  were  able  to 
communicate  with  the  knocker  by  asking  sim¬ 
ple  “yes”  or  “no”  questions.  Once  the  table  ap¬ 
parently  levitated.  Eventually,  Philip  seemed 
to  take  on  a  personality  of  his  own,  indepen¬ 
dent  of  the  one  the  group  had  assigned  him. 


He  would  reject  or  contradict  his  “life”  story. 
Once,  when  a  member  reminded  him  that  he 
was  purely  imaginary,  he  disappeared  for 
some  weeks,  to  reappear  only  when  members 
managed  to  recapture  some  semblance  of  be¬ 
lief  in  his  actual  existence. 

On  one  occasion,  the  group  demonstrated 
Philip’s  manifestations  on  a  television  pro¬ 
gram.  Iris  Owen  and  another  member,  Mar¬ 
garet  Sparrow,  wrote  a  book  on  the  episode, 
which  they  believed  demonstrated  the  reality 
not  of  ghosts  but  of  psychokinesis.  One  subse¬ 
quent  observer,  however,  cautions  that  though 
“potentially  highly  significant,  the  experiment 
has  not  been  repeated  by  other  researchers” 
(Dash,  1997). 

See  Also:  Tulpa 

Further  Reading 

Dash,  Mike,  1997.  Borderlands.  London:  Heine- 
mann. 

Owen,  Iris  M.,  and  Margaret  Sparrow,  1976.  Con  - 
juring  up  Philip.  New  York:  Harper  and  Row. 


Planetary  Council 

Celeste  Korsholm,  a  Sedona,  Arizona,  chan- 
neler  and  metaphysical  counselor,  learned  of 
the  Planetary  Council  one  day  in  1991.  In  an 
out-of-body  state,  she  met  the  twelve  as¬ 
cended  masters  who  compose  the  ruling  body 
of  Earth’s  solar  system.  Over  the  next  few 
years,  they  returned  individually  to  channel 
the  histories  of  the  planets  and  their  futures. 
Each  planet,  she  learned,  is  like  a  university. 
Each  of  us  comes  from  somewhere  else,  from 
a  higher  dimension  of  existence  known  as  the 
Source,  and  enters  through  star  gates  such  as 
Lyra,  Orion,  Sirius,  and  the  Pleiades,  “where 
our  higher  frequencies  of  Light  are  gradually 
decreased  to  prepare  for  life  in  the  denser 
third  dimension,”  in  Korsholm’s  words  (Kor¬ 
sholm,  1991),  on  the  way  to  the  solar  system. 

The  education  starts  at  the  Schools  of  Sat¬ 
urn,  where  the  pilgrim  gets  a  crash  course  in 
each  planet’s  vibrations  before  spending  a  sepa¬ 
rate  lifetime  on  at  least  one  other  planet  before 
making  the  decision  whether  to  volunteer  for 
“postgraduate  work  on  Earth”  (Korsholm, 


Power  of  Light  201 


1995).  On  the  chosen  planet,  one  assumes  the 
physical  form  of  its  inhabitants.  That  means 
that  on  Venus  one  becomes  a  winged  hu¬ 
manoid  that  gives  off  light  and  color  as  it  flies. 
Merbeings  live  on  Neptune,  and  on  Uranus 
one  finds  hairy  primates  with  the  features  of 
both  human  beings  and  the  great  apes.  Mars 
has  two  advanced  insect  races,  one  of  ants,  the 
other  of  praying  mantises.  Jupiter  houses 
giant,  intelligent  reptilian  forms.  Each  species 
got  its  Light  Intelligence  from  a  group  of  trav¬ 
eling  extraterrestrials  called  the  Watchers  who 
monitor  planets  looking  for  species  of  excep¬ 
tional  promise.  As  Earth  was  being  developed, 
the  inhabitants  of  other  planets  were  asked  to 
contribute  representatives,  thus  fairies,  mer¬ 
men  and  mermaids,  Bigfoot/Sasquatch,  in¬ 
sects,  and  dinosaurs.  Explorers  and  refugees 
from  star  wars  live  on  the  other  planets.  Evi¬ 
dence  of  the  presence  of  neighboring  extrater¬ 
restrials  can  be  found  in  archaeological  discov¬ 
eries  and  ancient  myths.  Each  group  tended  to 
concentrate  its  efforts  in  a  particular  region, 
for  example  Martians  in  the  Middle  East,  Ura- 
nians  in  Mexico,  and  Plutonians  in  China. 

Earth  and  other  planets  have  undergone 
much  turbulence,  much  of  it  caused  by  the 
tenth  planet,  Phoenix.  “This  huge  planet’s 
three  thousand  plus  year  orbit  is  at  right  an¬ 
gles  to  the  plane  of  all  the  other  planets’  or¬ 
bits,”  Korsholm  explains  (Korsholm,  1995), 
and  when  the  other  planets  are  on  the  same 
side  of  the  sun  as  it,  its  powerful  magnetic 
force  field  causes  havoc  on  the  surfaces  of 
those  worlds,  both  destroying  and  creating. 
The  Planetary  Council  must  always  monitor 
the  location  and  effects  of  Phoenix.  Its  mem¬ 
bers  also  deal  with  the  periodic  arrival  of 
groups  from  other  solar  systems.  Some  are 
highly  evolved  and  benign,  others  less  devel¬ 
oped  and  belligerent. 

According  to  Korsholm,  the  members  of 
the  Planetary  Council  are:  Elorus,  represent¬ 
ing  the  sun,  coordinates  the  council’s  work 
with  that  of  higher  space  intelligences  and 
Christ  councils.  Hermes  (Mercury)  is  in 
charge  of  communication  through  space. 
Adonis  (Venus)  guides  the  evolution  of  love 


and  beauty.  Enoch  (Earth)  oversees  prophecy. 
Croesus  (Mars)  is  responsible  for  the  coordi¬ 
nation  of  council  activities  with  the  dictates  of 
the  Ascended  Masters  in  the  Brotherhood  of 
Light.  Athena  (the  asteroid  belt,  formerly  the 
planet  Maldek)  defends  truth  and  justice.  Jove 
(Jupiter)  balances  magnetic  fields.  Zoroaster 
(Saturn)  monitors  order,  structure,  and  des¬ 
tiny.  Quetzalcoatal  (Uranus)  leads  religious 
and  philosophical  change.  Merlin  (Neptune) 
directs  scientific  discovery.  Lao-Tzu  (Pluto) 
offers  objective,  detached  wisdom,  and  Apollo 
(Phoenix)  generates  change.  All  of  these  indi¬ 
viduals  figure  in  earthly  mythology  and  (in 
the  case  of  Lao-Tzu,  the  founder  of  Taoism) 
history. 

See  Also:  Ascended  Masters;  Athena;  Fairies  encoun¬ 
tered;  Sasquatch 

Further  Reading 

Korsholm,  Celeste,  1991.  “Lao-Tzu,  Planetary 
Council  Member  from  Pluto.”  http://www.spir- 
itweb.org/Spirit/pluto-celeste.html. 

- ,  1995.  “Tales  from  the  Planets.”  http://spir- 

itweb.org/Spirit/tales-planets-celeste.html. 


Portia 

Portia  is  best  remembered  as  the  extraterres¬ 
trial  who  in  a  July  18,  1952,  channeling  with 
George  W.  Van  Tassel  introduced  Ashtar,  the 
most  ubiquitous  and  beloved  of  New  Age  be¬ 
ings.  The  psychic  message  was,  “Approaching 
your  solar  system  is  a  ventla  [spaceship]  with 
our  chief  aboard,  commander  of  the  station 
Schare  in  charge  of  the  first  four  sectors.  .  .  . 
We  are  waiting  here  at  72,000  miles  above 
you  to  welcome  our  chief,  who  will  be  enter¬ 
ing  this  solar  system  for  the  first  time”  (Van 
Tassel,  1952).  The  chief  was  Ashtar. 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Channeling;  Van  Tassel,  George  W. 

Further  Reading 

Van  Tassel,  George  W.,  1952.  I  Rode  a  Flying  Saucer! 
The  Mystery  of  the  Flying  Saucers  Revealed.  Los 
Angeles:  New  Age  Publishing  Company. 


Power  of  Light  (POL) 

One  day  in  1967,  a  deeply  unhappy  Swedish 
man,  Bjorn  Ortenheim,  vowed  to  commit  sui- 


202  Prince  Neosom 


Landscape  with  volcanic  craters,  Haleakala  Mountains,  Maui,  Hawaii  National  Park.  Bjorn  Ortenheim  was  informed  by 
Power  of  Light  that  Lemurian  ruins  with  still  powerful  energies  and  vibrations  could  be  found  on  or  near  the  ocean  around 
Maui.  (Library  of  Congress) 


cide.  Prior  to  committing  the  act,  however,  he 
lapsed  into  a  deep,  almost  comalike  sleep. 
When  he  awoke,  he  was  mysteriously  trans¬ 
formed,  full  of  scientific  ambitions  and  bold 
ideas.  He  soon  became  aware  that  otherworldly 
entities  were  instructing  him  during  his  sleep. 
They  were  particularly  interested  in  nonpollut¬ 
ing  technology  and  in  other  inventions  that 
would  elevate  human  consciousness.  In  1981, 
the  leader  of  the  group,  Power  of  Light  (Orten¬ 
heim  soon  began  thinking  of  him  as  POL),  ap¬ 
peared  to  him  in  waking  consciousness. 

Ortenheim  found  himself  ever  more  at¬ 
tracted  to  the  Hawaiian  island  of  Maui.  POL 
informed  him  that  Lemurian  ruins  with  still 
powerful  energies  and  vibrations  could  be 
found  on  or  near  the  ocean.  In  fact,  the  capi¬ 
tal  city  of  Lemuria,  Denerali,  lay  under  the 
water  in  the  bay  outside  Maui.  POL  said  a 
large  crystal  from  that  lost  continent  existed 


there.  Ortenheim  should  use  its  energies,  em¬ 
ploying  his  own  technological  innovations  to 
enhance  them,  to  raise  human  consciousness. 

He  soon  moved  to  Maui  to  pursue  his 
work,  always  under  POLs  guidance.  Accord¬ 
ing  to  Ortenheim,  POL  is  not  a  person  but  a 
near-god  who  is  among  God’s  highest  ser¬ 
vants.  POL  is,  he  says,  “in  charge  of  the  ulti¬ 
mate  energy  and  source  of  life  in  our  universe, 
the  Universal  Magnetic  Field,  UMF”  (Mont¬ 
gomery,  1985). 

See  Also:  Lemuria 

Further  Reading 

Montgomery,  Ruth,  1985.  Aliens  among  Us.  New 
York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 


Prince  Neosom 

Prince  Neosom  was  Lee  Childers,  a  Detroit 
baker  who,  in  1958,  reinvented  himself  as  a 


Psychoterrestrials  203 


member  of  the  royal  family  of  the  planet 
Tythan,  eight  and  a  half  light  years  from 
Earth.  Neosom  said  he  had  replaced  the  body 
of  a  stillborn  child  (Childers).  He  also  claimed 
that  he  could  travel  instantaneously  through 
space  simply  by  closing  his  eyes  and  wishing 
himself  to  other  planets.  Three  times,  he  said, 
the  men  in  black  had  killed  him,  and  three 
times  a  rejuvenation  machine  had  brought 
him  back  to  life. 

At  the  peak  of  his  brief  moment  in  the 
spotlight,  Neosom/Childers  was  brought  to 
New  York  City  to  lecture.  In  December  1958, 
he  appeared  on  Long  John  Nebel’s  popular 
WOR  radio  show,  which  catered  to  the  eccen¬ 
tric  and  the  esoteric,  but  he  managed  to  get 
thrown  off  the  air  before  his  allotted  time  was 
up;  his  stories  were  too  outlandish  even  for 
the  famously  tolerant  Nebel.  By  this  time, 
Childers  had  left  his  wife  and  five  children 
and  taken  up  with  Beth  Docker,  soon  re¬ 
named  Princess  Negonna,  whom  he  soon 
married  and  honeymooned  with  on  Tythan. 

Childers’s  career  on  saucerdom’s  fringes 
continued  until  the  early  1960s. 

See  Also:  Men  in  black 

Further  Reading 

Barker,  Gray,  1959.  “Chasing  the  Flying  Saucers.” 
Flying  Saucers  (May):  19-43. 

Mann,  Michael  G.,  1960.  “Prince  or  Eng,  He  Isn’t  a 
Spaceman!”  Saucer  News  7,  1  (March):  5-7. 

Mapes.  D.  O.,  1959.  Prince  Neosom,  Planet:  Tyton 
[sic].  Buffalo,  NY:  self-published. 

Psychoterrestrials 

New  Age  psychologist  Michael  Grosso  uses 
the  term  “psychoterrestrials”  to  describe  a 
range  of  anomalous  and  paranormal  entities, 
including  UFO  beings,  Marian  apparitions, 
and  men  in  black.  He  believes  that  such  enti¬ 
ties,  though  “mythic  constructs,”  are  able  to 
assume  a  quasi-physical  reality  because  of  the 
deep  resonance  they  have  in  humanity’s  col¬ 
lective  psyche.  Another  name  for  psychoter¬ 
restrials  is  psychic  projections. 

Grosso  believes  that  UFOs  and  other  exotic 
phenomena  are  “forces  of  rebirth”  that  the 


An  artist’s  impression  of  a  gray  alien,  based  on  witness 
descriptions,  an  example  of  a  psychoterrestrial  being 
(Debbie  Lee/Fortean  Picture  Library) 


“ultradimensional  mind”  has  conjured  up  to 
transform  mass  consciousness  in  order  to  save 
the  human  race  for  otherwise  certain  self- 
destruction.  “Given  the  timeless,  spaceless  na¬ 
ture  of  ESP  and  PK  [psychokinesis],  perhaps 
some  (or  all)  human  minds  form  a  system — a 
parallel  universe  of  mind,  a  distinct  entity 
with  its  own  properties.  ...  It  would  be  a 
mind  with  properties  distinct  from  compo¬ 
nent  minds,  on  the  assumption  that  the  whole 
is  greater  than  the  sum  of  its  parts.  .  .  .  Per¬ 
haps  this  is  the  entity  that  holds  the  secret  to 
the  UFO  mystery”  (Grosso,  1991). 

In  his  view,  psychoterrestrial  phenomena 
are  so  powerful  that,  for  example,  in  their 
UFO  manifestation  they  are  even  able  to 
show  up  on  radar.  Grosso  drew  inspiration  in 
his  speculations  from  the  celebrated  Swiss 
psychologist  and  philosopher  C.  G.  Jung.  In 
his  own  reflection  on  the  UFO  phenomenon, 
however,  Jung,  who  thought  UFOs  were 
probably  of  extraterrestrial  origin,  rejected  the 


Aliens,  or  psychoterrestrials,  capture  a  man  played  by  James  Earl  Jones  in  The  UFO  Incident,  an  NBC  TV  movie,  1975. 
(Photofest) 


notion  of  “materialized  psychisms”  as  impossi¬ 
ble,  and,  in  particular,  he  dismissed  the  no¬ 
tion  that  materialized  psychisms,  even  if  they 
could  be  proved  to  exist,  could  be  detected  by 
instruments  such  as  radar. 

See  Also:  Imaginal  beings;  Marian  apparitions;  Men 
in  black 

Further  Reading 

Grosso,  Michael,  1985.  The  Final  Choice:  Playing 
the  Survival  Game.  Walpole,  NH:  Stillpoint 
Publishing. 

- ,  1992.  Frontiers  of  the  Sold:  Exploring  Psychic 

Evohition.  Wheaton,  IL:  Quest  Books. 

- ,  1989.  “UFOs  and  the  Myth  of  the  New 

Age.”  In  Dennis  Stillings,  ed.  Cyberbiological 
Studies  of  the  Imaginal  Component  in  the  UFO 
Contact  Experience,  81-98.  St.  Paul,  MN:  Arches 
Project. 

- ,  1991.  “The  Ultradimensional  Mind.” 

Strange  Magazine  7  (April):  10-13. 

Jung,  C.  G.,  1959.  Flying  Saucers:  A  Modern  Myth  of 
Things  Seen  in  the  Skies.  New  York:  Harcourt, 
Brace  and  Company. 


Puddy’s  abduction 

An  incident  from  Australia  in  the  early 
1970s  may  or  may  not  shed  light  on  the 
UFO  abduction  phenomenon.  Maureen 
Puddy’s  experiences,  some  contend,  indicate 
that  persons  who  believe  that  aliens  have  kid¬ 
napped  them  may  instead  be  suffering  vivid 
hallucinations,  perhaps  in  altered  states  of 
consciousness. 

On  the  evening  of  July  3,  1972,  on  her  way 
home  from  seeing  her  hospitalized  son,  this 
thirty-seven-year-old  Victoria  woman  was 
alarmed  to  see  a  glowing  blue  UFO  pacing 
her  car  at  a  distance  of  no  more  than  a  hun¬ 
dred  feet.  Just  as  suddenly  as  it  appeared,  it 
was  gone.  One  night  later  that  month,  she 
began  hearing  a  mental  voice  repeatedly 
speaking  her  name.  The  next  evening,  July  25, 
at  the  same  place  she  had  seen  it  before,  the 
UFO  showed  up.  Her  car  engine  abruptly 


Puddy’s  abduction  205 


ceased  functioning,  and  everything  became 
eerily  silent.  A  mechanical  voice  speaking  “too 
perfect”  English  told  her,  “All  your  tests  will 
be  negative.”  It  went  on,  “Tell  the  media.  Do 
not  panic.  We  mean  no  harm”  (Magee,  1972, 
1978).  At  the  UFO’s  departure  the  car’s  en¬ 
gine  resumed  operation. 

She  next  heard  the  voice  in  February,  when  it 
instructed  her  to  return  to  the  “meeting  place.” 
By  this  time  she  had  met  with  two  prominent 
ufologists,  Judith  Magee  and  Paul  Norman,  so 
she  called  them  and  asked  them  to  meet  her  at 
the  designated  location.  As  Puddy  waited  in  her 
parked  car  for  the  two  to  arrive,  a  man  with 
long,  blond  hair,  wearing  a  uniform  that  looked 
like  a  ski  suit,  briefly  appeared  next  to  her  be¬ 
fore  he  vanished.  As  soon  as  they  pulled  up, 
Magee  and  Norman  joined  her  inside  her  vehi¬ 
cle.  Puddy  shouted  that  the  same  strange  man 
was  beckoning  to  her,  but  the  investigators  saw 
nothing.  She  then  seemed  to  faint,  though  her 
mouth  kept  moving.  She  spoke  of  being  in  a 
round  room  and  watching  as  a  mushroom¬ 
shaped  device  rose  from  the  middle  of  the  floor. 
It  was  covered  with  markings  reminiscent  of  hi¬ 
eroglyphics.  Near  it  stood  the  blond-haired  fig¬ 
ure  she  had  seen  minutes  before.  She  said  the 
man  was  telling  her  to  describe  what  she  was 
seeing.  All  the  while  Puddy  was  growing  ever 


more  frightened,  until  finally  she  broke  into 
tears.  At  that  moment  she  regained  full  con¬ 
sciousness  but  remembered  nothing. 

She  claimed  one  other  subsequent  en¬ 
counter  with  the  stranger,  whom  she  saw 
standing  in  the  road  about  a  week  later. 

Australian  ufologist  Keith  Basterfield 
would  write,  “All  who  interviewed  Maureen 
Puddy  thought  her  to  be  a  normal,  healthy  in¬ 
dividual.  The  entire  series  of  events  puzzled 
her,  and  she  got  nothing  but  ridicule  from 
persons  for  reporting  the  episodes”  (Baster¬ 
field,  1992).  Her  story  bore  some  resemblance 
to  abduction  accounts,  but  there  are  also  some 
differences,  notably  the  absence  of  the  med¬ 
ical  examination  which  figures  in  most  such 
experiences.  Still,  skeptics  see  it  as  evidence 
that  what  witnesses  believe  to  be  objective  ex¬ 
periences  may  in  fact  be  subjective  in  nature. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs 

Further  Reading 

Basterfield,  Keith,  1992.  “Present  at  the  Abduction.” 
International  UFO  Reporter  17,  3  (May/June): 
13-14,  23. 

Magee,  Judith,  1972.  “UFO  over  the  Mooraduc 
Road.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  18,  6  (November/ 
December):  3-5. 

- ,  1978.  “Maureen  Puddy’s  Third  Encounter.” 

Flying  Saucer  Review  24,  3  (November  1978): 
12-13,  15. 


R.  D. 

In  both  abduction  reports  and  contactee  sto¬ 
ries,  claimants  sometimes  report  seeing 
human  beings  onboard  a  UFO  and  in  the 
company  of  aliens.  One  such  incident  is  said 
to  have  occurred  on  June  5,  1964,  in  Ar¬ 
gentina.  At  4  A.M.,  a  doctor  and  his  wife  were 
driving  a  few  miles  from  the  airport  at  Pajas 
Blancas,  in  Cordoba  province,  when  their  en¬ 
gine  failed.  A  huge,  extraordinary-looking 
craft  landed  on  the  highway  in  front  of  them. 
For  the  next  twenty  minutes  the  couple  stared 
in  puzzlement  and  unease  at  the  UFO.  Then, 
according  to  a  press  account,  a  man  walked 
out  of  it  and  spoke  to  them  in  Spanish,  “Don’t 
be  afraid.  I  am  a  terrestrial.  My  name  is  R. 
D.”  Apparently  the  man  gave  his  full  name, 
but  published  accounts  give  only  his  initials. 
He  went  on,  “Tell  mankind  about  it,  in  your 
own  fashion”  (Creighton,  1974). 

The  man  walked  slowly  back  toward  the 
UFO  and  was  joined  by  two  gray-clad  beings 
who  had  suddenly  appeared.  They  boarded 
the  ship,  and  it  flew  rapidly  away,  a  violet-col¬ 
ored  trail  in  its  wake. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Creighton,  Gordon,  1974.  “The  Humanoids  in 
Latin  America.”  In  Charles  Bowen,  ed.  The  Hu  - 
manoids,  84-129.  London:  Futura  Publications. 


Ra 

Ra  channeled  through  Carla  Rueckert.  Ra  was 
not  an  individual  but  a  group  entity,  part  of 
the  “Confederation  of  Planets  in  the  Service 
of  the  Infinite  Creator”  (Rueckert  and  Elkins, 
1977).  The  goal,  Ra  said,  was  to  “give  instruc¬ 
tions  to  those  of  planet  Earth  who  would  seek 
the  instructions  for  how  to  produce  within 
themselves  the  vibration  that  is  more  harmo¬ 
nious  with  the  original  thought.” 

Further  Reading 

Rueckert,  Carla,  and  Don  Elkins,  1977.  Secrets  of  the 
UFOs.  Louisville,  KY:  L/L  Research. 

Rainbow  City 

Rainbow  City  was  the  ancestral,  earthly  home 
of  the  human  race,  according  to  a  mystically 
inclined  couple,  W.  C.  and  Gladys  Hefferlin. 
It  was  located  in  Antarctica  before  the  Earth 
tipped  on  its  side,  and  the  continent  became 
the  uninhabitable  place  as  it  is  known  today. 

The  Hefferlins  surfaced  in  1946,  in  short 
pieces  published  in  Ray  Palmer’s  Amazing  Sto  - 
ries,  then  publishing  a  series  of  stories  detail¬ 
ing  the  Shaver  mystery,  a  supposedly  true  ac¬ 
count  of  Richard  Shaver’s  adventures  with 
good  and  evil  races  living  in  caverns  under  the 
earth.  After  W.  C.  Hefferlin  made  a  passing 
reference  to  “Rainbow  City,”  Palmer  ap- 


207 


208  Rainbow  City 


pended  a  statement  describing  it  as  “the  head¬ 
quarters,  a  deserted  city  of  the  Gods  (or  the 
Elder  Race)  under  the  ice  of  the  [South]  Pole” 
(Kafton-Minkel,  1989).  Hefferlin  claimed  to 
have  access  to  advanced  weapons  and  devices 
left  over  from  Rainbow  City,  but  his  asser¬ 
tions  about  the  science  behind  them  were  so 
full  of  elementary  technical  errors  that  reader 
ridicule  encouraged  Palmer  to  cease  publish¬ 
ing  Hefferlin’s  writings. 

He  and  his  wife  reappeared,  however,  in 
1947  and  1948,  in  publications  of  the  Cali¬ 
fornia-based  Borderland  Sciences  Research 
Associates.  In  a  series  of  articles,  they  re¬ 
counted  their  association  with  a  mysterious 
man  named  Emery,  whom  they  first  met  in 
1927.  Over  time  they  developed  a  system  of 
telepathic  communication  with  him,  sending 
thoughts  back  and  forth  from  their  Indiana 
home  to  his  in  New  York  City.  Emery  began 
to  travel  widely,  dropping  out  of  sight  without 
explanation,  then  reappearing.  Just  before  the 
onset  of  World  War  II,  he  informed  them  that 
he  had  met  a  Tibetan  master  who  lived  in  a 
hidden  valley  in  that  nation.  Soon  he  was 
working  under  orders  from  the  Masters  of 
Human  Destiny,  otherwise  known  as  the  An¬ 
cient  Three. 

Recognizing  W.  C.  Hefferlin  as  a  reincar¬ 
nated  engineer  who  had  worked  for  the  an¬ 
cients  long  ago,  the  Three  asked  him  for  help 
in  constructing  a  fleet  of  three  hundred-fifty 
circle-winged  aircraft.  After  the  craft  were 
completed,  they  searched  Antarctica  for  the 
ruins  of  Rainbow  City,  where  the  Three  had 
lived  during  their  first  earthly  incarnation. 
Emery  himself  participated  in  the  search, 
which  ended  on  Thanksgiving  Day  1942 
when  he  found  Rainbow  City. 

Over  time,  Emery  revealed  the  secrets  of  the 
Three  to  the  Hefferlins.  Once,  they  said,  the 
human  race  ruled  hundreds  of  galaxies.  Unfor¬ 
tunately,  the  spacefarers  eventually  encountered 
the  Snake  People,  and  soon  deadly  conflict 
spread  through  the  cosmos.  After  centuries  of 
stalemate,  the  tide  turned  in  the  Snake  People’s 
favor.  The  Snake  People  pursued  the  humans 
through  space,  stranding  some  on  obscure, 


backwater  planets.  The  rest  made  it  to  the 
planet  now  known  as  Mars,  where  the  last  of 
the  Human  Empire  lived  in  relative  comfort 
for  a  long  time.  Then  the  planet  began  to  die, 
its  oxygen  and  water  evaporating  and  the  tem¬ 
perature  growing  ever  colder. 

Thus  the  humans  found  their  way  to  the 
third  planet  in  the  solar  system.  They  settled 
in  what  is  now  Antarctica,  a  pleasant,  temper¬ 
ate  place.  They  built  seven  cities,  each  with  its 
own  color  (Red  City,  Green  City,  Blue  City, 
and  so  on).  The  greatest  of  all  was  Rainbow 
City,  constructed  from  many  colors  of  a  very 
hard  plastic.  Under  the  wise  leadership  of  the 
son  and  daughter  of  the  Great  Ruler  (still  on 
Mars)  and  the  daughters  fiance  (later  to  be 
called  the  Ancient  Three),  the  colony  thrived, 
and  a  golden  age  ensued,  ending  when  the 
Snake  People,  having  discovered  where  the 
humans  were  hiding,  mounted  a  surprise  at¬ 
tack.  In  the  fierce  battles  that  followed,  the 
Earth  was  knocked  on  its  side,  turning 
Antarctica  into  a  wasteland.  The  humans  were 
driven  to  other,  now  warmer  continents. 
Their  technology  destroyed,  they  were  re¬ 
duced  to  a  primitive  state  and  gradually  lost 
all  memory  of  their  former  elevated  state. 

When  they  rediscovered  it,  Emery  and  his 
associates  found  the  city  surrounded  by  ten 
thousand  feet  of  ice,  thus  concealing  the  re¬ 
mains  from  previous  explorers.  Hot  springs 
beneath  the  city  kept  it  warm,  and  the  search 
party  went  through  all  six  levels.  Inside  the 
city,  plants  and  trees  of  all  kinds  still  grew, 
along  with  huge  butterflies.  All  kinds  of  evi¬ 
dence  of  the  ancients’  presence  survived,  in¬ 
cluding  clothes  (which  suggested  they  were 
eight  feet  tall)  and  advanced  technology.  The 
technology  included  a  teleportation  device 
and  a  vast  subway  system.  The  trains  were 
linked  to  hollow  caverns  all  over  the  earth. 
Emery  traveled  to  some  of  them  and  found 
yet  more  wonders  from  the  ancients. 

The  Ancient  Three  sought  to  restore  the 
human  race’s  former  glories.  According  to  the 
Hefferlins,  the  world’s  nonwhite  races  had  al¬ 
ready  accepted  their  leadership,  which  was 
headquartered  in  seven  temples  in  Africa, 


Ramtha  209 


Asia,  and  South  America.  The  “thought  ma¬ 
chines”  inside  these  temples  broadcast  vibra¬ 
tions  to  those  who  were  receptive  to  them. 
The  principal  message  was  that  other  nations 
must  free  themselves  of  European  domina¬ 
tion,  though  the  Ancient  Three  had  opposed 
the  Japanese  imperial  designs  that  helped 
spark  World  War  II.  Once  the  Ancient  Three 
had  realized  their  vision  and  taken  benevolent 
control  of  the  Earth,  there  would  be  no  more 
slavery,  colonialism,  or  excessive  taxation,  and 
all  races  would  be  equal. 

Though  the  Elefferlins  soon  faded  into  ob¬ 
scurity  without  ever  providing  proof  of  Rain¬ 
bow  City  (or  even  of  their  enigmatic  friend 
Emery,  for  that  matter),  the  notion  of  Rain¬ 
bow  City  figured  in  Robert  Dickhoff’s 
Agharta:  The  Subterranean  World  (1951)  and 
Michael  X.  Barton’s  Rainbow  City  and  the 
Inner  Earth  People  (I960). 

See  Also:  Shaver  mystery 

Further  Reading 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
100,000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwarfs,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

X,  Michael  [pseud,  of  Michael  X.  Barton],  1960. 
Rainbow  City  and  the  Inner  Earth  People.  Los  An¬ 
geles:  Futura. 

Ramtha 

Ramtha,  perhaps  the  leading  channeled  entity 
of  the  1980s,  first  appeared  in  a  Tacoma, 
Washington,  living  room  to  announce,  “I  am 
Ramtha,  the  Enlightened  One,  and  I  have 
come  to  help  you  over  the  ditch” — by  which, 
it  turned  out,  he  meant  the  “ditch  of  limita¬ 
tion”  (Knight,  1987).  J.  Z.  Knight  (born  Ju¬ 
dith  Darlene  Hampton)  and  her  husband  had 
been  experimenting  with  pyramids,  which  ac¬ 
cording  to  a  1970s  New  Age  belief  had  myste¬ 
rious  powers.  For  a  short  time,  Knight  be¬ 
lieved  that  Ramtha  was  a  demonic  entity. 
Soon,  however,  a  spiritualist  friend  helped  her 
understand  the  nature  of  her  experience,  and 
she  gave  her  guidance  in  how  to  channel 
Ramtha.  On  December  17,  1978,  she  gave 
the  first  public  channeling  of  Ramtha. 


Ramtha  claimed  to  be  35,000  years  old, 
born  on  the  lost  continent  of  Lemuria. 
Lemuria,  in  the  Pacific,  was  destroyed  in  an  ir¬ 
responsible  experiment  its  scientists  con¬ 
ducted.  Some  residents,  including  Ramtha’s 
family,  escaped  to  southern  Atlantis  (the  ex¬ 
periment  that  devastated  Lemuria  also  de¬ 
stroyed  much  of  north  Atlantis).  There  they 
lived,  experiencing  poverty  and  discrimina¬ 
tion  in  the  slums  of  a  city  called  Onai.  When 
he  grew  into  adulthood,  Ramtha  led  a  revolt, 
which  overthrew  the  existing  order  in  At¬ 
lantis.  As  he  was  recovering  from  wounds,  he 
became  interested  in  meditation  and  spent 
much  time  reflecting  on  metaphysical  ques¬ 
tions.  He  also  learned  to  alter  his  body  so  that 
its  vibrations  changed,  allowing  him  to  enter 
the  light  realm.  On  the  occasion  of  his  physi¬ 
cal  death,  he  ascended  permanently  to  that 
realm.  Just  before  that  happened,  though,  he 
demonstrated  his  new  paranormal  powers  in 
India,  where  he  is  still  remembered  and 
revered  as  the  incarnate  deity  Rama. 

In  the  early  1980s,  Knight  went  public 
with  Ramtha.  She  traveled  throughout  the 
United  States  giving  two-day  workshops 
known  as  “Ramtha  Dialogues.”  Along  the 
way,  she  attracted  the  attention  of  New  Age- 
oriented  celebrities  such  as  Shirley  MacLaine, 
Richard  Chamberlain,  Mike  Farrell,  and  Shel¬ 
ley  Fabres,  who  enthusiastically  supported  her 
work.  MacLaine  discussed  Ramtha  in  her 
best-selling  Dancing  in  the  Light  (1985). 
Knight  put  together  a  nonprofit  corporation 
that  evolved  into  the  non-tax-exempt  Sover¬ 
eignty,  Inc. 

By  this  time,  Knight  had  amassed  so  much 
money  that  a  growing  legion  of  critics  ques¬ 
tioned  her  sincerity.  She  now  lived  on  a  luxu¬ 
rious  horse-breeding  ranch  in  Yelm,  Washing¬ 
ton,  the  focus  of  a  large  following  of  pilgrims 
who  had  moved  to  the  Northwest  from 
homes  all  over  the  nation  and  the  world. 
Some,  seeking  a  safe  haven  from  the  cata¬ 
clysmic  Earth  changes  that  Ramtha  said  were 
about  to  occur,  had  left  families  to  do  so.  Ses¬ 
sions  with  Ramtha  were  expensive.  Beyond 
that,  critics  charged,  Ramtha  had  become,  in 


210  Ramu 


effect,  Knight’s  business  partner;  would-be  in¬ 
vestors  in  Knight’s  Arabian  horses  would  seek 
the  master’s  advice.  After  some  complained 
they  had  purchased  mediocre  horses  after 
heeding  Ramtha’s  advice,  authorities  investi¬ 
gated,  and  Knight  ended  up  reimbursing  un¬ 
happy  buyers,  though  no  charges  were  filed. 
Critics  also  asserted  that  the  once  gregarious, 
friendly  Ramtha  had  grown  ever  more  author¬ 
itarian  and  demanding.  Even  some  sympa¬ 
thetic  to  channeling  beliefs  speculated  that 
“whatever  energy  came  through  J.  Z.  Knight 
has  either  shifted,  departed,  or  been  replaced 
by  a  less  benign  entity”  (Klimo,  1987). 

In  1988,  Knight  formed  Ramtha’s  School  of 
Enlightenment,  which  claims  some  three  thou¬ 
sand  students  from  twenty-three  countries.  In 
1995,  a  small  scandal  erupted  when  press  ac¬ 
counts  exposed  the  Federal  Aviation  Adminis¬ 
tration’s  payment  of  $1.4  million  for  sensitiv¬ 
ity-training  classes  overseen  by  a  Ramtha 
disciple.  Over  the  past  decade  or  so,  according 
to  one  knowledgeable  observer,  “the  prophecies 
of  Knight  and  Ramtha  seem  to  have  moved 
closer  to  those  of  right-wing  survivalists  and 
anti-Semites,  who  foresee  a  world  held  in  the 
sinister  group  of  international  bankers  as  part 
of  a  New  World  Order”  (Brown,  1997). 

Knowledgeable  observers,  such  as  religious- 
studies  scholar  J.  Gordon  Melton,  say  that 
much  of  Ramtha’s  teaching  comes  from  the 
Gnostic  tradition,  which  holds  that  God  ex¬ 
ists  within  each  of  us  and  is  to  be  found  there 
through  contemplation  and  self-mastery. 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Channeling;  Lemuria 

Further  Reading 

Brown,  Michael  F.,  1997.  The  Channeling  Zone: 
American  Spirituality  in  an  Anxious  Age.  Cam¬ 
bridge,  MA:  Harvard  University  Press. 

Carroll,  Robert  Todd,  n.d.  “The  Skeptic’s  Dictio¬ 
nary:  Ramtha  aka  J.  Z.  Knight.”  http://skepdic. 
com/ channel.html. 

Kauki,  Christopher  Vincent,  1997.  “Ramtha  in  the 
Petri  Dish:  The  Mixing  of  Science  and  Faith  in 
Yelm.”  Syzygy  6,  1  (Winter/Spring):  139-142. 

Klimo,  Jon,  1987.  Channeling:  Investigations  on  Re  - 
ceiving  Information  from  Paranormal  Sources.  Los 
Angeles:  Jeremy  P.  Tarcher. 

Knight,  J.  Z.,  1987.  A  State  of  Mind.  New  York: 
Warner  Books. 


MacLaine,  Shirley,  1985.  Dancing  in  the  Light.  New 
York:  Bantam  Books. 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1998.  Finding  Enlightenment: 
Ramtha’s  School  of  Ancient  Wisdom.  Hillsboro, 
OR:  Beyond  Words  Publishing. 

Stearn,  Jess,  1984.  Sold  Mates.  New  York:  Bantam 
Books. 

Weinberg,  Steven  L„  ed.,  1986.  Ramtha.  Eastsound, 
WA:  Sovereignty. 

- ,  ed.,  1988.  Ramtha:  An  Introduction.  East- 

bound,  WA:  Sovereignty. 


Ramu 

Ramu  is  the  name  George  Adamski  gave  to  a 
visitor  from  Saturn.  With  Ramu  and  others, 
Adamski  flew  around  the  moon  one  memo¬ 
rable  night  in  1954.  He  cautioned,  however, 
that  Ramu,  like  the  other  Space  Brothers,  has 
“an  entirely  different  concept  of  names  as  we 
use  them”  (Adamski,  1955).  Thus,  Ramu  was 
not  really  the  spaceman’s  name.  Adamski  de¬ 
scribes  Ramu  as  slightly  over  six  feet,  with 
ruddy  complexion  and  dark  brown  eyes  and 
wavy  black  hair. 

A  different  Ramu  from  Saturn  figures  in  a 
story  that  farmer  Velma  Thayer  told  the 
Cincinnati  Enquirer  in  August  1955.  This 
Ramu  landed  in  a  flying  saucer  at  her  Lake 
Geneva,  Wisconsin,  farm  on  October  15, 
1928,  along  with  other  “little  fellows.”  All 
were  blond-haired  and  from  four  feet  six 
inches  to  five  feet  three  inches  in  height.  They 
stayed  for  ten  days  (it  is  not  clear  whether  at 
Thayer’s  residence  or  in  their  saucer).  Ramu 
told  Thayer  that  they  were  from  Saturn  and 
had  come  with  peaceful  intentions.  U.S.  gov¬ 
ernment  authorities  came  to  the  farm  and 
placed  a  guard  around  the  ship.  At  one  point, 
however,  the  guard  fell  asleep,  and  the  saucer 
escaped.  Thayer  said  she  had  had  occasional 
contacts  since  with  Ramu  and  his  crew. 

Nonetheless,  in  an  earlier  account — one 
published  in  a  contactee-oriented  magazine 
before  Adamski’s  Ramu  became  known — 
Thayer  did  not  mention  a  Ramu  in  connec¬ 
tion  with  the  alleged  experience,  suggesting 
that  the  inclusion  of  the  name  was  a  later  em¬ 
bellishment.  This  earlier  version  says  nothing 


Renata  211 


about  communication  or  interaction  with  the 
crew.  When  the  saucer  landed,  according  to 
her,  “Seven  small  people  emerged  and  ran  into 
the  woods,”  never  to  be  seen  again  (“Space 
Ship,”  1954).  In  their  absence,  she  examined 
the  ship  inside  and  out.  Rather  than  escaping, 
the  craft  was  taken  to  the  General  Electric  lab¬ 
oratory,  which  subsequently  informed  her 
that  it  was  made  up  of  materials  that  “defi¬ 
nitely  did  not  belong  to  this  earth.”  According 
to  Thayer,  a  dozen  landings  of  ships  with  sim¬ 
ilar  crews  took  place  in  Wisconsin  and  Illinois 
between  1919  and  1930. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Bartholomew,  Robert  E.,  and  George  S.  Howard, 
1998.  UFOs  and  Alien  Contact:  Two  Centuries  of 
Mystery.  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 

“Space  Ship  Lands  in  Celery  Field,”  1954.  Interplan  - 
etary  News  Digest  (March):  22. 


Raphael 

Raphael  is  responsible  for  the  “Starseed  trans¬ 
missions,”  said  to  come  from  a  parallel  dimen¬ 
sion  through  channeler  Ken  Carey.  Carey,  a 
Missouri  farmer,  had  no  previous  channeling 
experience  before  Raphael  came  through  one 
day  in  1979.  He  says  the  messages  first  arrived 
via  “waves  or  pulsations”  that  translated  sym¬ 
bols  into  their  verbal  correlates.  “Often,”  he 
writes,  “it  was  the  case  that  the  only  human 
conceptual  system  with  approximating  termi¬ 
nology  was  religious.  Hence,  the  occasional 
use  of  ‘Christian’  words  and  phrases”  (Carey, 
1982).  Eventually,  the  communications  oc¬ 
curred  more  straightforwardly  in  English. 

Raphael  says  he  exists  only  when  he  is  in¬ 
teracting  with  Carey  or  with  whomever  he  is 
communicating  through  Carey.  When  he  is 
not  active,  he  merges  “back  into  the  Being  be¬ 
hind  all  being,”  awaiting  his  next  mission.  On 
one  occasion,  however,  he  claimed  to  be  the 
intelligence  represented  by  Christ. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Carey,  Ken,  1982.  The  Starseed  Transmissions:  An  Ex  - 
traterrestrial  Report.  Kansas  City,  MO:  UNI¬ 
SUN. 


Raydia 

After  a  1979  UFO  sighting,  Lyssa  Royal 
found  herself  more  and  more  fascinated  with 
paranormal  subjects.  Her  interests  led  her,  in 
1984,  to  Darryl  Anka,  who  channeled  Bashar. 
During  the  period  of  her  association  with 
Anka,  she  had  a  vivid  dream  in  which  an  en¬ 
tity  appeared  to  inform  her  that  soon  she  her¬ 
self  would  be  channeling.  She  was  led  to  a 
channeling  class  in  Los  Angeles.  By  1985,  a 
number  of  entities  were  making  their  presence 
known  to  her.  One  was  Raydia,  who  stayed 
with  Royal  for  three  years. 

Royal  went  on  to  found  the  Association  of 
Love  and  Light,  channeling  Raydia  as  well  as 
some  others.  Raydia  was  a  “heart-centered” 
female  entity,  “a  collective  consciousness” 
with  “a  strong  affdiation  with  the  star  Arc- 
turus.”  She  last  communicated  in  1988, 
telling  persons  who  were  sitting  in  on  a  chan¬ 
neling  session,  “You  will  never  see  me  in  this 
form  again.”  Royal  says  that  Raydia  “inte¬ 
grated  herself”  into  an  entity  Royal  would 
subsequently  channel,  Germane  (“Behind  the 
Veil,”  1998). 

See  Also:  Bashar;  Channeling;  Germane 

Further  Reading 

“Behind  the  Veil:  A  Look  at  the  Phenomenon  of 
Channeling,”  1998.  http://www.royalpriest.com/ 
channel.htm. 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  Ameri  - 
can  Religions.  Fifth  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale 
Research. 

Renata 

Renata  channels  through  Scott  Amun.  On 
April  15,  1999,  she  (gender  is  presumed  since 
the  entity  does  not  specify  its  sex)  came 
through  for  the  first  time  to  discuss  various 
issues. 

Renata  says  that  on  her  planet,  Osyllium, 
people  look  and  act  much  like  humans;  yet, 
paradoxically,  Osyllium’s  history  is  richer  and 
more  diverse  than  Earth’s.  Perhaps  one  reason 
is  that  Osyllium  people  change  their  language 
every  four  or  five  years.  They  do  this  by  ad¬ 
justing  their  brain  frequencies,  and  the  pur¬ 
pose  is  to  accelerate  change  and  encourage 


212  Reptoid  child 


new  insight.  Great  changes  are  about  to  occur 
on  Earth  through  the  electrical  energy  that 
emanates  from  the  north  pole.  Human  beings 
soon  will  notice  a  “special  effect”  in  the 
northern  lights — a  message  from  Renatas 
people.  Humans  will  also  sense  a  changing 
situation  in  their  dreams,  which  will  help  pre¬ 
pare  them  for  their  “opening  into  higher  elec¬ 
trical  frequencies.” 

Further  Reading 

Amun,  Scott,  1999.  “Morning  Dawns  on  the 
Human  Race.”  http://www.scottamun.com/ 
write/ Aprill598write.htm. 


Reptoid  child 

In  a  story  represented  as  true  by  Mexican  ufol¬ 
ogist  Luis  Ramirez  Reyes,  a  woman  is  said  to 
have  given  birth  to  a  hideous  alien  baby  after  a 
missing-time,  presumed  abduction  experi¬ 
ence.  Ramirez  claims  that  the  birth  took  place 
in  September  1993  but  “due  to  its  very  nature 
has  been  kept  under  wraps.” 

The  unnamed  woman,  a  cosmetics  sales¬ 
person,  was  on  her  usual  route,  which  took 
her  between  Mexico  City  and  Poza  Rica,  Ver¬ 
acruz,  one  day  in  early  1993.  As  she  passed 
the  Teotihuacan  pyramids,  she  saw  what  she 
thought  was  a  UFO  in  the  clear  sky.  Suddenly, 
she  found  herself  in  Poza  Rica.  Though  her 
wristwatch  told  her  it  was  1 1  A.M.,  the  actual 
time  was  2  P.M.  She  had  no  idea  how  she  had 
traveled  the  185  miles  to  the  city. 

In  the  weeks  to  come,  she  experienced 
weakness  and  nausea.  When  a  doctor  exam¬ 
ined  her,  he  pronounced  her  pregnant.  She 
protested  that  this  was  impossible;  she  was  a 
virgin.  Nonetheless,  seven  months  later,  she 
gave  birth  to  a  hideous  creature  described  as 
having  “double-membraned  eyes,  thick  frog¬ 
like  lips,  joined  fingers  and  hard,  shell-feature 
on  its  skin  which  [was]  similar  to  a  tortoise’s 
shell.”  At  first  the  doctors  and  nurses  pan¬ 
icked.  The  clinic  director  finally  managed  to 
calm  them.  He  ordered  them  to  keep  the  mat¬ 
ter  strictly  confidential. 

The  creature  was  kept  in  an  incubator  for 
three  weeks,  fed  on  a  diet  of  herbs.  It  recoiled 


from  ordinary  light  but  was  comfortable  in 
infrared  light.  Scales  began  to  grow  along  its 
spine.  An  expert  “who  has  requested 
anonymity”  examined  photographs  of  the 
creature,  which  he  deduced  belonged  to  a 
“saurian”  species. 

The  mother  is  raising  the  creature  in  seclu¬ 
sion.  It  is  an  “amphibian  reptile”  said  to  be 
“horrible  to  behold.” 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Reptoids 

Further  Reading 

Corrales,  Scott,  2000.  “Alien  Shock:  The  Encounter 
Phenomenon  Overseas.”  Ohio  UFO  Notebook  2 1 : 
22-26. 


Reptoids 

Beings  sometimes  referred  to  as  “reptoids”  or 
“reptilians”  figure  in  a  number  of  abduction 
and  contact  reports.  According  to  one  source, 
three  different  varieties  exist:  “the  Reptoid 
(reptilian-humanoid  crossbreeds),  the  various 
reptilian-gray  crossbreed  types,  and  the  hierar¬ 
chical  reptilian  overlords  called  the  Draco 
(winged  reptilian  types)”  (“Reptilian  ‘Aliens,’” 
n.d.).  Draco  is  a  constellation  from  which, 
some  believe,  the  reptoids  come. 

A  close  encounter  of  the  third  kind  involv¬ 
ing  reptoids  (though  before  the  concept  had 
become  popular)  happened  on  November  17, 
1967,  when  thirteen-year-old  David  Seewaldt 
of  Calgary,  Alberta,  while  crossing  a  vacant 
lot,  heard  a  high-pitched  sound.  When  he 
looked  for  its  source,  he  saw  a  house-sized 
UFO  landing.  It  shot  a  beam  of  light  at  him, 
putting  him  into  a  trancelike  state  as  he  was 
levitated  into  the  craft.  There  two  hideous- 
looking  entities  with  brown  crocodile  skin 
took  off  Seewaldt’s  clothes  and  led  him  into  a 
room  where  he  was  examined  and  given  a 
shot.  He  was  then  beamed  back  to  the  field. 
By  the  time  he  got  home,  all  conscious  mem¬ 
ory  of  the  encounter  had  passed.  It  returned 
five  months  later  in  a  vivid  dream.  A  year 
later,  investigators,  including  a  University  of 
Alberta  psychologist,  interviewed  the  youth. 

John  S.  Carpenter,  a  Missouri-based  social 
worker  and  abduction  researcher,  reports  cases 


An  artist’s  rendition 
Schaffner/Fortean  Pi 


214  Reptoids 


of  “repulsive  and  insensitive”  reptilian  aliens. 
“What  is  fascinating,”  he  writes,  “is  that  per¬ 
sons  who  had  never  heard  of  these  lizard-types 
are  reporting  strikingly  similar  details  in  re¬ 
gards  [sic]  to  their  anatomy,  manner,  and  be¬ 
havior.  In  every  case  of  mine  the  reptilian 
forces  a  rape  upon  the  subject  with  no  expla¬ 
nation  or  apparent  reason”  (Carpenter,  1994). 
Another  researcher,  Karla  Turner,  has  written 
of  similar  incidents,  including  one  in  which 
an  abductee  “recalled”  being  on  a  table  sur¬ 
rounded  by  humanoid  aliens.  She  said,  “A 
reptile-looking  creature  was  getting  on  top  of 
me,  I  guess  to  rape  me,”  just  before  she  lapsed 
into  unconsciousness  (Turner,  1994). 

Besides  such  experiential  claims,  reptoid/ 
reptilian  aliens  have  given  rise  to  a  new 
mythology  that  fuses  conspiracy  theories,  bib¬ 
lical  literalism,  hollow  earth,  and  other  ideas. 
Among  the  most  bizarre  is  the  assertion  by  a 
leader  of  Britain’s  Green  Party,  David  Icke, 
who  holds  that  the  Royal  Family  are  shape- 
shifting  reptilians  who  conduct  bloody  rituals 
on  hapless  human  victims,  including  children. 
At  least  one  writer  reports  that  former  Presi¬ 
dent  George  Bush  is  a  reptilian.  Others  assert 
that  reptoids  live  in  vast  caverns  underground, 
working  in  collaboration  with  evil  forces  in 
U.S.  military  and  intelligence  communities. 
Others  say  that  the  reptilians  have  been  slan¬ 
dered,  that — except  for  their  (to  the  human 
eye)  unsettling  appearance — they  are  gentle, 
decent,  and  well  intentioned. 

One  who  speaks  well  of  reptilians  is  jazz 
singer  Pamela  Stonebrooke,  who  has  spoken 
openly  of  a  sexual  relationship  with  one.  She 
has  “great  respect”  for  him  and  a  “profound 
connection  with  this  being.”  Under  hypnosis, 
she  was  regressed  to  an  earlier  life  hundreds  of 
thousands  of  years  ago  to  find  herself  a  mem¬ 
ber  of  a  band  of  “reptilian  warriors  facing  a 
catastrophic  event  in  which  we  perished 
together.  ...  I  believe  that  on  one  level,  I  may 
be  meeting  these  entities  again,  perhaps  fellow 
warriors  from  the  past  warning  us  of  an  im¬ 
pending,  self-inflicted  doom”  (“The  Reptil¬ 
ians,”  n.d.).  Carpenter  has  written  of  reptoid 
witnesses  known  to  him,  “One  .  .  .  sheepishly 


admits  to  having  an  incredible  orgasm  while 
being  totally  repulsed  by  the  intruder’s 
grotesque  appearance.  Within  two  months  a 
second  female  from  the  same  town  reported 
independently  the  same  type  of  Reptilian  in¬ 
vader,  with  the  same  surprising  and  embarrass¬ 
ing  orgasmic  response!”  (Carpenter,  1993). 

Some  observers  believe  that  the  reptilians 
are  satanic  entities  related  to  the  serpent  who 
led  Adam  and  Eve  astray.  They  maintain  that 
hundreds  of  thousands  of  these  creatures — as 
many  as  one  hundred  fifty-thousand  in  New 
York  alone — live  in  underground  bases,  feast¬ 
ing  on  children  whom  they  lure  into  their 
lairs.  According  to  some,  however,  the  reptil¬ 
ians  are  vegetarians. 

John  Rhodes  writes  that  the  reptilians 
travel  from  their  home  region — Alpha  Draco- 
nis — in  mother  ships  with  most  of  the  occu¬ 
pants  in  a  state  of  suspended  animation  for 
the  bulk  of  the  voyage.  As  they  pass  planets, 
some  of  the  functioning  crew  fly  off  in  scout 
ships  to  study  the  new  worlds  and  establish 
subterranean  bases  thereon.  Where  Earth  is 
concerned,  according  to  Rhodes,  the  reptil¬ 
ians  hatch  their  plots  from  these  bases,  “estab¬ 
lishing  a  network  of  human-reptilian  cross¬ 
bred  infiltrates  [sic]  within  various  levels  of 
the  surface  culture’s  military  industrial  com¬ 
plexes,  government  bodies,  UFO/paranormal 
groups,  religious,  and  fraternal  (priest)  orders, 
etc.  These  crossbreeds,  some  unaware  of  their 
reptilian  genetic  ‘mind-control’  instructions, 
act  out  their  subversive  roles  as  ‘reptilian 
agents,’  setting  the  stage  for  an  [sic]  reptilian 
led  ET  invasion”  (Rhodes,  n.d.). 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Close  encounters  of 
the  third  kind;  Hollow  earth;  Hybrid  beings; 
King  Leo;  Reptoid  child;  Volmo 

Further  Reading 

Allan,  W.  K.,  1975.  “Crocodile-Skinned  Entities  at 
Calgary.”  Flying  Saucer  Revieiv  20,  6  (April): 
25-26. 

Carpenter,  John  S.,  1993.  “Abduction  Notes:  Reptil¬ 
ians  and  Other  Unmentionables.”  MUFON 
UFO  Journals 00  (April):  10—11. 

- ,  1994.  “Other  Types  of  Aliens:  Patterns 

Emerging.”  In  Andrea  Pritchard,  David  E. 
Pritchard,  John  E.  Mack,  Pam  Kasey,  and  Clau¬ 
dia  Yapp,  eds.  Alien  Discussions:  Proceedings  of  the 


215 


A  painting  of  Madame  Helene  Blavatsky,  who  proposed  the  theory  of  five  “root  races,  ”  with  the  symbol  of  the  Theosophical 
Society  above  her  head  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


216  Root  Races 


Abduction  Study  Conference,  91-95.  Cambridge, 
MA:  North  Cambridge  Press. 

Coleman,  Loren,  1988.  “Other  Lizard  People  Revis¬ 
ited.”  Strange  Magazine  3:  34. 

D’Light,  Joy,  and  Elliemiser,  1999.  “The  Reptilians 
and  King  Leo.”  http://www.greatdreams.com/ 
reptlan/repleo.htm. 

McClure,  Kevin,  1999.  “Dark  Ages.”  Fortean  Times 
129  (December):  28-32. 

“Reptilian  ‘Aliens’:  What  Do  They  Look  Like?,”  n.d. 
http :  // www.  rep  toids .  com/phydes  .htm. 

“Reptiles/Serpents/Lizards  in  History/Mythology/ 
Religion,”  n.d.  http://www.channell.com/users/ 
com/ cci  /  reptiles.htm. 

Rhodes,  John,  n.d.  “O.R.I.G.I.N.S.”  http://www. 
reptoids.com/ origins/htm. 

Turner,  Karla,  1994.  Taken:  Inside  the  Alien-Human 
Abductio n  Agenda.  Roland,  AR:  Kelt  Works. 


Root  Races 

In  the  alternative  reality  proposed  in  the  influ¬ 
ential  nineteenth-century  Theosophical  writ¬ 
ings  of  Helene  Petrovna  Blavatsky,  the  world 
has  seen  five  “root  races,”  each  with  its  own 
seven  “sub-races,”  and  these  latter  with  their 
own  “branch  races.”  Blavatsky  wrote  that  two 
more  root  races  will  come  before  the  human 
race  finishes  its  evolution. 

The  First  Root  Race,  of  “fire  mist”  folk, 
lived  near  the  north  pole  in  the  Imperishable 
Sacred  Land.  They  were  invisible.  The  Second 
Root  Race  were  astral  beings  on  their  way  to 
becoming  material  and  visible.  Also  living  in 
the  polar  region,  they  occupied  a  more  or  less 
material  continent  known  as  Hyperborea, 
where  they  learned  how  to  reproduce  sexually. 
The  Third  Root  Race  were  apelike  in  appear¬ 


ance  with  characteristics  of  both  sexes;  some 
had  four  arms,  and  some  had  an  eye  in  the 
back  of  their  heads.  These  beings  lived  on  the 
now-lost  Pacific  continent  of  Lemuria.  By  the 
time  the  Fourth  Root  Race,  dwelling  on  At¬ 
lantis,  appeared  on  Earth,  the  present  human 
form  had  developed.  Humans  represent  the 
Fifth  Root  Race.  In  the  relatively  near  future, 
the  Sixth  Root  Race  will  replace  humans. 
After  the  Seventh  Root  Race  has  risen  and 
fallen,  a  new  cycle  of  civilizations  will  begin 
on  the  planet  Mercury. 

Blavatsky  claimed  as  her  source  for  these 
revelations  an  “archaic  Manuscript — a  collec¬ 
tion  of  palm  leaves  made  impermeable  to 
water,  fire,  and  air,  by  some  specific  unknown 
process.  .  .  .  On  the  first  page  is  an  immacu¬ 
late  white  disk  within  a  dull  black  ground.  On 
the  following  page,  the  same  disk,  but  with  a 
central  point”  (Blavatsky,  1889).  These  “Stan¬ 
zas  of  Dzyan”  recorded  the  hidden  history  of 
the  cosmos  and  all  of  its  inhabitants,  includ¬ 
ing  the  human  race.  Other  scholars,  however, 
contend  that  Blavatsky  drew  on  contempo¬ 
rary  scientific  and  occult  literature  and  embel¬ 
lished  it  considerably,  though  not  quite  be¬ 
yond  recognition. 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Lemuria 

Further  Reading 

Blavatsky,  H.  P.,  1889.  The  Secret  Doctrine,  London: 
Theosophical  Publishing  Company. 

De  Camp,  L.  Sprague,  1970.  Lost  Continents:  The  At  - 
lands  Theme  in  History,  Science,  and  Literattire. 
New  York:  Dover  Publications. 

Meade,  Marion,  1980.  Madame  Blavatsky:  The 
Woman  behind  the  Myth.  New  York:  G.  P.  Put¬ 
nam’s  Sons. 


Saint  Michael 

Saint  Michael  the  Archangel  is  perhaps  best 
known  from  the  traditional  Georgia  Sea  Is¬ 
lands  spiritual  “Michael,  Row  the  Boat 
Ashore,”  but  even  in  contemporary  time 
some  people  claim  to  have  experienced  his 
presence.  One  is  a  Southern  California 
woman,  Melissa  MacLeod,  a  practicing 
Roman  Catholic.  In  the  1980s,  she  experi¬ 
enced  terrifying  nocturnal  visitations  in 
which  a  tall,  black-hooded  figure  stared  at  her 
menacingly  from  beside  her  bed.  She  is  con¬ 
vinced,  according  to  ufologist  Ann  Druffel, 
that  her  intense  belief  in  Michael  saved  her 
from  this  demonic  manifestation. 

Fascinated  by  MacLeod’s  experiences,  a 
friend,  writer  and  parapsychologist  Stephen 
A.  Schwartz,  engaged  in  three  months’  intense 
meditation  to  see  if  he  could  visualize 
Michael.  After  three  months,  a  point  of  light 
suddenly  shone  in  his  room.  Within  it,  the 
form  of  a  luminous  entity,  human  in  shape 
but  larger,  emerged  into  view.  “He  had  a  de¬ 
meanor  of  absolute  implacability,”  Schwartz 
recalled  (Druffel,  1998).  He  was  convinced  he 
had  seen  the  archangel. 

Further  Reading 

Druffel,  Ann,  1998.  How  to  Defend  Yourself 
against  Alien  Abduction.  New  York:  Three 
Rivers  Press. 


Sananda 

Sananda,  a  popular  channeling  entity,  is  a  pow¬ 
erful  being  who  is  Ashtar’s  superior  in  the  space 
mission  to  redeem  Earth.  Sananda,  known  as 
Jesus  in  an  earlier,  earthly  incarnation,  is  per¬ 
haps  best  known,  however,  as  the  principal 
contact  of  Dorothy  Martin  (Sister  Thedra), 
whose  failed  prophecy  of  earth-shaking  events 
in  December  1954  attracted  worldwide  atten¬ 
tion  and  became  the  subject  of  an  influential 
case  study  in  the  sociology  of  religion. 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Channeling;  Hierarchal  Board;  Sis¬ 
ter  Thedra 

Further  Reading 

Festinger,  Leon,  Henry  W.  Riecken,  and  Stanley 
Schachter,  1956.  When  Prophecy  Fails.  Min¬ 
neapolis:  University  of  Minnesota  Press. 

Tuella  [pseud,  of  Thelma  B.  Turrell],  ed.,  1989. 
Ashtar:  A  Tribute.  Third  edition.  Salt  Lake  City, 
UT:  Guardian  Action  Publications. 

Sasquatch 

Sasquatch — also  known  as  Bigfoot — is  a  large 
apelike  creature  unrecognized  by  zoology  but 
often  reported  seen  in  the  forests  of  the  Pacific 
Northwest  of  the  United  States  and  Canada’s 
far  west.  To  those  few  scientists  who  are  willing 
to  concede  its  possible  existence,  Sasquatch  is 
thought  to  be  related  to  Homo  sapiens  primate 
ancestors.  In  other  words,  though  intelligent  as 


217 


218 


Saint  Michael  casting  the  dragon  Satan  and  his  angels  down  to  Earth  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


Sasquatch  219 


A  photograph  of  the  track  of  a  huge  animal,  seen  by  Mount  Everest  climbers  and  said  to  be  made  by  the  Abominable 
Snowman,  1958.  Similar  creatures,  generally  called  Bigfoot  or  Sasquatch,  are  often  reported  in  the  forests  of  the  Pacific 
Northwest  of  the  United  States  and  Canada’s  far  west.  (Bettmann/Corbis) 


animals  go,  it  does  not  have  human,  much  less 
superhuman,  intelligence.  There  are,  however, 
individuals  who  claim  contacteelike  dealings 
with  Sasquatch,  which  they  describe  as  highly 
evolved  beings  with  extraordinary  mental 
powers. 

Southern  California  psychic  Joyce  Partise, 
holding  a  sealed  envelope  containing  a  pho¬ 
tograph  of  an  alleged  Sasquatch  footprint, 
declared  that  “there’s  a  civilization  of  thou¬ 
sands”  of  “gorilla  men”  who  live  under¬ 
ground  and  are  “able  to  communicate  with 
those  in  outer  space”  (Slate,  1976).  Some 
witnesses  assert  that  when  they  tried  to  take 
photographs  or  collect  other  direct  evidence 
of  their  Sasquatch  sightings,  the  creatures 
used  a  kind  of  hypnosis  to  prevent  them 
from  acting. 


Still  others  say  they  have  received  detailed 
psychic  messages,  often  consisting  of  spiri¬ 
tual  and  ecological  material.  The  Sasquatch 
may  appear,  at  least  initially,  as  no  more 
than  a  pair  of  glowing  eyes  or  a  ball  of  light 
that  can  enter  anywhere,  even  into  closed 
houses  and  bedrooms.  They  can  also  change 
shapes.  In  a  handful  of  cases,  UFO  witnesses 
say  they  have  seen  apelike  creatures  during 
close  encounters,  and  a  small  number  of  ab¬ 
duction  incidents  recount  onboard  interac¬ 
tions  with  Sasquatch  creatures,  seen  in  the 
company  of  (relatively)  more  conventional 
humanoids. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Chorvinsky,  Mark,  1994.  “Our  Strange  World.”  Fate 
47,  10  (October):  22-24. 


220  Satonians 


Fenwick,  Lawrence  J.,  1983.  “Multiple  Abductions 
in  Canada.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal  Pt.  I.  183 
(May):  10-13;  Pt.  II.  184  (June):  3-6. 

Halpin,  Marjorie,  and  Michael  M.  Ames,  eds.,  1980. 
Manlike  Monsters  on  Trial:  Early  Records  and 
Modern  Evidence.  Vancouver:  University  of 
British  Columbia  Press. 

Slate,  B.  Ann,  1976.  “Gods  from  Inner  Space.”  UFO 
Report  3,  1  (April):  36-38,  51-52,  54. 

Slate,  B.  Ann,  and  Alan  Berry,  1976.  Bigfoot.  New 
York:  Bantam  Books. 


Satonians 

Satonians,  according  to  the  Solar  Cross  Foun¬ 
dation,  a  onetime  organization  of  contactee 
sympathizers,  are  evil  space  people.  They  look 
exactly  like  good  space  people,  but  persons 
who  encounter  them  can  detect  their  negative 
thoughts.  They  also  respond  ambiguously  and 
evasively  when  asked  to  identify  themselves. 
Satonians  always  lose  in  conflicts  with  their 
benevolent  counterparts.  A  person  approach¬ 
ing  a  spacecraft  should  be  certain  it  is  not  a 
Satonian  ship. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Tuella  [pseud,  of  Thelma  B.  Turrell],  ed.,  1989. 
Ashtar:  A  Tribute.  Third  edition.  Salt  Lake  City, 
UT:  Guardian  Action  Publications. 


Secret  Chiefs 

“Secret  Chiefs”  are  shadowy  superhuman 
adepts  who  have  used  their  magical  power  and 
knowledge  to  initiate  and  guide  occult  groups 
and  hidden  societies. 

According  to  British  occultist  S.  L.  Mac¬ 
Gregor  Mathers  (1854-1918),  who  claimed 
to  have  met  the  Secret  Chiefs  on  a  number  of 
occasions,  these  people  or  entities  are  able  to 
live  in  both  physical  and  psychic  bodies.  They 
are,  he  told  a  correspondent,  “possessed  of  ter¬ 
rible  .  .  .  powers.  ...  I  felt  I  was  in  contact 
with  a  force  so  terrible  that  I  can  only  com¬ 
pare  it  to  the  shock  one  would  receive  from 
being  near  a  flash  of  lightning  during  a  great 
thunderstorm”  (Keith,  1997). 

Further  Reading 

Keith,  Jim,  1997.  Casebook  on  the  Men  in  Black.  Lil- 
burn,  GA:  IllumiNet  Press. 


Semjase 

Semjase  is  best  known  in  contactee  circles  as  a 
beautiful  spacewoman  from  the  planet  Erra 
in  the  Pleiades  star  system.  Eduard  “Billy” 
Meier  of  Switzerland  claims  to  have  met  her 
after  her  “beamship”  landed  on  his  farm  on 
the  afternoon  of  January  28,  1975,  initiating 
a  series  of  contacts  that  made  Meier  the  most 
well  known  and  controversial  of  the  second- 
generation  contactees.  Meier  would  allege 
trips  through  space  and  time  in  the  company 
of  Semjase  and  her  associates,  and  he  would 
produce  photographs  said  to  depict  her  but 
thought  by  critics  to  be  a  model  in  a  Sears 
catalog. 

According  to  Meier,  Semjase  is  around  350 
years  old,  though  she  looks  to  be  in  her  twen¬ 
ties.  She  is  blond,  blue-eyed,  and  fair-skinned. 
Her  only  extraterrestrial  characteristic  is  her 
extended  earlobes.  Because  she  possesses 
knowledge  remarkable  even  by  Pleiadian  stan¬ 
dards,  she  is  considered  an  Jshrjsh  (ish-rish),  a 
sort  of  demigoddess.  Before  meeting  Meier  in 
1975,  she  spent  eight  years  in  the  DAL  Uni¬ 
verse  (a  twin  parallel  universe  to  the  Earth’s, 
known  as  the  DERN  Universe)  in  the  com¬ 
pany  of  Asket,  a  DAL  native  woman  who  had 
assisted  Meier  through  his  early — child  and 
young- adult — interactions  with  extraterrestri¬ 
als.  She  then  left  the  DAL  Universe  and  re¬ 
turned  briefly  to  Erra  before  arriving  in  Eu¬ 
rope.  Meier  insists  that  her  orders  were  to 
work  exclusively  on  that  continent. 

While  visiting  the  headquarters  of  the 
Meier  movement,  the  Semjase  Silver  Star 
Center  in  Hinterschmidruti,  Switzerland,  on 
December  15,  1977,  she  suffered  a  life-threat¬ 
ening  accident.  A  beamship  rushed  her  back 
to  Erra  for  medical  treatment.  On  returning 
the  followed  May,  she  resumed  contact  with 
Meier.  Those  contacts  ended  on  March  16, 
1981,  when  other  duties  kept  her  away  until 
early  1984.  Their  final  contact  occurred  on 
February  3,  1984,  Meier’s  forty-seventh  birth¬ 
day.  The  following  November,  complications 
from  her  1977  accident  led  to  a  health  emer¬ 
gency.  She  was  taken  to  the  DAL  Universe  to 
begin  the  decades-long  process  of  recovery. 


Seth  221 


Fred  Bell  of  Laguna  Beach,  California,  has 
his  own  Semjase  tales  to  tell,  to  Meier’s  in¬ 
tense  displeasure.  An  inventor,  musician, 
artist,  and  holistic-health  enthusiast,  Bell — a 
committed  believer  in  pyramid  energy — once 
went  about  in  the  world  with  a  small  pyramid 
on  his  head.  He  says  that  beginning  in  1971 
he  received  mental  impressions  of  an  oddly  fa¬ 
miliar,  beautiful  blond  woman.  Eventually,  he 
became  convinced  that  he  had  known  her  in  a 
previous  lifetime,  when  he  was  an  archaeolo¬ 
gist  who  uncovered  evidence  that  Paladins 
landed  on  Earth  long  ago.  Soon  Bell  met 
Semjase  personally.  At  first  she  would  not  give 
him  her  name,  but  when  they  got  close — ap¬ 
parently  even  having  a  sexual  relationship  for 
a  time — she  told  him  her  life  history  and  re¬ 
vealed  the  secrets  of  the  Pleiadians.  She  helped 
him  with  various  projects  and  inventions.  Bell 
came  to  refer  to  Semjase  as  his  “soul  mate.” 
He  also  met  her  father,  Ptaah,  and  others. 

For  a  time,  Bell  was  on  friendly  terms  with 
Wendelle  C.  Stevens,  an  Arizona  man  most 
responsible  for  bringing  Meier’s  claims  to  an 
American  audience.  Stevens  has  published  a 
series  of  books  based  on  his  investigations  in 
Switzerland  and  also  on  Meier’s  contact  di¬ 
aries.  At  first  Stevens  cited  Bell’s  claims  as  in¬ 
dependent  evidence  for  the  existence  of  Sem¬ 
jase  and  Pleiadean  visitors. 

In  due  course,  however,  Meier  denounced 
Bell’s  stories  as  lies.  A  Pleiadian  named  Quet¬ 
zal  told  Meier  that  Bell  could  not  possibly  be 
telling  the  truth  because  Semjase  and  Ptaah 
had  never  been  to  America.  Moreover,  the 
Pleiadians  entered  into  physical  contact  only 
with  Meier,  and  nobody  else.  Quetzal  was 
among  the  extraterrestrials  with  whom  Bell 
supposedly  interacted. 

One  fundamentalist  Christian  writer  holds 
that  Meier  got  the  name  “Semjase”  from  the 
fallen  angel/demon  Shemyaza,  described  in 
the  apocryphal  Book  of  Enoch.  Or  it  might 
be  the  Semjase,  a  real  entity,  that  is  one  of 
Satan’s  emissaries,  one  of  the  “many  evil  de¬ 
ceptive  forces  at  work  in  the  world  right  now” 
(“Billy  Meier  and  the  Swiss  UFO  Case,”  n.d.). 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Meier,  Eduard  “Billy” 


Further  Reading 

“Billy  Meier  and  the  Swiss  UFO  Case,”  n.d.  http:// 
netpci.com/-tttbbs/Articles-UFO/semjase.html. 

Meier,  “Billy”  Eduard  Albert,  n.d.  “‘Billy’  Eduard  Al¬ 
bert  Meier  Dissociates  Elimself  from  Dr.  Fred 
Bell’s  Lies  and  Claims.”  http://www.figu.ch/us/ 
critics/contra/bell.htm. 

Steiger,  Brad,  1988.  The  Fellowship:  Spiritual  Contact 
Between  Humans  and  Outer  Space  Beings.  New 
York:  Dolphin/Doubleday. 


Seth 

Jane  Roberts’s  channeling  of  Seth  had  large 
impact  on  the  emerging  New  Age  movement 
in  the  1960s.  Seth  first  appeared  when  the 
Elmira,  New  York,  writer  and  her  husband 
were  playing  with  a  ouija  board  in  1963.  Soon 
Roberts  learned  how  to  put  herself  into  a 
trance  state  and  let  Seth — whom  she  thought 
of  less  as  a  spirit  than  as  some  kind  of  intelli¬ 
gent  energy  force — speak  through  her.  She 
recorded  these  sessions  and  used  a  few  of 
them  in  a  book,  How  to  Develop  Your  ESP 
Power  (1966),  later  reissued  as  The  Coming  of 
Seth  (1976). 

In  1970,  with  the  publication  of  The  Seth 
Material,  Roberts  commenced  writing  a  se¬ 
ries  of  books,  most  of  them  focused  on 
Seth’s  teachings.  In  time,  a  Seth  movement 
came  into  existence  on  the  New  Age  scene. 
Roberts  also  started  channeling  William 
James,  the  great  American  psychologist, 
philosopher,  and  psychical  researcher,  and 
releasing  books  based  upon  James’s  alleged 
postmortem  observations  and  experiences. 
Unlike  some  channelers  who  would  follow 
her,  Roberts  remained  reclusive  and  public¬ 
ity-shy  and  rarely  appeared  in  public.  She 
died  on  September  5,  1984.  After  her  death 
other  channelers  claimed  to  have  heard  from 
Seth.  One,  Thomas  Massari,  reported  that 
Seth  had  communicated  with  him  as  early  as 
1972. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Roberts,  Jane,  1970.  The  Seth  Material.  Englewood 
Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Elall. 

- ,  1972.  Seth  Speaks:  The  Eternal  Validity  of  the 

Sold.  Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Elall. 


222  Shaari 


- ,  1978.  The  Afierdeath  Journal  of an  American 

Philosopher:  The  World  View  of  William  James.  En¬ 
glewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

- ,  1981.  The  God  of  Jane:  A  Psychic  Manifesto. 

Englewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 


Shaari 

Shaari  is  an  extraterrestrial  who  inhabits  the 
body  of  a  young  professional  woman.  The 
woman,  an  occasional  practitioner  of  channel¬ 
ing,  was  seriously  injured  in  a  car  accident. 
After  the  accident,  she  decided  that  she  had 
served  her  life  purpose  and  would  go  on  to 
another  level  of  existence,  though  without 
“dying”;  instead,  she  gave  her  body  to  a  being 
of  higher  consciousness.  This  being  would  be 
able  to  observe  and  offer  insight  into  upcom¬ 
ing  planetary  changes  that  will  affect  every¬ 
body  who  lives  on  Earth. 

The  Intergalactic  Council  of  Twelve  (con¬ 
sisting  of  space  people  and  angels)  and  the 
Star  Command,  working  with  the  earth- 
woman,  carefully  effected  the  change  over  a 
period  of  six  months  between  January  and 
July  1989.  On  July  14,  the  exchange  occurred. 
By  this  time,  the  woman  was  out  of  the  hospi¬ 
tal  and  had  resumed  a  part-time  occupation, 
the  conducting  of  channeling  workshops.  The 
woman  was  holding  one  on  an  island  in  the 
Pacific  Northwest  when  she  was  instructed  to 
go  to  the  south  part  of  the  island,  lie  down  on 
the  shore,  and  breathe  rhythmically.  Shaari, 
waiting  in  a  spaceship  in  the  company  of 
Ashtar  and  others,  found  herself  enveloped  in 
light  and  drawn  into  the  womans  body. 

“Everything  that  I  was  familiar  with  had 
just  shifted,”  she  recalled.  “There  I  was  in  a 
body  that  felt  like  concrete.  Nothing  moved, 
everything  felt  very  heavy.  ...  As  I  started  to 
think  about  moving,  these  awkward  fleshy 
limbs  began  to  respond  and  jerk  and  twitch. 
Finally,  I  managed  to  get  on  my  feet  and  even¬ 
tually  made  it  back  to  the  workshop  site.  The 
people  there  were  wonderful  and  took  care  of 
me  in  all  ways.”  Shaari  says  her  mission  is  to 
“bridge  the  gap  between  human  and  extrater¬ 
restrial  communication  and  to  establish  the 


potential  for  technological  exchange  and  in¬ 
terplanetary  trade”  (Shaari,  1994). 

Prior  to  her  incarnation  on  Earth,  Shaari 
was  a  commander  in  the  Star  Command, 
which  she  had  served  for  most  of  her  750 
years.  She  was  born  a  Pleiadian/Arcturian  hy¬ 
brid  “created  out  of  the  thoughts  of  a 
Pleiadean  and  Arcturian  council.”  In  other 
words,  she  did  not  have  biological  parents. 
Even  so,  she  has  a  family  and  a  mate  named 
Mishar,  a  Star  Command  officer,  counselor, 
and  healer.  Nearly  seven  feet  tall,  he  hails 
from  Arcturus,  which  means  that  he  has  a 
spectacular  set  of  wings.  These  wings  allow 
him  to  shift  consciousness  and  to  run  through 
different  color,  light,  and  sound  frequencies. 
With  this  power  he  monitors  the  fluctuations 
of  mass  human  consciousness,  which  can  have 
an  adverse  effect  on  weather  patterns.  If  neces¬ 
sary,  he  shifts  that  consciousness  in  a  more 
positive  direction  toward  less  destructive 
weather.  Mishar  also  seeks  an  earthly  incarna¬ 
tion  but  has  yet  to  find  an  Earth  male  who  is 
willing  to  surrender  his  consciousness  in  ex¬ 
change  for  Mishar’s. 

The  British  Columbia  woman  who  now 
calls  herself  Shaari  claims  to  have  all  memories 
of  her  extraterrestrial  life  available  to  her  in 
waking  consciousness.  Though  she  can  chan¬ 
nel,  she  does  not  often  do  so  because  she  does 
not  have  the  need. 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Channeling;  Hybrid  beings 

Further  Reading 

Shaari,  1994.  “An  Extraterrestrials  Journey  to 
Earth.”  http://www.spiritweb.org/Spirit/et-jour- 
ney.html. 


Shan 

Shan  is  a  name  space  people  sometimes  call 
the  Earth.  Shan  is  regarded  as  a  troubled 
planet  strongly  influenced  by  dark  forces.  Its 
reputation  is  such  that  spaceships  from  other 
worlds  have  come  here  both  to  protect  extra¬ 
terrestrials  from  human  influence  and  to  re¬ 
form  humans  and  defeat  Satan. 

According  to  the  pseudonymous  contactee 
Patrick  J.  Bellringer,  Shan  is  undergoing  radi- 


Shaver  mystery  223 


cal  changes  now  that  it  has  been  permitted  to 
move  from  the  third  dimension  to  the  fourth 
dimension.  In  1962,  Shan  entered  the  Photon 
Belt,  an  invisible  band  of  powerful  light  en¬ 
ergy,  as  it  began  the  transition  which  contin¬ 
ues  now  but  which  will  be  completed  in  the 
early  years  of  the  twenty-first  century.  Begin¬ 
ning  on  August  17,  1987,  Shan  was  led  a  dis¬ 
tance  of  thirteen  million  light  years  into  a  new 
orbit  closer  to  the  Great  Central  Sun  as  mil¬ 
lions  of  starships,  using  powerful  magnetic 
beams,  transferred  it  to  another  solar  system 
in  the  Pleiades.  The  process  was  completed  on 
December  15,  1995.  Sahn  is  now  the  fourth 
planet  in  the  orbit  of  Coeleno  (see- lee-no). 

Few  human  beings  have  noticed  the  transi¬ 
tion  because  the  space  people  have  gone  to 
great  lengths  to  conceal  their  operation.  If  the 
sky  looks  familiar,  appearances  are  deceptive; 
the  familiar  stars  and  planets  have  been  re¬ 
placed  by  hovering  starships,  which  take  care 
to  remain  in  precisely  the  same  configuration 
as  the  constellations  of  old.  Only  the  most  ob¬ 
servant  have  realized  that  the  sun  is  emitting 
more  intense  light  but  looks  smaller  (because 
we  are  now  seven  million  miles  farther  away 
from  our  new  sun  so  as  to  adjust  for  the  dif¬ 
ferences  from  the  old  one).  Our  new  moon  is 
brighter  because  of  Coeleno’s  more  brilliant 
light.  Soon  Shan  will  be  moved  into  the  spiri¬ 
tually  advanced  fourth  dimension,  but  not  be¬ 
fore  all  kinds  of  devastating  changes  occur. 
Radical  weather  changes,  massive  volcanic 
eruptions,  and  other  cataclysms  will  wipe  out 
the  unenlightened  parts  of  humanity  (un¬ 
aware  of  but  still  under  Satan’s  influence)  so 
that  only  those  who  are  morally  pure  and  in¬ 
tellectually  superior  will  survive  to  enter  the 
new  realm. 

Among  the  victims  will  be  Satan  and  his 
minions,  who  live  on  Shan  but  remain  oblivi¬ 
ous  to  the  Earth’s  new  location  in  space.  The 
space  people  will  launch  a  surprise  attack  on 
Satan  and  drive  him  and  his  troops  into  the 
void  where  they  can  no  longer  do  harm. 

According  to  Bellringer — himself  reincar¬ 
nated  from  the  Coeleno  system  but  from  the 
fifth  planet,  Hatonn,  to  which  he  and  his 


Pleiadean  family  will  return  soon — Shan  from 
the  beginning  was  regarded  as  a  planet  of  un¬ 
usual  attractiveness.  Two  hundred  six  million 
years  ago  immigrants  from  the  Pleiades — our 
ancestors — settled  on  it.  Bellringer  states  that 
Shan  “held  a  position  at  the  cross-roads  of  the 
Cosmos  as  a  supply  planet  for  other  planets. 
Because  of  its  abundance  and  beauty  it  was 
chosen  as  the  ‘prison’  planet  by  Lucifer,  the 
Arch-Angel  when  he  left  the  Cosmic  Realms 
for  his  anarchy  against  God/Aton.”  Because  of 
the  presence  of  Satan  and  his  allies,  the  people 
of  Shan  have  had  an  extremely  difficult  time 
achieving  “complete  harmony  and  balance 
with  the  Laws  of  God  and  of  the  Creation.” 
Among  other  things,  Satan  has  kept  humans 
ignorant  or  fearful  of  the  extraterrestrial  races 
that  are  visiting  Shan  and  attempting  to 
change  it  for  the  better.  “Shan  has  been  a  spe¬ 
cial  schoolroom  for  the  ‘gifted  kids’ — a  tough 
course  to  learn  tough  lessons.  Sadly  enough, 
most  have  failed  the  course”  (Bellringer,  n.d.). 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Bellringer,  Patrick  H.,  n.d.  “People  of  the  Lie:  The 
Photon  Belt.”  http://www.fourwindslO.com/ 
phb/photon.htm. 


Shaver  mystery 

The  Shaver  mystery  is  named  after  Richard 
Sharpe  Shaver.  Shaver’s  strange  claims  about 
his  experiences  with  cavern-dwelling  deros 
(deranged  and  vicious)  and  teros  (virtuous  but 
overwhelmed),  warring  remnants  of  an  an¬ 
cient  earthly  race  and  possessors  of  advanced 
technologies,  were  featured  prominently  in 
the  popular  science-fiction  pulp  Amazing  Sto  - 
ties  between  1944  and  1948.  Amazing’s  editor, 
Ray  Palmer,  promoted  Shaver’s  stories  for  the 
next  three  decades,  and  Shaver  continued  to 
tell  them  until  his  death. 

The  genesis  of  the  episode  was  a  letter  the 
heretofore  obscure  Shaver  wrote  to  Amazing  in 
1943.  The  letter  purported  to  be  a  reproduc¬ 
tion  of  an  ancient  alphabet  from  Lemuria,  a 
lost  continent  said  to  have  sunk  into  the  Pacific 
Ocean  some  twelve  thousand  years  ago  (in  real- 


224  Shaver  mystery 


Cover  of  The  Hidden  World  magazine,  spring  1961, 
containing  articles  on  the  Shaver  mystery  (Fortean  Picture 
Library) 

ity,  Lemuria  is  a  nineteenth-century  invention). 
Palmer  published  it  in  Amazings  January  1944 
issue.  By  then,  he  and  Shaver  were  correspon¬ 
ding.  Shaver  produced  a  ten-thousand-word 
manuscript  titled  “A  Warning  to  Future  Man,” 
which  Palmer  rewrote  as  a  science-fiction 
novella,  “I  Remember  Lemuria!”  The  story  ap¬ 
peared  under  Shavers  by-line  in  the  March 
1945  issue.  Palmer  presented  it  as  a  true  story 
based  on  racial  memory,  though  Shaver 
claimed  that  he  had  received  his  knowledge  of 
humanity’s  hidden  history  direcdy  from  beings 
who  live  in  a  vast  network  of  tunnels  and  caves 
under  the  Earth’s  surface. 

The  response  was  a  flood  of  letters  from 
curious  readers  and  some  from  persons  who 
related  unusual  experiences  that  they  thought 
validated  Shaver.  A  promotional  genius  with 
the  instincts  of  a  carnival  barker,  Palmer 
coined  the  phrase  “Shaver  mystery,”  started  a 
Shaver  Mystery  Club,  and  opened  Amazings 


pages  to  allegedly  factual  material  and  science- 
fiction  stories  based  on  it.  Palmer  wrote  that 
when  he  visited  Richard  and  Dorothy  Shaver 
at  their  farm,  he  heard  mysterious  voices  that 
“could  not  have  come  from  Mr.  Shaver’s  lips.” 
They  were  speaking  first  in  English  then  in  a 
“strange  language,”  about  a  woman  who  ear¬ 
lier  that  day  had  been  “torn  into  four  quarters 
about  four  miles  away  and  four  miles  down 
[from  the  Shaver  house]”  (Palmer,  1961). 

At  least  in  its  most  vital  phase,  the  Shaver 
mystery  ended  in  1948,  when  pressure  from 
outraged  science-fiction  fans  led  Ziff-Davis, 
Amazings  publisher,  to  order  its  closing.  That 
same  year  Palmer  and  Curds  Fuller  founded 
Fate,  dedicated  to  the  “true  mysteries”  Amaz  - 
ing  had  featured  along  with  Shaver  matters, 
and  he  left  the  science-fiction  magazine  the 
following  year.  Not  long  afterward,  Palmer 
moved  to  Amherst,  Wisconsin,  where  he 
started  Mystic  (later  Search)  and  Other  Worlds 
(later  Flying  Saucers).  These  publications  car¬ 
ried  articles  by  and  about  Shaver.  Between 
1961  and  1964,  Palmer  published  sixteen  is¬ 
sues  of  a  trade -paper-formatted  magazine,  The 
Hidden  World,  devoted  entirely  to  the  Shaver 
mystery.  Shaver  died  in  1975.  Palmer,  who 
had  continued  to  champion  the  “mystery” 
while  disputing  some  of  Shaver’s  interpreta¬ 
tions,  died  two  years  later. 

Though  to  all  but  a  few  Shaver’s  claims 
were  outlandish  and  absurd,  even  grotesque, 
Shaver  did  not  strike  those  who  knew  him  as  a 
hoaxer.  There  seemed  little  doubt  that  Shaver 
believed  what  he  said,  notwithstanding  some 
noteworthy  inconsistencies  in  his  testimony 
over  the  years.  For  example,  he  told  at  least 
four  mutually  exclusive  stories  about  how  he 
learned  of  the  Earth’s  secret  past  and  its  sub¬ 
terranean  races.  In  his  most  frequent  telling, 
however,  it  occurred  first  through  telepathic 
messages  from  a  mysterious  woman,  then  as 
mental  voices  emanating  from  depraved  crea¬ 
tures  known  as  “deros”  (from  “z/ftrimental  ro  - 
hots,”  though  they  were  not  robots  as  such; 
see  explanation  on  next  page). 

These  experiences  seem  to  have  occurred  in 
the  early  1930s.  Always  vague  on  dates, 


Shaver  mystery  225 


Shaver  was  also  vague  on  what  was  happening 
in  his  life  amid  his  growing  realization  of,  and 
interaction  with,  the  reality  of  a  literal  under¬ 
ground.  It  appears,  from  uncertain  though 
not  entirely  implausible  inference,  that  he 
spent  some  time  in  a  mental  hospital,  and  he 
may  also  have  served  a  short  prison  stretch  for 
bootlegging.  On  occasion  Shaver  intimated  as 
much,  even  as  he  less  plausibly  claimed  to 
have  lived  in  the  caves  with  the  embattled 
teros  (“inttgrative  robots”;  again,  like  their  en¬ 
emies  the  deros,  beings  of  flesh  and  blood). 
How  long  he  supposedly  lived  there  is  also 
unclear. 

In  any  event,  out  of  these  elements  came  a 
complex,  alternate  history  of  the  human  race. 
Long  ago,  according  to  Shaver,  extraterrestri¬ 
als  known  as  Atlans  and  Titans  or  the  Elder 
Races  colonized  the  Earth.  (The  Atlans  lived 
on  Atlantis,  the  Titans  on  Lemuria.)  These  be¬ 
ings,  who  possessed  fantastic  technologies, 
lived  extraordinarily  long  lives  and  never 
stopped  growing,  owing  to  the  integrative 
(positive)  energies  cast  out  by  the  sun.  Some 
grew  to  fifty  feet,  a  few  considerably  more. 
Eventually,  however,  the  sun  changed  and 
began  to  beam  detrimental  (negative)  energy, 
causing,  among  other  effects,  aging  and  mor¬ 
tality.  To  block  the  deadly  rays,  the  Elders 
built  an  immense  Cavern  World  to  house  the 
Earth’s  fifty  billion  Atlans  and  Titans.  But  the 
effort  ultimately  failed,  and  twelve  thousand 
years  ago  the  Elders  who  survived  fled  to 
other  stars,  leaving  behind  a  small  population, 
which  had  fallen  victim  to  the  detrimental  ra¬ 
diation.  Some  wandered  to  the  surface  and  in 
time  forgot  their  history  as  they  became  the 
mortal  and  confused  Homo  sapiens.  The  oth¬ 
ers  stayed  in  the  caves  to  become  the  sadistic, 
cannibalistic  idiots  called  deros.  One  other 
group,  the  smallest  of  the  three,  was  the  teros, 
who  had  escaped  the  negative  rays  but  who, 
for  various  reasons,  had  not  joined  the  exodus 
from  Earth.  Both  the  deros  and  the  teros  were 
“robots”  not  because  they  were  walking  me¬ 
chanical  contraptions  but  because  they  were 
under  the  influence  of,  respectively,  negative 
and  positive  energies. 


The  deros  used  the  advanced  technologies 
to  torment  surface-dwellers.  As  Palmer  ex¬ 
plained  it,  they  “have  death  rays,  giant  rockets 
that  traverse  in  the  upper  air  .  .  .  ground  vehi¬ 
cles  of  tremendous  power,  machines  for  the 
revitalizing  of  sex,  known  as  ‘stim’  machines 
(in  which  these  degenerates  sometimes  spend 
their  whole  lives  in  a  sexual  debauch  that  ac¬ 
tually  deforms  their  bodies  in  horrible 
ways)  .  .  .  and  ben  rays  which  heal  and  restore 
the  body  but  are  also  capable  of  restoring  lost 
energy  after  a  debauch”  [Palmer,  1961]).  Be¬ 
sides  causing  plane  crashes,  madness,  violence, 
and  other  maladies  on  the  surface,  deros 
sometimes  abduct  human  beings,  usually 
women,  and  subject  them  to  hideous  tortures. 
Their  rays  cloud  human  thought  and  keep 
them  oblivious  to  the  deros’  existence.  The 
badly  outnumbered  teros  are  engaged  in  a 
protracted  but  ultimately  futile  conflict  with 
their  evil  counterparts. 

After  its  exile  from  Amazing,  the  Shaver  mys¬ 
tery  passed  from  the  attention  of  all  but  a  tiny 
band  of  occult  and  true-mystery  enthusiasts, 
who  continued  to  report  on  and  speculate 
about  deros  and  caverns  in  amateurish  newslet¬ 
ters  as  well  as  Palmer’s  periodicals.  The  “mys¬ 
tery”  figured  in  a  few  not  widely  read  UFO-era 
books,  including  Eric  Norman’s  The  Under-Peo  - 
pie  (1969)  and  Brinsley  le  Poer  Trench’s  Secret  of 
the  Ages:  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth  (1974). 
Several  writers  of  a  skeptical  bent  have  argued 
that  through  Shaver,  as  one  puts  it,  Palmer  “al¬ 
most  single-handedly  created  the  myth  of 
UFOs  as  extraterrestrial  visitors”  (Kafton- 
Minkel,  1989).  In  fact,  a  connection  between 
the  Shaver  mystery  and  the  international  UFO 
phenomenon  of  the  past  five  decades  has  yet  to 
be  demonstrated.  Flying  saucers  as  such  did  not 
enter  Shaverian  mythology  until  after  the  rest  of 
the  world  started  talking  about  them. 

A  more  interesting  issue  concerns  the  moti¬ 
vations  of  the  principals.  Shaver’s  manifest  be¬ 
lief  in  experiences  that  could  not  have  hap¬ 
pened  in  consensus  reality  leads  some,  such  as 
hollow-earth  chronicler  Walter  Kafton-Min- 
kel,  to  see  Shaver  as  a  visionary,  “a  member  of 
that  ancient  fellowship  of  receivers  of  revealed 


226  Shaw’s  Martians 


knowledge,”  a  prophet  like  Moses  or  Joseph 
Smith  though  without  the  religious  trappings. 
Even  if  Shaver  technologized  hell,  he  remained 
to  the  end  an  atheist  and  a  materialist.  To  him 
the  caverns  existed  in  this  world  and  had  noth¬ 
ing  to  do  with  the  supernatural. 

Though  usually  depicted  as  a  cynical  ex¬ 
ploiter  of  a  deluded  man  whom  any  responsi¬ 
ble  adult  would  have  directed  to  the  nearest 
psychiatrist,  Palmer  himself — for  all  his  pro¬ 
motional  instincts,  which  he  exercised  vigor¬ 
ously  in  the  long  course  of  his  association 
with  Shaver — may  have  been  caught  up  in  the 
belief  in  at  least  something.  Perhaps,  he  some¬ 
times  suggested  in  public  statements,  Shaver’s 
experiences  had  occurred  on  the  “astral  realm” 
(Steinberg,  1973).  On  one  occasion,  he  de¬ 
fended  the  “mystery”  in  private  circumstances 
in  which  he  not  only  had  nothing  to  gain  but 
also  risked  looking  foolish.  Though  we  will 
never  know  for  sure,  one  reasonable  reading 
of  Palmer’s  role  in  the  affair  is  that  this  com¬ 
plex  man  was  both  believer  and  exploiter. 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Brodies  deros;  Hollow  earth; 
Lemuria;  Mount  Lassen 

Further  Reading 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter,  1989.  Subterranean  Worlds: 
1 00, 000  Years  of  Dragons,  Dwarf,  the  Dead,  Lost 
Races  and  UFOs  from  inside  the  Earth.  Port 
Townsend,  WA:  Loompanics  Unlimited. 

Palmer,  Ray,  1961.  “Invitation  to  Adventure.”  The 
Hidden  World A-\  (Spring):  4— 14. 

- ,  1980.  “The  Dero  and  the  Tero.”  Gray 

Barker’s  Newsletter  12  (July):  7. 

Shaver,  Richard  S.,  1945.  “I  Remember  Lemuria!” 
Amazing  Stories  19 ,  1  (March):  12-70. 

Steinberg,  Gene,  1971.  “The  Caveat  Emptor  Inter¬ 
view:  Ray  Palmer.”  Caveat  Emptor  1  (Fall):  9-12, 
26. 

- ,  1973.  “The  Caveat  Emptor  Interview: 

Richard  S.  Shaver.”  Caveat  Emptor  10  (Novem¬ 
ber/December):  5-10. 

Wright,  Bruce  Lanier,  1999.  “From  Hero  to  Dero.” 
Fortean  Times  127  (October):  36-41. 


Shaw’s  Martians 

In  November  1896,  unidentified  “airships” — 
what  today  would  be  called  UFOs — were  re¬ 
ported  over  northern  California,  initiating  a 
flurry  of  sightings  and  excitement  that  within 


months  would  move  eastward  until  all  of 
America  was  affected.  This  was  the  first  UFO 
wave  in  America,  and  on  November  25,  1 896, 
the  first  ever  UFO  abduction  occurred — if 
one  credits  the  testimony  of  Colonel  H.  G. 
Shaw,  who  claimed  a  near  escape  from  capture 
by  Martians. 

Shaw  told  his  story  two  days  later  in  a  letter 
published  in  the  Stockton  Evening  Mail,  a  Cal¬ 
ifornia  paper  on  whose  editorial  staff  he  had 
once  served.  On  the  day  of  his  adventure,  he 
and  a  companion,  Camille  Spooner,  left  Lodi 
at  six  o’clock  in  the  morning  and  were  quietly 
moving  along  when  their  horse  abruptly 
snorted  in  terror  and  stopped  in  its  tracks. 
“Three  strange  beings  .  .  .  nearly  or  quite 
seven  feet  high  and  very  slender,”  of  more  or 
less  human  appearance,  strange  beauty,  and 
nudity,  stood  in  front  of  them  on  the  road. 
When  Shaw  approached  them  and  asked 
where  they  came  from,  they  gave  a  response 
that  to  his  ear  sounded  like  “warbling.” 
Speaking  to  each  other,  their  voices  gave  off  a 
“monotonous  chant.”  They  had  small  hands, 
delicate-looking  and  without  fingernails,  and 
long,  narrow  feet.  When  he  briefly  touched 
one,  Shaw  had  the  impression  that  the  being 
weighed  no  more  than  an  ounce.  He  wrote, 

They  .  .  .  were  covered  with  a  natural 
growth  ...  as  soft  as  silk  to  the  touch,  and 
their  skin  was  like  velvet.  Their  faces  and  heads 
were  without  hair,  the  ears  were  very  small,  and 
the  nose  had  the  appearance  of  polished  ivory, 
while  the  eyes  were  large  and  lustrous.  The 
mouth,  however,  was  small,  and  it  seemed  to 
me  that  they  were  without  teeth.  That  and 
other  things  led  me  to  believe  that  they  neither 
ate  nor  drank,  and  that  life  was  sustained  by 
some  sort  of  gas.  Each  of  them  had  swung 
under  the  left  arm  a  bag  to  which  was  attached 
a  nozzle,  and  every  little  while  one  or  the  other 
would  place  the  nozzle  in  his  mouth,  at  which 
time  I  heard  a  sound  as  of  escaping  gas. 

(Bullard,  1982) 

Each  also  carried  an  egg-sized  device  that  cast 
an  “intense  but  not  unpleasant  light”  when 
opened. 


Shiva  227 


At  this  point  the  beings — whom  Shaw  pre¬ 
sumed  to  be  from  Mars — tried  to  carry  him 
and  his  friend  away,  but  weighing  as  little  as 
they  did,  they  lacked  the  strength.  So  they 
turned  around  and  flashed  lights  in  the  direc¬ 
tion  of  a  nearby  bridge.  The  two  men  then 
perceived  an  airship,  some  one-hundred  fifty 
feet  long,  hovering  twenty  feet  over  the  water. 
The  three  Martians  floated  with  a  swaying 
motion  toward  the  craft.  A  door  opened  on 
the  side,  and  the  trio  disappeared  inside.  The 
ship  flew  away  and  was  seen  no  more. 

Concluding  his  letter,  Shaw  blasted  other 
airship  stories  as  “clumsy  fakes”  that  “should 
not  be  given  credence  by  anyone” — presum¬ 
ably  with  tongue  buried  deeply  in  cheek.  Be¬ 
sides  being  the  first  known  alien  encounter  in 
America  to  see  print,  Shaw’s  was  also  the  first 
of  many  hoaxes  to  come  in  the  months  ahead, 
as  newspaper  columns  were  filled  with  out¬ 
landish  tales  of  airships  and  their  occupants, 
extraterrestrial  and  human. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Allingham’s  Mart¬ 
ian;  Aurora  Martian;  Brown’s  Martians;  Calf¬ 
rustling  aliens;  Dentons’s  Martians  and  Venu- 
sians;  Hopkins’s  Martians;  Khauga;  Lethbridge’s 
aeronauts;  Martian  bees;  Michigan  giant;  Mince- 
Pie  Martians;  Monka;  Muller’s  Martians;  Smead’s 
Martians;  Smith;  Wilcox’s  Martians;  Wilson 

Further  Reading 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  ed.,  1982.  The  Airship  File:  A 
Collection  of  Texts  Concerning  Phantom  Airships 
and  Other  UFOs,  Gathered  from  Neivspapers  and 
Periodicals  Mostly  during  the  Flundred  Years  Prior 
to  Kenneth  Arnold’s  Sighting.  Bloomington,  IN: 
self-published. 

Sheep-killing  alien 

In  early  1968,  according  to  a  Bolivian  news¬ 
paper,  a  farm  woman  near  Otoco  went  to  her 
sheep  corral  early  one  evening  to  discover  that 
a  strange  net  had  been  placed  over  it.  A  hu¬ 
manlike  figure,  four  feet  tall  and  wearing  a 
bulky-looking  spacesuit,  was  busy  slaughter¬ 
ing  sheep  with  a  tubular,  hooked  instrument. 
After  killing  the  animals,  he  would  dump 
their  entrails  into  a  bag. 

The  woman  shouted  at  him  and  hurled 
stones  in  his  direction.  The  alien  strolled  over 


to  a  boxlike  instrument  with  a  wheel  at  the 
top.  As  he  twisted  the  wheel,  the  net  was 
withdrawn  into  the  box.  As  he  was  so  en¬ 
gaged,  the  witness  had  picked  up  a  club  and 
was  about  to  use  it  on  the  intruder.  In  re¬ 
sponse,  he  threw  his  weapon  at  her.  Each  time 
it  returned  to  his  hands  like  a  boomerang,  and 
each  time  it  passed  the  woman,  it  cut  her. 
Gathering  his  tools,  the  alien  then  floated 
noisily  upward  and  was  lost  to  sight. 

The  local  police  colonel  counted  thirty- 
four  dead  sheep.  Each  had  had  some  of  its  di¬ 
gestive  organs  removed. 

See  Also:  Calf-rustling  aliens;  Close  encounters  of 
the  third  kind 

Further  Reading 

Galindez,  Oscar  A.,  1970.  “Violent  Humanoid  En¬ 
countered  in  Bolivia.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  16,  4 
(July/ August):  15-17. 

Shiva 

Shiva  is  usually  known  as  a  major  Hindu  god, 
associated  both  with  destruction  and  chaos 
and  with  wisdom  and  meditation.  But  in  Feb¬ 
ruary  and  March  1994,  Shiva — “the  blood, 
the  muscle,  fur,  bone,  and  spirit  of  animals” — 
communicated  through  Sedona,  Arizona,  psy¬ 
chic  Toraya  Ayres.  He  spoke  from  and  for  the 
animal  point  of  view.  He  described  himself 
once  as  having  the  physique  of  a  bear,  another 
time  calling  himself  only  a  “body  of  energy” 
and  denying  that  he  had  any  physical  body. 

Shiva  said  that  human  beings  need  to  reex¬ 
amine  their  destructive  relationship  with  ani¬ 
mals.  Humans  should  not  see  animals  as  infe¬ 
rior  to  them  but  as  equal  but  different 
spiritual  beings.  Animals  do  not  have  a  con¬ 
cept  of  God,  but  they  do  have  a  profound  un¬ 
derstanding  of  their  place  in  nature’s  order. 
“We  do  live  in  an  eternal  now  of  loving  coop¬ 
eration  within  nature,  which  we  recognize 
without  words  as  a  divine  force,  and  as  many 
divine  energies  working  together  for  the 
greater  good.”  Like  humans,  animals  evolve 
and  move  into  higher  dimensions  “in  a  differ¬ 
ent  vibrational  range.” 

“The  physical  world  that  you  know  is  only 
a  tiny  part  of  reality,”  according  to  Shiva. 


228  Shovar 


“You  will  be  exploring  the  nonphysical  worlds 
and  dimensions,  too.  As  multi-dimensional 
beings  you  already  do  this  in  your  dreams,  but 
you  will  soon  do  it  consciously.” 

See  Also:  Ayala 

Further  Reading 

Ayres,  Toraya,  1997.  “Messages  from  the  Animal 
Kingdom.”  http://www.spiritweb.org/Spirit/ani- 
mal-kingdom-ayres.html. 


Shovar 

Shovar  is  the  name  of  a  humanlike  entity  the 
pseudonymous  Rachel  Jones  of  Coeur  d’A¬ 
lene,  Idaho,  allegedly  met  during  a  UFO- 
abduction  experience  over  a  two-hour  period 
between  June  20  and  21,  1977. 

Awakened  at  11:55  RM.  when  she  heard 
someone  walking  upstairs,  Jones  found  her¬ 
self  paralyzed.  She  saw  someone  enter  the 
room,  then  felt  a  lifting  sensation.  In  what 
seemed  an  instant,  she  regained  her  ability  to 
move.  She  was  astonished  to  see  that  it  was 
then  1:57  A.M. 

Under  hypnosis  conducted  by  psycholo¬ 
gist/ufologist  R.  Leo  Sprinkle,  she  told  of  see¬ 
ing  an  ugly  intruder  with  no  pupils  in  his 
eyes,  a  thin-lined  mouth,  normal-looking 
nose,  and  thinning  hair.  He  had  four  lingers 
on  each  hand  but  no  thumbs.  Picking  her  up, 
he  brought  her  to  an  unknown  place  and 
passed  through  a  door  into  a  chamber  with  a 
cold  floor.  Three  other  beings  were  there.  One 
was  human  or  near-human  in  appearance. 
The  man  accompanied  her  into  another  room 
containing  various  instruments,  including 
two  wheel-shaped  devices  and  a  boxlike  table. 
She  sat  on  the  table  and  conversed  with  the 
man,  who  said  his  name  was  Shovar.  He  asked 
her  to  take  off  her  shirt.  After  resisting,  she  re¬ 
luctantly  did  so.  Shovar  expressed  puzzlement 
about  her  suntan,  which  she  then  explained  to 
him. 

She  was  instructed  to  lie  on  her  stomach  as 
a  light  shined  on  her  back.  The  other  beings 
rubbed  a  liquid  on  her  shoulders.  It  caused 
great  pain,  and  she  protested.  Shovar  said  the 
pain  would  stop,  and  it  did.  She  did  not  ac¬ 


cept  his  apology,  however.  It  did  not  sound 
sincere,  and,  moreover,  she  got  the  distinct 
impression  that  he  did  not  even  know  what 
pain  was. 

Even  under  hypnosis  Jones  could  not  re¬ 
call  what  happened  next.  Her  memory 
picked  up  with  a  conversation  with  Shovar, 
who  she  realized  was  communicating  tele- 
pathically.  Shovar  told  her  that  they  had 
changed  her  so  that  she  would  be  “better  for 
others.”  They  had  met  before,  he  went  on, 
and  they  would  meet  again.  Asked  why  they 
had  taken  her,  he  replied  that  he  could  not 
answer  the  question  right  then.  Three  beings 
entered  the  room,  and  Jones  abruptly  found 
herself  back  in  bed. 

Headaches  plagued  her  for  the  next  few 
days,  and  she  noticed  a  small  round  scar  on 
her  shoulder. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Sprinkle,  Ronald 
Leo 

Further  Reading 

“Idaho  Abduction  Case,”  1977.  The  APRO  Bulletin 
(November). 


Sinat  Schirah  (Stan) 

Since  1983,  Sinat  Schirah,  known  affection¬ 
ately  as  Stan,  has  channeled  through  Arlene 
Nelson.  Three  years  later,  Nelson  began  a 
process  she  called  “pure  channeling” — chan¬ 
neling  so  intense  that  she  had  no  conscious 
sense  of  it  while  it  was  happening  or  con¬ 
scious  memory  of  it  afterward.  It  would  take 
place  one  weekend  every  month  between  Jan¬ 
uary  and  May. 

She  and  her  husband,  Mervin  “Beaver” 
Colver,  with  whom  Nelson  believes  she  has 
shared  a  number  of  incarnations,  founded 
Lifelight  University  in  Mill  Valley,  California, 
in  1987.  Students  are  instructed  in  a  variety  of 
New  Age  beliefs  and  practices.  Stan’s  chan¬ 
neled  messages  are  preserved  on  tapes  and  in 
books. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  Ameri  - 
can  Religions.  Fifth  edition.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale 
Research. 


Sister  Thedra  229 


Sister  Thedra 

Sister  Thedra  was  bom  Dorothy  Martin,  but 
to  most  of  the  world  she  is  remembered  as 
“Marian  Keach,”  the  pseudonym  given  her  in 
the  classic  sociological  book  When  Prophecy 
Fails  (1956).  In  1954,  through  space  people 
who  communicated  with  her  through  auto¬ 
matic  writing,  she  learned  of  an  imminent 
catastrophic,  earth-changing  event,  to  occur  a 
week  before  the  end  of  the  year.  She  and  her 
small  band  of  followers  in  Illinois  and  Michi¬ 
gan  would  be  swooped  up  in  a  flying  saucer 
and  rescued  just  before  the  cataclysm  took 
place.  Martin  and  her  followers  sought  to 
publicize  the  prophecy,  only  to  be  ridiculed  in 
newspapers  all  over  the  country.  After  the  fail¬ 
ure  of  the  prophecy,  Martin — soon  renamed 
“Sister  Thedra”  at  the  urging  of  her  space  con¬ 
tacts — moved  to  the  Southwest,  then  to  Peru 
for  five  years.  Returning  to  the  United  States, 
she  established  and  headed  a  contactee-ori- 
ented  spiritual  group  in  Mount  Shasta,  Cali¬ 
fornia.  Toward  the  end  of  her  life,  she  relo¬ 
cated  to  Sedona,  Arizona,  and  died  there  in 
1992. 

Born  in  1900  in  West  Virginia,  Martin  dis¬ 
covered  occultism  in  the  late  1930s  while  liv¬ 
ing  in  New  York  City.  First  attracted  to 
Theosophy,  she  explored  the  spectrum  of  eso¬ 
teric  literature  and  became  an  early  student  of 
Dianetics  (from  which  Scientology  grew).  She 
also  read  the  works  of  Guy  Warren  Ballard, 
creator  of  the  I  AM  movement,  arguably  the 
first  religious  group  to  make  extraterrestrial 
contacts  a  central  tenet.  Another  book,  Oah  - 
spe,  recorded  the  1881  channeling  of  John 
Ballough  Newbrough,  depicting  a  richly  pop¬ 
ulated  spiritual  cosmos  whose  inhabitants  in¬ 
clude  guardian  angels  known  as  “ashars”  who 
sail  the  universe  in  etheric  ships.  When  flying 
saucers  came  on  the  scene  and  the  contactee 
movement  followed  in  their  wake,  Martin  fol¬ 
lowed  developments  with  interest. 

In  the  meantime,  Charles  and  Lillian  Laug- 
head  (pronounced  Law- head)  were  doing  the 
same.  Their  own  odyssey  had  begun  in  1946, 
when  the  couple  were  Protestant  medical  mis¬ 
sionaries  in  Egypt  and  Lillian  started  suffering 


seemingly  untreatable  nightmares  and  fears. 
Seeking  relief,  the  couple  turned  to  occultism. 
On  their  return  to  the  United  States  in  1949, 
Dr.  Laughead  took  up  a  staff  position  at  the 
Michigan  State  College  Hospital  in  East  Lans¬ 
ing.  He  and  his  wife  continued  their  mystical 
studies,  incorporating  flying  saucers  into  their 
newfound  faith.  In  early  1953,  on  a  trip  to 
southern  California,  Laughead  met  George 
Adamski,  whose  claimed  meeting  with  a 
Venusian  named  Orthon  in  the  California 
desert  was  causing  a  worldwide  sensation.  Of 
particular  interest  to  Laughead  were  the  foot¬ 
prints  the  Venusian  had  left  in  the  desert  sand. 
They  contained  enigmatic  symbols  whose 
meaning  Adamski’s  followers  were  already  dis¬ 
cussing  and  debating. 

Laughead  returned  to  Michigan  with  draw¬ 
ings  of  the  prints,  which  his  wife  devoted  the 
next  five  months  to  deciphering.  She  con¬ 
cluded  that  the  left  print’s  symbols  depicted 
the  sinking  of  the  lost  continents  Atlantis  and 
Lemuria,  the  right  their  reemergence  from  the 
ocean  floor  following  geological  cataclysms 
that  soon  would  befall  the  planet. 

Through  an  automatic-writing  message 
given  him  by  an  acquaintance,  Dr.  Laughead 
heard  from  the  “Elder  Brother,”  who  later,  ac¬ 
cording  to  Laughead,  “identified  himself  as 
being  Jesus  the  Christ  and  also  Sananda.” 
Laughead  was  to  continue  his  work  with 
saucers,  and  soon  Venusians  would  contact 
him. 

At  this  stage,  the  Laugheads  had  not  heard 
of  Dorothy  Martin.  They  did  not  know  that 
she  also  was  in  psychic  contact  with  the  Elder 
Brother  as  well  as  with  a  group  of  beings  she 
called  the  Guardians.  In  April  1954,  one  of 
the  latter  introduced  himself  as  Sananda  from 
the  planet  Clarion.  In  a  previous  lifetime, 
Sananda  said,  he  was  Jesus.  Martin — or  at 
least  her  unconscious  mind — got  the  name 
Clarion  from  contactee  Truman  Bethurum, 
but  Bethurum’s  Clarion  was  a  planet  on  the 
other  side  of  the  moon;  Martin/Sananda’s 
Clarion,  on  the  other  hand,  existed  in  the 
etheric  realm.  A  companion  planet,  Cerus 
(sometimes  confusingly  referred  to  also  as  a 


230  Sister  Thedra 


“constellation”),  housed  other  space  people 
who  kept  Martin’s  arm  and  hand  in  furious 
motion  with  automatic  writing  as  they  made 
good  on  their  promise  to  teach  her  cosmic 
wisdom.  The  Elder  Brother  promised  that  he 
would  return  “soon.  .  .  .  They  that  have  told 
you  that  they  do  not  believe  shall  see  us  when 
the  time  is  right”  (Festinger  et  ah,  1956). 

Martin’s  messages  were  attracting  atten¬ 
tion,  and  a  handful  of  followers  soon  came 
together  in  the  Chicago  area.  Among  those 
who  spoke  with  Martin  was  John  Otto,  a 
UFO  lecturer  of  national  reputation  and  no¬ 
table  credulity.  Visiting  Detroit  to  hear  a  lec¬ 
ture  by  Adamski,  Otto  met  the  Faugheads, 
who  informed  him  of  their  saucer  interests 
and  experiences.  Otto  in  turn  urged  them  to 
get  in  touch  with  Martin.  Soon  afterward, 
they  wrote  and  introduced  themselves.  All  of 
this  seemed  particularly  significant  to  Martin 
when  she  received  a  message  urging  her  to  go 
to  East  Fansing  to  seek  “a  child  ...  to  whom  I 
am  trying  to  get  through  with  light.”  When 
informed,  Mrs.  Faughead  immediately  con¬ 
cluded  that  she  was  the  “child”  (Festinger,  et 
al,  1956). 

After  the  Faugheads  met  Martin  in  Oak 
Park  in  early  June  1954,  the  three  formed  a 
close  association  that  would  profoundly  affect 
their  lives  and  fortunes  in  the  months  and 
years  to  come.  By  this  time,  Martin  was  re¬ 
ceiving  as  many  as  ten  messages  a  day,  all  of 
them  ominous,  all  warning  of  imminent  dis¬ 
asters  and  cataclysms.  The  news  was  not  en¬ 
tirely  bad:  Those  who  would  “listen  and  be¬ 
lieve”  would  enter  a  New  Age  of  knowledge 
and  happiness.  The  messages  got  more  spe¬ 
cific.  Spaceships  would  land  soon,  and  se¬ 
lected  individuals  would  be  flown  to  other 
planets,  along  with  space  people  who  had 
been  on  secret  Earth  assignment. 

On  August  1,  Martin,  the  Faugheads,  and 
nine  believers  showed  up  at  a  Chicago-area 
military  base,  where  they  had  been  told  a  fly¬ 
ing  saucer  would  land  at  noon.  No  ship 
showed  up,  but  the  next  day  Sananda  in¬ 
formed  her  through  automatic  writing  that  he 
was  the  stranger  the  group  had  observed  pass¬ 


ing  by  during  the  wait  for  the  landing.  It 
would  not  be  the  last  time  Martin  would  in¬ 
flate  a  mundane  incident  into  a  signal  from 
the  cosmos.  Nor  would  it  be  the  last  of  the 
unfulfilled  prophecies. 

In  that  same  message  on  August  2, 
Sananda  warned  that  soon  a  tidal  wave  off 
Fake  Michigan  would  wash  over  Chicago  and 
cause  enormous  destruction.  Subsequent 
communications  spoke  of  enormous  geologi¬ 
cal  upheaval  that  would  break  North  America 
in  two,  sink  much  of  Europe  under  the  ocean, 
and  raise  Mu  from  its  underwater  grave. 

Martin  and  the  Faugheads  reported  these 
revelations  to  the  larger  world  in  a  seven-page 
mimeographed  document,  “Open  Fetter  to 
American  Editors  and  Publishers,”  sent  out 
on  August  30.  A  handwritten  addendum  ap¬ 
pended  at  the  last  minute  cited  December  20 
as  the  “date  of  evacuation,”  in  other  words, 
the  final  day  on  which  human  beings  living  in 
the  affected  area  could  save  themselves.  A  sec¬ 
ond  mailing  two  weeks  later  concerned  the 
“terrific  wave”  that  would  rise  from  Fake 
Michigan  at  dawn  on  December  21  and  en¬ 
gulf  Chicago. 

Soon  the  group  found  itself  featured  in  a 
tongue-in-cheek  newspaper  story.  The  public¬ 
ity  brought  followers,  curiosity-seekers,  and 
practical  jokers  to  Mrs.  Martin’s  door.  It  also 
brought  her  and  her  group  to  the  attention  of 
the  University  of  Minnesota’s  Faboratory  for 
Research  in  Social  Relations,  which  enlisted  the 
services  of  five  psychologists,  sociologists,  and 
graduate  students.  The  volunteers  were  to  ob¬ 
serve — as  participants  and  self-identified  be¬ 
lievers — a  prophetic  movement  at  work  and  to 
see  what  happened  when  the  anticipated  events 
did  not  occur.  In  due  course,  Feon  Festinger, 
Henry  W.  Riecken,  and  Stanley  Schachter,  the 
professors  who  had  directed  the  experiment, 
chronicled  the  episode  in  When  Prophecy  Fails. 

Though  Martin,  Faughead,  and  the  others 
harbored  ambivalent  feelings  about  the  public¬ 
ity  and  proselytization,  it  would  have  been  im¬ 
possible  to  conceal  what  was  going  on.  The 
group  now  claimed  followers  not  only  in  the 
Chicago  area  but  also  in  East  Fansing  and  De- 


Sister  Thedra  23 1 


troit.  In  East  Lansing,  Laughead  led  a  church- 
related  Quest  group  and,  moreover,  had  ties  to 
the  Detroit  saucer  community,  dominated  by 
contactees  and  mystics,  including  medium  Rose 
Phillips,  who  had  her  own  cosmic  sources. 
When  some  of  Martin’s  followers  asked  Phillips 
about  the  December  2 1  prophecy,  those  sources 
responded  ambiguously. 

On  the  Earth  plane,  Dr.  Laughead  was  fac¬ 
ing  a  serious  professional  and  personal  crisis 
over  his  ever  more  visible  advocacy  of  beliefs 
that  most  people  thought  bizarre  or  even 
laughable.  On  November  22,  he  was  asked  to 
resign  his  position  with  the  college  health  ser¬ 
vice  effective  December  1 ,  though  word  of  the 
firing  would  be  withheld  for  another  three 
weeks.  College  president  John  A.  Elannah 
later  told  the  press  that  students  had  com¬ 
plained  about  Laughead’s  “propagandizing” 
them  “on  a  peculiar  set  of  beliefs  of  question¬ 
able  validity”  (“The  End,”  1955).  Effectively 
cutting  their  ties  to  East  Lansing,  the  Laugh- 
eads  moved  into  the  Martin  residence  and 
awaited  the  arrival  of  the  flying  saucers  that 
would  save  them  and  their  companions  at  the 
onset  of  the  December  21  cataclysm. 

On  December  17,  a  Chicago  newspaper 
exposed  the  group’s  strange  beliefs  and  Laug¬ 
head’s  loss  of  employment.  Other  papers 
around  the  country,  and  soon  afterward  the 
world,  picked  up  the  story,  and  the  result  was 
blistering  ridicule  on  an  international  scale. 
The  publicity  also  left  the  relentlessly  gullible 
group  open  to  pranks  that  periodically  sent  its 
members  packing  in  preparation  for  meetings 
with  space  people  or  saucer  landings. 

Though  on  the  morning  of  the  twentieth 
the  Guardians  promised  that  they  would 
board  a  flying  saucer  just  after  midnight,  no 
spaceship  appeared.  Stunned,  the  group  tried 
to  figure  out  what  had  happened.  Finally, 
someone  suggested  that  the  group’s  positive 
work  had  prevented  the  flood.  Not  long  after¬ 
ward,  a  message  from  Sananda  confirmed  that 
interpretation.  When  Laughead  called  re¬ 
porters  and  wire  services  to  pass  on  the  good 
news,  he  triggered  a  fresh  round  of  ridicule- 
laced  stories.  Even  worse,  group  members 


who  had  given  up  jobs  and  cut  ties  with  skep¬ 
tical  family  members  faced  uncertain  futures. 

Prank  calls  and  visits  over  the  next  24  days, 
however,  kept  the  group  open  to  the  prospect 
of  a  landing.  Martin  also  claimed  that  earth¬ 
quakes  that  had  taken  place  in  Italy  and  Cali¬ 
fornia  validated  her  prophecy.  By  now  she  was 
grasping  at  anything.  A  message  on  the 
twenty-third  directed  everyone  to  stand  in 
front  of  the  Martin  house  at  6  P.M.  and  sing 
Christmas  carols,  at  which  time  a  saucer 
would  come  down  and  its  crew  would  engage 
the  group  in  personal  conversation.  The  mes¬ 
sage  further  instructed  the  group  to  publicize 
the  new  prophecy  and  to  invite  all  interested 
persons  to  come. 

For  Martin,  the  caroling  episode  marked  a 
turning  point.  It  sparked  a  near  riot  and  drew 
law-enforcement  personnel  to  the  scene.  Com¬ 
munity  pressure  forced  the  police  to  draw  up  a 
warrant  against  Martin  and  Laughead,  charg¬ 
ing  them  with  disturbing  the  peace  and  con¬ 
tributing  to  the  delinquency  of  minors.  She 
was  also  warned  that  she  faced  psychiatric  ex¬ 
amination  and  possible  institutionalization. 

Early  in  January  1955,  Dorothy  Martin 
slipped  out  of  town.  Under  an  assumed  name, 
she  flew  to  Arizona.  In  her  new  residence  she 
found  herself  much  closer  to  the  hub  of  con- 
tactee  activity.  Both  Truman  Bethurum  and 
George  Elunt  Williamson  (a  contactee,  fringe 
archaeologist,  and  alleged  witness  to  Adamski’s 
first  Venusian  encounter)  lived  in  Arizona.  The 
Laugheads,  now  resettled  in  southern  Califor¬ 
nia,  dropped  in  from  time  to  time. 

Through  Williamson’s  channelings,  the 
Laugheads  and  Martin  learned  of  the  Brother¬ 
hood  of  the  Seven  Rays,  a  supernatural  order 
dating  back  to  Lemurian  times  and  headquar¬ 
tered  in  the  present  Lake  Titicaca  in  Peru. 
Guided  by  further  prophecies  of  imminent 
apocalypse  channeled  through  both  William¬ 
son  and  Martin,  the  two — along  with  a  small 
band  of  disciples — moved  to  Titicaca  to  estab¬ 
lish  the  Priority  of  All  Saints  in  the  remote 
northern  town  Moyobamba.  From  Hemet, 
California,  the  Laugheads  kept  the  North 
American  faithful  abreast  of  developments.  A 


232  Sky  people 


bulletin  reported  day-by-day  activities  there. 
Each  report  was  accompanied  by  a  transcript 
of  channeled  or  automatically  written  mes¬ 
sages,  often  with  apocalyptic  overtones.  Soon, 
these  messages  said,  cataclysmic  changes 
would  bring  flying  saucers  down  from  the 
skies  and  Lemuria  and  Atlantis  up  from  the 
ocean  bottom. 

By  the  summer  of  1 957,  however,  nearly  all 
of  the  spiritual  pilgrims  were  back  in  the 
United  States.  The  exception  was  Martin, 
whom  Sananda  had  directed  to  stay  behind. 

Living  under  the  most  primitive  condi¬ 
tions,  suffering  from  poverty  and  ill  health, 
Martin  barely  survived.  She  felt  that  her  col¬ 
leagues  had  betrayed  her.  She  spent  a  portion 
of  her  meager  income  on  postage  for  mailings 
to  North  America,  but  no  one  seemed  to  lis¬ 
ten  or  care.  Even  so,  the  messages  continued 
to  come  at  a  furious  pace.  Now  they  included 
dramatic  visionary  encounters  with  various 
space  people,  angels,  and  religious  figures. 

Though  expecting  to  spend  the  rest  of  her 
life  in  the  Andes,  Martin  was  surprised  to  re¬ 
ceive  instructions  to  return  to  the  United 
States  in  1961.  She  moved  to  southern  Cali¬ 
fornia  and  was  there  for  nearly  a  year  before 
heading  to  the  far  northern  part  of  the  state 
and  Mount  Shasta,  long  an  attraction  to 
Americas  mystically  minded.  Occult  legend 
held  that  a  colony  of  Lemurians  lived  inside 
or  under  the  mountain.  The  Lemurians  main¬ 
tained  contacts  with  extraterrestrials  who  reg¬ 
ularly  arrived  in  saucers. 

Sananda  and  Sanat  Kumara  ordered  Mar¬ 
tin  to  establish  the  Association  of  Sananda 
and  Sanat  Kumara.  Finding  peace  and  stabil¬ 
ity  at  last,  she  took  up  residence  in  the  Shasta 
area  and  worked  with  a  small  but  devoted 
band  of  followers  who  carefully  recorded  and 
circulated  the  messages  she  received  daily. 

By  1988,  with  Sedona,  Arizona,  now  the 
New  Age  center  of  North  America,  the  space 
people  dictated  yet  another  move.  It  was  here, 
on  June  13,  1992,  that  Sister  Thedra’s  long, 
strange  trip  ended.  Just  before  her  death 
Sananda  told  her  of  his  plans  for  her  in  the 
next  world.  As  her  body  failed,  her  hand 


guided  a  pen  one  last  time  to  write  the  final 
message  from  her  beloved  cosmic  friend:  “It  is 
now  come  the  time  that  ye  come  out  of  the 
place  wherein  ye  are.  .  .  .  Let  it  be,  for  many 
shall  greet  thee  with  glad  shouts!” 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Atlantis;  Bethurum, 
Truman;  Contactees;  Lemuria;  Mount  Shasta; 
Orthon;  Sananda;  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Clark,  Jerome,  1997.  “The  Odyssey  of  Sister  The- 
dra.”  Syzygy  6,  2  (Summer/Fall):  203-219. 

“The  End  of  the  World,”  1955.  The  Saucerian  3,  2 
(Spring):  4-7,  55-60. 

Festinger,  Leon,  Henry  W  Riecken,  and  Stanley 
Schachter,  1956.  When  Prophecy  Fails.  Min¬ 
neapolis:  University  of  Minnesota  Press. 

Ibn  Aharon,  Y.  N.  [pseud.  ofYonah  Fortner],  1957. 
“Diagnosis:  A  Case  of  Chronic  Fright.”  Saucer 
News  4,  5  (August/September):  3-6. 


Sky  people 

Brinsley  le  Poer  Trench,  author  of  a  series  of 
books  proposing  esoteric  theories  about  every¬ 
thing  from  space  visitors  to  the  Earths  hidden 
history,  held  that  the  “sky  people” — called  the 
Elohim  in  the  Old  Testament — created  Ani¬ 
mal  or  Adamic  Man,  otherwise  known  as  the 
present  human  race.  The  creation  occurred  via 
what  would  now  be  called  genetic  engineer¬ 
ing,  and  it  was  done  by  a  renegade  band  of 
Elohim  called  the  Jehovah.  The  Jehovah, 
knowing  that  their  experiment  was  an  unau¬ 
thorized  one,  removed  their  creation  to  an  ob¬ 
scure  location — what  the  Bible  calls  the  Gar¬ 
den  of  Eden — on  Mars.  In  due  course, 
another  extraterrestrial  race,  known  as  the  Ser¬ 
pent  people,  learned  of  the  Garden  and  visited 
it,  curious  about  experiments  that  had  created 
women.  The  Serpent  people  gave  the  hereto- 
fore-innocent  inhabitants  of  the  Garden  wis¬ 
dom  and  scientific  knowledge,  and  they  also 
introduced  them  to  sexual  intercourse  and  re¬ 
production.  Many  of  the  Adamic  Women 
bore  children  sired  by  the  Serpent  race. 

The  Jehovah  were  furious  when  they  found 
out  about  the  Serpent  people’s  interference, 
but  it  was  too  late  for  them  to  continue  their 
domination  of  Adamic  Man.  The  individual 
Jehovah  most  responsible  for  the  experiment, 


Smith  233 


Noah-I,  was  driven  from  Mars.  With  his  cre¬ 
ations,  he  flew  back  to  Earth  in  a  spaceship 
(Noah’s  Ark)  and  populated  the  Earth. 

According  to  Trench,  all  human  conflict 
stems  from  mankind’s  dual  nature.  Only  if  we 
achieve  “total  consciousness” — in  which  both 
the  superior  Serpent  heritage  and  the  Animal 
nature  are  integrated — can  we  claim  our  place 
as  wise,  peaceful  citizens  of  the  galaxy. 

Further  Reading 

Trench,  Brinsley  le  Poer,  1960.  The  Sky  People.  Lon¬ 
don:  Neville  Spearman. 


Smead’s  Martians 

A  century  ago  pioneering  psychical  researcher 
James  Elyslop  investigated  a  case  in  which  an 
American  woman  received  psychic  messages 
from  Mars.  The  Martians,  however,  were  not 
natives  of  the  planet  but  deceased  relatives 
who  were  now  living  on  the  Red  Planet. 

The  woman,  whom  Hyslop  identifies  only 
as  Mrs.  Smead,  was  married  to  a  clergyman. 
All  her  life  she  had  had  psychic  experiences, 
many  of  them  involving  spirit  communica¬ 
tions  through  automatic  writing.  Then  in 
1895  a  different  set  of  messages  started  to 
come  through.  They  were  from  her  three  dead 
children  and  her  deceased  brother-in-law. 
One  of  the  daughters,  Maude,  provided  a  de¬ 
scription  of  her  new  home,  which  she  said  was 
crisscrossed  with  canals,  reflecting  a  belief  to 
that  effect  (since  conclusively  debunked) 
promulgated  by  astronomer  Percival  Lowell. 

The  communications  ceased,  then  resumed 
again  five  years  later  as  if  there  had  been  no 
interruption.  Invited  to  assess  them,  Hyslop 
deduced  that  they  came  out  of  a  “secondary 
personality” — what  now  would  be  called  the 
unconscious  mind — of  Mrs.  Smead’s.  He 
wrote, 

We  find  in  such  cases  evidence  that  we  need 
not  attribute  fraud  to  the  normal  conscious¬ 
ness,  and  we  discover  automatic  processes  of 
mentation  that  may  be  equally  acquitted  of 
fraudulent  intent;  while  we  are  also  free  from 
the  obligation  to  accept  the  phenomena  at 


their  assumed  value.  Their  most  extraordinary 
characteristic  is  the  extent  to  which  they  imi¬ 
tate  the  organizing  principle  intelligence  of  a 
normal  mind,  and  the  perfection  of  their  im¬ 
personation  of  spirits,  always  betraying  their 
limitations,  however,  just  at  the  point  where  we 
have  the  right  to  expect  veridical  testimony  to 
their  claims.  (Hyslop,  1908) 

See  Also:  Aliens  and  the  dead;  Allingham’s  Martian; 
Aurora  Martian;  Brown’s  Martians;  Dentons’s 
Martians  and  Venusians;  Hopkins’s  Martians; 
Khauga;  Martian  bees;  Mince-Pie  Martians; 
Monka;  Muller’s  Martians;  Shaw’s  Martians; 
Wilcox’s  Martians 
Further  Reading 

Hyslop,  James  H.,  1908.  Psychical  Research  and  the 
Resurrection.  London:  Fisher  Unwin. 


Smith 

During  a  wave  of  sightings  of  mysterious, 
never-explained  “airships”  (UFOs  in  modern 
terminology)  in  the  spring  of  1897,  a  Rock¬ 
land,  Texas,  man  named  John  Barclay  claimed 
an  encounter  with  a  close-lipped  pilot  who 
gave  only  his  last  name.  The  Houston  Daily 
Post  of  April  25  reported  the  incident. 

Around  1 1  P.M.,  as  Barclay  told  the  story, 
he  heard  his  dogs  barking  frantically.  Glanc¬ 
ing  out  his  window,  he  was  startled  to  see  an 
oblong-shaped  object  with  wings  circling  just 
above  his  pasture.  Moments  later  the  ship 
landed.  Winchester  rifle  in  hand,  the  witness 
stepped  outside  where  he  spotted  a  stranger. 
The  stranger  identified  himself  only  as 
“Smith.”  He  would  not  allow  Barclay  to  get 
closer  to  the  ship.  “We  cannot  allow  you  to 
get  any  closer,  but  do  as  we  request  [and]  your 
kindness  will  be  appreciated,”  Smith  said, 
“and  we  will  call  on  you  some  future  day  and 
reciprocate  your  kindness  by  taking  you  on  a 
trip.”  He  handed  Barclay  ten  dollars  and 
asked  him  to  purchase  lubricating  oil,  two 
cold  chisels,  and  bluestone  from  a  nearby  saw 
mill  and  railroad  depot.  On  his  return  Barclay 
asked  the  aeronaut  where  he  was  from.  “Any¬ 
where,”  Smith  replied,  then  added,  “We  will 
be  in  Greece  day  after  tomorrow.”  He  entered 
the  ship  and  was  gone. 


234  Source 


Since  conventional  aviation  history  attests 
that  no  such  ships  were  flying  over  America  in 
the  late  nineteenth  century,  some  UFO  writ¬ 
ers  have  theorized  that  the  so-called  aeronauts 
were  really  extraterrestrials  or  supernatural  en¬ 
tities  in  disguise.  A  more  likely  explanation  is 
that  the  stories  were  hoaxes  of  the  sort  that 
filled  many  period  newspapers. 

See  Also:  Aurora  Martian;  Lethbridge’s  aeronauts; 
Michigan  giant;  Ultraterrestrials;  Wilson 

Further  Reading 

Chariton,  Wallace  O.,  1991.  The  Great  Texas  Airship 
Mystery.  Plano,  TX:  Wordware  Publishing. 

Cohen,  Daniel,  1981.  The  Great  Airship  Mystery:  A 
UFO  of  the  1890s.  New  York:  Dodd,  Mead  and 
Company. 

Source 

The  Source,  a  sort  of  universal  mind,  was 
channeled  through  Paul  Solomon.  Solomons 
channeling  began  in  1972  when  he  was  living 
in  Atlanta  and  going  through  acute  personal 
distress  in  the  wake  of  a  failed  marriage.  In  an 
effort  to  deal  with  his  emotional  problems, 
Solomon  underwent  hypnosis.  Under  hypno¬ 
sis  a  powerful  voice  spoke  through  his  mouth, 
warning,  “You  have  not  attained  sufficient 
growth  or  spiritual  awareness  to  understand 
contact  with  these  records!”  Bewildered, 
Solomon  and  hypnotist  Harry  Snipes  III  de¬ 
cided  to  explore  the  mystery  in  a  second  ses¬ 
sion.  From  there  the  Source,  as  Solomon  and 
Snipes  called  it,  began  instructing  Solomon 
on  how  to  communicate  with  it  and  how  to 
pass  on  its  wisdom  to  others. 

The  Source  taught  a  spiritual  philosophy 
that  it  called  “Inner  Light  Consciousness,” 
thus  the  name  of  the  organization  Solomon 
soon  formed:  Fellowship  of  the  Inner  Light. 
In  1974,  Solomon  and  his  followers  relocated 
to  Virginia  Beach,  Virginia,  where  Edgar 
Cayce,  to  whom  Solomon  would  be  com¬ 
pared,  had  lived  and  had  pursued  his  spiritual 
work.  Like  Cayce’s,  Solomon’s  readings  en¬ 
compassed  Atlantis,  reincarnation,  healing, 
prophecies,  and  more. 

The  Source  claimed  to  be  a  greater  power 
than  the  spirit  or  channeling  entities  that  were 


a  good  part  of  the  focus  of  the  New  Age 
movement  of  the  1970s  and  1980s.  Its  mis¬ 
sion  was  to  provide  a  way  for  seekers  to  touch 
the  Holy  Spirit  within  them  and,  thereafter, 
to  let  it  guide  them.  Before  his  death  in  1994, 
Solomon  had  conducted  thousands  of  read¬ 
ings,  many  preserved  on  tape  and  sold  by  as¬ 
sociates  who  seek  to  keep  his  and  the  Source’s 
memory  alive. 

See  Also:  Atlantis;  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Beidler,  William,  1977.  “Paul  Solomon  .  .  .  Another 
Cayce?”  Fate  30,  2  (February):  56-61. 

A  Healing  Consciousness,  1978.  Virginia  Beach,  VA: 
Master’s  Press. 

Spiritual  Unfoldment  and  Psychic  Development 
through  Inner  Light  Consciousness,  1973.  Atlanta, 
GA:  Fellowship  of  the  Inner  Light. 

Wheeler,  W.  Alexander,  1994.  The  Prophetic  Revela  - 
tions  of  Paul  Solomon:  Earthivard  toivard  a  Heav  - 
enly  Light.  New  York:  Samuel  B.  Weiser. 


SPECTRA 

Under  hypnosis  on  November  30,  1971,  Is¬ 
raeli  psychic  Uri  Geller  “recalled”  an  incident 
that  occurred  when  he  was  three  years  old. 
Geller  encountered  a  dazzling  light  from 
which  a  voice  emanated.  The  voice  said  it  was 
his  “programmer.”  Over  the  years,  Geller  re¬ 
ceived  many  more  messages  from  this  intelli¬ 
gence,  which  called  itself  SPECTRA  and, 
sometimes,  Hoova.  It  gave  Geller  his  reported 
paranormal  talents.  In  the  opinion  of  Geller’s 
hypnotist  and  then-collaborator,  physician/ 
parapsychologist  Andrija  Puharich,  Geller 
may  have  been  a  prophet  “specifically  created 
to  serve  as  an  intermediary  between  a  ‘divine’ 
intelligence  and  man”  (Puharich,  1974). 

SPECTRA  claimed  it  was  a  supercomputer 
into  which  the  minds  and  bodies  of  a  wide  va¬ 
riety  of  intelligent  beings  had  been  trans¬ 
ferred.  These  beings  communicated  with 
Geller  through  automatic  writing,  states  of  al¬ 
tered  consciousness,  and  voices  on  blank 
tapes.  SPECTRA’s  first  appearance  on  Earth 
was  twenty  thousand  years  ago,  when  its 
spaceship  landed  in  the  present  nation  of  Is¬ 
rael.  Since  then  SPECTRA  has  seen  the  Jews 


Springheel  Jack  235 


Uri  Geller,  the  psychic  performer,  ca.  1978  (Hulton- 
Deutsch  Collection/ Corbis) 

as  its  special  people  and  has  tried  to  protect 
them.  In  the  meantime,  other  beings  from 
other  planets  and  dimensions  unrelated  to 
SPECTRA  have  visited  Earth.  The  beings  be¬ 
hind  SPECTRA  have  said  that  they  live  in  the 
future.  They  are  short  and  generally  human  in 
appearance,  looking  like — in  their  words — 
“certain  exotic  types  of  Japanese.” 

This  fantastic  tale  figured  largely  in 
Puharich’s  Uri  (1974),  but  Geller  himself  dis¬ 
tanced  himself  from  it.  His  own  autobiogra¬ 
phy,  published  a  year  after  Puharich’s  book, 
does  not  even  mention  SPECTRA,  though  it 
does  recount  his  childhood  close  encounter 
with  a  “silvery  mass  of  light”  that  seemed  to 
make  time  stand  still.  As  the  light  approached 
him,  the  youthful  Geller  felt  a  sharp  pain  in 
his  forehead,  then  lost  consciousness  for  an 
undetermined  period  of  time. 


Further  Reading 

Geller,  Uri,  1975.  Uri  Geller:  My  Story.  New  York: 
Praeger  Publishers. 

Puharich,  Andrija,  1974.  Uri:  A  Journal  of  the  Mys 
tery  of  Uri  Geller.  Garden  City,  NY:  Anchor 
Press/Doubleday  and  Company. 


Springheel  Jack 

Springheel  Jack  (sometimes  referred  to  as 
Spring  Heeled  Jack)  is  a  figure  out  of  Victo¬ 
rian  folklore,  a  mysterious  man  or  being  of  vi¬ 
olent  disposition  and  a  strange  ability  to  jump 
great  distances.  Stories  about  him  were  first 
told  in  suburban  London  in  September  1837. 
Some  victims  described  him  as  a  man  wearing 
a  flowing  cloak  and  glaring  at  his  victims  with 
glowing  eyes.  It  was  claimed  that  he  shot 
flames  from  his  mouth.  Others  said  he  dis¬ 
guised  himself  as  a  white  bull  or  bear,  while  at 
least  one  witness  claimed  he  wore  “polished 
steel  armor,  with  red  shoes”  (“Credulity,” 
1838).  Some  reports  suggested  that  the  at¬ 
tacker  was  not  acting  alone.  Many  of  the  at¬ 
tacks  were  on  women  and  were  seemingly  sex¬ 
ual  in  nature  (he  ripped  their  clothes),  though 
apparently  they  did  not  involve  actual  rape. 
London  police,  who  took  the  reports  seri¬ 
ously,  investigated  them  but  made  no  arrests. 
Popular  speculation  pointed  to  Henry  Mar¬ 
quis  of  Waterford,  a  man  noted  for  reckless¬ 
ness,  drunkenness,  and  other  behavioral  ex¬ 
cesses,  but  no  clear  or  convincing  evidence 
backed  up  the  suspicions.  Superstitious  peo¬ 
ple  held  that  Springheel  Jack  was  a  ghost,  and 
that  belief  took  root  in  folklore. 

Sporadic  sightings  of  a  mysterious  leaping 
figure  occurred  in  various  places  in  England 
into  the  twentieth  century.  In  1877,  many 
residents  of  Caistor,  Norfolk,  saw  someone 
dressed  in  sheepskin  (reminiscent  of  earlier  re¬ 
ports  of  Jack’s  cladding  himself  in  animal 
skin)  jumping  from  roof  to  roof,  and  the  same 
or  a  similar  individual  was  widely  observed  in 
Lincolnshire.  On  one  occasion,  when  a  mob 
chased  him,  he  leaped  over  walls  and  roofs.  In 
1 904,  in  Liverpool’s  Everton  district,  residents 
saw  a  man  dressed  in  a  cloak  and  black  boots 


236  Sprinkle,  Ronald  Leo 


executing  high  leaps,  on  one  occasion  al¬ 
legedly  springing  from  the  ground  to  a 
rooftop  twenty-five  feet  high. 

Though  Springheel  Jack  legends  are  not  a 
part  of  American  folklore,  figures  very  much 
like  him  appear  in  a  few  curious  episodes.  In 
1938,  a  century  after  the  London  reports, 
people  in  and  around  Provincetown,  Massa¬ 
chusetts,  claimed  encounters  with  a  leaping 
man  with  fierce-looking  eyes  and  pointed 
ears.  They  said  he  stunned  his  victims  with  a 
blue  flame  emanating  from  his  mouth.  Com¬ 
parable  stories  were  told  in  Baltimore  in  the 
summer  of  1951.  On  June  18,  1953,  three 
witnesses  in  a  Houston  neighborhood  al¬ 
legedly  sighted  a  leaping,  black-clad  figure  in 
a  cloak  and  saw  a  rocket-shaped  UFO  zoom 
away  moments  after  the  beings  disappear¬ 
ance.  At  least  two  other  cases  link  leaping, 
Jacklike  figures  to  UFOs,  one  in  Gallipolis, 
Ohio,  in  the  early  1960s,  another  at  Washing¬ 
ton’s  Yakima  Indian  Reservation  in  December 
1975. 

The  first  suggestion  that  Jack  may  have 
been  an  extraterrestrial  appeared  in  the 
March  6,  1954,  issue  of  the  British  magazine 
Everybody’s.  The  next  year,  in  a  book  on  Liver¬ 
pool  history  and  lore,  Richard  Whittington- 
Egan  remarked  that  such  a  theory  “would  ac¬ 
count  for  his  astounding  leaping  proclivities 
because  he  would  be  adapted  to  the  require¬ 
ments  of  life  on  a  greater-gravity  planet.  Like¬ 
wise,  differences  in  physical  constitution 
would  probably  enable  him  to  live  longer  on 
earth  and  might  well  explain  the  flame-like 
emanations  from  his  mouth”  (Whittington- 
Egan,  1955). 

On  the  other  hand,  in  an  extended  survey 
of  all  available  literature  on  the  legend,  British 
writer  Mike  Dash  rejected  any  notion  that  the 
various  reports  over  a  century  and  a  half  were 
connected  except  as  folklore.  In  Dash’s  view, 
“Springheel  Jack”  is  a  catchall  name  denoting 
unrelated  pranksters,  hoaxers,  and  criminals. 
Still,  it  is  hard  to  deny  that  intriguing  ques¬ 
tions  remain,  and  Springheel  Jack — whatever 
he  or  it  may  or  may  not  be — constitutes  an 
appealingly  romantic  mystery. 


Further  Reading 

“Credulity — The  Ghost  Story,”  1838.  London  Times 
(January  10). 

Dash,  Mike,  1996.  “Spring-Heeled  Jack:  To  Victo¬ 
rian  Bugaboo  from  Suburban  Ghost.”  In  Steve 
Moore,  ed.  Fortean  Studies,  Volume  3,  7-125. 
London:  John  Brown  Publishing. 

Haining,  Peter,  1977.  The  Legend  and  Bizarre  Crimes 
of  Spring  Lieeled  Jack.  London:  Frederick  Muller. 

Whittington-Egan,  Richard,  1955.  Liverpool  Colon  - 
nade.  Liverpool,  England:  Son  and  Nephew. 


Sprinkle,  Ronald  Leo  (1930-  ) 

R.  Leo  Sprinkle  is  a  psychologist  in  private 
practice  in  Laramie,  Wyoming.  Prior  to  that, 
as  a  member  of  the  counseling  department  of 
the  University  of  Wyoming,  he  became 
known  as  one  of  a  handful  of  mental-health 
professionals  with  a  sympathetic  interest  in 
the  UFO  phenomenon.  He  was  the  first  to 
study  the  psychological  make-up  of  abductees 
and  contactees.  In  1968,  as  a  psychological 
consultant  for  the  U.S.  Air  Force-sponsored 
University  of  Colorado  UFO  Project,  he  hyp¬ 
notized  a  Nebraska  police  officer  who  re¬ 
ported  a  puzzling  period  of  missing  time  dur¬ 
ing  a  close  encounter.  Sprinkle’s  principal 
interest,  however,  was  in  persons  who  be¬ 
lieved  themselves  to  be  in  psychic  and  other 
contact  with  friendly  space  people,  whom 
Sprinkle  called  “UFOlk.”  In  1980,  he  and  the 
Institute  for  UFO  Contactee  Studies  held  the 
first  Rocky  Mountain  Conference  on  UFO 
Investigation.  From  then  until  1996  he 
would  direct  the  meetings,  which  brought 
together  contactees,  their  followers,  and  in¬ 
terested  observers. 

Sprinkle’s  interest  was,  and  is,  more  than 
academic.  He  believes  himself  to  be  a  con¬ 
tactee  and  maintains  an  active  interest  in  rein¬ 
carnation  and  other  metaphysical  questions. 
UFOs  and  their  occupants  are  here,  he  be¬ 
lieves,  “so  that  human  development  moves 
from  Planetary  Persons  to  Cosmic  Citizens” 
(Sprinkle,  1995). 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Parnell,  June  O.,  and  R.  Leo  Sprinkle,  1990.  “Per¬ 
sonality  Characteristics  of  Persons  Who  Claim 


Star  People  237 


UFO  Experiences.”  Journal  of  UFO  Studies  2 
(new  series):  45-58. 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  1999.  Sold  Samples:  Personal  Explo  - 
rations  in  Reincarnation  and  UFO  Experiences. 
Columbus,  NC:  Granite  Publishing. 

- ,  1969.  “Personal  and  Scientific  Attitudes:  A 

Study  of  Persons  Interested  in  UFO  Reports.”  In 
Charles  Bowen,  ed.  Beyond  Condon:  Flying  Saucer 
Review  Special  Issue  No.  2,  June,  6-10.  London: 
Flying  Saucer  Review. 

- ,  1976.  “Flypnotic  and  Psychic  Aspects  of 

UFO  Research.”  In  Proceedings  of  the  1976 
CUFOS  Conference,  251-258.  Evanston,  IL: 
Center  for  UFO  Studies. 

- ,  1995.  “The  Significance  of  UFO  Experi¬ 
ences.”  In  David  Pursglove,  ed.  Zen  in  the  Art  of 
Close  Encounters,  164-165.  Berkeley,  CA:  New 
Being  Project. 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  ed.,  1980.  Proceedings  of  the  Rocky 
Mountain  Conference  on  UFO  Investigation. 
Laramie,  WY:  School  of  Extended  Studies. 


Star  People 

“Star  People”  is  a  notion  made  popular  in  the 
late  1970s  and  early  1980s.  Brad  Steiger,  a 
prolific  writer  on  paranormal,  occult,  and  ufo¬ 
logical  subjects,  introduced  the  phrase  in  a 
1976  book.  He  writes  that  the  “majority  of 
Amerindian  Medicine  People”  believe  that 
Star  People — individuals  who  many  lifetimes 
ago  came  to  Earth  with  a  mission  from  their 
home  worlds — are  “becoming  active  at  this 
time  in  an  effort  to  aid  mankind  [in  surviv¬ 
ing]  a  coming  Great  Purification  of  the 
planet”  (Steiger,  1976).  In  the  course  of  his 
investigation  of  channeling  and  channelers,  he 
says,  he  became  aware  of  women  he  calls  “Star 
Maidens.”  Such  women  shared  certain  physi¬ 
cal  characteristics  and  had  “memories”  of  ar¬ 
riving  on  Earth  twenty  thousand  years  ago  in 
a  starship.  Before  long  Steiger  became  con¬ 
vinced  that  just  as  many  men — including 
himself — had  similar  claims  to  extraterrestrial 
origin. 

Steiger  eventually  married  a  woman  he  be¬ 
lieved  to  be  a  Star  Maiden,  Francie  Paschal. 
Paschal  reported  a  lifetime  of  otherworldly  ex¬ 
periences,  beginning  with  childhood  visions 
in  which  an  apparitional  spaceman,  looking 
like  a  “Hollywood-type  Viking  prince,”  told 


her,  “Like  unto  another  Christ  child  you  will 
be.”  He  said  she  was  from  a  “planet .  .  .  like 
unto  Venus”  (Steiger,  1976).  She  and  Steiger 
believed  they  had  shared  previous  lives.  As 
part  of  what  they  believed  to  be  their  mission, 
the  couple  moved  from  upstate  New  York  to 
Scottsdale,  Arizona. 

An  article  on  their  beliefs  concerning  Star 
People  in  the  May  1,  1979,  issue  of  the  Na  - 
tional  Enquirer  brought  them  a  flood  of  let¬ 
ters  and  telephone  calls.  It  turned  out  that 
other  persons  suspected  that  they  also  were 
space  people  put  in  place  to  help  the  human 
race  through  coming  cataclysms  and  changes. 
Many  said  they  had  heard  a  disembodied 
voice  tell  them,  “Now  is  the  time,”  shortly 
before  they  read  the  Enquirer  piece.  The 
Steigers  went  on  to  release  books  in  the  “Star 
People  Series,”  three  originals  and  two 
reprints  of  earlier  Brad  Steiger  titles.  The 
originals  were  based  in  considerable  part  on 
Francie’s  channelings. 

According  to  these  messages,  the  Starseeds 
are  the  true  Star  People.  As  direct  descendants 
of  extraterrestrials,  they  have  both  alien  and 
human  genes.  The  Star  Helpers  are  descen¬ 
dants  of  the  extraterrestrials’  original  disciples. 
Later,  from  further  channeling,  hypnotic  re¬ 
gression,  and  testimony  from  others,  the 
Steigers  concluded  that  three  different  types 
of  space  ancestors  could  be  discerned:  Refu¬ 
gees  who  crash-landed  on  this  planet  thou¬ 
sands  of  years  ago,  after  escaping  from  turmoil 
and  destruction  on  their  home  planet;  Utopi¬ 
ans,  benign  aliens  who  colonized  other  worlds 
to  give  them  perfect  societies;  and  Energy 
Essences,  nonphysical  entities  who  drift 
through  space,  drop  in  on  planets,  and  occa¬ 
sionally  occupy  a  host  body. 

In  The  Star  People  (1981),  the  Steigers  re¬ 
ported  that  a  number  of  their  correspondents 
believed  they  had  insights  into  the  immediate 
future.  They  foresaw  worldwide  famine  in 
1982,  a  pole  shift  between  1982  and  1984, 
World  War  III  no  later  than  1985,  and  Ar¬ 
mageddon  around  1990.  Somewhere  in  the 
middle  of  this,  space  people  would  land  and 
announce  their  presence. 


238  Stellar  Community  of  Enlightened  Ecosystems 


By  the  mid-1980s,  the  Steigers  had  di¬ 
vorced,  and  only  Francie  maintained  enthusi¬ 
asm  for  the  Star  People  notion.  Her  death,  a 
few  years  later,  effectively  ended  what  re¬ 
mained  of  the  movement. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1973.  Revelation:  The  Divine  Fire.  En¬ 
glewood  Cliffs,  NJ:  Prentice-Hall. 

- ,  1976.  Gods  of  Aquarius:  UFOs  and  the 

Transformation  of  Man.  New  York:  Harcourt 
Brace  Jovanovich. 

- ,  1983.  The  Seed.  New  York:  Berkley  Books. 

Steiger,  Brad,  and  Francie  Steiger,  1981.  The  Star 
People.  New  York:  Berkley  Books. 

Steiger,  Francie,  1 982.  Reflections  from  an  Angel’s  Eye. 
New  York:  Berkley  Books. 

Stellar  Community  of 
Enlightened  Ecosystems 

Sometime  in  the  1980s,  Jerry  Doran  of  Wilm¬ 
ington,  California,  claims  to  have  had  an  out-of- 
body  experience.  He  ascended  into  space  where 
he  encountered  “live  blue  skinned  dolphins 
floating  inside  [a]  spaceship.”  Through  telepathy 
the  dolphins  informed  him  that  they  were  asso¬ 
ciated  with  the  Stellar  Community  of  Enlight¬ 
ened  Ecosystems.  The  community  sought  to 
guide  human  evolution  toward  attainment  of  a 
“Group  Mind  which  includes  the  animals  and 
plants  of  Earth,  the  Earth  itself,  the  Sun  and 
similar  enlightened  star  systems  throughout  the 
Cosmos”  (Melton,  Clark,  and  Kelly,  1990). 

Further  Reading 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  Jerome  Clark,  and  Aidan  A. 
Kelly,  1990.  New  Age  Encyclopedia.  Detroit,  MI: 
Gale  Research. 

Strieber,  Whitley  (1945-  ) 

Whitley  Strieber  began  his  career  as  a  success¬ 
ful  writer  of  horror  and  science-fiction  novels 
but  has  since  become  better  known  as  a  chron¬ 
icler  of  his  own  paranormal  and  otherworldly 
experiences,  including  abductions  by  UFOs. 

Born  to  a  prominent  San  Antonio  family,  he 
attended  the  University  of  Texas,  then  moved 
to  New  York  to  begin  a  writing  career.  On  the 
evening  of  December  26,  1985,  he  experienced 


Whitley  Strieber  (Dennis  Stacy/Fortean  Picture  Library) 


a  number  of  peculiar  encounters  of  which  he 
did  not  have  full  conscious  recall.  A  subsequent 
hypnosis  session  led  him  to  believe  that  he  had 
encountered  aliens  who  inserted  a  needle  into 
his  brain.  Strieber  sought  out  the  well-known 
abduction  investigator  Budd  Hopkins,  who 
lived  not  far  from  him  though  the  two  had  not 
met  till  then.  Hopkins  introduced  him  to  psy¬ 
chiatrist  Donald  F.  Klein,  who  subjected 
Strieber  to  psychological  tests  and  pronounced 
him  normal.  Strieber  and  Hopkins  soon  parted 
company  on  bad  terms  around  the  time 
Strieber  published  a  best-selling  account  of  his 
abduction  experiences,  Communion  (1987). 

Communion  sparked  something  of  an  up¬ 
roar,  with  some  critics — most  vocally  Thomas 
M.  Disch  in  The  Nation — accusing  Strieber  of 
having  written  a  science-fiction  novel  that  he 
was  passing  off  as  fact.  Strieber  also  had  his 
defenders,  who  argued  that  he  had  too  much 
to  lose  to  engage  in  that  sort  of  literary  fraud. 
A  follow-up  book,  Transformation  (1988),  re¬ 
counted  further  experiences,  and  it,  in  turn, 
was  followed  by  more  books  recounting  ever 


Sunar  and  Treena  239 


more  fantastic  interactions  with  “the  visitors,” 
as  Strieber  calls  them.  By  the  time  he  pub¬ 
lished  Secret  School  in  1996,  he  was  claiming 
that  aliens  had  been  interacting  with  him  all 
of  his  life,  beginning  in  his  childhood  when 
the  visitors  instructed  him  and  other  San  An¬ 
tonio  children  on  their  missions  as  adults. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Extraterrestrials 
among  us;  Hopkins,  Budd 

Further  Reading 

Conroy,  Ed,  1989 .  Report  on  “Communion”:  An  Inde  - 
pendent  Investigation  of  and  Commentary  on  Whit  - 
ley  Strieber’s  “ Communion .  ”  New  York:  William 
Morrow  and  Company. 

Strieber,  Whitley,  1987.  Communion:  A  True  Story. 
Beach  Tree/William  Morrow. 

- ,  1988.  Transformation:  The  Breakthrough. 

New  York:  William  Morrow  and  Company. 

- ,  1995.  Breakthrough:  The  Next  Step.  New 

York:  HarperCollins  Publishers. 

- ,  1996.  The  Secret  School:  Preparation  for 

Contact.  New  York:  HarperCollins  Publishers. 

Strieber,  Whitley,  and  Anne  Strieber,  eds.,  1997.  The 
Communion  Letters.  New  York:  HarperPrism. 

Swords,  Michael  D„  1987.  “Communion:  A  Reader’s 
Guide.”  MUFON  UFO  Journal  229  (May):  3-6. 


Sunar  and  Treena 

Dean  Anderson  of  Egg  Harbor,  Wisconsin, 
was  atop  a  riding  lawn  mower  at  a  golf  course 


when  a  flying  saucer  landed.  It  was  4:15  A.M., 
August  22,  1976.  A  door  opened,  and  two  be¬ 
ings,  a  man  and  a  woman,  floated  out  on  a 
beam  of  light.  As  they  stepped  toward  Ander¬ 
son,  the  saucer  vanished.  They  shook  Ander¬ 
son’s  hand,  and  the  man  said,  “We  come  in 
peace.  I  am  Sunar,  from  Jupiter.  This  is 
Treena.  She  comes  from  Saturn”  (Bartho¬ 
lomew  and  Howard,  1998).  Sunar,  who  had 
copper  skin,  said  he  was  more  than  two  hun¬ 
dred  years  old.  The  lightly  tanned  Treena,  clad 
in  a  one-piece,  skin-tight,  green,  glistening, 
metallic  suit,  looked,  Anderson  thought,  like 
Elizabeth  Taylor. 

The  space  people  told  him  that  they  had 
come  to  Earth  to  gather  specimens.  Before 
they  left,  they  handed  him  an  envelope  with 
instructions  not  to  open  it  for  five  Earth 
days.  After  waiting  for  the  designated  period, 
Anderson  found  a  golden  amulet  inside.  On 
one  side  there  was  a  bird  resembling  a  dove. 
On  the  other,  a  message  read,  “Peace  and 
friendship  forever,  Treena  and  Sunar,”  with 
depictions  of  Saturn  and  Jupiter  beside  the 
names. 

Further  Reading 

Bartholomew,  Robert  E„  and  George  S.  Howard, 
1998.  UFOs  and  Alien  Contact:  Two  Centuries  of 
Mystery.  Amherst,  NY:  Prometheus  Books. 


Tabar 

On  the  night  of  December  10,  1979,  a  Rhode 
Island  woman,  Elaine  Kaiser,  saw  a  white  light 
and  fell  unconscious.  Subsequent  probing 
through  hypnosis  elicited  the  “memory”  of 
floating  in  a  beam  into  a  room  aboard  a  space¬ 
craft.  There  she  encountered  a  giant  being  in  a 
dark  metallic  suit.  By  telepathy,  the  being  told 
her  his  name  was  Tabar,  and  he  was  from  2.4 
million  light  years  away.  She  was  laid  on  a 
table  and  connected  by  instruments  to  a  man 
who  lay  on  another.  She  did  not  recognize  the 
man.  The  procedure  seemed  to  be  something 
like  a  blood  transfusion.  At  first  it  was  painful, 
but  Tabar  waved  a  hand  in  front  of  her  face, 
and  the  discomfort  ceased. 

Several  months  later  Kaiser  saw  the  man  in 
an  audience.  He  did  not  act  as  if  he  recog¬ 
nized  her,  and  she  did  not  approach  him. 

Further  Reading 

“Alien  Visitors?”  1982.  Oakland  [Michigan]  Press 
(August  22). 

Tawa 

Tawa,  a  Blackfoot  Indian  and  a  friend  of 
Jesus  in  a  previous  incarnation,  emerged  in  a 
Ouija  board  session  in  suburban  Chicago  on 
August  22,  1968.  Previous  to  this,  Candy 
Fletcher  had  been  pursuing  spiritual  ques¬ 


tions  by  reading  metaphysical  books  and  ex¬ 
ploring  altered  states  of  consciousness.  But  it 
was  through  her  husband,  Rey,  that  Tawa 
spoke.  Under  hypnosis,  Rey  Fletcher  chan¬ 
neled  Tawa’s  teachings  until  late  1970  when 
he  turned  his  attention  to  more  prosaic  con¬ 
cerns.  His  wife,  however,  transcribed  the 
teachings  and  began  work  on  a  book  based 
on  them.  She  also  founded  the  Circle  of 
Power  Foundation.  In  1984  the  Fletchers 
moved  to  Victor,  Montana,  to  devote  full 
time  to  their  spiritual  concerns. 

According  to  Tawa,  Jesus  was  born  again 
into  the  world  in  1962,  but  the  individual 
had  yet  to  realize  that  he  was  the  Messiah. 
Soon,  however,  he  would  come  to  that  knowl¬ 
edge  and  reveal  himself  to  the  world,  which 
this  time  would  accept  his  mission.  But  before 
that  happened,  the  anti-Christ  would  exert 
malign  influences  and  power  before  Jesus  van¬ 
quished  him. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Fletcher,  C.  R.,  1984.  Spirit  in  His  Mind.  Victor, 
MT:  Circle  of  Power  Foundation. 

Tecu 

Tecu  (pronounced  Tey-coo)  is  an  entity  who 
channeled  through  a  young  California 


241 


242  Thee  Elohim 


woman,  Sanaya  Roman.  Roman  first  heard 
from  him  when  she  and  a  friend  were  vaca¬ 
tioning  in  Kauai,  Hawaii.  At  that  time,  he 
dictated  a  book-length  manuscript  on  how  to 
heal  psychically  and  how  to  use  the  universal 
laws  of  energy  to  one’s  benefit.  According  to 
Roman,  “Tecu  identified  himself  as  a  Lord  of 
Time  from  the  portals  of  the  world  of  essence 
where  all  matter  is  created”  (Roman  and 
Packer,  1987). 

He  came  to  her  a  second  time  on  another 
Hawaiian  trip.  Then  she  learned  that  he  came 
from  a  universe  of  a  different  frequency,  thus 
making  communication  difficult  and  infre¬ 
quent.  In  that  universe,  energy  is  “symmetri¬ 
cal.”  A  jolly  being,  he  took  in  good  humor  the 
difficulties  he  encountered  trying  to  walk  in 
Romans  body.  Because  in  his  realm  energy  is 
absorbed  whenever  it  is  necessary,  he  was  at 
first  perplexed  by  the  experience  of  eating 
food.  “Eating  is  at  the  root  of  your  problems,” 
he  remarked  wryly.  “First  you  have  to  have 
food.  Then  you  need  dishes.  Then  you  have  to 
build  a  house  to  contain  the  dishes.  Then  you 
have  to  go  to  work  to  pay  for  the  house.  All 
because  you  have  to  eat!” 

Tecu  came  back  on  several  occasions  to  dis¬ 
cuss  the  coming  Earth  changes  and  to  encour¬ 
age  Roman  to  continue  her  project  of  teach¬ 
ing  others  how  to  channel. 

See  Also:  Channeling 

Further  Reading 

Roman,  Sanaya,  and  Duane  Packer,  1987.  Opening 
to  Channel:  How  to  Connect  with  Your  Guide. 
Tiburon,  CA:  H.  J.  Kramer. 


Thee  Elohim 

In  April  1971,  a  Milwaukee  woman,  June 
Young,  experienced  a  vision  in  which  white 
and  black  people  linked  hands.  All  were  wear¬ 
ing  black  robes  with  large  white  rosaries 
around  their  necks.  Soon  she  began  receiving 
messages  from  Archangel  Michael.  “He  told 
me  to  start  a  class  dealing  with  the  higher  laws 
of  God,”  she  said.  “He  gave  me  full  instruc¬ 
tions.  The  lessons  were  brought  and  taught  by 
Michael  and  his  Angels.  Michael  is  the  head 


of  our  class  as  well  as  our  protector.”  She  came 
to  understand  that  her  original  vision  was  of 
the  group  she  would  form,  the  Arising  Sun’s 
Interplanetary  Class  of  Thee  Elohim. 

She  explained  to  writer  Brad  Steiger  that 
Thee  Elohim  are  the  seven  spirits  of  God: 
Chamuel,  Gabriel,  Raphael,  Zadkiel,  Mi¬ 
chael,  Jophiel,  and  Uriel.  “They  stand  before 
God  and  co-create  with  Him,”  she  explained. 
“They  manage  and  direct  all  forms  that  exist.” 

In  1972  Jophiel,  “the  angel  of  intuitive 
light,”  told  her  that  because  she  had  man¬ 
aged  to  overcome  “your  desires  of  the  flesh,” 
he  and  his  colleagues  were  giving  her  back 
the  name  she  had  held  in  her  previous  incar¬ 
nation  as  a  Venusian:  Bright  Star.  Ever  after 
she  went  by  that  name,  working  at  her  mis¬ 
sion  to  “bring  the  material  and  spiritual 
kingdoms  together.”  According  to  her  space 
friends,  the  Earth  would  go  through  devas¬ 
tating  physical  and  social  upheaval  in  the  last 
years  of  the  twentieth  century,  but  with  the 
help  of  the  space  people  and  their  terrestrial 
associates,  the  Earth’s  people  will  eventually 
enter  a  new  age  of  peace,  harmony,  and  spiri¬ 
tual  wisdom. 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Michael 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1976.  Gods  of  Aquarius:  UFOs  and  the 
Transformation  of  Man.  New  York:  Harcourt 
Brace  Jovanovich. 


Thompson’s  Venusians 

Samuel  Eaton  Thompson’s  story  is  as  strange 
as  any  from  the  UFO  age.  Before  the  word 
“contactees”  had  been  invented,  Thompson, 
an  elderly,  poorly  educated,  retired  railroad 
worker,  claimed  to  have  spent  two  days  in  the 
company  of  naked,  Edenic  Venusians  and, 
moreover,  seemed  to  actually  believe  his  own 
story  was  true. 

Thompson’s  strange  odyssey  began  on 
March  28,  1950,  as  he  was  driving  between 
Morton  and  Mineral,  Washington,  on  his  way 
home  from  a  visit  to  relatives  in  Markham.  As 
he  passed  through  a  wooded  area,  he  decided 
to  stop  and  take  a  break.  He  took  a  stroll 


Thompsons  Venusians  243 


down  an  old  logging  trail  that  took  him 
deeper  into  the  forest.  As  he  entered  a 
clearing,  he  saw  a  hovering  UFO  that,  he  later 
related  to  a  local  newspaper  reporter,  “ap¬ 
peared  to  be  made  of  a  glowing,  sun-colored 
substance  similar  to  plastic  and  was  shaped 
like  two  saucers  fused  together.  I  judged  it  was 
about  eighty  feet  horizontally  and  thirty-two 
vertically”  (“Centralian  Tells,”  1950).  Equally 
peculiar  was  the  sight  of  tanned,  fine-featured, 
naked  children  playing  on  steps  that  led  from 
the  saucer  to  the  ground. 

Excited,  Thompson  approached  the  craft, 
feeling  a  mild  heat  emanating  from  it — the 
cause,  he  would  learn  subsequently,  of  its  oc¬ 
cupants’  tanned  skins.  As  he  came  nearer,  his 
presence  brought  the  adults — beautiful  and 
nude,  with  dark  blond  hair — to  the  door. 
They  seemed  frightened  of  him.  He  told  them 
he  meant  no  harm,  and  they  relaxed.  After 
asking  him  in  clumsy  English  to  remove  his 
shoes  and  socks,  they  invited  him  inside, 
where  he  spent  the  next  forty  hours. 

He  learned  that  they  were  from  Venus. 
The  ship  was  also  their  home.  It  carried  ten 
men  and  ten  women  as  well  as  twenty-five 
children  between  six  and  fifteen  years  old.  In¬ 
terviewed  a  few  days  later  by  private  pilot  and 
well-known  UFO  witness  Kenneth  Arnold, 
Thompson  said  the  Venusians  were  friendly 
and  cheerful  but  curiously  naive.  He  com¬ 
pared  them  to  animals,  meaning  that  instinct 
rather  than  intellect  governs  their  activities. 
They  knew  nothing  of  the  technology  that 
powered  their  ship;  they  knew  which  buttons 
to  push  and  levers  to  pull  to  get  where  they 
wanted  to  go,  and  that  was  it.  They  had  no 
sense  of  time  and  no  curiosity,  and  because  of 
their  eating  habits — they  were  vegetarians 
and  stayed  away  from  cooked  foods — they 
never  got  sick  and  lived  long  lives.  Their  veg¬ 
etables  were  like  those  found  on  Earth,  and 
Thompson  ate  some  while  on  the  “spaceship” 
(the  word  the  Venusians  used  for  their  craft). 
He  pronounced  the  food  “just  great.” 

Venusians  fear  earthlings  because  human 
aircraft  had  shot  down  some  of  their  space¬ 
ships.  Earth  is  considered  a  bad  planet,  but 


Mars  is  even  worse.  There  are  twelve  inhab¬ 
ited  planets  in  the  solar  system.  Each  resident 
is  born  under  the  sign  of  the  planet  on  which 
he  or  she  is  born,  except  for  Earth,  whose 
problems  stem  from  the  fact  that  each  person 
is  born  under  a  different  sign.  Venusians  and 
earthlings  long  ago  were  very  close,  sharing 
“the  first  religion  ever  known,”  but  the  people 
of  Earth  eventually  became  corrupt,  and  a 
curse  was  cast  upon  their  planet.  Venusians 
and  other  space  people  are  now  reincarnating 
on  Earth;  their  goal  is  to  reform  the  earthlings 
and  prepare  them  for  Christ’s  Second  Coming 
in  A.D.  10,000. 

After  sleeping  overnight  in  a  chair  in  one  of 
the  ship’s  bedrooms,  Thompson  asked  for  per¬ 
mission  to  go  home  and  pick  up  a  camera. 
They  did  not  know  what  a  camera  was.  When 
he  explained,  they  said  he  could  go  but  asked 
him  not  to  bring  anyone  else  along.  The  pho¬ 
tographic  experiment  came  to  nil.  It  was  “just 
like  trying  to  take  a  picture  of  the  sun,”  he 
told  Arnold.  “It  has  a  glow  to  it.  That  film  was 
just  blank.  I  wanted  to  get  some  of  them  right 
onto  the  ground  to  take  some  pictures  of 
them,  but  they  wouldn’t  come  out”  (Clark, 
1981). 

The  Venusians  left  on  March  30,  caution¬ 
ing  Thompson  to  keep  certain  information  to 
himself.  If  he  ever  saw  them  again,  no  one  ever 
knew.  For  many  years  his  story  was  little 
known,  with  a  brief  newspaper  account  the 
only  record  of  it.  In  1980,  Arnold  gave  a  tape 
of  his  early  April  1950  interview  with  Thomp¬ 
son  to  Fate  magazine,  and  an  article  largely 
based  on  it  appeared  in  the  January  1981 
issue.  Arnold  remarked  on  Thompson’s  igno¬ 
rance  and  lack  of  imagination,  and  he  was 
convinced  that  Thompson  believed  his  story, 
its  outlandish,  even  absurd,  qualities  notwith¬ 
standing.  Arnold  speculated  that  he  had  un¬ 
dergone  some  sort  of  “psychic”  experience. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees;  Hopkins’s 
Martians 

Further  Reading 

Arnold,  Kenneth,  1980.  “How  It  All  Began.”  In 
Curtis  G.  Fuller,  ed.  Proceedings  of  the  First  Inter  - 
national  UFO  Congress,  17-29.  New  York: 
Warner  Books. 


244  Tibus 


“Centralian  Tells  Strange  Tale  of  Visiting  Venus 
Space  Ship  in  Eastern  Lewis  County,”  1950.  Cen  - 
tralia  [Washington]  Daily  Chronicle  (April  1). 
Clark,  Jerome,  1981.  “The  Coming  of  the  Venu- 
sians.”  Fate  34,  1  (January):  49-55. 

Tibus 

Tibus  channels  through  Diane  Tessman,  a 
channeling  contactee  now  living  in  Iowa. 
Tibus,  a  member  of  rhe  Ashtar  Command  and 
the  Free  Federation  of  Planets,  has  visited  the 
Earth  thousands  of  times.  Under  hypnosis  with 
psychologist/ufologist  R.  Leo  Sprinkle,  Tess¬ 
man  recounted  several  childhood  “memories” 
of  encountering  Tibus  aboard  a  mother  ship. 
Fie  was  in  the  company  of  two  humanoids,  one 
of  whom  was  insectlike  in  appearance.  The  hu¬ 
manoids  performed  medical  experiments  on 
her.  One  experiment,  which  occurred  when  she 
was  three  years  old,  left  a  surgical  scar  between 
her  nose  and  upper  lip.  Tessman  believes  that 
the  space  people  were  seeking  to  implant  a 
replica  ofTibus’s  soul  inside  her. 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Channeling;  Contactees;  Sprinkle, 
Ronald  Leo 
Further  Reading 

Montgomery,  Ruth,  1985.  Aliens  among  Us.  New 
York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 


Time  travelers 

According  to  Bruce  Goldberg,  a  California 
physician  and  a  prolific  writer  on  occult  and 
metaphysical  subjects,  visitors  from  the  future 
are  here.  He  claims  to  have  met  several 
“chrononauts,”  as  he  calls  them.  They  are 
here,  he  says,  to  help  us  in  our  spiritual  evolu¬ 
tion,  and  they,  not  extraterrestrials,  are  the 
agents  responsible  for  UFO  abductions. 

Time  travel  was,  or  will  be,  invented  in  the 
year  3050.  The  inventor,  Taatos,  was  the  god 
Hermes  thousands  of  years  ago,  in  another 
lifetime.  Before  Taatos  traveled  back  to  our 
time  to  talk  with  Dr.  Goldberg,  however,  he 
helped  send  holographic  images  into  our  pres¬ 
ent  reality.  Goldberg  writes  that  the  chrono¬ 
nauts  “have  mastered  hyperspace  travel  be¬ 
tween  dimension  [s],  and  can  move  through 


walls  and  solid  objects.  By  existing  in  the  fifth 
dimension,  they  can  observe  us  and  remain  in¬ 
visible.  Genetic  manipulation  of  our  chromo¬ 
somes  is  a  routine  procedure  for  them.  They 
have  greatly  speeded  up  our  rate  of  evolution.” 

While  traveling  in  an  out-of-body  state 
through  the  fifth  dimension,  Goldberg  en¬ 
countered  a  thirty-sixth-century  man  who 
called  himself  Traksa.  Traksa  told  him  that 
many  chrononauts  are  living  quiedy  among 
humans,  keeping  out  of  the  public  eye  and 
even  spending  much  of  their  time  in  a  literally 
invisible  state.  Traksa  eventually  acknowledged 
to  Goldberg  that  one  purpose  of  his  visit  was 
to  introduce  Goldberg  to  Art  Bell,  then  host  of 
a  nationwide  radio  show  catering  to  enthusi¬ 
asts  of  the  esoteric.  Goldberg  then  realized  that 
spelled  backwards,  Traksa’s  name  was  “ASK 
ART.”  Afterward  Goldberg  appeared  at  least 
nine  times  on  Bell’s  popular  program. 

He  also  met  Muat,  Traksa’s  supervisor  from 
the  fortieth  century.  In  earlier  lifetimes,  he 
played  big  roles  in  both  Atlantis  and  Lemuria. 
Nirev  (thirty-first  century)  helped  with  the 
nineteenth  century’s  industrial  revolution, 
and  Alsinoma  (thirty-fourth  century)  tutored 
Leonardo  da  Vinci.  Chat  Noy  (fiftieth  cen¬ 
tury)  is  or  will  be  one  of  the  great  pioneers  of 
time  travel. 

“Chrononauts  are  spiritual  people,”  Gold¬ 
berg  writes.  “They  follow  us  from  lifetime  to 
lifetime,  tracing  our  souls  back  to  previous 
lives  and  monitoring  our  spiritual  unfolding. 
Their  ultimate  purpose  is  to  facilitate  the  per¬ 
fection  of  the  human  soul  to  allow  for  ascen¬ 
sion  and  the  end  of  the  karmic  cycle.  There 
are  also  future  problems — wars,  pollution,  in¬ 
fertility — in  this  and  parallel  universes  that 
they  are  trying  to  avert  by  assisting  us  now  in 
our  spiritual  progress”  (Goldberg,  n.d.). 

Marc  Davenport  theorizes  that  UFOs  are 
visitors  from  the  future.  In  his  view,  “These 
time  machines  are  peopled  by  a  complex  mix¬ 
ture  of  human  beings,  evolved  forms  of  hu¬ 
manoid  beings,  genetically  engineered  life 
forms,  androids,  robots  and/or  alien  life 
forms.  These  occupants  make  use  of  advanced 
technology  based  on  principles  that  will  be 


Tulpa  245 


discovered  at  some  point  in  our  near  future  to 
produce  fields  around  their  craft  that  warp 
space-time.  By  manipulating  those  fields,  they 
are  able  to  traverse  what  we  think  of  as  space 
and  time  as  well”  (Davenport,  1992).  Daven¬ 
port,  however,  does  not  claim  to  have  seen 
any  of  these  time  travelers  himself. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Atlantis;  Lemuria 

Further  Reading 

Davenport,  Marc,  1992.  Visitors  from  Time:  The  Se  - 
cret  of  the  UFOs.  Tigard,  OR:  Wild  Flower  Press. 

Goldberg,  Bruce,  n.d.  “Time  Travelers  I  Have  Met.” 
http://www.drbrucegoldberg.com/TimeTravel- 
ers2.htm. 


Tin-can  aliens 

Four  miles  east  of  Long  Prairie,  Minnesota,  at 
7:40  P.M.  on  October  23,  1965,  a  young  radio 
announcer  named  James  Townsend  was 
rounding  a  curve  when  suddenly  he  saw  some¬ 
thing  in  the  road  and  slammed  on  his  brakes. 
It  was  a  rocket-shaped  UFO  resting  on  three 
fins.  The  car  skidded  to  a  halt  only  twenty  feet 
from  the  device,  which  stood  thirty  to  forty 
feet  tall  and  was  ten  feet  in  diameter. 

In  a  circle  of  light  beneath  the  UFO, 
Townsend  observed  three  objects  or  entities 
that  looked  like  beer  cans  on  tripod  legs  and 
with  three  matchstick  arms.  Even  though  they 
had  no  eyes,  he  was  certain  that  they  were 
staring  at  him.  When  he  stepped  out  of  his 
car,  they  came  toward  him.  After  what  seemed 
an  eternity,  they  scooted  under  the  ship  and 
disappeared  into  the  light  circle.  The  UFO 
shot  off  with  an  ear-splitting  roar. 

His  outlandish  story  notwithstanding,  law- 
enforcement  officers  and  civilian  investigators 
believed  that  Townsend,  a  devoutly  religious 
man,  was  not  perpetrating  a  hoax. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 

Further  Reading 

Jansen,  Clare  John,  1966.  “Little  Tin  Men  in  Min¬ 
nesota.”  Fate  19,  2  (February):  36-40. 

Tree-stump  aliens 

One  of  the  most  bizarre  close  encounters  of 
the  third  kind  ever  took  place  on  the  evening 


of  April  5,  1966,  in  Newport,  Oregon,  during 
a  nationwide  UFO  wave.  Though  such  re¬ 
ports  overwhelmingly  describe  human  or  hu¬ 
manoid  entities,  two  teenaged  girls  claimed  to 
have  seen  aliens  that  looked  like  tree  stumps. 

As  they  told  the  story,  they  were  walking  to 
the  house  of  one  of  them — Kathy  Reeves — 
when  they  sensed  that  someone  was  following 
them.  At  a  turn  in  the  road,  they  looked  be¬ 
hind  them  to  see  something  like  a  “flashlight 
with  a  cover  over  the  end.”  Assuming  it  was  a 
prankster  trying  to  scare  them,  they  threw 
rocks  toward  the  light.  But  when  they  did  so, 
other,  bigger  lights  suddenly  switched  on. 
Frightened,  the  girls  started  running.  Their 
dash  home  was  interrupted,  however,  by  a 
bizarre  sight:  three  shapes  moving  across  a 
pasture  apparently  heading  toward  the  lights. 

They  looked,  Kathy  Reeves  later  said,  like 
“three  little  tree  stumps”  walking  on  legs  that 
resembled  a  tree  trunk’s  tap  roots.  They  had 
no  heads  or  arms.  They  were  clad  in  multicol¬ 
ored  clothes,  “orange,  blue,  white,  yellow,  and 
watermelon-colored”  (Brandon,  1978).  The 
sight  set  the  witnesses  screaming  homeward. 

The  resulting  publicity  brought  investiga¬ 
tors  and  curiosity-seekers  to  the  Reeves  resi¬ 
dence  over  the  next  few  days.  At  least  two  of 
them,  including  Deputy  Sheriff  Thomas  W. 
Price,  reported  seeing  strange  moving  lights. 
There  were  no  further  reports  of  aliens,  tree- 
stump  ones  or  otherwise,  though. 

See  Also:  Close  encounters  of  the  third  kind 

Further  Reading 

Brandon,  Jim,  1978.  Weird  America:  A  Guide  to 
Places  of  Mystery  in  the  United  States.  New  York: 
E.  P.  Dutton. 


Tulpa 

“Tulpa”  is  aTibetan  term  for  an  entity  created 
by  mental  concentration.  Such  an  entity  is  be¬ 
lieved  to  take  on  at  least  a  quasi-physical  form 
and  to  be  visible  to  others  besides  its  creator. 

The  most  famous  tulpa  account  appears  in 
Alexandra  David-Neel’s  With  Mystics  and  Ma  - 
gicians  in  Tibet,  originally  published  in  1931. 
David-Neel,  an  adventurous  French  woman 


246  The  Two 


educated  at  the  Sorbonne,  traveled  widely 
through  Tibet  in  the  early  part  of  the  twenti¬ 
eth  century,  exploring  places  and  meeting 
Buddhist  holy  men  that  no  European  had  be¬ 
fore  encountered.  The  Geographical  Society 
of  Paris  awarded  her  a  gold  medal,  and  the  Le¬ 
gion  of  Honor  knighted  her. 

David-Neel  wrote  that  while  living  with 
the  Tibetan  yogis,  she  decided  to  conjure  up  a 
tulpa.  She  imagined  him  to  be  a  fat,  jolly 
lama.  After  some  months,  the  being  came  into 
existence.  Apparently  David-Neel  essentially 
considered  him  a  vivid  hallucination,  a  kind 
of  imaginary  companion,  and  she  was  unset¬ 
tled  when  it  began  to  take  on  a  reality  of  its 
own.  First,  she  claimed,  it  became  no  longer 
necessary  for  her  to  think  of  it  for  it  to  appear, 
and  it  seemed  to  adopt  a  recognizable  person¬ 
ality  and  to  perform  appropriate  actions. 

“A  change  gradually  took  place  in  my 
lama,”  she  said.  “The  countenance  I  had 
given  him  altered;  his  chubby  cheeks  thinned 
and  his  expression  became  vaguely  cunning 
and  malevolent.  He  became  more  importu¬ 
nate.  In  short,  he  was  escaping  me.  One  day  a 
shepherd  who  was  bringing  me  butter  saw  the 
phantasm,  which  he  took  for  a  lama  of  flesh 
and  bone.” 

Alarmed,  she  decided  that  she  had  to  de¬ 
stroy  the  entity.  It  was  not  easy.  It  took  six 
months  of  hard  mental  work.  She  concluded, 
“That  I  should  have  succeeded  in  obtaining  a 
voluntary  hallucination  is  not  surprising. 
What  is  interesting  in  such  cases  of  ‘material¬ 
ization’  is  that  other  persons  see  the  form  cre¬ 
ated  by  thought.” 

Though  such  first-person  allegations  of 
real-life  tulpas  are  exceedingly  rare,  David- 
Neel’s  story  would  inspire  a  great  deal  of  spec¬ 
ulation  that  seeks  to  explain  a  broad  range  of 
extraordinary  entities,  from  lake  monsters  to 
UFO  humanoids,  as  tulpalike  “thought 
forms”  or  (in  Michael  Grosso’s  phrase)  “psy¬ 
choterrestrials”  (Grosso,  1992). 

See  Also:  Imaginal  beings;  Psychoterrestrials 

Further  Reading 

David-Neel,  Alexandra,  1957.  With  Mystics  and M a  - 
gicians  in  Tibet.  New  York:  University  Books. 


Grosso,  Michael,  1992.  Frontiers  of  the  Soul:  Explor  - 
ing  Psychic  Evolution.  Wheaton,  IL:  Quest  Books. 

The  Two 

The  Two  were  Marshall  Herff  Applewhite, 
also  known  as  Bo,  and  Bonnie  Lu  Nettles,  also 
known  as  Peep,  two  of  the  stranger  flying- 
saucer  contactees.  Nettles  would  be  long  dead 
when  Applewhite,  then  heading  a  cultlike 
group  called  Heaven’s  Gate,  led  thirty-eight 
followers  to  mass  suicide  in  a  house  in  a 
wealthy  neighborhood  of  San  Diego  in  March 
1997.  Their  departure  from  this  world — in¬ 
tended  to  free  their  bodies  so  that  their  souls 
could  board  a  spaceship  thought  to  be  accom¬ 
panying  the  Hale-Bopp  comet — generated 
headlines  the  world  over. 

Behind  the  tragedy  lay  a  quarter-century  of 
spiritual  odyssey  that  began  in  1972,  when 
the  psychiatrically  troubled  Applewhite,  a 
musical  director  at  a  local  Episcopal  church, 
met  Nettles,  a  nurse,  at  a  Houston  hospital. 
The  Two  shared  an  interest  in  the  occult,  and 
in  Nettles,  Applewhite  found  someone  he  had 
been  looking  for:  a  woman  with  whom  to  es¬ 
tablish  a  platonic  relationship  and  a  shared 
metaphysical  mission.  Applewhite’s  homosex¬ 
uality  had  caused  him  legal  and  employment 
problems  and  spiritual  confusion.  The  occult 
doctrine  the  Two  would  create,  under  guid¬ 
ance  from  space  people,  eschewed  sexuality 
and  demanded  chastity  from  its  adherents. 

Beginning  in  1973,  Applewhite  and  Net¬ 
tles  set  out  on  a  rambling  pilgrimage  through 
several  western  states.  While  living  along 
Oregon’s  Rogue  River,  they  experienced  a 
revelation  that  they  were  the  two  witnesses 
who  Revelation  1 1  had  prophesied  would 
appear  on  Earth  during  its  last  days.  Their 
first  attempt  to  announce  themselves  to  a 
larger  world  occurred  in  Oklahoma  City, 
where  they  introduced  themselves  to  local 
ufologist  Hayden  Hewes,  who  had  a  flair  for 
publicity.  They  told  Hewes  to  announce  that 
they  were  here  to  help  the  human  race  as¬ 
cend  to  its  next  evolutionary  level.  According 
to  Hewes,  they  spoke  as  if  “humans  were 


The  Two  247 


alien  to  them”  (Hewes  and  Steiger,  1976). 
Their  behavior  and  general  demeanor  were 
so  odd  that  Hewes  wondered  if  they  were  ac¬ 
tual  extraterrestrials. 

Through  leaflets  signed  by  Human  Individ¬ 
ual  Metamorphosis  (HIM),  the  Two  sought 
followers.  The  documents  identified  them  as 
two  individuals  who  had  come  from  an  ad¬ 
vanced  realm  to  testify  to  the  same  message 
that  Jesus  had  given  to  the  world.  Those  who 
followed  them  would  have  to  abandon  all  ties 
to  this  world,  including  family,  friends,  jobs, 
and  possessions.  When  they  achieved  meta¬ 
morphosis,  they  would  experience  actual  bio¬ 
logical  and  chemical  changes  in  their  bodies. 

Bo  and  Beep,  as  they  then  called  them¬ 
selves,  made  themselves  available  to  the  public 
in  the  spring  of  1975  at  a  meeting  held  in  the 
home  of  a  Los  Angeles  psychic.  Twenty-four 
persons  followed  them  to  participate  in  further 
gatherings  in  California,  Colorado,  and  else¬ 
where,  where  new  believers  were  solicited  to 
become  Bo  and  Peep’s  sheep.  Little  of  this  at¬ 
tracted  press  attention  until  twenty  members 
of  an  audience,  which  had  come  to  hear  the 
Two  in  Waldport,  Oregon,  disappeared  with 
them  the  next  day.  Newspaper  accounts  de¬ 
picted  the  couple  as  mysterious.  The  account 
even  seemed  to  leave  open  the  possibility  that 
the  missing  audience  members  had  flown  off 
in  a  UFO.  In  fact,  they  had  joined  the  pilgrim¬ 
age.  Six  weeks  later,  two  University  of  Mon¬ 
tana  sociologists  found  them — though  not  Bo 
and  Peep — in  Arizona.  Bo  and  Peep,  fearing 
assassination,  had  dropped  out  of  sight.  Before 
their  departure,  however,  they  separated  their 
150  to  200  followers  in  autonomous  “families” 
of  about  a  dozen  persons  each.  Within  each 
family  there  was  further  breakdown  into  cou¬ 
ples,  preferably  a  man  and  a  woman,  who  were 
to  observe  each  other  carefully.  Sex  and  even 
friendship  were  explicitly  discouraged;  the  “re¬ 
lationship”  had  one  purpose,  which  was  that 
each  person  would  have  his  or  her  faults 
pointed  out,  thus  making  it  possible  to  over¬ 
come  human  limitations. 

Each  family  went  its  own  way,  supporting 
itself  via  meetings,  contributions  by  new 


Marshall  Herff  Appleivhite  and  Bonnie  Lit  Nettles, 
photographed  after  their  1975  arrest  by  local  police  in 
Harlington,  Texas,  for  auto  theft  and  credit  card  fraud 
(Bettmann/Corbis) 


members,  and  begging.  The  reception  of  such 
proselytizing  was  usually  hostile,  but  small 
numbers  of  recruits  filled  the  ranks,  often  re¬ 
placing  those  who  had  lost  interest.  Most  fol¬ 
lowers  were  occult  tourists  whose  fascination 
with  any  particular  metaphysical  doctrine  was 
only  passing.  The  failure  of  flying  saucers  to 
arrive  to  take  believers  to  a  New  World  also 
discouraged  interest. 

In  early  1976,  the  movement,  now  consist¬ 
ing  of  fewer  than  one  hundred  members,  re¬ 
treated  with  Bo  and  Beep  to  a  mountain  camp 
near  Laramie,  Wyoming.  The  couples  author¬ 
itarian  control  was  intensified,  and  those 
judged  unqualified  were  forced  out.  By  fall, 
the  band  had  relocated  to  Salt  Lake  City. 
Around  this  time,  two  members  inherited  a 
great  deal  of  money,  which  they  turned  over 
to  Bo  and  Peep.  They  purchased  houses 
(“crafts”  in  their  terminology)  in  Denver  and 


248  The  Two 


Dallas-Fort  Worth  and  essentially  removed 
themselves  from  the  world.  Press  stories  about 
them  were  few,  though  in  1979  one  member 
spoke  with  Time  and  recounted  the  day-to- 
day  spiritual  activities  of  the  group,  which 
were  rigidly  directed.  Nettles  died,  apparently 
of  cancer,  in  1985. 

In  1993,  the  group  reemerged  into  view 
with  an  advertisement  in  USA  Today  and  fol¬ 
lowed  it  with  pronouncements  in  other  publi¬ 
cations.  Now  calling  themselves  Total  Over¬ 
comers,  members  lectured  in  various  cities. 
Two  years  later,  the  group,  by  then  called 
Heaven’s  Gate,  moved  to  San  Diego  and  set 
up  a  successful  computer  business  with  its 
own  web  site.  In  October  1996,  it  purchased  a 
mansion  in  San  Diego’s  exclusive  Rancho 
Santa  Fe. 

It  was  there  that  the  mass  suicide  occurred, 
apparently  on  the  night  of  March  25-26, 
1997.  Alerted  by  an  anonymous  phone  call 
(the  caller  was  later  identified  as  Richard  Ford, 
one  of  the  group’s  followers),  police  found  the 
bodies  of  thirty-nine  identically  dressed  men 
and  women  of  androgynous  appearance. 
Some  of  them,  it  was  learned,  had  been  surgi¬ 
cally  castrated.  All  had  died  of  poison  and  suf¬ 
focation.  One  of  them  was  Applewhite.  Ac¬ 
cording  to  a  videotaped  statement,  the  deaths 
occurred  so  that  members  could  leave  their 


“vehicles”  (bodies)  and  join  a  giant  spaceship 
that  they  believed  was  following  the  Hale- 
Bopp  comet. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Balch,  Robert  W.,  1995.  “Waiting  for  the  Ships:  Dis¬ 
illusionment  and  the  Revitalization  of  Faith  in 
Bo  and  Peep’s  UFO  Cult.”  In  James  R.  Lewis,  ed. 
The  Gods  Have  Landed:  Neiv  Religions  from  Other 
Worlds,  1 37-166.  Albany,  NY:  State  University  of 
New  York  Press. 

Bruni,  Frank,  1997.  “Cult  Leader  Believed  in  Space 
Aliens  and  Apocalypse.”  New  York  Times  (March 
28). 

“Flying  Saucery  in  the  Wilderness,”  1979.  Time  (Au¬ 
gust  27):  58. 

Hewes,  Hayden,  and  Brad  Steiger,  eds.,  1976.  UFO 
Missionaries  Extraordinary.  New  York:  Pocket 
Books. 

Hoffmann,  Bill,  Cathy  Burke,  and  the  staff  of  the 
New  York  Post,  1997.  Heavens  Gate:  Cult  Suicide 
in  San  Diego.  New  York:  Harper-Paperbacks. 

Niebuhr,  Gustav,  1997.  “On  the  Furthest  Fringes  of 
Millennialism.”  New  York  Times  (March  28). 

Oliver,  Evelyn  Dorothy,  1997.  “Graduating  to  the 
Next  Level:  The  Heaven’s  Gate  Tragedy  in  the 
Context  of  New  Age  Ideology.”  Syzygy  6,1  (Win¬ 
ter/Spring):  43-58. 

Peters,  Ted,  1977.  UFOs — God’s  Chariots?  Flying 
Saucers  in  Politics,  Science,  and  Religion.  Atlanta, 
GA:  John  Knox  Press. 

Steiger,  Brad,  1976.  Gods  ofAqttarius:  UFOs  and  the 
Transformation  of  Man.  New  York:  Harcourt 
Brace  Jovanovich. 


Ulkt 

Ulkt,  a  Martian,  introduced  himself  through 
automatic  writing  to  a  Salt  Lake  City  UFO 
buff,  Mary  Sewall,  in  early  1982.  He  told  her 
that  Earth  is  overloaded  with  negative  vibra¬ 
tions.  Humans  cannot  join  the  federation  of 
intelligent  worlds  until  they  learn  to  cast  posi¬ 
tive  vibrations.  If  they  stop  conflict  and  im¬ 
moral  behavior,  their  collective  vibratory  rate 
will  rise.  Ulkt  signed  each  communication 
with  what  looked  like  an  H  on  its  side.  Sewall 
took  this  to  be  a  symbol  of  infinity. 

Further  Reading 

Sprinkle,  R.  Leo,  ed.,  1982.  Proceedings:  Rocky 
Mountain  Conference  on  UFO  Investigation. 
Laramie,  WY:  School  of  Extended  Studies,  Uni¬ 
versity  of  Wyoming. 

Ultraterrestrials 

Ultraterrestrials  dwell  in  the  superspectrum,  a 
field  of  intelligent  energy  capable  of  manipu¬ 
lating  matter.  Ultraterrestrials  are  among  the 
materialized  manifestations  from  this  alterna¬ 
tive  reality.  They  appear  to  human  beings  in  a 
range  of  guises:  as  demons,  extraterrestrials, 
channeling  intelligences,  angels,  fairies,  mon¬ 
sters,  men  in  black,  and  other  supernatural  en¬ 
tities.  They  are  behind  all  of  the  worlds  reli¬ 
gions,  and  they  have  manipulated  history.  All 


ultraterrestrials  have  one  thing  in  common:  a 
detestation  of  human  beings  and  all  they  stand 
for.  Human  beings  who  encounter  them  often 
end  up  psychically  enslaved  or  destroyed. 

In  Keel’s  view,  heavily  influenced  by  tradi¬ 
tional  demonology,  “The  Devil’s  emissaries  of 
yesteryear  have  been  replaced  by  the  mysteri¬ 
ous  ‘men  in  black.  ’  The  quasi-angels  of  Bibli¬ 
cal  times  have  become  magnificent  spacemen. 
The  demons,  devils,  and  false  angels  were  rec¬ 
ognized  as  liars  and  plunderers  by  early  man. 
These  same  impostors  now  appear  as  long¬ 
haired  Venusians”  (Keel,  1970). 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Fairies  encountered;  Keel, 
John  Alva;  Men  in  black 

Further  Reading 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  UFOs:  Operation  Trojan  Horse. 
New  York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 

Ummo 

Ummo  is  supposedly  the  name  of  a  planet 
that  revolves  around  a  star  known  to  Ummites 
as  Iumma,  14.6  light  years  from  the  Earth.  It 
is  also  the  focus  of  one  of  the  most  complex, 
enigmatic  hoaxes  in  the  history  of  the  con- 
tactee  movement. 

The  episode  began  in  February  1966  in  a 
Madrid  suburb,  where  witnesses  allegedly  saw 
a  UFO  hovering  close  to  the  ground.  One 


249 


250  Ummo 


One  of  several  UFO  photographs  taken  by  “Antonio  Pardo  ”  at  San  Jose  de  Valderas,  Madrid,  Spain,  June  1,  1967  (Fortean 
Picture  Library) 


witness,  Jose  Luis  Jordan  Pena,  reported  see¬ 
ing  a  strange  symbol  on  the  bottom  of  the 
craft.  It  resembled  two  reverse  parentheses, 
with  a  vertical  bar  between  them.  Only  Jordan 
Pena  told  of  seeing  such  a  symbol  (in  fact 
quite  similar  to  the  stylized  H  used  sometimes 
to  represent  the  planet  Uranus),  which  he  de¬ 
scribed  in  a  letter  to  prominent  Spanish  ufolo¬ 
gist  Antonio  Ribera.  On  June  1,  1967,  the 
same  man  claimed  to  have  investigated  an¬ 
other  close  encounter  at  San  Jose  de  Valderas, 
near  Madrid.  He  said  witnesses  had  told  him 
that  they  saw  a  symbol  on  the  UFO’s  bottom. 
It  was  like  the  earlier  one,  except  that  now  a 
horizontal  bar  crossed  the  vertical  and  linked 
the  two  reverse  parentheses.  The  following 
day,  Antonio  San  Antonio,  a  newspaper  pho¬ 
tographer,  took  a  phone  call  from  an  anony¬ 
mous  young  man.  The  caller  said  he  had 
taken  pictures  of  the  UFO,  and  San  Antonio 


could  pick  them  up  at  a  certain  photographic 
laboratory.  One  of  the  pictures  depicted  the 
curious  logo. 

Soon  afterward,  leaflets  signed  “Henri 
Dagousset”  asserted  that  the  UFO  had  left 
capsules  in  the  area.  “Dagousset”  offered  three 
hundred  dollars  for  each  sample,  referring  tak¬ 
ers  to  a  general  delivery  address  at  Madrid’s 
main  post  office.  In  August,  Barcelona  writer 
Marius  Lleget,  author  of  a  recently  published 
UFO  book,  received  a  letter  with  no  return 
address  from  “Antonio  Pardo.”  Inside  the  en¬ 
velope  were  two  more  pictures  of  the  San  Jose 
de  Valderas  object  with  the  identical  symbol. 
Pardo  said  he  had  taken  them  moments  after 
the  first  photographer  had  snapped  his.  He 
also  enclosed  a  green  plastic  strip  with  the 
symbol  on  it,  explaining  that  he  had  recovered 
it  from  a  boy  who  had  found  it  and  a  similar 
strip  inside  a  mysterious  tube.  (Subsequent 


Ummo  251 


analysis  determined  it  to  be  a  weather-resist¬ 
ant  plastic  developed  for  military  and  aero¬ 
space  use.  It  was,  in  other  words,  of  earthly 
origin.)  Then  a  man  identifying  himself  as 
Pardo  phoned  Lleget  and  spoke  with  him  at 
length.  Lleget  never  asked  for  his  address,  and 
Pardo  did  not  provide  it,  to  the  later  frustra¬ 
tion  of  Ribera  and  Rafael  Farriols.  The  two 
ufologists  called  every  Antonio  Pardo  (An¬ 
thony  Brown  in  English)  in  Madrid’s  phone 
book  without  ever  finding  anyone  who  would 
own  up  to  being  Lleget’s  informant. 

A  related  development,  investigators  would 
soon  learn,  had  occurred  on  May  20,  when 
the  Spanish  newspaper  Informaciones  pub¬ 
lished  a  peculiar  announcement:  that  soon  a 
flying  saucer  would  land  near  Madrid  to  re¬ 
turn  earthbound  extraterrestrials  to  their 
home  planet,  Ummo.  On  the  evening  of  the 
thirtieth,  three  persons  reportedly  watched  a 
UFO  land  near  a  restaurant  in  Santa  Monica, 
another  Madrid  suburb.  The  next  day,  accord¬ 
ing  to  one  of  the  witnesses,  impressions,  burn 
marks,  and  small  amounts  of  a  metallic  sub¬ 
stance  attested  to  the  UFO’s  presence.  These 
alleged  events  seemed  to  confirm  a  prediction 
made  by  contactee  Fernando  Sesma,  president 
of  the  Society  of  the  Friends  of  Space,  on  May 
31.  In  a  speech  to  a  small  group,  he  revealed 
that  since  1965  he  and  two  associates  had 
been  recipients  of  phone  messages  and  written 
communications  from  Ummites.  They  had 
informed  him  of  a  sighting  to  occur  on  June 
1.  They  provided  the  exact  geographical  coor¬ 
dinates.  The  Santa  Monica  incident  seemed  to 
confirm  the  Ummites’  statement. 

The  written  messages  soon  started  to  arrive 
in  the  mail  of  Spanish  UFO  enthusiasts,  then 
to  some  of  their  French  colleagues.  Postmarks 
indicated  that  they  were  sent  from  all  over  the 
world,  from  cities  in  Europe  to  others  in  New 
Zealand  and  Canada.  On  each  page  the 
Ummo  symbol  appeared.  It  was  the  same  one 
Jordan  Pena  and  other  witnesses  had  report¬ 
edly  seen  and  the  anonymous  young  man  had 
photographed.  The  messages  typically  con¬ 
sisted  of  many  pages  of  discourse  on  Ummite 


life,  society,  science,  technology,  language, 
and  politics.  Besides  the  monographs,  there 
were  phone  calls  from  purported  Ummites, 
always  speaking  with  great  precision  in  a 
monotone  voice.  Untraceable  or  unsigned  let¬ 
ters  came  from  human  beings  who  had  dealt 
with  Ummites  face  to  face  (they  were  de¬ 
scribed  as  tall,  blond,  and  Scandinavian  in  ap¬ 
pearance)  and  witnessed  marvelous  technol¬ 
ogy.  The  quantity  of  such  material  was 
astounding.  By  1983,  according  to  an  esti¬ 
mate  by  one  knowledgeable  student  of  the 
episode,  some  sixty-seven  hundred  Ummo- 
related  communications  were  in  the  hands  of 
a  variety  of  recipients.  Most  were  written  in 
Spanish,  a  small  minority  in  stilted  French 
that  seemed  to  have  been  translated  from 
Spanish. 

In  one  document,  the  Ummites  said  they 
had  arrived  on  Earth  in  March  1950.  The  fol¬ 
lowing  April  24,  they  revealed  in  another  doc¬ 
ument  that  they  had  stolen  a  number  of  items 
from  a  family  in  an  isolated  house  in  the 
French  Alps.  By  this  time,  the  French  govern¬ 
ment  had  become  interested,  and  at  last  it  had 
an  investigatable  claim.  But  official  inquiries 
turned  up  nothing:  no  police  records,  no  evi¬ 
dence  of  the  cave  in  which  the  Ummites  as¬ 
serted  they  had  been  living  between  their 
landing  and  the  break-in.  In  the  1970s,  the 
San  Jose  de  Valderas  “UFO”  fell  victim  to 
photoanalysis  that  established  that  the  object 
was  an  eight-inch  plate,  the  symbol  drawn  in 
ink.  Still,  the  communications  continued,  and 
an  Ummo  cult  grew  up  around  them.  A  num¬ 
ber  of  books,  mostly  in  Spanish  and  French, 
would  examine  or  celebrate  Ummo. 

Though  no  evidence  supports  the  existence 
of  Ummo  and  Ummites,  the  identity  of  the 
perpetrators  of  the  hoax  is  still  unknown. 
French- American  ufologist  Jacques  Vallee, 
trained  in  astrophysics  and  computer  sciences, 
characterizes  the  contents  of  the  documents  as 
“clever  and  occasionally  stimulating.  ...  A 
science  journalist,  a  government  engineer 
working  on  advanced  projects,  or  a  frustrated 
writer  could  match  the  psychological  profile 


252  Unholy  Six 


of  the  UMMO  author”  (Vallee,  1991).  He 
contends  that  the  perpetrator  or  perpetrators 
got  their  inspiration  from  Jorge  Luis  Borges’s 
fantastic  short  story  “Tlon,  Uqbar,  Orbis,  Ter- 
tius”  (1941),  a  fable  about  imaginary  planets 
that  in  some  sense  become  “real.”  Other  sus¬ 
pects  are  Fernando  Sesma,  Jordan  Pena,  or 
some  intelligence  agency  involved  in  a  psy¬ 
chological  experiment.  Hilary  Evans  thinks  a 
better,  more  sustained  investigation  by  the 
Spanish  ufologists  who  probed  the  affair 
would  have  produced  answers  and  made 
Ummo  less  mysterious  than  it  appears  to  be. 
Whatever  the  case,  Ummo  documents  still 
show  up  in  the  mail  of  a  few  individuals,  most 
prominently  the  French  aerospace  engineer 
Jean-Pierre  Petit.  Whoever  is  beyond  the 
episode  has  expended  much  time  and  energy 
to  it  over  three  decades. 

Further  Reading 

Evans,  Hilary,  1983.  “Ummo:  A  Perfect  Case?”  The 
Utiexplained  12,  134:  2661-2665. 

- ,  1983.  “The  Ummites  Tell  All.”  The  Unex  - 

plained  12,  135:  2686-2689. 

- ,  1983.  “Ummo — Red  Alert.”  The  Unex  - 

plained  12,  137:  2738-2740. 

Ribera,  Antonio,  1975.  “The  Mysterious  ‘UMMO’ 
Affair.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  Pt.  I.  20,  4  (Janu¬ 
ary):  20-24;  Pt.  II.  20,  5  (March):  13-16;  Pt.  III. 
21,  1  (June):  26-28;  Pt.  IV.  21,  2  (August): 
24—25,  27;  Pt.  V.  21,  3—4  (November):  43—46. 

Vallee,  Jacques,  1991.  Revelations:  Alien  Contact  and 
Human  Deception.  New  York:  Ballantine  Books. 


Unholy  Six 

According  to  George  Hunt  Williamson,  six 
solar  systems  housing  planets  peopled  by 
“negative  space  intelligences”  exist  in  the 
Orion  nebula.  The  “Unholy  Six”  live  on 
dying  worlds,  and  they  plan  to  destroy  the 
Earth  so  that  they  can  have  access  to  its  re¬ 
sources.  The  Orion  group  has  its  own  subver¬ 
sive  agents  on  Earth,  working  with  them  to 
undercut  the  work  of  friendly,  pro-human 
space  visitors  of  the  Space  Confederation. 
Though  incapable  of  entering  the  Earth’s  at¬ 
mosphere  in  their  own  spacecraft,  the  Unholy 
Six  project  their  intelligences  into  the  brains 
of  certain  earthlings. 

Williamson  wrote  that  the  underlying  cause 
of  conflict  between  the  Space  Confederation 
and  the  Unholy  Six  is  that  “the  former  are 
Deists  and  the  latter  are  Ideists.”  In  other 
words,  the  Space  Confederation  believes  in  a 
divine  power  to  which  all  are  answerable,  and 
the  Unholy  Six  believe  only  in  the  primacy  of 
the  “id” — the  power  of  the  individual.  “For 
countless  millennia  there  have  been  no  possi¬ 
bilities  of  reconciliation  between  these 
groups,”  Williamson  said  (Williamson,  1959). 

See  Also:  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1953.  Other  Tongues — 
Other  Flesh.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

- ,  1959.  Road  in  the  Sky.  London:  Neville 

Spearman. 


Vadig 

Vadig  is  an  extraterrestrial  invented  by  self- 
confessed  hoaxer  Thomas  F.  Monteleone.  In 
March  1968,  as  a  psychology  student  at  the 
University  of  Maryland,  Monteleone  heard 
West  Virginia  contactee  Woodrew  Deren- 
berger  talking  about  his  space  contacts  on 
Washington,  DC,  radio  station  WWDC. 
Derenberger  claimed  to  have  traveled  to  the 
planet  Lanulos.  Convinced  that  Derenberger 
was  lying,  Monteleone  decided  to  play  a  prac¬ 
tical  joke  and  to  assert  that  he,  too,  had  been 
to  Lanulos.  He  called  the  station  under  the 
name  “Ed  Bailey”  and  added  new  details 
about  the  planet  and  its  people.  Derenberger 
readily  agreed  with  what  the  caller  said. 

To  Monteleone’s  chagrin,  the  station  was 
able  to  trace  the  call.  Derenberger’s  manager 
Harold  Salkin  phoned  him  and  learned  his 
true  identity.  A  week  later,  Salkin,  Deren¬ 
berger,  and  the  latter’s  wife  called  on  Mon¬ 
teleone,  who  tape-recorded  the  interview.  In 
the  interview,  the  young  man  reported  that 
while  driving  home  on  an  interstate  highway 
he  witnessed  a  UFO  landing.  Two  aliens 
emerged,  and  one  introduced  himself  as 
Vadig.  Two  months  later,  Vadig  showed  up  at 
the  Washington  restaurant  where  Monteleone 
worked  part-time.  He  arranged  a  meeting, 
ending  the  encounter,  as  he  had  before,  with 


the  enigmatic  words  “I’ll  see  you  in  time.” 
The  following  Sunday  night,  Vadig  drove  the 
young  man  into  rural  Maryland  where  they 
boarded  a  spaceship  and  flew  to  Lanulos, 
where  the  inhabitants  walk  about  naked.  One 
week  later  Monteleone  met  Vadig  and  another 
Lanulosian  for  the  last  time. 

Not  long  after  the  initial  interview  the 
Derenbergers  and  Salkin  returned  to  talk 
once  more,  bringing  along  with  them  occult 
journalist  John  A.  Keel.  Keel,  who  thought 
Monteleone  had  revealed  information  only  a 
real  contactee  would  know,  wrote  about  the 
Vadig  encounter  in  later  magazine  articles 
and  in  a  book.  When  Vadig  said  he  would 
“see  you  in  time,”  according  to  Keel,  he  was 
hinting  that  UFO  beings  “originate  outside 
of  our  time  frame.  .  .  .  UFOs  are  from  an¬ 
other  time  cycle  vastly  different  from  our 
own”  (Keel,  1969). 

Monteleone  went  on  to  a  short  career  as  a 
public  contactee.  His  story  appears  in  a  book 
Derenberger  wrote  with  Harold  W.  Hubbard 
in  1970,  cited  as  evidence  of  the  authenticity 
of  Lanulos  and  the  author’s  experiences  with 
it.  In  1979,  in  a  short  article  in  Omni,  Mon¬ 
teleone  confessed  the  hoax,  noting,  “I  contra¬ 
dicted  Mr.  Derenberger’s  story  on  purpose. 
But  on  each  occasion,  he  would  give 
ground  .  .  .  and  in  the  end  corroborate  my 


253 


254  Val  Thor 


own  falsifications.  He  even  claimed  to  know 
personally  the  ‘UFOnaut’  who  contacted  me!” 
A  fuller  account  of  the  episode  appeared  in 
1980  in  a  Fate  article  by  ufologist  Karl  T. 
Pflock.  By  this  time  Monteleone  had  em¬ 
barked  on  what  was  to  prove  a  successful  ca¬ 
reer  as  a  science-fiction  writer. 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Keel,  John  Alva 

Further  Reading 

Derenberger,  Woodrow  W.,  and  Harold  W  Hub¬ 
bard,  1971.  Visitors  from  Lanulos.  New  York: 
Vantage  Press. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New 
York:  Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and 
Company. 

- ,  1969.  “The  Time  Cycle  Factor.”  Flying 

Saucer  Review  15,  3  (May/June):  9-13. 

Monteleone,  Thomas  F.,  1979.  “Last  Word:  The 
Gullibility  Factor.”  Omni  1  (May):  146. 

Pflock,  Karl  T.,  1980.  “Anatomy  of  a  UFO  Hoax.” 
Fate'S 3,  11  (November):  40-48. 

Val  Thor 

Val  (or  Valiant)  Thor,  a  Venusian,  met  Frank 
E.  Stranges,  evangelist  and  contactee,  in  the 
Pentagon  one  morning  in  December  1959.  At 
the  time  Stranges  was  conducting  a  Christian 
crusade  in  Washington.  An  anonymous  Pen¬ 
tagon  official  of  his  acquaintance  invited  him 
to  the  building.  In  one  room  he  met  a  hand¬ 
some,  tanned  man  with  wavy  brown  hair.  In 
the  course  of  a  half-hour  conversation,  the 
stranger  informed  him  that  he  was  from 
Venus.  Over  the  course  of  years,  Stranges  flew 
on  spacecraft  with  Val  Thor  and  wrote  two 
books  about  their  experiences  together. 

Stranges  reported  that  Venusians  are  physi¬ 
cally  like  humans  in  all  ways,  except  that  they 
do  not  have  fingerprints.  Fingerprints  “are  a 
sign  of  fallen  man,”  according  to  Val  Thor 
(Stranges,  1974).  Venusians,  who  are  without 
sin,  are  devout  Christians,  but  they  have  no 
need  for  the  Bible  because  of  their  closeness  to 
its  author.  In  their  first  meeting  Stranges 
learned  that  seventy-seven  Venusians  were  liv¬ 
ing  secretly  in  the  United  States,  but  that 
number  was  subject  to  constant  change  be¬ 
cause  the  Space  Brothers  were  always  coming 
and  going.  Val  himself  was  scheduled  to  re¬ 


turn  to  Venus  on  March  16,  I960.  The  Venu¬ 
sians  had  come  to  Earth  to  “help  mankind  re¬ 
turn  to  the  Lord.” 

On  the  morning  of  February  5,  1968,  Val 
Thor  phoned  Stranges  and  instructed  him  to 
meet  at  the  San  Diego  Airport.  From  there, 
the  two  drove  across  the  border  into  a  coastal 
town  in  Sonora,  Mexico.  Near  there,  they 
boarded  a  flying  saucer  with  a  large  crew,  in¬ 
cluding  a  woman  named  Teel.  Inside  Val’s 
compartment,  Stranges  learned  that  his  friend 
had  spoken  with  Sen.  Robert  F.  Kennedy,  then 
running  for  the  Democratic  nomination  to  the 
presidency.  Kennedy  had  written  Val  a  letter 
requesting  a  meeting,  and  Val  had  responded. 
Val  found  Kennedy  “nervous  and  suspicious.” 
That  evening  aboard  the  spaceship,  as  they 
watched  a  large  televisionlike  screen,  Stranges, 
Val,  and  several  dozen  Venusians  sorrowfully 
observed  Kennedy’s  assassination. 

On  another  occasion,  in  January  1974, 
Stranges  flew  to  Las  Vegas  to  meet  Val  and 
friends.  At  the  airport,  two  young  men 
dressed  in  black  called  him  by  name.  Assum¬ 
ing  they  were  the  space  people  who  were  to 
take  him  to  Val  Thor,  he  followed  them  into  a 
black  Cadillac.  Suddenly,  they  and  a  third, 
similarly  clad  man  turned  on  him  and  were 
beating  him  severely  when  two  men — space 
people — came  to  the  rescue.  They  caused  the 
Cadillac  and  the  three  men  in  black,  agents  of 
dark  forces  opposed  to  the  Venusians’  benevo¬ 
lent  mission,  to  disappear.  They  then  took 
Stranges  to  the  scheduled  conference  with  Val 
inside  a  flying  saucer. 

Still  an  active  lecturer  and  saucer  personal¬ 
ity,  Stranges  claims  to  have  photographic  proof 
of  Val’s  existence.  The  photographs,  repro¬ 
duced  in  his  books  and  shown  at  his  lectures, 
depict  a  man  dressed  in  a  suit  and  surrounded 
by  other  persons  in  what  look  like  ordinary  so¬ 
cial  situations.  Val  Thor  resembles  a  Holly¬ 
wood  bit  player  more  than  an  extraterrestrial. 

See  Also:  Contactees;  Men  in  black 

Further  Reading 

Stranges,  Frank  E.,  1974.  My  Friend  from  beyond 
Earth.  Second  edition.  Van  Nuys,  CA:  Interna¬ 
tional  Evangelism  Crusades. 


Van  Tassel,  George  W.  255 


- ,  1972.  The  Stranger  at  the  Pentagon.  Second 

edition.  Van  Nuys,  CA:  International  Evangelism 
Crusades. 

Valdar 

In  I960,  a  young  man  identified  only  as 
Edwin  was  working  in  a  factory  in  Durban, 
South  Africa,  when  he  met  and  befriended  a 
new  supervisor.  One  night  while  the  two  were 
fishing  together,  the  latter  spoke  into  a  me¬ 
chanical  device,  called  up  space  people,  and 
produced  a  sky  show  with  UFOs.  Soon  after¬ 
ward,  the  man  confessed  to  Edwin  that  his 
real  name  was  Valdar.  He  also  told  Edwin  that 
he  was  from  Koldas,  a  planet  that  existed  in 
an  anti-matter  universe  to  which  he  must 
soon  return.  He  left  Edwin  the  device  before 
he  disappeared.  In  a  few  months,  the  two 
were  talking  over  the  interdimensional  radio. 
Edwin  learned  that  Koldas  is  one  planet  in  a 
twelve-world  confederation. 

The  exchange  continued  for  years.  Before 
long,  Edwin  channeled  the  messages  rather 
than  taking  them  through  the  radio.  Many  of 
the  messages  were  of  a  technical  and  scientific 
nature.  Others  were  occult  and  metaphysical. 
In  1986,  South  African  ufologist  Carl  van 
Vlierden  published  a  book-length  account  of 
Edwin’s  alleged  experiences  and  messages. 

Further  Reading 

Hind,  Cynthia,  1996.  UFOs  over  Africa.  Madison, 
WI:  Horus  House. 

Van  Vlierden,  Carl,  and  Wendelle  C.  Stevens,  1986. 
UFO  Contact  from  Planet  Koldas.  Tucson,  AZ: 
UFO  Photo  Archives. 

Van  Tassel,  George  W  (1910-1978) 

Besides  being  a  contactee  himself,  George  Van 
Tassel  made  his  mark  as  the  foremost  pro¬ 
moter  of  the  early  contactee  movement.  Every 
year  he  sponsored  the  Giant  Rock  Interplane¬ 
tary  Spacecraft  Convention  at  his  residence  in 
the  high  desert  between  Yucca  Valley  and 
Joshua  Tree,  California.  He  also  introduced 
Ashtar,  among  the  most  ubiquitous  and 
beloved  of  channeling  entities,  to  the  occult 
and  flying-saucer  world. 


Bom  in  Ohio,  Van  Tassel  moved  to  Califor¬ 
nia  in  1 930  with  his  family.  He  worked  as  an 
aircraft  technician  for,  among  others,  Howard 
Hughes.  In  1947,  the  Van  Tassels  took  up  resi¬ 
dence  inside  an  immense,  partially  hollowed- 
out  rock  called  simply  Giant  Rock.  Van  Tassel 
started  receiving  psychic  messages  from  extra¬ 
terrestrials  in  January  1952,  the  first  of  them 
from  “Lutbunn,  senior  in  command  first  wave, 
planet  patrol,  realms  of  Schare  [pronounced 
Share-ee,  a  starship  station  in  space].  We  have 
your  contact  aboard  80,000  feet  above  this 
place”  (Van  Tassel,  1952).  A  flood  of  other 
messages  followed  in  the  next  days,  weeks,  and 
months,  all  from  peace-loving  space  people  as¬ 
sociated  with  the  Council  of  Seven  Lights  on 
the  planet  Shanchea.  Van  Tassel  wrote  what 
may  be  the  first  contactee  book,  in  the  modern 
sense,  I  Rode  a  Flying  Saucer!  (1952).  Its  title 
notwithstanding,  at  that  point  all  of  his  con¬ 
tacts  had  been  mental  ones.  Not  until  August 
24,  1953,  would  Van  Tassel  board  a  spacecraft 
(or  “ventla,”  in  the  vocabulary  of  his  space 
friends). 

Beginning  in  early  1953,  Van  Tassel  held 
weekly  public  channeling  sessions.  The  Giant 
Rock  conventions  began  that  spring,  attract¬ 
ing  the  new  contactee  stars  and  their  followers 
and  affording  the  emerging  movement  much 
publicity.  Soon  Van  Tassel,  in  person  and 
through  his  College  of  Universal  Wisdom, 
was  raising  money  for  the  Integratron,  a  ma¬ 
chine  to  be  built  according  to  extraterrestrials’ 
specifications.  It  was  supposed  to  rejuvenate 
tissue  and  restore  youthful  vigor.  By  1959,  the 
structure  was  partially  built,  but  for  all  Van 
Tassel’s  subsequent  efforts  it  would  never  be 
completed. 

More  than  any  other  single  figure,  Van  Tas¬ 
sel  gave  direction  and  cohesion  to  what  other¬ 
wise  would  have  been  a  disparate  movement. 
He  supported  contactees  whose  claims — as 
was  often  the  case — conflicted  with  his  own, 
to  the  expense  of  his  own  credibility.  Ufologist 
Isabel  L.  Davis,  for  example,  saw  him  as  a 
charlatan  who  knew  fully  well  that  the  contact 
stories  were  bogus.  Others,  however,  judged 
him  to  be  sincere  and  dedicated  to  a  meta- 


256  Vegetable  Man 


George  Van  Tassel  ( right)  with  Long  John  Nebel  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


physical  vision  in  which,  however  outlandish 
it  may  have  seemed  to  others,  he  truly  be¬ 
lieved. 

Van  Tassel  died  in  Santa  Ana,  California, 
on  February  9,  1978.  Since  then,  some  chan¬ 
neled  have  reported  messages  from  him.  “I 
was  immediately  taken  into  fellowship  with 
the  Great  Masters  of  the  Council  of  which  I 
wrote,”  he  told  one  (Tuella,  1989). 

See  Also:  Ashtar;  Channeling;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Curran,  Douglas,  1985.  In  Advance  of  the  Landing: 
Folk  Concepts  of  Outer  Space.  New  York:  Abbeville 
Press. 

Davis,  Isabel  L.,  1957.  “Meet  the  Extraterrestrial.” 
Fantastic  Universe  8,  5  (November):  31-59. 

Reeve,  Bryant,  and  Helen  Reeve,  1957.  Flying  Saucer 
Pilgrimage.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

Tuella  [pseud,  of  Thelma  B.  Turrell],  ed.,  1989. 
Ashtar:  A  Tribute.  Third  edition.  Salt  Lake  City, 
UT:  Guardian  Action  Publications. 

Van  Tassel,  George  W.,  1952.  I  Rode  a  Flying  Saucer! 
The  Mystery  of  the  Flying  Saucers  Revealed.  Los 
Angeles:  New  Age  Publishing  Company. 


- ,  1958.  The  Council  of  Seven  Lights.  Los  An¬ 
geles:  DeVorss  and  Company. 

Vegetable  Man 

Jennings  Frederick,  a  young  West  Virginia 
man,  claimed  that  while  bow-and-arrow 
hunting  one  afternoon  in  July  1968,  he  heard 
a  “high-pitched  jabbering,  much  like  that  of  a 
recording  running  at  exaggerated  speed.” 
Even  so,  he  could  understand  it,  and  it  was 
communicating  to  him  that  he  should  not  be 
afraid.  “I  come  as  a  friend,”  the  voice  said. 
“We  know  of  you  all.  I  come  in  peace.  I  wish 
medical  assistance.  I  need  your  help.”  Then 
Frederick  saw  the  creature  whom  wags  would 
soon  dub  Vegetable  Man. 

The  being  had  semi-human  facial  features. 
Its  ears  were  long,  its  eyes  yellow  and  slanted, 
and  it  had  very  thin  arms  about  the  size  of  a 
quarter  in  diameter.  It  had  three  seven-inch- 
long  fingers  at  the  end  of  each  arm.  Instead  of 


Villanuevas  visitors  257 


fingertips,  the  fingers  had  needlelike  tips  and 
suction  cups.  Its  slender  body  looked  like  the 
stalk  of  a  plant,  and  so  did  its  color:  green. 

Suddenly  the  entity  gripped  Frederick’s 
hand.  Before  he  realized  what  was  happening, 
it  was  drawing  blood  from  it.  Then  its  eyes 
turned  red,  and  they  began  to  rotate  like  spin¬ 
ning  orange  circles.  The  effect  was  hypnotic. 
Frederick  no  longer  felt  any  pain  from  the  ex¬ 
traction,  which  lasted  a  minute  or  so.  After¬ 
ward,  a  restored  Vegetable  Man  bounded  up  a 
nearby  hill,  each  of  his  steps  covering  twenty- 
five  feet. 

Frederick’s  pain  resumed.  As  he  started  to 
walk  home,  he  heard  a  humming  sound.  It 
made  him  panic  because  he  thought  the  entity 
might  be  coming  after  him  in  its  flying  saucer. 
He  ran  as  fast  as  he  could  and  got  back  home 
unharmed. 

Frederick  was  friends  with  Gray  Barker  of 
Clarksburg,  West  Virginia,  a  publisher  and 
promoter  of  outlandish  saucer  materials. 
Barker  was  also  a  self-confessed  hoaxer  and 
encouraged  other  hoaxers.  For  a  time,  Veg¬ 
etable  Man  played  a  large  role  in  Barker’s  pro¬ 
motions.  No  one  else  has  ever  reported  an  en¬ 
counter  with  him. 

See  Also:  Tree-stump  aliens 

Further  Reading 

Steiger,  Brad,  1978 .  Alien  Meetings.  New  York:  Ace 
Books. 


Venudo 

Dan  Boone,  the  son-in-law  of  George  W.  Van 
Tassel,  a  leading  figure  in  the  contactee  move¬ 
ment  of  the  1950s  and  1960s,  was  in  a  Yucca 
Valley,  California,  liquor  store  early  one  Satur¬ 
day  evening  when  he  heard  a  group  of  peo¬ 
ple — two  men  and  two  women — ask  for  di¬ 
rections  to  Giant  Rock.  He  offered  to  lead 
them  there,  and  they  followed  him  to  the  site. 
Boone  assumed  they  were  there  to  attend  the 
weekly  channeling  and  discussion  group  Van 
Tassel  held.  He  was  right.  The  leader,  who 
said  his  name  was  Venudo,  sat  near  Boone 
and  Van  Tassel  while  the  other  three  rested  on 
a  couch  nearby. 


Venudo  casually  produced  a  device  that  had 
been  hanging  around  his  neck.  He  tapped  it 
and,  in  full  view  of  about  thirty  witnesses,  he 
vanished  instantly.  A  minute  later  he  became 
visible  again.  Boone  asked  him  if  he  could  do 
that  once  more,  and  Venudo  obliged.  This  time 
Boone  reached  over  and  felt  Venudo’s  shoulder, 
though  he  could  not  see  it.  According  to 
Boone,  Venudo  and  his  friends  were  space  peo¬ 
ple  checking  in  on  Van  Tassel’s  activities. 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Contactees;  Van  Tassel, 
George  W. 

Further  Reading 

Hamilton,  William  F.,  Ill,  1996.  Alien  Magic:  UFO 
Crashes — Abductions — Underground  Bases.  New 
Brunswick,  NJ:  Global  Communications. 


Villanueva’s  visitors 

In  1953,  Salvador  Villanueva  Medina’s  claimed 
encounter  with  friendly  men  from  another 
world  sparked  international  excitement.  Fol¬ 
lowers  of  the  emerging  contactee  movement 
saw  it  as  evidence  that  the  space  people  were 
now  expanding  their  mission  to  Latin  America, 
and  for  a  time  Villanueva  became  something  of 
a  hero  in  that  region’s  occult  world. 

As  the  story  went,  Villanueva,  a  taxi  and 
limousine  driver,  was  contracted  to  drive  from 
Mexico  City  up  to  Laredo,  Texas.  He  and  his 
two  passengers  from  Texas  left  Mexico  City 
on  the  morning  of  August  22.  In  the  late  af¬ 
ternoon,  the  car’s  differential  gave  out,  and 
Villanueva  managed  to  roll  the  car  to  the  side 
of  the  highway  before  it  came  to  a  complete 
stop.  The  two  passengers  decided  to  walk  to 
the  nearest  village  to  see  if  they  could  find  a 
mechanic.  The  driver  stayed  with  the  car  and 
did  what  he  could  to  get  it  running  again.  He 
jacked  up  the  car  and  crawled  underneath  it 
and  began  tinkering.  There  was  little  traffic, 
and  he  felt  very  much  alone. 

Darkness  had  fallen  when  he  heard  foot¬ 
steps.  From  beneath  the  vehicle,  he  saw  two 
legs  covered  in  what  look  like  corduroy.  He 
crawled  out  uneasily  and  stood  to  face  the 
man.  The  stranger  had  a  pale  white  face.  He 
was  dressed  in  a  one-piece  suit  and  had  a 


258  VTVenus 


three-inch-wide  belt  around  his  waist.  Lights 
shone  from  little  holes  in  the  belt,  and  he  was 
holding  a  helmet  under  his  arm.  He  had  fine 
features  and  a  penetrating  stare.  He  had 
shoulder-length  gray  hair  and  his  face  was 
hairless.  He  was  four  feet  tall. 

Too  stunned  and  frightened  to  speak,  Vil¬ 
lanueva  could  not  find  the  words  to  respond  to 
two  questions,  spoken  in  fluent  Spanish,  about 
what  was  wrong  with  the  car.  Finally,  he  man¬ 
aged  to  ask  if  the  man  was  an  aviator.  The  little 
man  replied  in  the  affirmative,  then  added  an 
odd  remark  about  “my  machine  which  you 
people  call  an  airplane.”  He  indicated  that  it 
was  parked  behind  a  mound  not  far  away. 

Feeling  more  comfortable,  Villanueva  in¬ 
vited  him  to  sit  down  in  the  car.  But  at  that 
moment  the  lights  on  the  belt  started  to  flash, 
and  a  buzzing  noise  sounded.  The  stranger 
donned  his  helmet  and  walked  toward  the 
hill.  The  driver  returned  to  his  business  with 
the  car,  and  not  long  afterward  two  motorcy¬ 
cle  police  officers  came  by  and  ordered  him  to 
take  the  vehicle  off  the  road.  Afterward,  he  lay 
down  to  sleep  inside  it. 

Sometime  later,  knocks  sounded  on  the 
window.  Groggily  Villanueva  sat  up,  assuming 
that  his  passengers  had  returned.  He  was  sur¬ 
prised  to  see  instead  the  “aviator”  and  a  com¬ 
panion,  the  latter  a  taller  version  of  the  first. 
They  entered  the  car  and  conversed  with  the 
driver.  The  shorter  one  did  most  of  the  talking. 
As  they  described  their  home,  Villanueva  real¬ 
ized  that  they  were  space  people.  It  took  him 
awhile  to  decide  that  they  were  not  joking. 

Over  the  next  few  hours,  he  learned  much 
about  their  home  world,  its  civilization,  its 
cities,  its  technology,  and  more.  Thousands  of 
years  ago,  he  was  told,  many  destructive  wars 
were  fought  between  the  planet’s  nations, 
until  finally  its  inhabitants  established  a  one- 
world  government  under  what  amounted  to  a 
benevolent  dictatorship  of  a  council  of  wise 
men.  The  state  raised  and  educated  the  chil¬ 
dren,  and  there  was  no  serious  poverty.  People 
from  this  planet  live  undetected  among  earth¬ 
lings,  reporting  on  human  affairs  to  their  oth¬ 
erworldly  superiors. 


Toward  dawn  the  buzzing  sounds,  emanat¬ 
ing  from  either  the  helmets  or  the  belts,  re¬ 
sumed.  The  two  left  the  car,  with  Villanueva 
following.  Eventually,  they  came  to  the  ship,  a 
saucer-shaped  structure.  The  men  invited  him 
inside  the  craft,  but  at  that  moment  he  lost  his 
nerve  and  fled  back  to  the  car.  From  it  he  saw 
the  saucer  ascend  and  disappear  in  the  direc¬ 
tion  of  the  rising  sun. 

When  his  experience  became  known  soon 
afterward,  Villanueva  was  compared  to  the 
prominent  American  contactee  George 
Adamski.  Adamski  met  Villanueva  in  Mexico 
in  the  spring  of  1955  and  asked  him  a  series 
of  questions.  An  American  couple  that  also 
was  there  would  write,  “If  the  questions  as¬ 
tounded  us,  so  did  the  answers.  Salvador 
passed  his  examination  at  the  hands  of  a  man 
who,  having  seen  a  saucer  himself,  knew  how 
to  ask  about  certain  things  which  no  mere 
imaginary  contact  could  give  the  answers  to” 
(Reeve  and  Reeve,  1957).  Desmond  Leslie, 
Adamski  s  associate  and  co-author,  visited  Vil¬ 
lanueva  later  that  year.  Leslie  claimed  that 
Adamski  had  confided  “the  Key”  to  him,  ex¬ 
plaining  that  “every  man  who  has  received  a 
true  and  physical  contact  with  men  from 
other  worlds  has  been  given  a  certain  ‘Key’ 
whereby  it  shall  be  known  that  he  is  speaking 
truly.  No  man .  .  .  could  ever  stumble  upon 
this  key  by  guess  or  chance.  .  .  .  Villanueva 
gave  it  without  hesitation”  (Good,  1998). 

Unlike  Adamski  and  other  contactees  of  the 
period,  Villanueva  did  not  embark  on  a  profes¬ 
sional  career.  So  far  as  is  known,  he  claimed  no 
further  meetings  with  extraterrestrials. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Good,  Timothy,  1998.  Alien  Base:  Earth’s  Encounters 
with  Extraterrestrials.  London:  Century. 

Reeve,  Bryant,  and  Helen  Reeve,  195 1 .  Flying  Saucer 
Pilgrimage.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 


VlVenus 

The  woman  who  called  herself  “VlVenus” — 
“Viv”  for  short — made  her  mark  in  the  mid- 
1970s  to  the  early  1980s.  She  said  she  was  a 


Volmo  259 


Venusian  who  replaced  a  woman,  her  exact 
physical  double,  who  had  committed  suicide 
in  a  New  York  hotel  on  September  24,  I960. 
As  she  was  brought  to  Earth  that  night,  she 
lost  all  memory  of  her  life  on  Venus,  “a  world 
of  Love”  ( VIVenus ,  1982).  The  memories  re¬ 
turned  seven  years  later,  and  she  embarked  on 
a  mission  to  reform  this  corrupt,  cruel  planet. 

From  Christmas  1974  until  mid- 1982,  Viv 
walked  an  average  of  ten  miles  a  day  and 
preached  the  cosmic  gospel  to  whoever  would 
listen.  When  she  wasn’t  preaching,  she  was 
playing  guitar  and  singing  interplanetary 
hymns.  In  1980,  she  campaigned  for  her  fa¬ 
vorite  presidential  candidate  under  the  slogan 
“It’s  Not  Odd  to  Vote  for  God”  (Shoemaker, 
1980). 

See  Also:  Dual  reference 

Further  Reading 

Shoemaker,  Susan,  1980.  “A  Venusian  Visitor  Goes 
Campaigning.”  Oakland  [California]  Tribune 
(July  13). 

VIVenus:  Starchild,  1982.  New  York:  Global  Com¬ 
munications. 


Volmo 

Ted  Rice  grew  up  in  rural  Alabama.  Early  in 
life  he  learned  that  he  had  psychic  abilities,  and 
he  was  aware  of  what  he  took  to  be  spirit  guides 
but  later  identified  as  extraterrestrials.  One  of 
these  was  a  reptoid  entity  named  Volmo. 

Volmo  communicated  spiritual  truths  to 
Rice  as  he  slept.  It  was  only  when  he  saw  Volmo 
that  he  realized  Volmo  was  not  an  angel  but  a 
grotesque-looking  alien.  Under  hypnosis,  in  an 
ostensible  reliving  of  his  first  physical  en¬ 
counter,  he  remarked  that  Volmo  “just  isn’t 
human.  .  . .  He’s  really  tall ...  six  and  a  half  feet 
tall . .  .  and  massive.  He’s  got  a  strong,  powerful 
body,  and  it’s  dark  colored,  dull  gray  or  olive 
brown.  . . .  They’re  dark,  sort  of  yellow-gold, 
with  sharp  teeth.  .  .  .  There  are  only  three  or 
four  fingers  on  each  hand,  and  I  think  they’re 
webbed.  The  hands  look  clawlike,  because  he’s 
got  these  long,  pointed  nails  on  each  finger.” 

See  Also:  King  Leo;  Reptoid  child;  Reptoids 

Further  Reading 

Turner,  Karla,  1994.  Masquerade  of  Angels.  Roland, 
AR:  Kelt  Works. 


Walk-ins 

Ruth  Montgomery  popularized  the  notion  of 
the  “Walk-in,”  highly  evolved  souls  who  take 
over  the  bodies  of  human  beings  who  are  will¬ 
ing  to  relinquish  them.  These  beings  are  be¬ 
lieved  to  be  so  advanced  that  it  is  not  practi¬ 
cal,  or  sometimes  even  possible,  for  them  to 
go  through  the  normal  process  of  reincarna¬ 
tion,  starting  out  as  a  baby.  In  any  event,  they 
have  no  time  to  waste  and  a  serious  mission  to 
fulfill.  In  Montgomery’s  words: 

There  are  Walk-ins  on  this  planet.  Tens  of 
thousands  of  them.  Enlightened  beings,  who, 
after  successfully  completing  numerous  incar¬ 
nations,  have  attained  sufficient  awareness  of 
the  meaning  of  life  that  they  can  forego  the 
time-consuming  process  of  birth  and  child¬ 
hood,  returning  directly  [to]  the  adult 
bodies.  .  .  .  The  motivation  of  the  Walk-in  is 
humanitarian.  He  returns  to  physical  being 
in  order  to  help  others  help  themselves, 
planting  seed-concepts  that  will  grow  and 
flourish  for  the  benefit  of  mankind.  (Mont¬ 
gomery,  1979) 

Walk-ins,  according  to  Montgomery,  in¬ 
clude  Moses,  Jesus,  Mohammed,  Christo¬ 
pher  Columbus,  Abraham  Lincoln,  Gandhi, 
Mary  Baker  Eddy,  Thomas  Jefferson,  Ben¬ 
jamin  Franklin,  and  others  who  have  played 


large  roles  in  politics,  religion,  the  arts,  and 
other  aspects  of  human  life. 

In  a  later  elaboration  of  the  notion,  Mont¬ 
gomery  contended  that  there  are  also  extrater¬ 
restrial  Walk-ins,  in  other  words  the  souls  of 
kindly  space  people  who  have  possessed  (after 
mutual  agreement)  the  bodies  of  humans.  The 
extraterrestrial  Walk-ins  are  among  the  ad¬ 
vanced  souls  that  come  to  guide  humans  into 
a  New  Age  of  peace,  harmony,  and  spiritual 
insight. 

Further  Reading 

Montgomery,  Ruth,  1979.  Strangers  among  Us:  En  - 
lightened  Beings  from  a  World  to  Come.  New  York: 
Coward,  McCann,  and  Geoghegan. 

- ,  1983.  Threshold  to  Tomorrow.  New  York: 

G.  P.  Putnams  Sons. 

- ,  1985.  Aliens  among  Us.  New  York:  G.  P 

Putnam’s  Sons. 


Walton’s  abduction 

Few  UFO  abduction  cases  are  as  spectacular 
or  as  puzzling  as  one  that  allegedly  took  place 
in  November  1975  in  a  remote  area  of  east- 
central  Arizona.  Forestry  worker  Travis  Wal¬ 
ton’s  five-day  disappearance  received  world¬ 
wide  attention  when  it  occurred,  and  it  has 
since  been  the  subject  of  books,  television  dra¬ 
mas,  a  movie,  polygraph  tests,  and  endless 
controversy. 


261 


262  Walton’s  abduction 


UFO  abductee  Travis  Walton  ( Dennis  Stacy/Fortean 
Picture  Library) 

The  incident  began  as  the  seven-member 
crew  of  young  men,  ranging  in  age  from  sev¬ 
enteen  to  twenty-eight,  were  quitting  work  at 
6  A.M.  on  November  5.  As  they  left  the  site, 
located  in  the  Apache-Sitgreaves  National 
Forest,  they  noticed,  ahead  of  them,  a  brilliant 
glow,  its  source  hidden  by  the  trees.  As  their 
pickup  continued  down  the  road,  they  ob¬ 
served  a  disc-shaped  structure,  approximately 
one-hundred  feet  in  diameter,  twenty  feet 
wide,  and  eight  feet  high.  It  was  hovering 
twenty  feet  above  a  clearing.  As  the  pickup 
slowed  down,  Walton  jumped  out  and  ran  to¬ 
ward  the  object.  According  to  Walton’s  own 
testimony  as  well  as  what  other  crew  members 
subsequently  told  law-enforcement  authori¬ 
ties  and  civilian  ufologists,  Walton  got  within 
six  feet  of  the  bottom  of  the  craft.  Sounds 
began  to  come  from  the  UFO,  unnerving 
Walton,  who  was  starting  to  back  away  when 
a  bluish  green  beam  hit  him,  shooting  him 
back  some  ten  feet. 


Terrified,  the  others  fled  in  the  truck.  A  few 
minutes  later,  their  panic  somewhat  subsided, 
they  returned  to  retrieve  their  coworker,  only  to 
find  no  trace  of  him.  After  twenty  minutes  of 
fruitless  searching,  they  drove  to  nearby  Fleber, 
Arizona,  and  reported  the  disappearance  to  the 
authorities.  The  crew  returned  to  the  site  in  the 
company  of  two  sheriff’s  officers.  They  found 
no  clues  to  tip  them  off  to  Walton’s  where¬ 
abouts.  At  midnight,  Walton’s  mother  and 
other  family  members  were  notified.  The  next 
day  searches  resumed.  By  now  the  authorities 
suspected  that  either  the  crew  had  murdered 
Walton  and  concocted  a  wild  UFO  tale  to 
cover  up  the  deed  or  Walton  and  his  brother 
Duane  had  engineered  a  hoax  for  monetary 
reasons.  No  actual  evidence  supported  either  of 
these  suppositions,  but  the  alternative — that  a 
UFO  had  kidnapped  Travis  Walton — was  too 
outlandish  to  be  taken  seriously. 

As  publicity  spread,  reporters,  ufologists, 
and  curiosity-seekers  descended  on  the  scene, 
and  charges  and  countercharges  flew.  The  au¬ 
thorities  insisted  that  the  witnesses  undergo 
polygraph  examination.  According  to  exam¬ 
iner  Cy  Gilson,  the  results  in  five  cases  were 
positive — indicating  that  the  men  had  given  a 
sincere  account — and  in  one  instance  incon¬ 
clusive.  Sheriff  Marlin  Gillespie  declared  that 
he  was  now  convinced  that  the  UFO  story 
was  true,  after  all. 

Near  midnight  on  November  10,  Walton’s 
brother-in-law  Grant  Neff  took  a  call,  which 
he  first  took  to  be  a  prank,  from  a  weak¬ 
voiced,  confused-sounding  man  who  claimed 
to  be  Travis  Walton.  The  caller  said  he  was 
phoning  from  a  gas  station  in  Heber,  thirty 
miles  east  of  Taylor,  where  Neff  and  his  wife 
lived.  When  Neff  seemed  ready  to  hang  up, 
the  voice  became  desperate,  and  Neff  realized 
that  he  was  indeed  speaking  with  Travis.  Neff 
and  Duane  Walton  drove  to  Heber  and  found 
Travis  at  a  phone  both  near  the  station,  shiv¬ 
ering  in  the  same  clothes  he  had  been  wearing 
five  days  earlier.  It  was  only  eighteen  degrees 
outside. 

A  complex  series  of  events  followed,  with 
hoax  charges  being  leveled  by  some  (though 


Walton’s  abduction  263 


not  all)  local  police  officers  and  then  by 
William  H.  Spaulding,  head  of  a  Phoenix- 
based  group  called  Ground  Saucer  Watch.  Jim 
and  Coral  Lorenzen,  directors  ofTucson’s  Aer¬ 
ial  Phenomena  Research  Organization 
(APRO),  entered  the  investigation  and,  with 
the  National  Enquirer,  arranged  for  Walton  to 
take  a  secret  polygraph  test.  It  was  adminis¬ 
tered  by  John  J.  McCarthy,  who  did  not  hide 
his  skepticism  of  Walton’s  claim  and  grilled 
him  about  a  youthful  scrape  with  the  law.  Af¬ 
terward,  when  Walton  had  taken  the  exami¬ 
nation,  McCarthy  declared  that  he  had 
flunked  it.  Walton’s  critics  cited  the  test  as  rea¬ 
son  to  reject  Walton’s  story,  while  his  defend¬ 
ers  disputed  the  results  as  the  consequence  of 
a  hostile  examiner’s  harassment  of  an  already 
shaken  witness.  In  any  case,  the  results  were 
suppressed  and  did  not  come  to  light  until 
UFO  debunker  Philip  J.  Klass  learned  about 
it  sometime  later  from  McCarthy. 

The  following  February,  Duane  Walton 
and  then  Travis  took  a  polygraph,  this  one  run 
by  George  J.  Pfeifer.  Pfeifer  concluded  that 
their  responses  were  truthful.  Mary  Kellett, 
their  mother,  whom  some  had  accused  of 
being  a  conspirator  in  a  hoax,  also  passed  the 
test,  in  Pfeifer’s  judgment. 

Walton  would  tell  the  same  story  without 
elaboration  over  the  next  two  decades  and 
more.  Fie  reported  that  after  the  beam  hit 
him,  he  lost  consciousness  and  had  no  mem¬ 
ory  of  anything  until  he  awoke  in  what  he 
thought  was  a  hospital.  The  atmosphere  was 
wet  and  heavy,  and  he  had  a  hard  time  breath¬ 
ing  in  it.  Three  humanoid  figures  with  big 
staring  eyes,  large  hairless  heads,  and  tiny 
mouths,  ears,  and  noses,  stood  by  the  bedside. 

Terrified,  he  leaped  out  of  bed  and  pushed 
one  into  another.  Grabbing  a  cylindrical  tube 
he  noticed  on  a  shelf  jutting  from  the  wall,  he 
waved  it  like  a  weapon  toward  the  beings, 
who  put  out  their  hands  as  if  to  stop  him. 
After  a  short  time,  they  fled  through  a  door 
behind  them.  Soon  afterward  Walton  ran  out 
the  door  himself  and  ran  to  his  left,  through  a 
curving,  three-feet-wide  corridor.  Seeing  an 
open  room  to  his  right,  he  ducked  into  it.  The 


A  drawing  by  Travis  Waltons  boss,  Michael  Rogers,  based 
on  Waltons  description  of  the  being  he  saw  when  he  was 
abditcted  (Fortean  Picture  Library) 


room  seemed  empty,  though  Walton  was 
nervous  about  a  high-backed  metal  chair  in 
the  middle.  Because  he  was  observing  it  from 
the  back,  he  did  not  know  if  anyone  was  sit¬ 
ting  in  it  or  not.  No  one  was.  As  Walton  ap¬ 
proached  it,  the  lights  in  the  room  began  to 
dim.  When  he  stepped  back,  the  light  re¬ 
turned.  As  he  went  forward  again,  the  light 
dimmed  again,  and  now  stars  surrounded 
him.  Fie  did  not  know  if  he  was  witnessing  a 
planetarium  effect  or  if  the  room  had  become 
transparent.  He  would  recall  that  the  experi¬ 
ence  was  “like  sitting  in  a  chair  in  the  middle 
of  space”  (Walton,  1978). 

On  the  right  arm  of  the  chair,  he  saw  a 
panel  of  buttons  and  a  screen  with  black 
lines  going  up  and  down.  On  the  left  there 
was  a  lever.  Curious,  Walton  pushed  the 
lever  forward.  Suddenly  the  lines  on  the 
screen  moved,  and  the  stars  began  to  spin 
even  while  maintaining  their  relative  posi¬ 
tions.  When  he  let  go  of  the  lever,  everything 
returned  to  the  way  it  had  been  before.  After 


264  Walton’s  abduction 


he  stood  up,  the  light  returned  to  the  room, 
and  the  stars  disappeared. 

At  that  point,  a  human-looking  figure 
wearing  a  spacesuit  and  helmet  entered  the 
room.  He  stood  over  six  feet  tall,  looked  to  be 
about  two-hundred  pounds,  and  had  blond 
hair  long  enough  to  cover  his  ears.  His  skin 
was  deeply  tanned.  Thinking  that  the  stranger 
was  a  fellow  human  being  (even  though  he 
would  recall  that  the  eyes  were  peculiar,  a 
“strange  bright  golden  hazel”),  Walton  felt  re¬ 
lieved  and  peppered  him  with  questions.  In 
response  the  figure  only  grinned,  then  beck¬ 
oned  him  to  follow.  He  took  Walton’s  arm, 
and  the  two  proceeded  down  the  curving  hall¬ 
way.  They  came  to  a  door  and  opened  it  to 
enter  a  tiny  “metal  cubicle”  of  a  room.  They 
passed  through  it  into  a  huge  space  that  Wal¬ 
ton  thought  looked  like  a  hangar  of  some 
kind.  Inside  it  was  bright  as  sunshine,  and 
breezes  blew  as  if  they  were  outdoors.  He  real¬ 
ized  that  they  had  just  left  the  craft.  When  he 
turned  to  examine  it,  he  observed  that  it  re¬ 
sembled  the  UFO  he  had  seen  in  the  clearing 
but  this  one  was  bigger.  He  also  saw  two  other 
identical  but  smaller  craft  parked  near  the 
wall. 

They  then  went  through  another  door  into 
another  hallway,  strolling  past  a  number  of 
closed  double  doors  until  finally  they  entered 
yet  another  room.  Inside  this  room  two  men 
and  a  woman  sat,  not  only  dressed  like  his 
companion  but  looking  enough  like  him  that 
Walton  wondered  if  they  were  related  to  him. 
They  were  all  good-looking,  and  the  woman’s 
hair  was  longer  than  the  men’s.  The  three  were 
not  wearing  helmets.  Walton  had  assumed 
that  he  had  not  been  able  to  communicate 
with  the  first  man  because  the  stranger  could 
not  hear  him  through  the  helmet.  But  like  the 
first  man,  they  did  not  respond  to  Walton’s 
questions,  just  smiled  pleasantly.  When  the 
helmeted  man  left,  the  others  led  him  to  a 
table.  Suddenly  frightened,  Walton  demanded 
to  know  what  they  were  doing.  The  woman 
forced  something  that  looked  like  an  oxygen 
mask  with  no  connecting  tubes  onto  his  face. 
He  passed  out.  The  next  thing  he  knew,  he 


was  lying  on  his  back  near  Heber,  ten  miles 
from  where  he  had  been  before  all  of  this 
started.  In  the  darkness  “one  of  those  round 
craft  [hovered]  there  for  just  a  second.  I 
looked  up  just  as  a  light  went  out.  A  white 
light  just  went  off  on  the  bottom  of  it.  The 
craft  was  dark,  and  it  wasn’t  giving  off  any 
light”  (Barry,  1978). 

Walton’s  return  was  an  international  news 
event.  Soon  afterward,  UFO  debunker  Philip 
J.  Klass  embarked  on  what  would  amount  to  a 
lifelong  crusade  to  prove  that  Walton,  his 
family,  and  the  logging  crew  had  conspired  to 
hoax  the  incident.  No  very  good  evidence  of  a 
hoax  would  emerge,  however,  even  after  one 
of  the  crew  was  reportedly  offered  ten  thou¬ 
sand  dollars  to  expose  the  story.  Walton  went 
on  to  marry,  become  a  family  man  and  re¬ 
spected  member  of  his  community,  and  write 
two  books  on  his  experience,  the  second  con¬ 
taining  a  long  and  pointed  rejoinder  to  the 
skeptics’  case.  On  February  1,  1993,  Travis 
Walton,  Duane  Walton,  and  witness  Allen 
Dalis  (who  had  not  seen  Travis  in  two 
decades)  underwent  new  polygraph  examina¬ 
tions,  again  administered  by  Cy  Gilson. 
Gilson  judged  them  to  be  telling  the  truth 
when  they  responded  affirmatively  to  the 
UFO  questions  and  negatively  to  the  hoax 
charges.  In  March  1993  Paramount  Pictures 
released  a  movie  drama,  Fire  in  the  Sky,  based 
loosely  on  the  incident,  with  D.  B.  Sweeney 
in  the  role  ofTravis. 

Few  students  of  this  complex  episode  be¬ 
lieve  it  to  be  a  hoax.  Alternative,  non-UFO 
explanations  tend  to  focus  on  psychological 
or  natural  causes.  One  theory  holds  that 
Walton  and  his  companions  saw  an  earth¬ 
quake  light — a  luminous  phenomenon  gen¬ 
erated  by  electrical  fields  in  rocks  in  fault 
zones — that  triggered  hallucinations.  A 
problem  with  this  hypothesis  is  the  thinly 
clad  Walton’s  survival  in  the  woods  over  five 
bitterly  cold  mountain  nights.  The  Walton 
abduction  story  remains  one  of  the  most  in¬ 
triguing  cases  of  the  UFO  age. 

Interestingly,  Walton’s  is  one  of  the  first 
two  cases  in  the  UFO  literature  to  describe 


Waltons  abduction  265 


A  dramatization  of  the  abdiiction  of  Travis  Walton  as  seen  in  the  movie  Fire  in  the  Sky,  1993  (Photofest) 


the  gray  aliens  that  would  assume  a  promi-  November  1975.  It  was  known  to  ufologists 
nent  role  in  the  abduction  phenomenon  of  Jim  and  Coral  Lorenzen,  who  were  quietly  in- 
later  years.  The  other  incident  was  one  of  vestigating  it  when  the  Walton  story  erupted 
which  Walton  could  not  have  been  aware  in  into  the  headlines.  U.S.  Air  Force  Sergeant 


266  Wanderers 


Charles  Moody  had  confided  to  them  that  the 
previous  August  13,  he  saw  a  UFO  in  the 
New  Mexico  desert  and  was  taken  aboard.  In 
early  N  ovember,  in  a  letter  to  the  Lorenzens, 
he  had  this  to  say  of  the  occupants:  “The  be¬ 
ings  were  about  five  feet  tall  and  very  much 
like  us  except  their  heads  were  larger  and  hair¬ 
less,  their  eyes  very  small  [,]  and  the  mouth 
had  very  thin  lips”  (Lorenzen  and  Lorenzen, 
1977).  Moody’s  description  is  virtually  identi¬ 
cal  to  the  one  Walton  gave  to  the  first  group 
of  humanoids  he  allegedly  encountered.  Wal¬ 
ton’s  also  anticipated  later  abduction  lore  in 
claiming  to  see  both  little  gray  entities  and  the 
more  humanlike  beings  whom  some  ufolo¬ 
gists  would  call  Nordics  aboard  the  same  ship. 

See  Also:  Abductions  by  UFOs;  Nordics 

Further  Reading 

Barry,  Bill,  1978.  Ultimate  Encounter:  The  True  Story 
of  a  UFO  Kidnapping.  New  York:  Pocket  Books. 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  1987.  UFO  Abductions:  The 
Measure  of  a  Mystery.  Volume  1:  Comparative 
Study  of  Abductions.  Volume  2:  Catalogue  of  Cases. 
Mount  Rainier,  MD:  Fund  for  UFO  Research. 

Clark,  Jerome,  1998.  “Walton  Abduction  Case.”  In 
Jerome  Clark.  The  UFO  Encyclopedia,  Second 
Edition:  The  Phenomenon  from  the  Beginning, 
981-998.  Detroit,  MI:  Omnigraphics. 

Gansberg,  Judith  M.,  and  Alan  L.  Gansberg,  1980. 
Direct  Encounters:  The  Personal  Histories  of  UFO 
Abductees.  New  York:  Walker  and  Company. 

Klass,  Philip  J.,  1989.  UFO  Abductions:  A  Dangerous 
Game.  Updated  edition.  Buffalo,  NY:  Prome¬ 
theus  Books. 

Lorenzen,  Coral,  and  Jim  Lorenzen,  1977.  Abducted! 
Confrontations  with  Beings  from  Outer  Space.  New 
York:  Berkley. 

Persinger,  Michael  A.,  1979.  “Possible  Infrequent 
Geophysical  Sources  of  Close  UFO  Encounters: 
Expected  Physical  and  Behavioral  Biological  Ef¬ 
fects.”  In  Richard  F.  Haines,  ed.  UFO  Phenomena 
and  the  Behavioral  Scientist,  396-433.  Metuchen, 
NJ :  Scarecrow  Press. 

Walton,  Travis,  1978.  The  Walton  Experience.  New 
York:  Berkley  Medallion  Books. 

- ,  1996.  Fire  in  the  Sky:  The  Walton  Experi  - 

ence.  New  York:  Marlowe  and  Company. 


Wanderers 

Wanderers  are  extraterrestrials  who  traverse 
the  cosmos  in  search  of  what  George  Hunt 


Williamson  calls  “trash  can  worlds” — in  other 
words,  backward  planets  such  as  the  Earth. 
When  they  find  such  a  world,  they  offer  their 
souls  to  the  reincarnation  cycle.  On  Earth 
their  leader  was  the  Elder  Brother — also 
known  as  the  Son  of  Thought  Incarnate  and, 
in  a  later  life,  Jesus  Christ.  The  Elder  Brother 
came  to  this  planet  accompanied  by  one  hun¬ 
dred  forty-four  thousand  Lesser  Avatars.  Over 
the  centuries,  many  forgot  their  cosmic  ori¬ 
gins  and  mission,  but  some  kept  the  faith. 
After  World  War  II,  with  the  coming  of  flying 
saucers,  the  seeding  process  accelerated.  A 
“space  friend”  told  Williamson,  “Many  of  our 
people  are  in  your  world  now.  There  are 
nearly  ten  million  of  them,  with  six  of  those 
million  in  the  United  States  itself.” 

See  Also:  Williamson,  George  Hunt 

Further  Reading 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1953.  Other  Tongues — 
Other  Flesh.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

White  Eagle 

White  Eagle,  believed  to  represent  the  New 
Testament’s  Saint  John,  was  channeled 
through  British  spiritualist  medium  Grace 
Cooke  (also  known  as  Minesta)  from  the 
1930s  until  her  death  in  1979.  By  the  1950s, 
White  Eagle’s  teachings  had  found  their  way 
to  North  America.  White  Eagle  taught  an 
eclectic  mix  of  Christian-based  ideas  and  rein¬ 
carnation  theories  as  well  as  the  occult  doc¬ 
trine  of  the  Great  White  Brotherhood.  He  ad¬ 
vocated  kindness  toward  one’s  fellows  and 
vegetarianism,  and  love  for  animals. 

Further  Reading 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  1996.  Encyclopedia  of  American 
Religions.  Detroit,  MI:  Gale  Research. 

White’s  little  people 

One  August  night  in  1891,  hours  before  he 
would  leave  his  native  El  Dorado,  Kansas,  to 
move  to  Kansas  City  and  become  one  of  Amer¬ 
ica’s  most  highly  regarded  journalists,  William 
Allen  White  was  awakened  by  the  bright 
moonlight  streaming  in  through  his  back  win¬ 
dow.  He  was  about  to  turn  his  head  in  the  op- 


Wilcox’s  Martians  267 


posite  direction  when  he  thought  he  heard 
music.  Looking  outside,  he  saw  a  group  of  little 
people — no  more  than  three  or  four  inches 
high — dancing  under  the  elm  tree.  They  also 
seemed  to  be  humming  along  with  the  melody. 
The  scene  was  clear  and  unmistakable. 

Yet,  still  unable  to  credit  his  senses,  he 
turned  away,  then  glanced  back.  The  strange 
tiny  figures  were  still  there.  He  got  up  and 
looked  through  another  window  in  case  the 
whole  scene  was  simply  a  trick  of  light.  He 
could  still  see  the  figures.  He  moved  about 
vigorously  to  discharge  any  extant  images 
kept  over  from  sleep.  After  five  minutes  the 
little  people  began  to  fade  away,  and  soon 
only  the  grass  on  which  they  had  been  mov¬ 
ing  remained. 

Exhausted,  he  returned  to  bed  and  fell 
asleep.  He  would  never  forget  the  incident. 
Recalling  it  many  years  later  in  his  autobiog¬ 
raphy,  he  reflected  ruefully,  “When  I  recall 
that  hour  I  am  so  sure  that  I  was  awake  I 
think  maybe  I  am  still  crazy.” 

See  Also:  Fairies  encountered 

Further  Reading 

White,  William  Allen,  1946.  Autobiography.  New 
York:  Macmillan. 


Wilcox’s  Martians 

As  he  went  about  his  chores  on  the  morning 
of  April  24,  1964,  Newark  Valley,  New  York, 
dairy  farmer  Gary  T.  Wilcox  had  a  premoni¬ 
tion  that  something  out  of  the  ordinary  was 
going  to  happen  that  day.  Driving  his  tractor 
up  a  hill,  he  glimpsed  a  shiny  object  just  in¬ 
side  a  nearby  clump  of  woods.  He  stopped  the 
tractor,  got  off,  and  walked  toward  the  woods. 
The  closer  perspective  allowed  him  to  see  that 
the  object  was  an  egg-shaped  structure, 
twenty  feet  long  and  sixteen  feet  wide,  hover¬ 
ing  two  feet  above  the  ground.  All  the  while  it 
emitted  a  sound  that  to  Wilcox’s  ears  was  like 
a  car  idling.  Just  after  he  touched  the  UFO, 
two  Martians  came  up  from  under  it. 

Wilcox  did  not  learn  of  their  planet  of  ori¬ 
gin  immediately,  but  the  figures  did  not  look 
earthly.  Four  feet  tall  and  two  feet  wide,  they 


were  clad  in  silver  suits  that  covered  their  en¬ 
tire  bodies.  Each  carried  a  small  tray  filled 
with  soil  and  plant  samples.  An  eerie  voice  ad¬ 
dressed  him,  apparently  from  the  chest  of  the 
nearer  figure  (the  other  stood  near  the  UFO). 
The  voice  said,  “We  are  from  what  you  know 
as  the  planet  Mars”  (Schwarz,  1983).  Asked 
what  he  was  doing,  Wilcox  explained  that  he 
was  spreading  manure.  The  Martian  wanted 
to  know  what  manure  was,  and  he  asked  a  se¬ 
ries  of  questions  about  it.  He  said  he  would 
like  a  sample  of  it,  but  when  Wilcox  volun¬ 
teered  to  go  to  the  barn  to  retrieve  some,  the 
alien  changed  the  subject.  They  could  come 
to  Earth  only  every  two  years,  he  said,  and 
warned  would-be  travelers  from  Earth  to  stay 
away  from  Mars,  since  its  conditions  are  in¬ 
hospitable  to  human  life.  They  were  here  to 
study  the  Earth’s  organic  life,  and  they  said 
something  that  Wilcox  understood  to  mean 
that  “the  earth  and  Mars,  plus  some  other 
planets,  might  be  changed  around.”  They  also 
predicted  that  within  a  year  two  American  as¬ 
tronauts,  John  Glenn  and  Virgil  (Gus)  Gris¬ 
som,  and  two  Soviet  cosmonauts  would  be 
killed.  They  said  that  other  Martian  ships 
were  surveying  the  Earth. 

After  two  hours,  the  conversation  ended. 
The  Martians  said  that  Wilcox  should  not  tell 
anyone  about  the  exchange  “for  your  own 
good,”  though  Wilcox  did  not  interpret  this 
as  a  threat. 

All  the  while,  Wilcox  would  tell  family 
members,  he  suspected  that  he  was  at  the  re¬ 
ceiving  end  of  a  hoax  engineered  by  the  televi¬ 
sion  show  Candid  Camera.  He  found  a  jelly- 
like  substance  on  the  ground  where  the  UFO 
had  been,  but  he  could  not  pick  it  up.  It 
slipped  through  his  fingers. 

Wilcox  confided  the  story  to  family  mem¬ 
bers  and  friends.  The  matter  probably  would 
have  ended  there  if  two  local  women,  who 
worked  with  Floyd  Wilcox,  Gary’s  younger 
brother,  had  not  heard  the  story.  Both  be¬ 
longed  to  a  Washington-based  UFO  organiza¬ 
tion.  They  asked  permission  to  interview 
Gary  Wilcox,  who  provided  them  with  a  short 
statement.  A  neighbor  woman  interested  in 


268  Williamson,  George  Hunt 


UFOs  spoke  with  him  at  greater  length  and 
examined  the  landing  site,  but  rain  had 
washed  away  whatever  might  have  been  there 
originally.  She  alerted  the  sheriff’s  office, 
which  sent  a  deputy  to  investigate.  On  May  7 
a  detailed  account  appeared  in  the  Bingham  - 
ton  Press,  after  a  reporter  spoke  with  a  reluc¬ 
tant  Wilcox.  Subsequently,  Walter  N.  Webb, 
an  astronomer  and  field  investigator  for  the 
National  Investigations  Committee  on  Aerial 
Phenomena,  spoke  with  Wilcox  and  others. 
“Neighbors,  friends,  and  authorities  unani¬ 
mously  agreed  that  Wilcox  had  a  good  reputa¬ 
tion  in  the  area,”  Webb  would  write.  Wilcox 
had  no  previous  history  of  interest  in  the  eso¬ 
teric  and  in  fact  was  not  much  of  a  reader. 

A  psychiatric  examination  conducted  by 
Berthold  Eric  Schwarz,  M.D.,  a  psychothera¬ 
pist,  concluded  that  Wilcox  suffered  no  men¬ 
tal  abnormalities.  Unlike  many  figures  in  the 
contactee  movement,  Wilcox  made  no  at¬ 
tempt  to  exploit  his  alleged  experience.  He 
discussed  it  only  when  asked,  and  with  no¬ 
table  hesitation.  He  made  no  further  claims  of 
encounters  with  extraterrestrials. 

See  Also:  Allingham’s  Martian;  Aurora  Martian; 
Brown’s  Martians;  Close  encounters  of  the  third 
kind;  Dentonss  Martians  and  Venusians;  Hop¬ 
kins’s  Martians;  Khauga;  Martian  bees;  Mince- 
Pie  Martians;  Monka;  Muller’s  Martians;  Shaw’s 
Martians 

Further  Reading 

Hotchkiss,  Olga  M.,  1964.  “New  York  UFO  and  Its 
‘Little  People’.”  Fate  17,  9  (September):  38-42. 

Ochs,  Reid  A.,  1964.  “Martian  ‘Visit’  Stirs  Tioga.” 
Binghamton  [New  York]  Press  (May  7). 

Schwarz,  Berthold  E.,  1983.  UFO-Dynamics:  Psychi  - 
atric  and  Psychic  Aspects  of  the  UFO  Syndrome. 
Two  volumes.  Moore  Haven,  FL:  Rainbow 
Books. 

Webb,  Walter  N.,  1965.  The  Newark  Valley-Conklin, 
New  York,  Incidents:  The  Binghamton  Area  Flap  of 
1964.  Cambridge,  MA:  self-published. 


Williamson,  George  Hunt  (1926-1986) 

George  Hunt  Williamson  was  a  leading  figure 
in  the  contactee  movement  of  the  1950s.  On 
that  fringe  he  even  had  a  reputation  as  a 
scholar  and  deep  thinker,  even  if  by  main¬ 


stream  standards  his  ideas  about  ancient  and 
modern  visitations  from  space  by  friendly  and 
hostile  extraterrestrials  seemed  the  product  of 
a  fertile,  even  crankish  imagination.  William¬ 
son  claimed  not  only  to  have  witnessed 
George  Adamski’s  meeting  with  a  Venusian  in 
the  California  desert  in  November  1952  but 
also  to  have  had  contacts  with  space  people 
himself.  A  colorful,  intelligent,  and  educated 
man,  Williamson  advanced  many  ideas  that 
still  circulate  in  popular  culture,  though  he 
himself  dropped  out  of  sight  in  the  1 960s  and 
died  in  obscurity  in  Long  Beach,  California, 
in  January  1986. 

Born  in  Chicago,  Williamson  pursued  ar¬ 
chaeological  and  anthropological  interests  in 
college.  Several  psychic  experiences  in  his 
youth  drew  him  to  the  occult  and  the  para¬ 
normal,  and  then  to  flying  saucers.  He  had 
close  contacts  with  the  Chippewa  and  the 
Hopi  and  lived  with  them  in  the  early  1950s. 
In  1952,  while  residing  in  Prescott,  Arizona, 
he  and  his  wife,  Betty,  met  Alfred  and  Betty 
Bailey.  The  two  couples  attempted  to  contact 
saucers  and  soon  began  receiving  messages, 
through  automatic  writing  and  the  ouija 
board,  from  visitors  from  Venus,  Mars, 
Jupiter,  Saturn,  and  Neptune.  Then  one  mes¬ 
sage,  from  Zo  of  Neptune,  informed  them 
that  they  would  be  receiving  Morse  code  sig¬ 
nals  on  the  radio.  They  were  instructed  to  ap¬ 
proach  one  of  Baileys  coworkers,  Lyman 
Streeter,  who  was  a  ham-radio  operator.  Soon 
Streeter,  his  wife,  and  the  two  other  couples 
were  hearing  from  extraterrestrials  with  color¬ 
ful  names:  Zo,  Affa,  Um,  and  Regga.  Further 
communications  took  place  through  radio 
and  mental  telepathy. 

Through  his  reading,  Williamson  heard  of 
George  Adamski,  a  Californian  who  was  pro¬ 
ducing  pictures  of  alleged  spacecraft.  The  two 
exchanged  letters,  and  Adamski  invited 
Williamson  to  visit  him  at  his  home  in  Palo- 
mar  Gardens.  In  the  presence  of  the 
Williamsons  and  the  Baileys,  Adamski  chan¬ 
neled  messages  from  space  people.  On  No¬ 
vember  20,  alerted  that  a  landing  would 
occur,  the  two  couples  met  with  Adamski  and 


Williamson,  George  Hunt  269 


George  Hunt  Williamson  (left),  who  received  regtdar  radio  messages  from  extraterrestrials  in  the  early  1950s  (Fortean 
Picture  Library) 


two  associates  along  the  California-Arizona 
border.  The  other  six  would  sign  affidavits  at¬ 
testing  to  their  observation  (albeit  from  some 
distance)  of  Adamski’s  meeting  with  a  space¬ 
man.  (Later  the  Baileys  would  withdraw  their 
testimony,  saying  they  had  seen  nothing  out 
of  the  ordinary.) 

Williamson  went  on  to  write  a  series  of 
books  both  about  his  contacts  and  about  his 
theories  about  the  role  space  people  have 
played  in  the  human  past  and  present.  Such 
books  as  Other  Tongues — Other  Flesh  (1953), 
Secret  Places  of  the  Lion  (1958),  and  Road  in  the 
Sky  (1959)  anticipated  themes  that  Erich  von 
Daniken  and  others  would  popularize  in  the 
1970s  during  the  “ancient  astronauts”  craze. 
Williamson  split  with  Adamski  after  the  latter 
urged  him  not  to  publicize  his  psychic  con¬ 
tacts,  since  Adamski  decried  such  methods  of 
communications  to  his  followers,  even  while 
privately  practicing  them.  But  Williamson 


delved  ever  deeper  into  the  occult  and  pursued 
his  own  attempts  at  space  communication  by 
various  means.  In  1955,  he  and  Richard  Miller 
formed  the  Telonic  Research  Center  to  estab¬ 
lish  radio  and  other  contacts  with  extraterres¬ 
trials,  though  within  months  he  and  Miller 
parted  amid  much  mutual  recrimination. 

The  following  year  he  joined  up  with  the 
Brotherhood  of  the  Seven  Rays,  a  band  of  psy¬ 
chics  and  contactees  (including  Dorothy  Mar¬ 
tin,  better  known  as  Sister  Thedra),  and  spent 
a  year  at  its  colony  in  a  remote  area  of  Peru, 
convinced  that  cataclysmic  Earth  changes 
were  soon  to  occur.  When  they  did  not, 
Williamson  and  everyone  except  Martin  re¬ 
turned  to  the  United  States.  There  William¬ 
son  resumed  writing  books,  one  of  them  a 
thinly  disguised  anti-Semitic  work  titled 
UFOs  Confidential!  (1958).  In  1958,  he  went 
on  a  world  tour  and,  in  1961,  he  lectured  in 
Japan,  where  he  was  treated  as  something  of  a 


270  Wilson 


celebrity.  His  last  book,  which  he  wrote  under 
the  pseudonym  “Brother  Philip,”  was  pub¬ 
lished  the  same  year.  Soon,  however,  William¬ 
son — now  calling  himself  Michel  d’Obren- 
ovic — retired  from  a  public  career  and  was  so 
little  heard  from  that  many  thought  him 
dead. 

During  his  heyday,  critics  accused  William¬ 
son  of  a  range  of  shortcomings  and  base  moti¬ 
vations,  among  them  bigotry,  paranoia,  and 
charlatanism.  His  shrillest  attackers,  associ¬ 
ated  with  James  W.  Moseley’s  Saucer  News, 
debunked  Williamson’s  assertions  about  his 
academic  background  (far  from  being  a 
Ph.D.,  as  he  said  he  was,  he  did  not  have  even 
an  undergraduate  degree),  and  one  reviewer 
noted  similarities  between  the  supposedly 
nonfictional  Road  in  the  Sky  and  a  science-fic¬ 
tion  series  by  Isaac  Asimov.  After  his  death, 
however,  scientist  and  UFO  historian  Michael 
D.  Swords  acquired  the  bulk  of  Williamson’s 
collection,  which  includes  a  massive  amount 
of  private  correspondence  and  other  material. 
Based  on  his  reading  of  it,  Swords  concludes 
that  for  all  his  exaggeration  and  credential- 
inflation,  Williams  was  essentially  honest.  In 
his  estimation  Williamson  “actually  believed 
all  the  stuff — the  wild,  amazing,  impossible- 
to-believe  stuff — that  he  wrote  about.  .  .  . 
Williamson  is  not  easy  to  explain  and  cannot 
be  deposited  into  some  conveniently  labeled 
box”  (Swords,  1993). 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Affa;  Contactees;  Sister 
Thedra 

Further  Reading 

Brother  Philip  [pseud,  of  George  Hunt  Williamson], 
1961.  Secret  of  the  Andes.  Clarksburg,  WV: 
Saucerian  Books. 

Griffin,  John,  1989.  Visitants.  Santa  Barbara,  CA: 
self-published. 

Ibn  Aharon,  Y.  N.  [pseud,  of  Yonah  Fortner],  1960. 
Review  of  Road  in  the  Sky.  Saucer  Nexus  7,  2 
(June):  6. 

Leslie,  Desmond,  and  George  Adamski,  1953.  Flying 
Saucers  Have  Landed.  New  York:  British  Book 
Centre. 

Moseley,  James  W.,  and  Michael  G.  Mann,  1959. 
“Screwing  the  Lid  down  on  ‘Doctor’ 
Williamson.”  Saucer  News  6,  2  (February/ 
March):  3-5. 


Swords,  Michael  D.,  1993.  “UFOs  and  the  Amish.” 
International  UFO  Reporter  18,  5  (September/ 
October):  12-13. 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  1953.  Other  Tongues — 
Other  Flesh.  Amherst,  WI:  Amherst  Press. 

- ,  1958.  Secret  Places  of  the  Lion.  Amherst, 

WI:  Amherst  Press. 

- ,  1959.  Road  in  the  Sky.  London:  Neville 

Spearman. 

Williamson,  George  Hunt,  and  Alfred  C.  Bailey, 
1954.  The  Saucers  Speak! A  Documentary  Report  of 
Interstellar  Communication  by  Radiotelegraphy. 
Los  Angeles:  New  Age  Publishing  Company. 
Williamson,  George  Hunt,  and  John  McCoy,  1958. 
UFOs  Confidential!  The  Meaning  behind  the 
Most  Closely  Guarded  Secret  of  All  Time.  Corpus 
Christi,  TX:  Essene  Press. 


Wilson 

During  the  spring  of  1897,  American  news¬ 
papers  reported  frequently  outlandish  ac¬ 
counts  of  mysterious  “airships,”  dirigible-  or 
cigar-shaped  structures  whose  origins  were 
(and  still  are)  shrouded  in  mystery.  Some 
people  speculated  that  they  housed  Martian 
visitors,  and  indeed  some  spectacular  hoaxes 
played  to  that  belief.  The  more  common  the¬ 
ory,  however,  held  that  an  enterprising  Amer¬ 
ican  had  invented  advanced  aircraft  and  was 
flying  it  around  the  country  with  a  crew  of 
aeronauts.  Stories  carried  in  the  press  re¬ 
ported  meetings  with  the  enigmatic  inventor, 
though  most  were  contradictory  and  dubi¬ 
ous.  Historians  of  aviation  have  ignored  this 
episode,  and  today  only  ufologists  have  exam¬ 
ined  it  carefully,  holding  that  the  airship  scare 
was  an  early  UFO  wave.  Among  the  more  cu¬ 
rious  accounts  to  be  published  in  the  press  of 
the  period  were  a  series  of  ostensibly  related 
incidents,  all  but  one  of  which  occurred  in 
Texas,  involving  an  aeronaut  identified  as 
“Wilson.” 

Someone  who  may  have  been  Wilson  ap¬ 
pears  first  in  an  alleged  encounter  near 
Greenville,  Texas,  late  on  the  evening  of  April 
16,  according  to  a  letter  C.  G.  Williams  pub¬ 
lished  in  the  Dallas  Morning  News  on  the 
nineteenth.  Williams  reportedly  saw  an  “im¬ 
mense  cigar-shaped  vessel”  as  he  was  taking  a 


Wilson  271 


walk.  Three  crew  members  stepped  outside, 
two  to  work  on  the  structure,  the  third  to  chat 
with  the  witness.  The  stranger  told  Williams 
that  he  had  built  the  ship  after  many  years  of 
experiment  and  error  “at  a  little  town  in  the 
interior  of  New  York.” 

The  May  16  issue  of  the  same  newspaper 
carried  a  letter  forwarded  by  Dr.  D.  H. 
Tucker.  Tucker  said  that  a  young  man  who 
subsequently  drowned  in  a  flood  in  Missis¬ 
sippi  had  written  the  original,  recounting  an 
experience  that  occurred  on  April  19  in  the 
Lake  Charles,  Louisiana,  area.  While  riding  in 
his  buggy,  he  spotted  an  airship  approaching. 
A  high-pitched  whistle  from  the  vessel 
spooked  his  horses,  and  he  was  thrown  to  the 
ground.  When  the  ship  landed,  two  men 
rushed  from  it  to  help  him  to  his  feet  and  to 
extend  their  apologies.  One  introduced  him¬ 
self  as  “Mr.  Wilson,”  though  the  witness 
doubted  that  was  his  real  name.  Wilson  stated 
that  he  and  his  companion,  Scott  Warren,  had 
invented  a  fleet  of  ships.  They  were  now  seek¬ 
ing  to  demonstrate  that  long-distance  airship 
travel  was  safe  and  economical.  The  young 
man  was  invited  to  tour  the  vehicle,  where  he 
met  two  other  crew  members. 

That  same  day,  at  around  1 1  P.M.,  at  Beau¬ 
mont,  Texas,  according  to  an  account  pub¬ 
lished  in  the  Houston  Daily  Post  of  April  2 1 , 
lights  in  a  neighbor’s  pasture  caught  the  eyes 
of  J.  R.  Ligon  and  his  son  Charley.  They  ob  - 
served  “four  men  moving  around  a  large  dark 
object”  that  they  recognized,  as  they  ap¬ 
proached  it,  as  an  airship.  Its  crew  asked  for 
water  and  accompanied  the  two  to  the  house, 
where  they  filled  their  buckets.  “I  accosted 
one  of  the  men,”  the  elder  Ligon  reported, 
“and  he  told  me  his  name  was  Wilson.  .  .  . 
They  were  returning  from  a  trip  out  on  the 
Gulf  and  were  now  headed  toward  Iowa, 
where  the  airship  was  built.”  It  was  one  of  five 
that  had  been  constructed  there.  The  Ligons 
accompanied  them  back  to  the  ship,  a  huge 
structure  136  feet  long  and  20  feet  wide,  with 
four  large  wings  and  propellers  attached  to 
bow  and  stern.  Wilson  explained  it  was  pow¬ 
ered  by  “electricity.” 


On  April  25  the  New  Orleans  Daily  Pica  - 
yune  carried  an  interview  with  a  visitor,  Rabbi 
A.  Levy  of  Beaumont.  Levi  recalled  that  “about 
10  days  ago,”  on  hearing  that  an  airship  had 
landed  late  that  night  on  a  farm  just  outside 
town,  he  hastened  to  the  site.  There  sat  an  air¬ 
ship  some  150  feet  long  with  100-foot  wings. 
“I  spoke  to  one  of  the  men  when  he  went  into 
the  farmer’s  house,  and  shook  hands  with 
him,”  Levy  claimed.  “Yes,  I  did  hear  him  say 
where  it  was  built,  but  I  can’t  remember  the 
name  of  the  place,  or  the  name  of  the  inventor. 
He  said  that  they  had  been  traveling  a  great 
deal,  and  were  testing  the  machine.  I  was  do 
dumbfounded  that  I  could  not  frame  an  intel¬ 
ligent  question  to  ask.”  He  did  remember, 
though,  that  “electricity”  powered  the  craft. 

At  Uvalde,  three  hundred  miles  southwest 
of  Beaumont,  twenty-three  hours  after  the 
Ligons’s  alleged  encounter,  Sheriff  H.  W.  Bay¬ 
lor  witnessed  an  airship  landing  near  his  home. 
Baylor  saw  three  crew  members  and  spoke 
with  one,  a  Mr.  Wilson,  a  native  of  Goshen, 
New  York.  The  aeronaut  recalled  an  old  friend, 
Captain  C.  C.  Akers,  whom  he  said  he  had 
known  in  Fort  Worth.  Now,  he  understood, 
Akers  lived  in  the  area.  Baylor  replied  that  he 
knew  Akers,  who  was  employed  as  a  customs 
officer  in  Eagle  Pass  but  who  frequently  visited 
Uvalde.  After  asking  the  sheriff  to  give  his  best 
to  Akers,  Wilson  and  his  crew  flew  away.  The 
Houston  Daily  Post,  which  reported  the  story 
in  its  April  21  issue,  mentioned  the  sighting, 
the  same  night  as  Baylor’s  alleged  encounter 
with  Wilson,  of  an  airship  passing  just  north 
of  the  Baylor  residence.  Contacted  by  the  Gal  - 
veston  Daily  News  (April  28),  Akers  confirmed 
that  twenty  years  earlier  he  had  known  “a  man 
by  the  name  of  Wilson  from  New  York 
state.  .  .  .  He  was  of  a  mechanical  turn  of  mind 
and  was  then  working  on  aerial  navigation  and 
something  that  would  astonish  the  world.” 

At  midnight  on  April  22,  east  of  Josserand 
(seventy- five  miles  northwest  of  Beaumont),  a 
“whirring  noise”  awoke  farmer  Frank  Nichols, 
according  to  the  Houston  Daily  Post  (April 
26).  On  investigating,  he  spotted  a  large,  bril¬ 
liantly  lighted  airship  in  his  cornfield.  Two 


272  Wilson 


crew  members  asked  if  they  could  draw  water 
from  his  well.  Afterward,  they  invited  him 
into  the  craft,  which  had  a  six-  or  eight-man 
crew.  One  told  him  that  “highly  condensed 
electricity”  powered  it.  It  was  one  of  five  built 
in  a  small  Iowa  town. 

The  following  evening  an  airship  landed  at 
Kountze,  twenty  miles  northwest  of  Beau¬ 
mont.  Onlookers  talked  with  its  pilots,  Wilson 
and  Jackson,  who  said  it  would  take  a  few  days 
to  complete  necessary  repairs.  The  Houston 
Daily  Post  (April  25)  assured  readers  that  any¬ 
one  who  wanted  to  see  the  marvelous  machine 
“may  do  so  by  coming  to  Kountze  any  time 
before  Monday  night.”  This  is  the  one  Wilson 
story  that  was  an  obvious  practical  joke. 

On  April  30,  the  Daily  Post  carried  a  letter 
from  H.  C.  Legrone  of  Deadwood,  130  miles 
north  of  Beaumont.  Legrone  wrote  that  after 
something  disturbed  his  horses  on  the  evening 
of  April  28,  he  stepped  outside  to  observe  an 
approaching  airship.  It  descended  on  a  nearby 
field.  He  related, 

Its  crew  was  composed  of  five  men,  three  of 
whom  entertained  me,  while  the  other  two 
took  rubber  bags  and  went  for  a  supply  of 
water  at  my  well,  100  yards  off.  They  informed 
me  that  this  was  one  of  five  ships  that  had  been 
traveling  the  country  over  recently,  and  that 
this  individual  ship  was  the  same  one  recently 
landed  near  Beaumont .  .  .  after  having  trav¬ 
eled  pretty  well  all  over  the  Northwest.  They 
stated  that  these  ships  were  put  up  in  an  inte¬ 
rior  town  in  Illinois.  They  were  rather  reticent 
about  giving  out  information  in  regards  to  the 
ship,  manufacture,  etc.,  since  they  had  not  yet 
secured  everything  by  patent. 


Whatever  the  airships  may  or  may  not 
have  been,  they  were  nobody’s  inventions, 
and  the  name  of  the  mysterious  Mr.  Wilson  is 
not  to  be  found  in  any  history  of  aviation. 
Put  bluntly,  the  stories  make  no  sense.  They 
could  not  have  happened  in  any  way  in 
which  the  verb  “happened”  is  ordinarily  un¬ 
derstood.  In  light  of  the  numerous  hoaxes, 
journalistic  and  other,  the  Wilson  stories, 
however  intriguing,  must  be  viewed  with  a 
fair  degree  of  suspicion.  Nonetheless,  occult- 
oriented  writers  such  as  John  A.  Keel  argue 
that  the  seemingly  normal  American  pilots 
reported  in  1897  press  accounts  were  actually 
supernatural  entities — Keel  calls  them  ultra¬ 
terrestrials — in  disguise.  According  to  Keel, 
the  ultraterrestrials  staged  encounters  “in  rel¬ 
atively  remote  places,”  contacting  a  few  wit¬ 
nesses  and  passing  on  bogus  tales  “which 
would  discredit  not  only  them  but  the  whole 
mystery.  Knowing  how  we  think  and  how  we 
search  for  consistencies,  the  ultraterrestrials 
were  careful  to  sow  inconsistencies  in  their 
wake”  (Keel,  1970). 

See  Also:  Keel,  John  Alva;  Smith;  Ultraterrestrials 

Further  Reading 

Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  ed.,  1982.  The  Airship  File:  A 
Collection  of  Texts  Concerning  Phantom  Airships 
and  Other  UFOs,  Gathered  from  Newspapers  and 
Periodicals  Mostly  during  the  Htmdred  Years  Prior 
to  Kenneth  Arnold’s  Sighting.  Bloomington,  IN: 
self-published. 

Chariton,  Wallace  O.,  1991.  The  Great  Texas  Airship 
Mystery.  Plano,  TX:  Wordware  Publishing. 

Cohen,  Daniel,  1981.  The  Great  Airship  Mystery:  A 
UFO  of  the  1890s.  New  York:  Dodd,  Mead,  and 
Company. 

Keel,  John  A.,  1970.  UFOs:  Operation  Trojan  Horse. 
New  York:  G.  P.  Putnam’s  Sons. 


Xeno 

In  the  early  morning  hours  of  January  30, 
1965,  while  walking  along  a  beach  near  Wat¬ 
sonville,  California,  Sid  Padrick  saw  a  flying 
saucer  descend  and  hover  a  foot  or  two  above 
the  sand.  A  voice  speaking  from  the  craft  as¬ 
sured  him  that  he  was  not  in  danger.  When  a 
door  opened,  Padrick  entered  and  soon  met  a 
human-looking  figure  in  a  two-piece  uniform. 
The  figure,  speaking  in  unaccented  English, 
introduced  himself  as  Xeno.  He  took  Padrick 
on  a  tour  of  the  craft,  during  which  he  saw 
eight  other  crew  members,  one  a  “very  pretty” 
young  woman.  They  paid  little  attention  to 
Padrick,  and  all  his  communication  was  with 
Xeno. 

Xeno  and  his  companions  were  light¬ 
skinned  and  resembled  human  beings  except 
for  unusually  sharp  chins  and  noses.  Xeno  ex¬ 
plained  that  the  ship  and  its  crew  came  from  a 
planet  behind  a  planet  visible  from  Earth. 
Their  own  planet,  however,  was  always  hid¬ 
den  from  earthly  view.  They  lived  in  a  com¬ 
munal  society  without  war,  disease,  or  crime. 
They  also  had  a  religion  that  worshipped  the 
Supreme  Deity.  During  the  tour  Padrick  was 
shown  a  “consultation  room”  used  for  worship 
and  invited  to  go  inside.  After  he  prayed 
there,  Padrick  experienced  a  kind  of  religious 
awakening. 


During  their  interaction,  he  noticed  that 
whenever  he  would  ask  Xeno  a  question, 
Xeno  would  hesitate  for  as  long  as  half  a 
minute  before  answering.  Patrick  speculated 
that  he  was  getting  telepathic  instructions  on 
how  to  reply.  He  was  shown  a  photograph  of  a 
city  on  Xeno’s  planet.  Through  a  telescopelike 
device  he  observed  a  cigar-shaped  mother  ship 
which  had  brought  the  smaller  craft  through 
space. 

Padrick  was  told  that  Xeno’s  people  were 
here  only  to  explore.  They  had  no  desire  for 
contact  because  of  earthlings’  hostility  and 
generally  primitive  attitudes.  After  about  two 
hours,  Padrick  left  the  craft  with  a  promise 
that  he  would  meet  the  space  people  again 
soon. 

On  February  4,  Padrick  informed  Hamil¬ 
ton  Air  Force  Base  of  his  experience.  A  U.S. 
Air  Force  officer,  Major  D.  B.  Reeder,  inter¬ 
viewed  him  four  days  later,  and  the  two  went 
to  the  encounter  site.  Though  the  officer  in¬ 
terviewed  several  locals  who  said  Padrick  was 
trustworthy,  the  officer  did  not  believe  his  tes¬ 
timony  and  urged  Project  Blue  Book,  the  U.S. 
Air  Force’s  UFO -investigative  group,  to  take 
no  further  action. 

Nonetheless,  after  seeing  the  story  in  a  San 
Francisco  newspaper,  L.  D.  Cody,  the  civilian 
director  of  aerospace  education  at  Hamilton, 


273 


274  Xeno 


requested  a  full  briefing  from  Reeder.  Later 
that  month,  Cody  personally  interviewed 
Padrick  and  his  family.  In  his  estimation 
Padrick  “seemed  sincere.”  He  thought  Padrick 
had  either  had  the  experience  or  dreamed  it 
(Cody,  1967). 

After  accounts  of  Padrick’s  alleged  experi¬ 
ence  were  published  in  the  press,  he  was  be¬ 
sieged  by  letters  and  calls  from  UFO  buffs. 
One  pointed  out  that  “Xeno” — heretofore 
Padrick  had  spelled  the  name  phonetically  as 
“Zeno” — is  Greek  for  “stranger.” 

Following  the  initial  publicity,  Padrick  did 
a  few  lectures  and  spoke  at  several  contactee 
conferences,  sticking  to  his  basic  story  with¬ 
out  elaboration,  but  then  dropped  out  of 
sight.  In  1970,  local  newspapers  reported  that 
a  friend  was  suing  Padrick,  who  had  borrowed 
one  thousand  dollars  to  write  a  book  detailing 
his  experience  but  had  not  repaid  it  or  even 


been  able  to  produce  evidence  that  a  manu¬ 
script  existed.  Padrick  insisted  that  a  third 
person  had  borrowed  the  manuscript  and 
never  returned  it.  The  San  Jose  Municipal 
Court  decreed  that  Padrick  had  to  make  good 
on  the  loan. 

From  some  accounts  Padrick  had  further 
alien  contacts  after  the  January  1965  inci¬ 
dent,  but  he  has  never  spoken  about  them  in 
public. 

See  Also:  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Cody,  L.  D.,  1967.  Letter  to  James  E.  McDonald 
(August  25). 

“Contactee  Loses  Court  Case,”  1971.  UFO  Investi  - 
gator  (April):  1. 

“The  Padrick  ‘Space  Contact,’”  1965.  Little  Listening 
Post  12,  3  (August/September/October):  2-5. 

“Watsonville’s  Weird  Story — A  Ride  on  a  Space¬ 
ship,”  1965.  San  Francisco  News  Call  Btdletin 
(February  12). 


Yada  di  Shi’ite 

Yada  di  Shi’ite  lived  five-hundred  thousand 
years  ago,  a  member  of  the  ancient  civilization 
of  Yu,  located  in  the  Himalayas,  or  so  he  told 
San  Diego  medium  Mark  Probert,  through 
whom  he  channeled  from  the  1940s  until 
Probert’s  death  in  1969.  Yada  di  Shi’ite  was 
one  of  several  entities  who  composed  the 
Inner  Circle. 

Probert,  a  man  with  little  formal  educa¬ 
tion,  entered  the  metaphysical  realm  when  he 
started  talking  in  his  sleep.  His  wife,  Irene, 
took  note  of  what  he  was  saying.  Soon  the 
episode  became  known  to  a  local  man,  veteran 
occultist  N.  Meade  Layne.  Layne  took  over 
Probert’s  spiritual  education,  and  soon  Yada  di 
Shi’ite  and  others  were  speaking  through  the 
medium.  The  others  included  Ramon  Natalli, 
in  life  a  lawyer  and  a  friend  of  Galileo;  Profes¬ 
sor  Alfred  Luntz,  a  nineteenth-century  Angli¬ 
can  clergyman;  and  Charles  Lingford,  in  life  a 
dancer  and  artist. 

Through  Probert’s  Inner  Circle  Kethra 
E’Da  Foundation  and  Layne’s  better-known 
Borderland  Sciences  Research  Associates,  the 
channelings  of  Yada  di  Shi’ite  and  associ¬ 
ates — eventually  their  number  expanded  to 
eleven — found  an  international  audience.  In 
the  early  age  of  flying  saucers,  the  late  1940s 
and  early  1950s,  the  Circle’s  pronouncements 


on  the  subject  were  particularly  influential, 
and  they  founded  the  basis  of  Layne’s  The 
Ether  Ship  and  Its  Solution  (1950),  which  was 
widely  read  in  fringe  circles  and  is  still  an  in¬ 
fluence  on  latter-day  occult  saucer  theorists 
such  as  John  A.  Keel. 

See  Also:  Channeling;  Keel,  John  Alva 

Further  Reading 

Barker,  Gray,  1956.  They  Knew  Too  Much  about  Fly  - 
ing  Saucers.  New  York:  University  Books. 

Layne,  N.  Meade,  The  Ether  Ship  and  Its  Solution. 
Vista,  CA:  Borderland  Sciences  Research  Asso¬ 
ciates. 

Yamski 

On  April  24,  1965,  just  a  day  after  the  death 
of  George  Adamski,  a  flying  saucer  allegedly 
landed  near  the  Devonshire  village  of  Scori- 
ton.  Three  humanlike  beings  clad  in  space- 
suits  emerged.  One,  who  looked  like  a  youth 
of  thirteen  or  fourteen,  identified  himself  as 
“Yamski”  to  the  sole  witness,  a  groundskeeper 
and  handyman  named  Ernest  Arthur  Bryant. 
Yamski,  who  spoke  in  Eastern  European- 
inflected  English,  expressed  the  wish  that 
“Des”  or  “Les”  could  be  there.  Bryant  was 
given  a  brief  tour  of  the  craft  and  a  promise  of 
further  contacts. 

Some  of  Adamski’s  partisans  had  been  ex¬ 
pecting  him  to  reincarnate  and  return  to 


275 


27 6  Y’hova 


Earth.  In  fact,  his  associate  and  onetime  co¬ 
author  Desmond  Leslie  openly  predicted  it  in 
an  obituary  he  wrote  for  England’s  Flying 
Saucer  Review.  Bryant,  who  claimed  never  to 
have  heard  of  this  famous  contactee,  produced 
a  sketch  of  Yamski,  who  bore  some  resem¬ 
blance  to  a  youthful  Adamski.  Subsequently, 
Bryant  brought  forth  physical  evidence  that 
he  said  the  space  people  had  given  him. 

In  1967,  Eileen  Buckle,  who  had  investi¬ 
gated  the  case,  wrote  about  it  in  a  thick  book 
that  essentially  endorsed  the  case,  notwith¬ 
standing  growing  evidence  that  Bryant  had  a 
hard  time  telling  the  truth  even  about  the 
most  mundane  aspects  of  his  life.  Bryant  died 
just  after  Buckle’s  book  was  published.  British 
ufologist  Norman  Oliver,  who  interviewed 
Bryant’s  wife  around  that  time,  was  told  that 
Bryant’s  story  was  bogus.  He  had  based  it  on 
his  considerable  reading  of  UFO  and  occult 
literature  and  his  extensive  knowledge  of 
Adamski’s  claims.  Oliver  exposed  the  many 
dubious  elements  of  the  case  in  a  self-pub¬ 
lished  monograph. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Buckle,  Eileen,  1967.  The  Scoriton  Mystery.  London: 
Neville  Spearman. 

Leslie,  Desmond,  1965.  “Obituary:  George  Adam¬ 
ski.”  Flying  Saucer  Review  11,  4  (July/ August) : 
18-19. 

Oliver,  Norman,  1968.  Sequel  to  Scoriton.  London: 
self-published. 


Y’hova 

According  to  the  “extraterrestrialism”  theories 
of  Yonah  Fortner  (who  wrote  under  the  pseu¬ 
donym  Y.  N.  ibn  Aharon),  visitors  from  other 


worlds  landed  on  Earth  and  interacted  with 
its  most  advanced  ancient  civilizations,  no¬ 
tably  those  of  the  Chaldeans  and  the  At- 
lanteans.  The  Chaldeans,  who  possessed  an 
advanced  technology,  were  especially  close  to 
aliens,  even  intermarrying  with  one  group,  the 
Elohim.  Another  group  was  the  Titans,  who 
helped  the  Chaldeans  vanquish  the  malevo¬ 
lent  alien  race  known  as  the  Serpent  People. 
Eventually,  warfare  among  alien  races  broke 
out  on  the  Earth’s  surface.  In  the  midst  of  this 
conflict,  one  alien  showed  up  around  1340 
B.C.  Shaday  Elili  Athunu,  otherwise  known 
as  Y’hova,  befriended  a  local  malcontent 
named  Abraham,  whom  he  promised  to  pro¬ 
tect  if  he,  his  family,  and  his  people  followed 
him.  Y’hova  is  known  to  humans  as  God. 

Fortner  stated  that  the  “God  of  Israel 
should  not  be  confused  with  the  general  run 
of  space  visitors  because  he  was  either  unique 
or  very  nearly  unique  in  his  decision  to  make 
a  career  among  the  people  of  earth.  .  .  .  [He] 
is  a  very  august  and  ancient  being .  .  .  who 
comes  from  a  higher  order  of  being,  a  dimen¬ 
sion  beyond  all  known  dimensions”  (Stein¬ 
berg,  1977). 

Fortner  outlined  his  theories  in  a  series  of 
articles  published  in  Saucer  News  between 
1957  and  I960.  His  sources,  he  insisted,  were 
rare  and  arcane  Middle  Eastern  documents, 
but  when  challenged,  he  was  unable  to  prove 
that  they  existed. 

Further  Reading 

Ibn  Aharon,  Y.  N.  [pseud,  of  Yonah  Fortner],  1960. 
“A  Note  on  the  Evolution  of  Extraterrestrialism.” 
Saucer  News  7,  4  (December):  6-9. 

Steinberg,  Gene,  1977.  “Dr.  Yonah  Aharon — Origi¬ 
nator  of  the  Ancient  Astronaut  Theory.”  UFO 
Report 4,  2  (June):  26-27,  74-78. 


Zagga 

Zagga  hails  from  the  planet  Zakton  at  the  far 
side  of  the  Milky  Way  galaxy.  Zakton  is  some 
seventy-five  thousand  light  years  beyond 
Gemini.  One  of  the  twelve  members  of  the 
Galactic  Council,  he  was  sent  to  Saturn.  From 
there  he  transited  to  Earth,  entering  the  body 
of  a  boy  at  the  instant  of  birth.  Zagga  claims 
that  on  his  home  planet  children  are  con¬ 
ceived  not  by  sexual  intercourse  but  by  pure 
thought.  People  do  not  have  names.  He  was 
given  the  appellation  “Zagga”  only  after  he 
volunteered  for  the  Earth  mission.  In  letters 
to  saucerian  writer  John  W.  Dean,  Zagga  at¬ 
tested  to  the  authenticity  of  George  Adamski’s 
claim  to  have  attended  an  interplanetary  con¬ 
ference  on  Saturn  in  March  1962. 

According  to  Dean,  Zagga  was  “a  fine  look¬ 
ing  young  man  of  about  twenty-five  years  of 
age”  in  1961  when  Dean  met  him  at  Buck 
Nelson’s  contactee  convention  in  Missouri. 
Zagga  told  Dean,  “I  had  known  the  one  you 
call  Jesus  before  and  after  his  incarnation  on 
earth.  I  know  Him  as  a  great  friend”  (Dean, 
1964).  Dean  said  he  knew  Zagga’s  earthly 
name  and  address  but  was  not  to  reveal  them. 

See  Also:  Adamski,  George;  Contactees 

Further  Reading 

Dean,  John  W.,  1964.  Flying  Saucers  and  the  Scrip  - 
tures.  New  York:  Vantage  Press. 


Zandark 

In  the  fall  of  1973,  an  anonymous  woman  re¬ 
ceived  psychic  communications  from  Zan¬ 
dark,  a  “member  of  the  United  Cosmic  Coun¬ 
cil;  a  Commander  in  Chief  in  Charge  of 
Directing  Technical  Transmissions  Via  Mental 
Telepathy  of  the  Combination  of  Medium- 
istic  Telepathy  under  the  Direction  of  the 
Confederation  of  Cosmic  Space  Beings” 
(Keel,  1975).  Zandark’s  people  are  here  to 
bring  peace,  and  they  have  been  here  a  long 
time.  They  built  the  Sphinx,  the  pyramids, 
and  other  classic  ancient  structures. 

Further  Reading 

Keel,  John  A.,  1975.  The  Mothman  Prophecies.  New 
York:  Saturday  Review  Press/E.  P.  Dutton  and 
Company. 

Zolton 

In  a  registered  letter  sent  to  U.S.  Air  Force  In¬ 
telligence  on  November  20,  1953,  an  uniden¬ 
tified  woman  mailed  a  recently  channeled 
message  from  an  Ashtar  associate  named 
Zolton,  “Commander  from  the  center  of  the 
Sector  System  of  Vela.”  Zolton  sought  to  alert 
the  authorities  in  Washington  to  the  space 
people’s  purpose. 

He  warned  the  Pentagon  that  visiting  ex¬ 
traterrestrials  knew  of  “destructive  plans  for- 


277 


278  Zolton 


mulated  for  offensive  and  defensive  war”  and 
were  prepared  to  stop  them  by  crippling 
earthly  weapons  technology  without  hurting 
any  person  or  thing.  The  visitors  would  not 
hesitate,  however,  to  “control  minds  ...  in 


order  to  secure  this  solar  system.  This  is  a 
friendly  warning”  (Wilkins,  1955). 

See  Also:  Ashtar 
Further  Reading 

Wilkins,  Harold  T.,  1955.  Flying  Saucers  Uncensored. 
New  York:  Citadel  Press. 


Index 


“A,”  1 

Abducted!  (Lorenzen  and 
Lorenzen),  2 
Abduction  (Mack),  5 
Abductions,  xii,  xiii,  1—6, 
184-185 

from  automobiles,  35-36 
Buff  Ledge,  52-53 
calf-rustling  aliens,  55-57 
of  cars,  20 
of  celebrities,  124 
of  children,  26,  53,  139, 
212-213 

dual  reference  experience, 
88-90,  192,  221, 

258-259 

early  contactee  movement, 

72 

extraterrestrials  among  us, 

96-97 

Hill,  Betty  and  Barney,  2, 

3(fig.):  66 

humans  on  UFOs,  207 
hybrid  entities,  126-127 
imaginal  beings,  129 
increasing  reports  of,  66-67 
by  insectoids,  130 
Malaysian  Bunians,  53-54 
medical  examinations  during, 
169 

men  in  black,  171 
missing  time,  1 5 


physical  evidence  of,  17-18 
pregnancies,  126 
by  reptoids,  212-213 
time  travelers,  244-245 
unaware  abductees,  1 8 
Walton’s  five-day 

disappearance,  261-266 
witnesses  to,  204-205 
Aboard  a  Flying  Saucer 
(Bethurum),  43 
Abraham,  7 
Abram,  7 

“Active  imagination,”  7 
Adama,  7,  58 

Adamski,  George,  8-10,  9(fig.)> 
71  (fig.).  150,229 
Allingham’s  Martian,  19 
contacted  extraterrestrials, 
165-166 

early  contactee  movement,  70 
EBEs,  94 

as  extraterrestrial,  1 1 
extraterrestrials  among  us, 
95-96 

Space  Brothers,  187 
traveling  with  Ramu, 
210-211 

Venusian  contact,  195-196 
Villanueva’s  visitors,  258 
Wilcox’s  Martians,  268-269 
Yamski  as  reincarnation  of, 
275-276 


Aenstrians,  10-11 
Aerial  Phenomena  Research 
Organization  (APRO), 

82,  263 

Aetherius,  11-12 
Aetherius  Society,  12 
Aetherius  Speaks  to  Earth  (King), 
12 

Affa,  12-13 
Agents,  13 

Agharta:  The  Subterranean  World 
(Dickhoff),  14—15,  209 
Agharti,  13-15 
Ahab,  15 

Aho,  Wayne  S.,  76 
Akon,  15 

Alamogordo,  New  Mexico,  105 
Alana,  36 

Alans  Message:  To  Men  of  Earth 
(Fry),  105 

Alien  diners,  16-17 
Alien  DNA,  17-18,  25 
Aliens  and  the  dead,  18 
Alla-An,  Jyoti,  170 
Allan,  Christopher,  19 
Allingham,  Cedric,  19 
Allingham’s  Martian,  19 
Alpert,  Richard.  See  Baba  Ram 
Dass 

Alpha  Zoo  Loo,  19—20 
Altisi,  Jackie,  61 
Alyn,  20-21 


279 


280  Index 


Ameboids,  21 
Amnesia  associated  with 
abductions,  1 ,  4 
Amun,  Scott,  211—212 
“Anchor”  (pseud.).  See  Grevler, 
Ann 

Ancient  Three,  208 
Anderson,  Dean,  239 
Anderson,  Harry,  102 
Anderson,  Rodger  I.,  60-61 
Andolo,  21 

Andra-o-leeka  and  Mondra-o- 
leeka,  21-22 
Angel  of  the  Dark,  22 
Angels,  22,  40,  107,  217,  221, 
242 

Angelucci,  Orfeo,  22-23, 

22(fig.) 

Animals 

bird  aliens,  44 
cetaceans,  58 
channeling  of,  36-37 
dolphins,  238 
Kappa,  139-140,  140(fig.) 
mutilation  of,  55-57,  173, 
227 

mystical  animals,  146 
octopus  aliens,  191 
reptoids,  56,  144-145, 
212-214,  213(fig.),  259 
Sasquatch,  217-219 
talking  mongoose,  107—1 1 1 
Venusian  puppies,  1 54 
See  also  Insectoids;  Reptoids 
Anka,  Darryl,  39—40,  211 
Anoah,  23—24 
Antarctica,  207-208 
Anthon,  24 

Anti-Semitism,  117—118,  123, 
153,210,  269 
Antron,  24 
Anunnaki,  24—25 
Apol,  Mr.,  25 
Appelle,  Stuart,  6 
Applewhite,  Marshall  Herff, 
246-248 

APRO.  See  Aerial  Phenomena 
Research  Organization 
Argentina,  82,  83 
Arising  Sun’s  Interplanetary 
Class  of  Thee  Elohim, 
242 


Arizona,  36,  134,  199,  200,  227 
Arna  and  Parz,  26 
Arnold,  Kenneth,  70,  82,  94 
Artemis,  26-27 
Arthea,  36 

Ascended  Masters,  27,  59-61, 

201 

Ascensions,  28 

Ashtar,  27-29,  30,  70,  94,  145, 
178,  201,  255,  277-278 
Asmitor,  29-30 
Association  of  Love  and  Light, 
211 

Athena,  30,  201 
Atlantis,  xvi,  31-34,  31  (fig.), 
182-183 

channeling  people  from,  209 
destruction  of,  47 
extraterrestrials  settling,  146 
Jessups  “little  people,”  135 
as  part  of  Lemuria,  156 
Root  Races,  216 
Shaver  mystery,  225 
as  site  of  Satanism,  114 
The  Source,  234 
Atlantis:  The  Antediluvian  World 
(Donnelly),  3 1  (fig.),  32 
Aura  Rhanes,  22,  34,  43-44,  96, 
150 

Aurora  Encounter  (film),  35 
Aurora  Martian,  34-35 
Aurora  (planet),  47 
Ausso,  35-36 

Australia  as  site  of  occurrence, 

204-205 

Automatic  writing,  12,  113 
Avinash,  36 
Ayala,  36-37 

Ayres,  Toraya  (Carly),  36-37, 
227-228 
Azelia,  37-38 

Baba  Ram  Dass,  94 
Back,  39 

Bacon,  Francis,  32 
Bailey,  Alfred,  268 
Bailey,  Betty,  268 
Ballard,  Guy  Warren,  69,  122, 
183,  229 

Barclay,  John,  233-234 
Barker,  Gray,  83,  141,  170,  257 
Bartholomew,  39 


Bashar,  39-40,  211 
Basterfield,  Keith,  205 
Bauer,  Henry  H.,  xi 
Baxter,  Marla.  See  Weber, 
Constance 

Beasts,  Men  and  Gods 

(Ossendowski),  13 
Beckley,  Timothy  Green,  1 53 
Behind  the  Flying  Saucers 
(Scully),  63,  82,  195 
Being  of  Light,  40 
Beirne,  Mary,  164 
Bell,  Art,  244 
Bell,  Fred,  221 

Bellringer,  Patrick  J.  (pseud.), 
222-223 

Bender,  Albert  K.,  141—142,  170 
Berlitz,  Charles,  42,  85 
Bermuda  Triangle,  xii,  14,  33, 
41-42,  92,  104 
The  Bermuda  Triangle  (Berlitz), 
42 

The  Bermuda  Triangle  Mystery — 
Solved  (Kusche),  42 
Bernard,  Raymond  (pseud.).  See 
Siegmeister,  Walter 
Bethurum,  Truman,  22,  34, 

43- 44,  43(fig.),  70,  96, 
150,  229,  231 

Bigfoot.  See  Sasquatch 
Bird  aliens,  44 

Birmingham,  Frederick  William, 

44- 45 

Birmingham’s  ark,  44—45 
Blavatsky,  Helene  Petrovna,  32, 
69,  122,  156,  215(fig.), 
216 

Blessed  Virgin  Mary  (BVM), 
162-165 

Blodget,  Charlotte,  195 
Blowing  Cave,  45-47 
Blue  John  Caves,  165 
Bo.  See  Applewhite,  Marshall 
Herff 
Bolivia,  227 
Bonnie,  47 

The  Book  of  Knowledge:  The  Keys 
of  Enoch  (Hurtak),  173 
The  Book  of  the  Damned  (Fort), 
69 

Boone,  Dan,  257 
Bord,  Janet,  xiii,  99 


Index  28 1 


Borderland  Sciences  Research 
Associates,  208,  275 
Boys  from  Topside,  47-48 
Brady,  Enid,  76-77 
Brazil,  64,  140 
Brodie,  Steve,  49 
Brodies  deros,  48-50 
Brodu,  Jean-Louis,  162 
Brookesmith,  Peter,  198  (fig.) 
Brotherhood  of  the  Seven  Rays, 

231,  269 

Brown,  Courtney,  50-51 
Brown,  Michael  E,  61,  174 
Brown  Mountain  lights,  187 
Browning,  Frederick,  134 
Brown’s  Martians,  50-51 
Bryant,  Alice,  22 
Bryant,  Ernest  Arthur, 
275-276 

Buckle,  Eileen,  276 
Bucky,  51-52 

Buff  Ledge  abduction,  52-53 
Bullard,  Thomas  E.,  2,  4,  56 
Bunians,  53-54 
Bush,  George,  214 
Burden,  Brian,  142 
BVM.  See  Blessed  Virgin  Mary 
Byrd,  Richard  E.,  xvi,  151 
Byrne,  John,  101 

Calf-rustling  aliens,  55-57 
California  as  site  of  occurrence, 
195-196,  226,  273 
Campbell,  Lady  Archibald, 

103 

Campbell,  Steuart,  19 
Canada,  200 

Canadian  government,  47-48 
Captive  extraterrestrials,  57 
Carey,  Ken,  211 
Carpenter,  John  S.,  212—214 
Carrington,  Hereward,  107 
Cataclysmic  events,  27-29,  30, 
31,33-34,  47 
Cayce,  Edgar,  32-33,  234 
CE3.  See  Close  encounters  of 
the  third  kind 
Cetaceans,  58 
Chaldeans,  27 6 
Chalker,  Bill,  17,  18,  44 
Chamberlin,  Richard,  209 
Chaneques,  58-59 


Channeling,  xii,  xiii,  xv— xvi, 
23-24,  59-61 
abraham,  7 

through  alien  implants,  24, 
125-126 
alien  women,  24 
ancient  civilizations,  275 
Andolo,  21 
animals,  227 
Anoah,  23—24 
Ashtar  and  Ashtar 

Command,  201,  244 
Atlanteans,  32-33 
biblical  figures,  7,  12 
cetaceans,  58 
Germane,  211 
God-figures,  73,  75,  93-94, 
117-118,  119,  211, 
241-242,  266 
group  energies  and  entities, 
111,154-155,170,174, 
207,  234 
Higher  Being,  88 
for  instructional  purposes,  161 
intelligences  from  beyond, 
130 

Metatron,  173-174 
military  as  witnesses,  12-13 
multiple  entities,  79-81 
Nostradamus,  188-189 
from  other  planets,  130-131, 
145,  146-147,  191,  200 

philosophical  and 

technological,  47-48 
for  prophetic  purposes,  21, 
26-27,  27-29,  32-33, 
39-40,  211-212 
“pure”  channeling,  228 
Ramtha,  209-210 
reincarnated  beings,  158, 
161,222 
Seth,  221 

Star  People,  237-238 
Van  Tassel,  256 
Venusians,  76-77 
Chapman,  Robert,  19 
Chiefjoseph,  61,  6 1  (fig.) 
Childers,  Lee,  202-203 
Children,  212 

as  abductees,  26,  53,  139, 
212-213 

close  encounters,  133-134 


as  contactees,  26,  67,  134,  143 
fairies  and,  73-75,  101 
Chorvinsky,  Mark,  115-117 
Christianity,  113,  221 
Elvis  as  Jesus,  92-93 
Marian  apparitions,  162-165 
Master  plans,  80-81 
reaction  to  Ashtar,  28 
See  also  Demons  and 

Demonology;  God-figures 
Christopher,  61 
Chung  Fu,  61-62 
Church  Universal  and 

Triumphant,  153-154 
Churchward,  James,  xvi,  156 
Circle  of  Inner  Truth,  62 
Circle  of  Power  Foundation,  241 
Civilizations,  lost.  See  Atlantis; 
Blowing  Cave;  Hollow 
earth;  Lemuria 
Clamar,  Aphrodite,  2 
Clarion  (planet),  21-22,  43 
Clark,  Jerome,  55-56,  95, 
198(fig.) 

Close  encounters  of  the  third 
kind  (CE3),  xv,  xvi, 

62-67 

Aenstrians,  10—11 
alien  diners,  16-17 
Angelucci,  Orfeo,  23 
bird  aliens,  44 
Birmingham’s  ark,  44—45 
calf-rustling  aliens,  55-57 
disappearing  aliens,  245 
giant  beings,  175 
Hill,  Barney  and  Betty,  2 
Jahrmin  and  Jana,  133-134 
Lethbridge’s  aeronauts, 
157-158 

miniature  pilots,  177 
Mothman,  178-179 
Nordics,  187-188 
octopus  aliens,  191 
reptoids,  212-214 
Shaw’s  Martians,  226-227 
sheep-killing  aliens,  227 
shopping  for  aliens,  233-234 
space  travel,  21-22 
Villanueva’s  visitors,  257-258 
Wilcox’s  Martians,  267-268 
See  also  Contactees;  Fairies; 
Martians;  Men  in  black 


282  Index 


Cocoon  people,  67-68 
Cody,  L.  D„  273-274 
Cole,  Yvonne,  94 
Collins,  Brian,  101 
Columbus,  Christopher,  261 
Colver,  Mervin  “Beaver,”  228 
The  Coming  of  Seth  (Roberts), 
221 

The  Coming  of  the  Fairies 
(Doyle),  74 

Communication,  64-65 

from  other  planets,  150-151 
spoken,  158,  177-178, 

195- 196 

telepathic,  17,  39,  90,  187, 

196- 197,  229-230,  241, 
277 

written,  12,  113,  249 
See  also  Telephone  calls  from 
extraterrestrials 
Communion:  A  True  Story 
(Strieber),  xii,  4-5,  17, 
96-97,  238 

Conspiracy  theories,  118,  121, 
123,  153,210 

Constable,  Trevor  James,  2 1 , 

71 

Contactees,  1,  15,  68-72, 
134-135,  144-145, 
234-235,  268-270 
Adamski,  George,  8-10 
agents,  13 
angels,  242 

Angelucci,  Orfeo,  22-23, 
22(fig.) 
children,  123 
early  movement,  105-106 
giant  aliens,  194-195 
godlike  figures,  112-113 
Grim  Reaper,  115—116 
Heaven’s  Gate,  246-248 
hoaxes,  184 
lifesaving  experiences, 
111-112 

from  other  planets,  141-142 
recollection  under  hypnosis, 

136-137,  241 
repeat  experiences,  195 
tape  recording,  177-178 
Venusians,  51-52,  87-88, 
105, 149-150 

Warminster  Mystery,  10—12 


See  also  Abductions; 

Adamski,  George;  Close 
encounters  of  the  third 
kind;  Flying  saucers; 
Meier,  Eduard  “Billy”; 
Radio  messages;  Sprinkle, 
Ronald  Leo;  Williamson, 
George  Hunt 

Contacts  OVNI  Cergy-Pontoise 
(Prevost),  130 
Cookes,  Grace,  266 
Cooper,  Milton  William,  95,  121 
Cosmic  awareness,  72-73, 
79-81,  88 
Cosmic  Awareness 

Communications,  73 
Cosmic  language,  1 
Cottingley  fairies,  73-75 
The  Council,  75 
Cox,  Norma,  123 
Creighton,  Gordon,  136 
Crenshaw,  Dennis  G.,  153 
Critias  (Plato),  31 
Crombie,  R.  Ogilvie,  146 
Curry,  75-76 
Cyclopeans,  76 
Cymatrili,  76-77 

“Dagousset,  Henri,”  250 
DAL  Universe,  220 
Dalis,  Allen,  264 
Dancing  in  the  Light  (Maclaine), 
209 

von  Daniken,  Erich,  269 
Darkness  over  Tibet  (Illion),  14 
Darr,  Lorraine,  159-160 
Darrah,  Adele,  28 
Dash,  Mike,  236 
Davenport,  Marc,  244—245 
David  of  Landa,  79-81 
David-Neel,  Alexandra,  245 
Davies,  Peter,  19 
Davis,  Isabel  L.,  83,  255 
Dead  extraterrestrials,  81-87, 
84(fig.),  120,  194-195 
Dean,  John  W.,  22,  277 
Death,  xiii 

dead  extraterrestrials,  81-87, 
84(fig.),  120,  194-195 
fourth  dimension,  104-105 
Grim  Reaper,  115—116, 
115-117 


Lee,  Gloria,  133 
suicides,  xiii,  30,  246-248 
DeLong,  Maris,  145 
Demons  and  demonology,  71, 
143,  170-172,  214,  221, 
222-223,  24.  See  also 
Satanism 

Denton,  Sherman,  87 
Denton,  William,  87 
Denton’s  Martians  and 
Venusians,  87 

Department  of  Interplanetary 
Affairs,  33 

Derenberger,  Woodrew,  253 
DERN  Universe,  220 
Deros,  45-46,  48-49 
Devas,  36-37 
The  Devil’s  Triangle 

(documentary),  42 
Diane,  87-88 

Dickhoff,  Robert  Ernst,  14-15 

Disch,  Thomas  M.,  238 

Divine  Fire,  88 

D’Light,  Joy,  144 

DNA,  17-18,  25 

Docker,  Beth,  203 

Donnelly,  Ignatius,  32 

Doran,  Jerry  238 

Doraty,  Judy,  56 

Doreal,  Maurice,  1 83 

Doty,  Richard,  120 

Dove,  Lonzo,  172 

Doyle,  Sir  Arthur  Conan,  73-74 

Drake,  W.  R„  161-162 

Druffel,  Ann,  136,  217 

Drugs,  psychedelic,  29-30 

Dual  reference,  88-90,  192, 

221,  258-259 
Dugja,  90 
Duncan,  James,  19 
Durby,  William,  72-73 
A  Dweller  on  Two  Planets 
(Oliver),  181-182 

The  Earth  Chronicles  (Stitchin), 
24 

Earth  Coincidence  Control 
Office,  91—92 
Earths  in  the  Solar  World 
(Swedenborg),  68 
EBEs.  See  Extraterrestrial 
biological  entities 


Index  283 


Eddy,  Mary  Baker,  261 
Ekker,  Doris,  117 
Elder  Race,  92,  208 
Ellis,  Richard,  33-34 
Elvis  as  Jesus,  92-93 
Emenegger,  Robert,  119,  120 
Emmanuel,  93-94 
Escape  from  Destruction 

(Bernard),  113-114 
Eternal  life  theories,  7 
The  Ether  Ship  and  Its  Solution 
(Layne),  275 
Eunethia,  94-95 
Evans,  Hilary,  34,  252 
Evans-Wentz,  W.  Y„  99 
Extraterrestrial  biological  entities 

(EBEs),  57,  94-95 

Extraterrestrial  Earth  Mission, 

36 

Extraterrestrials  among  us, 

95-97 

Fabares,  Shelley,  209 
Fairies  encountered,  xii,  xiii, 

99-103 

Chaneques,  58-59 
Cottingley  fairies,  73-75 
Jessup’s  “little  people,”  135 
Jinns,  135-136 
Kappa,  139-140 
Malaysian  Bunians,  53-54 
White’s  little  people, 

266-267 

See  also  Ultraterrestrials 
Fairies:  Real  Encounters  with 
Little  People  (Bord),  xiii 
Fairy  captures,  103-104 
The  Fairy  Faith  in  Celtic 

Countries  (Evans-Wentz), 
99 

Fairy  Tale:  A  True  Story  (Him), 

75 

Farewell,  Good  Brothers 

(documentary),  173 
Farrell,  Mike,  209 
Fatima,  Our  Lady  of,  162-163 
Fellowship  of  the  Inner  Light, 
234 

Ferguson,  William,  143 
Ferreira,  Antonio  Carlos,  37-38 
Fields,  Ralph  B.,  179-181 
Fire  in  the  Sky  (film),  264 


Fletcher,  Candy,  241 
Fletcher,  Rey,  241 
Flournoy,  Theodore,  69,  185 
Flying  Saucer  from  Mars 
(Allingham),  19 
Flying  saucers.  See  Spaceships 
Flying  Saucers  and  the  Three  Men 
(Bender),  141 
The  Flying  Saucers  Are  Real 
(Keyhoe),  63 

Flying  Saucers  Have  Landed 
(Leslie  and  Adamski),  8 
Fodor,  Nandor,  108,  110 
Fontaine,  Franck,  130 
Fontes,  Olavo  T.,  64 
Food,  alien,  64-65 
Ford,  Richard,  248 
Fort,  Charles,  69,  142 
Fortner,  Yonah,  2 76 
Fossilized  aliens,  104 
Fourth  dimension,  104-105 
Frank  and  Frances,  105 
Franklin,  Benjamin,  261 
Frederick,  Jennings,  256—257 
Friedman,  Stanton  T.,  84 
Friend,  Robert,  13 
From  India  to  the  Planet  Mars 
(Flournoy),  69,  185 
From  Outer  Space  to  You 
(Menger),  172 

Fry,  Daniel  William,  105-106 
Fuller,  Curtis,  224 
Fuller,  John  G.,  2 

Gabriel,  107 

Gaddis,  Vincent  H.,  14,  42 
Gaia,  36 

Gandhi,  Mahatma,  261 
Gardner,  Edward,  73-74 
Gardner,  Marshall  B.,  122 
GeBauer,  Leo,  82 
Gef,  107-111 

Geller,  Uri,  234-235,  235 (fig.) 
Gentzel,  Charles  Boyd,  119 
Germane,  111,  160,211 
Giannini,  F.  Amadeo,  151 
Giant  Rock  Interplanetary 

Spacecraft  Convention, 

166,  255 

Gill,  William  Booth,  63 
Gilson,  Cy,  262,  264 
Girvan,  Waveney,  19 


Gnosticism,  210 
Goblin  Universe,  111 
God-figures,  73,  75,  93-94, 
113,  117-118,  119,211, 
241-242,  242,  266 
Godfrey,  Alan,  136-137, 

137  (fig.) 

Godfrey,  Cinda,  92-93 
Goldberg,  Bruce,  2 44 
Good,  Timothy,  134-135,  165 
Gordon,  111-112 
Gray  Face,  112-113 
Gray-skinned  aliens,  2,  15,  50, 
56,  67-68,  79,  112-113, 
203(fig.),  261-266 
Great  Mother,  113-114 
Great  White  Brotherhood,  23, 
27,  114-115 

Greater  Nibiruan  Council, 

24-25,  115 
Green,  Gabriel,  178 
Green-skinned  aliens,  37 
Grevler,  Ann,  1 
Grey,  Margot,  40 
Griffiths,  Frances,  73-75 
Grim  Reaper,  115—117 
Grise,  Allan,  159 
Gross,  Germana,  39 
Grosso,  Michael,  129,  203 
Gyeorgos  Ceres  Hatonn, 
117-118 

Haeckel,  Ernst,  155-156 
Halley,  Edmond,  122 
Hallucinations,  205 
Hamilton,  Alex,  55 
Hamilton,  William,  47,  167 
Hansen,  Myrna,  56 
Hanson,  Nuria,  1 1 1—1 12 
Harris,  Melvin,  1 10 
Hatonn.  See  Gyeorgos  Ceres 
Hatonn 

Hawaii  as  site  of  occurrence, 
202,  242 
Haydon,  S.  E.,  35 
Heard,  Gerald,  166 
Heaven’s  Gate,  xiii,  246-248 
Hefferlin,  W.  C.  and  Gladys, 
207-209 

Hewes,  Hayden,  35,  246-247 
Hicks,  Esther,  7 
Hierarchal  Board,  119 


284  Index 


Higdon,  E.  Carl,  Jr.,  35-36 

Higher  Being,  88 

Hill,  Barney  and  Betry,  2, 

3(fig.)>  66 
Hill,  James,  1 54 
Hilton,  James,  13 
Hind,  Cynthia,  15,  67,  169 
Hingley,  Jean,  176-177 
Hoaxes,  xvi,  184 

Adamski,  George,  8-10 
alien  autopsy  film,  xii,  85 
Allingham’s  Martian,  19 
Bethurum,  Truman,  43 
controversy  over  Aura 
Rhanes,  34 

Cottingley  fairies,  73-75 
dead  extraterrestrials,  8 1-83 
Fontaine  abduction,  130 
fourth  dimension,  104—105 
Holloman  aliens,  120 
Menger  and  Weber,  172-173 
Shaw’s  Martians,  226—227 
Ummo,  249—252 
unconfirmed  hoaxes, 
177-178,  234 
use  of  ventriloquism,  110 
Vadig,  253-254 
Vegetable  Man,  257 
Yamski,  276 
Hodson,  Geoffrey,  74 
Holiday,  F.  W.,  Ill 
Holloman  aliens,  119—121 
Hollow  earth,  xii,  xvi,  121—123 
Agharti,  13-15 
Atlantis,  33 
Blowing  Cave,  45-47 
land  beyond  the  Pole, 
151-153 

Mount  Lassen,  179-181 
Mount  Shasta,  181-184 
See  also  Atlantis;  Lemuria; 
Shaver  mystery 

The  Hollow  Earth  (Bernard),  xvi, 
123 

The  Hollow  Globe  (Sherman), 
122 

Honey,  C.  A.,  10,  96 
Honor,  123—124 
Hood,  Hedy,  133 
Hopkins,  Budd,  xiii,  2-3,  5-6, 
124-125,  126,  238-239 
Hopkins’s  Martians,  125 


Horsley,  Peter,  134-135 
How  to  Develop  Your  ESP  Power 
(Roberts),  221 
Howard,  Dana,  87-88 
Howe,  Linda  Moulton,  56,  120 
Hubbard,  Harold  W.,  253 
Hufford,  David  J.,  193 
Human-alien  hybrids.  See 
Hybrid  beings 
Humphrey,  Hubert,  10 
Hurtak,  James,  84,  173 
Hutson,  John,  12 
Hweig,  125-126 
Hybrid  beings,  26,  96,  126-127 
Azelia,  37-38 
as  motive  for  abduction,  4 
nonhuman  hybrids, 

212-214,  222 
Nordics  as,  188 
reptoids,  212-214 
See  also  Pregnancy;  Sexual 
contact 

Hynek,  J.  Allen,  xv,  64,  65 
Hyperborea,  216 
Hypnosis,  xii,  191 

aliens  and  the  dead,  1 8 
Buff  Ledge  abduction,  53 
channeling  during,  39,  79, 
234,  244 

dual  reference,  88-90 
recalling  abduction 
experience,  4,  24,  66, 
112-113,  136,  228,  241 
remembering  reptoids,  214, 
259 

used  on  abductees,  1-2 
Hyslop,  James,  233 

I  AM  Activity.  See  Ballard,  Guy 
Warren 

I  Rode  a  Flying  Saucer!  (Van 
Tassel),  70,  255 

Ibn  Aharon,  Y.  N.  (pseud.).  See 
Fortner,  Yonah 
Icke,  David,  214 
Idaho  as  site  of  occurrence,  199, 
228 

Illion,  Theodore,  14 
Imaginal  beings,  129 
Imagining  Atlantis  (Ellis),  33-34 
Impersonations  of 

extraterrestrials,  28 


Inner  Light  Consciousness,  234 
The  Inner  World  (Culmer),  122 
Insectoids,  130,  184-185 
Insects,  166 

Inside  the  Space  Ships  (Adamski), 
8,  196 

Intelligences  du  Dehors,  130 
Intelligences  from  Beyond,  130 
Intergalactic  councils,  21,61 
International  Flying  Saucer 
Bureau,  141-142 
Internet  information,  xii,  33 
Interplanetary  Connections,  40 
Interplanetary  Parliament, 

11-12 

The  Interrupted  Journey  (Fuller), 
2 

Intruders  (Hopkins),  4,  124 
Invisible  Horizons  (Gaddis),  42 
Invisible  Residents  (Sanderson), 
42,  192 

Ireland  as  site  of  occurrence, 
103-104,  164 
Irving,  James,  107—111 
Ishkomar,  130-131 
Isis  Unveiled  (Blavatsky),  122 

J.  W.,  133 

Jacobs,  David  M.,  xiii,  5-6,  13, 
18,  96,  126,  188 
Jadoo  (Keel),  143 
Jahrmin  and  Jana,  133-134 
Jamaludin,  Ahmad,  53-54 
James,  William,  221 
Janus,  134-135 
Jefferson,  Thomas,  261 
Jehovah,  232 
Jerhoam,  135 

Jessup,  Morris  Ketchum,  135 
Jessup’s  “little  people,”  135 
Jesus,  12,24,  92-93,  154,  241, 
261,  277.  See  also 
Sananda 

Jewish  mysticism,  173—174 

Jews,  234-235 

Jinns,  135-136 

John  XXIII,  10 

Jonerson,  Ellen,  102 

Jordan  Pena,  Jose  Luis,  250,  251 

Joseph,  136-137,  137(fig.) 

A  Journey  to  the  Earth’s  Interior 
(Gardner),  122 


Index  285 


Juliana,  Queen  of  Holland,  10 
Jung,  C.  G„  23,  203-204 
Jupiter,  22,  239 

Kafton-Minkel,  Walter, 
225-226 

Kaiser,  Elaine,  241 
Kannenberg,  Ida  M.,  125—126 
Kantarians,  139 
Kappa,  139-140,  I40(fig.) 
Karen,  140 

Karmic  Board,  140-141 
Katchongva,  Chief  Dan,  199 
Kazik,  141-142 
Keach,  Marian  (pseud.).  See 
Martin,  Dorothy 
Keel,  John  A.,  142-143,  275 
alien  telephone  calls,  25 
hybridization,  4 
hysterical  pregnancies,  xvii, 
126 

men  in  black,  171 
occult  entities,  66,  71 
personal  encounters  with 
ultraterrestrials,  194 
Texas  airships,  272 
Vadig  hoax,  253 
Keely,  John,  101 
Kellett,  Mary,  263 
Kennedy,  John  E,  10 
Kerin,  Dermot,  115 
Keyhoe,  Donald  E.,  48 
Khauga,  143 
Khoury,  Peter,  17-18 
Kidnapping.  See  Abductions 
Kihief,  143—144 
Kinder,  Gary,  168 
King,  George,  12 
King  Leo,  144-145 
King  of  the  World,  14 
Kingdoms  within  Earth  (Cox), 
123 

Kirk,  Robert,  99 
Klarer,  Elizabeth,  15 
Klass,  Philip  J.,  5,  263,  264 
Klein,  Donald  F.,  238 
Klimo,  Jon,  154—155 
Knight,  J.  Z.,  161,  209—210 
Knowles,  Herbert  B.,  12 
Korff,  Kal,  168 
Korsholm,  Celeste,  200 
Korsholm,  Jananda,  133-134 


Korton,  28,  30,  145 
Kronin,  145 
Kuiper,  Gerard,  1 66 
Kuran,  145-146 
Kurmos,  146 
Kusche,  Larry,  42 
Kwan  Ti  Laslo,  146—147 

Laan-Deeka  and  Sharanna, 

149-150 

Lady  of  Pluto,  150-151 
Lael,  Ralph,  187 
Lake  Titicaca,  Peru,  231 
Land  beyond  the  Pole,  151-153 
Landa,  xiii,  xiv,  79-81 
Lanello,  153-154 
Lanser,  Edward,  1 83 
Larsen,  Julius,  12 
Laskon,  154 

Laughead,  Charles  and  Lillian, 
229-232 

Lawson,  Alvin  H.,  3 
Layne,  N.  Meade,  69-70,  143, 
275 

Lazaris,  154-155 
Le  Plongeon,  Augustus,  156 
Leander,  John,  194 
Leary,  Timothy,  94 
Lee,  Gloria,  61,  119,  133 
Lemuria,  xvi,  7,  155-157, 
182-184 
Atlantis  and,  33 
channeling  people  from,  209 
destruction  of,  47 
Jessup’s  “little  people,”  135 
purported  locations  of,  173, 
202 

queen  of,  90 
Root  Races,  216 
Shaver  mystery,  223-226 
as  site  of  Satanism,  114 
See  also  Atlantis;  Hollow 
earth 

Lemuria:  Lost  Continent  of  the 
Pacific  (Lewis),  156,  182 
LePar,  William,  75 
Leslie,  Desmond,  8,  258,  276 
Lethbridge  aeronauts,  157-158 
Lever,  Marshall,  61-62 
Lewis,  H.  Spencer,  122,  156, 
182 

Li  Sung,  158 


Lie-detector  tests.  See  Polygraph 
examinations 

Life  after  Life  (Moody),  40 
Light,  heavenly,  40 
Ligon,  J.  R.,  271 
Lilly,  John,  91 

Limbo  of  the  Lost  (Spencer),  42 
Lincoln,  Abraham,  261 
Linn-Erri,  158-159 
Lleget,  Marius,  250-251 
London,  England,  135 
Lorenzen,  Coral,  2,  82,  263, 
265-266 

Lorenzen,  Jim,  2,  82,  263, 
265-266 

Lost  civilizations.  She  Atlantis; 
Blowing  Cave;  Hollow 
earth;  Lemuria 
Lost  Horizon  (Hilton),  13 
Loveland  Frogman,  213(fig.) 
Lundahl,  Arthur,  12-13 
Luno,  159-160 
Lyrans,  160 

Macdonald,  Keith,  xiii,  xiv,  xv, 
79-81 

Mack,  John  E.,  xii— xiii,  5,  72, 
89 

Maclaine,  Shirley,  209 
MacLeod,  Melissa,  217 
Mafu,  161 
Magee,  Judith,  205 
Magonia,  161-162 
Malaysia,  53-54 
Maldek  (planet),  24 
Marcoux,  Charles  A.,  45-47 
Marian  apparitions,  162-165 
Mark,  165-166 
Mars,  visits  to,  21—22 
Marshall,  George  C.,  94 
Martian  bees,  166 
Martians,  143 

as  Adamic  man,  232-233 
Allingham’s  Martian,  19 
Aurora  Martian,  34-35 
Browns  Martians,  50-51 
communication  through 
writing,  249 
Denton’s  Martians  and 
Venusians,  87 
early  contactee  movement, 
68-69 


286  Index 


Hopkins’s  Martians,  125 
Mince-pie  Martians, 

175-177 

Monka,  28,  30,  177-178 
Muller’s  Martians,  185 
as  root  race,  14-15 
Shaw’s  Martians,  226-227 
Smead’s  Martians,  233 
Snake  People,  208 
Wilcox’s  Martians,  267-268 
Martin,  Dorothy,  217,  229,  269 
Martins,  Joao,  64 
Mary,  166-167 
Mary,  Blessed  Virgin.  See 
Marian  apparitions 
Massari,  Thomas,  22 1 
Mathers,  S.  L.  MacGregor,  220 
Matthews,  Arthur  Henry,  105 
Maui,  Hawaii,  202 
Mayer,  Harry,  166-167 
McCarthy,  John  J.,  263 
McGraw,  Walter,  109 
McHale,  John,  164 
McLean,  Ken,  24 
McLoughlin,  Mary,  164 
Me-leelah,  169—170 
Media 

radio  messages,  12-13, 
157-158,  177-178,255 
telephone  calls  from 

extraterrestrials,  10—11, 
25,  79-81,  145 

television  and  newspaper 
reporting,  xii,  xiii 
Meier,  Eduard  “Billy,”  71-72, 
167-169,  188,  220-221 
Melchizedek  Order  of  the  White 
Brotherhood,  23 
Melora,  170 

Melton,  J.  Gordon,  69,  210 
Memories  ofTomorrow 
(Woodrew),  192 
Men  in  black  (M1B),  25, 

141-142,  170-172,  197, 
203,  245,  254 

Menger,  Connie.  See  Weber, 
Constance 

Menger,  Howard,  20—21, 

20(fig.),  172-173,  187 
Merk,  173 
Mersch,  173 
Metatron,  173-174 


Meton  (planet),  15 
Mexico  as  site  of  occurrence, 
163-164,  212,  257-258 
MIB.  See  Men  in  Black 
Michael,  174-175,  242 
Michigan  giant,  174 
Migrants,  175 
Military  involvement 

Bender’s  men  in  black,  14 1 
Boys  from  Topside,  47-48 
captive  extraterrestrials,  57 
dead  extraterrestrials,  81-85 
EBEs,  94-95 

Holloman  aliens,  1 19—121 
land  beyond  the  Pole, 
151-152 

men  in  black,  171 
Padrick’s  Xeno,  273-274 
witnesses  to  channeling, 
12-13 

Zolton,  277-278 
Miller,  Dick,  177-178,  269 
Mince-pie  Martians,  175-177 
Miniature  pilots,  177 
Ministry  of  Universal  Wisdom, 
28 

Minnesota,  245 
Miranda  (planet),  26-27 
Missing  time,  1—3 
Missing  Time  (Hopkins),  3,  124 
Mission  Rama,  196 
Missouri  as  site  of  occurrence, 

16,  125 

Mohammed,  261 
Monka,  28,  30,  177-178 
Monteleone,  Thomas  F., 
253-254 

Montgomery,  Ruth,  88,  261 
Moody,  Charles,  266 
Moody,  Raymond  A.,  40 
Moore,  Mary-Margaret,  39 
Moore,  Patrick,  19 
Moore,  William  L.,  57,  84 
Moseley,  James  W.,  43 
Moses,  261 

Motels,  aliens  staying  in, 

16-17 

Mothman,  4,  143,  178-179 
The Mothman  Prophecies  (Keel),  4 
Mount  Lassen,  179-181 
Mount  Shasta,  33,  156, 
181-184,  182(fig.) 


as  entrance  to  hollow  earth, 

122 

inhabitants  of,  47 
Lemurian  queen  residing  at, 
90 

Martin,  Dorothy,  and,  229, 
232 
Mr.  X,  184 
Mu.  See  Lemuria 
MU  the  Mantis  Being,  184-185 
Muller,  Catherine  Elise,  69,  185 
Muller’s  Martians,  185 
My  Saturnian  Lover  (Baxter), 

172 

The  Narrative  of  Arthur  Gordon 
Pym  (Poe),  122 
Native  religions,  199 
Nazi  sympathizers,  123,  153 
Near-death  experiences,  40 
Neasham,  Robert,  12-13 
Nebel,  Long  John,  50,  51, 

71  (fig.),  172,  203, 
256(fig.) 

Neff,  Grant,  262 
Nelson,  Arlene,  228 
Nelson,  Buck,  51-52 
Nettles,  Bonnie  Lu,  246-248 
Nevada  as  site  of  occurrence,  34 
New  Age  movements,  xii, 

92-93,  102-103,  161, 
209-210,  221 
New  Mexico  as  site  of 

occurrence,  57,  65,  82, 

83,  84-85,  85,  86(fig.), 
94,  105,  119-121,  195, 
266 

Newbrough,  John  Ballough,  69, 
229 

Newfoundland  as  site  of 
occurrence,  102 
Newton,  Silas,  82 
Noma,  187 

Nordics,  187-188,  266 
Norman,  Paul,  205 
North  Pole,  151-153 
Nostradamus,  188-189, 
189(fig.) 

Nyman,  Joseph,  88-90 

Oahspe  (Newbrough),  28-29, 
69,  229 


Index  287 


O’Barski,  George,  67 
Observers,  multiple,  xvi 
Adamski,  George,  8 
Allinghams  Martian,  19 
Buff  Ledge  abduction,  52-53 
Hill,  Barney  and  Betty,  2 
Octopus  aliens,  191 
Office  of  Naval  Intelligence,  12 
Ogatta,  191—192 
Ohio  as  site  of  occurrence, 
178-179 
OINTS,  42, 192 
Old  Hag,  192-194 
Oleson’s  giants,  194-195 
Oliver,  Frederick  Spencer, 
181-184 
Oliver,  John,  135 
Oliver,  Norman,  276 
Olliana  Olliana  Alliano,  195 
Oregon  as  site  of  occurrence,  15, 
102 

Oreon  (planet),  22 
Ortenheim,  Bjorn,  201—202 
Orthon,  70,  195-196 
Ossendowski,  Ferdinand,  13-14 
Other  Intelligences.  See  OINTs 
Other  Tongues — Other  Flesh 
(Williamson),  157,  175, 
269 

Ottawa  Flying  Saucer  Club,  48 
Otto,  John,  230 
Our  Haunted  Planet  (Keel),  25 
Out-of-body  experiences,  26, 

40,  87,  143,  159,  200, 

238 

Owen,  A.  R.  G.,  200 
Owen,  Iris,  200 
Oxalc,  196-197 
Oz  Factor,  197-198 

Padrick,  Sid,  273-274 
Paladin,  David,  139 
Palmer,  Ray,  46,  151,  207-208, 
223,  224,  226 
Pancakes,  64-65 
“Pardo,  Antonio,”  250-251 
Partise,  Joyce,  219 
Parz,  26 

Paschal,  Francie.  See  Steiger, 
Francie  Paschal 
Passport  to  Magonia  (Vallee), 

102, 161-162 


Paul  2,  199 

Peep.  See  Nettles,  Bonnie  Lu 
Pfeifer,  George  J.,  263 
Pflock,  Karl  T„  254 
The  Phantom  of  the  Poles  (Reed), 
122 

Philip,  200 
Phoenix  Project,  117 
Photographs,  8,  73-75, 

167-168,  250,  251,254 
Picasso,  Fabio,  76,  139-140 
Planetary  Council,  200, 

200-201 

Planetary  Light  Association,  23 
Plato,  31 

Pleiadeans,  71-72,  167-168, 
169,  187-188,200, 
220-221 
Pluto,  150-151 
Poe,  Edgar  Allan,  122 
POL.  See  Power  of  Light 
Polygraph  examinations,  35-36, 
43,97,105,172,261,263 
Poppen,  Nicholas  von,  83 
Portia,  28,  201 
Portugal,  162-163 
Possession  by  extraterrestrials, 
29-30 

Power  of  Light  (POL),  201—203 
Pregnancy 

impregnation  by 

extraterrestrials,  4,  15,  96, 
126,  212 

See  also  Hybrid  beings;  Sexual 
contact 

Presley,  Elvis,  92-93 
Preston,  Clyde,  112-113 
Prevost,  Jean-Pierre,  130 
Price,  Harry,  110 
Price,  Thomas  W,  245 
Prince  Neosom,  202-203 
Priority  of  All  Saints,  231 
Probert,  Mark,  69-70,  275 
Project  Alert,  30 
Project  Blue  Book,  13—14, 
63-65,  171,273 
Project  Magnet,  47-48 
Prophecies,  188-189,  195 
Atlantis,  32-33 
cataclysmic  events,  130-131, 
169 

of  extraterrestrials,  1 1 


of  human  future,  9 1 
Second  Coming,  113 
Martin,  Dorothy,  and  failed, 
229-232 

telepathic  communication, 

26-27 

Wilcox’s  Martians,  267-268 
Prophet,  Mark  L.,  153—154 
Psychic  experiments,  87,  200 
Psychic  manifestations, 

245-246,  259 
Psychic  projections.  See 
Psychoterrestrials 
Psychological  issues,  1 84 
causes  of  abduction  stories, 
3-4 

imaginal  beings,  129 
Jung  on  Orfeo  Angelucci,  23 
nightmares,  192-194 
research,  xv 

sanity  of  experients,  xiv— xv, 
35-36,  268 

Psychoterrestrials,  203-204 
Puddy,  Maureen,  204-205 
Puddys  abduction,  204-205 
Puharich,  Andrija,  191 
Pursel,  Jach,  154-155 

R.  D„  207 
Ra,  207 

Radio  messages,  12-13, 

157-158,  177-178,255 
Rahm,  Peter,  99-100 
Rainbow  City,  207-209 
Rainbow  City  and  the  Inner 

Earth  People  (Barton),  209 
Ramtha,  154,  161,  209—210 
Ramu,  196,  210-211 
Randles,  Jenny,  171,  197-198, 
198  (fig.) 

Raphael,  211 
Ratliff,  Buffard,  104 
Raydia,  211 
Reed,  William,  122 
Reeder,  D.  B.,  273 
Reeves,  Kathy,  245 
Reincarnated  beings,  23,  24, 
61-62,  153-154,  158, 
199,  208 
Renata,  211-212 
Renaud,  Robert  P.,  158-159 
Reptoid  child,  212 


288  Index 


Reptoids,  56,  144-145,  145, 
212-214,  213(fig.),  259 
The  Republic  (Plato),  31-32 
Restaurants,  aliens  in,  16-17 
Revelation:  The  Divine  Fire 
(Steiger),  29 

Reyes,  Luis  Ramirez,  212 
Rhode  Island  as  site  of 
occurrence,  24 1 
Rhodes,  John,  214 
Ribera,  Antonio,  250 
Rice,  Ted,  259 
Ring,  Kenneth,  40,  129 
Road  in  the  Sky  (Williamson), 
157,  269,  270 
Robbins,  Dianne,  7,  58 
Roberts,  Jane,  221 
Robinson,  John  J.,  49 
Rocky  Mountain  Conference  on 
UFO  Investigation, 
xiv— xv,  24,  72,  236 
Rogo,  D.  Scott,  164-165 
Rohre,  Joseph,  57 
Rojcewicz,  Peter  M.,  7,  197 
Rolfe,  Jessica  (pseud.),  145-146 
Roman,  Sanaya,  242 
Root  races,  216 
Roper  poll,  6 
Rosas,  Lester,  149-150 
Rosicrucians,  114-115,  183 
Rosing,  Christopher,  129 
Roswell,  New  Mexico,  84-85 
The  Roswell  Incident  (Moore),  85 
Rowe,  Kelvin,  150-151 
Royal,  Lyssa,  211 
Royal  Order  of  Tibet,  8 
Rueckert,  Carla,  207 
Ruwa,  Zimbabwe,  67 

Sagan,  Carl,  xi,  184 
Sagrada  Familia,  Brazil,  76 
Saint  Michael,  217 
San  Antonio,  Antonio,  250 
Sananda,  28,  117-118,  119, 

154,  217,  229,  231,  232 
Sanderson,  IvanT.,  42,  192 
Sandler,  Allan,  119 
Santana,  Carlos,  173,  174(fig.) 
Sasquatch,  217-219 
Satanism,  113-114.  See  also 

Demons  and  demonology 
Satonians,  220 


Saturn,  20-21,  172,210,  239 
Scarberry,  Linda,  179 
Scarberry,  Roger,  178 
Schattler,  Philip  L.,  155-157 
Schiff,  Steve,  85 
Schirmer,  Herbert,  2 
Schmidt,  Reinhold,  184 
Schroeder,  John  E.,  16,  17 
Schultz,  Dave,  173,  195 
Schwartz,  Stephen  A.,  217 
Schwarz,  Berthold  Eric,  268 
Scott-Elliot,  W„  156 
Scully,  Frank,  82,  195 
Second  Coming,  1 12-1 13 
Secret  Chiefs,  220 
The  Secret  Common-Wealth 
(Kirk),  99 

The  Secret  Doctrine  (Blavatsky), 
122,  156 

Secret  of  the  Ages :  UFOs  from 
inside  the  Earth  (Trench), 
225 

The  Secret  of  the  Saucers 
(Angelucci),  23(fig.) 

Secret  Places  of  the  Lion 

(Williamson),  157,  269 
Secret  School  (Strieber),  240 
Sedona,  Arizona,  36,  134,  200, 
227 

Seewaldt,  David,  212-213 
Semjase,  167-168,  220-221 
Seth,  154,  221 

The  Seth  Material  (Roberts),  221 
Sewall,  Mary,  245 
Sexual  contact  with  aliens,  124 
Aura  Rhanes,  34,  43 
evidence  of,  17-18 
hysterical  pregnancies,  126 
withjinns,  136 
with  Pleiadeans,  22 1 
producing  offspring,  37-38, 
64 

reptoids,  214 
Weber’s  Saturnian  lover, 
20-21 

See  also  Hybrid  beings; 
Pregnancy 
Shaari,  222 
Shambhala,  13 
Shan,  222-223 
Shan-Chea  satellite,  21 
Shangri-La,  13-15,  I4(fig.) 


Shartle,  Paul,  119-120 
Shaver,  Richard  Sharpe,  48-49, 
123,  156,  223-226 
Shaver  mystery,  14,  45,  48-50, 
207,  223-226 
Shaw,  H.  G.,  226—227 
Shaw’s  Martians,  226-227 
Sheaffer,  Robert,  102 
Shearer,  Carolyn,  154 
Sheep-killing  alien,  227 
Shell,  Robert,  29-30 
Sherman,  M.  L.,  122 
Shiva,  36-37,  227-228 
Shockley,  Paul,  73 
Short,  Robert,  28 
Shoush,  Tawani,  151-153 
Shovar,  228 

Shuttlewood,  Arthur,  10-11 
Shuttlewood,  Graham,  1 1 
Siegmeister,  Walter,  xvi,  123 
Silence  Group,  9-10 
Simon,  Benjamin,  2 
Simonton,  Joe,  64 
Simpson,  Dorothy,  16 
Sinat  Schirah,  228 
Sister  Thedra,  229-232 
Sitchin,  Zecharia,  24—25,  115 
Sky  people,  232-233 
Slade,  Henry,  104 
Smead’s  Martians,  233 
Smith,  233—234 
Smith,  Helene  (pseud.).  See 
Muller,  Catherine  Elise 
Smith,  Wilbert  B.,  47-48 
Snake  People,  208 
Sneide,  Ole  J.,  70 
Socorro,  New  Mexico,  65 
Solar  Cross  Foundation,  220 
Solem,  Paul,  199 
Solomon,  Paul,  234 
Source,  234 

Space  Brothers,  159,  187-188, 
210-211,  254 
Space  travel 

early  contactee  movement, 
68-69 

out-of-body  experiences, 

143 

Standing  Horse’s  travels, 
21-22 

with  Venusians,  149—150, 
159-160,  242-243 


Index  289 


Spaceships,  xvi,  62-64 
abductions  by,  1-6 
Adamski,  George,  and, 

8-10 

aliens  from,  239 
Angelucci,  Orfeo,  and,  23 
Birmingham’s  ark,  44—45 
blueprints  for,  133 
cigar-shaped  spacecraft,  26 
contact  with,  39-40,  154, 
157-158 

dead  extraterrestrials,  81-84, 
82 

disc-shaped,  124 

early  contactee  movement, 

70 

EBEs,  95 

failure  to  appear,  1 99 
hoaxes,  249—252 
humans  on  UFOs,  207 
landings  in  Texas,  270-271 
manned  craft,  275-276 
Martians  in,  19,  226—227 
pancake-shaped,  67,  106 (fig.) 
from  Saturn,  210 
See  also  Abductions;  Close 
encounters  of  the  third 
kind 

Sparrow,  Margaret,  200 
Spaulding,  William  H.,  263 
Spears,  Terry,  115 

SPECTRA,  234-235 
Spence,  Lewis,  32 
Spencer,  John  Wallace,  42 
Spooner,  Camille,  226 
Springheel  Jack,  235-236 
Sprinkle,  Ronald  Leo,  36,  72, 
79,  228,  236,  244 
St.  Louis,  Missouri,  16 
Stalnaker,  Lydia,  24 
Stan.  See  Sinat  Schirah 
Standing  Horse,  Frank  Buck, 
21-22,  154 

Star  People,  96,  143-144, 
237-238 

The  Star  People  (Steiger  and 
Steiger),  237 
Starr,  Jelaila,  115 
Starseed  transmissions,  211,  237 
Steen,  Claude  E.,  57 
Steiger,  Brad,  29,  88,  96,  131, 
143-144,  237-238,  242 


Steiger,  Francie  Paschal, 
143-144 

Steinman,  William,  57 
Stellar  Community  of 

Enlightened  Ecosystems, 
238 

Stevens,  Wendelle  C.,  168,  221 
Stirling,  Allan  Alexander,  94 
Stockholm  Syndrome,  89 
Stonebrooke,  Pamela,  214 
Stranges,  Frank  E.,  254 
Strieber,  Whitley,  xii,  4-5, 
96-97,  238-239 
Stringfield,  Leonard  H.,  83-84 
Subterranean  kingdoms.  See 
Hollow  earth 

Suicides,  xiii,  30,  246-248 
Sumerian  writings,  25 
Sunar  and  Treena,  239 
Sunderland,  Gaynor,  26 
Swan,  Frances,  12 
Swedenborg,  Emanuel,  68-69 
Swords,  Michael  D.,  4,  270 
Sydney,  Australia,  17-18 
Symmes,  John  Cleves,  xvi,  122 

Tabar,  241 
Taken  (Turner),  67 
Tawa,  241 

Taylor,  Charles,  41-42 
Tecu,  241—242 
Teed,  Cyrus,  122 
Telephone  calls  from 

extraterrestrials,  10-11, 
25,79-81,  145 
Telonic  Research  Center,  269 
Telos,  47 
Teros,  45-46 

The  Terror  That  Comes  in  the 
Night  (Hufford),  193 
Tessman,  Diane,  244 
Texas  as  site  of  occurrence, 
34-35,  233-234 
Thayer,  Velma,  210 
Thee  Elohim,  242 
Theosophists,  104,  114-115, 
122,  133,  215(fig.),  229 
They  Kneiv  Too  Much  about 
Flying  Saucers  (Barker), 
141,  170 

Thompson,  Samuel  Eaton, 

242-243 


Thompson’s  Venusians, 

242-243 

Thorner,  W.  E„  101 
The  Threat  (Jacobs),  96 
Tibus,  244 
Timaeus  (Plato),  31 
Time  travelers,  244—245 
Tin-can  aliens,  245 
Toews,  Edmoana,  1 1 1-1 12 
Toronto  Society  for  Psychical 
Research,  200 
Torrent,  Argentina,  76 
Torres,  Penny,  161 
Townsend,  James,  245 
Transformation  (Strieber),  238 
Traum,  Artie,  101 
Tree-stump  aliens,  245 
Trench,  Brinsley  le  Poer,  225, 
232 

Trigano,  Lyonel,  44 
Tulpa,  245-246 
Turner,  Harry  Joe,  19-20 
Turner,  Karla,  67-68,  214 
Turrell,  Thelma  B.,  30 
The  Two,  246-248 

UFO  and  the  Bible  (Jessup),  135 
The  UFO  Experience  (Hynek), 

62 

UFO  Experience  Support 
Association,  17 
The  UFO  Incident  (film), 
204(fig.) 

UFO  Project,  236 
UFO-Abductions:  A  Dangerous 
Game  (Klass),  5 

UFOs  Confidential!  (Williamson 
and  McCoy),  269 
Ulkt,  249 

Ultraterrestrials,  25-26,  245 
Ummo,  249—252 
Unaware  abductees,  1 8 
Unconscious,  role  in  paranormal 
experience,  xiv 
The  Under-People  (Norman), 

225 

Unholy  Six,  252 

Unveiled  Mysteries  (Ballard),  183 

Uranus,  12 

Vadig,  253-254 
Val  Thor,  254 


290  Index 


Valdar,  255 

Vallee,  Jacques,  66,  102, 
161-162, 251 

Van  Tassel,  George  W,  27-29, 
70,  201,255-256, 
256(fig.),  25 7 

Vaughan,  Alan,  158 
Vegetable  Man,  256-257 
Venudo,  257 
Venus,  visits  to,  21-22, 
149-150 
Venusians,  1 

Adamski’s  contact,  8, 
195-196 
Agharti,  15 
channeling,  76-77 
as  Christians,  254 
contactees,  51-52,  87-88, 
105,  149-150 
dead  extraterrestrials,  82 
Denton’s  Martians  and 
Venusians,  87 
reincarnated  angel,  199 
Thompson’s  Venusians, 
242-243 

traveling  with,  149-150, 
242-243 

Venusian  puppies,  1 54 
visiting  Lemuria,  173 
Weber  as,  21,  172-173 
See  also  VIVenus 
Villanueva  Medina,  Salvador, 
257-258 

Villanueva’s  visitors,  257-258 
Villas-Boas,  Antonio,  64 
VIVenus,  258-259 
Volmo,  259 

Volpe,  Anthony  and  Lynn, 

26-27 

Wales  as  site  of  occurrence,  26, 
157-158,  170 


Walk-ins,  36,  88,  261 
Walton,  Duane,  262-263 
Walton,  Travis,  2,  261-266 
Walton’s  abduction,  261-266 
Wanderers,  95,  266 
Wardrop,  Dennis,  117 
Warminster  mystery,  10—11 
The  Warminster  Mystery 

(Shuttlewood),  10-11 
Watson,  Ron  and  Paula,  56 
Webb,  Walter  N„  52-53,  268 
Weber,  Constance,  20-21, 

20  (fig.),  172-173 
Weiss,  Jann,  23 
Wettlaufer,  Brianna,  28 
Whales.  See  Cetaceans 
When  Prophecy  Fails  (Festinger, 
Riecken,  and  Schachter), 
229,  230 

White,  William  Allen, 

266- 267 
White  Eagle,  266 

The  White  Sands  Incident  (Fry), 
105 

White’s  little  people,  266-267 
Why  We  Are  Here  (Lee),  133 
Wight,  George  D.,  45-47 
Wilcox,  GaryT.,  65-66, 

267- 268 

Wilcox’s  Martians,  65-66, 

267- 268 

Williams,  Edward,  100-101 
Williamson,  George  Hunt,  199, 

268- 270,  269  (fig.) 
Adamski,  George,  and,  8 
communication  by  automatic 

writing,  12—13 
early  contactee  movement, 

70 

EBEs,  94 

extraterrestrials  among  us, 

95 


Lemuria,  157 
and  Martin’s  failed 
prophecies,  231 
migrants,  175 
subversive  aliens  on  Earth, 
252 

Venusians  visiting  Lemuria, 
173 

Wilson,  270-272 
Wisconsin  as  site  of  occurrence, 
64,  239 

With  Mystics  and  Magicians  in 
Tibet  (David-Neel), 
245-246 

Witnessed  (Hopkins),  124 
Woodrew,  Greta,  191 
Woods,  William,  170 
Worlds  beyond  the  Poles 
(Giannini),  151 
Wright,  Elsie,  73-75 
Wyoming  as  site  of  occurrence, 
35-36 

Xeno, 273—274 

Yada  di  Shi’ite,  275 
Yamski,  275-276 
Yarbro,  Chelsea  Quinn,  174 
Yeats,  W.  B.,  103-104 
Y’hova,  276 
Young,  June,  242 
Young,  Kenny,  57 

Zagga,  277 
Zamora,  Lonnie,  65 
Zandark,  277 

Ziff-Davis  publications,  156 
Zinsstag,  Lou,  95,  196 
Zollner,  Johann  F.  C.,  104 
Zolton,  277-278 
Zundel,  Ernst,  123